Loading...
The URL can be used to link to this page
Your browser does not support the video tag.
MARSHALL STREET WRF PROCESS CONTROL GATES REPAIRS - FDEP - 18-0047-UT
TO: BRIGHT AND BEAUTIFUL • BAY TO BEACH ENGINEERING DEPARTMENT Owen Kohler, Assistant City Attorney Jon P. Jennings, City Manager's Office Frank Hibbard, Mayor City of Clearwater Rosemarie Call, City Clerk's Office FROM: Engineering Contract & Procurement Specialist DATE: July 26th, 2022 RE: Marshall Street WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) Project No. 18 -0047 -UT Attached are the contract documents awaiting review and approval for the above noted project. Once signed, please route to the next person for signature. City Council approved this contract on June 16th, 2022. Should you have any questions, please contact Shawna Blauvelt. Thank you. ROUTING: City Attorney - Owen Kohler Er City Manager's Office - Jon P. Jennings City Mayor's Office - Frank Hibbard ❑ City Clerk's Office - Rosemarie Call ❑ City Engineers Office - Shawna Blauvelt DATE: • • Marshall Street WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) (18 -0047 -UT) CONTRACT DOCUMENTS & SPECIFICATIONS Prepared for BRIGHT AND BEAUTIFUL • BAY TO BEACH Bid Specifications • September/2021 City of Clearwater, Florida Marshall Street WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) (18 0047 -UT) TABLE OF CONTENTS SECTION I ADVERTISEMENT OF BIDS & NOTICE TO CONTRACTORS SECTION II INSTRUCTIONS TO BIDDERS SECTION III GENERAL CONDITIONS SECTION IV TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS SECTION IVa SUPPLEMENTAL TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS APPENDIX OTHER PROJECT DOCUMENTATION SECTION V CONTRACT DOCUMENTS Prepared in the Office of the City Engineer COVER Page II Updated 2/11/2016 • • • • • • INVITATION TO BID NOTICE TO CONTRACTORS Marshall Street WRF Process Control Gate Repairs (FDEP) Documents and plans for Project # 18 -0047 -UT are available at www.myclearwater.com/bid. The work includes: Design improvements include the replacement of the existing slide gates within the aeration basins 4-13. While the basins are isolated and drained for gate replacement, the Contractor will remove all accumulated grit in the aeration basins, replace damaged or missing elements of the diffused air system and make structural repairs as noted on the plans. Pre -Bid Conference: Wednesday, March 16, 2022 @ 10 am Zoom Meeting: Meeting ID: 824 8425 1006 Passcode: 753789 Site visit following zoom meeting. Pre -qualification DEADLINE: April 4, 2022 Category: Wastewater Treatment Facilities Pre -qualification Amount: $2.5 Million Bids DUE: April 27, 2022 J3id Opening: Wednesday, April 27, 2022 @ 2 pm Zoom Meeting: Meeting ID: 895 1008 1037 Passcode: 514460 City of Clearwater, Project # 18 -0047 -UT Procurement Office, 3rd Floor 100 S. Myrtle Ave, Clearwater, FL 33756-5520 Issued by Lori Vogel, CPPB, Procurement Manager For additional information contact Engineering Dept.: 727-562-4750 SECTION II INSTRUCTIONS TO BIDDERS Table of Contents SECTION II i INSTRUCTIONS TO BIDDERS 1 1. COPIES OF BIDDING DOCUMENTS 1 2. QUALIFICATION OF BIDDERS 1 3. EXAMINATION OF CONTRACT DOCUMENTS AND SITE 1 4. INTERPRETATIONS AND ADDENDA 2 5. BID SECURITY OR BID BOND 3 6. CONTRACT TIME 3 7. LIQUIDATED DAMAGES 3 8. SUBSTITUTE MATERIAL AND EQUIPMENT 3 9. SUBCONTRACTORS 3 10. BID/PROPOSAL FORM 4 11. SUBMISSION OF BIDS 4 12. MODIFICATION AND WITHDRAWAL OF BIDS 5 13. REJECTION OF BIDS 5 14. DISQUALIFICATION OF BIDDER 5 15. OPENING OF BIDS 5 16. LICENSES, PERMITS, ROYALTY FEES AND TAXES 5 17. IDENTICAL TIE BIDS/VENDOR DRUG FREE WORKPLACE 6 18. AWARD OF CONTRACT 7 19. BID PROTEST 7 20. TRENCH SAFETY ACT 8 21. CONSTRUCTION SITE EROSION AND SEDIMENT CONTROL MANAGEMENT MEASURES 9 SECTION II i Updated 07/13/2020 SECTION II — Instructions to Bidders 1. COPIES OF BIDDING DOCUMENTS • 1.1. Complete sets of the Bidding Documents are accessible through the City of Clearwater website at address: www.myclearwater.com/bid. Bidding Documents may include, but are not limited to, plans, specifications, bond forms, contract form, affidavits, bid/proposal form, and addendums. 1.2. Complete sets of Bidding Documents must be used in preparing bids. Neither the City nor the Engineer shall be liable for errors or misinterpretations resulting from the use of incomplete sets of Bidding Documents, by Bidders, sub -bidders, or others. • • 2. QUALIFICATION OF BIDDERS 2.1. Each prospective Bidder must pre -qualify to demonstrate, to the complete satisfaction of the City of Clearwater, that the Bidder has the necessary facilities, equipment, ability, financial resources and experience to perform the work in a satisfactory manner. An application package for pre -qualification may be obtained by contacting the City of Clearwater, Engineering Department, P.O. Box 4748, Clearwater, Florida 33758-4748 (mailing address); 100 South Myrtle Avenue, Clearwater, Florida 33756-5520 (street address) or by phone at (727) 562-4750. Pre -qualification requirement information is also available on the City of Clearwater Website at address: www.myclearwater.com/government/city-departments/engineering/construction- management. Contractors wanting to pre -qualify to bid on a project as a General Contractor must do so two weeks (ten workdays) prior to the bid opening date. Bidders currently pre -qualified by the City do not have to make reapplication. It is the Contractor's responsibility to confirm pre - qualification status before a Bid Opening. The Contractor shall provide copies of the current Contractor License/Registration with the State of Florida and Pinellas County in the bid response. 3. EXAMINATION OF CONTRACT DOCUMENTS AND SITE 3.1. It is the responsibility of each Bidder, before submitting a Bid, to (a) examine the Contract Documents thoroughly; (b) visit the site to become familiar with local conditions that may in any manner affect cost, progress, performance or furnishing of the work; (c) consider and abide by all applicable federal, state and local laws, ordinances, rules and regulations; and (d) study and carefully correlate Bidder's observations with the Contract Documents, and notify Engineer in writing of all conflicts, errors or discrepancies in the Contract Documents. 3.2. For the purposes of bidding or construction, bidder may rely upon the accuracy of the technical data contained in reports of explorations and tests of subsurface conditions at the site which have been utilized by the Engineer in the preparation of the Contract Documents, but not upon non-technical data, interpretations or opinions contained therein or for the completeness thereof. Drawings relating to physical conditions of existing surface and subsurface conditions (except Underground Facilities) which are at or contiguous to the site and which have been utilized by the Engineer in preparation of the Contract Documents, may be relied upon by Bidder for accuracy of the technical data contained in such drawings but not upon the completeness thereof for the purposes of bidding or construction. SECTION II Page 1 of 9 Updated 07/13/2020 SECTION II — Instructions to Bidders 3.3. Information and data reflected in the Contract Documents with respect to Underground Facilities at or contiguous to the site are based upon information and data furnished to the City and Engineer by owners of such Underground Facilities or others, and the City does not assume responsibility for the accuracy or completeness thereof unless expressly provided in the Contract Documents. 3.4. Provisions concerning responsibilities for the adequacy of data furnished to prospective Bidders on subsurface conditions, Underground Facilities, other physical conditions, possible conditions, and possible changes in the Contract Documents due to differing conditions appear in the General Conditions. 3.5. Before submitting a Bid, each Bidder shall, at Bidder's own expense, make or obtain any additional examinations, investigations, explorations, tests and studies and obtain any additional information and data which pertain to the physical conditions (surface, subsurface and Underground Facilities) at or contiguous to the site or otherwise which may affect cost, progress, performance or furnishing the work in accordance with the time, price and other terms and conditions of the Contract Documents. 3.6. On request in advance, City will provide each Bidder access to the site to conduct such explorations and tests at Bidder's own expense as each Bidder deems necessary for submission of a Bid. Bidder shall fill all holes and clean up and restore the site to its former condition upon completion of such explorations and tests. 3.7. The lands upon which the Work is to be performed, rights-of-way and easements for access thereto and other lands designated for use by the Contractor in performing the Work are identified in the Contract Documents. All additional lands and access thereto required for temporary construction facilities or storage of materials and equipment are to be provided by the Contractor. Easements for permanent structures or permanent changes in existing structures are to be obtained and paid for by the City unless otherwise provided in the Contract Documents. 3.8. The submission of a Bid will constitute an unequivocal representation by the Bidder that the Bidder has complied with every requirement of these Instructions to Bidders and that, without exception, the Bid is premised upon performing and furnishing the Work required by the Contract Documents by such means, methods, techniques, sequences or procedures of construction as may be indicated in or required by the Contract Documents, and that the Contract Documents are sufficient in scope and detail to indicate and convey understanding of all terms and conditions of performance and furnishing of the work. 4. INTERPRETATIONS AND ADDENDA 4.1. All questions as to the meaning or intent of the Contract Documents are to be directed in writing to the Engineer. Interpretations or clarifications considered necessary by the Engineer in response to such questions will be issued by Addenda, via the Jiffy Reprographics Plan Room to all parties recorded by the Plan Room as plan holders having received the Bidding Documents. Questions received after the time frame specified on the pre-bid meeting agenda, prior to the date for opening of Bids, may not be answered. Only information provided by formal written Addenda will be binding. Oral and other interpretations of clarifications will be without legal effect. 4.2. Addenda may also be issued to modify the Bidding Documents as deemed advisable by the City or Engineer. SECTION II Page 2 of 9 Updated 07/13/2020 SECTION II — Instructions to Bidders 5. BID SECURITY OR BID BOND • 5.1. Each Bid must be accompanied by Bid Security made payable to the City of Clearwater in an amount equal to ten percent (10%) of the Bidder's maximum Bid price and in the form of a certified or cashier's check or a Proposal/Bid Bond (on form provided in Section V) issued by a surety meeting the requirements of the General Conditions. 5.2. The Bid Security of the Successful Bidder will be retained until such Bidder has executed the Agreement and furnished the required Payment and Performance bonds, whereupon the Bid Security will be returned. If the Successful Bidder fails to execute, deliver the Agreement and furnish the required Bonds within ten (10) days after the award of contract by the City Council, the City may annul the bid and the Bid Security of the Bidder will be forfeited. The Bid Security of any Bidder whom the City believes to have a reasonable chance of receiving the award may be retained by the City until the successful execution of the agreement with the successful Bidder or for a period up to ninety (90) days following bid opening. Security of other Bidders will be returned approximately fourteen (14) days after the Bid Opening. 5.3. The Bid Bond shall be issued in the favor of the City of Clearwater by a surety company qualified to do business in, and having a registered agent in, the State of Florida. 6. CONTRACT TIME 6.1. The number of consecutive calendar days within which the work is to be completed is set forth in the Technical Specifications. 7. LIQUIDATED DAMAGES • 7.1. Provisions for liquidated damages are set forth in the Contract Agreement, Section V. 8. SUBSTITUTE MATERIAL AND EQUIPMENT 8.1. The contract, if awarded, will be on the basis of material and equipment described in the Drawings or specified in the Specifications without consideration of possible substitute or "or equal" items. Whenever it is indicated in the Drawings or specified in the Specifications that a substitute or "or equal" item may be furnished or used, application for its acceptance will not be considered by the Engineer until after the effective date of the Contract Agreement. The procedure for submittal of any such application is described in the General Conditions and as supplemented in the Technical Specifications. 9. SUBCONTRACTORS 9.1. If requested by the City or Engineer, the Successful Bidder, and any other Bidder so requested, shall, within seven (7) days after the date of the request, submit to the Engineer an experience statement with pertinent information as to similar projects and other evidence of qualification for each Subcontractor, supplier, person and organization to be used by the Contractor in the completion of the Work. The amount of subcontract work shall not exceed fifty percent (50%) of the Work except as may be specifically approved by the Engineer. If the Engineer, after due investigation, has reasonable objection to any proposed Subcontractor, supplier, other person or organization, he may, before recommending award of the Contract to the City Council, request the Successful Bidder to submit an acceptable substitute without an increase in Contract Price or Contract Time. If the Successful Bidder declines to make any such substitution, the City may award the contract to the next lowest and most responsive Bidder SECTION II Page 3 of 9 Updated 07/13/2020 SECTION II — Instructions to Bidders that proposes to use acceptable Subcontractors, Suppliers, and other persons and organizations. Declining to make requested substitutions will not constitute grounds for sacrificing the Bid Security to the City of any Bidder. Any Subcontractor, supplier, other person or organization listed by the Contractor and to whom the Engineer does not make written objection prior to the recommendation of award to the City Council will be deemed acceptable to the City subject to revocation of such acceptance after the Effective Date of the Contract Agreement as provided in the General Conditions. 9.2. No Contractor shall be required to employ any Subcontractor, supplier, person, or organization against whom he has reasonable objection. 10. BID/PROPOSAL FORM 10.1. The Bid/Proposal Form is included with the Contract Documents and shall be printed in ink or typewritten. All blanks on the Bid/Proposal Forms must be completed. Unit Prices shall be to no more than two decimal points in dollars and cents. The Bidder must state in the Bid/Proposal Form in words and numerals without delineation's, alterations or erasures, the price for which they will perform the work as required by the Contract Documents. Bidders are required to bidonall items in the Bid/Proposal form. The lump sum for each section or item shall be for furnishing all equipment, materials, and labor for completing the section or item as per the plans and contract specifications. Should it be found that quantities or amounts shown on the plans or in the proposal, for any part of the work, are exceeded or should they be found to be less after the actual construction of the work, the amount bid for each section or item will be increased or decreased in direct proportion to the unit prices bid for the listed individual items. 10.2. Bids by corporations shall be executed in the corporate name by the president or a vice- president (or other corporate officer accompanied by evidence of authority to sign) and the corporate seal shall be affixed. The corporate address and state of incorporation shall be shown below the Signature. If requested, the person signing a Bid for a corporation or partnership shall produce evidence satisfactory to the City of the person's authority to bind the corporation or partnership. 10.3. Bids by partnerships shall be executed in the partnership name and signed by a general partner, whose title shall appear under the signature and the official address of the partnership shall be shown below the signature. 10.4. All names shall be typed or printed below the signature. 11. SUBMISSION OF BIDS 11.1. Sealed Bids shall be submitted at or before the time and at the place indicated in the Advertisement for Bids and shall be submitted in a sealed envelope with the project name and number on the bottom left hand corner. If forwarded by mail, the Bid shall be enclosed in another envelope with the notation "Bid Enclosed" on the face thereof and addressed to the City of Clearwater, attention Purchasing Manager. Bids will be received at the office indicated in the Advertisement until the time and date specified. Bids in any other form will not be accepted. 11.2. The sealed bid envelope shall contain, but not be limited to, the Proposal/Bid Bond and corresponding Power of Attorney, Affidavit, Non Collusion Affidavit, Proposal (pages one SECTION II Page 4 of 9 Updated 07/13/2020 • SECTION II — Instructions to Bidders and two), Addendum Sheet, Bidder's Proposal, and Scrutinized Companies and Business Operations with Cuba and Syria Certification Form. 12. MODIFICATION AND WITHDRAWAL OF BIDS 12.1. Bids may be modified or withdrawn by an appropriate document duly executed (in the manner that a Bid must be executed) and delivered as described in the Advertisement of Bids. A request for withdrawal or a modification shall be in writing and signed by a person duly authorized to do so. Withdrawal of a Bid will not prejudice the rights of a Bidder to submit a new Bid prior to the Bid Date and Time. After expiration of the period for receiving Bids, no Bid may be withdrawn or modified. 12.2. After a bid is received by the City, the bidder may request to modify the bid for typographical or scrivener's errors only. The bidder must state in writing to the City that a typographical or scrivener's error has been made by the bidder, the nature of the error, the requested correction of the error, and what the adjusted bid amount will be if the correction is accepted by the City. The City reserves the right at its sole discretion to accept, reject, or modify any bid. 13. REJECTION OF BIDS 13.1. To the extent permitted by applicable State and Federal laws and regulations, the City reserves the right to reject any, and all Bids, and to waive any, and all informalities. Grounds for the rejection of a bid include but are not limited to a material omission, unauthorized alteration of form, unauthorized alternate bids, incomplete or unbalanced unit prices, or irregularities of any kind. Also, the City reserves the right to reject any Bid if the City believes that it would not be in the best interest of the public to make an award to that Bidder, whether because the Bid is not responsive or the Bidder is unqualified or of doubtful financial ability or fails to meet any other pertinent standard or criteria established by the City. The City reserves the right to decide which bid is deemed to be the lowest and best in the interest of the public. 14. DISQUALIFICATION OF BIDDER 14.1. Any or all bids will be rejected if there is any reason for believing that collusion exists among the bidders, the participants in such collusion will not be considered in future proposals for the same work. Each bidder shall execute the Non -Collusion Affidavit contained in the Contract Documents. 15. OPENING OF BIDS 15.1. Bids will be opened and read publicly at the location and time stated in the Advertisement for Bids. Bidders are invited to be present at the opening of bids. 16. LICENSES, PERMITS, ROYALTY FEES AND TAXES 16.1. The Contractor shall secure all licenses and permits (and shall pay all permit fees) except as specifically stated otherwise in the Technical Specifications. The Contractor shall comply with all Federal and State Laws, County and Municipal Ordinances and regulations, which in any manner effect the prosecution of the work. City of Clearwater building permit fees and impact fees will be waived except as specifically stated otherwise in the Technical Specifications. SECTION II Page 5 of 9 Updated 07/13/2020 SECTION II — Instructions to Bidders 16.2. The Contractor shall assume all liability for the payment of royalty fees due to the use of any construction or operation process, which is protected by patent rights except as specifically stated otherwise in the Technical Specifications. The amount of royalty fee, if any, shall be stated by the Contractor. 16.3. The Contractor shall pay all applicable sales, consumer, use, and other taxes required by law. The Contractor is responsible for reviewing the pertinent State Statutes involving the sales tax and sales tax exemptions and complying with all requirements. 16.4. The City of Clearwater is exempt from state sales tax on materials purchased by the City and incorporated into the WORK. The City of Clearwater reserves the right to implement the Owner Direct Purchase (ODP) Option, as may be indicated in the Scope of Work Description in Section IV — Technical Specifications and as defined in Section III — General Conditions. 17. IDENTICAL TIE BIDSNENDOR DRUG FREE WORKPLACE 17.1. In accordance with the requirements of Section 287.087 Florida Statutes regarding a Vendor Drug Free Workplace, in the event of identical tie bids, preference shall be given to bidders with drug-free workplace programs. Whenever two or more bids which are equal with respect to price, quality, and service are received by the City for the procurement of commodities or contractual services, a bid received from a business that certifies that it has implemented a drug-free workplace program shall be given preference in the award process. Established procedures for processing tie bids will be followed if none or all of the tied bidders have a drug-free workplace program. In order to have a drug-free workplace program, a contractor shall supply the City with a certificate containing the following six statements and the accompanying certification statement: (1) Publish a statement notifying employees that the unlawful manufacture, distribution, dispensing, possession, or use of a controlled substance is prohibited in the workplace and specifying the actions that will be taken against employees for violations of such prohibition. (2) Inform employees as to the dangers of drug abuse in the workplace, the business's policy of maintaining a drug-free workplace, any available drug counseling, rehabilitation, and employee assistance programs, and the penalties that may be imposed upon employees for drug abuse violations. (3) Give each employee engaged in providing the commodities or contractual services that are under bid a copy of the statement specified in subsection (1). (4) In the statement specified in subsection (1), notify the employees that, as a condition of working on the commodities or contractual services that are under bid, the employee will abide by the terms of the statement and will notify the employer of any conviction of, or plea of guilty or nolo contendere to, any violation of chapter 893, or of any controlled substance law, of the United States, or of any state, for a violation occurring in the workplace no later than five (5) days after such conviction. (5) Impose a sanction on or require the satisfactory participation in a drug abuse assistance or rehabilitation program if such is available in the employee's community, by any employee who is so convicted. (6) Make a good faith effort to continue to maintain a drug-free workplace through implementation of this section. I certify that this firm does/does not (select only one) fully comply with the above requirements. SECTION II Page 6 of 9 Updated 07/13/2020 SECTION II — Instructions to Bidders 18. AWARD OF CONTRACT • 18.1. Discrepancies between words and figures will be resolved in favor of words. Discrepancies in the multiplication of units of work and unit prices will be resolved in favor of the unit prices. Discrepancies between the indicated sum of any column of figures and the correct sum thereof will be resolved in favor of the correct sum. 18.2. In evaluating the Bids, the City will consider the qualifications of the Bidders, whether the Bids comply or not with the prescribed requirements, unit prices, and other data as may be requested in the Bid/Proposal form. The City may consider the qualifications and experience of Subcontractors, suppliers and other persons and organizations proposed by the Contractor for the Work. The City may conduct such investigations as the City deems necessary to assist in the evaluation of any Bid and to establish the responsibility, qualifications and financial ability of Bidders, proposed Subcontractors, Suppliers and other persons, and organizations to perform and furnish the Work in accordance with the Contract Documents to the City's satisfaction within the prescribed time. 18.3. If the Contract is to be awarded, it will be awarded to the lowest responsible, responsive Bidder whose evaluation by the City indicates to the City that the award will be in the best interest of the City. 18.4. Award of contract will be made for that combination of base bid and altemate bid items in the best interest of the City, however, unless otherwise specified all work awarded will be awarded to only one Contractor. 18.5. The successful bidder/contractor will be required to comply with Section 119.0701, Florida • Statutes (2014), specifically to: (a) Keep and maintain public records that ordinarily and necessarily would be required by the City of Clearwater in order to perform the service; (b) Provide the public with access to public records on the same terms and conditions that the City of Clearwater would provide the records and at a cost that does not exceed the cost provided in this chapter or as otherwise provided by law; (c) Ensure that public records that are exempt or confidential and exempt from public records disclosure requirements are not disclosed except as authorized by law; and (d) Meet all requirements for retaining public records and transfer, at no cost, to the City of Clearwater all public records in possession of the contractor upon termination of the contract and destroy any duplicate public records that are exempt or confidential and exempt from public records disclosure requirements. All records stored electronically must be provided to the public agency in a format that is compatible with the information technology systems of the City of Clearwater. 19. BID PROTEST • 19.1. RIGHT TO PROTEST: Any actual bidder who is aggrieved in connection with the solicitation or award of a contract may seek resolution of his/her complaints initially with the Purchasing Manager, and if not satisfied, with the City Manager, in accordance with protest procedures set forth in this section. 19.2. PROTEST PROCEDURE: SECTION II Page 7 of 9 Updated 07/13/2020 SECTION II — Instructions to Bidders A. A protest with respect to the specifications of an invitation for bid or request for proposal shall be submitted in writing a minimum of five (5) work days prior to the opening of the bid or due date of the request for proposals, unless the aggrieved person could not have been reasonably expected to have knowledge of the facts giving rise to such protest prior to the bid opening or the closing date for proposals. Opening dates for bids or due dates for requests for proposal will be printed on the bid/request document itself B. Protests in respect to award of contract shall be submitted in writing a maximum of five (5) workdays after notice of intent to award is posted, or is mailed to each bidder, whichever is earlier. Notice of intent to award will be forwarded to bidders upon telephonic or written request. Protests of recommended award should cite specific portions of the City of Clearwater Code of Ordinances that have allegedly been violated. C. Exceptions to the five (5) day requirements noted in both A and B above may be granted if the aggrieved person could have not been reasonably expected to have knowledge of the facts giving rise to such protest prior to the bid opening, posting of intent to award, or due date for requests for proposals. Request for exceptions should be made in writing, stating reasons for the exception. D. The Purchasing Manager shall respond to the formal written protest within five (5) workdays of receipt. The Purchasing Manager's response will be fully coordinated with the appropriate Department Director and the Assistant City Manager. E. If the protestor is not satisfied with the response from the Purchasing Manager, he/she may then submit in writing within five (5) work days of receipt of that response his/her reason for dissatisfaction, along with copies of his/her original formal protest letter and the response from the Purchasing Manager, to the City Manager. F. The City Manager as Purchasing Agent for the City has the fmal authority in the matter of protests. The City Manager will respond to the protestor within ten (10) workdays of receipt of the appeal. 19.3. PROTEST FEE: When filing a formal protest, the protesting vendor must include a fee in the amount of 5% of the selected vendor's total bid to offset the City's additional expenses related to the protest. This fee shall not exceed $2,500 nor be less than $50. If either the Purchasing Manager or the City Manager upholds the protest, the City will refund 100% of the fee paid. 19.4. STAY OF PROCUREMENT DURING PROTEST: In the event of a timely protest, the Purchasing Manager shall not proceed with the solicitation or award of contract until all administrative remedies have been exhausted or until the City Manager makes written determination that the award of contract without delay is necessary to protect the best interest of the City. 20. TRENCH SAFETY ACT 20.1. The Bidder shall comply with the provisions of the City of Clearwater's Ordinance related to trench digging (Ordinance No. 7918-08) along with the Florida Trench Safety Act (Sections 553.60-553.64, Florida Statutes) and the provisions of the Occupational Safety and Health Administration's (OSHA) excavation safety standards, 29 C.F.R.s 1926.650 Subparagraph P, or current revisions of these laws. SECTION II Page 8 of 9 Updated 07/13/2020 SECTION II — Instructions to Bidders 21. CONSTRUCTION SITE EROSION AND SEDIMENT CONTROL • MANAGEMENT MEASURES 21.1. The Bidder shall comply with the provisions of the Environmental Protection Agency (EPA) National Pollution Discharge Elimination System (NPDES) stormwater permit and implement stormwater pollution prevention plans (SWPPP's) or stormwater management programs (both using best management practices (BMPs) that effectively reduce or prevent the discharge of pollutants into receiving waters. A. The control of construction -related sediment loadings is critical to maintaining water quality. The implementation of proper erosion and sediment control practices during the construction stage can significantly reduce sediment loadings to surface waters. B. Prior to land disturbance, prepare and implement an approved erosion and sediment control plan or similar administrative document that contains erosion and sediment control provisions. NPDES Management Measures available at City of Clearwater Engineering Environmental Division and EPA websites to help address construction -related Best Management Practices. • • SECTION 11 Page 9 of 9 Updated 07/13/2020 SECTION III GENERAL CONDITIONS • Table of Contents: 1. DEFINITIONS 1 2. PRELIMINARY MATTERS 5 2.1. DELIVERY OF BONDS AND CERTIFICATES OF INSURANCE 5 2.2. COPIES OF DOCUMENTS 5 2.3. COMMENCEMENT OF CONTRACT TIME/NOTICE TO PROCEED, STARTING THE PROJECT 5 2.4. BEFORE STARTING CONSTRUCTION 5 2.5. PRECONSTRUCTION CONFERENCE 6 2.6. PROGRESS MEETINGS 6 3. CONTRACT DOCUMENTS, INTENT 6 3.1. INTENT 6 3.2. REPORTING AND RESOLVING DISCREPANCIES 7 4. AVAILABILITY OF LANDS, SUBSURFACE AND PHYSICAL CONDITIONS, REFERENCE POINTS 7 4.1. AVAILABILITY OF LANDS 7 4.2. INVESTIGATIONS AND REPORTS 7 4.3. PHYSICAL CONDITIONS, UNDERGROUND FACILITIES 8 4.4. REFERENCE POINTS 8 • 5. BONDS AND INSURANCE 9 5.1. PERFORMANCE AND PAYMENT BOND/CONTRACT BOND 9 5.2. INSURANCE REQUIREMENTS 9 5.2.1. COMMERCIAL GENERAL LIABILITY INSURANCE 9 5.2.2. COMMERCIAL AUTOMOBILE LIABILITY INSURANCE 10 5.2.3. WORKERS' COMPENSATION AND EMPLOYER'S LIABILITY INSURANCE10 5.2.4. PROFESSIONAL LIABILITY/MALPRACTICE/ERRORS OR OMISSIONS INSURANCE 10 5.2.5. CONTRACTOR'S EQUIPMENT/INLAND MARINE/PROPERTY INSURANCE10 5.2.6. BUILDER'S RISK INSURANCE 10 5.3. OTHER INSURANCE PROVISIONS 10 5.4. WAIVER OF RIGHTS 11 6. CONTRACTOR'S RESPONSIBILITIES 12 6.1. SUPERVISION AND SUPERINTENDENCE 12 6.2. LABOR, MATERIALS AND EQUIPMENT 12 6.3. SUBSTITUTES AND "OR EQUAL" ITEMS 13 6.4. SUBCONTRACTORS, SUPPLIERS AND OTHERS 13 6.5. USE OF PREMISES 14 6.5.1. STAGING AREAS 15 6.5.2. RESTORATION TIME LIMITS 15 6.6. LICENSE AND PATENT FEES, ROYALTIES AND TAXES 15 6.7. LAWS AND REGULATIONS 16 • 6.7.1. E -VERIFY 16 6.8. PERMITS 16 SECTION III i Updated 6/1/2021 SECTION III — General Conditions 6.9. SAFETY AND PROTECTION 17 6.10. EMERGENCIES 18 • 6.11. DRAWINGS 18 6.11.1. SHOP DRAWINGS, SAMPLES, RFIs, AND SUBMITTAL REVIEW 18 6.11.2. AS -BUILT DRAWINGS 19 6.11.3. CAD STANDARDS 21 6.11.4. DELIVERABLES 23 6.12. CONTRACTOR'S GENERAL WARRANTY AND GUARANTEE 23 6.13. CONTINUING THE WORK 23 6.14. INDEMNIFICATION 24 6.15. CHANGES IN COMPANY CONTACT INFORMATION 24 6.16. PUBLIC RECORDS 24 7. OTHER WORK 25 7.1. RELATED WORK AT SITE 25 7.2. COORDINATION 26 8. OWNER'S RESPONSIBILITY 26 9. OWNER REPRESENTATIVE'S STATUS DURING CONSTRUCTION 26 9.1. OWNER'S REPRESENTATIVE 26 9.2. CLARIFICATIONS AND INTERPRETATIONS 27 9.3. REJECTING OF DEFECTIVE WORK 27 9.4. SHOP DRAWINGS, CHANGE ORDERS, AND PAYMENTS 27 9.5. DECISIONS ON DISPUTES 27 • 9.6. LIMITATIONS ON OWNER REPRESENTATIVE'S RESPONSIBILITIES 28 10. CHANGES IN THE WORK 29 11. CHANGES IN THE CONTRACT PRICE 29 11.1. CHANGES IN THE CONTRACT PRICE 29 11.2. ALLOWANCES AND FINAL CONTRACT PRICE ADJUSTMENT 31 11.3. UNIT PRICE WORK 31 12. CHANGES IN THE CONTRACT TIME 31 13. TESTS AND INSPECTIONS, CORRECTION, REMOVAL OR ACCEPTANCE OF DEFECTIVE WORK 32 13.1. TESTS AND INSPECTION 32 13.2. UNCOVERING THE WORK 33 13.3. OWNER'S REPRESENTATIVE MAY STOP THE WORK 33 13.4. CORRECTION OR REMOVAL OF DEFECTIVE WORK 33 13.5. WARRANTY/CORRECTION PERIOD 34 13.6. ACCEPTANCE OF DEFECTIVE WORK 34 13.7. OWNER MAY CORRECT DEFECTIVE WORK 34 14. PAYMENTS TO CONTRACTOR AND COMPLETION 35 14.1. APPLICATION FOR PROGRESS PAYMENT 35 14.2. CONTRACTOR'S WARRANTY OF TITLE 36 14.3. REVIEW OF APPLICATIONS FOR PROGRESS PAYMENTS 36 14.4. PARTIAL UTILIZATION 37 14.5. FINAL INSPECTION 37 • 14.6. FINAL APPLICATION FOR PAYMENT 37 14.7. FINAL PAYMENT AND ACCEPTANCE 38 14.8. WAIVER OF CLAIMS 38 SECTION III ii Updated 6/1/2021 SECTION III — General Conditions 15. SUSPENSION OF WORK AND TERMINATION 39 15.1. OWNER MAY SUSPEND THE WORK 39 15.2. OWNER MAY TERMINATE 39 15.3. CONTRACTOR MAY STOP WORK OR TERMINATE 40 16. DISPUTE RESOLUTION 40 17. MISCELLANEOUS 41 17.1. SUBMITTAL AND DOCUMENT FORMS 41 17.2. GIVING NOTICE 41 17.3. NOTICE OF CLAIM 41 17.4. PROFESSIONAL FEES AND COURT COSTS INCLUDED 41 17.5. ASSIGNMENT OF CONTRACT 41 17.6. RENEWAL OPTION 41 17.7. ROLL -OFF CONTAINERS AND/OR DUMPSTERS 42 18. ORDER AND LOCATION OF THE WORK 42 19. MATERIAL USED 42 20. CONFLICT BETWEEN PLANS AND SPECIFICATIONS 42 21. OWNER DIRECT PURCHASE (ODP) 42 21.1. SALES TAX SAVINGS 42 21.2. TITLE AND OWNER RISK 43 21.3. CONTRACTOR'S RECEIPT OF MATERIALS 43 21.4. ODP RECORDS, WARRANTIES, AND INDEMNIFICATION 44 22. RESIDENT NOTIFICATION OF START OF CONSTRUCTION 44 22.1. GENERAL 44 22.2. EXAMPLE 45 23. PROJECT INFORMATION SIGNS 45 23.1. SCOPE AND PURPOSE 45 23.2. PROJECT SIGN, FIXED OR PORTABLE 46 23.3. FIXED SIGN 46 23.4. PORTABLE SIGNS 46 23.5. SIGN COLORING 46 23.6. SIGN PLACEMENT 46 23.7. SIGN MAINTENANCE 46 23.8. TYPICAL PROJECT SIGN 47 24. AWARD OF CONTRACT, WORK SCHEDULE AND GUARANTEE 47 25. SCRUTINIZED COMPANIES AND BUSINESS OPERATIONS WITH CUBA AND SYRIA CERTIFICATION FORM AND ISRAEL CERTIFICATION FORM 48 SECTION III iii Updated 6/1/2021 • • • SECTION III — General Conditions 1. DEFINITIONS Addenda Written or graphic instruments issued prior to the opening of Bids which clarify, correct, or change the Bidding Requirements or the contract documents. Agent Architect, engineer or other outside agency, consultant or person acting on behalf of the City. Agreement The written contract between Owner and Contractor covering the Work to be performed; other Contract Documents are attached to the Agreement and made a part thereof as provided therein. Application for Payment The form accepted by Engineer which is to be used by Contractor in requesting progress or final payments and which is to be accompanied by such supporting documentation as is required by the Contract Documents. Approve The word approve is defined to mean satisfactory review of the material, equipment, or methods for general compliance with the design concepts and with the information given in the Contract Documents. It does not imply a responsibility on the part of the Engineer to verify in every detail conformance with the Drawings and Specifications. Bid The offer or proposal of the bidder submitted on the prescribed form setting forth the prices for the work to be performed. Bidding Documents The advertisement or invitation to Bid, instructions to bidders, the Bid form, and the proposed Contact Documents (including all Addenda issued prior to receipt of Bids). Bonds Performance and payment bonds and other instruments of security. Change Order A written order to Contractor signed by Owner and Contractor authorizing an addition, deletion or revision in the Work, or an adjustment in the Contract Price or the Contract Time issued on or after the effective date of the Agreement. City The City of Clearwater, Pinellas County, Florida. Construction Inspector A person who is the authorized representative of the Construction Manager and inspects City construction projects in order to ensure the Contractor's work complies with the intent of the Contract Documents. Construction Manager The person who is typically in responsible charge of City construction projects. The Construction Manager assumes responsibility for the management of construction contracts at the Preconstruction Conference. The Construction Manager chairs the Preconstruction Conference and is the authority on any disputes or decisions regarding SECTION III Page 1 of 49 Updated 6/1/2021 SECTION III — General Conditions contract administration and performance. The Construction Manager typically acts as the Owner's Representative during construction. Contract Documents The Agreement, Addenda (which pertain to the Contract Documents), Contractor's Bid (including documentation accompanying the bid and any post -Bid documentation submitted prior to the execution of the Agreement) when attached as an exhibit to the Agreement, the Bonds, Instructions to Bidders, these General Conditions, any Supplementary Conditions, the Specifications and the Drawings, any other exhibits identified in the Agreement, together with all Modifications issued after the execution of the Agreement. Contract Price The Contract price constitutes the total compensation (subject to authorized adjustments) payable by Owner to Contractor for performing the Work. Contract Time The number of days or the date stated in the Agreement for the completion of the Work. Contractor The Person with whom the Owner has entered into the Agreement. For the purposes of this contract, the person, firm, or corporation with whom this contract or agreement has been made by the City of Clearwater or its duly authorized representative. Critical Path Method Construction Schedule (CPM) A graphic format construction schedule that displays construction activities as they relate to one another for the purpose of identifying the most efficient way to perform the work in a timely manner. The critical path identifies which activity is critical to the execution of the schedule. Day A calendar day of twenty-four (24) hours measured from midnight to the next midnight. Defective An adjective which when modifying the word Work refers to Work that is unsatisfactory, faulty or deficient, or does not conform to the Contract Documents or does not meet the requirements of any inspection, reference standard, test or approval referred to in the Contract Documents, or has been damaged prior to Engineers recommendation of final payment. Drawings The drawings, which will be identified in Technical Specifications or the Agreement, which show the character and scope of the Work to be performed and which have been prepared or approved by Engineer and are referred to in the contract documents. Shop drawings are not Drawings as so defined. Engineer The duly appointed representative of the City Manager of the City of Clearwater. For the purposes of this contract, the City Engineer of the City of Clearwater, Pinellas County, Florida, or his authorized representative. For certain projects, the Engineer may serve as the Owner's Representative during construction. Engineer's Consultant A Person having a contract with Engineer to furnish services as Engineer's independent SECTION III Page 2 of 49 Updated 6/1/2021 SECTION III — General Conditions professional associate or consultant with respect to the Project and who is identified as such in the Supplementary Conditions. F.D. O. T. Specifications The Standard Specifications for Road and Bridge Construction as issued by the Florida Department of Transportation (latest English edition). Furnish The words "furnish", "furnish and install", "install", and "provide" or words of similar meaning shall be interpreted, unless otherwise specifically stated, to mean "furnish and install complete in place and ready for service". Inspection The term "inspection" and the act of inspecting means examination of construction to ensure that it conforms to the design concept expressed in the Drawings and Specifications. These terms shall not be construed to mean supervision, superintending, or overseeing. Laws and Regulations Any and all applicable laws, rules, regulations, ordinances, codes, and orders of any kind of governmental bodies, agencies, authorities, and courts having jurisdiction. Liens Liens, charges, security interests or encumbrances upon real property or personal property. Milestone A principal event specified in the contract Documents relating to an intermediate completion date or time prior to the final completion date. Notice to Proceed (NTP) A written notice given by the Owner to the Contractor fixing the date on which the Contract Time will commence to run and on which Contractor shall start to perform his obligations under the Contract Documents. Owner The City of Clearwater, Florida. For the purposes of this contract, the person who is the City's authorized representative from the City's Department with whom will be responsible for the maintenance and operation of the Work once the Work is completed. For certain projects, a designee of the Owner may serve as the Owner's Representative during construction. Owner's Representative Designee of the Owner with authority to act on behalf of the Owner during construction. Person A natural person, or a corporation, partnership, firm, organization, or other artificial entity. Project The total construction of which the Work to be provided under the Contract Documents may be the whole or a part as indicated elsewhere in the Contract Documents. Partial Utilization Use by Owner of a substantially completed part of the Work for the purpose for which is intended (or a related purpose) prior to Final Completion of all the Work. SECTION III Page 3 of 49 Updated 6/1/2021 SECTION III — General Conditions Representative of Contractor The Contractor shall assign a responsible person or persons, one of whom shall be at the construction site at all times, that work is progressing. The names and positions of these persons shall be submitted to the City Engineer at the time of the pre -construction conference. This person or persons shall not be changed without written approval of City Engineer. Request for Information (RFI) An official written request for clarification of the intent of the contract documents from the Contractor to the Engineer. Shop Drawing All drawings, diagrams, illustrations, schedules and other data which are specifically prepared by or for Contractor to illustrate some portion of the Work and all illustrations, brochures, standard schedules, performance charts, instructions, diagrams and other information prepared by a supplier and submitted by Contractor to illustrate material or equipment for some portion of the Work. Specifications Those portions of the Contract Documents consisting of written technical descriptions of materials, equipment, construction systems, standards and workmanship as applied to the Work and certain administrative details applicable thereto. Subcontractor A person having a direct contract with Contractor or with any other Subcontractor for the performance of a part of the Work at the site. Substantial Completion The Work (or a specified part thereof) which has progressed to the point where, in the opinion of Engineer, as evidenced by Engineer's definitive certificate of Substantial Completion, it is sufficiently complete, in accordance with the Contract documents, so that the Work (or specified part) can be utilized for the purposes for which it is intended; or if no such certificate is issued, when the Work is complete and ready for final payment as evidenced by the Engineer's recommendation of final payment. The terms "substantially complete" and "substantially completed" as applied to all or part of the Work refer to Substantial Completion thereof. Supplementary Conditions The part of the Contract which amends or supplements these General Conditions. Supplier A manufacturer, fabricator, supplier, distributor, material man or vendor having a direct contract with Contractor or with any Subcontractor to furnish materials or equipment to be incorporated in the Work by the Contractor. Surety Any person, firm or corporation which is bound with Contractor and which engages to be responsible for Contractor and his acceptable performance of the Work by a Bid, Performance or Payment Bond. Underground Facilities All pipelines, conduits, ducts, cables, wires manholes, vaults, tanks, tunnels or other such facilities or attachments, and any encasements containing such facilities which have been installed underground to furnish any of the following services or materials: electricity, SECTION III Page 4 of 49 Updated 6/1/2021 SECTION III — General Conditions gases, steam, liquid petroleum products, telephone or other communications, cable television, sewage and drainage removal or treatment, traffic or other control systems or water. Unit Price Work Work to be paid for on the basis of unit prices. Work The entire completed construction or the various separately identifiable parts thereof required to be furnished under the Contract Documents. Work includes and is the result of performing or furnishing labor and incorporating materials and equipment into the construction, and performing or furnishing services and furnishing documents, all as required by the Contract Documents. Work Change Directive A written directive to Contractor, issued on or after the Effective Date of the Agreement and signed by the Engineer, ordering an addition, deletion, or revision in the Work, or responding to differing or unforeseen physical conditions under which the Work is to be performed or emergencies. Work Change Directive will not change the Contract Price or Contract Time but is evidence that the parties expect that the change directed or documented by a Work Change Directive will be incorporated in a subsequently issued Change Order following negotiations by the parties as to its effect, if any, on the Contract Price or Contract Times. 2. PRELIMINARY MATTERS • 2.1. DELIVERY OF BONDS AND CERTIFICATES OF INSURANCE When Contractor delivers the executed Agreements to the Owner, Contractor shall also deliver to the Owner such Bonds and Certificates of Insurance as Contractor may be required to furnish by this contract. • 2.2. COPIES OF DOCUMENTS Engineer shall furnish to Contractor one (1) copy of Contract Documents for execution. Additional copies will be furnished, upon request, at the cost of reproduction. 2.3. COMMENCEMENT OF CONTRACT TIME/NOTICE TO PROCEED, STARTING THE PROJECT The Contract Time will commence on the day indicated in the Notice to Proceed. Contractor shall start to perform the work on the date the Contract Time commences to run. No work shall be done at the site prior to the date that the Contract Time commences to run. Pursuant to Section 255.05(1)(b), Florida Statutes, the Notice to Proceed cannot be issued until Contractor provides City with a certified copy of the recorded bond issued by the Pinellas County Clerk of Court. 2.4. BEFORE STARTING CONSTRUCTION Before undertaking each part of the Work, Contractor shall carefully study and compare the Contract Documents and check and verify pertinent figures shown thereon and all applicable field measurements. Contractor shall promptly report in writing to Engineer any conflict, error or SECTION III Page 5 of 49 Updated 6/1/2021 SECTION III — General Conditions discrepancy which Contractor may discover; and shall obtain a written interpretation or clarification from Engineer before proceeding with any work effected thereby; however, Contractor shall not be liable to the Owner for failure to report any conflict, error or discrepancy in the Drawings or Specifications, unless Contractor had actual knowledge thereof or should reasonably have known thereof No verbal agreement or conversation with any officer, Agent or employee of the Owner or Engineer's Consultant, either before or after the execution of this Contract, shall affect or modify any of the terms or obligations herein contained. Contractor shall not commence any work at any time without approved insurance required by these General Conditions. Failure to obtain this insurance will be the sole responsibility of the Contractor. 2.5. PRECONSTRUCTION CONFERENCE After Contract has been fully executed and before the start of the Work, the Owner's Representative shall schedule a preconstruction conference to be attended by Contractor, Engineer, Owner and others as appropriate to establish a working understanding among the parties as to the Work and to discuss the schedule of the Work and general Contract procedures. The Contractor shall submit to the Owner's Representative prior to the Notice to Proceed, a color Critical Path Method (CPM) Construction Schedule. This is to be a sequence of events including submittal review and procurement. Notice to Proceed is usually established at the preconstruction conference and such date can be inserted into the schedule at that time. The Contractor shall also submit a Submittal Schedule for review by the Engineer. This is to make sure that the list is complete, and this schedule shall be the basis of a Submittal Log. The Contractor shall submit to the Owner's Representative prior to the Notice to Proceed, a completed Emergency Call List, a completed Authorized Signature List, and Verification of Illegal Discharge Construction Site Training. 2.6. PROGRESS MEETINGS The Contractor is required to attend Progress Meetings. These meetings will be scheduled on a weekly, bi-weekly, or monthly basis depending on the needs of the project. The Contractor shall bring to each meeting an updated submittal log, an updated request for information (RFI) log, a look -ahead schedule to cover the project activity from the current meeting to the next meeting, and all material test reports generated in the same time period. 3. CONTRACT DOCUMENTS, INTENT 3.1. INTENT The Contract Documents comprise the entire Agreement between Owner and the Contractor concerning the Work. They may be altered only by written agreement. The Contract Documents are complementary; what is called for by one is as binding as if called for by all. It is the intent of the Contract Documents to describe a functionally complete project (or part thereof) to be constructed in accordance with the Contract Documents. Any Work, materials or equipment which may reasonably be inferred from the Contract Documents or from prevailing custom or from trade usage as being required to produce the intended result will be furnished and performed whether or not specifically called for. When words or phrases, which have a well-known technical or construction industry or trade meaning, are used to describe Work, materials or equipment, such words or phrases shall be interpreted in accordance with that meaning. Clarifications and SECTION III Page 6 of 49 Updated 6/1/2021 SECTION III — General Conditions interpretations of the Contract Documents shall be issued by the Owner's Representative. Reference to standards, specifications, manuals or codes of any technical society, organization or association, or to the code, Laws or Regulation of any governmental authority, whether such reference be specific or by implication, shall mean the latest standard specification, manual or code, or Laws or Regulations in effect at the time of opening of Bids except as may be otherwise specifically stated in the Contract Documents. However, no provision of any referenced standard specification, manual or code, whether or not specially incorporated by reference in the responsibilities of Owner or Contractor as set forth in the Contract Documents, shall change the duties and responsibilities of Owner, Contractor, Engineer or Owner's Representative, or any of their Agents or employees from those set forth in the Contract Documents. Clarifications and interpretations of the Contract shall be issued by the Owner's Representative. Each and every provision of law and clause required by law to be inserted in these Contract documents shall be deemed to be inserted herein, and they shall be read and enforced as through it were included herein, and if through mistake or otherwise, any such provision is not inserted, or if not correctly inserted, then upon the application of either party, the Contract Documents shall forthwith be physically amended to make such insertion. 3.2. REPORTING AND RESOLVING DISCREPANCIES If, during the performance of the Work, Contractor discovers any conflict, error, ambiguity or discrepancy within the Contract Documents or between the Contract Documents and any provision of any such Law or Regulation applicable to the performance of the Work or of any such standard, specification, manual or code or of any instruction of any Supplier, Contractor shall report it to the Owner's Representative in writing at once, and Contractor shall not proceed with the Work affected thereby (except in an emergency) until an amendment or supplement to Contract Documents has been issued by one of the methods provided in these General Specifications, provided however, that Contractor shall not be liable to Owner, or Owner's Representative for failure to report any such conflict, error, ambiguity or discrepancy unless Contractor knew or reasonably should have known thereof. 4. AVAILABILITY OF LANDS, SUBSURFACE AND PHYSICAL CONDITIONS, REFERENCE POINTS 4.1. AVAILABILITY OF LANDS The Owner shall furnish, as indicated in the Contract Documents, the lands upon which the Work is to be Performed, rights-of-way, easements, rights of entry for access thereto, and such other lands which are designated for the use of Contractor. The Owner shall identify any encumbrances or restrictions not of general application but specifically related to use of lands so furnished with which Contractor will have to comply in performing the Work. Easements for permanent structures or permanent changes in existing facilities will be obtained and paid for by the Owner, unless otherwise provided in the Contract Documents. 4.2. INVESTIGATIONS AND REPORTS Reference is made to the Supplementary Conditions and Technical Specifications for identification of those reports of investigations and tests of subsurface and latent physical conditions at the site or otherwise affecting cost, progress or performance of the Work which have been relied upon by Engineer in preparation of the Drawings and Specifications. Such reports are not guaranteed as to accuracy or completeness and are not part of the Contract Documents. Contractor shall promptly SECTION III Page 7 of 49 Updated 6/1/2021 SECTION III — General Conditions notify the Owner's Representative in writing of any subsurface or latent physical conditions at the site, or in an existing structure, differing materially from those indicated or referred to in the Contract Documents. Engineer will promptly review those conditions and advise if further investigation or tests are necessary. Owner or Engineer shall obtain the necessary additional investigations and tests and furnish copies to the Engineer and Contractor. If Engineer finds that the results of such investigations or tests indicate that there are subsurface or latent physical conditions, which differ materially from those, indicated in the contract Documents, and which could not reasonably have been anticipated by Contractor, a work change, or Change Order will be issued incorporating the necessary revisions. 4.3. PHYSICAL CONDITIONS, UNDERGROUND FACILITIES The information and data shown or indicated in the Contract Documents with respect to existing Underground Facilities at or contiguous to the site is based on information and data furnished to Owner or Engineer by the owners of such Underground Facilities or by others. Unless otherwise expressly provided in the Contract Documents, Owner and Engineer shall not be responsible for the accuracy or completeness of any such information or data; and the cost of all the following will be included in the Contract Price and Contractor shall have full responsibility for: (i) reviewing and checking all such information and data, (ii) locating all Underground Facilities shown or indicated in the Contract Documents, (iii) coordination of the Work with the owners of such Underground Facilities during construction, and (iv) the safety and protection of all such Underground Facilities and repairing any damage thereto resulting from the Work. The Contractor is required to call the Sunshine State One Call of Florida prior to any excavation per State regulations and to notify any utility owners who are not a member of the Sunshine State One Call of Florida prior to any excavation. The Sunshine State One Call of Florida is an agency for the protection and location of utilities prior to any excavation and contact number is available in local telephone directory. 4.4. REFERENCE POINTS Engineer shall provide engineering surveys to establish reference points for construction, which in Engineer's judgment are necessary to enable Contractor to proceed with the Work. Contractor shall be responsible for laying out the Work, unless otherwise noted in the Contract, shall protect and preserve the established reference points and shall make no changes or relocations without the prior written approval of the Owner and Engineer. Contractor shall report to Engineer whenever any reference point is lost or destroyed or requires relocation because of necessary changes in grades or locations and shall be responsible for the accurate replacement or relocation of such reference points by a surveyor licensed in the State of Florida. The Contractor is referred to the Technical Specifications for more specific information regarding the provision of construction surveys. If a City survey crew is assigned to the project and there is excessive stake replacement caused by negligence of Contractor's forces after initial line and grade have been set, as determined by the Engineer, the Contractor will be charged at the rate of $200.00 per hour. Time shall be computed for actual time on the project. All time shall be computed in one-hour increments with a minimum charge of one hour. SECTION III Page 8 of 49 Updated 6/1/2021 SECTION III — General Conditions 5. BONDS AND INSURANCE Ill 5.1. PERFORMANCE AND PAYMENT BOND/CONTRACT BOND • • Contractor shall furnish a Performance and Payment Bond pursuant to Section 255.05, Florida Statutes in an amount equal to the Contract Price as security for the faithful performance and payment of all Contractor's obligations under the Contract Documents. This bond shall remain in effect at least one year after the date when final payment becomes due unless a longer period of time is prescribed by laws and regulations or by the Contract Documents. Contractor shall also furnish such other Bonds as are required by the Supplementary Conditions. All Bonds shall be in the form prescribed by the Contract Documents in Section V and shall be executed by such sureties as are named in the current list of "Companies Holding Certificates of Authority as Acceptable Sureties on Federal Bonds and as Acceptable Reinsuring Companies" as published in Circular 570 (amended) by the Audit Staff, Bureau of Government Financial Operations, U.S. Treasury Department. All bonds signed by an agent must be accompanied by a certified copy of such agents' authority to act. All bonds shall be deemed to contain all of the Conditions of Section 255.05, Florida Statutes, even if such language is not directly contained within the bond and the Surety shall be licensed and qualified to do business in the State of Florida. Owner reserves the right to reject any surety. If the Surety on any Bond furnished by the Contractor is declared bankrupt or becomes insolvent or its right to do business is terminated in any state where any part of the Project is located or it ceases to meet the requirements of these Contract Documents, the Contractor shall within five days after notice thereof substitute another Bond and surety, both of which must be acceptable to Owner. 5.2. INSURANCE REQUIREMENTS The Contractor shall, at its own cost and expense, acquire and maintain (and cause any Subcontractors, representatives or agents to acquire and maintain) during the term with the City, sufficient insurance to adequately protect the respective interest of the parties. Coverage shall be obtained with a carrier having an AM Best Rating of A -VII or better. In addition, the City has the right to review the Contractor's deductible or self-insured retention and to require that it be reduced or eliminated. Specifically, the Contractor must carry the following minimum types and amounts of insurance on an occurrence basis or in the case of coverage that cannot be obtained on an occurrence basis, then coverage can be obtained on a claims -made basis with a minimum four (4) year tail following the termination or expiration of this Agreement: The following insurance limits may be achieved by a combination of primary and umbrella/excess liability policies. 5.2.1. COMMERCIAL GENERAL LIABILITY INSURANCE Commercial General Liability Insurance coverage, including but not limited to, premises operations, products/completed operations, products liability, contractual liability, advertising injury, personal injury, death, and property damage in the minimum amount of $1,000,000 (one million dollars) per occurrence and $2,000,000 (two million dollars) general aggregate. SECTION III Page 9 of 49 Updated 6/1/2021 SECTION III — General Conditions 5.2.2. COMMERCIAL AUTOMOBILE LIABILITY INSURANCE Commercial Automobile Liability Insurance coverage for any owned, non -owned, hired or borrowed automobile is required in the minimum amount of $1,000,000 (one million dollars) combined single limit. 5.2.3. WORKERS' COMPENSATION AND EMPLOYER'S LIABILITY INSURANCE Statutory Workers' Compensation Insurance coverage in accordance with the laws of the State of Florida, and Employer's Liability Insurance in the minimum amount of $100,000 (one hundred thousand dollars) each employee each accident, $100,000 (one hundred thousand dollars) each employee by disease and $500,000 (five hundred thousand dollars) aggregate by disease with benefits afforded under the laws of the State of Florida. Coverage should include Voluntary Compensation, Jones Act, and U.S. Longshoremen's and Harbor Worker's Act coverage where applicable. Coverage must be applicable to Employees, Contractors, Subcontractors, and Volunteers, if any. 5.2.4. PROFESSIONAL LIABILITY/MALPRACTICE/ERRORS OR OMISSIONS INSURANCE Professional Liability/Malpractice/Errors or Omissions Insurance coverage appropriate for the type of business engaged in by the Contractor with minimum limits of $1,000,000 (one million dollars) per occurrence. If a claims -made form of coverage is provided, the retroactive date of coverage shall be no later than the inception date of claims -made coverage, unless prior policy was extended indefinitely to cover prior acts. Coverage shall be extended beyond the policy year either by a supplemental extended reporting period (ERP) of as great a duration as available, and with no less coverage and with reinstated aggregate limits, or by requiring that any new policy provide a retroactive date no later than the inception date of claims -made coverage. 5.2.5. CONTRACTOR'S EQUIPMENT/INLAND MARINE/PROPERTY INSURANCE If Contractor is using its own property in connection with the performance of its obligations under this Agreement, then Contractor's Equipment—Inland Marine Insurance and/or Property Insurance on an "All Risks" basis with replacement cost coverage for property and equipment in the care, custody and control of others is recommended. City is not responsible for Contractor's (or any Subcontractors, Representatives, or Agents) equipment or property. 5.2.6. BUILDER'S RISK INSURANCE The City will provide at its expense, Builder's Risk Insurance for the project to cover all risks of loss in the complete and full value of the project. Contractor agrees to cooperate in a timely mariner with providing any information or documentation required for the application and by the carrier as the project proceeds. 5.3. OTHER INSURANCE PROVISIONS Upon approval of this Agreement by City Council, and then annually upon the anniversary date(s) of the insurance policy's renewal date(s) for as long as this Agreement remains in effect, the Contractor will furnish the City with a Certificate of Insurance(s) (using appropriate ACORD certificate, SIGNED by the Issuer, and with applicable endorsements) evidencing all of the SECTION III Page 10 of 49 Updated 6/1/2021 • • • SECTION III — General Conditions coverage set forth above and naming the City as an "Additional Insured." In addition, when requested in writing from the City, Contractor will provide the City with certified copies of all applicable policies. The address where such certificates and certified policies shall be sent or delivered is as follows: Attn: Contract and Procurement Specialist City of Clearwater Engineering Department P.O. Box 4748 Clearwater, FL 33758-4748 1. The Description (of Operations/Locations/Vehicles) should specify Project Name and Project Number. 2. Contractor shall provide thirty (30) days written notice of any cancellation, non -renewal, termination, material change or reduction in coverage. 3. Contractor's insurance as outlined above shall be primary and non-contributory coverage for Contractor's negligence. 4. Contractor reserves the right to appoint legal counsel to provide for the Contractor's defense, for any and all claims that may arise related to Agreement, work performed under this Agreement, or to Contractor's design, equipment, or service. Contractor agrees that the City shall not be liable to reimburse Contractor for any legal fees or costs as a result of Contractor providing its defense as contemplated herein. The stipulated limits of coverage above shall not be construed as a limitation of any potential liability to the City, and the City's failure to request evidence of this insurance shall not be construed as a waiver of Contractor's (or Subcontractors, Representatives, or Agents) obligation to provide the insurance coverage specified. 5.4. WAIVER OF RIGHTS The Owner and Contractor intend that all policies purchased in accordance with Article on Insurance will protect the Owner, Contractor, Subcontractors, Engineer, Engineer's Consultants and all other persons or entities identified in the Supplementary Conditions to be listed as insured or additional insured in such policies and will provide primary coverage for all losses and damages caused by the perils covered thereby. All such policies shall contain provisions to the effect that in the event of payment of any loss or damage the insurers will have no rights of recovery against any of the insured or additional insured thereunder, the Owner and Contractor waive all rights against each other and their respective officers, directors, employees and agents for all losses and damages caused by, arising out of or resulting from any of the perils covered by such policies and any other property insurance applicable to the work; and, in addition, waive all such rights against Subcontractors, Engineer, Engineer's Consultants and all other persons or entities identified in the Supplementary Conditions to be listed as insured or additional insured under such policies for losses and damages so caused. None of the above waivers shall extend to the rights that any party making such waiver may have to the proceeds of insurance otherwise payable under any policy so issued. In addition, the Owner waives all rights against Contractor, Subcontractors, Engineer, Engineer's Consultant and the officers, directors, employees and agents of any of them for: (i) loss due to business interruption, loss of use or other consequential loss extending beyond direct physical loss or damage to the Owner property or the Work caused by, arising out of or resulting from fire or other peril, whether or not insured by the Owner and; (ii) loss or damage to the completed Project or part thereof caused by, arising out of or resulting from fire or other insured peril covered by any property insurance maintained on the completed Project or part thereof by the Owner during partial utilization, after substantial completion or after final payment. SECTION III Page 11 of 49 Updated 6/1/2021 SECTION III — General Conditions 6. CONTRACTOR'S RESPONSIBILITIES 6.1. SUPERVISION AND SUPERINTENDENCE Contractor shall supervise, inspect, and direct the Work competently and efficiently, devoting such attention thereto and applying such skills and expertise as may be necessary to perform the Work in accordance with the Contract Documents. Contractor shall be solely responsible for the means, methods, techniques, sequences, and procedures of construction. Contractor shall not be responsible for the negligence of others in the design or specification of a specific means, method, technique, sequence, or procedure of construction which is shown or indicated in and expressly required by the Contract Documents. Contractor shall be responsible to see that the completed work complies accurately with the Contract Documents. Contractor shall keep on the work at all times during its progress a competent resident superintendent, who shall not be replaced without notice to the Owner's Representative except under extraordinary circumstances. The superintendent will be Contractor's representative at the site and shall have authority to act on behalf of Contractor. All communications to the superintendent shall be as binding as if given to Contractor. The Contractor's superintendent shall keep a mobile cell phone on his person, so he can be contacted whenever necessary. Contractor shall employ only competent persons to do the work and whenever the Owner's Representative shall notify Contractor, in writing, that any person on the work appears to be incompetent, unfaithful, disorderly, disrespectful or otherwise unsatisfactory, such person shall be removed from the project and shall not again be employed on it except with the written consent of the Owner's Representative. Contractor represents the City of Clearwater and shall conduct themselves in a professional manner to the public at all times. Contractor shall reimburse Owner for additional engineering and inspection costs incurred as a result of overtime work in excess of the regular working hours or on the Owner normally approved holidays. At such times when Inspector overtime is required, the Contractor shall sign an overtime slip documenting such hours and the Contractor shall be provided a copy for his records. At the end of the project and prior to payment of withheld retainage funds, the Contractor shall deliver to the Owner a check made out to the Owner of Clearwater for full reimbursement of all Inspector overtime hours. Withheld retainage shall not be released until the Owner has received this check. Minimum number of chargeable hours for inspection costs on weekends or holidays shall be four hours. The cost of overtime inspection per hour shall be $80.00 per hour. Contractor shall provide and maintain in a neat and sanitary condition, such sanitary accommodations for the use of Contractor's employees as may be necessary to comply with the requirements of Laws and Regulations and the Engineer. 6.2. LABOR, MATERIALS AND EQUIPMENT Contractor shall provide competent, suitably qualified personnel to survey, lay out and construct the work as required by the Contract Documents. Contractor shall at all times maintain good discipline and order at the site. Except as otherwise required for the safety or protection of persons or the work or property at the site or adjacent thereto, and except as otherwise indicated in the Contract Documents, all work at the site shall be performed during regular working hours. Contractor shall adhere to the Community Development Code, Section 3-1508 regarding noise restrictions from 6:00 p.m. to 7:00 a.m. any day and all -day Sunday. Contractor will not permit overtime work or the performance of work on Saturday, Sunday, or any legal holiday without Owner consent given after prior notice to Engineer. SECTION III Page 12 of 49 Updated 6/1/2021 • SECTION III — General Conditions Unless otherwise specified in the General Requirements, Contractor shall furnish and assume full responsibility for all materials, equipment, labor, transportation, construction equipment and machinery, tools, appliances, fuel, power, light, heat, telephone, water, sanitary facilities, temporary facilities, and all other facilities and incidentals necessary for the furnishing, performance, testing, start-up and completion of the Work. All materials and equipment installed in the Work shall be of good quality and new, except as otherwise provided in the Contract Documents. If required by Engineer, Contractor shall furnish satisfactory evidence (including reports of required tests) as to the quality of materials and equipment. The Contractor shall provide suitable and secure storage for all materials to be used in the Work so that their quality shall not be impaired or injured. Materials that are improperly stored, may be rejected by the Engineer without testing. All materials and equipment shall be applied, installed, connected, erected, used, cleaned, and conditioned in accordance with the instructions of the applicable manufacturer, fabricator, supplier, or distributor, except as otherwise provided in the Contract Documents. The City of Clearwater, at its sole discretion, reserves the right to purchase major equipment or materials to be incorporated into the Work under the Owner Direct Purchase (ODP) Option, per Section III, Article 21. In such event, the Contractor shall cooperate and assist the Owner of Clearwater, at no additional cost, to implement the ODP documents and procedures. 6.3. SUBSTITUTES AND "OR EQUAL" ITEMS Whenever an item of material or equipment is specified or described in the Contract Documents by using the name of a proprietary item or the name of a particular Supplier, the specification or description is intended to establish the type, function and quality required. Unless the specification or description contains or is followed by words reading that no like, equivalent or "or equal" item or no substitution is permitted, other items of material or equipment or material or equipment of other Suppliers may be accepted by Engineer. If in Engineer's sole discretion an item of material or equipment proposed by Contractor is functionally equal to that named and sufficiently similar so that no change in related Work will be required, it may be considered by Engineer for approval. If in the Engineer's sole discretion an item of material or equipment proposed by Contractor does not qualify as an "or equal" item, it may be considered as a proposed substitute item. Contractor shall submit sufficient information as required by the Engineer to allow the Engineer to determine that the item of material or equipment proposed is essentially equivalent to that named and is an acceptable substitute, therefore. Request for review of proposed substitute and "or equal" will be not be accepted by Engineer from anyone other than Contractor. Request for substitute and "or equal" items by Contractor must be submitted in writing to Owner's Representative and will contain all information as Engineer deems necessary to make a determination. Request for substitute shall identify why a substitute is submitted and include advantages to the Owner. All data provided by Contractor in support of any proposed substitute or "or equal" item will be at Contractor's expense. Engineer will be allowed a reasonable time to evaluate each proposal or submittal made per this paragraph. Engineer will be sole judge of acceptability. 6.4. SUBCONTRACTORS, SUPPLIERS AND OTHERS The Contractor shall deliver to the Owner's Representative before or at the preconstruction conference a list of all Subcontractors, suppliers and other persons and organizations proposed by the Contractor for Work to be performed on the Project. The Contractor shall include with this list SECTION III Page 13 of 49 Updated 6/1/2021 SECTION III — General Conditions the qualifications and references for each Subcontractor, supplier or other person and organization for review and approval. Any changes to this list must be submitted to the Owner's Representative for approval prior to the substitution of any Subcontractors, suppliers or other persons and organizations before performing any Work on the Project for the Contractor. Contractor shall be fully responsible to Owner and Engineer for all acts and omissions of the Subcontractors, Suppliers and other persons performing or furnishing any of the work under a direct or indirect contract with Contractor just as Contractor is responsible for Contractor's own acts and omissions. Nothing in the Contract Documents shall create for the benefit of any such Subcontractor, Supplier or other person any contractual relationship between Owner or Engineer and any Subcontractor, Supplier or other person, nor shall it create any obligation on the part of Owner or Engineer to pay or to see to the payment of any moneys due any such Subcontractor, Supplier or other person. Contractor shall be solely responsible for scheduling and coordinating the work of Subcontractors, Suppliers and other persons performing or furnishing any of the work under a direct or indirect contract with Contractor. Contractor shall require all Subcontractors, Suppliers and such other persons performing or furnishing any of the work to communicate with the Engineer through Contractor. The divisions and sections of the Specifications and the identifications of any Drawings shall not control Contractor in dividing the work among Subcontractors or Suppliers or delineating the work to be performed by any specific trade. All work performed for Contractor by a Subcontractor or Supplier will be pursuant to an appropriate agreement between Contractor and the Subcontractor or Supplier which specifically binds the Subcontractor or Supplier to the applicable terms and conditions of the Contract Documents for the benefit of Owner and Engineer. Contractor shall not pay or employ any Subcontractor, Supplier or other person or organization whether initially or as a substitute, against whom Owner or Engineer may have reasonable objection. Contractor shall not be required to employ any Subcontractor, Supplier or other person or organization to furnish or perform any of the work against whom Contractor has reasonable objection. Owner or Engineer will not undertake to settle any differences between Contractor and his Subcontractors or between Subcontractors. 6.5. USE OF PREMISES Contractor shall confine construction equipment, the storage of materials and equipment and the operations of works to the site and land areas identified in and permitted by the Contract Documents on other land areas permitted by Laws and Regulations, right-of-way, permits and easements, and shall not unreasonably encumber the premises with construction equipment or other materials or equipment. Contractor shall assume full responsibility for any damage to any such land or area, or to the owner or occupant thereof or of any adjacent land or areas, resulting from the performance of the Work. Should any claim be made by any such owner or occupant because of the performance of the Work, Contractor shall promptly settle with such other party by negotiation or otherwise resolve the claim by arbitration or other dispute resolution proceed in or at law. Contractor shall, to the fullest extent permitted by Laws and Regulations, indemnify and hold harmless Owner, Engineer, Engineer's Consultant and their officials, directors, employees and agents from and against all claims, costs, losses and damages arising out of or resulting from any claim or action, legal or equitable, brought by any such owner or occupant against Owner, SECTION III Page 14 of 49 Updated 6/1/2021 • • • SECTION III — General Conditions Engineer or any other party indemnified hereunder to the extent caused by or based upon Contractor's performance of the Work. During the progress of the Work, Contractor shall keep the premises free from accumulations of waste materials, rubbish and other debris resulting from the Work. At the completion of the Work or at intervals established by the Engineer, Contractor shall remove all waste materials, rubbish and debris from and about the premises as well as all tools, appliances, construction equipment and machinery and surplus materials. Contractor shall restore to original condition all property not designated for alteration by the Contract Documents. 6.5.1. STAGING AREAS The Contactor shall obtain and deliver to the City written permission for the use of all staging and storage areas outside of the Limits of Construction. Use of right of way within the limits of construction must be approved by the City. All applicable erosion control, tree barricade and restoration, including time limits, specifications, etc., must be followed. Contractor must provide portable restroom that is lockable for the safety of the Contractor and the surrounding residents. 6.5.2. RESTORATION TIME LIMITS The timely restoration of all impacted areas, especially in the Right -of -Ways, is very important to the Citizens of Clearwater therefore, these time limits are imposed: • Debris piles shall be removed within five (5) consecutive calendar days. • Concrete driveways and sidewalks shall be replaced within ten (10) consecutive calendar days of removal. Resident access shall be maintained at all times. • All arterial and collector roadways shall be restored ASAP. • Local streets and asphalt driveways shall be restored as soon as a sufficient quantity is generated, however, this is never to exceed fifteen (15) consecutive calendar days. Local and resident access shall be maintained at all times. • Any irrigation systems or components damaged or impacted by construction activities shall be repaired or replaced "in-kind" within forty-eight (48) hours to minimize the loss of turfgrass or landscape plantings, particularly during periods of drought. • Sod must be restored "in-kind" within fourteen (14) consecutive calendar days of a successful pipe pressure test, removal of concrete forms, backfill of excavations, replacement of driveways or sidewalks or another project specific milestone. It must be watered for a period of thirty (30) days after it is placed. Erosion control and dust control of denuded areas must be maintained at all times. If the project or a portion of it does not involve right -of ways, then a different schedule of sod restoration may be considered. 6.6. LICENSE AND PATENT FEES, ROYALTIES AND TAXES Contractor shall pay all license fees and royalties and assume all costs incident to the use in the performance of the work or the incorporation in the Work of any invention, design, process, product or device which is the subject of patent rights or copyrights held by others. If a particular invention, design, process, product or device is specified in the Contract Documents for use in the performance of the work and if to the actual knowledge of Owner or Engineer its use is subject to patent rights or copyrights calling for the payment of any license fee or royalty to others, the existence of such rights shall be disclosed by Owner or Engineer in the Contract Documents. SECTION III Page 15 of 49 Updated 6/1/2021 SECTION III — General Conditions To the fullest extent permitted by Laws and Regulations, Contractor shall indemnify and hold harmless Owner, Engineer, Engineer's Consultants and the officers, directors, employees, agents and other consultants of each and any of them from and against all claims, costs, losses and damages arising out of or resulting from any infringement of patent rights or copyrights incident to the use in the performance of the Work or resulting from the incorporation in the Work of any invention, design, process, product or device not specified in the Contract Documents, and shall defend all such claims in connection with any alleged infringement of such rights. Contractor shall pay all sales, consumer, use, and other taxes required to be paid by Contractor in accordance with the Laws and Regulations of the State of Florida and other governmental agencies, which are applicable during the performance of the work. 6.7. LAWS AND REGULATIONS Contractor shall give all notices and comply with all Laws and Regulations applicable to furnishing and performance of the Work. Except where otherwise expressly required by applicable Laws and Regulations, neither Owner nor Owner's Representative shall be responsible for monitoring Contractor's compliance with any Laws or Regulations. If Contractor performs any work knowing or having reason to know that it is contrary to Laws or Regulations, Contractor shall bear all claims, costs, losses and damages caused by or arising out of such work: however, it shall not be Contractor's primary responsibility to make certain that the Specifications and Drawings are in accordance with Laws and Regulations, but this shall not relieve Contractor of Contractor's obligations to the Owner to report and resolve discrepancies as described above. 6.7.1. E -VERIFY Contractor and its Subcontractors shall register with and use the E -Verify system to verify the work authorization status of all newly hired employees. Contractor will not enter into a contract with any Subcontractor unless each party to the contract registers with and uses the E -Verify system. Subcontractor must provide Contractor with an affidavit stating that Subcontractor does not employ, contract with, or subcontract with an unauthorized alien. Contractor shall maintain a copy of such affidavit. The City may terminate this Contract on the good faith belief that Contractor or its Subcontractors knowingly violated Florida Statutes 448.09(1) or 448.095(2)(c). If this Contract is terminated pursuant to Florida Statute 448.095(2)(c), Contractor may not be awarded a public contract for at least 1 year after the date of which this Contract was terminated. Contractor is liable for any additional costs incurred by the City as a result of the termination of this Contract. See Section 448.095, Florida Statutes (2020). See "VERIFICATION OF EMPLOYMENT ELIGIBILITY FORM" in Appendix. 6.8. PERMITS Unless otherwise provided in the Supplementary Conditions, Contractor shall obtain and pay for all construction permits and licenses. The Owner shall assist Contractor, when necessary, in obtaining such permits and licenses. Contractor shall pay all governmental charges and inspection fees necessary for the prosecution of the Work, which are applicable at the time of opening of Bids. Contractor shall pay all charges of utility owners for connections to the work, and the Owner shall pay all charges of such utility owners for capital costs related thereto such as plant investment fees. SECTION III Page 16 of 49 Updated 6/1/2021 • • • SECTION III — General Conditions Unless otherwise stated in the Contract Documents, Clearwater Building Permit Fees will be waived. 6.9. SAFETY AND PROTECTION Contractor shall be responsible for initiating, maintaining, and supervising all safety precautions and programs in connection with the Work. Contractor shall take all necessary precautions for the safety of, and shall provide the necessary protection to prevent damage, injury or loss to: (i) all persons on the work site or who may be affected by the work, (ii) all the Work and materials and equipment to be incorporated therein, whether in storage on or off the site; and (iii) other property at the site or adjacent thereto, including trees, shrubs, lawns, walks, pavements, roadways, structures, utilities and Underground Facilities not designated for removal, relocation or replacement in the course of construction. In the event of temporary suspension of the work, or during inclement weather, or whenever Owner's Representative may direct; Contractor shall, and shall cause Subcontractors, to carefully protect the Work and materials against damage or injury from the weather. If, in the opinion of the Owner's Representative, any portion of Work or materials shall have been damaged or injured by reason of failure on the part of the Contractor or any Subcontractors to so protect the Work, such Work and materials shall be removed and replaced at the expense of Contractor. The Contractor shall initiate and maintain an accident prevention program which shall include but shall not be limited to the establishment and supervision of programs for the education and training of employees in the recognition, avoidance and prevention of unsafe conditions and acts. Contractor shall provide first aid services and medical care to his employees. The Contractor shall develop and maintain an effective fire protection and prevention program and good housekeeping practices at the site of contract performance throughout all phases of construction, repair, alteration, or demolition. Contractor shall require appropriate personal protective equipment in all operations where there is exposure to hazardous conditions. The Engineer may order that the work stop if a condition of immediate danger to the Owner's employees, equipment or if property damage exists. This provision shall not shift responsibility or risk of loss for injuries of damage sustained from the Contractor to Owner, and the Contractor shall remain solely responsible for compliance with all safety requirements and for the safety of all persons and property at the site of Contract performance. The Contractor shall instruct his employees required to handle or use toxic materials or other harmful substances regarding their safe handling and use. The Contractor shall take the necessary precautions to protect pedestrians and motorists from harm, and to prevent disruptions of such traffic due to construction activity. Contractor shall comply with all applicable Laws and Regulations of any public body having jurisdiction for safety of persons or property and to protect them from damage, injury, or loss; and shall erect and maintain all necessary safeguards for such safety and protection. Contractor shall notify owners of adjacent property and of Underground Facilities and utility owners when execution of the work may affect them, and shall cooperate with them in the protection, removal, relocation, and replacement of their property. All damage, injury or loss to any property caused, directly or indirectly, in whole or part, by Contractor, any Subcontractor, Supplier or any other person or organization directly or indirectly employed by any of them to perform or furnish any of the work or anyone for whose acts any of them may be liable, shall be remedied by Contractor. Contractor's duties and responsibilities for safety and for protection of the Work shall continue until such time as all the Work is completed and Engineer has issued a notice to Owner and Contractor that the Work is acceptable. SECTION III Page 17 of 49 Updated 6/1/2021 SECTION III — General Conditions 6.10. EMERGENCIES In emergencies affecting the safety or protection of persons or the Work or property at the site or adjacent thereto, Contractor, with or without special instruction or authorization from Owner or the Owner's Representative, is obligated to act to prevent damage, injury or loss. Contractor shall give Engineer prompt written notice if Contractor believes that any significant changes in the Work or variations from the Contract Documents have been caused thereby. If the Owner's Representative determines that a change in the Contract Documents is required because of the action taken by Contractor in response to such an emergency, a Work Change Directive or Change Order will be issued to document the consequences of such action. 6.11. DRAWINGS 6.11.1. SHOP DRAWINGS, SAMPLES, RFIs, AND SUBMITTAL REVIEW Contractor shall submit Shop Drawings to Engineer for review and approval as called for in the Technical Specifications or required by the Engineer. The data shown on the Shop Drawings will be complete with respect to quantities, dimensions, specified performance and design criteria, materials and similar data to show Engineer the materials and equipment Contractor proposes to provide and to enable Engineer to review the information. Contractor shall also submit Samples to Engineer for review and approval. Before submitting each Shop Drawing or Sample, Contractor shall have determined and verified: (i) all field measurements, quantities, dimensions, specified performance criteria, installation requirements, materials, catalog numbers and similar information with respect thereto, (ii) all materials with respect to intended use, fabrication, shipping, handling, storage, assembly and installation pertaining to the performance of the Work, and (iii) all information relative to Contractor's sole responsibilities in respect to means, methods, techniques, sequences and procedures of construction and safety precautions and programs incident thereto. Contractor shall also have reviewed and coordinated each Shop Drawing or Sample with other Shop Drawings and Samples with the requirements of the Work and the Contract Documents. Each submittal will have a transmittal cover sheet identifying the shop drawing name, number, and technical specification reference; will bear a stamp or specific written indication that Contractor has satisfied Contractor's obligations under the Contract Documents with respect to Contractor's review and approval of that submittal. At the time of submission, Contractor shall give Engineer specific written notice of such variations, if any, that the Shop Drawing or Sample submitted may have from the requirements of the Contract Documents, such notice to be in a written communication separate from the submittal; and, in addition, shall cause a specific notation to be made on each Shop Drawing and Sample submitted to Engineer for review and approval of each such variation. The Contractor shall maintain a submittal log as mentioned in Article 2.5. The Engineer shall receive updated copies at each progress meeting, and the Engineer shall respond to each submittal within fourteen (14) consecutive calendar days. The Contractor shall maintain a request for information (RFI) log as mentioned in Article 2.5. The Engineer shall receive updated copies at each progress meeting, and the Engineer shall respond to each RFI within fourteen (14) consecutive calendar days. The untimely submission of Submittal or RFIs shall not be grounds for a delay claim from the Contractor. Engineer's review and approval of Shop Drawings and Samples will be only to determine if the items covered by the submittals will, after installation or incorporation in the Work, conform to the information given in the Contract Documents and be compatible with the design concept of SECTION III Page 18 of 49 Updated 6/1/2021 SECTION III — General Conditions the completed Project as a functioning whole as indicated the Contract Documents. Engineer's review and approval will not extend to means, methods, techniques, sequences or procedures of construction (except where a particular means method, technique, sequence or procedure of construction is specifically and expressly called for by the Contract Documents) or to safety precautions or programs incident thereto. The review and approval of a separate item as such will not indicate approval of the assembly in which the item functions. Contractor shall make corrections required by Engineer and shall return the required number of corrected copies of Shop Drawings and submit as required new Samples for review and approval. Contractor shall direct specific attention in writing to revisions other than the corrections called for by Engineer on previous submittals. Engineer's review and approval of Shop Drawings or Samples shall not relieve Contractor from responsibility for any variation from the requirements of the Contract Documents unless Contractor has in writing called Engineer's attention to each such variation at the time of submission and Engineer has given written approval of each such variation by specific written notation thereof incorporated in or accompanying the Shop Drawing or Sample approval; nor will any approval by the Engineer relieve the Contractor from responsibility for complying with the requirements of paragraph above discussing field measurements by the Contractor. Contractor shall furnish required submittals with complete information and accuracy in order to achieve required approval of an item within two (2) submittals. Owner's Representative reserves the right to back charge Contractor, for Engineer's costs for resubmittals that account for a number greater than twenty percent (20%) of the total number of first-time submittals, per the approved initial submittal log. Owner's Representative reserves the right to back charge Contractor for all third submittals. The number of first-time submittals shall be equal to the number of submittals agreed to by Engineer and Contractor. All costs to Engineer involved with subsequent submittal of Shop Drawings, Samples or other items requiring approval will be back charged to Contractor at the rate of 3.0 times direct technical labor cost by deducting such costs from payments due Contractor for Work completed. In the event, that Contractor requests a substitution for a previously approved item, all of Engineer's costs in the reviewing and approval of the substitution will be back charged to Contractor, unless the need for such substitution is beyond the control of Contractor. 6.11.2. AS -BUILT DRAWINGS The Contractor shall keep and maintain one set of blueprints, As -Built Drawings, in good order and legible condition to be continuously marked -up at the job site. The Contractor shall mark and annotate neatly and clearly all project conditions, locations, configurations and any other changes or deviations which may vary from the details represented on the original Contract Plans, including revisions made necessary by Addenda, Shop Drawings, and Change Orders during the construction process. The Contractor shall record the horizontal and vertical locations, in the plan and profile, of all buried utilities that differ from the locations indicated or which were not indicated on the Contract Plans and buried (or concealed), construction and utility features which are revealed during the construction period. All abandoned during construction pipes and utilities must be clearly identified on the As-Builts including the methods used to abandon. The As -Built Drawings shall be available for inspection by the Engineer, Engineer's Consultant, and the Owner's Representative at all times during the progress of the Project. The As -Built Drawings shall be reviewed by the Owner's Representative, or his designee, for accuracy and compliance with the requirements of "As -Built Drawings" prior to submittal of the monthly pay requests. The pay requests shall be rejected if the marked -up redline prints do not SECTION III Page 19 of 49 Updated 6/1/2021 SECTION III — General Conditions conform to the "As -Built Drawings" requirements. As -Built Drawings shall be submitted to the Owner Inspector for approval upon completion of the project and prior to acceptance of final pay request. Final pay request shall not be processed until As -Built Drawings have been reviewed by the Engineer or the Engineer's Consultant for accuracy and completeness. Prior to placing new potable water mains in service, the Contractor shall provide the Engineer intersection drawings, as specified for the water mains. The Owner's acceptance of the As -Built Drawings does not relieve the Contractor of the sole responsibility for the accuracy and completeness of the As -Built Drawings. 6.11.2.1. General The Contractor shall prepare an AS -BUILT SURVEY per chapter 5J-17.052, Florida Administrative Code (see definition below), signed and sealed by a Florida registered land surveyor. The Contractor will deliver to the Owner two hard copies of signed and sealed As -Built Drawings and an AutoCAD file. 5J-17.050 Definition: (10)(a) As -Built Survey: a survey performed to obtain horizontal and/or vertical dimensional data so that constructed improvements may be located and delineated: also known as Record Survey. This survey shall be clearly titled "AS -BUILT SURVEY" and shall be signed and sealed by a Florida registered land surveyor. The survey must be delivered to the Owner of Clearwater Construction Division upon substantial completion of the project. If this condition is not met, the Owner will procure the services of a Professional Surveyor and Mapper registered in the State of Florida and will back charge the Contractor a fee of $1,800 per day or any portion thereof to provide the Owner with the required As -Built Survey. 6.11.2.2. Sanitary and Storm Sewer Piping Systems 1. Manholes and inlets shall be located by survey coordinates (northing, easting, and elevation) based on the approved horizontal and vertical datum or utilize the stationing supplied on the construction plans. New and replaced service connections shall be dimensioned to the nearest downstream manhole. All manholes, cleanouts and catch basin invert and rim elevations, manhole and catch basin dimensions, pipe sizes, and pipe material shall also be noted on the plan view and also on the profile if one exists. The terminal ends of all subdrains, inverts of all pipe in structures, and the flow line of inlets shall also be noted on the plan view and also on the profile if one exists. 2. Pipe materials and areas of special construction shall be noted. 6.11.2.3. Pressure Pipe construction (Water, Reclaimed Water, Force Main) All pipes shall be located by survey coordinates (northing, easting, and elevation) based on the approved horizontal and vertical datum or utilize the stationing supplied on the construction plans. Coordinates shall be at all pipe bends, tees, valves, reducers, and deflections. Also, all new and replaced service connections for potable and reclaimed water will be located as described above. Additionally, there must be survey coordinates no further than 100 feet apart on linear type construction and shall denote top of pipe elevation at those points. SECTION III Page 20 of 49 Updated 6/1/2021 • SECTION 111— General Conditions 6.11.2.4. Electrical and Control Wiring The As -Built Drawings shall include all changes to the original Contract Plans. The As -Built Drawings shall also include the size, color, and number of wires and conduit. For projects where this information is too voluminous to be contained on the blueline prints, the Contractor shall prepare supplemental drawings, on same size sheets as the blueline prints, showing the additional conduit runs, 1 -line diagrams, ladder diagrams, and other information. The wiring schematic diagrams shall show termination location and wiring identification at each point on the ladder diagram. 6.11.2.5. Horizontal and Vertical Control The As -Built Survey shall be based on the original datum used for the construction design plans or if required by the Owner the datum shall be referenced to the North American Datum of 1983/90 (horizontal) and the North American Vertical Datum of 1988. The unit of measurement shall be the United States Foot. Any deviation or use of any other datum, (horizontal and or vertical), must be approved by the Owner of Clearwater Engineering Department. 6.11.2.6. Standards The As -Built Survey shall meet the Minimum Technical Standards per Chapter 5J-17 and the Clearwater CAD STANDARDS set forth below. In addition to locating all improvements that pertain to the As -Built Survey it is the requirement of the Owner to have minimum location points at every change in direction and no more than 100 feet apart on all pressure pipes. 6.11.2.7. Other • The As -Built Drawings shall reflect any differences from the original Contract Plans, in the same level of detail and units of dimensions as the Plans. • 6.11.3. CAD STANDARDS 6.11.3.1. Layer Naming 6.11.3.1.1. Prefixes and Suffixes AB-... prefix denotes As -Built information DI-... prefix denotes digitized or scanned entities DEMO-... prefix denotes demolition P-... prefix denotes proposed entities — line work and symbols F-... prefix denotes future entities (proposed but not part of this contract) - line work and symbols X-... prefix denotes existing entities — line work and symbols ... -CANOPY Suffix denotes tree canopies ...-CL suffix denotes centerline of road, ditch, swale etc. ...-LN suffix denotes all linework ...-PT suffix denotes points from survey data or from design stakeout ...-TX suffix denotes text — use for all text, no matter the prefix 6.11.3.1.2. Laver Naming Definitions: BENCH benchmark, temporary benchmarks BLDG buildings, sheds, fmished floor elevation SECTION III Page 21 of 49 Updated 6/1/2021 SECTION III — General Conditions BOC curbs BOLLARD bollards BRUSH brush lines CABLE cable TV lines and appurtenances CONCSLAB concrete slabs DRIVE driveways EASEMENT easements EOP edge of pavement without curbs FENCE all fences FLOW flow lines GRADE grade slopes, grade breaks GROUND soft ground (unpaved, unimproved) HANDRAIL handrails HEDGE hedges LANDSCAPE landscape areas LOT platted lot lines information MISC miscellaneous linework MONU property corners, monumentation PHONE telephone lines and appurtenances PROPERTY property lines information ROAD roads ROW Right -of -Way information SEAWALL seawalls SHORE shoreline, water elevation SWALE swales TOB top of bank TOE toe of slope TRAFFIC signal poles, control boxes TREE trees, bushes, planters UT-ELEC power lines and appurtenances UT -GAS gas lines and appurtenances UT-RCW reclaimed water UT -SAN sanitary lines and appurtenances UT -STM storm lines and appurtenances UT-TCOM telecommunication systems UT-WAT potable water lines and appurtenances, sprinklers WALK sidewalk WALL walls, except seawall Other layers may be created as required or needed, using above format or easy to understand logic. 6.11.3.2. Layer Properties All AutoCAD objects shall be drawn with their General Properties to be "ByLayer", pertaining to "Color", "Linetype", and "Lineweight". 6.11.3.3. Text Styles All text shall use standard AutoCAD fonts. SECTION III Page 22 of 49 Updated 6/1/2021 • • SECTION III — General Conditions Text style for X-... (existing) layers shall use the Simplex font, oblique angle of 0°, and a text height of 0.06 times the plot scale. Text style for P-... (proposed) and F-... (future) layers shall use the Simplex font, oblique angle of 22.5°, and a text height of 0.1 times the plot scale. 6.11.4. DELIVERABLES The As -Built Survey shall be produced on bond material, 24" x 36" at a scale of 1"=20' unless approved otherwise. The consultant shall deliver two hard copies and one digital copy of all drawings. Requested file formats are Autodesk DWG and Adobe PDF files. Please address any questions regarding format to Mr. Tom Mahony, at (727) 562-4762 or e-mail address Thomas.Mahony@myClearwater.com. 6.12. CONTRACTOR'S GENERAL WARRANTY AND GUARANTEE Contractor warrants and guarantees to Owner, Engineer and Engineer's Consultants that all Work will be in accordance with the Contract Documents and will not be defective. Contractor's warranty and guarantee hereunder includes defects or damage caused by abuse, vandalism, modification, or operation by persons other than Contractor, Subcontractors or Suppliers. Until the acceptance of the Work by the Owner, the Work shall be under the charge and care of the Contractor, and he shall take every necessary precaution against injury or damage to any part thereof by action of the elements, or from any other cause whatsoever, arising from the execution or non -execution of the Work. The Contractor shall rebuild, repair, and make good, at his own expense, all injuries or damages to any portion of the Work occasioned by any cause before its completion and final acceptance by the Owner. In addition, "the Contractor shall remedy any defects in the work at his own expense and pay for any damage to other work resulting therefrom which appear within a period of one year from the date of final acceptance". Contractor's warranty and guarantee hereunder excludes improper maintenance and operation by Owner's employees and normal wear and tear under normal usage for any portion of the Work, which has been partially accepted by the Owner for operation prior to final acceptance by the Owner. Contractor's obligation to perform and complete the Work in accordance with the Contract Documents shall be absolute. None of the following will constitute an acceptance of Work that is not in accordance with the Contract Documents or a release of Contractor's obligation to perform the Work in accordance with the Contract Documents: (i) observations by Owner's Representative, (ii) recommendation of any progress or final payment by Owner's Representative, (iii) the issuance of a certificate of Substantial Completion or any payment by the Owner to contractor under the Contract Documents, (iv) use or occupancy of the Work or any part thereof by Owner, (v) any acceptance by Owner or any failure to do so, (vi) any review and approval of a Shop Drawing or Sample submittal or the issuance of a notice of Acceptance by the Engineer. 6.13. CONTINUING THE WORK Contractor shall carry on the work and adhere to the progress schedule during all disputes or disagreements with the Owner. No work shall be delayed or postponed pending resolution of any disputes or disagreements, except as the Owner or Contractor may otherwise agree in writing. SECTION III Page 23 of 49 Updated 6/1/2021 SECTION III — General Conditions 6.14. INDEMNIFICATION To the fullest extent permitted by law, Contractor agrees to defend, indemnify, and hold the City, its officers, agents, and employees, harmless from and against any and all liabilities, demands, claims, suits, losses, damages, causes of action, fines or judgments, including costs, attorneys', witnesses', and expert witnesses' fees, and expenses incident thereto, relating to, arising out of, or resulting from: (i) the services provided by Contractor personnel under this Agreement; '(ii) any negligent acts, errors, mistakes or omissions by Contractor or Contractor personnel; and (iii) Contractor or Contractor personnel's failure to comply with or fulfill the obligations established by this Agreement. Contractor will update the City during the course of the litigation to timely notify the City of any issues that may involve the independent negligence of the City that is not covered by this indemnification. The City assumes no liability for actions of Contractor and will not indemnify or hold Contractor or any third party harmless for claims based on this Agreement or use of Contractor -provided supplies or services. Notwithstanding anything contained herein to the contrary, this indemnification provision shall not be construed as a waiver of any immunity to which Owner is entitled or the extent of any limitation of liability pursuant to § 768.28, Florida Statutes. Furthermore, this provision is not intended to nor shall be interpreted as limiting or in any way affecting any defense Owner may have under § 768.28, Florida Statutes or as consent to be sued by third parties. 6.15. CHANGES IN COMPANY CONTACT INFORMATION Contractor shall notify Owner by US mail addressed to the City Engineer of any changes in company contact information. This includes contact phone, address, project manager, email addresses, etc. 6.16. PUBLIC RECORDS The CONTRACTOR will be required to comply with Section 119.0701, Florida Statutes. IF THE CONTRACTOR HAS QUESTIONS REGARDING THE APPLICATION OF CHAPTER 119, FLORIDA STATUTES, TO THE CONTRACTOR'S DUTY TO PROVIDE PUBLIC RECORDS RELATING TO THIS CONTRACT, CONTACT THE CUSTODIAN OF PUBLIC RECORDS, Rosemarie Call, phone: 727-562-4092 or Rosemarie.CallAmyclearwater.com, 600 Cleveland Street, Suite 600, Clearwater, FL 33755. The Contractor's duty to comply with public records law applies specifically to: a) Keep and maintain public records required by the City of Clearwater (hereinafter "public agency") to perform the service being provided by the Contractor hereunder. b) Upon request from the public agency's custodian of public records, provide the public agency with a copy of the requested records or allow the records to be inspected or copied within a reasonable time at a cost that does not exceed the cost provided for in Chapter 119, Florida Statutes, as may be amended from time to time, or as otherwise provided by law. c) Ensure that public records that are exempt or confidential and exempt from public records disclosure requirements are not disclosed except as authorized by law for the SECTION III Page 24 of 49 Updated 6/1/2021 • • • SECTION III — General Conditions duration of the contract term and following completion of the contract if the Contractor does not transfer the records to the public agency. d) Upon completion of the contract, transfer, at no cost, to the public agency all public records in possession of the Contractor or keep and maintain public records required by the public agency to perform the service. If the Contractor transfers all public records to the public agency upon completion of the contract, the Contractor shall destroy any public records that are exempt or confidential and exempt from public records disclosure requirements. If the Contractor keeps and maintains public records upon completion of the contract, the Contractor shall meet all applicable requirements for the retaining public records. All records stored electronically must be provided to the public agency, upon request from the public agency's custodian of public records in a format that is compatible with the information technology systems of the public agency. e) A request to inspect or copy public records relating to a public agency's contract for services must be made directly to the public agency. If the public agency does not possess the requested records, the public agency shall immediately notify the Contractor of the request and the Contractor must provide the records to the public agency or allow the records to be inspected or copied within a reasonable time. f) The Contractor hereby acknowledges and agrees that if the Contractor does not comply with the public agency's request for records, the public agency shall enforce the contract provisions in accordance with the contract. g) A Contractor who fails to provide the public records to the public agency within a reasonable time may be subject to penalties under Section 119.10, Florida Statutes. h) If a civil action is filed against a Contractor to compel production of public records relating to a public agency's contract for services, the court shall assess and award against the Contractor the reasonable costs of enforcement, including reasonable attorney fees, if: 1. The court determines that the Contractor unlawfully refused to comply with the public records request within a reasonable time; and 2. At least 8 business days before filing the action, the plaintiff provided written notice of the public request, including a statement that the Contractor has not complied with the request, to the public agency and to the Contractor. i) A notice complies with subparagraph (h)2. if it is sent to the public agency's custodian of public records and to the Contractor at the Contractor's address listed on its contract with the public agency or to the Contractor's registered agent. Global Express Guaranteed, or certified mail, with postage or shipping paid by the sender and with evidence of delivery, which may be in an electronic format. j) A Contractor who complies with a public records request within 8 business days after the notice is sent is not liable for the reasonable costs of enforcement. 7. OTHER WORK 7.1. RELATED WORK AT SITE The City reserves the right to have its own forces enter the construction site at any time and perform work as necessary in order to perform infrastructure repair or maintenance, whether related to the project or not. The Contractor will allow complete access to all utility owners for these purposes. The City may have its own forces perform new work related to the project, however, this work will be identified in the Contract Scope of Work and coordination will be such that this activity is SECTION III Page 25 of 49 Updated 6/1/2021 SECTION III — General Conditions denoted in the Contractor's CPM Schedule so as not to cause any delays or interference with the Contractor's work or schedule. 7.2. COORDINATION If the Owner contracts with others for the performance of other work on the Project at the site, the following will be set forth in the Scope of Work: (i) the person who will have authority and responsibility for coordination of the activities among the various prime Contractors will be identified; (ii) the specific matters to be covered by such authority and responsibility will be itemized; and (iii) the extent of such authority and responsibilities will be provided. Unless otherwise provided in the Supplementary Conditions, the Owner shall have sole authority and responsibility in respect of such coordination. 8. OWNER'S RESPONSIBILITY Except as otherwise provided in these General Conditions, the Owner shall issue all communications from the Owner to the Contractor through Owner's Representative. The Owner shall furnish the data required of the Owner under the Contract Documents promptly and shall make payments to Contractor promptly when they are due as provided in these General Conditions. The Owner is obligated to execute Change Orders as indicated in the Article on Changes In The Work. The Owner's responsibility in respect of certain inspections, tests, and approvals is set forth in the Article on Tests and Inspections. In connection with the Owner's right to stop work or suspend work, see the Article on Engineer may Stop the Work. The Article on Suspension of Work and Termination deals with the Owner's right to terminate services of Contractor under certain circumstances. Owner shall not supervise, direct or have control or authority over, nor be responsible for, Contractor's means, methods, techniques, sequences or procedures of construction or the safety precautions and programs incident thereto, or for any failure of Contractor to comply with Laws and Regulations applicable to the furnishing or performance of the Work. The Owner will not be responsible for Contractor's failure to perform or furnish the Work in accordance with the Contract Documents. 9. OWNER REPRESENTATIVE'S STATUS DURING CONSTRUCTION 9.1. OWNER'S REPRESENTATIVE Dependent of the project type, the Owner's Representative during the construction period will either be the Construction Manager, the Engineer, or a designee of the Project's Owner. The duties, responsibilities and the limitations of authority of Owner's Representative during construction are set forth in the Contract Documents and shall not be extended without written consent of Owner and Engineer. SECTION III Page 26 of 49 Updated 6/1/2021 SECTION III — General Conditions 9.2. CLARIFICATIONS AND INTERPRETATIONS Engineer will issue with reasonable promptness such written clarifications or interpretations of the requirements of the Contract Documents regarding design issues only, in the form of Submittal responses, RFI responses, Drawings or otherwise, as Engineer may determine necessary, which shall be consistent with the intent of and reasonably inferable from Contract Documents. All other clarifications and interpretations of the Contract Documents shall be issued form the Owner's Representative. Such written clarifications and interpretations will be binding on the Owner and Contractor. If Contractor believes that a written clarification or interpretation justifies an adjustment in the Contract Price or the Contract Time and the parties are unable to agree to the amount or extent thereof, if any, Contractor may make a written claim therefore as provided in the Articles for Change of Work and Change of Contract Time. 9.3. REJECTING OF DEFECTIVE WORK The Owner's Representative or the Engineer will have authority to disapprove or reject Work which Owner's Representative or the Engineer believes to be defective, or that Owner's Representative or the Engineer believes will not produce a completed Project that conforms to the Contract Documents or that will prejudice the integrity of the design concept of the completed Project as a functioning whole as indicated by the Contract Documents. The Owner's Representative or the Engineer will also have authority to require special inspection or testing of the Work whether or not the Work is fabricated, installed or completed. 9.4. SHOP DRAWINGS, CHANGE ORDERS, AND PAYMENTS In connection with Engineer's authority as to Shop Drawings and Samples, see articles on Shop Drawings and Samples. In connection with Owner's Representative authority as to Change Orders, see the articles on Changes of Work, Contract Price and Contract Time. In connection with Owner's Representative authority as to Applications for Payment, see the articles on Payments to Contractor and Completion. 9.5. DECISIONS ON DISPUTES The Owner's Representative will be the initial interpreter of the requirements of the Contract Documents and judge of the acceptability of the work thereunder. Claims, disputes and other matters relating to the acceptability of the work or the interpretation of the requirements of the Contract Documents pertaining to the performance and furnishing of the work and Claims under the Articles for Changes of Work, Changes of Contract Time and Changes of Contract Price will be referred initially to Owner's Representative in writing with a request for a formal decision in accordance with this paragraph. Written notice of each such claim, dispute or other matter will be delivered by the claimant to Owner's Representative and the other party to the Agreement promptly, but in no event later than thirty (30) days, after the start of the occurrence or event giving rise thereto, and written supporting data will be submitted to Owner's Representative and the other party within sixty (60) days after the start of such occurrence or event unless Owner's Representative allows an additional period of time for the submission of additional or more accurate data in support of such claim, dispute or other matter. The opposing party shall submit any response to Owner's Representative and the claimant within thirty (30) days after receipt of the claimant's last submittal unless Owner's Representative allows additional time. Owner's Representative will render a formal decision in writing within thirty (30) days after receipt of the opposing party's submittal, if any, in accordance with this paragraph. Owner Representative's written decision on such claim, dispute or other matter will be final and binding upon the Owner SECTION III Page 27 of 49 Updated 6/1/2021 SECTION III — General Conditions and Contractor unless (i) an appeal from Owner Representative's decision is taken within thirty (30) days of the Owner Representative's decision, or the appeal time which may be stated in a Dispute Resolution Agreement between Owner and Contractor for the settlement of disputes or (ii) if no such Dispute Resolution Agreement has been entered into, a written notice of intention to appeal from Owner Representative's written decision is delivered by the Owner or Contractor to the other and to Owner's Representative within thirty (30) days after the date of such decision and a formal proceeding is instituted by the appealing party in a forum of competent jurisdiction to exercise such rights or remedies as the appealing party may have with respect to such claim, dispute or other matter in accordance with applicable Laws and Regulations within sixty (60) days of the date of such decision, unless otherwise agreed in writing by the Owner and Contractor. When functioning as interpreter and judge, Owner's Representative will not show partiality to the Owner or Contractor and will not be liable in connection with any interpretation or decision rendered in good faith in such capacity. The rendering of a decision by Owner's Representative with respect to any such claim, dispute or other matter will be a condition precedent to any exercise by the Owner or Contractor of such rights or remedies as either may otherwise have under the Contract Documents or by Laws or Regulations in respect of any such claim, dispute or other matter pursuant the Article on Dispute Resolution. 9.6. LIMITATIONS ON OWNER REPRESENTATIVE'S RESPONSIBILITIES Neither Owner Representative's authority or responsibility under this paragraph or under any other provision of the Contract Documents nor any decision made by Owner's Representative in good faith either to exercise or not exercise such authority or responsibility or the undertaking, exercise or performance of any authority or responsibility by Owner's Representative shall create, impose or give rise to any duty owed by Owner's Representative to Contractor, any Subcontractor, any Supplier, any other person or organization or to any surety for or employee or agent of any of them. Owner's Representative will not supervise, direct, control or have authority over or be responsible for Contractor's means, methods, techniques, sequences or procedures of construction, or the safety precautions and programs incident thereto, or for any failure of Contractor to comply with Laws and Regulations applicable to the furnishing or performance of the work. Owner's Representative will not be responsible for Contractor's failure to perform or furnish the work in accordance with the Contract Documents. Owner's Representative will not be responsible for the acts or omissions of Contractor or of any Subcontractor, any Supplier, or of any other person or organization performing or furnishing any of the work. Owner Representative's review of the final Application for Payment and accompanying documentation and all maintenance and operating instructions, schedules, guarantees, bonds and certificates of inspection, tests and approvals and other documentation required to be delivered by the Contractor will only be to determine generally that their content complies with the requirements of the Contract Documents and, in the case of certificates of inspections, tests and approvals that the results certified indicate compliance with the Contract Documents. The limitations upon authority and responsibility set forth in this paragraph shall also apply to Owner Representative's CEI, the Engineer's Consultants, and assistants. SECTION III Page 28 of 49 Updated 6/1/2021 SECTION III — General Conditions 10. CHANGES IN THE WORK Without invalidating the Agreement and without notice to any surety, the Owner may, at any time or from time to time, order additions, deletions, or revisions in the Work. Such additions, deletions, or revisions will be authorized by a Written Amendment, a Change Order, or a Work Change Directive. Upon receipt of any such document, Contractor shall promptly proceed with the Work involved which will be performed under the applicable conditions of the Contract Documents (except as may otherwise be specifically provided). If the Owner and Contractor are unable to agree as to the extent, if any, of an adjustment in the Contract Price or an adjustment of the Contract Time that should be allowed as a result of a Work Change Directive, a claim may be made therefore as provided in these General Conditions. Contractor shall not be entitled to an increase in the Contract Price or an extension of the Contract Time with respect to any Work performed that is not required by the Contract Documents as amended, modified and supplemented as provided in these General Conditions except in the case of an emergency as provided or in the case of uncovering work as provided in article for Uncovering Work. The Owner and Contractor shall execute appropriate Change Orders or Written Amendments recommended by Owner's Representative covering: • changes in the work which are (i) ordered by the Owner (ii) required because of acceptance of defective work under the article for Acceptance of Defective Work or correcting defective Work under the article for Owner May Correct Defective Work or (iii) agreed to by the parties; • changes in the Contract Price or Contract Time which are agreed to by the parties; and • changes in the Contract Price or Contract Time which embody the substance of any written decision rendered by Owner's Representative pursuant to the article for Decisions on Disputes; • provided that, in lieu of executing any such Change Order, an appeal may be taken from any such decision in accordance with the provisions of the Contract Documents and applicable Laws and Regulations, but during any such appeal, Contractor shall carry on the Work and adhere to the progress schedule as provided in the article for Continuing the Work. If notice of any change affecting the general scope of the work or the provisions of the Contract Documents (including, but not limited to, Contract Price or Contract Time) is required by the provisions of any Bond to be given to a surety, the giving of any such notice will be Contractor's responsibility, and the amount of each applicable Bond will be adjusted accordingly. 11. CHANGES IN THE CONTRACT PRICE 11.1. CHANGES IN THE CONTRACT PRICE The Contract Price constitutes the total compensation (subject to authorized adjustments) payable to Contractor for performing the Work. All duties, responsibilities and obligations assigned to or undertaken by Contractor shall be at Contractor's expense without change in the Contract Price. The Contract Price may only be adjusted by a Change Order or by a Written Amendment. Any claim for an adjustment in the Contract Price shall be based on a written notice of claim stating the general nature of the claim, to be delivered by the party making the claim to the other party and to Owner's Representative or promptly (but in no event later than thirty days) after the start of the occurrence or event giving rise to the claim. Notice of the amount of the claim with supporting SECTION III Page 29 of 49 Updated 6/1/2021 SECTION III — General Conditions data shall be delivered within sixty (60) days after the start of such occurrence or event, unless Owner's Representative allows additional time for claimant to submit additional or more accurate data in support of the claim, and shall be accompanied by claimant's written statement that the claimed adjustment covers all known amounts to which the claimant is entitled as a result of said occurrence or event. No claim for an adjustment in the Contract Price will be valid if not submitted in accordance with this paragraph. The value of any Work covered by a Change Order or of any claim for an adjustment in the Contract Price will be determined as follows: (i) where the Work involved is covered by unit prices contained in the Contract Documents, by application of such unit prices to the quantities of the items involved (ii) where the Work involved is not covered by unit prices contained in the Contract Documents, by a mutually agreed lump sum (which may include an allowance for overhead and profit), (iii) where the Work is not covered by unit prices contained in the Contract Documents and agreement is reached to establish unit prices for the Work. Where the work involved is not covered by unit prices contained in the Contract Documents and where the Owner's Representative, the Owner, the Engineer, the Engineer's Consultant, and Contractor cannot mutually agree on a lump sum price, the City of Clearwater shall pay for directed changes in the Work, on "COST REIMBURSEMENT" basis. The Contractor shall apply for compensation, detailing Contractors forces, materials, equipment, Subcontractors, and other items of direct costs required for the directed work. The application for Cost Reimbursement shall be limited to the following items: 1. Labor, including foremen, for those hours associated with the direct work (actual payroll cost, including wages, fringe benefits, labor insurance and labor taxes established by law). Expressly excluded from this item are all costs associated with negotiating the subject change. 2. Materials associated with the change, including sales tax. The costs of materials shall be substantiated through vendors' invoices. 3. Rental or equivalent rental costs of equipment, including necessary transportation costs if specifically used for the Work. The rental rates shall not exceed the current rental rates prevailing in the locality or as defined in the rental Rate Blue Book for Construction Equipment (a.k.a. DataQuest Blue Book). The rental rate is defined as the full -unadjusted base rental rate for the appropriate item of construction equipment and shall cover the costs of all fuel, supplies, repairs, insurance, and other costs associated with supplying the equipment for work ordered. Contractor -owned equipment will be paid for the duration of time required to complete the work. Utilize lowest cost combination of hourly, daily, weekly, or monthly rates. Do not exceed estimated operating costs given in Blue Book. Operating costs will not be allowed for equipment on stand-by. 4. Additional costs for Bonds, Insurance if required by the City of Clearwater. The following fixed fees shall be added to the costs of the directed work performed by the Contractor or Subcontractor. A. A fixed fee of fifteen percent (15%) shall be added to the costs of Item 1 above. If work is performed by a Subcontractor, the Contractor's fee shall not exceed five percent (5%), and the Subcontractor's fee shall not exceed ten percent (10%). B. A fixed fee of ten percent (10%) shall be added to the costs of Item 2 above. C. No markup shall be added to the costs of Items 3 and 4. SECTION III Page 30 of 49 Updated 6/1/2021 SECTION III — General Conditions The fixed fees shall be considered the full compensation for all cost of general supervision, overhead, profit, and other general expense. • 11.2. ALLOWANCES AND FINAL CONTRACT PRICE ADJUSTMENT It is understood that Contractor has included in the Contract Price all allowances so named in the Contract Documents and shall cause the Work so covered to be furnished and performed for such sums as may be acceptable to Owner and Engineer. Contractor agrees that: (i) the allowances include the cost to Contractor (less any applicable trade discounts) of materials and equipment required by the allowances to be delivered at the Site, and all applicable taxes; and (ii) Contractor's costs for unloading and handling on the site, labor, installation costs, overhead, profit and other expenses contemplated for the allowances have been included in the Contract Price and not in the allowances and no demand for additional payment on account of any of the foregoing will be valid. Prior to final payment, an appropriate Change Order will be issued as recommended by Owner's Representative to reflect actual amounts due Contractor on account of Work covered by allowances and all the Work actually performed by the Contractor, and the Contract Price shall be correspondingly adjusted. 11.3. UNIT PRICE WORK Where the Contract Documents provide that all or part of the Work is to be Unit Price Work, initially the Contract Price will be deemed to include for all Unit Price Work an amount equal to the sum of the established unit price for each separately identified item of unit price work times the estimated quantity of each item as indicated in the Agreement. The estimated quantities of items of Unit Price Work are not guaranteed and are solely for the purpose of comparison of Bids and determining an initial Contract Price. Determinations of the actual quantities and classifications of Unit Price Work performed by Contractor will be made by Owner's Representative. Each unit price will be deemed to include an amount considered by Contractor to be adequate to cover Contractor's overhead and profit for each separately identified item. The Owner or Contractor may make a claim for an adjustment in the Contract Price if: (i) the quantity of any item of Unit Price Work performed by Contractor differs materially and significantly from the estimated quantity of such item indicated in the Contract Documents; and (ii) there is no corresponding adjustment with respect to any other item of Work; and (iii) if Contractor believes that Contractor is entitled to an increase in Contract Price as a result of having incurred additional expense or the Owner believes that the Owner is entitled to a decrease in Contract Price and the parties are unable to agree as to the amount of any such increase or decrease. On unit price contracts, Owner endeavors to provide adequate unit quantities to satisfactorily complete the construction of the project. It is expected that in the normal course of project construction and completion that not all unit quantities will be used in their entirety and that a finalizing change order which adjusts contract unit quantities to those unit quantities actually used in the construction of the project will result in a net decrease from the original Contract Price. Such reasonable deduction of final Contract Price should be anticipated by the Contractor in his original bid. 12. CHANGES IN THE CONTRACT TIME The Contract Time (or Milestones) may only be changed by a Change Order or a Written Amendment. Any claim for an adjustment of the Contract Time (or Milestones) shall be based on written notice delivered by the party making the claim to the other party and to Owner's Representative promptly, but in no event later than thirty (30) days, after the occurrence of the SECTION III Page 31 of 49 Updated 6/1/2021 SECTION III —General Conditions event giving rise to the claim and stating the general nature of the claim. Notice of the extent of the claim with supporting data shall be delivered within sixty (60) days after such occurrence, unless Owner's Representative allows an additional period of time to ascertain more accurate data in support of the claim, and shall be accompanied by the claimant's written statement that the adjustment claimed is the entire adjustment to which the claimant has reason to believe it is entitled as a result of the occurrence of said event. All claims for adjustment in the Contract Time (or Milestones) shall be determined by Owner's Representative. No claim for an adjustment in the Contract Time (or Milestones) will be valid if not submitted in accordance with the requirements of this paragraph. All time limits stated in the Contract Documents are of the essence of the Agreement. Where Contractor is prevented from completing any part of the work within the Contract Time (or Milestones) due to delay beyond the control of Contractor, the Contract Time (or Milestones) may be extended in an amount equal to the time lost due to such delay if a claim is made therefore as provided in the article for Changes in the Work. Delays beyond the control of Contractor shall include, but not be limited to, acts by the Owner, acts of utility owners or other contractors performing other work as contemplated by the article for Other Work, fires, floods, epidemics, abnormal weather conditions or acts of God. Delays attributable to and within the control of a Subcontractor or Supplier shall be deemed to be delays within the control of Contractor. Where Contractor is prevented from completing any part of the Work within the Contract Times (or Milestones) due to delay beyond the control of both the Owner and Contractor, an extension of the Contract Time (or Milestones) in an amount equal to the time lost due to such delay shall be Contractor's sole and exclusive remedy for such delay. In no event shall the Owner be liable to Contractor, any Subcontractor, any Supplier, any other person, or to any surety for or employee or agent of any of them, for damages arising out of or resulting from (i) delays caused by or within the control of Contractor, or (ii) delays beyond the control of both parties including but not limited to fires, floods, epidemics, abnormal weather conditions, acts of God or acts by utility owners or other contractors performing other work as contemplated by paragraph for Other Work. 13. TESTS AND INSPECTIONS, CORRECTION, REMOVAL OR ACCEPTANCE OF DEFECTIVE WORK 13.1. TESTS AND INSPECTION Contractor shall give Owner's Representative and Engineer timely notice of readiness of the Work for all required inspections, tests or approvals, and shall cooperate with inspection and testing personnel to facilitate required inspections or tests. Contractor shall employ and pay for the services of an independent testing laboratory to perform all inspections, tests, or approvals required by the Contract Documents. The costs for these inspections, tests or approvals shall be borne by the Contractor except as otherwise provided in the Contract Documents. If Laws or Regulations of any public body having jurisdiction require any Work (or part thereof) specifically to be inspected, tested or approved by an employee or other representative of such public body including all Owner Building Departments and Owner Utility Departments, Contractor shall assume full responsibility for arranging and obtaining such inspections, tests or approvals, pay all costs in connection therewith, and furnish Owner's Representative the required certificates of inspection or approval. Unless otherwise stated in the Contract Documents, Owner SECTION III Page 32 of 49 Updated 6/1/2021 • • SECTION III — General Conditions permit and impact fees will be waived. Contractor shall also be responsible for arranging and obtaining and shall pay all costs in connection with any inspections, tests or approvals required for Owner's and Engineer's acceptance of materials or equipment to be incorporated in the Work, or of materials, mix designs, or equipment submitted for approval prior to Contractor's purchase thereof for incorporation of the Work. If any Work (or the work of others) that is to be inspected tested or approved is covered by Contractor without written concurrence of Owner's Representative, it must, if requested by Owner's Representative, be uncovered for observation. Uncovering Work as provided in this paragraph shall be at Contractor's expense unless Contractor has given Owner's Representative and Engineer timely notice of Contractor's intention to cover the same and Owner's Representative has not acted with reasonable promptness in response to such notice. 13.2. UNCOVERING THE WORK If any Work is covered contrary to the written request of Owner's Representative, it must, if requested by Owner's Representative, be uncovered for Owner Representative's observation and replaced at Contractor's expense. If Owner's Representative considers it necessary or advisable that covered Work be observed by Owner's Representative or inspected or tested by others, Contractor, at Owner Representative's request, shall uncover, expose or otherwise make available for observation, inspection or testing as Engineer or Owner's Representative may require, that portion of the Work in question, furnishing all necessary labor, material and equipment. If it is found that such Work is defective, Contractor shall pay all claims, costs, losses and damages caused by, arising out of or resulting from such uncovering, exposure, observation, inspection and testing and of satisfactory replacement or reconstruction (including but not limited to all costs of repair or replacement of work of others); and the Owner shall be entitled to an appropriate decrease in the Contract Price for the costs of the investigation, and, if the parties are unable to agree as to the amount thereof, may make a claim therefore as provided in the article for Change in Contract Price. If, however, such Work is not found to be defective, Contractor shall be allowed an increase in the Contract Price or an extension of the Contract Time (or Milestones), or both, directly attributable to such uncovering, exposure, observation, inspection, testing, replacement and reconstruction; and, if the parties are unable to agree as to the amount or extent thereof, Contractor may make a claim therefore as provided the article for Change in Contract Price and Change of Contract Time. 13.3. OWNER'S REPRESENTATIVE MAY STOP THE WORK If the Work is defective, or Contractor fails to supply sufficient skilled workers or suitable materials or equipment, or fails to furnish or perform the Work in such a way that the completed Work will conform to the Contract Documents, Engineer or Owner's Representative may order Contractor to stop the Work, or any portion thereof, until the cause for such order has been eliminated; however, this right of Owner's Representative to stop the Work shall not give rise to any duty on the part of Owner's Representative or Owner to exercise this right for the benefit of Contractor or any surety or other party. If the Owner's Representative stops Work under this paragraph, Contractor shall be entitled to no extension of Contract Time or increase in Contract Price. • 13.4. CORRECTION OR REMOVAL OF DEFECTIVE WORK If required by Engineer or Owner's Representative, Contractor shall promptly, as directed, either correct all defective Work, whether or not fabricated, installed or completed, or, if the Work has SECTION III Page 33 of 49 Updated 6/1/2021 SECTION III — General Conditions been rejected by Engineer or Owner's Representative, remove it from the site and replace it with Work that is not defective. Contractor shall pay all claims, costs, losses and damages caused by or resulting from such correction or removal (including but not limited to all costs of repair or replacement of work of others). 13.5. WARRANTY/CORRECTION PERIOD If within one year after the date of Substantial Completion or such longer period of time as may be prescribed by Laws or Regulations or by the terms of any applicable special guarantee required by the Contract Documents or by any specific provision of the Contract Documents, any Work is found to be defective, Contractor shall promptly, without cost to the Owner and in accordance with the Owner's written instructions; (i) correct such defective Work, or, if it has been rejected by the Owner, remove it from the site and replace it with Work that is not defective and (ii) satisfactorily correct or remove and replace any damage to other Work or the work of others resulting therefrom. If Contractor does not promptly comply with the terms of such instructions, or in an emergency where delay would cause serious risk of loss or damage, the Owner may have the defective Work corrected or the rejected. Work removed and replaced, and all claims, costs, losses and damages caused by or resulting from such removal and replacement (including but not limited to all costs of repair or replacement of work of others) will be paid by Contractor. In special circumstances where a particular item of equipment is placed in continuous service before Final Completion of all the Work, the correction period for that item may start to run from an earlier date if specifically, and expressly so provided in the Specifications or by Written Amendment. Where defective Work (and damage to other Work resulting therefrom) has been corrected, removed or replaced under this paragraph the correction period hereunder with respect to such Work will be extended for an additional period of one year after such correction or removal and replacement has been satisfactorily completed. 13.6. ACCEPTANCE OF DEFECTIVE WORK If, instead of requiring correction or removal and replacement of defective Work, the Owner prefers to accept it, the Owner may do so. Contractor shall pay all claims, costs, losses, and damages attributable to the Owner's evaluation of and determination to accept such defective Work such costs to be approved by Owner's Representative as to reasonableness. If any such acceptance occurs prior to Owner Representative's recommendation of final payment, a Change Order will be issued incorporating the necessary revisions in the Contract Documents with respect to the Work; and the Owner shall be entitled to an appropriate decrease in the Contract Price, and, if the parties are unable to agree as to the amount thereof, the Owner may make a claim therefore as provided in article for Change of Contract Price. If the acceptance occurs after the Owner Representative's recommendation for final payment an appropriate amount will be paid by Contractor to the Owner. 13.7. OWNER MAY CORRECT DEFECTIVE WORK If Contractor fails within a reasonable time after written notice from Owner's Representative to correct defective Work or to remove and replace rejected Work as required by Owner's Representative in accordance with the article for Correction and Removal of Defective Work or if Contractor fails to perform the Work in accordance with the Contract Documents, or if Contractor fails to comply with any other provision of the Contract Documents, the Owner may, after seven SECTION III Page 34 of 49 Updated 6/1/2021 • SECTION III — General Conditions days' written notice to Contractor, correct and remedy any such deficiency. In exercising the rights and remedies under this paragraph the Owner shall proceed expeditiously. In connection with such corrective and remedial action, the Owner may exclude Contractor from all or part of the site, take possession of all or part of the Work, and suspend Contractor's services related thereto, and incorporate in the Work all materials and equipment stored at the site or for which the Owner has paid Contractor but which are stored elsewhere. Contractor shall allow Owner, Owner's Representatives, Agents and Employees, the Owner's other contractors, and Owner's Representative, Engineer, and Engineer's Consultants access to the site to enable the Owner to exercise the rights and remedies under this paragraph. All claims, costs, losses and damages incurred or sustained by the Owner in exercising such rights and remedies will be charged against Contractor and a Change Order will be issued incorporating the necessary revisions in the Contract Documents with respect to the Work; and the Owner shall be entitled to an appropriate decrease in the Contract Price, and, if the parties are unable to agree as to the amount thereof, the Owner may make a claim therefore as provided in the article for Change of Contract Price. Such claims, costs, losses and damages will include but not be limited to all costs of repair or replacement of work of others destroyed or damaged by correction, removal or replacement of Contractor's defective Work. Contractor shall not be allowed an extension of the Contract Time (or Milestones) because of any delay in the performance of the Work attributable to the exercise by the Owner of the Owner's rights and remedies hereunder. 14. PAYMENTS TO CONTRACTOR AND COMPLETION Requests for payment shall be processed in accordance with F.S. 218.735 and as described herein. Progress payments on account of Unit Price Work will be based on the number of units completed. • 14.1. APPLICATION FOR PROGRESS PAYMENT Contractor shall submit (not more often than once a month) to Owner's Representative for review an Application for Payment filled out and signed by Contractor covering the Work completed once each month and accompanied by such supporting documentation as is required by the Owner's Representative and the Contract Documents. Unless otherwise stated in the Contract Documents, payment will not be made for materials and equipment not incorporated in the Work. Payment will only be made for that portion of the Work, which is fully installed including all materials, labor, and equipment. A retainage of not less than five (5%) of the amount of each Application for Payment for the total of all Work, including As -Built Survey and Inspector overtime reimbursement, completed to date will be held until final completion and acceptance of the Work covered in the Contract Documents. No progress payment shall be construed to be acceptance of any portion of the Work under contract. The Contractor shall review with the Engineer or the Construction Inspector all quantities and work for which payment is being applied for and reach agreement prior to submittal of an Official Pay Request. The Engineer or the Construction Inspector will verify that the on-site marked up As -Built Drawings are up to date with the work and are in compliance with the Contract Documents. In addition to all other payment provisions set out in this contract, the Owner's Representative may require the Contractor to produce for Owner, within fifteen (15) days of the approval of any progress payment, evidence and/or payment affidavit that all Subcontractors and Suppliers have been paid any sum or sums then due. A failure on the part of the Contractor to provide the report as required herein shall result in further progress or partial payments being withheld until the report is provided. SECTION III Page 35 of 49 Updated 6/1/2021 SECTION III — General Conditions 14.2. CONTRACTOR'S WARRANTY OF TITLE Contractor warrants and guarantees that title to all Work, materials and equipment covered by any Application for Payment, whether incorporated in the Project or not, will pass to the Owner no later than the time of payment, free and clear of liens. No materials or supplies for the Work shall be purchased by Contractor or Subcontractor subject to any chattel mortgage or under a conditional sale contact or other agreement by which an interest is retained by the seller. Contractor warrants that he has good title to all materials and supplies used by him in the Work, free from all liens, claims or encumbrances. Contractor shall indemnify and save the Owner harmless from all claims growing out of the lawful demands of Subcontractors, laborers, workmen, mechanics, materialmen, and furnishers of machinery and parts thereof, equipment, power tools, and all supplies incurred in the furtherance of the performance of this Contract. Contractor shall at the Owner's request, furnish satisfactory evidence that all obligations of nature hereinabove designated have been paid, discharged, or waived. If Contractor fails to do so, then the Owner may, after having served written notice on said Contractor either pay unpaid bills, of which the Owner has written notice, or withhold from the Contractor's unpaid compensation a sum of money deemed reasonably sufficient to pay any and all such lawful claims until satisfactory evidence is furnished that all liabilities have been fully discharged, whereupon payment to Contractor shall be resumed in accordance with the terms of this Contract, but in no event shall the provisions of this sentence be construed to impose any obligations upon the Owner to the Contractor or the Surety. In paying any unpaid bills of the Contractor, the Owner shall be deemed the agent of Contractor and any payment so made by the Owner shall be considered as payment made under the Contract by the Owner to Contractor, and the Owner shall not be liable to Contractor for any such payment made in good faith. 14.3. REVIEW OF APPLICATIONS FOR PROGRESS PAYMENTS The Owner's Representative will within twenty (20) business days after receipt authorize and process payment by the Owner a properly submitted and documented Application for payment unless the application requires review by an Agent. If the Application for payment requires review and approval by an Agent, properly submitted and documented Applications for payment will be paid by the Owner within twenty-five (25) business days. If an Application for payment is rejected, notice shall be given within twenty (20) business days of receipt indicating the reasons for refusing payment. The reasons for rejecting an Application will be submitted in writing, specifying deficiencies, and identifying actions that would make the Application proper. In the latter case, Contractor may make the necessary corrections and resubmit the Application. The Owner's Representative or Agent may refuse to recommend the whole or any part of any payment to Owner. Owner's Representative or Agent may also refuse to recommend any such payment, or, because of subsequently discovered evidence or the results of subsequent inspections or test, nullify any such payment previously recommended, to such extent as may be necessary in Owner Representative's or Agent's opinion to protect the Owner from loss because: (i) the Work is defective, or completed Work has been damaged requiring correction or replacement, (ii) the Contract Price has been reduced by amendment or Change Order, (iii) the Owner has been required to correct defective Work or complete Work, or (iv) Owner's Representative or Agent has actual knowledge of the occurrence of any of the events enumerated in the article on Suspension of Work and Termination. The Owner may refuse to make payment of the full amount recommended by the Owner's Representative or Agent because: (i) claims have been made against the Owner on account of Contractor's performance or furnishing of the Work, (ii) Liens have been filed in connection with the Work, except where Contractor has delivered a specific Bond satisfactory to the Owner to SECTION III Page 36 of 49 Updated 6/1/2021 SECTION III — General Conditions secure the satisfaction and discharge of such Liens, (iii) there are other items entitling the Owner to a set-off against the amount recommended, or (iv) the Owner has actual knowledge of any of the events described in this paragraph. The Owner shall give Contractor notice of refusal to pay in accordance with the time constraints of this section with a copy to the Owner's Representative or Agent, stating the reasons for such actions, and Owner shall promptly pay Contractor the amount so withheld, or any adjustment thereto agreed to by the Owner and Contractor, when Contractor corrects to the Owner's satisfaction the reasons for such action. 14.4. PARTIAL UTILIZATION Use by the Owner at the Owner's option of any substantially completed part of the Work which (i) has specifically been identified in the Contract Documents, or (ii) Owner, Engineer, Owner's Representative, and Contractor agree constitutes a separately functioning and usable part of the Work that can be used by the Owner for its intended purpose without significant interference with Contractor's performance of the remainder of the Work, may be accomplished prior to Final Completion of all the Work subject to the following: The Owner at any time may request Contractor in writing to permit the Owner to use any such part of the Work which the Owner believes to be ready for its intended use and substantially complete. If Contractor agrees that such part of the Work is substantially complete, Contractor will certify to Owner, Owner's Representative, and Engineer that such part of the Work is substantially complete and request Owner's Representative to issue a certificate of Substantial Completion for that part of the Work. Contractor at any time may notify Owner, Owner's Representative, and Engineer in writing that Contractor considers any such part of the Work ready for its intended use and substantially complete and request Owner's Representative to issue a certificate of Substantial Completion for that part of the Work. Within a reasonable time after either such request, Owner, Contractor, Owner's Representative, and Engineer shall make an inspection of that part of the Work to determine its status of completion. If Engineer does not consider that part of the Work to be substantially complete, Engineer will notify Owner, Owner's Representative, and Contractor in writing giving the reasons, therefore. If Engineer considers that part of the Work to be substantially complete, the provisions of the articles for Substantial Completion and Partial Utilization will apply with respect to certification of Substantial Completion of that part of the Work and the division of responsibility in respect thereof and access thereto. 14.5. FINAL INSPECTION Upon written notice from Contractor that the entire Work or an agreed portion thereof is complete, Owner's Representative will make a final inspection with Engineer, Owner and Contractor and will within thirty (30) days notify Contractor in writing of particulars in which this inspection reveals that the Work is incomplete or defective. The Owner's Representative will produce a final punch list, deliver it to the Contractor within five (5) days of completion and assign a date for this work to be completed not less than thirty (30) days from delivery of the list. Failure to include any corrective work or pending items does not alter the responsibility of the Contractor to complete all the construction services purchased pursuant to the contract. Contractor shall immediately take such measures as are necessary to complete such Work or remedy such deficiencies. 14.6. FINAL APPLICATION FOR PAYMENT After Contractor has completed all such corrections to the satisfaction of Owner's Representative and has delivered in accordance with the Contract Documents all maintenance and operating instructions, As -Built, schedules, guarantees, Bonds, certificates or other evidence of insurance SECTION III Page 37 of 49 Updated 6/1/2021 SECTION III — General Conditions required by the paragraph for Bonds and Insurance, certificates of inspection, Inspector overtime reimbursement as required in the Contract Documents and other documents, Contractor may make application for fmal payment following the procedure for progress payments. The final Application for Payment shall be accompanied (except as previously delivered) by: (i) all documentation called for in the Contract Documents, including but not limited to the evidence of insurance required by paragraph for Bonds and Insurance, and (ii) executed consent of the surety to final payment using the form contained in Section V of the Contract Documents. Prior to application for final payment, Contractor shall clean and remove from the premises all surplus and discarded materials, rubbish, and temporary structures, and shall restore in an acceptable manner all property, both public and private, which has been damaged during the prosecution of the Work and shall leave the Work in a neat and presentable condition. 14.7. FINAL PAYMENT AND ACCEPTANCE If through no fault of Contractor, final completion of the Work is significantly delayed and if Owner's Representative so confirms, the Owner shall, upon receipt of Contractor's fmal Application for payment and recommendation of Owner's Representative, and without terminating the Agreement, make payment of the balance due for that portion of the Work fully completed and accepted. If the remaining balance to be held by the Owner for Work not fully completed or corrected is less than the retainage stipulated in the Agreement, and if Bonds have been furnished as required in paragraph for Bonds and Insurance, the written consent of the surety to the payment of the balance due for that portion of the Work fully completed and accepted shall be submitted by Contractor to Owner's Representative with the Application for such payment. Such payment shall be made under the terms and conditions governing final payment, except that such payment shall not constitute a waiver of claims. If on the basis of Owner Representative's observation of the Work during construction and final inspection, and Owner Representative's review of the final Application for Payment and accompanying documentation, all as required by the Contract Documents, Owner's Representative is satisfied that the Work has been completed and Contractor's other obligations under the Contract Documents have been fulfilled, Owner's Representative will indicate in writing his recommendation of payment and present the Application to Owner for payment. Thereupon, Owner's Representative will give written notice to Owner and Contractor that the Work is acceptable subject to the provisions of this article. Otherwise, Owner's Representative will return the Application to Contractor, indicating in writing the reasons for refusing to recommend final payment, in which case Contractor shall make the necessary corrections and resubmit the Application. If the Application and accompanying documentation are appropriate as to form and substance, the Owner shall, within twenty (20) days after receipt thereof pay Contractor the amount recommended by Owner's Representative. 14.8. WAIVER OF CLAIMS The making and acceptance of final payment will constitute: a waiver of all claims by the Owner against Contractor, except claims arising from unsettled Liens, from defective Work appearing after final inspection, from failure to comply with the Contract Documents or the terms of any special guarantees specified therein, or from Contractor's continuing obligations under the Contract Documents; and a waiver of all claims by Contractor against the Owner other than those previously made in writing and still unsettled. SECTION III Page 38 of 49 Updated 6/1/2021 SECTION III — General Conditions 15. SUSPENSION OF WORK AND TERMINATION • 15.1. OWNER MAY SUSPEND THE WORK • • At any time and without cause, Owner's Representative may suspend the Work or any portion thereof for a period of not more than ninety (90) days by notice in writing to Contractor, which will fix the date on which Work will be resumed. Contractor shall resume the Work on the date so fixed. Contractor shall be allowed an adjustment in the Contract Price or an extension of the Contract Times, or both, directly attributable to any such suspension if Contractor makes an approved claim therefore as provided in the articles for Change of Contract Price and Change of Contract Time. 15.2. OWNER MAY TERMINATE Upon the occurrence of any one or more of the following events: • Contractor persistently fails to perform the work in accordance with the Contract Documents (including, but not limited to, failure to supply sufficient skilled workers or suitable materials or equipment or failure to adhere to the progress schedule as adjusted from time to time); • Contractor disregards Laws and Regulations of any public body having jurisdiction; • Contractor violates Article 6.7.1 of this Section III; • Contractor disregards the authority of Owner's Representative; • Contractor otherwise violates in any substantial way any provisions of the Contract Documents; or if the Work to be done under this Contract is abandoned, or if this Contract or any part thereof is sublet, without the previous written consent of the Owner, or if the Contract or any claim thereunder is assigned by Contractor otherwise than as herein specified, or at any time Owner's Representative certifies in writing to the Owner that the rate of progress of the Work or any part thereof is unsatisfactory or that the work or any part thereof is unnecessarily or unreasonably delayed; • Lack of funding. The City's performance and obligation to pay under this Contract is contingent upon an annual appropriation by the Clearwater City Council. The Owner may, after giving Contractor (and the surety, if any), seven days' written notice and, to the extent permitted by Laws and Regulations, terminate the services of Contractor, exclude Contractor from the site and take possession of the Work and of all Contractor's tools, appliances, construction equipment and machinery at the site and use the same to the full extent they could be used by Contractor (without liability to Contractor for trespass or conversion), incorporate in the Work all materials and equipment stored at the site or for which the Owner has paid Contractor but which are stored elsewhere, and finish the Work as the Owner may deem expedient. In such case Contractor shall not be entitled to receive any further payment until the Work is finished. If the unpaid balance of the Contract Price exceeds all claims, costs, losses, and damages sustained by the Owner arising out of or resulting from completing the Work such excess will be paid to Contractor. If such claims, costs, losses, and damages exceed such unpaid balance, Contractor shall pay the difference to the Owner. Such claims, costs, losses and damages incurred by the Owner will be reviewed by Owner's Representative as to their reasonableness and when so approved by Owner's Representative incorporated in a Change Order, provided that when exercising any rights or remedies under this paragraph the Owner shall not be required to obtain the lowest price for the Work performed. SECTION III Page 39 of 49 Updated 6/1/2021 SECTION III — General Conditions Where Contractor's services have been so terminated by the Owner, the termination will not affect any rights or remedies of the Owner against Contractor then existing or which may thereafter accrue. Any retention or payment of moneys due Contractor by the Owner will not release Contractor from liability. Upon seven (7) days' written notice to Contractor and Owner's Representative, the Owner may, without cause and without prejudice to any other right or remedy of the Owner, elect to terminate the Agreement. In such case, Contractor shall be paid (without duplication of any items): • for completed and acceptable Work executed in accordance with the Contract Documents prior to the effective date of termination, including fair and reasonable sums for overhead and profit on such Work; • for expenses sustained prior to the effective date of termination in performing services and furnishing labor, materials or equipment as required by the Contract Documents in connection with uncompleted Work, plus fair and reasonable sums for overhead and profit on such expenses; • for all claims, costs, losses and damages incurred in settlement of terminated contracts with Subcontractors, Suppliers and others; • and for reasonable expenses directly attributable to termination. Contractor shall not be paid on account of loss of anticipated profits or revenue or other economic loss arising out of or resulting from such termination. 15.3. CONTRACTOR MAY STOP WORK OR TERMINATE If, through no act or fault of Contractor, the Work is suspended for a period of more than ninety (90) days by the Owner or under an order of court or other public authority, or the Owner's Representative fails to act on any Application for Payment within thirty (30) days after it is submitted or the Owner fails for thirty (30) days to pay Contractor any sum finally determined to be due, then Contractor may, upon seven (7) days' written notice to the Owner and Owner's Representative, and provided the Owner or Owner's Representative does not remedy such suspension or failure within that time, terminate the Agreement and recover from the Owner payment on the same terms as provided in the article for the Owner May Terminate. However, if the Work is suspended under an order of court through no fault of Owner, the Contractor shall not be entitled to payment except as the Court may direct. In lieu of terminating the Agreement and without prejudice to any other right or remedy, if Owner's Representative has failed to act on an Application for Payment within thirty (30) days after it is submitted, or the Owner has failed for thirty (30) days to pay Contractor any sum finally determined to be due, Contractor may upon seven (7) days' written notice to the Owner and Owner's Representative stop the Work until payment of all such amounts due Contractor. The provisions of this article are not intended to preclude Contractor from making claim under paragraphs for Change of Contract Price or Change of Contract Time or otherwise for expenses or damage directly attributable to Contractor's stopping Work as permitted by this article. 16. DISPUTE RESOLUTION If and to the extent that the Owner and Contractor have agreed on the method and procedure for resolving disputes between them that may arise under this Agreement, such dispute resolution method and procedure will proceed. If no such agreement on the method and procedure for resolving such disputes has been reached, subject to the provisions of the article for Decisions on Disputes, the Owner and Contractor may exercise such rights or remedies as either may otherwise SECTION III Page 40 of 49 Updated 6/1/2021 • • • SECTION III — General Conditions have under the Contract Documents or by Laws or Regulations in respect of any dispute provided, however, that nothing herein shall require a dispute to be submitted to binding arbitration. 17. MISCELLANEOUS 17.1. SUBMITTAL AND DOCUMENT FORMS The form of all submittals, notices, change orders, pay applications, logs, schedules and other documents permitted or required to be used or transmitted under the Contract Documents shall be determined by the Owner's Representative subject to the approval of Owner. 17.2. GIVING NOTICE Whenever any provision of the Contract Documents requires the giving of written notice, notice will be deemed to have been validly given if delivered in person to the individual or to a member of the firm or to an officer of the corporation for whom it is intended, or if delivered or sent by registered or certified mail, postage prepaid, to the last business address known to the giver of the notice. 17.3. NOTICE OF CLAIM Should the Owner or Contractor suffer injury or damage to person or property because of any error, omission or any act of the other party or of any of the other party's officers, employees or agents or others for whose acts the other party is legally liable, claim will be made in writing to the other party within a reasonable time of the first observance of such injury or damage. The provisions of this paragraph shall not be construed as a substitute for or a waiver of the provisions of any applicable statute of limitations or repose. 17.4. PROFESSIONAL FEES AND COURT COSTS INCLUDED Whenever reference is made to "claims, costs, losses and damages," the phrase shall include in each case, but not be limited to, all fees and charges of engineers, architects, attorneys and other professionals and all court or other dispute resolution costs. 17.5. ASSIGNMENT OF CONTRACT The Contractor shall not assign this contract or any part thereof or any rights thereunder without the approval of Owner, nor without the consent of surety unless the surety has waived its rights to notice of assignment. 17.6. RENEWAL OPTION Annual Contracts issued through the Engineering Department may be renewed for up to three (3) years, upon mutual consent of both the Owner and the Contractor/Vendor. All terms, conditions and unit prices shall remain constant unless otherwise specified in the contract specifications or in the Invitation to bid. Renewals shall be made at the sole discretion of the Owner and must be agreed to in writing by both parties. All renewals are contingent upon the availability of funds, and the satisfactory performance of the Contractor as determined by the Construction Department. SECTION III Page 41 of 49 Updated 6/1/2021 SECTION III — General Conditions 17.7. ROLL -OFF CONTAINERS AND/OR DUMPSTERS All City construction projects shall utilize City of Clearwater Solid Waste roll -off containers and/or dumpsters for their disposal and hauling needs. For availability or pricing contact City of Clearwater, Solid Waste Department, by phone: (727) 562-4929. 18. ORDER AND LOCATION OF THE WORK The City reserves the right to accept and use any portion of the work whenever it is considered to the public interest to do so. The Engineer shall have the power to direct on what line or street the Contractor shall work and order thereof. 19. MATERIAL USED All material incorporated into the final work shall be new material unless otherwise approved by the Engineer. If requested by the Engineer, the Contractor shall furnish purchase receipts of all materials. 20. CONFLICT BETWEEN PLANS AND SPECIFICATIONS The various Contract Documents shall be given precedence, in case of conflict, error or discrepancy, as follows: Modifications, Contract Agreement, Addenda, Supplementary General Conditions, General Conditions, Supplementary Technical Specifications and Technical Specifications. In a series of Modifications or Addenda the latest will govern. In the case of an inconsistency between Drawings and Specifications or within either Document not clarified by addendum, the better quality, more stringent or greater quantity of Work shall be provided in accordance with the Engineer/Architect's interpretation. 21. OWNER DIRECT PURCHASE (ODP) 21.1. SALES TAX SAVINGS The Owner reserves the right to purchase certain portions of the materials or equipment for the Project directly in order to save applicable sales tax in compliance with Florida Law since owner is exempt from the payment of sales tax. The contract price includes Florida sales and other applicable taxes for materials, supplies, and equipment which will be a part of the Contractor's Work. Owner -purchasing of construction materials or equipment, if selected, will be administered on a deductive Change Order basis. The contract price shall be reduced by the actual cost of the materials or equipment purchased by owner plus the normally applicable sales tax, even if the actual cost is in excess of the cost for the materials or equipment as -bid by the Contractor. For purposes of calculating Engineering Fees, Contractor Fees, Architects' Fees, and any other amounts that are based on the contract amount, however, the original, as -bid contract amount shall be used. Direct purchase shall be considered for single items or materials that exceed $10,000 in value and/or items identified in Section V, Bidders Proposal. The Contractor shall provide the Owner an ODP Summary of all intended suppliers, vendors, equipment, and materials for consideration as ODP materials or equipment (refer to ODP Instructions in Contract Appendix). SECTION III Page 42 of 49 Updated 6/1/2021 • • • SECTION III — General Conditions 21.2. TITLE AND OWNER RISK Owner will issue Purchase Orders and provide a copy of Owner's Florida Consumer Certification of Tax Exemption and Certificate of Entitlement directly to the Vendor for ODP materials or equipment. Invoices for ODP materials or equipment shall be issued to the Owner, and a copy sent to the Contractor. Notwithstanding the transfer of ODP materials or equipment by the Owner to the Contractor's possession, the Owner shall retain legal and equitable title to any and all ODP materials or equipment; therefore, the owner assumes the risk of damage or loss at the time of purchase or delivery of items, unless material is damaged as the result of negligence by the Contractor. 21.3. CONTRACTOR'S RECEIPT OF MATERIALS The Contractor shall be fully responsible for all matters relating to the receipt of materials or equipment furnished to the Owner including, but not limited to, verifying correct quantities, verifying documents of orders in a timely manner, coordinating purchases, providing and obtaining all warranties and guarantees required by the Contract Documents, and inspection and acceptance of the goods at the time of delivery. The Owner shall coordinate with Contractor and Vendor delivery schedules, sequence of delivery, loading orientation, and other arrangements normally required by the Contractor for the particular materials or equipment furnished. The Contractor shall provide all services required for the unloading and handling of materials or equipment. The Contractor agrees to indemnify and hold harmless the Owner from any and all claims of whatever nature resulting from non-payment of goods to suppliers arising from the action of the Contractor. As ODP materials or equipment are delivered to the job site, the Contractor shall visually inspect all shipments from the suppliers and approve the vendor's invoice for items delivered. The Contractor shall assure that each delivery of ODP materials or equipment is accompanied by documentation adequate to identify the Purchase Order against which the purchase is made. This documentation may consist of a delivery ticket and/or an invoice from the supplier conforming to the Purchase Order together with such additional information as the Owner may require. The Contractor will then forward an electronic copy of the invoice and supporting documentation to the Owner for payment within fourteen (14) calendar days of receipt of said goods or materials. Such payment shall be directly from public funds, from Owner to Vendor. The Contractor shall insure that ODP materials or equipment conform to the Specifications and determine prior to acceptance of goods at time of delivery if such materials or equipment are patently defective, and whether such materials or equipment are identical to the materials or equipment ordered and match the description on the bill of lading. If the Contractor discovers defective or non -conformities in ODP materials or equipment upon such visual inspection, the Contractor shall not utilize such nonconforming or defective materials or equipment in the Contractor's Work and instead shall properly notify the Owner of the defective or nonconforming condition so that repair or replacement of those materials or equipment can occur without undue delay or interruption to the Project. If the Contractor fails to perform such inspection and otherwise incorporates into the Contractor's Work such defective or nonconforming ODP materials or equipment, the condition of which it either knew or should have known by performance of an inspection, Contractor shall be responsible for all damages to the Owner, resulting from Contractor's incorporation of such materials or equipment into the Project, including liquidated damages. SECTION III Page 43 of 49 Updated 6/1/2021 SECTION III — General Conditions 21.4. ODP RECORDS, WARRANTIES, AND INDEMNIFICATION The Contractor shall maintain records of all ODP materials or equipment it incorporates into Contractor's Work from the stock of ODP materials or equipment in its possession. The Contractor shall account monthly to the Owner for any ODP materials or equipment delivered into the Contractor's possession, indicating portions of all such materials or equipment which have been incorporated in the Contractor's Work. The Contractor shall be responsible for obtaining and managing all warranties and guarantees for all materials, equipment and products as required by the Contract Documents. All repair, maintenance, or damage -repair calls shall be forwarded to the Contractor for resolution with the appropriate supplier, vendor, or Subcontractor. The Owner shall indemnify and hold Contractor harmless from any sales tax (and interest and penalties incurred in connection therewith) in the event there is a final determination that purchases made by Owner, which Owner treats as being exempt from sales tax, are subject to sales tax. "Final determination" shall mean an assessment by the Department of Revenue that is no longer subject to protest, or a determination of a court having jurisdiction over such matters that is final and not subject to appeal. Contractor agrees to promptly notify owner of any audit, assessment, proposed assessment or notice of deficiency issued with regard to the Project and relating to ODP materials or equipment. ODP Purchase Orders must be closed out prior to closing out the contract/Contractor Purchase Order. If material costs needed for project exceed the ODP Purchase Order amount, the ODP Purchase Order will not be increased. Amounts in excess of the ODP Purchase Order will be paid for by the Contractor. 22. RESIDENT NOTIFICATION OF START OF CONSTRUCTION 22.1. GENERAL The Contractor shall notify all residents along the construction route or within a 500 -foot radius, unless stated otherwise in the Contract Documents, with a printed door hanger notice indicating the following information about the proposed construction work and the Contractor performing the work: City seal or logo; the scheduled date for the start of construction; the type of construction; general sequence and scheduling of construction events; possibility of water service disruption and/or colored water due to construction efforts; Contractor's name, the Superintendent's name, Contractor address and telephone number; Contractor's company logo (optional); requirement for residents to remove landscaping and/or other private appurtenances which are in conflict with the proposed construction; and other language as appropriate to the scope of Contract work. Sample door hanger including proposed language shall be approved by the City prior to the start of construction. Notification shall be printed on brightly colored and durable card stock and shall be a minimum of 4-1/4 by 11 inches in size. Notification (door hanger) shall be posted to residences and businesses directly affected by the Contractor's activities no later than seven (7) days prior to the start of construction activity. Directly affected by the Contractor's activities shall mean all Contractor operations including staging areas, equipment and material storage, principal access routes across private property, etc. Contractor cannot start without proper seven (7) day notice period to residents. Contractor is required to maintain sufficient staff to answer citizen inquiries during normal business hours and to maintain appropriate message recording equipment to receive citizen inquires after business hours. SECTION III Page 44 of 49 Updated 6/1/2021 SECTION III — General Conditions Resident notification by the Contractor is a non-specific pay item to be included in the bid items provided in the contract proposal. 22.2. EXAMPLE CLEAR WATER BRIGHT AND BEAUTIFUL • BAY TO BEACH NOTICE OF CONSTRUCTION TODAY'S DATE: / / PLEASE EXCUSE US FOR ANY INCONVENIENCE We are the construction contractor performing the (state project name) for the City of Clearwater in your area. The work will be performed in the public right-of-way adjacent to your property. This notice is placed a minimum of seven (7) days in advance of construction to notify property owners of the pending start of construction. (Brief description of the construction process to be expected by the property owners) The construction process may necessitate the removal of certain items from the right-of-way. Typical items such as sprinklers, grass, and postal approved mailboxes will be replaced by the contractor within a reasonably short period of time. The replacement of driveways and sidewalks will be made using standard asphalt or concrete materials. The property owner is responsible for the expense and coordination to replace driveways and sidewalks which have customized colors, textures and/or materials. Small trees, shrubs, landscaping materials, unauthorized mailboxes or structures within the right-of-way which must be removed due to the construction process will not be replaced. The property owner is responsible to relocate any such items which the property owner wishes to save prior to the start of construction. Vehicles parked on the streets or within the right- of-way may be required to be placed elsewhere. We are available to answer any questions you may have regarding the construction process or any particular item that must be relocated. Please contact our Construction Manager at (727) . We will be more than happy to assist you. Construction is anticipated to begin on: Company Name Company Address Contractor Phone Number 23. PROJECT INFORMATION SIGNS 23.1. SCOPE AND PURPOSE The Owner desires to inform the general public on the Owner's use and expenditure of public funding for general capital improvement and maintenance projects. To help accomplish this purpose, the Contractor is required to prepare and display public project information signs during the full course of the contract period. These signs will be displayed at all location(s) of active work. Payment to Contractor for the preparation, installation and management of project sign(s) shall be SECTION III Page 45 of 49 Updated 6/1/2021 SECTION III — General Conditions included in the cost of the work. The number of and type of signs will be stated in SECTION IV, SCOPE OF WORK. 23.2. PROJECT SIGN, FIXED OR PORTABLE Sign type shall be "fixed" on stationary projects and "portable" on projects which have extended locations or various locations. The particular wording to be used on the signs will be determined after contract award has been approved. Contractor will be provided the wording to be used on sign at the preconstruction conference. 23.3. FIXED SIGN Fixed sign shall be 4 -foot by 6 -foot (4'x6') in size. Sign material shall be Aluminum DIBOND or exterior grade plywood with a minimum thickness of 1/2 -inches painted white on both sides with exterior rated paint. Sign shall be attached to a minimum of two (2) 4 -inch by 4 -inch (31/2"x31/2") below grade pressure treated (P.T.) wooden posts and braced as necessary for high winds. Posts shall be long enough to provide secure anchoring in the ground. Bottom of sign must be a minimum of 24 -inches above the ground. Alternate mounting system or attachment to fencing or other fixed structure can be considered for approval. 23.4. PORTABLE SIGNS Portable sign shall be a minimum of 24 -inches by 30 -inches (24"x30") in size and will be attached to a standard sized portable traffic barricade. Sign material shall be aluminum, 0.080 -inches or thicker, background of white reflective sheeting, and shall be silkscreen or vinyl lettering. Portable sign shall be two signs located and attached to each side of the traffic barricade. 23.5. SIGN COLORING Background shall be white. Project Descriptive Name shall be in blue lettering. All other lettering shall be black. Basic lettering on sign shall be in all capital letters, of size proportional to the sign itself. Each sign shall depict the City's logo. The Project Manager/City Representative shall provide the appropriate electronic logo file(s) to the Contractor. 23.6. SIGN PLACEMENT Signs shall be placed where they are readily visible by the general public which pass by the project site. Signs are not to be placed where they may become a hazard or impediment to either pedestrian or vehicular traffic. For construction projects outside of the Owner's right-of-way, the signs will be placed on the project site. For projects constructed inside of the Owner's right-of-way, the signs will be placed in the right-of-way. Portable signs are to be moved to the locations of active work on the project. Multiple portable signs will be necessary where work is ongoing in several locations at the same time. Fixed signs are to be placed at the start of construction and will remain in place until the request for final payment. 23.7. SIGN MAINTENANCE The Contractor is responsible for preparation, installation, movement, maintenance, replacement, removal, and disposal of all project signs during the full course of the contract period. The Contractor will place and secure portable signs from dislocation by wind or other actions. Signs are to be cleaned as necessary to maintain legibility and immediately replaced if defaced. SECTION III Page 46 of 49 Updated 6/1/2021 • SECTION III —General Conditions 23.8. TYPICAL PROJECT SIGN 6' PROJECT NAME PROJECT NUMBER DEPARTMENT NAME N CONTRACTOR: COMPLETION DATE: FUNDING: OWNER'S REPRESENTATIVE: } t' fl +.. MIGHT AND BEA mFuL• BAY TO BEACH 3'q" 4"x4" Post (TYP.) Project Sign Details: Font Type: Franklin Gothic Medium, (ALL CAPS) Font Colors: Blue - Pantone 3015 and Black. 24. AWARD OF CONTRACT, WORK SCHEDULE AND GUARANTEE It will be required that the work will commence not later than five (5) calendar days after the Engineer gives written Notice to Proceed (NTP), which notice shall be given as outlined in Article 2 of these General Conditions. It is further required that all work within this contract be completed within the indicated number of consecutive calendar days as determined in Section IV, Scope of Work. Contract Time to commence at start date noted on the Notice to Proceed. If the Contractor fails to complete the work within the stipulated time, the City will retain the amount stated in the Contract, per calendar day, for each day that the contract remains incomplete. The work shall be discontinued on Saturdays, Sundays, and approved Holidays. If it becomes necessary for the Contractor to perform work on Saturdays, Sundays, and approved City of Clearwater Employee Holidays, that in the opinion of the Engineer, will require the presence of Inspectors, the Contractor shall pay the City of SECTION III Page 47 of 49 Updated 6/1/2021 SECTION III — General Conditions Clearwater, Florida, the amount of Four Hundred Eighty Dollars ($480.00) per each eight-hour (8) day for each Inspector given such assignment. The Contractor shall remedy any defects in the work at his own expense and pay for any damage to other work resulting therefrom which appear within a period of one (1) year from the date of final acceptance. 25. SCRUTINIZED COMPANIES AND BUSINESS OPERATIONS WITH CUBA AND SYRIA CERTIFICATION FORM AND ISRAEL CERTIFICATION FORM Pursuant to Section 287.135, Florida Statutes, any vendor, company, individual, principal, subsidiary, affiliate, or owner on the Scrutinized Companies with Activities in Sudan List, the Scrutinized Companies with Activities in the Iran Petroleum Energy Sector List, or is engaged in business operations in Cuba or Syria, is ineligible for, and may not bid on, submit a proposal for, or enter into or renew a contract with the City of Clearwater for goods or services for an amount equal to or greater than one million ($1,000,000.00) dollars. Any vendor, company, individual, principal, subsidiary, affiliate, or owner on the Scrutinized Companies that Boycott Israel List, or is engaged in a boycott of Israel, is ineligible for, and may not bid on, submit a proposal for, or enter into or renew a contract with the City of Clearwater for goods or services for ANY amount. Each entity submitting a bid, proposal, or response to a solicitation must certify to the City of Clearwater that it is not on the aforementioned lists, or engaged in business operations in Cuba or Syria, or engaged in a boycott of Israel at the time of submitting a bid, proposal or response, in accordance with Section 287.135, Florida Statutes. Business Operations means, for purposes specifically related to Cuba or Syria, engaging in commerce in any form in Cuba or Syria, including, but not limited to, acquiring, developing, maintaining, owning, selling, possessing, leasing or operating equipment, facilities, personnel, products, services, personal property, real property, military equipment, or any other apparatus of business or commerce. Boycott Israel or boycott of Israel means refusing to deal, terminating business activities, or taking other actions to limit commercial relations with Israel, or persons or entities doing business in Israel or in Israeli - controlled territories, in a discriminatory manner. A statement by a company that it is participating in a boycott of Israel, or that it has initiated a boycott in response to a request for a boycott of Israel or in compliance with, or in furtherance of, calls for a boycott of Israel, may be considered as evidence that a company is participating in a boycott of Israel. The certification forms (the Certification) are attached hereto, and must be submitted, along with all other relevant contract documents, at the time of submitting a bid, proposal, or response. Failure to provide the Certification may deem the entity's submittal non-responsive. If the City of Clearwater determines that an entity has submitted a false certification form, been placed on the Scrutinized Companies with Activities in Sudan List or the Scrutinized Companies with Activities in the Iran Petroleum Energy Sector List or the Scrutinized Companies that Boycott Israel List, or engaged in business operations in Cuba or Syria, or engaged in a boycott of Israel, then the contract may be terminated at the option of the City of Clearwater. Other than the submission of a false certification, the City of Clearwater, on a case-by-case basis and in its sole discretion, may allow a company to bid on, submit a proposal for, or enter into or renew a contract for goods or services, if the conditions set forth in Section 287.135, Florida Statutes, apply. The City retains the right to pursue civil penalties and any other applicable rights and remedies as provided by law for the false submission of the attached certification forms. SECTION III Page 48 of 49 Updated 6/1/2021 • • • SECTION III — General Conditions See Section V of the Contract for Certification Forms to be executed and submitted with the Bid/Proposal Form. SECTION III Page 49 of 49 Updated 6/1/2021 SECTION IV • TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS Table of Content: 100 SERIES: GENERAL 1 101. SCOPE OF WORK 1 102. FIELD ENGINEERING 2 102-1. LINE AND GRADE PERFORMED BY THE CONTRACTOR 2 102-2. LINE AND GRADE PERFORMED BY THE CITY 2 103. DEFINITION OF TERMS 2 103-1. REFERENCE STANDARDS 3 104. STREET CROSSINGS, ETC. 3 105. AUDIO/VIDEO RECORDING OF WORK AREAS 3 105-1. CONTRACTOR TO PREPARE AUDIO/VIDEO RECORDING 3 105-2. SCHEDULING OF AUDIONIDEO RECORDING 3 105-3. PROFESSIONAL VIDEOGRAPHERS 3 105-4. EQUIPMENT 3 105-5. RECORDED AUDIO INFORMATION 4 105-6. RECORDED VIDEO INFORMATION 4 • 105-7. VIEWER ORIENTATION 4 105-8. LIGHTING 4 105-9. SPEED OF TRAVEL 4 105-10. VIDEO LOG/INDEX 4 105-11. AREA OF COVERAGE 5 105-12. COSTS OF VIDEO SERVICES 5 106. STREET SIGNS 5 107. WORK ZONE TRAFFIC CONTROL 5 107-1. CONTRACTOR RESPONSIBLE FOR WORK ZONE TRAFFIC CONTROL 5 107-2. WORK ZONE TRAFFIC CONTROL PLAN 5 107-3. ROADWAY CLOSURE GUIDELINES 6 107-4. APPROVAL OF WORK ZONE TRAFFIC CONTROL PLAN 7 107-5. INSPECTION OF WORK ZONE TRAFFIC CONTROL OPERATION 7 107-6. PAYMENT FOR WORK ZONE TRAFFIC CONTROL 7 107-7. CERTIFICATION OF WORK ZONE TRAFFIC CONTROL SUPERVISOR 8 108. OVERHEAD ELECTRIC LINE CLEARANCE 8 108-1. CLEARANCE OPTIONS 8 108-2. REQUIRED MINIMUM CLEARANCE DISTANCES 8 200 SERIES: SITEWORK 10 201. EXCAVATION FOR UNDERGROUND INFRASTRUCTURE WORK 10 201-1. EXCAVATION, BACKFILLING, AND COMPACTION FOR UNDERGROUND INFRASTRUCTURE 11 • 202. OBSTRUCTIONS 22 SECTION IV i Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV -Technical Specifications 203. DEWATERING 23 203-1. GENERAL 23 203-2. OBSERVATION WELLS 24 203-3. PUMPING AND DRAINAGE - GENERAL 24 203-4. PERMIT REQUIREMENTS 28 204. UNSUITABLE MATERIAL REMOVAL 29 204-1. BASIS OF MEASUREMENT 29 204-2. BASIS OF PAYMENT 29 205. UTILITY TIE IN LOCATION MARKING 29 206. CLEARING AND GRUBBING 29 206-1. BASIS OF MEASUREMENT 30 206-2. BASIS OF PAYMENT 30 207. EROSION AND SEDIMENT CONTROL 30 207-1. GENERAL 30 207-2. TRAINING OF PERSONNEL 30 207-3. STABILIZATION OF DENUDED AREAS 30 207-4. PROTECTION AND STABILIZATION OF SOIL STOCKPILES 31 207-5. PROTECTION OF EXISTING STORM SEWER SYSTEMS 31 207-6. SWALES, DITCHES AND CHANNELS 31 207-7. UNDERGROUND UTILITY CONSTRUCTION 31 207-8. MAINTENANCE 31 207-9. COMPLIANCE 31 208. CONSTRUCTION AND REPAIR OF SEAWALLS AND OTHER BEACH • EROSION CONTROL STRUCTURES 32 208-1. EXISTING SEAWALLS AND REVETMENTS 32 208-2. TOP OF CAP ELEVATION 32 208-3. SEAWALLS AND REVETMENTS LOCATED SEAWARD OF THE CCL 32 208-4. PLACEMENT OF NEW SEAWALL 32 208-5. POST CONSTRUCTION SURVEY 33 208-6. RIP -RAP 33 208-7. RETAINING WALL IN LIEU OF VERTICAL SEAWALL 33 209. MAINTENANCE OF OPERATIONS 33 209-1. GENERAL 33 209-2. EXECUTION 33 209-3. BASIS OF MEASUREMENT 35 210. DETECTION OF FACILITIES 35 211. RELOCATIONS 36 211-1. RELOCATION SHOWN ON DRAWINGS 36 211-2. RELOCATIONS NOT SHOWN ON DRAWINGS 36 212. RESTORATION PROCEDURES 36 212-1. INTERIM RESTORATION 36 212-2. FINAL RESTORATION 36 300 SERIES: MATERIALS 38 301. CONCRETE 38 • 302. EXCAVATION AND FORMS FOR CONCRETE WORK 38 SECTION IV ii Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV - Technical Specifications 302-1. EXCAVATION 38 302-2. FORMS 38 303. REINFORCEMENT 38 303-1. BASIS OF PAYMENT 39 304. BACKFILL 39 304-1. MATERIALS AND GENERAL 39 304-2. TESTING AND INSPECTION 39 305. RIPRAP 40 305-1. BASIS OF MEASUREMENT 40 305-2. BASIS OF PAYMENT 40 306. FLOWABLE FILL 41 307. MATERIAL INDEPENDENT TESTING 42 400 SERIES: SANITARY SEWER 43 401. SANITARY MANHOLES 43 401-1. BUILT UP TYPE 43 401-2. PRECAST TYPE 44 401-3. DROP MANHOLES 46 401-4. FRAMES AND COVERS 46 401-5. MANHOLE COATINGS 46 401-6. CONNECTIONS TO MANHOLES 46 401-7. MEASUREMENT AND PAYMENT 46 402. RAISING OR LOWERING OF SANITARY SEWER STRUCTURES 46 402-1. BASIS OF PAYMENT 46 403. SANITARY SEWERS AND FORCE MAINS 46 403-1. MATERIALS 46 403-2. INSTALLATION 47 403-3. INSPECTIONS OF LINES AND MANHOLES 47 403-4. TESTING 49 403-5. BASIS OF PAYMENT 49 404. CURED -IN-PLACE PIPE SANITARY SEWER REHABILITATION 50 404-1. GENERAL 50 404-2. MEASUREMENT & PAYMENT 51 404-3. SUBMITTALS 51 404-4. CURED -IN-PLACE PIPE (CIPP) FOR GRAVITY SEWER MAINS 52 404-5. CURED -IN-PLACE PIPE (CIPP) FOR SERVICE LATERALS 55 405. SANITARY MANHOLE LINER RESTORATION 59 405-1. SCOPE AND INTENT 59 405-2. MEASUREMENT & PAYMENT 60 405-3. CEMENTITIOUS COATING SYSTEM 61 405-4. RAVEN 405 EPDXY COATING SYSTEM 65 405-5. SPRAYWALL POLYURETHANE COATING SYSTEM 69 405-6. INTERNAL MANHOLE CORBEL SEALING SYSTEM 73 406. SMOKE AND DYE TESTING 76 406-1. GENERAL PROTOCOL 76 406-2. REPORTING 76 SECTION IV iii Updated 6/2/2021 • SECTION IV -Technical Specifications 406-3. DYE INVESTIGATION 78 406-4. MEASUREMENT AND PAYMENT 80 406-5. BASIS OF PAYMENT 80 500 SERIES: POTABLE AND RECLAIMED WATER MAINS, FIRE LINES AND APPURTENANCES 81 501. SCOPE 81 502. MATERIALS 81 502-1. GENERAL 81 502-2. PIPE MATERIALS AND FITTINGS 81 502-3. GATE VALVES 93 502-4. VALVE BOXES 94 502-5. HYDRANTS 95 502-6. SERVICE SADDLES/ POLYETHYLENE SERVICE LINES 96 502-7. BACKFLOW PREVENTERS 97 502-8. TAPPING SLEEVES AND LINESTOPS 97 502-9. LINE STOPPING ASSEMBLIES 99 502-10. BLOW OFF HYDRANTS 100 503. CONSTRUCTION 100 503-1. MATERIAL HANDLING 100 503-2. PIPE LAYING 101 503-3. SETTING OF VALVES, HYDRANTS AND FITTINGS 119 503-4. CONNECTIONS TO EXISTING POTABLE WATER OR RECLAIMED WATER LINES • 122 504. PIPELINE CLEANING 123 504-1. PIPELINE PIGGING 123 504-2. FINAL PIPELINE FLUSHING 124 505. TESTS 124 505-1. HYDROSTATIC PIPELINE TESTING 124 505-2. NOTICE OF TEST 125 506. DISINFECTION AND TESTING 125 506-1. DISINFECTION MATERIALS 125 506-2. FLUSHING SYSTEM 126 506-3. FINAL DISINFECTION PROCEDURE FOR POTABLE WATER MAINS 126 506-4. FLUSHING AND RESIDUAL CHLORINE TESTS 128 506-5. BACTERIALOGICAL TESTS 128 507. CORRECTION OF NON -CONFORMING WORK 129 508. OBTAINING WATER FOR FLUSHING AND TESTING 129 509. MEASUREMENT AND PAYMENT 129 509-1. GENERAL 129 509-2. FURNISH AND INSTALL WATER MAINS 130 509-3. FURNISH AND INSTALL FITTINGS 130 509-4. FURNISH AND INSTALL GATE VALVES COMPLETE WITH BOXES AND COVERS 130 509-5. FURNISH AND INSTALL FIRE HYDRANTS 130 0 600 SERIES: STORMWATER 132 SECTION IV iv Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV - Technical Specifications 601. RAISING OR LOWERING OF STORM DRAINAGE STRUCTURES 132 601-1. BASIS OF PAYMENT 132 602. UNDERDRAINS 132 602-1. BASIS OF MEASUREMENT 132 602-2. BASIS OF PAYMENT 132 603. STORM SEWERS 133 603-1. TESTING AND INSPECTION 133 603-2. BASIS OF PAYMENT 133 604. STORM MANHOLES, INLETS, CATCH BASINS OR OTHER STORM STRUCTURES 134 604-1. BUILT UP TYPE STRUCTURES 134 604-2. PRECAST TYPE 134 604-3. BASIS OF PAYMENT 135 605. GABIONS AND MATTRESSES 135 605-1. MATERIAL 135 605-2. PERFORMANCE 136 700 SERIES: STREETS AND SIDEWALKS 137 701. RESTORATION OR REPLACEMENT OF DRIVEWAYS, CURBS, SIDEWALKS AND STREET PAVEMENT 137 702. ROADWAY BASE AND SUBGRADE 137 702-1. BASE 137 702-2. SUBGRADE 139 703. ASPHALTIC CONCRETE MATERIALS 139 703-1. ASPHALTIC CONCRETE 139 703-2. HOT BITUMINOUS MIXTURES - PLANT, METHODS, EQUIPMENT & QUALITY ASSURANCE 140 703-3. ASPHALT MIX DESIGNS AND TYPES 140 703-4. ASPHALT PAVEMENT DESIGNS AND LAYER THICKNESS 140 703-5. GENERAL CONSTRUCTION REQUIREMENTS 140 703-6. CRACKS AND POTHOLE PREPARATION 141 703-7. ADJUSTMENT OF MANHOLES AND APPURTANENCES 141 703-8. ADDITIONAL ASPHALT REQUIREMENTS 142 703-9. BASIS OF MEASUREMENT 142 703-10. BASIS OF PAYMENT 142 704. ADJUSTMENT TO THE UNIT BID PRICE FOR ASPHALT 143 705. ASPHALT DRIVEWAYS 143 705-1. BASIS OF MEASUREMENT 143 705-2. BASIS OF PAYMENT 143 706. CONCRETE CURBS 143 706-1. BASIS OF MEASUREMENT 144 706-2. BASIS OF PAYMENT 144 707. CONCRETE SIDEWALKS AND DRIVEWAYS 144 707-1. CONCRETE SIDEWALKS 144 707-2. CONCRETE DRIVEWAYS 144 707-3. CONCRETE CURB RAMPS 145 SECTION IV v Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV -Technical Specifications • 707-4. BASIS OF MEASUREMENT 145 707-5. BASIS OF PAYMENT 145 708. MILLING OPERATIONS 145 708-1. EQUIPMENT, CONSTRUCTION & MILLED SURFACE 145 708-2. ADDITIONAL MILLING REQUIREMENTS 145 708-3. SALVAGEABLE MATERIALS 146 708-4. DISPOSABLE MATERIALS 146 708-5. ADJUSTMENT AND LOCATION OF UNDERGROUND UTILITIES 146 708-6. ADJUSTMENT OF UTILITY MANHOLES 146 708-7. TYPES OF MILLING 146 708-8. MILLING OF INTERSECTIONS 147 708-9. BASIS OF MEASUREMENT 147 708-10. BASIS OF PAYMENT 147 800 SERIES: TRAFFIC SIGNALS, SIGNS AND MARKINGS 148 801. TRAFFIC SIGNAL EQUIPMENT AND MATERIALS 148 801-1. BASIS OF MEASUREMENT AND PAYMENT 148 802. SIGNING AND MARKING 148 802-1. BASIS OF MEASUREMENT AND PAYMENT 149 803. ROADWAY LIGHTING 149 803-1. BASIS OF MEASUREMENT AND PAYMENT 149 900 SERIES: LANDSCAPING/RESTORATION 150 • 901. WORK IN EASEMENTS OR PARKWAYS 150 902. GENERAL PLANTING SPECIFICATIONS 150 • 902-1. IRRIGATION 150 902-2. LANDSCAPE 156 903. SODDING 166 904. SEEDING 167 905. LAWN MAINTENANCE SPECIFICATIONS 167 905-1. SCOPE 167 905-2. SCHEDULING OF WORK 167 905-3. WORK METHODS 168 906. LEVEL OF SERVICE 169 907. COMPLETION OF WORK 170 908. INSPECTION AND APPROVAL 170 909. SPECIAL CONDITIONS 170 910. TREE PROTECTION 170 910-1. TREE BARRICADES 170 910-2. ROOT PRUNING 171 910-3. PROPER TREE PRUNING 172 911. IRRIGATION SYSTEM DESIGN 172 912. IRRIGATION SYSTEM INSTALLATION 173 SECTION IV vi Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications 100 SERIES: GENERAL 101. SCOPE OF WORK Project Name: MSWRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) Project Number: 18 -0047 -UT Scope of Work: Design improvements to address deficiencies identified at the MSWRF by the FDEP in an August 7, 2018 letter. Improvements required to be addressed include the replacement of the existing slide gates within the aeration basins 4-13. While the basins are isolated and drained for gate replacement, the Contractor will remove all accumulated grit in the aeration basins, replace damaged or missing elements of the diffused air system, and make structural repairs as noted on the plans. The city reserves the right to increase funds during the contract term if work exceeds original estimates, subject to required authorizations. Beyond the initial one-year term, the city reserves the right to renew the contract for up to three (3) years. The Contractor shall provide copies of a current Contractor License/Registration with the state of Florida and Pinellas County in the bid response. The Contractor shall provide 1 Fixed project signs as described in Section III, Section 23 of the Contract Documents. The final number of project signs will be determined at the beginning of the project based on the Contractor's schedule of work submitted for approval. Additional project signs may be required at no additional cost to the city due to the Contractor's schedule of work. Contract Period: 330 Consecutive Calendar Days SECTION IV Page 1 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 • SECTION IV —Technical Specifications 102. FIELD ENGINEERING 102-1. LINE AND GRADE PERFORMED BY THE CONTRACTOR Unless otherwise specified, the Contractor shall provide and pay for field engineering service required for the project. Such work shall include survey work to establish lines and levels and to locate and lay out site improvements, structures, and controlling lines and levels required for the construction of the work. Also included are such Engineering services as are specified or required to execute the Contractor's construction methods. Engineers and Surveyors shall be licensed professionals under the laws of the State of Florida. The Contractor shall provide three (3) complete sets of As -Built Surveys to the Engineer prior to final payment being made as outlined in Section III (General Conditions), Section 6.11.2 of these Contract Documents. 102-1.1. GRADES, LINES AND LEVELS Existing basic horizontal and vertical control points for the project are those designated on the Drawings or provided by the city. Control points (for alignment only) shall be established by the Engineer. The Contractor shall locate and protect control points prior to starting site work and shall preserve all permanent reference points during construction. In working near any permanent property corners or reference markers, the Contractor shall use care not to remove or disturb any such markers. In the event that markers must be removed or are disturbed due to the proximity of construction work, the Contractor shall have them referenced and reset by a Professional Land Surveyor licensed in the State of Florida. 102-1.2. LAYOUT DATA • The Contractor shall layout the work at the location and to the lines and grades shown on the Drawings. Survey notes indicating the information and measurements used in establishing locations and grades shall be kept in notebooks and furnished to the Engineer with the record drawings for the project. • 102-2. LINE AND GRADE PERFORMED BY THE CITY If line and grade is supplied by the city, at the completion of all work the Contractor shall be responsible to have furnished to the project inspector a replacement of the wooden lath and stakes used in the construction of this project. Excessive stake replacement caused by negligence of Contractor's forces, after initial line and grade have been set, as determined by the City Engineer, will be charged to the Contractor at the rate of $200.00 per hour. Time shall be computed for actual time on the project. All time shall be computed in one-hour increments. Minimum charge is $200.00. The Contractor shall provide three (3) complete sets of As -built Surveys to the Engineer prior to final payment being made as outlined in Section III (General Conditions), Section 6.11.2 of these Contract Documents. 103. DEFINITION OF TERMS For the Purpose of these Technical Specifications, the Definition of Terms from Section III, Article 1 — Definitions of these Contract Documents shall apply. For the purpose of the Estimated Quantities, the Contractor's attention is called to the fact that the estimate of quantities as shown on the Proposal is approximate and is given only as a basis of calculation upon which the award of the contract is to be made. The city does not assume any responsibility that the final quantities will remain in strict accordance with estimated quantities nor shall the Contractor plead misunderstandings or deception because of such estimate of quantities or of the character or location of the work or of other conditions or situations pertaining thereto. SECTION IV Page 2 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV —Technical Specifications The basis of payment for work and materials will be the actual amount of work done and materials furnished. Contractor agrees that they will make no claim for damages, anticipated profits, or otherwise on account of any difference between the amounts of work performed and materials actually furnished and the estimated amounts thereof. 103-1. REFERENCE STANDARDS Reference to the standards of any technical society, organization, or associate, or to codes of local or state authorities, shall mean the latest standard, code, specification, or tentative standard adopted and published at the date of receipt of bids, unless specifically stated otherwise. The most stringent specification prevails in the case where more than one specification is referenced for the same task. Contractor shall utilize applicable Florida Department of Transportation (FDOT) Standards and Specifications for tasks that are not covered by city's Standards and Specifications. 104. STREET CROSSINGS, ETC. At such crossings, and other points as may be directed by the Engineer, trenches shall be bridged in an open and secure manner, so as to prevent any serious interruption of travel upon the roadway or sidewalk, and also to afford necessary access to public or private premises. The material used, and the mode of constructing said bridges, and the approaches, thereto, must be satisfactory to the Engineer. The cost of all such work must be included in the cost of the trench excavation. 105. AUDIONIDEO RECORDING OF WORK AREAS 105-1. CONTRACTOR TO PREPARE AUDIONIDEO RECORDING Prior to commencing work, the Contractor shall have a continuous color audio/video recording taken along the entire length of the Project including all affected project areas. Streets, easements, rights-of-way, lots or construction sites within the Project must be recorded to serve as a record of pre -construction conditions. 105-2. SCHEDULING OF AUDIONIDEO RECORDING The video recordings shall not be made more than twenty-one (21) days prior to construction in any area. 105-3. PROFESSIONAL VIDEOGRAPHERS The Contractor shall engage the services of a professional videographer. The color audio/video recording shall be prepared by a responsible commercial firm known to be skilled and regularly engaged in the business of pre -construction color audio/video recording documentation. Use of drones must be in accordance with Federal Aviation Administration (FAA) regulations. 105-4. EQUIPMENT All equipment, accessories, materials, and labor to perform this service shall be furnished by the Contractor. The total audio/video system shall reproduce bright, sharp, clear pictures with accurate colors and shall be free from distortion, tearing, rolls or any other form of imperfection. The audio portion of the recording shall reproduce the commentary of the camera operator with proper volume, clarity and be free from SECTION IV Page 3 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications • distortion and interruptions. In some instances, audio/video coverage may be required in areas not accessible by conventional wheeled vehicles. Such coverage shall be obtained by walking. 105-5. RECORDED AUDIO INFORMATION Each recording shall begin with the current date, project name and be followed by the general location, i.e., viewing side and direction of progress. Accompanying the video recording of each video shall be a corresponding and simultaneously recorded audio recording. This audio recording, exclusively containing the commentary of the camera operator or aide, shall assist in viewer orientation and in any needed identification, differentiation, clarification, or objective description of the features being shown in the video portion of the recording. The audio recording shall also be free from any conversations. 105-6. RECORDED VIDEO INFORMATION All video recordings must continuously display transparent digital information to include the date and time of recording. The date information shall contain the month, day, and year. The time information shall contain the hour, minutes, and seconds. Additional information shall be displayed periodically. Such information shall include, but not be limited to, project name, contract number, direction of travel and the viewing side. This transparent information shall appear on the extreme upper left hand third of the screen. Camera pan, tilt, zoom -in and zoom out rates shall be sufficiently controlled such that recorded objects will be clearly viewed during video playback. In addition, all other camera and recording system controls, such as lens focus and aperture, video level, pedestal, chrome, white balance, and electrical focus shall be properly controlled or adjusted to maximize picture quality. • 105-7. VIEWER ORIENTATION The audio and video portions of the recording shall maintain viewer orientation. To this end, overall establishing views of all visible house and business addresses shall be utilized. In areas where the proposed construction location will not be readily apparent to the video viewer, highly visible yellow flags shall be placed by the Contractor in such a fashion as to clearly indicate the proposed centerline of construction. When conventional wheeled vehicles are used as conveyances for the recording system, the vertical distance between the camera lens and the ground shall not exceed ten feet (10'). The camera shall be firmly mounted such that transport of the camera during the recording process will not cause an unsteady picture. • 105-8. LIGHTING All recording shall be done during time of good visibility. No videoing shall be done during precipitation, mist, or fog. The recording shall only be done when sufficient light is present to properly illuminate the subjects of recording and to produce bright, sharp video recordings of those subjects. 105-9. SPEED OF TRAVEL The average rate of travel during a particular segment of coverage shall be directly proportional to the number, size, and value of the surface features within the construction area's zone of influence. The rate of speed in the general direction of travel used during videoing shall not exceed forty-four (44) feet per minute. 105-10. VIDEO LOG/INDEX All videos shall be permanently labeled and shall be properly identified by video number and project title. Each video shall have a log of that video's contents. The log shall describe the various segments of coverage contained on the video in terms of the names of the streets or location of easements, coverage beginning SECTION IV Page 4 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications and end, directions of coverage, video unit counter numbers, engineering survey or coordinate values (if reasonably available) and the date. 105-11. AREA OF COVERAGE Video coverage shall include all surface features located within the zone of influence of construction supported by appropriate audio coverage. Such coverage shall include, but not be limited to, existing driveways, sidewalks, curbs, pavements, drainage system features, mailboxes, landscaping, culverts, fences, signs, Contractor staging areas, adjacent structures, etc., within the area covered by the project. Of particular concern shall be the existence of any faults, fractures, or defects. Taped coverage shall be limited to one side of the Site, street, easement or right of way at any one time. 105-12. COSTS OF VIDEO SERVICES The cost to complete the requirements under this section shall be included in the contract items provided in the proposal sheet. There is no separate pay item for this work. 106. STREET SIGNS The removal, covering or relocation of street signs by the Contractor is prohibited. All street signs shall be removed, covered, or relocated by the city's Traffic Engineering Division in accordance with Sections 700, 994, 995, and 996 of FDOT's Standard Specifications. The Contractor shall notify the city's Traffic Engineering Division a minimum of twenty-four (24) hours in advance of the proposed sign relocation, covering or removal. 107. WORK ZONE TRAFFIC CONTROL 107-1. CONTRACTOR RESPONSIBLE FOR WORK ZONE TRAFFIC CONTROL The Contractor shall be responsible to furnish, operate, maintain and remove all work zone traffic control associated with the Project, including detours, advance warnings, channelization, hazard warnings and any other necessary features, both at the immediate work site and as may be necessary at outlying points. 107-2. WORK ZONE TRAFFIC CONTROL PLAN The Contractor shall prepare a detailed traffic control plan designed to accomplish the level of performance outlined in the Scope of the Work and/or as may be required by construction permits issued by Pinellas County and/or the FDOT for the Project, incorporating the methods and criteria contained in Part VI, Standards and Guides for Traffic Controls for Street and Highway Construction, Maintenance, Utility and Incident Management Operations in the Manual on Uniform Traffic Control Devices published by the U.S. Department of Transportation and adopted as amended by the Florida Department of Transportation, or most recent addition. This plan shall be reviewed and approved by city Engineering Department Traffic Operations personnel regardless if Maintenance of Traffic (MOT) plan details are included in the contract plans. SECTION IV Page 5 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications • 107-2.1. WORK ZONE SAFETY The general objectives of a program of work zone safety are to protect workers, pedestrians, bicyclists and motorists during construction and maintenance operations. This general objective may be achieved by meeting the following specific objectives: • Provide adequate advance warning and information regarding upcoming work zones. • Provide the driver clear directions to understanding the situation they will be facing as the driver proceeds through or around the work zone. • Reduce the consequences of an out of control vehicle. • Provide safe access and storage for equipment and material. • Promote speedy completion of projects (including thorough cleanup of the site). • Promote use of the appropriate traffic control and protection devices. • Provide safe passageways for pedestrians through, in, and/or around construction or maintenance work zones. • • "When an existing pedestrian way or bicycle way is located within a traffic control work zone, accommodation must be maintained and provision for the disabled must be provided. Only approved pedestrian longitudinal channelizing devices may be used to delineate a temporary traffic control zone pedestrian walkway. Advanced notification of sidewalk closures and marked detours shall be provided by appropriate signs." Per the 2014 FDOT Standard Specifications for Road and Bridge Construction or latest revision. FDOT Design Standards (DS): 102-5 Traffic Control, 102-5.1 Standards, are the minimum standards for the use in the development of all traffic control plans (use the latest edition). All traffic control plans must be submitted to the city Engineering Department, Traffic Operations Division for review and approval prior to installation. Contractor shall also provide notification to city Engineering, Traffic Operations Division a minimum of 72 -hours in advance of mobilization. Approved MOT must always be on site and accessible to the city Project Manager and/ or Representative. 107-3. ROADWAY CLOSURE GUIDELINES Roadway types: Major Arterials, Minor Arterials, Local Collectors, and Local Following are typical requirements to be accomplished prior to closure. The number of requirements increases with traffic volume and the importance of access. Road closures affecting business or sole access routes will increase in process requirements as appropriate. For all but local streets, no road or lane closures are allowed without prior approval by the City Engineer or designated Representative (Engineering Traffic Operations Manager). 107-3.1. ALL ROADWAYS Obtain permits for Pinellas County or Florida Department of Transportation roadways. Traffic control devises conform to national and state standards. 107-3.1.1. PUBLIC NOTIFICATION Standard property owner notification prior to start of construction for properties directly affected by the construction process. SECTION IV Page 6 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications 107-3.2. MAJOR ARTERIALS, MINOR ARTERIALS, LOCAL COLLECTORS Consult with city Engineering Traffic Operations Division staff for preliminary traffic control options. Develop Formal Traffic Control Plan for Permit Submittal to Regulatory Agency as necessary. 107-3.2.1. PUBLIC NOTIFICATION Message Board Display, Minimum of seven (7) day notice period prior to road closure and potentially longer for larger highway. The message board is to be provided by the Contractor. 107-3.3. MAJOR ARTERIALS, MINOR ARTERIALS 107-3.3.1. PUBLIC NOTIFICATION Releases can be issued as PowerPoint Presentation for C -View System utilizing television monitors. 107-3.4. MAJOR ARTERIALS 107-3.4.1. PUBLIC NOTIFICATION News Releases shall be issued by the city Public Communication Department. The Message Board may need to be displayed for a period longer than seven (7) days. 107-4. APPROVAL OF WORK ZONE TRAFFIC CONTROL PLAN The Contractor is invited and encouraged to confer in advance of bidding, and is required, as a specification of the work, to confer in advance of beginning any work on the Project, with the Traffic Operations Division, Municipal Services Building, 100 South Myrtle Avenue, telephone (727) 562-4747, for the purpose of approval of the Contractor's proposed detailed traffic control plan. All maintenance of traffic (MOT) plans shall be signed and sealed by a Professional Engineer or an individual who is certified in the preparation of MOT plans in the State of Florida. Contractor is required to submit the MOT preparer's accreditation along with the plan submittal. 107-5. INSPECTION OF WORK ZONE TRAFFIC CONTROL OPERATION The city Engineering Traffic Operations Division may inspect and monitor the traffic control plan and traffic control devices of the Contractor. The city's Construction Inspector assigned to the project may make known requirements for any alterations or adjustments to the traffic control devices. The Contractor shall take direction from the city representative. 107-6. PAYMENT FOR WORK ZONE TRAFFIC CONTROL Payment for work zone traffic control is a non-specific pay item to be included in the construction costs associated with other specific pay items unless specifically stated otherwise. SECTION IV Page 7 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV —Technical Specifications •107-7. CERTIFICATION OF WORK ZONE TRAFFIC CONTROL SUPERVISOR • • The city may require that the Supervisor or Foreman controlling the work for the Contractor on the Project have a current International Municipal Signal Association, Work Zone Traffic Control Safety Certification or Worksite Traffic Supervisor Certification from the American Traffic Safety Association with additional current Certification from the Florida Department of Transportation. This requirement for Certification will be noted in the Scope of Work and/or sections of these Technical Specifications. When the certified supervisor is required for the Project, the supervisor will be on the Project site at all times while work is being conducted. The Worksite Traffic Supervisor shall be available on a twenty-four (24) hour per day basis and shall review the project on a day-to-day basis as well as being involved in all changes to traffic control. The Worksite Traffic Supervisor shall have access to all equipment and materials needed to maintain traffic control and handle traffic related situations. The Worksite Traffic Supervisor shall ensure that routine deficiencies are corrected within a twenty-four (24) hour period. The Worksite Traffic Supervisor shall be available on the site within 45 minutes after notification of an emergency situation, prepared to positively respond to repair the work zone traffic control or to provide alternate traffic arrangements. Failure of the Worksite Traffic Supervisor to comply with the provisions of this sub section may be grounds for decertification or removal from the project or both. Failure to maintain a designated Worksite Traffic Supervisor or failure to comply with these provisions will result in temporary suspension of all activities except traffic and erosion control and such other activities deemed to be necessary for project maintenance and safety. 108. OVERHEAD ELECTRIC LINE CLEARANCE 108-1. CLEARANCE OPTIONS When working in the vicinity of overhead power lines, the Contractor shall utilize one of the following options: Option 1: Having the power lines de -energized and visibly grounded. Option 2: Maintaining a minimum distance of twenty feet (20') of clearance for voltages up to 350 kV and fifty feet (50') of clearance for voltages more than 350 kV. Option 3: Determine the line voltage and provide clearance in accordance with the following table. 108-2. REQUIRED MINIMUM CLEARANCE DISTANCES VOLTAGE [nominal, kV, alternating current] MINIMUM CLEARANCE DISTANCE [feet] Up to 50 10 Over 50 to 200 15 Over 200 to 350 20 Over 350 to 500 25 Over 500 to 750 35 Over 750 to 1,000 45 SECTION IV Page 8 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV —Technical Specifications Over 1,000 (as established by the utility owner/operator or registered professional engineer who is a qualified person with respect to electric power transmission and distribution) Note: The value that follows "to" is up to and includes that value. For example, over 50 to 200 means up to and including 200kV. The equipment supplied and installed shall meet the requirements of the National Electric Code and all applicable local codes and regulations SECTION IV Page 9 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications • 200 SERIES: SITEWORK • • 201. EXCAVATION FOR UNDERGROUND INFRASTRUCTURE WORK The Contractor is responsible to take all necessary steps to conduct all excavation in a manner which provides for the successful completion of the proposed work while at all times maintaining the safety of the workmen, the general public and both public and private property. The Contractor's methods of work will be consistent with the standard practices and requirements of all appropriate Safety Regulatory Agencies, particularly the Occupational Safety and Health Administration (OSHA) requirements for excavation. Unless otherwise specifically stated in these plans and specifications, the methods of safety control and compliance with regulatory agency safety requirements are the full and complete responsibility of the Contractor. For the purposes of the Contractor's safety planning in the bidding process, the Contractor is to consider all excavation to be done in the performance of this contract to be in soil classified as OSHA "Type C". The Contractor's attention is called to specific requirements of OSHA for excavation shoring, employee entry, location of excavated material adjacent to excavation, the removal of water from the excavation, surface encumbrances and in particular the requirement of a "Competent Person" to control safety operations. The Contractor shall submit to the city if requested prior to the start of work a safety plan for the excavation and work activities. The Contractor will identify their Competent Person to city staff at the start of construction. Clearwater Fire Dept. requires a Trench Permit and site inspection for any depths greater than five feet (5') and any excavation that exceeds twenty feet (20') shall require the submittal of a trench shoring plan prepared by a Professional Engineer actively licensed in the State of Florida. City staff is required from time to time to perform inspections, tests, survey location work, or other similar activity in an excavation prepared by the Contractor. City staff, in conformance with the OSHA Excavation Safety Requirements, is to only enter an excavation in compliance with these OSHA standards. The city's staff reserve the option to refuse entry into the Contractor's excavation if, in the opinion of the city's staff, the entry into the Contractor's excavation is unsafe or does not conform to OSHA requirements. If this circumstance occurs, the Contractor must either provide the necessary safety requirements or provide alternate means for the accomplishment of the city's work at the Contractor's expense. The construction quantities, if any, contained in the bid proposal for this contract do not contain sufficient quantities to allow the Contractor to perform excavation work using strictly the "open cut" method whereby no shoring systems are used and trench side slopes are cut to conform to OSHA safety requirements without a shoring system. In addition to safety reasons, the Contractor is required to use excavation and trench - shoring methods in compliance with all safety requirements which allow the Contractor to control the amount of restoration work necessary to complete the project. Not more than four hundred feet (400') of trench shall be opened at one time in advance of the completed work unless written permission is received from the city and/or the Engineer for the distance specified. For pipe installation projects, the trench shall be a minimum of six inches (6") wider on each side than the greatest external horizontal width of the pipe or conduit, including hubs, intended to be laid in them. The bottom of the trench under each pipe joint shall be slightly hollowed, to allow the body of the pipe to rest throughout its length. In case a trench is excavated at any place, except at joints, below the grade of its bottom as given, or directed by the Engineer, the filling and compaction to grade shall be done in such manner as the Engineer shall direct, without additional compensation. SECTION IV Page 10 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications 201-1. EXCAVATION, BACKFILLING, AND COMPACTION FOR UNDERGROUND INFRASTRUCTURE 201-1.1. GENERAL Scope of Work: The work included under this Section consists of dewatering, excavating, trenching, sheeting/shoring, grading, backfilling, and compacting those soil materials required for the construction of the structures, piping, ditches, utility structures and appurtenances as shown on the Drawings and specified herein. Definitions: A. Maximum Density: Maximum weight in pounds per cubic foot of a specific material as determined by ASTM D1557. B. Optimum Moisture Content: The optimum moisture content shall be determined by ASTM D 1557 specified to determine the maximum dry density for relative compaction. Field moisture content shall be determined on the basis of the fraction passing the 3/4 -inch sieve. C. Rock Excavation: Excavation of any hard -natural substance which requires the use of special impact tools such as jack hammers, sledges, chisels, or similar devices specifically designed for use in cutting or breaking rock, but exclusive of trench excavating machinery. D. Suitable Soil Materials: Suitable materials for fills shall be a non -cohesive, non -plastic granular local sand and shall be free from vegetation, organic material, marl, silt or muck and shall be classified as A-1, A-3 or A-2-4 in accordance with AASHTO Designation M-145. Not more than 10 percent (%) by weight of fill material shall pass the No. 200 Sieve. The Contractor shall furnish all additional fill material required. E. Unsuitable Soil Materials: Unsuitable materials are classified as A-2-5, A-2-6, A-2-7, A-4, A-5, A- 6, A-7, and A-8 in accordance with AASHTO Designation M-145. Plan for Earthwork: A. The Contractor shall be responsible for having determined to his satisfaction, prior to the submission of his bid, the conformation of the ground, the character and quality of the substrata, the types and quantities of materials to be encountered, the nature of the groundwater conditions, the prosecution of the work, the general and local conditions and all other matters which can in any way affect the work under this Contract according to the General Conditions. B. Prior to commencing the excavation, the Contractor shall submit a plan of his proposed operations, including maintenance of traffic, to the Engineer and the city for review and approval. The Contractor shall consider, and his plan for excavation shall reflect, the equipment and methods to be employed in the excavation. The prices established in the Proposal for the work to be done will reflect all costs pertaining to the work. No claims for extras based on substrata or groundwater table conditions shall be allowed. Trench Safety: A. All trench excavations which exceed 5 feet in depth shall comply at all times with the applicable trench safety standards as stated in the OSHA excavation safety standards 29 CFR S. 1926.650 Subpart P as regulated and administered by the Florida Department of Labor and Employment Security as the "Florida Trench Safety Act". B. The Contractor shall comply with all of the requirements of the Florida Trench Safety Act. The Contractor shall acknowledge that included in various items of his bid proposal and in the total bid price are costs for complying with the provisions of the Act. Testing: A Certified Testing Laboratory employed by the Contractor shall make such tests as are required to demonstrate compliance with these specifications. The Contractor shall schedule his work to permit a SECTION IV Page 11 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 • • • SECTION IV — Technical Specifications reasonable time for testing before placing succeeding lifts and shall keep the laboratory informed of his progress. All costs for all testing shall be paid by the Contractor. Changed Job Conditions: If, in the opinion of the Engineer or the city Representative, conditions encountered during construction warrant a change in the structure footing elevation, or in the depth of removal of unsuitable material from that indicated in the soils report, an adjustment will be made in the contract price as provided in the General and Special Conditions. Utility Construction Surveys: A. Prior to commencing excavation, backfill or dewatering for utilities, the Contractor shall conduct a survey of those existing structures which, in the opinion of the Engineer, may be subject to settlement or distress resulting from excavation or dewatering operations. B. The Contractor shall monitor the structures surveyed to ascertain evidence of settlement or distress during construction. If settlement or distress becomes evident, the Contractor shall be required to repair the structures to the previous condition to the satisfaction of the Engineer and the city. All costs for repairs shall be paid by the Contractor. Submittals: A. Submit to the Engineer for review the proposed methods of construction, including dewatering, excavation, bedding, filling, compaction, and backfilling for the various portions of the work. Review shall be for method only. The Contractor shall remain responsible for the adequacy and safety of the methods. B. Submit to the Engineer for review and approval the sieve analyses and soil classifications completed by the Geotechnical Engineer hired by the Contractor, for materials to be used for pipe bedding and trench and structural backfill including Structural Fill, Class I and Class II soil materials, Crushed Stone bedding materials and Coarse Sand materials. C. Submit to the Engineer for review, the soil compaction results 201-1.2. mATERIALS General Requirements: A. All fill materials from on and off-site sources shall be subject to the approval of the Engineer and the city. B. All fill material shall be unfrozen and free of organic material, trash, or other objectionable material. Excess or unsuitable material as designated by the Engineer shall be removed from the job site by the Contractor. Common Fill Materials: A. Common fill shall be sand, free of clay, organic material, muck, loam, wood, trash and other objectionable material which may be compressible, or which cannot be compacted properly. It shall not contain stones, rock, concrete or other rubble larger than 1 -1/2 -inches in diameter. It shall have physical properties which allow it to be easily spread and compacted. B. Common fill shall be no more than 10 percent by weight finer than the No. 200 mesh sieve. C. The Contractor shall utilize as much excavated material as possible for reuse as backfill material in accordance with the Contract Drawings and Project Specifications or as directed by the Engineer. D. The Engineer shall direct the Contractor on the type of material allowed in certain sections of the earthwork operations. SECTION IV Page 12 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications Structural Fill: Structural fill shall be well graded sand to gravel -sand having the following gradation: U.S. Sieve Size Percent Passing by Weight 1 -inch 100% No. 4 Sieve 75% to 100% No. 40 Sieve 15% to 80% No. 100 Sieve 0 to 30% No. 200 Sieve 0 to 10% Class I Soils*: Manufactured angular, granular material, 1/4 -inch to 1-1/2- inches in size, including materials having significance such as crushed stone or rock, broken coral, crushed slag, cinders, or crushed shells. Sieve analysis for crushed stone is given below separately. A. Crushed Stone: Crushed stone shall consist of clean mineral aggregate free from clay, loam or organic matter conforming with particle size limits as included in Table 201-A below. Unless approved otherwise by the engineer, crushed stone for PVC, FRP or HDPE pipe bedding shall conform with ASTM C33 stone size No. 89 and crushed stone for ductile iron pipe shall conform to ASTM C33 stone size No. 68 or 78. * Soils defined as Class I soils are not defined in ASTM D2487. Class II Soils**: A. GW: Well -graded gravels and gravel -sand mixtures, little or no fines, clean. Fifty (50) percent or more retained on No. 4 sieve. More than 95 percent retained on No. 200 sieve. B. GP: Poorly graded gravels and gravel -sand mixtures, little or no fines, clean. Fifty (50) percent or more retained on No. 4 sieve. More than 95 percent retained on No. 200 sieve. C. SW: Well -graded sands and gravelly sands, little or no fines, clean. More than fifty (50) percent passing No. 4 sieve. More than 95 percent retained on No. 200 sieve. D. SP: Poorly graded sands and gravelly sands, little or no fines, clean. More than fifty (50) percent passing No. 4 sieve. More than 95 percent retained on No. 200 sieve. ** In accordance with ASTM D2487, less than 5 percent passing No. 200 sieve. Coarse Sand: Sand shall consist of clean mineral aggregate with particle size limits as follows: U.S. Sieve Size Percent Passing By Weight No. 10 Sieve 100% No. 20 Sieve 0 to 30% No. 40 Sieve 0 to 5% Other Material: All other material, not specifically described, but required for proper completion of the work shall be selected by the Contractor and approved by the Engineer. 201-1.3. cLEARING AND gRUBBING 201-1.3.1. GENERAL A. Clearing: Clearing shall completely remove and dispose of all timber, shrubs, brush, stumps, limbs, roots, grass, weeds, other vegetative growth, rubbish and all other objectionable obstructions resting on or protruding through the surface of the ground. Remove all evidence of their presence from the surface including sticks and branches. Remove and dispose of trash piles and rubbish that is scattered over the construction site or collects there during construction. Those trees, shrubs, vegetative growth, and fencing, if any, which are designed by the Engineer to remain, shall be SECTION IV Page 13 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 • • • SECTION IV — Technical Specifications preserved and protected as hereinafter specified. Clearing operations shall be conducted so as to prevent damage to existing structures and installations and to those under construction, so as to provide for safety of employees and others. B. Grubbing: Grubbing shall consist of the complete removal of all stumps, roots larger than 1-1/2 inches in diameter, matted roots, brush, timber, logs, and any other organic or metallic debris remaining after clearing not suitable for foundation purposes, resting on, under or protruding through the surface of the ground to a depth of 18 -inches below the subgrade or the bottom of utility trenches. All depressions excavated below the original ground surface for or by the removal of such objects, shall be refilled with suitable materials and compacted to a density conforming to the surrounding ground surface. C. Stripping: Remove and dispose of all organics and sod, topsoil, grass, and grass roots, and other objectionable material remaining after clearing and grubbing from the areas designated to be stripped. Grass, grass roots and organic material in areas to be excavated or filled shall be stripped to the depth as noted in the soils report. In areas so designated, topsoil shall be stockpiled. Stripped material and unsuitable material, such as organic material, shall be disposed of by the Contractor unless directed otherwise by the Engineer. 1. In areas so designated, topsoil shall be stripped and stockpiled. Topsoil so stockpiled shall be protected until it is placed as specified. Any topsoil remaining after all work is in place shall be disposed of by the Contractor. 201-1.3.2. CLEARING AND GRUBBING OPERATIONS Clearing and Grubbing Limits: All excavation areas associated with new structures, slabs, utilities and roadways shall be cleared and grubbed to the following depths: A. Proposed Structures: 2 -feet below existing grade within a 5 -foot margin of each structure and replaced with compacted structural fill material as specified in Section 201-2.2 B. Building Site Areas not specifically noted above: 2 -feet below existing grade within a 5 -foot margin of each building site area and replaced with compacted structural fill material as specified in Section 201-2.2. C. Utility Trenches: 1.5 -feet below the bottom of the utility trench within the entire width of the trench and replaced with compacted Class II Soils, Type SW or SP material as specified in Section 201- 2.2. D. Roadway and Paved Area: 2 -feet below existing grade within a 5 -foot margin of areas paved and replaced with compacted common fill material as specified. E. All Other Areas: 1 -foot below completed surface and replaced with compacted common fill material as specified. Areas to be Stripped: All excavation and embankment areas associated with new structures, slabs, walks, and roadways shall be stripped. Stockpile areas shall be stripped. 201-1.3.3. DISPOSAL OF DEBRIS MATERIAL A. Disposal of Clearing and Grubbing Debris: The Contractor shall dispose of all material and debris from the clearing and grubbing operations by hauling such material and debris away to an approved disposal site and dispose of in accordance with all local laws, codes, and ordinances. Disposal by burning or burial on-site shall not be permitted. The cost of disposal (including hauling) of cleared and grubbed material and debris shall be considered a subsidiary obligation of the Contractor, the cost of which shall be included in the contract price. B. Disposal of Stripped Material: Remove all stripped material and dispose off-site in a legal manner, unless otherwise directed by the Engineer to stockpile the material, such as topsoil, for use in the final Work. SECTION IV Page 14 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications 201-1.3.4. PRESERVATION OF TREES AND SHRUBBERY A. Trees and Shrubbery: All existing trees, shrubbery, and other vegetative material may not be shown on the Drawings. Inspect the site as to the nature, location, size, and extent of vegetative material to be removed or preserved, as specified herein. Preserve, in place, trees that are specifically shown on the Drawings and designated to be preserved. B. Tree Protection: Those trees which are designated for preservation shall be carefully protected from damage. The Contractor shall erect such barricades, guards, and enclosures as may be considered necessary for the protection of the trees during all construction operations. C. Preservation and Protection of Trees, Shrubs, and Other Plant Material: 1. All plant materials (trees, shrubbery, and plants) beyond the limits of clearing and grubbing shall be saved and protected from damage resulting from the work. No filling, excavating, trenching, or stockpiling of materials will be permitted within the drip line of these trees or plants. The drip line is defined as a circle drawn by extending a line vertically to the ground from the outermost branches of a tree, plant, or group of plants. To prevent soil compaction within the drip line area, no equipment will be permitted within this area. 2. When trees are close together, restrict entry to area within drip line by fencing or a protective barrier. In areas where no fence or barrier is erected, the trunks of all trees 2 - inches or greater in caliper shall be protected by encircling the trunk entirely with boards held securely by 10 -gauge wire and staples. This protection shall extend from ground level to a height of 6 -feet. Neatly cut and remove tree branches where such cutting is necessary to affect construction operations. The cutting and removing must be performed or supervised by an I.S.A certified arborist. Remove branches other than those required to affect the work to provide a balanced appearance of any tree. Scars resulting from the removal of branches shall be treated with a tree sealant. 201-1.3.5. PRESERVATION OF DEVELOPED PRIVATE PROPERTY A. The Contractor shall exercise extreme care to avoid unnecessary disturbance of developed private property. Trees, shrubbery, gardens, lawns, and other landscaping, which in the opinion of the Engineer must be removed, shall be replaced and replanted to restore the construction easement to the condition existing prior to construction. B. All soil preparation procedures and replanting operations shall be under the supervision of a nurseryman experienced in such operations. C. Improvements to the land such as fences, walls, outbuildings, etc., which of the necessity of construction activities must be removed, shall be replaced with equal quality materials and workmanship. D. The Contractor shall clean up the construction site across from developed private property directly after construction is completed upon approval of the Engineer. 201-1.3.6. PRESERVATION OF PUBLIC PROPERTY The appropriate paragraphs of Sections 203-2.3.4. and 203-2.3.5. of these specifications shall apply to the preservation and restoration of all damaged areas of public lands, parks, rights-of-way, easements, etc. 201-1.4. EXCAVATION PROTECTION 201-1.4.1. SHEETING AND BRACING A. Furnish, put in place, and maintain such sheeting and bracing as required to support the sides of excavations, to prevent any movement which could in any way diminish the width of the excavation below that necessary for proper construction, and to protect adjacent utilities or structures, other aboveground structures, utility poles, etc. from being undermined, and to protect workers from SECTION IV Page 15 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 • SECTION IV — Technical Specifications hazardous conditions or other damage. Such support shall consist of braced steel sheet piling, braced wood lagging and soldier piles and beams or other approved methods. If the Engineer or the city is of the opinion that at any points, sufficient or proper supports have not been provided, they may order additional supports to be put in place at the expense of the Contractor, and compliance with such order shall not relieve or release the Contractor from his responsibility for the sufficiency of such supports. Care shall be taken to prevent voids from occurring adjacent to the sheeting, but if voids are formed, they shall be immediately filled and compacted. Where soil cannot be properly compacted to fill a void, lean concrete shall be used as backfill, at no additional expense to the city. B. The Contractor shall construct the sheeting outside the neat lines of the foundation unless deemed otherwise for the Contractor's method of operation. Sheeting shall be plumb and securely braced and tied in position. Sheeting and bracing shall be adequate to withstand all pressure to which the structure or trench shall be subjected. Any deformation, movement or bulging which may occur, shall be corrected by the Contractor at his own expense, to provide the necessary clearances and dimensions. C. Where sheeting and bracing is required to support the sides of excavations for utility structures, other structures, power poles, etc., the Contractor shall engage a Professional Geotechnical Engineer, registered in the state of Florida, to design the sheeting and bracing. The sheeting and bracing installed shall conform to the design, and certification of the installation shall be provided by the Professional Geotechnical Engineer. D. The installation of sheeting, particularly by driving or vibrating, may cause distress to existing structures. The Contractor shall evaluate the potential for such distress and, if necessary, take all precautions to prevent distress of existing structures because of sheeting installation. E. The Contractor shall leave in place to be embedded in the backfill all sheeting and bracing not shown on the Drawings but which the Engineer or the city may direct him in writing to leave in place at any time during the progress of the work for the purpose of preventing injury to any structures or property, whether public or private. The Engineer or the city may direct that timber or steel sheeting used for sheeting and bracing be cut off at any specified elevation. F. The right of the Engineer or the city to order sheeting and bracing to be left in place shall not be construed as creating any obligation on their part to issue such orders, and their failure to exercise their right to do so shall not relieve the Contractor from liability for damages to persons or property occurring from or upon the work occasioned by negligence or otherwise, growing out of a failure on the part of the Contractor to leave in place sufficient sheeting and bracing to prevent any caving or moving of the ground. G. Steel or wood sheeting installed for utility pipeline construction shall not, under any circumstances be withdrawn, if driven below the top of any utility pipeline. Steel sheeting, soldier piles and wood sheeting earth support systems installed for utility pipeline construction shall be cut-off and left -in- place at least 3 -feet below the ground surface, but no lower than 2 -feet above the top of the utility pipe. H. All sheeting and bracing not left in place shall be carefully removed in such manner as not to endanger the new construction or other structures, utilities, or property outside the construction area. All voids left or caused by withdrawal of sheeting shall be immediately refilled with sand by compacting with tools specifically adapted to that purpose, or otherwise as may be directed by the Engineer or the city. 201-1.5. EXCAVATING FOR UTILITY STRUCTURES Excavation work shall be performed in a safe and proper manner with appropriate precautions being taken against all hazards. Excavations shall provide adequate working space and clearances for the work to be performed therein and for installation and removal of concrete forms. In no case shall excavation faces be undercut for extended footings. SECTION IV Page 16 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications Excavation shall be made to such dimensions as will give suitable room for building the foundations and the structures, for bracing and supporting, for pumping and draining, for installing the pipelines, and for all other work required. A. Excavation for precast or prefabricated structures shall be carried to an elevation two (2) feet lower than the proposed outside bottom of the structure to provide space for the backfill and bedding material. B. Excavation for structures constructed or cast -in-place in dewatered or dry excavations shall be carried down to the 2 -feet below the bottom of the structure where dewatering methods are such that a dry evacuation bottom is exposed and the naturally occurring material at this elevation leveled and left ready to receive construction. Material disturbed below the founding elevation in dewatered excavations shall be replaced with Class B concrete. Prior to backfilling, document the location, elevation, size, material type and function of all new subsurface installations, and utilities encountered during excavation and construction. Excavation equipment operators and other concerned parties shall be familiar with subsurface obstructions as shown on the Drawings and should anticipate the encounter of unknown obstructions during the work. Encounters with subsurface obstructions shall be hand excavated. Excavation and dewatering shall be accomplished by methods which preserve the undisturbed state of subgrade soils. Subgrade soils which become soft, loose, "quick" or otherwise unsatisfactory for support of structures as a result of inadequate dewatering or caused by other construction methods, shall be removed and replaced with crushed stone as required by the Engineer at the Contractor's expense. The bottom of excavations shall be rendered firm and dry before placing any structure or pipe. Excavated material not suitable for backfill shall be removed from the site and disposed of by the Contractor, in a legal manner. The bedding schedule for pipes shall be as shown in Table 201-C. If the sub -grade is unsuitable, the Contractor shall, remove and replace all unsuitable material below pipe with selected common fill or bedding rock, compacted to 95 percent Modified Proctor density. All pavements and sidewalks shall be cut prior to removal, with saws or accepted power tools. Excavated material shall be stockpiled in such a manner as to prevent nuisance conditions. Surface drainage shall not be hindered. All structure and pipe locations and elevations as required herein must be permanently documented by the Contractor, on the As-Builts, prior to the Engineer's approval of the Application for Payment for that work. 201-1.6. TRENCH EXCAVATION FOR UTILITY PIPELINES 201-1.6.1. TRENCH EXCAVATION FOR PIPE LAYING - GENERAL A. The Contractor shall not open more trench in advance of pipe laying than is necessary to expedite the work. Four hundred (400) feet shall be the maximum length of open trench for any pipeline under construction. All trench excavation shall be open cut from the surface. B. Alignment, Grade, and Minimum Cover: The alignment and grade or elevation of each pipeline shall be fixed and determined from offset stakes. Vertical and horizontal alignment of pipes, and the maximum joint deflection used in connection therewith shall be in conformance with the requirements of Section 500 covering installation of pipe. C. Where pipe grades or elevations are not definitely fixed by the Contract Drawings, trenches shall be excavated to a depth sufficient to provide a depth of backfill cover over the top of the pipe of Between the range of 30- 42 -inches. Greater pipe cover depths may be necessary on vertical curves or to provide necessary clearance beneath existing pipes conduits, drains, drainage structures, or SECTION IV Page 17 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications • other obstructions encountered at normal pipe grades. Measurement of pipe cover depth shall be made vertically from the outside top of pipe to finished ground or pavement surface elevation. 201-1.6.2. LIMITED TRENCH WIDTHS A. Trenches shall be excavated to a width which shall provide adequate working space and sidewall clearances for proper pipe installation, jointing, and embedment. However, minimum permissible sidewall clearances between the installed pipe and each trench wall, expressed in inches, shall be as follows: • • Nominal Pipe Size, in Inches Nominal Sidewall Clearance, in Inches 60 24 54 21 48 19 36 or smaller 12 B. Stipulated minimum sidewall clearances are not minimum average clearances but are minimum clear distances which shall be required. C. Cutting trench banks on slopes to reduce earth load to prevent sliding and caving will be permitted only in areas where the increased trench width will not interface with surface features or encroach on right-of-way limits. Slopes shall not extend lower than one foot above the top of the pipe. 201-1.6.3. MECHANICAL EXCAVATION The use of mechanical equipment will not be permitted in locations where its operation would cause damage to trees, buildings, culverts, and other existing property, utilities, or structures above or below ground. In all such locations, hand excavating methods shall be used. Mechanical excavation equipment used for trench excavation shall be of the type, design, and construction, and shall be so operated, such that the rough trench excavation bottom elevation can be controlled, that uniform trench widths and vertical sidewalls are obtained at least from an elevation one foot above the top of the installed pipe to the bottom of the trench, and that trench alignment is such that the pipe when accurately laid to specified alignment will be centered in the trench with adequate clearance between the pipe and sidewalls of the trench. Undercutting the trench sidewall to obtain clearance shall not be permitted. 201-1.6.4. PAVEMENT CUTTING Cuts in concrete pavement, asphalt pavement, and asphaltic base pavements shall be no larger than necessary to provide adequate working space for proper installation of pipe and appurtenances. Cutting shall be started with an asphalt or concrete saw in a manner which will provide a clean groove for the full depth of pavement along each side of the trench and along the perimeter of cuts for structures. Asphalt pavement and asphaltic base pavement over trenches excavated for pipelines shall be removed so that a shoulder not less than 6 -inches in width at any point is left between the cut edge of the pavement and the top edge of the trench. Trench width at the bottom shall not be greater than at the top and no undercutting shall be permitted. Pavement cuts shall be made to and between straight or accurately marked curved lines which, unless otherwise required, shall be parallel to the centerline of the trench. Pavement removed for connections to existing lines or structures shall not be greater than necessary for the installation as determined by the Engineer. Road restoration shall be full road width. 201-1.6.5. ARTIFICIAL FOUNDATIONS IN TRENCHES Whenever so ordered by the Engineer due to the presence of unsuitable material at the designed depth, the Contractor shall excavate to such depth below grade as the Engineer may direct and the trench bottom shall be brought to grade with such material as the Engineer may order installed. All piling, concrete, or other SECTION IV Page 18 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications foundations made necessary by unstable soil shall be installed as directed by the Engineer. Compensation for extra excavation and piling, concrete, or other foundations, except where provided by contract unit prices, shall be made in accordance with the contract provisions for extra work. 201-1.6.6. BELL HOLES Bell holes shall provide adequate clearance for tools and methods used in installing pipe. No part of any bell or coupling shall be in contact with the trench bottom, trench walls, or granular embedment when the pipe is jointed. 201-1.7. UNDERCUT OF EXCAVATIONS If the bottom of any structure or trench excavation is below that shown on the Drawings or specified because of Contractor error, convenience, or unsuitable subgrade due the Contractor's excavation methods, the Contractor shall refill to normal grade with approved fill at his own cost. Fill material and compaction method shall be as directed by the Engineer. 201-1.8. STABILIZATION OF EXCAVATIONS Subgrades for concrete structures and trench bottoms shall be firm, dense, and thoroughly compacted and consolidated; shall be free from mud and muck; and shall be sufficiently stable to remain firm and intact. Subgrades for concrete structures or trench bottoms which are otherwise solid, but which becomes mucky on top due to construction operations, shall be reinforced with one or more layers of crushed rock or gravel. Not more than 1/2 -inch depth of mud or muck shall be allowed to remain on stabilized trench bottoms when the pipe bedding material is placed thereon. The finished elevation of stabilized subgrades for concrete structures shall not be above subgrade elevations shown on the Drawings. All stabilization work shall be performed by and at the expense of the Contractor. 201-1.9. BACKFILL AND COMPACTION 201-1.9.1. MATERIALS A. To the maximum extent available, excess earth obtained from structure and trench excavation shall be used for the construction of fills and embankments. B. Materials used as backfill shall be free from rocks or stones larger than 1 -1/2 -inches in their greatest dimension; brush or vegetation, stumps, logs, roots, debris, and organic or other deleterious materials; and must be acceptable to the Engineer. C. Backfilling and construction of fills and embankments during freezing weather shall not be done except by permission of the Engineer. No backfill, fill, or embankment materials shall be installed on frozen surfaces, nor shall frozen materials be in any backfill, fill or embankment. 201-1.9.2. BACKFILL PLACEMENT AND COMPACTION A. Backfill materials shall be placed in approximately horizontal layers not to exceed 8 -inches in un - compacted thickness. Material deposited in piles or windrows by excavating and hauling equipment shall be spread and leveled before compaction. B. Each layer of material being compacted shall have the optimum uniform moisture content to ensure satisfactory compaction. The Contractor shall be required to add water and harrow, disc, blade, or otherwise work the material in each layer to ensure uniform moisture content and adequate compaction. SECTION IV Page 19 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications • C. Each layer shall be thoroughly compacted by rolling or other method acceptable to the Engineer to 95% of relative density at optimum moisture content as determined by Modified Proctor Method, ASTM D1557, latest revision. D. Whenever a trench passes through a backfill or embankment area, material shall be placed and compacted to an elevation 12 -inches above the top of the pipe before the trench is excavated. E. Backfill and compact excavations and construct embankments for structures according to the schedule listed in Table 201-B. Backfill and bedding schedule for pipes is listed in Table 201-C. (Modified Proctor for compaction shall be as determined by ASTM D-1557, latest revision). F. Pipe shall be laid in open trenches unless otherwise indicated on the Drawings or elsewhere in the Contract Documents. G. Excavations shall be backfilled to the original grade or as indicated on the Drawings. Deviation from this grade because of settling shall be corrected. Backfill operation shall be performed to comply with all rules and regulations and in such a manner that it does not create a nuisance or safety hazard. H. Embankments shall be constructed true to lines, grades and cross sections shown on the plans or ordered by the Engineer or the city. Embankments shall be placed in successive layers of not more than 8 -inches in thickness, loose measure, for the full width of the embankment. As far as practicable, traffic over the work during the construction phase shall be distributed so as to cover the maximum surface area of each layer. I. If the Contractor requests approval to backfill material utilizing lifts and/or methods other than those specified herein, such request shall be in writing to the Engineer. Approval will be considered only after the Contractor has performed tests, at the Contractor's expense, to identify the material used and density achieved throughout the backfill area utilizing the method of backfill requested. The Engineer's approval shall be in writing. • 201-1.9.3. STRUCTURE FOUNDATION PREPARATION The existing ground beneath proposed tankage, building foundations and equipment base slabs and slabs on grade shall be removed and the area proof rolled. Proof -rolling should consist of at least 10 passes of a self-propelled vibrator compactor capable of delivering a minimum impact force of 30,000 to 35,000 pounds per drum to the soils. Each pass should overlap the preceding pass by 30 percent to insure complete coverage. Backfilled areas shall be compacted in 8 -inch layers to a density of not less than 95 percent of Modified Proctor Dry Density as determined by ASTM D1557, latest revision, for a depth of not less than 2 -feet below the bottom of the foundations or concrete slabs. Any unsuitable foundation material shall be removed and replaced with suitable material. Slabs on Grade: Subgrades for concrete slabs shall be removed, backfilled, and compacted to the required grade. The top 2 -feet of concrete slab subgrade in cut sections and all fill material shall be compacted in 8 - inch layers to a density of not less than 95 percent of Modified Proctor Dry Density as determined by ASTM D1557, latest revision. • 201-1.10. DRAINAGE FROM EXCAVATIONS Trenches across roadways, driveways, walks, or other traffic ways adjacent to drainage ditches or water courses shall not be backfilled prior to completion of backfilling the trench on the upstream side of the traffic way to prevent impounding water after the pipe has been laid. Bridges and other temporary structures required to maintain traffic across such unfilled trenches shall be constructed and maintained by the Contractor. Backfilling shall be done so that water will not accumulate in unfilled or partially filled trenches. SECTION IV Page 20 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications All material deposited in roadway ditches or other water courses crossed by the line of trench shall be removed immediately after backfilling is completed and the original sections, grades, and contours of ditches or water courses shall be restored. Surface drainage shall not be obstructed longer than necessary. 201-1.11. FINAL GRADING After other outside work has been finished, and backfilling completed and settled, all areas on the site of the work which are to be graded shall be brought to grade within the tolerance off 0.1 feet at the indicated elevations, slopes, and contours where seeding or sodding is not required or, where sodding is required within three (3) inches of finished grade. Use of graders or other power equipment will be permitted for final grading and dressing of slopes, provided the result is uniform and equivalent to hand work. All surfaces shall be graded to secure effective drainage. Unless otherwise shown, a slope of at least one percent shall be provided. After grading and where seeding is required, topsoil shall be evenly spread to a minimum depth of six (6) inches. Topsoil shall be from an Engineer approved source and shall be free of trash, debris and surface vegetation. Grading and surfacing shall be completed to the satisfaction of the Engineer and the Owner. 201-1.12. EXCESS EXCAVATED MATERIAL Insofar as needed, suitable excavated materials shall be used in fills and embankments as shown on the Drawings. All suitable excess excavated material shall be placed at an on-site stockpile area as directed by the city. The Contractor shall segregate different types of excavated materials (i.e. sands, clayey sands) as much as possible in the stockpile areas. All unsuitable materials shall be disposed of by the Contractor offsite, in a legal manner. The Contractor shall slope and compact the stockpile with a light roller type vehicle to maintain stability. The Contractor shall maintain proper soil and erosion control measures. 201-1.13. SETTLEMENT The Contractor shall be responsible for all settlement of backfill, fills, and embankments which may occur within the guarantee period stipulated in the General Conditions of the Contract. The Contractor shall make, or cause to be made, all repairs or replacements made necessary by settlement within 30 days after notice from the Engineer or the city. SECTION IV Page 21 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications • TABLE 201-A STANDARD SIZES OF COARSE AGGREGATE AMOUNTS FINER THEN EACH LABORATORY SIEVE (SQUARE OPENINGS), MASS PERCENT • • TABLE 201-B COMPACTION AND BACKFILL SCHEDULE FOR STRUCTURES Area U. S. Sieve Size, Percent Passing By Weight Aggregate Nominal Size Structural Fill (Section 201-2.2., Structural Fill) 8 -inch lifts compacted to 95% Modified Proctor maximum dry density (98% Modified Proctor maximum dry density under pavement). Fill should not be placed over any in-place soils until those layers have been compacted to 95% Modified Proctor maximum dry density (98% Modified Proctor maximum dry density under pavement). Around structures, foundations and slabs (minimum 5 -foot outside structure)Structural Structural Fill (Section 201-2.2., Fill) 8 -inch lifts compacted to 95% Modified Proctor maximum dry density (98% Modified Proctor maximum dry density under pavement). Use light rubber -tired or vibratory plate compactors. From cleared existing surface to subgradefor paved and gravelavelroadway surfaces Common Fill (Section 201-2.2., Common Fill) 12 -inch lifts, compacted to 95% Modified Proctor maximum dry density (98% Modified Proctor maximum dry density under pavement). Disturbed area requiring seeding and mulching Size Square 1 -1/2 -in 1 -in. 3/4 -in. 1/2 -in. 3/8 -in. No. 4 No. 8 No. 16 No. 50 No. Openings 57 1 -in. to No. 4 100% 95%- 100% -- 25%- 60% -_ 0-10% 0-5% -- -- 68 3/4 -in. to No.8 -- 100% 90%- 100% -- 30%- 65% 5%- 25% 0- 10% 0-5% -- 78 1/2 -in. to No. 8 -- -- 100% 90%- 100% 40%- 75% 5%- 25% 0- 10% 0-5% -- 89 3/8 -in. to No. 16 -- -- -- 100% 90%- 100% 20%- 55% 5%- 30% 0-10% 0-5% TABLE 201-B COMPACTION AND BACKFILL SCHEDULE FOR STRUCTURES Area Material Compaction Beneath structures foundations, slabs,,and pavements. (minimum 2 -foot depth below concrete foundation bottom) Structural Fill (Section 201-2.2., Structural Fill) 8 -inch lifts compacted to 95% Modified Proctor maximum dry density (98% Modified Proctor maximum dry density under pavement). Fill should not be placed over any in-place soils until those layers have been compacted to 95% Modified Proctor maximum dry density (98% Modified Proctor maximum dry density under pavement). Around structures, foundations and slabs (minimum 5 -foot outside structure)Structural Structural Fill (Section 201-2.2., Fill) 8 -inch lifts compacted to 95% Modified Proctor maximum dry density (98% Modified Proctor maximum dry density under pavement). Use light rubber -tired or vibratory plate compactors. From cleared existing surface to subgradefor paved and gravelavelroadway surfaces Common Fill (Section 201-2.2., Common Fill) 12 -inch lifts, compacted to 95% Modified Proctor maximum dry density (98% Modified Proctor maximum dry density under pavement). Disturbed area requiring seeding and mulching Topsoil 2 -inch to 4 -inch lifts, compacted to 85% Modified Proctor maximum dry density. 202. OBSTRUCTIONS Any pipes, conduits, wires, mains, footings, driveways, or other structures encountered shall be carefully protected from damage or displacement. Any damage thereto shall be fully, promptly, and properly repaired by the Contractor to the satisfaction of the Engineer and the city of Clearwater thereof. Any survey monument or benchmark which must be disturbed shall be carefully referenced before removal, and unless otherwise provided for, shall be replaced upon completion of the work by a Florida registered Professional Surveyor and Mapper (PSM). Any concrete removed due to construction requirements shall be removed to the nearest expansion joint or by saw cut. Contractor shall consult Inspector/Project Manager for the approved means of removal and replacement. SECTION IV Page 22 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications 203. DEWATERING 203-1. GENERAL The work to be performed under this Section shall include the design and installation of a temporary dewatering system(s) until completion of construction to remove subsurface waters from structure or utility trench excavations as required. The Contractor shall furnish all equipment; labor and materials necessary to remove storm water or subsurface groundwater from excavation areas in accordance with the requirements set forth, as shown on the Drawings, and/or geotechnical report. Qualifications: For major dewatering activities the temporary dewatering system shall be designed, installed and operated by a firm who regularly engages in the design, installation and operation of dewatering systems and who is fully experienced, reputable, and qualified in the design, installation and operation of such dewatering systems. The firm shall have a successful record of operation for a minimum of five (5) years prior to bid date. The dewatering system firm shall have experience for installation of at least three (3) successful dewatering operations of a similar nature and size in the state of Florida. The dewatering system shall be developed to the point that it is capable of dewatering the site surrounding all structures or utility trenches as shown on the Drawings. Each dewatering system shall be capable of dewatering and maintaining groundwater levels at the respective excavations. Observation wells shall be constructed for the purpose of testing each system. The Contractor shall at all times during construction provide and maintain proper equipment and facilities to remove and dispose of all water entering excavations, and shall keep such excavations dry so as to obtain a satisfactory undisturbed subgrade foundation condition until the fill, structures or pipes to be built thereon have been completed to such extent that they will not be floated or otherwise damaged by allowing water levels to return to natural levels. In critical dewatering situations, the Contractor shall have on hand at the construction site, backup dewatering pumps and other critical components of the dewatering system that are operational and could be used in the event of breakdowns of the primary equipment. The Contractor's plan shall include temporary culverts, barricades, and other protective measures to prevent damage to property or injury to any person or persons. Prior to construction, the dewatering plan shall be prepared and submitted to the city's Engineering Department, Public Utilities Department, Industrial Pretreatment Program (IPP) Coordinator, Wastewater Environmental Manager and the Public Utilities Department Director or Assistant Director for review and approval. It shall include site-specific notes and details presenting the Contractor's proposed dewatering and disposal methods. The city will field -inspect the dewatering operation throughout construction. All costs for dewatering shall be included in the unit price bid per linear foot of pipe, or, in the case of other underground structures, in the cost of such structures. 203-1.1. Definition of Terms for Dewatering System Minor Dewatering Activity: A single stage well point dewatering system, operating for less than 30 days total duration, and not requiring a Notice of Dewatering Activity filed with the local Water Management District. Major Dewatering Activity: Any major dewatering system, operating for more than 30 days duration, requiring a Notice of Dewatering Activity filed with the local Water Management District. Major dewatering systems shall include, but not be limited to, multi -stage well point dewatering systems, drilled horizontal or vertical sock drain systems, dewatering deep well pump systems and educator dewatering systems. SECTION IV Page 23 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications • 203-2. OBSERVATION WELLS For major dewatering activities, prior to excavation, the Contractor shall install groundwater observation wells at locations as directed and designed by the Contractor's Geotechnical Engineer and as approved by the Engineer adjacent to structures or underground utility under construction for the purpose of monitoring water levels during excavations. Where required, the observation well construction shall consist of well screen, casing, and cap of approved size and material of construction. The observation well shall be placed in a 2 -1/2 -inch bore hole which shall be carried to an elevation at least 4 feet below the final bottom grade of structure or utility trench excavation. The annular space surrounding the intake point and the riser pipe shall be sealed in such a way as to prevent infiltration from surface water. The observation well shall be developed in such a manner as to ensure proper indication of subsurface water levels adjacent to the well. The Contractor shall be responsible for maintaining the observation wells and for observing and recording the elevation of groundwater until the structure or utilities requiring excavation are completed and backfilled. Each observation well shall be observed and recorded daily. Measurements shall be supplied daily to the Engineer and the city. The Engineer may require that the observation wells reflect true groundwater levels by adding water to the well, recording the drop in the level from the time the water was added. Any plugged observation well shall be redeveloped, if necessary, to indicate true groundwater levels. Observation wells shall be fully grouted and abandoned when the dewatering system is removed as directed by the Geotechnical Engineer, and in a manner acceptable to the Geotechnical Engineer. 203-3. PUMPING AND DRAINAGE - GENERAL Unless specifically authorized by the Engineer, all pipes, except sub drains, shall be laid "in the dry". In the dry shall be defined to be within 2 percent of the optimum moisture content of the soil. The Contractor shall dewater trench excavation as required for the proper execution of the work, using one or more of the following approved methods: well point system, trenched gravity under drain system, or sumps with pumps. Well point systems must be efficient enough to lower the water level in advance of the excavation and maintain it continuously in order that the trench bottom and sides shall remain firm and reasonably dry. The well points shall be designed especially for this type of service, and the pumping unit used shall be capable of maintaining a high vacuum, and at the same time, of handling large volumes of air as well as of water. Dewatering shall at all times be conducted in such a manner as to preserve the undisturbed bearing capacity of the subgrade soils 2 -feet below the proposed bottom of excavation and to preserve the integrity of adjacent structures. As a minimum, the water level shall be 2 -feet below the trench bottom. Well or sump installations shall be constructed with proper sand filters to prevent drawing of finer grained soil from the surrounding soils. Dewatering by trench pumping shall not be permitted if migration of fine-grained natural material from bottom, side walls, or bedding material may occur. A well point system, trench drain, sump pump operation, or other dewatering method shall be utilized to maintain the excavation in a dry condition for preparation of the trench bottom and until the structures or pipes to be built thereon have been completed to such extent that they will not be floated or otherwise damaged by allowing water levels to return to natural levels. No water shall be allowed to contact masonry or concrete within 24 hours after being placed. Water entering the excavation from surface runoff shall be collected in shallow ditches around the perimeter of the excavation, drained to sumps, and pumped from the excavation to maintain the excavation bottom free from standing water. The Contractor shall take all additional necessary precautions and prevent uplift of any structure during construction. SECTION IV Page 24 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications Flotation of structures or piping shall be prevented by the Contractor by maintaining a positive and continuous operation of the dewatering system. The Contractor shall be fully responsible and liable for all damages which may result from failure of the dewatering system. The conveying of water other than storm water surface runoff in open ditches or trenches will not be allowed unless prior approval is obtained. Permission to use any drainage ditches, storm sewers, drains or other storm drainage facilities for water conveyance or disposal purposes during dewatering operations shall be obtained from the controlling authority having jurisdiction. Any requirements and costs for such use shall be the responsibility of the Contractor. However, the Contractor shall not cause flooding by overloading or blocking up the flow in the drainage facilities, and the Contractor shall leave the facilities unrestricted and as clean as originally found. Any damage to existing facilities shall be repaired or restored, as directed by the Engineer or the authority having jurisdiction, at no cost to the city or the Owner of the facilities. The Contractor shall be responsible for disposing of all water resulting from trench dewatering operations and shall dispose of the water without damage or undue inconvenience to the work, the surrounding area, or the general public. The Contractor may be required to divert the water from the dewatering process to a location determined by the Engineer or city Project Manager or Inspector and obtain a discharge permit from Florida Department of Environmental Protection (FDEP). Alternatively, if Contractor elects to contain produced groundwater on the project site, a dewatering plan must be submitted to the Engineer or city for approval (even if a discharge permit is not required). The Contractor shall take all necessary precautions to preclude the accidental discharge of fuel, oil, or other contaminants in order to prevent adverse effects on groundwater or receiving water quality. 203-3.1. DEWATERING EQUIPMENT The dewatering equipment shall be standard dewatering equipment of proven ability as designed, manufactured, and installed by firms having experience in the design and production of such equipment. The equipment fumished shall be designed, constructed, and installed in accordance with the best practices and methods. The Contractor shall provide adequate equipment for the removal of surface or subsurface waters that may accumulate in the excavation. Flotation and migration of fines shall be prevented by the Contractor by maintaining a positive and continuous operation of the dewatering system. The Contractor shall be fully responsible and liable for all damages that may result from the operation and/or failure of this system. Sound levels for dewatering pumps shall meet governmental agencies ordinance levels. Sound levels in excess of such ordinance are sufficient cause to have the work halted until equipment can be quieted to these levels Work stoppage by the Engineer, city or other governmental agencies for excessive noise shall not relieve the Contractor of the other portions of this specification including, but not limited to contract time and contract price. Engine -driven pumps shall be equipped with critical grade type silencers, sound blankets or other types of sound mitigation measures to comply with Noise Ordinances. Engine driven dewatering pumps shall have a maximum rating of 80 decibels at a distance of 5 feet from the engine for sound attenuation, nor shall the pump engine noise exceed 50 decibels at a distance of 50 feet from the engine. There may be practical and feasible, electrical "power drops" and electric motor -driven equipment shall be used in lieu of portable generators. The dewatering system shall operate in such a manner as to preserve the undisturbed bearing capacity of the subgrade soils at the proposed structures or utilities and to preserve the integrity of any adjacent structures. Removal of dewatering equipment shall be accomplished following backfilling and compaction, and after the Contractor and the Engineer both agree, that the system is no longer required. All materials and equipment constituting the dewatering system shall be removed by the Contractor. SECTION IV Page 25 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 • • • SECTION IV — Technical Specifications Immediately upon completion of the dewatering operations, the Contractor shall remove all of his equipment, materials, and supplies from the site of the Work, remove all surplus materials and debris, fill in all holes or excavations, grout all groundwater monitoring wells installed for the dewatering operations and grade the site to elevations of the surface levels which existed before the work started. The site shall be thoroughly cleaned and graded as directed by the Engineer and approved by the city. 203-3.2. DEWATERING CONSIDERATIONS The Contractor shall install a temporary dewatering system for the removal of subsurface water encountered during construction of the proposed structures or underground utilities. The Contractor shall provide adequate equipment for the removal of storm or subsurface waters which may accumulate in the excavations. If well points are used, Contractor shall adequately space well points to maintain the necessary dewatering. Provide suitable filter sand and/or other means to prevent pumping of fine sands and silts. A continual check shall be maintained by the Contractor to ensure that the subsurface soil is not being removed by the dewatering operations. Pumping from well points shall be continuous and standby pumps shall be provided. The Contractor's proposed method of dewatering shall include groundwater observation wells to determine the water level during construction. Observation wells shall be installed along pipelines as required to verify depth to water level and at locations approved by the Engineer. At all times, site grading shall promote drainage. Surface runoff shall be diverted from excavations. Water entering the excavation from the surface shall be collected in shallow ditches around the perimeter of the excavation, drained to sumps, and pumped or drained by gravity to maintain an excavation bottom free from standing water. Flotation shall be prevented by the Contractor by maintaining a positive and continuous removal of water. The Contractor shall be fully responsible for all damages which may result from failure to adequately keep excavations dewatered. The Contractor shall construct and place all pipelines, structures, concrete work, structural fill, backfill and bedding material in -the -dry. If subsurface water is encountered, utilize suitable equipment to adequately dewater the excavation so that it will be "in -the -dry" for work and pipe laying. For the purposes of this specification, "in -the -dry" is defined to be within ±2 percent of the optimum moisture content of the soil. A well point system or other dewatering method accepted by the respective jurisdictional agency (agencies) shall be utilized, if necessary, to maintain the excavation in a dry condition for preparation of the trench bottom and for pipe laying. The Contractor shall not make the final 24 -inches of excavation until the water level is a minimum of 2 -feet below proposed bottom of the excavation. Dewatering by trench pumping will not be permitted if migration of fine-grained natural material from bottom, side walls, or bedding material will occur. In the event that satisfactory dewatering cannot be accomplished due to subsurface conditions or where dewatering could damage existing structures, obtain the Owner's and the Engineer's approval of wet trench construction procedures before commencing construction. 203-3.3. DISPOSAL OF PUMPED WATER Discharge water to on-site disposal areas (if shown on the Drawings) or as required by permits. The Contractor shall dispose of water from the Work in a suitable manner without damage to adjacent properties or facilities. No water shall be discharged without appropriate treatment for adverse contaminants. No water shall be drained in work built or under construction without prior consent from the Owner. Water shall be filtered to remove sand and fine soil particles before disposal into any drainage system. SECTION IV Page 26 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications Discharge water from dewatering operations to temporary infiltration pits, if possible. Discharge to storm sewers, canals, stream, or wetlands, only if specifically allowed for in Dewatering Permit. No discharges from dewatering operations shall be allowed to wastewater collection systems or wastewater pumping stations at any time. In no case, shall discharges from dewatering operations result in turbidity reaching wetlands or any waterways. If turbidity exceeds limits allowed by jurisdictional permitting agency(ies), stop all activities, and install additional erosion and sedimentation control as required by the Southwest Florida Water Management District or the FDEP. Flooding of streets, roadways, driveways, or private property shall not be permitted during dewatering activities. Contractor shall not dam -up, divert, or cause water to flow in excess in existing gutters, roadway pavements or other structures. For proper water discharges and disposal from dewatering operations, the Contractor may be required to divert or provide discharge piping to transport the water to a suitable place for legal discharge, as determined by the Engineer and the city. 203-3.4. GROUNDWATER TREATMENT (IF REQUIRED) If the concentrations of tested groundwater quality parameters exceed those allowable in the FDEP Generic Permit for the Discharge of Produced Groundwater from any Non -Contaminated Site Activity (62- 621.300(2), F.A.C.), the Contractor shall treat the effluent discharged from the dewatering system. The Contractor shall immediately notify the Engineer and the city Engineering Department and discuss the parameters that exceed allowable limits. The Contractor shall meet with the FDEP to determine treatment and disposal alternatives that are acceptable to the FDEP. The Contractor shall apply for and obtain any and all permits and/or treatment approvals that FDEP requires including but not limited to the following: 1. Generic Permit for Discharges from Petroleum Contaminated Sites (62-621.300(1)). Allows discharges from sites with automotive gasoline, aviation gasoline, jet fuel, or diesel fuel contamination; or, 2. Permit for all Other Contaminated Sites (62-04; 62-302; 62-620 & 62-660). The coverage is available only through the individual NPDES permit issued by FDEP, allows discharges from sites with general contaminant issues i.e. ground water and/or soil contamination other than petroleum fuel contamination; or, 3. Generic Permit for the Discharge of Produced Ground Water from Any Non -Contaminated Site Activity (62-621.300(2), F.A.C.); or, 4. Generic Permit for Stormwater Discharge from Large or Small Construction Activities (62- 621.300(4)(a), F.A.C.); or, 5. An Individual Wastewater Permit (62-604.300(8) (a). The Contractor shall implement the appropriate treatment that is acceptable to FDEP, the Engineer and the city to attain compliance for all excess limits encountered during dewatering activities. Treatment may include, but is not limited to: Chemical, Physical, Biological, Electrolysis, Ion Exchange, Aeration, Activated Carbon Absorption, or any combination of the these. The Contractor shall make every effort to minimize the spread of contamination into uncontaminated areas. Provide for the health and safety of all workers at the job site and make provisions necessary for the health and safety of the public that may be exposed to any potentially hazardous conditions. Ensure provision SECTION IV Page 27 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 • • • SECTION IV —Technical Specifications adhere to all applicable laws, rules or regulations covering hazardous conditions and will be in a manner commensurate with the level of severity of the conditions. If necessary, provide contamination assessment and remediation personnel to handle site assessment, determine the course of action necessary for site security and perform the necessary steps under applicable laws, rules and regulations for additional assessment and/or remediation work to resolve the contamination issue. Delineate the contamination area(s) and any staging or holding area required and develop a work plan that will provide the schedule of projected completion dates for the final resolution of the contamination issue. Maintain jurisdiction over activities inside any delineated contamination areas and any associated staging or holding areas. Be responsible for the health and safety of workers within the delineated areas. Provide continuous access to representatives of regulatory or enforcement agencies having jurisdiction. 203-4. PERMIT REQUIREMENTS The dewatering of any excavation areas and the disposal of water during construction shall be in strict accordance with the latest revisions of the National Pollutant Discharge Elimination System (NPDES), and all local and state government rules and regulations. The Contractor shall be responsible for submitting the Notice of Intent to use the Generic Permit for the Discharge of Groundwater from Dewatering Operations and associated fee in accordance with FDEP Requirements, F.A.C. 62-621.300(2)(b) and must receive written notice from the FDEP prior to discharging produced groundwater into the city's streets, storm sewers or waterways. The Contractor shall obtain and pay all respective fees for all local, state, and federal permits required applicable to the withdrawal, treatment and disposal/discharge of water produced from the dewatering operations, prior to the start of work. Contractor shall be responsible for acquiring and complying with all permits required to discharge produced water from dewatering and shall protect waterways from turbidity during the operation. Prior to discharging produced groundwater from any construction site, the contractor must collect samples and analyze the groundwater, which must meet acceptable discharge limits per FDEP "Generic Permit for the Discharge of Produced Ground Water from Any Non -Contaminated Site Activity" Chapter 62-621.300(2), FAC. The Contractor shall have on-site and available for review the analytical testing results performed in accordance with FDEP Chapter 62-621.300(2), FAC. Consumptive Use Permit (CUP): If pumping requirements exceed certain limits, the Contractor shall pay for and obtain a CUP from the regional Water Management District for such pumped volumes. If a consumptive use permit is required by the local Water Management District, the Contractor shall be responsible for obtaining said permit. Comply with all conditions of the Dewatering Permit issued by the Water Management District. Apply for permit extensions or modifications, when required. All water produced from dewatering shall be pumped from the trench or other excavation and shall be disposed of in strict accordance with applicable permits. The Contractor will be allowed to discharge product water from dewatering into storm sewers, or ditches having adequate capacity, canals or suitable disposal pits, or other surface waters in accordance with the Dewatering Plan, provided that the water has been sampled and tested by the Contractor, is in compliance with the concentration limits specified in 62- 621.300(2) FAC, and the Contractor has obtained an FDEP Generic Permit for the production of groundwater. The frequency of water sampling and testing shall be determined by the Engineer based on existing conditions and field observations. SECTION IV Page 28 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV —Technical Specifications 204. UNSUITABLE MATERIAL REMOVAL All unsuitable material, such as muck, clay, rock, etc., shall be excavated from under pipes, structures and roadways and removed from the site. All material removed is property of the Contractor, who shall dispose of said material off-site at their expense. The limits and depths of the excavation shall be determined in the field by the Engineer. Approved replacement materials shall meet the requirements of Section 304. 204-1. BASIS OF MEASUREMENT The basis of measurement shall be the number of cubic yards of clean fill placed as determined by either cross sections of the excavation, truck measure, or lump sum as specified in the Scope of Work and Contract Proposal. Included in the cost of removing unsuitable material is the cost to place suitable material/clean fill. 204-2. BASIS OF PAYMENT The unit price for the removal of unsuitable material shall include: all materials, equipment, tools, labor, disposal, hauling, excavating, dredging, placing, compaction, dressing surface and incidentals necessary to complete the work. If no pay item is given, the removal of unsuitable material shall be included in the most appropriate bid item. 205. UTILITY TIE IN LOCATION MARKING The tie in locations for utility laterals of water, sanitary sewer, and gas shall be plainly marked on the back of the curb. Marking placed on the curb shall be perpendicular with respect to the curb of the tie in location on the utility lateral. Marks shall not be placed on the curb where laterals cross diagonally under the curb. The tie in location shall be the end of the utility lateral prior to service connection. Markings shall be uniform in size and shape and colors in conformance with the current code adopted by the American Public Works Association: SAFETY RED Electric Power Lines, Cables, Conduit and Lighting Cables HIGH VISIBILITY SAFETY YELLOW Gas, Oil, Steam, Petroleum or Gaseous Materials SAFETY ALERT ORANGE Communication, Alarm or Signal Lines, Cables or Conduit SAFETY BLUE Potable Water SAFETY GREEN Sewer Systems and Drain Lines PURPLE Reclaimed Water, Irrigation and Slurry Lines WHITE Proposed Excavation PINK Temporary Survey Markings Marks placed on curbs shall be rectangular in shape and placed with the long dimension perpendicular to the flow line of the curb. Marks placed on valley gutter and modified curb shall be six-inch (6") x three inch (3") and placed at the back of the curb. Marks placed on State Road and vertical curb shall be four - inch (4") x two inch (2") and be placed on the curb face. 206. CLEARING AND GRUBBING The work included in this specification includes the removal and disposal of all structures, appurtenances, asphalt, concrete, curbs, walls, trees, roots, vegetation, boulders, conduits, poles, posts, pipes, inlets, brush, stumps, debris and other obstructions resting on or protruding through the ground surface necessary to prepare the area for construction. SECTION IV Page 29 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 • • • SECTION IV —Technical Specifications Clearing and grubbing shall be performed in accordance with Section 110 of FDOT's Standard Specifications. Unless otherwise specified in the contract documents, the Contractor shall take ownership of all removed material and dispose of them off-site in accordance with all Local, State and Federal Requirements. 206-1. BASIS OF MEASUREMENT The basis of measurement shall be either a lump sum quantity or the number of acres cleared and grubbed as specified on the plans or directed by the Engineer. 206-2. BASIS OF PAYMENT The pay item for clearing and grubbing shall include: all removal and disposal of materials and structures as well as all materials, hauling, equipment, tools, labor, leveling of terrain, landscape trimming and all incidentals necessary to complete the work. 207. EROSION AND SEDIMENT CONTROL 207-1. GENERAL Erosion and sediment control shall conform to the requirements of the FDOT Standard Specifications for Prevention, Control, and Abatement of Erosion and Water Pollution. Contractor shall use temporary erosion and sediment control features found in the State of Florida Erosion and Sediment Control Designer and Reviewer Manual (E&SC Manual) or the city of Clearwater Standard Indices. Contractor shall prepare and submit a Stormwater Pollution Prevention Plan (SWPPP) and National Pollutant Discharge Elimination System (NPDES) permit in accordance with FDEP criteria for an NPDES construction activity permit. Visit www.dep.state.fl.us/water/stormwater/npdes for more information. Contractor shall obtain a FDEP generic permit for the discharge of produced groundwater. All soil erosion and sediment control measures shall be installed prior to disturbance and maintained through project completion. 207-2. TRAINING OF PERSONNEL The city may require that the Supervisor or Foreman controlling the work for the Contractor on the Project have a current FDEP Florida Stormwater, Erosion, and Sedimentation Control Inspector Training & Certification. All personnel working on the Project shall complete illicit discharge training once per calendar year. Contractor shall provide documentation to the city prior to Notice to Proceed (NTP). Example of training and training sign -in sheet will be provided by the city to the Contractor at the Pre - Construction Meeting. 207-3. STABILIZATION OF DENUDED AREAS No disturbed area may be denuded for more than thirty (30) calendar days unless otherwise authorized by the City Engineer. During construction, denuded areas shall be covered by mulches such as straw, hay, filter fabric, seed and mulch, sod, or some other temporary vegetation. Within sixty (60) calendar days after final grade is established on any portion of a project site, that portion of the site shall be provided with established permanent soil stabilization measures per the original site plan, whether by impervious surface or landscaping. SECTION IV Page 30 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications 207-4. PROTECTION AND STABILIZATION OF SOIL STOCKPILES Fill material stockpiles shall be protected at all times by on-site drainage controls which prevent erosion of the stockpiled material. Control of dust from such stockpiles may be required, depending upon their location and the expected length of time the stockpiles will be present. In no case shall an un -stabilized stockpile remain after thirty (30) calendar days. 207-5. PROTECTION OF EXISTING STORM SEWER SYSTEMS During construction, all storm sewer inlets in the vicinity of the project shall be protected by temporary erosion and sediment control features found in the State of Florida Erosion and Sediment Control Designer and Reviewer Manual (E&SC Manual) or the city of Clearwater Standard Indices, or equals approved by the City Engineer before installation. 207-6. SWALES, DITCHES AND CHANNELS All swales, ditches and channels leading from the site shall be sodded within three (3) days after finished grade is established. All other interior swales, etc., including detention areas will be sodded and maintained by the Contractor prior to issuance of a Certificate of Occupancy. 207-7. UNDERGROUND UTILITY CONSTRUCTION The construction of underground utility lines and other structures shall be done in accordance with the following standards: no more than 400 linear feet of trench shall be open at any one time; and, wherever consistent with safety and space consideration, excavated material shall be cast to the uphill side of trenches. Trench material shall not be cast into or onto the slope of any stream, channel, road ditch or waterway. No trench shall be open at the end of a workday, weekdays, or weekends. 207-8. MAINTENANCE All erosion and siltation control devices shall be checked daily by the Contractor, especially after each rainfall. The erosion and sedimentation control devices shall be cleaned out and/or repaired as required so sediment removal for the device does not exceed fifty (50) percent of its capacity. Contractor shall prepare and submit a Stormwater Pollution Prevention Plan (SWPPP) Construction Inspection Report on a weekly basis and within 24 hours of a storm that is 0.50 inches or greater. No additional payment will be made to the Contractor for the re-establishment of erosion control devices which may become damaged, destroyed, or otherwise rendered unsuitable for their intended function during the construction of the Project. Near completion of the project, after obtaining written approval by the Engineer, the Contractor shall dismantle and remove the temporary devices used for sediment control during construction. All erosion control devices in seeded areas shall be left in place until the grass is established. Seed areas around devices, and mulch after removing or filling temporary control devices. Cleanup all areas. 207-9. COMPLIANCE Failure to comply with the aforementioned requirements as determined by the city's project manager or inspector may result in a fine and/or more stringent enforcement procedures such as (but not limited to) issuance of a "Stop Work Order". SECTION IV Page 31 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV —Technical Specifications • 208. CONSTRUCTION AND REPAIR OF SEAWALLS AND OTHER BEACH EROSION CONTROL STRUCTURES • • 208-1. EXISTING SEAWALLS AND REVETMENTS Existing seawalls and revetments on natural water bodies may be replaced with a revetment or with a vertical seawall with the provision of rip rap placed at the base of the wall up to the mean high water line for the entire length of the seawall. Revetments and seawalls may be replaced with a vertical seawall in manmade water bodies, provided that the seawall is within the property line and maintains the established shoreline. 208-2. TOP OF CAP ELEVATION The top of cap elevation for all replacement and new seawalls and seawall caps shall not exceed 4.8 feet North American Vertical Datum (NAVD 88) If the top of a seawall cap is constructed at an elevation differing from the adjacent property owner top of cap elevation by greater than one foot, then a return wall is required to sufficiently provide for the break in grade at the property line. Seawalls exceeding 4.8 feet NAVD 88 in height prior to the effective date of this Section may be maintained, repaired, and replaced to their current height. 208-3. SEAWALLS AND REVETMENTS LOCATED SEAWARD OF THE CCL Seawalls and revetments located seaward of the coastal construction setback line are controlled by regulations of the Division of Beaches and Shores of the Florida Department of Environmental Protection. Replacement of a seawall or revetment that is located seaward of the coastal construction setback line necessitates submission of a permit application to the state department of environmental protection. 208-4. PLACEMENT OF NEW SEAWALL The placement of a new seawall waterward of an existing seawall is permitted, subject to the following conditions: A. A Florida registered professional engineer must certify the new seawall design. B. The new seawall shall not extend more than 18 inches from the waterward face of the original alignment of the existing vertical seawall location. C. The new seawall shall be placed vertically plumb. D. Placing a seawall in front of an existing seawall shall only be permitted once unless the seawall behind the new seawall is removed. E. Existing seawall sections that interfere with new seawall location shall be removed. F. The new seawall shall include an adequate closure of gaps at each property line. G. For zoning purposes, the setbacks for the property will be measured from either the property line or the waterside of the original seawall slab, whichever is more restrictive, and will not be adjusted to accommodate the new seawall addition. For purposes of pier construction, the shore normal dimensions will be measured from the waterside of the original seawall slab. SECTION IV Page 32 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications 208-5. POST CONSTRUCTION SURVEY Prior to final inspection and approval of a new or replacement seawall or seawall cap, a post -construction survey shall be required. Repairs of existing seawalls and seawall caps which do not alter the height or location shall not be subject to this requirement. 208-6. RIP -RAP On all -natural waterways, an apron of rip -rap shall be placed at the base of all new and repaired seawalls up to the mean high water line for the entire length of the seawall to absorb the wave energy and protect the underlying soft earth or sand from being carried away, as well as to provide habitat for desirable marine species. This rip -rap shall be required at the base of all new seawalls and at the time that an existing seawall is repaired where the replacement constitutes greater than 50 percent of the entire length of the seawall or includes the replacement of a panel. 208-7. RETAINING WALL IN LIEU OF VERTICAL SEAWALL A retaining wall may be built as an alternative to a vertical seawall, provided that all activities, including dredging, filling, slope grading, or equipment access and similar activities and all portions of the wall are located landward of the mean high water line. 209. MAINTENANCE OF OPERATIONS 209-1. GENERAL This Section sets forth the requirements for scheduling and performing the work to keep existing utilities in continuous, reliable operation. The Contractor shall furnish all labor, materials, equipment, and incidentals necessary to maintain existing utilities service during construction. Contractor shall also keep on hand adequate equipment, supplies, and incidentals to repair pipe breaks and to contain and dispose of all spilled materials. 209-2. EXECUTION A. Before any work begins, the Contractor shall submit for city review a Maintenance of Flow Plan. The Maintenance of Flow Plan shall include all procedures to be performed by the Contractor to maintain continuous operation of the city's existing utility services. The Plan shall also include emergency response and remedial action measures. Maintenance of Flow Plan: 1. The Contractor shall prepare a Maintenance of Flow Plan with two points of contact that describes in detail the work that will be performed by the Contractor to maintain continuous operation of the city's existing utility services. Maintenance of Flow Plan shall address the temporary and permanent flow diversion of utilities and other city facilities. 2. Temporary diversion of the utility flows shall be done using a minimum of two (2) bypass pumps (one duty, one standby) to pump from the upstream manhole to the downstream manhole. Bypass pumps shall have hospital grade sound attenuation. The Contractor shall obtain peak wet weather flow rates in the utility from the city and shall demonstrate in the Maintenance of Flow Plan that adequate pumping capacity is provided to accommodate peak wet weather flow. The Contractor and city personnel that are experienced in the SECTION IV Page 33 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 • SECTION IV —Technical Specifications collection system shall determine the float levels in the field, pump on, standby or lag pump on, and high-level alarm. The Contractor shall have full responsibility for the operation and management of the temporary diversion/ bypass. The high-level alarm shall be connected to an auto dialer or remote monitoring system to notify the Contractor of an alarm condition. The bypass pump suction manhole shall use the collection system for a temporary wet well storage; however, surcharging in the existing utility system shall be limited. Once the high-level float alarm is triggered, it shall allow enough time for emergency Contractor personnel to arrive on scene and resolve the problem prior to any utility overflows. The bypass suction and discharge pipes may require the removal of the manhole tops which will result in excess odor escaping from the manholes. The Contractor shall provide a means to seal odors within the bypass manholes to minimize odors during the temporary diversion. 3. The Maintenance of Flow Plan shall include a sequence of construction with projected time, in days, for each step in the sequence. 4. If the work required to maintain utility operation must occur during evening, night or weekend hours, the Contractor shall notify the affected residents in advance of the projected work. The Contractor shall reimburse the city for overtime work, including inspector overtime, in excess of regular working hours. The Contractor must also get permission from city Project Manager before working outside of Noise Ordinance hours. 5. Identify the person(s) responsible for executing the Maintenance of Flow Plan and the systems to be put in place for monitoring the existing utility system's ability to maintain flow. B. All utility relocation work shall be completed prior to construction. The Contractor shall familiarize himself with the site, including the locations, sizes, and conditions of the existing utilities in and around the work zones where relocation of existing utilities is required. The location of storm sewer inlets, drainage swales, and runoff patterns should be identified, and a Plan developed to contain potential releases. C. The Contractor shall carry out his operations in accordance with all applicable OSHA regulations, including confined space entry requirements, as well as local, city, and state requirements, and in accordance with the approved MOT plan. In addition, the Contractor shall protect the public from harm while performing the work by using barricades, warning lights and other means as necessary. D. The Contractor shall keep existing utilities in service during all phases of construction and coordinate any system shutdowns with the city sufficiently in advance to provide alternative service. The Contractor shall provide a minimum of 10 days' notice. Contractor shall protect the city's utility system for any spills or overflows during construction. The city's Project Manager and Dispatch (727-462-6633) shall be notified of any spills or overflows immediately. E. Any temporary work, facilities, roads, walks, protection of existing structures, piping, blind flanges, valves, equipment, etc. that may be required shall be furnished and maintained by the Contractor. The cost shall be included in the appropriate bid items. F. The Contractor shall schedule the work in such a manner so that all existing utility systems are maintained in continuous operation. All short-term or partial utility system shutdowns shall be approved in writing by the city. If, in the opinion of the city, a shutdown is not required in order for the Contractor to perform the work, the Contractor shall utilize alternative methods to accomplish the work. The city shall be provided a minimum of ten (10) business days' notice of Contractor's need for any existing utility system shutdown or if there is a need of assistance from the Public Utilities Department. Contractor must also provide the city with at least two (2) business days' notice before Contractor is allowed to work at city facilities. G. Required shutdowns shall not begin until all materials are on -hand, pre -assembled, as possible, and ready for installation. Upon commencement of the shutdown period, the Contractor shall proceed with the work continuously, start to finish, until the work is completed, and the system is tested, cleared for service, and ready for operation. If the Contractor completes all required work before SECTION IV Page 34 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications the specified shutdown period has ended, the city may immediately place the system back in service. H. The city shall have the sole authority to prohibit or order work stopped. The city reserves the right to cancel scheduled shutdowns if conditions warrant. Delays to the Contractor caused by cancellations will be considered in evaluating requests for a time extension. They will not be considered an entitlement to additional compensation. However, compensation may be considered at city's sole discretion. I. During inclement weather, all work which might be damaged or rendered inferior by such weather conditions shall be suspended. The orders and decisions of the city as to suspensions shall be final and binding. During suspension of the work from any cause, the work shall be suitably covered and protected to preserve it from injury by the weather or otherwise, if the city shall so direct surplus materials shall be removed. Contractor shall protect the city's utility system from inflow during inclement weather during the construction. J. The Contractor shall submit a Critical Path Method (CPM) work schedule at the pre -construction meeting showing all critical items of work and anticipated shut down times. Note that no activity will be allowed until the CPM is approved by the city or the Engineer of Record (EOR). K. Contractor must submit a detailed schedule and process description for proposed testing. Training of all new equipment must be videotaped including two weeks of training prior to startup. If there are multiple sites under the same contract each site startup shall occur as soon as it is complete. If there are multiple shifts at any site(s) where city staff require training, Contractor shall hold multiple trainings convenient for each shift. L. Required shutdowns shall not begin until all materials are on -hand, pre -assembled to the extent possible, and ready for installation. Upon commencement of the shutdown period, the Contractor shall proceed with the work continuously, start to finish, until the work is completed, and the system is tested, cleared for service, and ready for operation. If the Contractor completes all required work before the specified shutdown period has ended, the city may immediately place the system back in service. 209-3. BASIS OF MEASUREMENT There shall be no separate measurement and payment for this task. 210. DETECTION OF FACILITIES The locations of all existing underground piping, structures, and other facilities are shown based on information received from the respective owner. The locations are shown without express or implied representation, assurance, or guarantee that they are complete, correct, or a represent a true picture of the actual underground facilities to be encountered. It is the Contractor's responsibility to verify the correct location and sizing of all utilities (including connection points). All appropriate utility companies and agencies shall be contacted 72 hours prior to excavation. Call "One Call"/ "Sunshine 811" at 8-1-1; "Sunshine 811" administrative offices may be reached at (800) 638-4097. The Contractor shall at all times employ acceptable methods and exercise reasonable care and skill so as to avoid unnecessary delay, injury, damage, or destruction of existing utilities or cause interference. The Contractor shall conduct exploratory excavations as necessary for the purpose of locating underground pipelines, structures, and utilities in advance of construction. Test pits shall be excavated in areas of potential conflicts between existing and proposed facilities and at piping connections to existing facilities a minimum of 48 hours and 1000 ft in advance of work. If there is a potential conflict, the Contractor shall notify the Owner and Engineer immediately and provide as much information as possible including but not SECTION IV Page 35 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications • limited to location, elevation, utility type, material, and size. Test pits shall be backfilled immediately after their purpose has been satisfied. There shall be no additional compensation for exploratory excavations. • • 211. RELOCATIONS 211-1. RELOCATION SHOWN ON DRAWINGS Relocations shown on the Drawings: Public utility installations or structures, including but not limited to poles, signs, fences, piping, conduits and drains that interfere with the positioning of the work which are shown on the Drawings to be removed, relocated, replaced or rebuilt by the Contractor shall be considered as part of the general cost of doing the Work and shall be included in the prices bid for the various contract items. No separate payment shall be made, therefore. All existing castings, including valve boxes, junction boxes, manholes, hand holes, pull boxes, inlets and similar structures in the areas of construction that are to remain in service and in areas of trench restoration and pavement replacement, shall be adjusted by the Contractor to bring them flush with the surface of the finished work. All existing utility systems which conflict with the construction of the work herein, which can be temporarily removed and replaced, shall be accomplished at the expense of the Contractor. Work shall be done by the utility unless the utility approves in writing that the Work may be done by the Contractor. 211-2. RELOCATIONS NOT SHOWN ON DRAWINGS Where public utility installations or structures are encountered during the course of work, and are not indicated on the Drawings or in the specifications, and when in the opinion of the city, removal, relocation, replacement, or rebuilding is necessary to complete the work, such work shall be accomplished by the utility having jurisdiction or such work may be requested in writing by the city for the Contractor to perform and fairly compensated once work is complete. If such work is accomplished by the utility having jurisdiction, it will be carried out expeditiously and the Contractor shall give full cooperation to permit the utility to complete the removal, relocation, replacement, or rebuilding as necessary. 212. RESTORATION PROCEDURES 212-1. INTERIM RESTORATION All excavations shall be backfilled and compacted as specified by the city and Engineer at the end of each working day. For excavations within existing paved areas, the limerock base or soil cement base shall be spread and compacted to provide a smooth surface free of aggregate material. The Contractor shall keep the site accessible to the city Staff at all times for the purpose of operating and maintaining the existing facility during construction. All pipe and fittings shall be neatly stored in a location, which will cause the least disturbance to the public. All debris shall be removed and properly disposed of by the end of each working day. 212-2. FINAL RESTORATION After completing all installations, pressure testing, bacteriological testing, and associated work, final restoration shall be performed. In no event shall final restoration begin after substantial completion. Any SECTION IV Page 36 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications additional restoration required after testing shall be repaired in a timely manner at no additional cost to the city. Maintenance of all restored facilities shall be the Contractor's responsibility. This maintenance shall be performed on an on-going basis during the course of construction. The Contractor's Progress Schedule shall reflect the above restoration requirements. SECTION IV Page 37 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications • 300 SERIES: MATERIALS • • 301. CONCRETE The Contractor shall notify the Construction Inspector a minimum of twenty-four (24) hours in advance of all concrete placements. Contact Building Inspectors from the city Planning Department if building a structure is required. The Contractor shall give Building Inspectors a minimum of 48 hours in advance to inspect. Unless otherwise noted elsewhere or directed, the following requirements shall be adhered to: All concrete work shall be performed in accordance with the latest editions of the Design and Control of Concrete Mixtures by the Portland Cement Association, the American Concrete Institute, and FDOT's Standard Specifications. Unless otherwise specified, all concrete shall have fiber mesh reinforcing and have a minimum compressive strength of 3000 psi at twenty-eight (28) days. The cement type shall be Type I and shall conform to AASHTO M85 latest edition. The aggregate shall conform to ASTM C33 or latest current edition. All ready -mix concrete shall conform to ASTM C94 or latest edition. The slump for all concrete shall be in the range of three inches (3") to five inches (5"), except when admixtures or special placement considerations are required. All concrete shall be tested in the following manner: Placement of less than five cubic yards (5 cy) shall be tested at the Engineer's discretion. Otherwise, for each class, for each day, for every fifty cubic yards (50 cy) or part thereof exceeding five cubic yards (5 cy), one set of three (3) compressive strength cylinders will be required (1 at 7 days and 2 at 28 days). At the discretion of the Engineer, unacceptable test results may require the Contractor to provide further tests, as determined by the Engineer, to determine product acceptability, or need for removal, and compensation or denial thereof. 302. EXCAVATION AND FORMS FOR CONCRETE WORK 302-1. EXCAVATION Excavating for concrete work shall be made to the required depth of the subgrade or base upon which the concrete is to be placed. The base or subgrade shall be thoroughly compacted to a point six inches (6") outside said concrete work before the forms are placed. 302-2. FORMS Forms for concrete work shall be either wood or metal, except curbs. Curb forms shall be metal only, unless at radius, intermittent sections less than ten (10) linear feet or with written permission from the Engineer. The forms shall be free from warps or bends, shall have a depth equal to the dimensions required for the depth of the concrete deposited against them and shall be of sufficient strength when staked to resist the pressure of concrete without moving or springing. 303. REINFORCEMENT When required, reinforcement shall be placed in the concrete work. Reinforcement deformation shall be performed as per ASTM A615 Standard Specification for Deformed and Plain Carbon -Steel Bars for Concrete Reinforcement or latest edition. Reinforcement steel grades shall be billet intermediate or hard. Twisted Bars shall not be used, Fabric Reinforcement shall conform to the requirements of ASTM A1064 SECTION IV Page 38 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications or latest edition that is relevant. Welded deformed steel wire fabric for Concrete reinforcement shall meet the requirements of AASHTO M 221 (ASTM A1064) or latest edition that is relevant. Welded wires shall be elevated with the use of chairs. Epoxy coated reinforcing Steel Bars shall meet ASTM A775/A77 requirements or latest edition. 303-1. BASIS OF PAYMENT Reinforcement shall not be paid for separately. The cost of such work shall be included in the contract unit price for the item of work specified. 304. BACKFILL 304-1. MATERIALS AND GENERAL Material for backfill other than under Gabion mattresses shall be carefully selected from the excavated material or from other sources as may be required by the Engineer. Such material shall be granular, free from any deleterious material including but not limited to clay, muck, organic matter or debris, contain no rocks or other hard fragments greater than three inches (3") in the largest dimension and all fill shall be similar material. Material for backfill under Gabion mattresses shall be an A-1 soil meeting AASHTO M145 (latest edition). Backfill shall be carried up evenly in layers not exceeding eight inches (8") in thickness and shall be compacted into place by mechanical tamping to 98% before the next layer is applied. A hydro -hammer shall not be used for compaction. Backfill placed around pipes shall be carefully placed below the pipe haunch, around the sides, and top of pipe by hand shovels and thoroughly compacted to twelve inches (12") above the pipe by tamping or other suitable means. For backfill in small areas that do not permit any type of tamping, Contractor may use flowable fill to achieve required density. Refer to Section 306 for more details on flowable fill. Where wet conditions are such that dewatering by normal pumping methods would not be effective, as determined by the Engineer, Contractor may use #57 stone (meeting FDOT's specifications) and hand tamping until backfill has reached an elevation and condition such as to make the use of the mechanical tampers practical. Fully wrap the stones with a layer of Type D filter fabric of FDOT Index 199 (latest edition). Do not place stones within four feet (4') of the ends of trench or ditch; use normally accepted backfill material at the ends. Where new cast -in-place concrete work is performed, do not place backfill until the specified twenty-eight (28) days compressive strength occurs. Heavy construction equipment shall not be permitted to cross over pipes or culverts until placing and compacting backfill material to the finished earthwork grade or to an elevation of at least four feet (4') above the top of the pipe or culvert. The cost of backfill, flowable fill, alternative approved material for wet conditions, and extra dewatering effort to achieve required density, etc., shall be included in the contract unit price or lump sum price for the item of the work specified. 304-2. TESTING AND INSPECTION Contractor shall employ and pay for the services of an independent testing laboratory, approved by the Engineer, to perform density testing on backfilled material. All testing shall be witnessed by the Engineer's Representative. The test shall be repeated until satisfactory results are obtained. The Contractor shall be charged for all retests and re -inspection services. SECTION IV Page 39 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 • • • SECTION IV — Technical Specifications Backfill under all types of pavement areas shall be compacted in layers not to exceed 6" in thickness unless an alternate method is approved by the Engineer. Backfill shall be a minimum of 98% compaction as determined by AASHTO T 180 - Modified Proctor Density Test (latest edition) to the bottom of pavement. Backfill outside of pavement areas shall be compacted to the full depth to the ground surface to a minimum of 95% compaction as determined by AASHTO T 180 - Modified Proctor Density Test (latest edition). Backfill under buried structures shall be in accordance with these specifications to prevent future subsidence. Backfill Testing: The Contractor shall demonstrate the adequacy of backfill compaction by performing density testing. For each test location, density testing shall be performed at six-inch (6") lifts. The character of the backfill material will be observed during the excavation for density testing to determine conformance with the specifications. Density testing shall be performed using nuclear field density equipment or conventional weight -volume methods. If the weight -volume method is used, volume shall be determined by using the sand replacement test (ASTM D1556/ D1556M the latest edition) or liquid displacement methods (ASTM D2167 latest edition). If nuclear methods are used, the trench correction effect shall be accounted for by recalibrating the nuclear gauge on its calibration block at the location of each test prior to taking the density measurement. The Contractor shall furnish all equipment, tools, and labor to prepare the test site for testing. Normal Testing Frequency: One test shall be performed for each one hundred feet (100') of backfill or fraction thereof or for each single run of pipe/culvert connecting two (2) successive structures whichever is less. The location of the test within each section shall be selected by the Engineer's Representative. Testing shall progress as each one hundred -foot (100') section is completed. Four (4) tests equally spaced around each structure shall be performed on each six-inch (6") lift. Testing which indicates that unacceptable material has been incorporated into the backfill, or that insufficient compaction is being obtained shall be followed by expanded testing to determine the limits of the unacceptable backfill. Expanded Testing Requirements: If normal testing within a testing section indicates unacceptable backfill, the Engineer's Representative may require additional testing within the same test section to determine the limits of unacceptable backfill. Additional testing required by the Engineer's Representative shall be paid for by the Contractor and shall not exceed testing of four (4) additional locations within the test section. Unacceptable backfill within the limits established by the testing shall be removed and replaced by the Contractor at no additional cost to the city. Additional testing beyond that required may be performed by the Contractor at his expense to further delineate limits of unacceptable backfill. 305. RIPRAP The work included in this specification includes the construction of riprap as shown on the plans. The riprap shall be constructed per Section 530 of FDOT's Standard Specifications (latest edition). 305-1. BASIS OF MEASUREMENT The basis of measurement for riprap will be weight, in tons, in surface dry natural state. The scales must be calibrated and certified by an independent party and carry a state certification. 305-2. BASIS OF PAYMENT The pay item for sand -cement riprap shall include: all materials, testing, labor, grout, hauling, equipment, excavation, backfill, dressing and shaping for placement of sand -cement and all incidentals necessary to complete the work. SECTION IV Page 40 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications The pay item for rubble riprap shall include: all materials, required bedding stone, dressing and shaping for placement of bedding stone, filter fabric, testing, hauling, excavating, backfill, dressing and shaping for placement of rubble, and all incidentals necessary to complete the work. No payment will be granted if concrete or stone that exists on-site is used as rubble riprap. 306. FLOWABLE FILL Flowable fill is used in backfill and to fill all abandoned pipelines that are not removed. Mains that need to be abandoned shall be cut, capped, and filled with flowable fill meeting the requirements specified herein. Flowable fill shall adhere to Section 121 of FDOT specifications (latest edition). The Contractor shall be responsible for producing a flowable mixture using these guidelines and adjusting his mixture design as called for by circumstances or as may be directed by the Engineer. General mix requirements are as follows: Components Excavatable Non Excavatable Cellular Concrete Cement (lb/yd3) 75-100 75-150 Min 150 Supplementary Cementitious Materials (lb/yd3) None 150-600 Fine Aggregate * * * Water ** ** ** Air 5-35% 5-15% *** Unit Weight (lb/ft3) 90-110 100-125 20-80 28 Day Compressive Strength **** **** **** * Fine aggregate shall be proportioned to yield 1 cubic yard (yd3). ** Mix design shall produce a consistency that will result in a flowable self -leveling product at the time of placement *** In cellular concrete, preformed foam shall be proportioned at the jobsite to yield 1 cubic yard in accordance with design requirements **** The requirements for percent air, compressive strength, and unit weight are for laboratory designs only and are not intended for jobsite acceptance requirements Weights for fine aggregate and water shall be adjusted according to cementitious content. The mix proportions shall be adjusted for removability, pumpability and flowability. If required, strength test data shall be provided prior to batching. If required by the Engineer, the flowability can be measured by afflux time determined in accordance with ASTM C939/ C939M — 16a (latest edition) and shall be 30 seconds +/- 5 seconds as measured on mortar passing the No. 4 sieve. The equipment required to perform this test shall be provided by the Contractor. The Contractor shall flush all raw sewage, sludge, debris, and water from the force mains prior to filling pipeline with flowable fill. If not discharged into a sanitary sewer system, the Contractor shall collect all flushing water and dispose of at a wastewater treatment facility. City Public Utilities Department IPP Coordinator and Director and/or Assistant Director must approve of the discharge into the collection system or wastewater treatment plant. The Contractor must locate and verify all connections of the piping before filling the pipeline with flowable fill to avoid redirection and reconnection and report them to the Engineer. During placement of fill, compensate for irregularities in sewer pipe, such as obstructions, open joints, or broken pipe to ensure no voids remain unfilled. SECTION IV Page 41 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 • SECTION IV —Technical Specifications Clean placement areas of sewer and water lines of debris that may hinder fill placement. Remove excessive amounts of sludge and other substances that may degrade performance of fill. Remove free water prior to starting fill placement. All proposed new force mains shall be installed, pressure tested, and placed in-service prior to abandoning the existing force mains. All pipes shall be abandoned in a manner which results in the abandoned pipeline not being pressurized. Flowable fill shall be produced and delivered using concrete construction equipment. Placing flowable fill shall be by chute, pumping or other methods approved by the Engineer. The flowable fill shall be placed to the designated fill line without vibration or other means of compaction. Placement shall be avoided during inclement weather, e.g. rain or ambient temperatures below 40°F. The Contractor shall take all necessary precautions to prevent any damages caused by the hydraulic pressure of the fill during placement prior to hardening. Also, necessary means to confine the materials within the designated space shall be provided by the Contractor. During placement of the fill, the Contractor is to avoid construction stoppage that would exceed the working time of the fill. If for any case that the fill would harden, the Contractor is responsible for properly installing fill into the abandoned pipeline from another location and shall meet the requirements specified herein. A city Engineering Department Representative shall be present to witness the placement of flowable fill in abandoned pipelines. A 48-hour notice shall be given to the city before the placement of fill. The flowable fill shall be proportioned and placed as specified herein. In general, the strength desired is the maximum hardness that can be excavated at a later date using conventional excavating equipment. No curing protection is required. The fill shall be left undisturbed until material obtains sufficient strength. Sufficient strength is a minimum of 150 psi penetration resistance as measured using a handheld penetrometer. The penetrometer shall be provided by the Contractor. All flowable fill areas subjected to traffic loads must have a durable riding surface. Payment of the applicable lump sum price shall be full compensation for furnishing all labor, materials and equipment necessary and will include, but is not limited to the necessary costs associated with the installation of the flowable fill as shown in the Drawings and as described in the Contract Documents. 307. MATERIAL INDEPENDENT TESTING The city shall have the right to have an independent testing laboratory select, test, and analyze, at the expense of the city, test specimens of any or all materials to be used. The results of such tests and analyses shall be considered, along with the tests or analyses made by the Contractor, to determine compliance with the applicable specifications for the materials so tested or analyzed. The Contractor hereby understands and accepts that wherever any portion of the work is discovered, as a result of such independent testing or investigation by the city, which fails to meet the requirements of the Contract documents, all costs of such independent inspection and investigation as well as all costs of removal, correction, reconstruction, or repair of any such work shall be borne solely by the Contractor. SECTION IV Page 42 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications 400 SERIES: SANITARY SEWER 401. SANITARY MANHOLES 401-1. BUILT UP TYPE Manholes shall be constructed of brick with cast iron frames and covers as shown on the drawings. Invert channels shall be constructed smooth and semicircular in shape conforming to the inside of the adjacent sewer section. Changes in direction of flow shall be made in a smooth curve of as large a radius as possible. Changes in size and grade of channels shall be made gradually and evenly. Invert channels shall be formed by one of the following methods: formed directly into concrete manhole base, build up with brick and mortar, or lay half tile in concrete. For invert channels formed using the brick and mortar, or the half tile in concrete approaches the entire bench and channel area will be coated with a minimum of one-half inch of Xypex Megamix II or approved equal. The manhole floor outside of channels shall be made smooth and sloped toward channels. Free drop in manholes from inlet pipe invert to top of floor outside the channels shall not exceed 12 inches (12"). Standard Drop Manholes shall be constructed wherever free drop exceeds twelve inches (12"). Doghouse manholes and flat top manholes are not permitted. If a drop manhole is needed, only outside drop manholes allowed. Manhole steps shall not be provided. Joints shall be completely filled with mortar, shall be smoothed from inside of manholes. The entire interior and exterior of brick manholes shall be plastered with one half inch (1/2") of Mega Mix II with Bio San as supplied by Xypex or approved equal. Brick used may be solid only. Brick shall be laid radially with every sixth course being a stretcher course. Maintenance of Flow Plan: 1. The Contractor shall prepare a Maintenance of Flow Plan that describes in detail the work that will be performed by the Contractor to maintain continuous operation of the city's existing utility services. Maintenance of Flow Plan shall address the temporary and permanent flow diversion of gravity sewers and service laterals. 2. Temporary diversion of the gravity sewer flows shall be done using bypass pumps (one duty, one standby) to pump from the upstream manhole to the downstream manhole. Bypass pumps shall have hospital grade sound attenuation. The Contractor shall obtain peak wet weather flow rates in the gravity sewer from the city and shall demonstrate in the Maintenance of Flow Plan that adequate pumping capacity is provided to accommodate peak wet weather flow. The Contractor and city personnel that are experienced in the collection system shall determine the float levels in the field, pump on, standby or lag pump on, and high-level alarm. The high-level alarm shall be connected to an auto dialer to notify the Contractor of an alarm condition. The bypass pump suction manhole shall use the collection system for a temporary wet well storage; however, surcharging in the existing sewer system shall be limited. Once the high-level float alarm is triggered, it shall allow enough time for emergency Contractor personnel to arrive on scene and resolve the problem prior to any sanitary sewer overflows. The bypass suction and discharge pipes may require the removal of the manhole tops which will result in excess odor escaping from the manholes. The contractor shall provide a means to seal odors within the bypass manholes to minimize odors during the temporary diversion. 3. The Maintenance of Flow Plan shall include a sequence of construction with projected time, in days, for each step in the sequence. SECTION IV Page 43 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 • • • SECTION IV — Technical Specifications 4. If the work required to maintain utility operation must occur during evening, night or weekend hours, the Contractor shall notify the affected residents in advance of the projected work. The Contractor shall reimburse the city for overtime work, including inspector overtime, in excess of regular working hours. The Contractor must also get permission from city Project Manager before working outside of Noise Ordinance hours. 5. Identify the person(s) responsible for executing the Maintenance of Flow Plan and the systems to be put in place for monitoring the existing utility system's ability to maintain flow. 401-2. PRECAST TYPE Precast Sanitary Manholes shall conform to this specification unless otherwise approved by the City Engineer. AASHTO M 85 Type II cement, with Xypex Admix C -1000R or approved equal, shall be used throughout with a minimum wall thickness of five inches (5"). The precast sections shall conform to ASTM C478 (latest edition). Section joints shall be a tongue and groove with "ram neck" gasket, Pro Stik Butyl Sealant or "0" ring to provide a watertight joint. Caulking of joint shall not be allowed. Minimum concrete strength shall be 4000 psi at 28 days. Xypex admixture must be added to the concrete at the time of batching. Under normal conditions, the crystalline powder shall be added to the concrete mix at the following rates: 1. Xypex Admix C -1000R 3.5 % by weight of cement content Note: For enhanced chemical protection or for meeting specific project requirements or where the concrete mix design contains higher than 25% type F fly ash content or includes a Portland cement/slag cement/type C fly ash blend, consult with manufacturer or its authorized representative to determine appropriate dosage rates. One set of shop drawings and location inventory shall be submitted to the city Project Manager and Engineer of Record for approval. Approval of shop drawings does not relieve Contractor of responsibility for compliance to these specifications unless letter from Contractor requesting specific variance is approved by the City Engineer. Location inventory submitted with shop drawing shall detail parts of manhole per manhole as numbered on the construction plans. All manhole parts shall be numbered or lettered before being sent to the job site to permit proper construction placement. A plan or list of the numbering system shall be present on the job site when manhole components are delivered. Precast manhole dimensions, drop entry, grout flow of channel, etc., shall be as shown on city of Clearwater Engineering Index 302 Sheets. Manhole sections shall be rejected if abused during shipping or placement and if pipe openings are not properly aligned. The "break in" to precast manholes for pipe entry will not be allowed. The manhole base shall be set on a pad of A 1 or A 2 Classification compacted soil approximately five inches (5") thick as referenced in Section 304-2 and twelve inches (12") of # 57 grade stone, wrapped in geotextile to secure proper seating and bearing. Refer to these Technical Specifications, Section 304 for backfill and compaction requirements. 401-2.1. MANHOLE ADJUSTMENT RINGS (GRADE RINGS) Between the top of the manhole cone/corbel and the manhole cover frame, a manhole adjustment ring shall be installed. The intent of the manhole adjustment ring is to accommodate future grade changes without disturbing the manhole. See Section IV, Section 703-7, Asphaltic Concrete — Adjustment of Manholes. All final grade adjustment of manhole covers, and frame assemblies shall be completed utilizing injection molded high density polyethylene (HDPE) adjustment rings as manufactured by LADTECH, Inc. or an approved equal. The adjustment rings shall be manufactured from polyethylene plastic as identified in ASTM Specification D4976 (Standard Specification for Polyethylene Plastic Molding and Extrusion SECTION IV Page 44 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications Materials) the latest edition. Material properties shall be tested and qualified for usage per the ASTM Test Methods referenced in the above ASTM standard. The adjustment rings shall be molded from 100% recycled material. The plastic rings shall be manufactured utilizing the injection molding process as defined by SPE (Society of Plastic Engineers). The adjustment rings shall be tested to assure compliance with impact and loading requirements per the AASHTO Standard Specification for Highway Bridges latest edition. Installation shall be per manufacture's recommendations for vacuum test installations only. The annular space between the rings and cone basin, the rings, and the rings and cover frame shall be sealed utilizing an approved butyl rope (not caulk) sealant. All adjustment for matching road grade shall be made utilizing a molded and indexed slope ring. All grade rings shall be covered by the LADTECH, Inc. warranty or one of equal terms and duration. Grade rings shall be Traffic Rated AASHTO HS -20 (latest edition). 401-2.2. STAINLESS STEEL MANHOLE STORM WATER INFLOW ABATEMENT INSERTS (DISH/PAN) 401-2.2.1. MATERIALS AND DESIGN General: The insert, gasket and relief valve shall be manufactured of materials resistant to corrosion from atmospheres containing hydrogen sulfide and dilute sulfuric acid. Insert: The insert body shall be manufactured of 304 stainless steel with a thickness of not less than 18 gauge. The insert shall have straight sides designed to allow a loose fit into the ring for easy removal. The insert manufacturer must furnish a "load test verification" showing a load test failure in excess of 3000 lbs. For added strength, no less than three (3) ribs shall be stamped in bottom of the insert. Gasket: The gasket shall be extruded onto the stainless dish with a Synthetic elastomer having the following physical properties: • Tensile Strength: 335 psi - ASTM D412 Elongation 400-600% - ASTM D412 Shore Hardness: 25 Shore A - ASTM D2240 Adhesion to Stainless: 580 psi - ASTM D454 l/D7234 (Use latest edition) Relief Valve: The gas relief valve shall be designed to release at a pressure of .5 to 1.5 PSI and have a water leak down rate no greater than 5 gallons per 24 hours. The valve shall be installed in the insert by means of a hole tapped in the insert by the manufacturer. The valve shall be made of nitrite for prevention of corrosion from contact with hydrogen sulfide, dilute sulfuric acid and other gases associated with waste- water collections systems. Handle: The dish shall have a handle of 3/16" plastic -coated stainless-steel cable installed on the body of the dish. The handle shall be attached with a #6 high-grade stainless-steel rivet. The cable shall be braided in a manner which resists cutting with common bolt cutters. The cable terminal and eye shall be stainless steel. • Manhole Frames: Manhole frame sizes vary, and the city will provide the successful bidder with specific dimensions and number of required inserts for each manhole frame size. Maximum insert outside diameter (OD) will not exceed 26.5 inches nor be less than 23 inches. Most frames have an outside diameter of 23.5 inches with a clear opening of 21.5 inches. 401-2.2.2. MEASUREMENT AND PAYMENT Payment of each inflow abatement insert shall be full compensation for furnishing all labor, materials and equipment necessary but not limited to the costs associated for the installation of the sanitary manholes' pans/dishes. SECTION IV Page 45 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 • SECTION IV — Technical Specifications • 401-3. DROP MANHOLES Standard drop inlets to manholes shall be constructed of commercial pipe, fittings, and specials as detailed on the drawings. Only outside drop manholes allowed. • • 401-4. FRAMES AND COVERS Manhole frames and covers shall be set in a full bed of mortar with the top of the cover flush with or higher than finished grade as directed. Refer to Clearwater Standard Detail Index 301. 401-5. MANHOLE COATINGS The exterior of all precast manholes shall not require any specific coating. The interior shall be coated with either Spraywall®, Polyurethane or Raven 405 Epoxy at the direction of the city at a thickness not less than 125 mil. For new manholes install geotextile wrap at the joints. 401-6. CONNECTIONS TO MANHOLES Connections to existing sanitary manholes using approved PVC sewer main shall be made with a manhole adapter coupling by NPC Kor-N-Seal® with stainless steel bands or approved equal water stop coupling. 401-7. MEASUREMENT AND PAYMENT Payment of each inflow abatement insert shall be full compensation for furnishing all labor, materials, and equipment necessary but not limited to the costs associated for the installation of the sanitary manholes. 402. RAISING OR LOWERING OF SANITARY SEWER STRUCTURES Sanitary Sewer Structures shall be raised or lowered as indicated on the plans or as indicated by the Engineer. 402-1. BASIS OF PAYMENT Payment, unless covered by a bid item, shall be included in the cost of the work. 403. SANITARY SEWERS AND FORCE MAINS 403-1. MATERIALS 403-1.1. GRAVITY SEWER PIPE GRAVITY SEWER PIPE SHALL BE POLYVINYL CHLORIDE OR DUCTILE IRON. All polyvinyl chloride mains (pipe and fittings) shall be at least 6 -inch -diameter, SDR 26, and conform to ASTM D3034; laterals can be four -inch (4") PVC schedule 40. Pipe and fittings shall be plainly marked with the ASTM designation. Strong back stainless steel Fernco is required for all non-mechanical PVC connections. The bell end of joints and fittings shall have a rubber sealing ring to provide a tight flexible seal in conformance with ASTM D3212 (latest edition). The laying length of pipe joints shall be a maximum of twenty feet (20'). SECTION IV Page 46 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications Unless otherwise noted in these specifications or the construction plans, ductile iron pipe and fittings for gravity sewer shall conform to Section 502-2.1. of these Technical Specifications for DIP water main except the pipe interior shall be lined with Protecto 401 ceramic epoxy in accordance with manufacturer's recommendations. Where sanitary sewer main is to be placed between buildings lots in a sideline easement, the sewer main shall, insofar as possible, be constructed without manholes or lateral connections within the side easement. A two-way cleanout shall be installed on each lateral at the property line. 403-1.2. FORCE MAIN PIPE FORCE MAIN PIPE SHALL BE POLYVINYL CHLORIDE, DUCTILE IRON OR HDPE. Unless otherwise noted in the specifications or construction plans, polyvinyl chloride, ductile iron and HDPE force main pipe and fittings shall conform to Section 502-2.1 and 502-2.2 of these Technical Specifications for water main pipe except that DIP shall be lined with Protecto 401 ceramic epoxy in accordance with manufacturer's recommendations. All polyvinyl chloride pipe which has become deteriorated due to exposure to ultraviolet radiation shall be rejected. 403-2. INSTALLATION 403-2.1. GRAVITY SEWER PIPE Installation of Thermoplastic gravity sewer pipe shall be in conformance with recommended practices contained in ASTM D2321 (latest edition). The bottom trench width in an unsupported trench shall be limited to the minimum practicable width (typically pipe OD plus eight inches (8") to twelve inches (12") on each side) allowing working space to place and compact the haunching material. The use of trench boxes and movable sheeting shall be performed in such a manner that removal, backfill and compaction will not disturb compacted haunching material or pipe alignment. Dewatering of the trench bottom shall be accomplished using adequate means to allow preparation of bedding, placement of the haunching material and placement of the pipe in the trench without standing water. Dewatering shall continue until sufficient backfill is placed above the pipe to prevent flotation or misalignment. Where pipe bedding is insufficient to adequately support the pipe, the Contractor will be required to remove unsuitable material and pipe bedding and replace with Class I material (one half inch (1/2") diameter aggregate) to provide firm support of the pipe. The laterals shown on the plans do not necessarily reflect exact locations. The Contractor is required to locate all existing laterals for reconnection and to coordinate with the construction inspector, the location of all new laterals. 403-2.2. FORCE MAIN PIPE Installation of force main pipe shall be in conformance with Section 503 of these Technical Specifications for water main pipe. 403-3. INSPECTIONS OF LINES AND MANHOLES A. Inspection of completed lines and manholes shall be scheduled within a reasonable time after construction or when required by the Engineer. Before scheduling an inspection, the Contractor shall prepare the lines by cleaning and flushing. Manholes shall be clean, finished, and free of leaks. B. Manholes shall be on a true and uniform grade. The inverts shall have a smooth steel troweled finish. All benches shall be uniformly sloping. The frames shall be tight and properly set in mortar SECTION IV Page 47 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 • • • SECTION IV — Technical Specifications on solid masonry. The invert, benches and adjacent pipe shall be free of splattered mortar. All required interior lining or paint shall be kept intact. Manhole frames shall be adjusted to grade with the covers and frames cleaned and free of mortar and asphaltic mixtures. All precast manhole seams shall be filled with an approved asphaltic compound. C. Pipe between manholes shall be true to line and grade. Dips and sags with one inch or more of trapped water shall be cause for rejection. Air testing may be required also at the Contractor's expense. Contractor shall provide personnel to assist with inspections. D. The Contractor shall provide city Public Utilities Department and the Engineer with a Television Inspection of the completed gravity sewers in accordance with the following: 1. Shall be performed by a National Association of Sewer Service Companies (NASSCO) Pipeline Assessment & Certification Program (PACP) Certified Operator who will use software that is compatible with CUES Granite products latest version software to NASSCO PACP Standards. 2. Shall be submitted as digital media that includes video and data base file in PACP format and include a printed copy of the PACP television inspection log. 3. Shall perform a manhole inspection and provide a completed NASSCO Manhole Inspection form (latest version) for each manhole that is inspected 4. All pertinent data recorded in audio on the media to include: a. Subdivision name and phase number. b. Manhole numbers (these numbers must match manhole numbers on "as built" and record drawings). c. Date of inspection d. Size and material of pipe e. Service connection locations, right or left f. All distances between manholes g. Locations of suspected and obvious pipe deficiencies (i.e., bad joints, breaks or leaks, etc.) 5. PVC pipe shall have a deflection test using a seven and one-half percent (go -no-go) test mandrel of appropriate size, which shall be visible on video at all times. 6. The printed NASSCO PACP television report (indicating manhole numbers) which will accompany the media. This written report must include: a. Manhole numbers (these numbers must match manhole numbers on "as -built" and record drawings). b. Service connection locations, right or left. c. Reference to service connection locations out of manholes. d. Locations of suspected and obvious pipe deficiencies (i.e., bad joints, breaks or leaks, etc.). e. Depth of each manhole. f. Actual measured distance (on ground) between manholes. 7. All visual and television inspections shall be completed by the contractor and approved by city Public Utilities Department and Engineer after the road base has been constructed but prior to the placing of any asphalt. 8. Television Inspection Media must clearly show details of structural defects, misalignments and infiltration. SECTION IV Page 48 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications 403-4. TESTING 403-4.1. TESTING OF GRAVITY SEWERS The Contractor shall take all precautions to secure a perfectly watertight sewer under all conditions. The water tightness of a sewer which has a crown lying below groundwater level shall be tested by measuring infiltration. The water tightness of sewers having crowns lying above groundwater level shall be tested by filling the pipe with water so as to produce a hydrostatic head of two feet or more above the crown of the sewer at the upper end of the test section or the water table outside of the sewer, whichever is higher, and then measuring the exfiltration. In no case shall the infiltration or exfiltration exceed fifty (50) gallons per inch of diameter per mile per day. The Contractor shall furnish all labor, materials and equipment to test the amount of infiltration or exfiltration under the Engineer's direction. Where the infiltration or exfiltration is excessive, the Contractor at their own expense shall take the necessary steps to remedy such conditions by uncovering the sewer, remaking the joints or by replacing the entire length of sewer as required by the Engineer. No such repaired joints may be backfilled until after they have been tested and found to be acceptable. Care shall be taken to avoid flotation. The Contractor shall TV inspect all mains and provide to the Engineer to verify the true and uniform grade and the absence of bellies or dropped joints prior to acceptance. Any dips or sags of more than five percent (5%) of the pipe inside diameter (ID) dimension from its design alignment shall be cause for rejection. The above tests shall be performed at the discretion of the Engineer on any or all sections of the line. 403-4.2. TESTING OF FORCE MAINS Force mains shall be tested under a hydrostatic pressure of 150 psi for two (2) hours, as described in Section 504 of these Technical Specifications for the testing of water mains. 403-5. BASIS OF PAYMENT 403-5.1. GRAVITY SEWER PIPE Payment for in place sanitary sewer gravity main pipe shall be the unit price per linear foot per appropriate range of depth of cut as contained in the contract bid. Measurement for payment shall be along the centerline of the sewer main from center to center of manholes. Payment for laterals shall be the unit price per linear foot of pipe as measured from the centerline of the sewer main pipe to the terminal end of the lateral pipe including a two-way cleanout at the property line. Payment for sewer pipe shall include all labor, equipment, and materials necessary to complete the installation. This shall include clearing and grubbing, excavation, shoring and dewatering, backfill and grading. 403-5.2. FORCE MAIN PIPE PAYMENT Payment and measurement of force main pipe shall be the same as described in Section 506 of these Technical Specifications for water main pipe. SECTION IV Page 49 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications • 404. CURED -IN-PLACE PIPE SANITARY SEWER REHABILITATION • • 404-1. GENERAL It is the intention of this specification to provide for the trenchless restoration of sanitary sewers, mains and service laterals, by the installation and curing of a resin impregnated felt tube/cured-in-place pipe (CIPP) liner. The liner shall be jointless, continuous from manhole to manhole, watertight and chemically resistant to withstand exposure to domestic sewage. Installation and curing shall include all labor, materials and equipment to provide for a complete, fully restored and functioning installation. Any proposed installer/contractor, or liner system, must be pre -approved by the city prior to receiving bids. The installer must be certified by the liner system manufacturer for installation of the liner system. The city reserves full and complete authority to approve the satisfactory nature of the both the liner system and the installer. The contractor shall provide trenchless reconstruction of service laterals and mainline sewers. The contractor shall have the capability of performing city's selected services which include televised inspection, data collection, system flow analysis, and pipeline reconstruction. The contractor shall employ adequate staff to perform the services required, staff should include Project Representative, Project Manager, Field Supervisor and Senior Foreman. Field supervisory personnel employed by the CIPP Contractor will have at least five (5) years of experience in the performance of the work and tasks as stated in the Contract Documents. Staff shall be proficient and experienced in all phases of services mentioned. The contractor shall perform all work and shall be a licensed Contractor for these services. The contractor shall be certified in confined space entry (OSHA) and traffic control. The contractor shall provide services that include safety measures for both the public and workers, including traffic control, and shall coordinate all scheduling with the city. The contractor shall work with the city in establishing priorities and in preparing work assignments. The contractor shall be completely responsible for the control of the environment of the work site during on-site operations. All precautions shall be taken by the selected contractor to protect the workers, public and city staff from the exposure to harmful or hazardous substances with the sewer system. The contractor shall be responsible for the transport and disposal of all waste materials. The selected contractor shall be responsible for all waste material spills and clean-up in the loading, hauling, and unloading of the contractor's equipment. The contractor shall be responsible for conforming to any and all requirements regarding hauling and disposal of sewer wastes from each city's work site in accordance with OSHA regulations and those that may be mandated by the Federal of State Governments. The contractor shall ensure that all waste material transporters possess all required local, state and federal transportation permits and that they comply with all local, state and federal regulations, including but without limitation, 40 CFR Part 263, "Standards Applicable to Transporters of Hazardous Wastes" and Chapter 17-730, Part 3, Florida Administrative Code, as may be amended from time to time. The contractor shall inform the city of its planned work schedules and shall afford the city reasonable opportunity to observe and inspect the contractor's work in process. The city will be advised of all schedule changes and notified when a work site is left for a 24-hour period when work is not complete. The contractor shall report to city's Inspector their daily progress. SECTION IV Page 50 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications Work hours shall be from 7:00 AM to 3:30 PM Monday through Friday unless authorized in writing by the city's Project Manager. 404-2. MEASUREMENT & PAYMENT Payment for sanitary sewer rehabilitation using the cured -in-place product shall be made per linear foot including all preparation, installation, curing, flow maintenance, lateral reconnection, submittals, light cleaning (3 passes of cleaning head) of piping, material removal & disposal, CCTV inspection/reporting (pre & post installation) sealing of all leaks, connection to all manholes, traffic control on city streets, testing such as infiltration and/or exfiltration, provision of equipment, labor, materials, operations, restoration, etc., to provide a fully completed and operational sewer. Payment shall be measured from center of manhole to center of manhole for the sanitary sewer mains and from the connection to the main to the terminus of the liner for service laterals. 404-3. SUBMITTALS The Contractor shall submit the following information: 1. Manufacturer's certification that the materials to be used meet the referenced standards and these specifications. 2. License or certificate verifying Manufacture's/Licensor's approval of the installer. 3. Proposed equipment and procedures for accomplishing the work. 4. Lining Manufacturer's product data and instructions for resin and catalyst system. 5. Design Calculations, in accordance with the Appendix of ASTM F1216 or latest edition, for each length of liner to be installed including the thickness of each proposed CIPP. It will be acceptable for the Contractor to submit a design for the most severe line condition and apply that design to all of the line sections. To be completed and certified by a Professional Engineer proficient in the design of pipeline systems. All calculations shall include data that conforms to the requirements of these specifications. 6. A detailed installation plan describing all preparation work, cleaning operation, pre -closed-circuit television (CCTV) inspections, flow maintenance, traffic control, installation procedure, method of curing, service reconnection, quality control, testing to be performed, final CCTV inspection, and all else necessary and appropriate for a complete CIPP liner installation. 7. Tube wet -out and cure method including: a complete description of the proposed wet -out procedure, manufacturer's recommended cure method- for each diameter and thickness of CIPP liner to be installed, and detailed curing procedure detailing the curing medium and the method of application. 8. A detailed installation schedules. 9. All SDS sheets for all materials to be furnished for the project. 10. Weekly work schedules shall be submitted no later than close of business on proceeding Thursdays for the work on the following week. Scope of the schedule shall include the following: cleaning operations, CCTV pre & post operations, lining, and crew leader's information including phone number. SECTION IV Page 51 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV —Technical Specifications • 404-4. CURED -IN-PLACE PIPE (CIPP) FOR GRAVITY SEWER MAINS • • 404-4.1. LINER MATERIAL The liner material shall be an epoxy, vinyl ester or polyester fiber felt resin -impregnated tubing or city Engineering Department approved equal, sized to tightly fit the internal circumference and length of the designated gravity sewer. The cured liner shall meet the minimum initial structural properties as listed in ASTM F1216. The liner shall be designed in accordance with the Appendices in ASTM F1216. It shall be assumed that a fully deteriorated gravity sewer pipeline having no structural strength will be rehabilitated with H-20 traffic loading, the water table's at the ground surface and the product installed will have a minimum expected lifetime of fifty (50) years. In no case shall the liner thickness be less than six millimeters (6 mm) for pipe sizes six inches (6") through eight inches (8") and 7.5 millimeters for pipe sizes ten inches (10") through twelve inches (12") in diameter. Minimum liner thickness for pipes greater than twelve inches (12") shall be as specified by the city. Liner shall be sized by Contractor to provide a tight fit to the inside circumference of the host pipe and shall be a continuous jointless lining from manhole to manhole. Unless otherwise specified, the Contractor shall use an epoxy vinyl ester or polyester resin and catalyst system, and a fiber felt tube compatible with the inversion or other approved alternate installation process and having the followin>; minimum physical nronerties for the cured nine: PROPERTY VALUE TEST METHOD MINIMUM (psi) Tensile Strength ASTM D638 or latest edition 3,000 Flexural Strength Modified ASTM D790 or latest edition 4,500 Flexural Modulus of Elasticity Modified ASTM D790 250,000 Long -Term (50 year) Modulus of Elasticity ASTM D7790 or latest edition 125,000 The epoxy vinyl ester or polyester resin and fiber felt tubing system shall be in accordance with the requirements of ASTM F1216 and be fabricated to a size that, when installed, will neatly fit the interior of the host pipe. Allowance shall be made for circumferential stretching during a direct (non -inversion) pull in. The CIPP product shall fit tightly to the host sewer pipe (with minimal shrinkage) in such a way as to minimize water migration (tracking) between the liner and the host pipe. A vacuum impregnation process shall be used in conjunction with a roller system to achieve a uniform distribution of the resin throughout the tube under controlled conditions. The volume shall be adjusted by adding five to ten (10) percent excess resin for the change in resin volume due to polymerization and to allow for any migration of resin into cracks or joints in the host pipe. The outside of the fabric tube shall be marked every 5 feet with the name of the manufacturer or CIPP system, manufacturing lot and production footage. 404-4.2. CHEMICAL JOINT, CRACK AND ANNULAR SPACE SEALING MATERIALS FOR ACTIVE LEAKS AND SERVICE LATERAL CONNECTIONS Chemical joint and crack sealing materials shall have the following properties: 1. React quickly to form a permanent watertight seal 2. Resultant seal shall be flexible and immune to the effects of wet/dry cycles 3. Non -biodegradable and immune to the effects of acids, alkalis, and organics in sewage 4. Component packaging and mixing compatible with field conditions and worker safety SECTION IV Page 52 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV—Technical Specifications 5. Extraneous sealant left inside pipe shall be readily removable; and shall be compatible with the repair resin utilized. Chemical joint sealing material shall be acrylic resin type and shall be furnished with activators, initiators, inhibitors, and any other materials recommended by the manufacturer for a complete grout system. Sealing grout shall be furnished in liquid form in standard manufacturer's containers. 404-4.3. MANHOLE CONNECTIONS A seal, consisting of a resin mixture or hydrophilic seal compatible with the installed CIPP shall be applied at manhole walls in accordance with the CIPP System manufacturer's recommendation. Cost associated with manhole seals shall be included in the contract price of CIPP installation. 404-4.4. INSTALLATION AND EXECUTION 404-4.4.1. CLEANING/SURFACE PREPARATION It shall be the responsibility of the Contractor to clean and prepare the existing pipes for rehabilitation. The Contractor shall perform light cleaning (3 passes of the jet head) using a jetting system capable of providing 60 gallons of flow at 3,000 psi. After light cleaning has been completed the Contractor shall attempt a pre- installation CCTV inspection. If the Contractor believes that the piping requires additional cleaning the collected CCTV video will be provided to the Inspector before beginning any heavy cleaning of the piping. Light cleaning is included in the cost of liner installation and heavy cleaning will be measured as a separate pay item. The Contractor will thoroughly clean the interior of the sewers to produce a clean interior surface free of all coatings, sand, rock, roots, sludge, or other deleterious materials prior to liner insertion. Flow maintenance will be provided by the Contractor as required. Bypass operations are to be so arranged as to cause minimum disruptions to local traffic, residents and commercial facilities. During the cleaning and preparation operations all necessary precautions shall be taken to protect the public, all property and the sanitary sewer facilities from damage. All material removed from the sewers shall be the Contractor's responsibility for prompt disposal in accordance with all regulatory agency requirements. The Contractor may be required to control the rate of sewer cleaning in the sanitary system to avoid heavy pollution loads at the city's treatment plants. 404-4.4.2. TELEVISION INSPECTION After cleaning, and again after the rehabilitation work on each section of pipe is completed, all pipe sections shall be visually inspected with a digital CCTV camera and recorded in DVD format. Cost of CCTV inspections is included in the cost of pipe lining CCTV data shall be provided to the city designated Project Manager. Asset Management (OWAM) software. This section describes the requirements of the Contractor in providing the following minimum requirements for video capture, photo capture and database structure to the city. The city is currently using CUES Granite video and data collection software. The Contractor shall provide the TV Inspections in the same CUES Granite product database, photo, and video capture format. The Contractor -provided TV inspections, database, DVDs, photos, and related files shall have the ability to direct synchronize to the city's existing CUES Granite product database. 404-4.4.2.1. IMAGE (PHOTOS) CAPTURE FORMAT AND REQUIREMENTS The Inspection image files (pictures) shall have the ability to export to industry standard formats to include JPEG, BMP, and TIFF formats and be transferable by disk, thumb drive, DVD and/or external hard drive to an external personal computer utilizing standard viewers and printers. SECTION IV Page 53 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications • 404-4.4.2.2. DIGITAL VIDEO FORMAT AND REQUIREMENTS Digital video files (Inspection Videos) shall be captured and/or recorded in the MPEG format or as specified by the city. The video capture files shall be in MPEG format with data linking (Inspection Observations) to the database file(s). The "Link" of the video capture file to the database observation file is required. The inspection observation(s) shall link to the video record in real-time. The accompanying database shall support the following code system: PACP, or current code system being utilized by the city. The Database and Software program (CUES Granite products) shall be able to import asset data from an Esri ArcGIS (v.10.1+) geodatabase utilizing the network features to associate Sewer Mains with corresponding Sewer Nodes. The database structure shall retain information on the various structures found within a sewer or storm system. It is important that the structures, nodes, manholes and pipe identifiers and related attribute information be retained as separate tables from the inspection allowing import of existing data from multiple sources. The data structure allows different projects to reside within a single database. Information gathered in projects shall be available to view by project or by system. Data gathered during project inspection shall be available to view by the selected structure. Therefore, all inspections can be viewed on a structure even if gathered in different projects. 404-4.4.2.3. SYNCHRONIZATION The database shall have the ability to synchronize assets and inspections from replicated databases. The synchronization process should have built-in error checking for duplicates, updates and any modifications to the data being synched. This allows for multiple sources of data to be effectively consolidated into a single unitary database for analysis and evaluation. • 404-4.4.3. LINER INSTALLATION Liner shall be sized to field measurements obtained by the Contractor to provide a tight fit to the full interior circumference of the existing sanitary sewer and shall be a continuous, joint -less liner product from inside of manhole to inside of manhole. Contractor shall use installation methods approved by the liner manufacturer including liner placement, reforming to fit existing pipe, pressure and heat requirements and reconnection of laterals. The Contractor shall immediately notify the city of any construction delays taking place during the insertion operation. Contractor shall provide flow maintenance measures as described by the approved Flow Maintenance Plan. Flow Maintenance Plan shall be approved by the city Project Manager prior to 48 -hours of mobilization. Flow Maintenance Plan shall include redundancy. Liner entries at manholes shall be smooth, free of irregularities, and watertight. No pinholes, tears, cracks, thin spots, or other defects in the liner shall be permitted. Such defects shall be removed and replaced by the Contractor at their expense. OSHA requirements for installation procedures, in particular, confined spaces are to be met. • 404-4.4.4. LATERAL RECONNECTION Sanitary laterals shall be reconnected as soon as possible to renew service. Laterals are to be reconnected by means of robotics, by internally cutting out the liner to 100% of the area of the original opening. All lateral reconnections are to be grouted, as directed by the city to prevent leakage. Grouting method and material is to be approved by the city. Cost for robotic reconnection shall be included in the cost to install the liner. If the city wishes to reconnect service lateral using a different method the cost to do so will be measured and paid for separately. Any reconnections to laterals and connections to manholes which are observed to leak shall be resealed by the Contractor. All laterals discovered during the lining process are to be reconnected unless specifically directed otherwise by the city. Contractor shall notify all local system users when the sanitary system will not be available for normal usage by the delivery of door hangers seven days before commencement with SECTION IV Page 54 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications appropriate information regarding the construction project. Contractor shall notify the Senior Public Information Coordinator from the city Public Communications Department prior to distribution. 404-4.4.5. TIME OF CONSTRUCTION Construction schedules will be submitted by the Contractor and approved by the city. At no time will any sanitary sewer service connection remain inoperative for more than an eight (8) hour period without a service bypass being operated by the Contractor. In the event that sewage backup occurs and enters buildings, the Contractor shall be responsible for cleanup, repair and property damage costs and claims. 404-4.4.6. TESTING AND ACCEPTANCE Post cleaning and television inspection shall proceed only after all necessary work and preparation has been completed, including the following: • Placement of traffic control measures in accordance with these specifications • Implementation of adequate flow control • Pre -installation cleaning and television inspection • Installation of CIPP liner in accordance with specifications • All services re -instated including grout sealing in accordance with these specifications The Contractor shall clean and televise the assigned gravity sewer in accordance with Sections 404-4.4.1, 404-4.4.2, 404-4.4.2.1, 404-4.4.2.2 and 404-4.4.2.3. The interior surface of the pipeline shall be cleaned with high pressure water jet equipment immediately prior to conducting the post television inspection. Jetting equipment will provide a minimum of sixty (60) gallons per minute of water at 3,000 psi. All service locations, gouges, cracks, bumps, bulges and obstructions, such as dropped joints, shall be noted on the inspection. In the case of bellies in the line, the pipe shall be cleared of any standing water to provide continuous visibility during the post inspection. The Contractor shall provide all inspections in digital PACP format including printed inspection logs to the city. Cost associated with post -televising and cleaning shall be included in the contract price of CIPP installation. The finished liner shall be free of significant visual defects, damage, deflection, holes, leaks and other defects. Each individual pipe segment contained in a development is to be considered an "individual project" such that all work, including all deliverables shall be reviewed and accepted prior to the city accepting and processing payment for that individual project. No partial payments will be made on individual sewer projects. 404-4.4.7. CLEANUP Cleanup is an essential part of the work. As the work progresses and is completed, the Contractor shall clean the various sites of all operations and completely restore all work areas to the satisfaction of the city. This cleanup shall be done as promptly as practicable and shall not be left until the end of the construction period. No part of the work shall be considered complete and no payment will be made until cleanup is completed. 404-5. CURED -IN-PLACE PIPE (CIPP) FOR SERVICE LATERALS 404-5.1. LINER MATERIAL The lining material shall be a fiberglass/polyester needle fleece vacuum epoxy resin -impregnated or equivalent material tube, matching the diameter of the lateral pipe, which is inserted into the service lateral to be rehabilitated and cured -in-place by an acceptable curing method. No Polyester resins will be accepted. SECTION IV Page 55 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications • The epoxy shall be suitable for the design conditions as well as the curing process. The cured liner shall provide a service life of 50 years and shall have the minimum structural properties listed below: PROPERTY VALUE TEST METHOD MINIMUM (psi) Tensile Strength ASTM D638 3,000 Flexural Strength Modified ASTM D790 4,500 Modulus of Elasticity ASTM D790 250,000 The liner system shall consist of a sectional liner in the mainline (full wrap around the circumference of the main line extending 5" on either side of the service) and the continuous lateral liner shall have the capacity to extend to within 10 feet of the building foundation. The liner shall form a continuous, one-piece, tight fitting, corrosion resistant and verifiable non -leaking cured in place pipe. The one-piece section liner shall be manufactured in a factory setting prior to its arrival on site. No component of the liner (i.e. lateral tube to mainline piece) shall be glued or sewn fused in the field prior to installation. The material shall be capable of conforming to offset joints, bells, and disfigured pipe sections. The liner shall be designed, fabricated, and installed for the actual conditions encountered for this application including the material of the host pipe, in accordance with the applicable provisions of ASTM F 1216(latest edition), and shall meet the following minimum design conditions: AASHTO H-20 live load with one truck passing; Soil Weight 120 pounds per cubic foot. Coefficient of friction Ku'=0.130; Groundwater: At the ground surface; fully deteriorated pipe with 2 percent (min.) ovality. If ovality of existing pipe is found to be worse, use actual percent up to 5 percent (max.); Soil Modulus 1,000 psi; Factor of Safety = 2; Soil Depth: Depth of Cover will be determined by field measurements. The liner shall be designed to withstand all imposed loads, including live loads and, if applicable hydrostatic pressure. The liner shall have sufficient wall thickness to withstand all anticipated external pressures and loads that may be imposed after installation. The design shall be performed and certified by a professional engineer licensed by the Florida. The liner and resin shall be manufactured by Trelleborg Pipe Seals, BLD, Inc., LMK, Inc., or approved equal. The finished liner product shall be chemically resistant to domestic sewage over the expected lifetime of the rehabilitated pipe. The lateral liner system shall create epoxy resin migration into the defect/joints of the existing lateral. A combination of mechanical and chemical bonding shall be created between the lateral lining system and existing host pipe. 404-5.2. EPDXY RESIN MATERIAL The epoxy system shall meet the requirements of ASTM F1216 (latest edition), Section 5.2. The epoxy installed liner system shall produce a liner that will comply with the structural requirements specified herein and shall provide chemical resistance for the flow media in the gravity pipe. The epoxy shall be compatible with the rehabilitation process, shall be able to cure in the presence or absence of water, and shall have an initiation temperature for cure as recommended by the epoxy manufacturer. Polyester and Vinylester resins contain styrene and volatile organic compounds which are susceptible to shrinkage and UV Curing will not be accepted. Submitted documentation from the epoxy manufacturer specifically describing the chemical characteristics of the epoxy system, including allowable mixing, impregnation, and handling time, transportation and storage time, and recommended curing cycle including temperatures, pressures, and times. The epoxy manufacturer's documentation must also include maximum allowable time for handling the impregnated tube prior to insertion and the maximum allowable elapsed time from insertion to exotherm. If remedial measures are available to extend either of the maximum allowable times indicated above, without affecting the physical properties of the epoxy, the epoxy manufacturer should describe these measures and the time limits beyond which even these measures will not prevent alteration of the physical properties of the epoxy. SECTION IV Page 56 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications 404-5.3. INSTALLATION AND EXECUTION The Contractor, when required, shall provide for the flow of sewage around the section(s) of main pipe where the service lateral designated for lining is located. The bypass shall be made by plugging the line at an existing upstream manhole and pumping the flow into a downstream manhole or adjacent system. The pump and bypass lines shall be of adequate capacity and size to handle the flow. Contractor must coordinate installation with property owner(s). Delivery, storage, and handling of approved products are the responsibility of the Contractor. The Contractor shall keep them safe from damage and stored with the proper environmental containment as outlined by the manufacturer. No products should be used that have exceeded the designated shelf life as outlined by the manufacturer. Remove damaged products from site. Promptly replace damaged products with new products at no additional cost to the city. If the service lateral lining process requires the installation of a cleanout, the city must approve the work before it is done. 404-5.3.1. PRE -LINING INSPECTION Prior to inspecting each service lateral the piping will be cleaned to allow passage of the camera. A recorded CCTV video survey must be completed on the sewer main and service laterals with a pan and tilt camera. The inspection shall confirm the location and clock reference of the lateral junctions to be lined, any offsets within the mainline or service lateral, any intrusion from the lateral into the main; the angle at which the connection comes in; any changes in angle of approach of the lateral for the length of the repair; the potential flows coming through the lateral pipe; the potential flows going through the sewer main pipe; the diametric size of the connection for the length of the liner; the size of the main pipe at the point of the liner and the presence of active infiltration within the vicinity of the work area. Cost to complete the necessary pipe cleaning and CCTV inspection will be included in the cost to install the lateral liner. Two copies of the pre -lining inspection shall be submitted to the Public Utilities Dept. The Contractor shall be responsible for having a copy of the pre -lining inspections in the field as well. Immediately prior to liner insertion, the camera shall traverse the lateral to inspect for debris which may have entered the line after the existing condition video recording. 404-5.3.2. LATERAL PREPARATION It shall be the responsibility of the Contractor to clear the line of obstructions such as solids, roots, or broken pipe that will prevent the insertion of the liner. A high speed rotating hydraulic cutter shall be used to cut roots, grease or other obstructions in the pipe. The cut shall be made flush with the wall of the pipe to be restored, and the debris shall be pushed down the lateral pipe to the main pipe and to the downstream manhole and is to be removed by the contractor. If inspection reveals an obstruction that cannot be removed by conventional cleaning equipment, the Contractor shall notify the city and the cleaning effort shall be abandoned. The Contractor shall confirm that the sewer is clean enough to ensure an effective lining. The line segment shall not be lined until approved by the city. Built-up deposits on the sewer main and lateral pipe walls shall be removed. The removal shall reach at least one foot beyond the liner product to allow the bladder to inflate tightly against the pipe walls ensuring a smooth transition from the liner product to the existing pipe wall. Where the sewer main pipe has been lined previously with a CIPP liner, a check should be made to ensure the prior lateral reopening work created a lateral opening that is flush with the lateral pipe. If this is not the case, the mainline CIPP must be trimmed back using a lateral cutter. Where active infiltration is present and when it is recommended by the liner manufacturer the infiltration must be stopped in advance by grouting. SECTION IV Page 57 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications • 404-5.3.3. LINER INSTALLATION Notify all property owners not identified for service flow maintenance that their sewage service will be discontinued while the liner is being installed. Notify each affected property owner at least 7 days in advance of commencement of the work, giving the date, start time and time when service will be completely restored. Also provide a telephone number which property owners can call for information during the work. If required for flow maintenance for selected services, Contractor shall excavate at the property line down to the service lateral for the installation of a cleanout. The preferred method of excavation shall be vacuum excavation. Although other installation techniques may be accepted, they must be pre -approved by the city. The service lateral shall be thoroughly cleaned prior to attaching the PVC wye connection. The riser pipe shall be sealed with a screw type plug, the excavation backfilled with sand or pea gravel, and the surface restored to preconstruction conditions. Service lateral liner material shall be vacuum impregnated on site with the epoxy resin immediately prior to installation. Impregnation should be carried out under vacuum using electric impregnation table with pinch rollers set at the correct gap as per the manufacturer's instructions. Impregnation should take place in a clean, temperature -controlled cab in which the materials are protected from direct sunlight, objects which may damage the coating. Impregnation should not take place using a manual roller in which the material is subject to excessive pressure and that the materials are squeezed resulting in a resin slug. All the calculated resin shall be confined to the liner to ensure the correct mechanical properties can be achieved. Impregnation should not take place outside in an uncontrolled environment in which the materials are exposed to the elements. The liner should not be placed on the ground where it is susceptible to damage from objects such as stones, grit, glass etc. During and upon completion of the impregnation process the liner should be stored in a container to avoid damage prior to loading the material into the installation device. • • The liner product shall be loaded inside a pressure apparatus above ground. The pressure apparatus, with an end attached to a robotic manipulator device, shall be positioned in the mainline pipe at the service connection that is to be rehabilitated. The robotic device together with a television camera will be used to align the repair product with the service connection opening. The robotic device shall hold the collar in place while air pressure, supplied to the pressure apparatus through a hose, shall be used to invert the liner into the lateral pipe. The insertion pressure will be adjusted to fully deploy the liner product into the lateral connection and hold the liner product tight to the main and lateral pipe walls. After insertion is completed, recommended pressure must be maintained on the impregnated liner product for the duration of the curing process. The Contractor shall apply a heat source and circulation system to affect a cure of the epoxy system. The equipment shall be capable of uniformly raising the temperature of the pressurized fluid above the temperature required to affect a complete curing of the epoxy system. Initial cure shall be deemed to be completed when the temperature gauge on the heat source indicates that the temperature inside the tube is of a magnitude to realize an exotherm. The minimum cure period shall be as recommended by the system manufacturer. The finished liner product shall be free of dry spots, lifts, delamination, and excess epoxy. The installed liner product should not inhibit the post installation video inspection, using a closed-circuit television camera, of the mainline and service lateral pipes or future pipe cleaning operations. During the warranty period any defects with the liner product that affect the performance or cleaning of the lateral connection shall be repaired at the contractor's expense in a manner acceptable to the city. The Contractor shall inform the city of service laterals in which a liner product cannot be installed due to pre-existing conditions. These services will be identified, documented, video recorded, and the city will be SECTION IV Page 58 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications informed of the conditions encountered. The Contractor will not attempt to install a liner product in these services unless directed by the city. Contractor may be permitted, at the direction of the city, to install service liners from inside the existing cleanout location to the main line sewer if conditions allow. Final liner product must include a lateral connection repair brim type liner to seal the connection at the host pipe and overlap the service liner installed from the cleanout. 404-5.3.4. TESTING AND ACCEPTANCE Following installation of the service lateral liners, conduct a final, video recorded, CCTV/color television inspection of the completed work including the service lateral connections at the sewer main and the full length of all service laterals lined during the progress of the work. Copies of these recordings and those made prior to the liner installation shall be submitted to the city for approval and shall be retained by the city. Field acceptance of the liner shall be based on the city's evaluation of the installation including CCTV inspection video recordings and a review of certified test data for the installed pipe samples. groundwater infiltration of the liner shall be zero. There shall be no evidence of splits, cracks, breaks, lifts, kinks, delamination or crazing in the liner. If any defective liner is discovered after it has been installed, it shall be removed and replaced with either a sound liner or a new pipe at no additional cost to the city. The cost for all necessary testing shall be included in the cost associated with the lining. The Contractor shall clean up each project area after the work is completed and all testing is accepted. Remove and dispose of all excess materials and debris at each location as directed by the city. 405. SANITARY MANHOLE LINER RESTORATION 405-1. SCOPE AND INTENT It is the intent of this portion of the specification to provide for the repair, rehabilitation and groundwater infiltration abatement of manhole walls, corbels/cones, pipe connections and bench and channel/trough areas. All manhole rehabilitation products will be installed in accordance with the manufacturer's recommendations and these specifications. The purpose of the rehabilitation work is to eliminate inflow and infiltration, provide corrosion protection, and to restore the structural integrity of the manhole. For any particular system the Contractor will submit manufacturer's technical data and application instructions. All OSHA regulations shall be met in the completion of the work and the contractor shall be responsible for all necessary maintenance of traffic. The contractor shall warrant all work against defects in materials and workmanship for a period of one 1 years, unless otherwise noted, from the date of final acceptance of the project. Contractor shall, within a reasonable time after receipt of written notice thereof, repair defects in materials or workmanship which may develop during said one year period, and any damage to other work caused by such defects or the repairing of same, at his own expense and without cost to the city. The following lists all elements of potential rehabilitation activity: 1. REMOVE STEPS 2. STOP ACTIVE INFILTRATION. 3. PATCH VOIDS AND ALL FRAME CONNECTIONS WITH NON -SHRINK GROUT. 4. REMOVE LOOSE COATING MATERIALS. 5. RESURFACE CORBEL/WALLS WITH CEMENTITIOUS MORTAR. 6. REBUILD/REPAIR BENCH & CHANNEL/TROUGH/SEAL PIPE CONNECTIONS. 7. COAT CORBEL/CONE, WALLS, BENCH AND TROUGH WITH AN APPROVED CEMENTITIOUS, EPDXY, OR POLYURATHANE, COATING/LINING SYSTEM. 8. ADJUST FRAME AND COVER HEIGHT. 9. RESET FRAME AND COVER. SECTION IV Page 59 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications • 10. REMOVE ROOTS. 11. PROVIDE INFLOW INSERT/DISH/PAN. 12. REMOVE DEBRIS. 13. PERFORM STRUCTURAL REPAIR. 14. REPLACE FRAME AND COVER. 15. SEAL FRAME TO CORBEL/CONE CONNECTION WITH AN APPROVED POLYUREA COATING/LINING SYSTEM It is implicit that many of the repair activities listed above will not be measured and paid for separately as they will be included in the cost of rehabilitating the manhole substrate. These activities include stopping active infiltration, patching voids, removal of loose coating materials, resurfacing of the corbel & wall, removing roots, and removing miscellaneous debris. Repair activities which will have a separate measurement and payment item include: Rebuilding/Repairing Bench & Channel/Trough; Interior Manhole Coating; Adjusting/Resetting Frame & Cover, Replacing Frame & Cover and Sealing Frame to Corbel Connection. • • 405-2. MEASUREMENT & PAYMENT 405-2.1. MANHOLE LINERS/COATING Payment for manhole rehabilitation shall be per vertical linear foot of liner/coating which is installed/applied. Lining systems will generally be measured from the manhole bench to the top of existing, or new, corbel/cone. Cementitious, Epoxy and Polyurethane coating systems will be measured from the lowest pipe invert to the bottom of the manhole frame. No separate payment will be made for the following items: Flow Maintenance; Maintenance of Traffic; Debris Disposal; Miscellaneous Excavation, including necessary pavement removal and replacement; Infiltration control in manhole and at all pipe connections; Grout, Brick and mortar placement to fill voids and level surfaces; Brick replacement; Root removal, Installation of pipe extensions and connectors as necessary; Removal and replacement of manhole steps, Replacement of unpaved roadway and grass or shrubbery; Replacement of roadway base (including backfill and compaction) and asphalt surface; and Appurtenant work as required to complete the identified rehabilitation. The cost of such work shall be included in the pay item, per vertical linear foot of liner/coating. 405-2.2. REPLACE FRAME & COVER Payment for manhole frame and cover replacement will include removal of existing frame and cover and replacement with a new frame and cover which meets the criteria established by Section 401-4 of the city's specifications. The Contractor will also install and/or replace manhole pans and dishes if it is damaged or missing. Refer to Section 401-2.2. from these Section IV Technical Specifications. Where manholes fall in paved areas, refer to Standard Detail Index 104, "Street and Driveway Replacement for Concrete and Asphaltic Concrete Surfaces ". Payment will be made for each manhole frame and cover replaced. No separate payment will be made for maintenance of traffic, necessary pavement removal and replacement, or replacement of grass or shrubbery. 405-2.3. REBUILD BENCH & CHANNEL/TROUGH Payment for rebuilding bench and channel/trough will include removal of existing bench and channel (if applicable) and constructing a new bench and channel using the criteria established by Section 401-1 of the city's specifications. Payment will be made for each bench and channel repaired/installed. No separate payment will be made for the removal of the existing bench and channel, by-pass pumping, and preparation of the manhole invert. SECTION IV Page 60 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications 405-2.4. RESET/ADJUST MANHOLE FRAME & COVER Payment for adjusting, or resetting, manhole frame will include removal of existing frame, removal of existing mortar, preparing top of corbel surface, installation of necessary riser material as described in Section 401-2.1, and placement of existing frame. No separate payment will be made for necessary maintenance of traffic, pavement removal and replacement, or replacement of grass or shrubbery. All work will be performed in accordance with Section 401-4 of the city's specifications. Where manholes fall in paved areas, refer to Standard Detail Index 104, "Street and Driveway Replacement for Concrete and Asphaltic Concrete Surfaces". Payment will be made for each manhole frame and cover adjusted. No separate payment will be made for maintenance of traffic, necessary pavement removal and replacement, or replacement of grass or shrubbery. 405-2.5. SEAL MANHOLE FRAME TO CORBEL CONNECTION WITH POLYUREA MATERIAL Payment for providing a water tight connection between the manhole frame and the manhole corbel /cone will include placement of non -shrink grout in any area between the frame and corbel which is void of mortar, preparing the frame and corbel/cone to accept the polyurea material and testing the thickness of the application. No separate payment will be made for necessary maintenance of traffic. All work will be performed in accordance with Section 405-7 of the city's specifications. 405-3. CEMENTITIOUS COATING SYSTEM This specification shall govern all work to spray/apply a monolithic fiber reinforced cementitious liner to the wall, channel, invert and bench surfaces of brick, concrete, or any other construction material; Strong Seal MS 2C product or approved equal. Described are procedures for manhole cleaning preparation, application of material and testing. The applicator must be approved, trained and certified as having successfully completed factory training. The applicator/contractor shall furnish all labor, equipment and materials for applying the Strong Seal MS 2C product directly to the contour of the manhole to form a structural cementitious liner of a minimum one half inch (1/2") thickness using a machine specially designed for the application. As it is the intention of the city to rehabilitate the entire structure; corbel, walls, bench and channel/trough the contractor will be required to provide by-pass pumping as the necessary cure time exceeds four (4) hours. In no case will flow through plugs be allowed. All aspects of the installation shall be in accordance with the manufacturer's recommendations and with the following specifications: 1. The elimination of active infiltration prior to making the application. 2. The removal of any loose and unsound material. 3. The spray application of a pre -blended cementitious mix to form a monolithic liner in a two (2) coat application. 405-3.1. SUBMITTALS Submittals shall be made in accordance with the following: 1. Technical data sheet on each product used, including ASTM test results indicating the product conforms to and is suitable for its intended use per these specifications. 2. Safety Data Sheets (SDS) for each product used. 3. Project specific guidelines and recommendations. 4. Applicator Qualifications: a. Manufacturer certification that the Applicator has been trained in the handling, mixing and application of the products to be used. SECTION IV Page 61 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 • • • SECTION IV — Technical Specifications b. Certification that the equipment to be used for applying the products has been approved by the protective coating manufacturer and Applicator personnel have been trained and certified for proper use of the equipment. c. Written document providing three (3) years of experience and five (5) recent references of Applicator indicating successful application of the materials provided d. Installed a minimum of 50,000 square feet of plural component spray applied coating the same or similar to that specified within the last two (2) years. e. Proof of any necessary federal, state, or local permits or licenses necessary for the project. 405-3.2. MATERIALS 405-3.2.1. PATCHING MIX A Strong A Seal or approved equal shall be used as a patching mix according to the manufacturer's recommendations and shall have the following minimum requirements: 1. Compressive Strength (ASTM C109) 15 min., 200 psi; 6 hrs., 1,400 psi 2. Shrinkage (ASTM C596) 28 days, 150 psi 3. Bond (ASTM C1072) 28 days, 150 psi 4. Cement Sulfate resistant 0% at 90% R.H. 5. Density, when applied 105 +/- 5 pcf 405-3.2.2. INFILTRATION CONTROL A Strong A Plug or approved equal shall be used to stop minor water infiltration according to the manufacturer's recommendations and shall have the followin>; minimum requirements: 1. Compressive strength (ASTM C109) 600 psi, 1 hr.; 1000 psi 24 hrs. 2. Bond (ASTM C1072) 30 psi, 1 hr.; 80 psi, 24 hrs. 405-3.2.3. GROUTING MIX Strong -Seal Grout or approved equal shall be used for stopping very active infiltration and filling voids according to the manufacturer's recommendations. The grout shall be volume stable and have a minimum twenty-eight (28) day compressive strength of 250 psi and a one (1) day strength of 50 psi. 405-3.2.4. COATING MIX Strong Seal MS 2C or approved equal shall be used to form the monolithic liner covering all interior manhole surfaces and shall have the following minimum requirements at twenty-eight (28) days: The physical requirements must be verified by an independent, certified, third party testing laboratory within the last five years. The proposed third -party laboratory must be submitted with the bid package; any bid package not including the verifiable, independent third -party testing shall be ruled non-responsive and will be refected. 1. Compressive strength (ASTM C109) 3,000 psi 2. Tensile strength (ASTM C496) 300 psi 3. Flexural strength (ASTM C78) 600 psi 4. Shrinkage (ASTM C596) 0% at 90% R.H. 5. Bond (ASTM C1072) 130 psi 6. Density, when applied 105 + pcf 7. Chemical Resistance (ASTM D543/G20) immersion service for: a. Municipal sanitary sewer environment b. Sulfuric Acid, 30% c. Sodium Hydroxide, 10% d. Sodium Hypochlorite, 3% SECTION IV Page 62 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications Fiberglass rods which are contained in the product shall be alkaline resistant and shall be one-half inch (1/2") to five-eighths inch (5/8") long with a diameter of 635 to 640 microns. Products shall, in the unmixed state, have a lead content not greater than two percent (2%) by weight. Strong Seal MS 2C shall be made with Calcium Aluminate Cement and shall be used according to the manufacturer's recommendations in applications where there is evidence of severe sulfide conditions. Product must be factory blended requiring only the addition of water at job site. Bag weight shall be 50 to 51 pounds and contents must have a dry bulk density of 50 to 56 pounds per cubic foot. Cement content must be 65% to 75% of total weight of bag. One bag of product when mixed with correct amount of water must have a wet density of 95 to 108 pounds per cubic foot and must yield a minimum of 0.67 cubic foot of volume. Product shall not include any basic ingredient that exceeds maximum allowable EPA limit for any heavy metal. Manufacturer must provide SDS sheets for product(s) to be used in reconstruction process. A two (2) coat application of liner material will be required (no exceptions) with the first coat rough troweled to force materials into cracks and crevices to set the bond. The second coat to be spray applied to assure a minimum of one-half inch (1/2") thickness after troweling or brush finishing to a relatively smooth finish. 405-3.2.5. WATER Water shall be clean and potable not to exceed 80°F (Fahrenheit). 405-3.2.6. OTHER MATERIALS No other material shall be used with the mixes previously described without prior approval or recommendation from the manufacturer. 405-3.3. APPLICATION EQUIPMENT A specially designed machine consisting of an optimized progressive cavity pump capable of producing a minimum of 250 psi pumping pressure, contra blend mixer with twin ribbon paddles with discharge, and an air system for spray application of product. Equipment must be complete with water storage and metering system. Mixer and pump are to be hydraulically powered. Equipment is to be mounted to heavy duty construction tandem axle road worthy trailer complete with electric brakes and running lights. Internal combustion engine must be included to power the hydraulic system and air compressor. 405-3.4. INSTALLATION AND EXECUTION 405-3.4.1. PREPARATION 1. All foreign material shall be removed from the manhole wall and bench using a high-pressure water spray (minimum 1,200 psi). Loose and protruding brick, mortar and concrete shall be removed using a mason's hammer and chisel and/or scraper. Fill any large voids with brick and quick setting patching mix. 2. Active leaks shall be stopped using quick setting specially formulated mixes according to the manufacturer's recommendations. When severe infiltration is present, drilling may be required in order to pressure grout using a cementitious grout. Manufacturer's recommendations shall be followed when pressure grouting is required. 3. Any bench, invert/channel/trough or service line repairs shall be made at this time using the quick setting mix and following the manufacturer's recommendations. 4. Any active flows shall be dammed, plugged, or diverted as required to ensure all liquids are maintained below or away from the surfaces to be coated until final applications are cured as recommended by the manufacturer. SECTION IV Page 63 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 • SECTION IV —Technical Specifications 5. Prior to commencing surface preparation, Contractor shall inspect all surfaces specified to receive the coating and notify city, in writing, of any noticeable disparity in the site, structure or surfaces which may interfere with the work, use of materials or procedures as specified herein. 405-3.4.2. MIXING For each bag of product, use the amount of water specified by the manufacturer and mix using the Spray Mate Model 35C or 35D equipment for thirty (30) seconds to one (1) minute after all materials have been placed in the mixing hopper. Place the mix into the holding hopper and prepare another batch with timing such that the nozzleman can spray in a continuous manner without interruption until each application is complete. 405-3.4.3. SPRAYING The surface, prior to spraying, shall be damp without noticeable free water droplets or running water. Materials shall be sprayed, applied to a minimum uniform thickness to ensure that all cracks, crevices and voids are filled, and a somewhat smooth surface remains after light troweling. The light troweling is performed to compact the material into voids and to set the bond. Not before the first application has begun to take an initial set (disappearance of surface sheen which could be fifteen (15) minutes to one (1) hour depending upon ambient conditions) is the second application made to assure a minimum total finished thickness of one-half inch (1/2"). The surface is then troweled to a smooth finish being careful not to over trowel so as to bring additional water to the surface and weaken it. A brush finish may be applied to the finished coat to remove trowel marks. Manufacturer's recommendation shall be followed whenever more than twenty-four (24) hours have elapsed between applications. The bench will be sprayed such that a gradual slope is produced from the walls to the invert with the thickness at the edge of the invert being no less than one-half inch (1/2"). The invert/channel/trough area shall also be sprayed in a manner that provides a gradual slope through the structure while achieving one-quarter inch (1/4") thickness coverage. The wall/bench and bench/invert/channel/trough intersections shall be rounded to a uniform radius, the full circumference of the intersection. The final application shall have a minimum of four (4) hours cure time before being subjected to active flow. The corbel/cone to manhole frame joint shall be sealed according to Section 405-7. 405-3.4.4. PREPARATION OF SAMPLES At some point during the application, at least four (4) two inch (2") cubes will be prepared for each manhole, or from every fifty (50) bags of product used, identified and submitted, in accordance with the city's or Manufacturer's directions, for compression strength testing as described in ASTM C109. 405-3.4.5. CURING Ambient manhole conditions are adequate for curing so long as the manhole is covered. It is imperative that the manhole be covered as soon as possible after the application has been completed. 405-3.5. TESTING AND ACCEPTANCE Manhole will be vacuum tested from the top of manhole frame to the manhole base. All pipes entering the manhole shall be plugged, taking care to securely place the plug from being drawn into the manhole. The test head shall be placed, and the seal inflated in accordance with the manufacturers' recommendations. A vacuum pump of ten inches (10") of mercury shall be drawn and the vacuum pump shut off. With the valves closed, the time shall be measured for the vacuum to drop to nine inches (9"). The manhole shall pass if the time is greater than sixty (60) seconds for forty-eight inch (48") diameter, seventy five (75) seconds for sixty inch diameter (60"), and ninety (90) seconds for seventy-two inch (72") diameter manholes. If the manhole fails the initial test, necessary repairs shall be made. Retesting shall proceed until a satisfactory test is obtained. Tests shall be performed by the Contractor under the direction of the city. SECTION IV Page 64 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications 405-4. RAVEN 405 EPDXY COATING SYSTEM This specification shall govern all work to spray/apply a monolithic epoxy material to the wall, channel, invert and bench surfaces of brick, concrete, or any other construction material; Raven 405 product or approved equal. Described are procedures for manhole cleaning preparation, application of material and testing. The applicator must be approved, trained, and certified as having successfully completed factory training. The applicator/contractor shall furnish all labor, equipment, and materials for applying the Raven 405 product directly to the contour of the manhole to form a structural liner of a minimum 125 mil thickness using a machine specially designed for the application. As it is the intention of the city to rehabilitate the entire structure; corbel, walls, bench, and channel/trough the contractor will be required to provide by-pass pumping as necessary if the cure time exceeds one (1) hour. In no case will flow through plugs be allowed. All aspects of the installation shall be in accordance with the manufacturer's recommendations and with the following specifications: 1. The elimination of active infiltration prior to making the application. 2. The removal of any loose and unsound material. 3. Preparing the manhole to provide a clean, dry, sound and monolithically smooth surface 4. The spray application of a Solvent -free epoxy coating to be applied to specified thickness 405-4.1. SUBMITTALS Submittals shall be made in accordance with the following: 1. Technical data sheet on each product used, including ASTM test results indicating the product conforms to and is suitable for its intended use per these specifications. 2. Safety Data Sheets (SDS) for each product used. 3. Project specific guidelines and recommendations. 4. Applicator Qualifications: a. Manufacturer certification that the Applicator has been trained in the handling, mixing and application of the products to be used. b. Certification that the equipment to be used for applying the products has been approved by the protective coating manufacturer and Applicator personnel have been trained and certified for proper use of the equipment. c. Written document providing three (3) years of experience and five (5) recent references of Applicator indicating successful application of a 100% solids high -build solvent -free coating by spray application. d. Applicator must provide written documentation of having installed a minimum of 50,000 square feet of plural component spray applied epoxy coating the same or similar to that specified within the last two (2) years. e. Proof of any necessary federal, state, or local permits or licenses necessary for the project. 405-4.2. MATERIALS 405-4.2.1. PATCHING MIX Strong Seal, or approved equal, shall be used as a patching mix according to the manufacturer's recommendations and shall have the following minimum requirements: 1. Compressive Strength (ASTM C-109) 15 min., 200 psi; 6 hrs., 1,400 psi 2. Shrinkage (ASTM C-596) 28 days, 150 psi 3. Bond (ASTM C-952) 28 days, 150 psi 4. Cement Sulfate resistance SECTION IV Page 65 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 • • SECTION IV — Technical Specifications 5. Density, when applied 105 +/- 5 pcf 405-4.2.2. INFILTRATION CONTROL Strong Plug, or approved equal, shall be used to stop minor water infiltration according to the manufacturer's recommendations and shall have the followin>; minimum requirements: 1. Compressive strength (ASTM C109) 600 psi, 1 hr.; 1000 psi 24 hrs. 2. Bond (ASTM C1072) 30 psi, 1 hr.; 80 psi, 24 hrs. 405-4.2.3. GROUTING MIX Strong -Seal Grout, or approved equal, shall be used for stopping very active infiltration and filling voids according to the manufacturer's recommendations. The grout shall be volume stable and have a minimum twenty-eight (28) day compressive strength of 250 psi and one (1) day strength of 50 psi. 405-4.2.4. COATING MATERIAL Coating product shall be applied to all interior surfaces to protect the host substrate and repair materials from all forms of chemical or bacteriological attack typically found in municipal sanitary sewer systems and to impart a degree of structural enhancement. Coating product physical properties shall be substantiated through submittal of accredited third -party testing results and shall be representative of the actual field applied product and cure mechanism(s) to be employed in the field. The physical requirements must be verified by an independent third -party testing shall be ruled non-responsive and will be rejected. 100% Solids, Solvent -Free, Ultra -High Build Epoxy Coating to be spray applied to all interior surfaces of exposed concrete above the spring line or as otherwise detailed: 1. Manufacturer: Raven Lining Systems, Broken Arrow, Oklahoma 800-324-2810 or 918-615-0140 fax. 2. Product: Raven 405, or approved equal — 100% solids, solvent -free ultra -high -build epoxy system exhibiting the following characteristics: a. Product Type: amine cured epoxy b. VOC Content (ASTM D2584): 0% c. Compressive Strength, (ASTM D695): 18,000 psi d. Tensile Strength, (ASTM D638): 7,600 psi e. Flexural Modulus, (ASTM D790): 700,000 psi f. Adhesion to Concrete, (ASTM D4541/7234): >200 psi with substrate (concrete) failure g. Chemical Resistance (ASTM D543/G20) immersion service for: • Municipal sanitary sewer environment • Sulfuric Acid, 30% • Sodium Hydroxide, 10% • Sodium Hypochlorite, 3% h. Successful Pass: Sanitation District of L.A. County Coating Evaluation Study and SSPWC 210.2.3.3 (Greenbook "Pickle Jar" Chemical Resistance test) 100% Solids, Solvent -Free, Ultra -High Build Epoxy Coating to be manually or spray applied to interior surfaces of exposed concrete above or below the typical flow line; specifically designed for accelerated cure and suitable for release of flow in less than 45 minutes at normal service temperatures or as otherwise detailed. 405-4.2.5. OTHER MATERIALS • No other material shall be used with the mixes previously described without prior city approval. SECTION IV Page 66 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications 405-4.3. INSTALLATION AND EXECUTION 405-4.3.1. PREPARATION 1. All foreign material shall be removed from the manhole wall and bench using a high-pressure water spray (minimum 5,000 psi). Loose and protruding brick, mortar and concrete shall be removed using a mason's hammer and chisel and/or scraper. Fill any large voids with brick and quick setting patching mix. 2. Active leaks shall be stopped using quick setting specially formulated mixes according to the manufacturer's recommendations. When severe infiltration is present, drilling may be required in order to pressure grout using a cementitious grout. Manufacturer's recommendations shall be followed when pressure grouting is required. 3. Any bench, invert/channel/trough or service line repairs shall be made at this time using the quick setting mix and following the manufacturer's recommendations. 4. Any active flows shall be dammed, plugged, or diverted as required to ensure all liquids are maintained below or away from the surfaces to be coated until final applications are cured as recommended by the manufacturer. 5. The area between the corbel and the manhole frame and any other area that might exhibit movement or cracking due to expansion and contraction shall be grouted with a flexible grout or gel. A termination groove "key" cut into the substrate between the bottom of the manhole frame and concrete is recommended for placement of the flexible grout or gel. The "key" shall be a minimum '/a" w x 1/4" d, cut at a minimum 45° angle (60° maximum). 6. Prior to commencing surface preparation, Contractor shall inspect all surfaces specified to receive the coating and notify city, in writing, of any noticeable disparity in the site, structure or surfaces which may interfere with the work, use of materials or procedures as specified herein. 405-4.3.2. APPLICATION Application procedures shall conform to the recommendations of the coating product(s) manufacturer, including environmental controls, product handling, mixing, application equipment, and methods. Spray equipment shall be specifically designed to accurately ratio and apply the coating product(s) and s Prepared surfaces shall be coated via spray application of the coating product(s) described herein unless otherwise recommended by the coating product manufacturer. In all cases the coating product shall be applied to a minimum dry film thickness of 125 mils to surface profiles. Subsequent top coating or additional coats of the coating product(s) shall occur within the products recoat window. Additional surface preparation procedures will be required if this recoat window is exceeded. Coating product(s) shall interface with adjoining construction materials/components throughout the manhole structure to effectively seal and protect substrates from attack by corrosive elements and to ensure the effective elimination of infiltration into the sewer system. Termination points of the coating product(s) shall be made at the manhole frame and corbel joint (or other man way as is present), and a minimum of 1" interfacing within each pipe penetrating the structure. The corbel/cone to manhole frame joint shall be sealed according to Section 405-7. The entire bench and invert/channel/trough will be thoroughly coated noting that the invert/channel/trough area will be sprayed in a manner that provides a gradual slope through the structure while achieving 125 mils thickness coverage. 405-4.4. TESTING & ACCEPTANCE Coating system thickness shall be inspected to ensure compliance with the specifications herein. 1. During application a wet film thickness gauge, meeting ASTM D4414 (latest edition) - Standard Practice for Measurement of Wet Film Thickness of Organic Coatings by Notched Gages, shall be SECTION IV Page 67 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV —Technical Specifications • used. Measurements shall be taken, documented, and attested to by Contractor for submission to the city. 2. After the coating product(s) have cured in accordance with manufacturer recommendations, coating system thickness shall be measured according to SSPC-PA 9 - Measurement of Dry Coating Thickness on Cementitious Substrates Using Ultrasonic Gages. High voltage holiday detection for coating systems installed in corrosive environments, when it can be safely and effectively employed, shall be performed to ensure monolithic protection of the substrate. After the coating product(s) have cured in accordance with manufacturer recommendations, all surfaces shall be inspected for holidays in accordance with NACE RPO 188-99 Discontinuity (Holiday) Testing of New Protective Coatings on Conductive Substrates or ASTM D4787 Standard Practice for Continuity Verification of Liquid or Sheet Linings Applied to Concrete Substrates. All detected holidays shall be marked and repaired according to the coating product(s) manufacturer's recommendations. 1. Test voltage shall be a minimum of 100 volts per mil of coating system thickness. 2. Detection of a known or induced holiday in the coating product shall be confirmed to ensure proper operation of the test unit. 3. All areas repaired shall be retested following cure of the repair material(s). 4. In instances where high voltage holiday detection is not feasible a close visual inspection shall be conducted, and all possible holidays shall be marked and repaired as described above. 5. Documentation of areas tested, equipment employed, results, and repairs made shall be submitted to the city by the Contractor. Adhesion of the coating system to the substrate shall be confirmed in a minimum of 10% of the manholes coated, or for large structures once every 1000 square feet of coated area. After the coating product(s) have cured in accordance with manufacturer recommendations, testing shall be conducted in accordance with • ASTM D7234 Pull -Off Adhesion Strength of Coatings on Concrete Using Portable Pull -Off Adhesion Testers. city's Project Manager shall select the manholes/areas to be tested. 1. For each test manhole a minimum of three 20 mm dollies shall be affixed to the coated surface; one at the cone/corbel area, one at the midsection and one near the bottom of the structure. 2. For larger structures a minimum of three 20 mm dollies shall be affixed to the coated surface at random locations within each 1000 square foot area or as otherwise agreed upon. 3. The adhesive used to attach the dollies to the coating shall be rapid setting with tensile strengths in excess of at least twice the anticipated failure point (generally 1000 psi) and permitted to cure in accordance with manufacturer recommendations. The coating and dollies shall be adequately cleaned and prepared to receive the adhesive. Failure of the dolly adhesive shall be deemed a non - test and require retesting. 4. Prior to performing the pull test, the coating shall be scored to the substrate, or within 10 mils of the substrate surface, by mechanical means without disturbing the dolly or coating system bond within the test area. 5. Two of the three adhesion pulls in each test area shall exceed 200 psi and shall include substrate adhered to the back of the dolly or no visual signs of the coating product in the test hole. Pulls tests with results between 150 and 200 psi may be acceptable if more than 50 percent of the substrate in the test area is adhered to the dolly. 6. Should a structure, or area, fail to achieve two successful pulls as described above, additional testing shall be performed at the discretion of the Owner or Project Engineer. Any areas detected to have inadequate bond strength shall be evaluated by the city. Further bond tests may be performed in that area to determine the extent of potentially deficient bonded area and repairs shall be made by Contractor. 7. All adhesion testing shall be performed by qualified personnel using calibrated equipment as specified by the applicable ASTM standard(s). • SECTION IV Page 68 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications 8. All adhesion testing shall be documented and submitted in a consistent format detailing location, test values, description of the failure point/mode, scoring method employed, adhesive used, cure time of coating and adhesive and other data as deemed necessary by the city. 9. All adhesion test locations shall be repaired by the Contractor at no cost to the city. 10. Visual inspection shall be made by the Project Engineer and/or Inspector. Any deficiencies in the finished coating affecting the performance of the coating system or the operational functionality of the structure shall be marked and repaired according to the recommendations of the coating product(s) manufacturer. 405-5. SPRAYWALL POLYURETHANE COATING SYSTEM This specification shall govern all work to spray/apply a monolithic polyurethane material to the wall, channel, invert and bench surfaces of brick, concrete, or any other construction material; SprayWall product or approved equal. Described are procedures for manhole cleaning preparation, application of material and testing. The applicator must be approved, trained and certified as having successfully completed factory training. The applicator/contractor shall furnish all labor, equipment and materials for applying the SprayWall product directly to the contour of the manhole to form a structural liner of a minimum 125 thickness using a machine specially designed for the application. As it is the intention of the city to rehabilitate the entire structure; corbel, walls, bench and channel/trough the contractor will be required to provide by-pass pumping as the necessary if the cure time exceeds one (1) hour. In no case will flow through plugs be allowed. All aspects of the installation shall be in accordance with the manufacturer's recommendations and with the following specifications: 1. The elimination of active infiltration prior to making the application. 2. The removal of any loose and unsound material. 3. Preparing the manhole to provide a clean, dry, sound and monolithically smooth surface 4. The spray application of a Solvent -free polyurethane coating to be applied to specified thickness. 405-5.1. SUBMITTALS The following items shall be submitted: 1. Technical data sheet on each product used, including ASTM test results indicating the product conforms to and is suitable for its intended use per these specifications. 2. Safety Data Sheets (SDS) for each product used. 3. Project specific guidelines and recommendations. 4. Applicator Qualifications: a. Manufacturer certification that the Applicator has been trained in the handling, mixing and application of the products to be used. b. Certification that the equipment to be used for applying the products has been approved by the protective coating manufacturer and Applicator personnel have been trained and certified for proper use of the equipment. c. Written document providing three (3) years of experience and five (5) recent references of Applicator indicating successful application of a 100% solids high -build solvent -free coating by spray application. d. Written document stating that the contractor has installed a minimum of 50,000 square feet of plural component spray applied polyurethane coating the same or similar to that specified within the last two (2) years. e. Proof of any necessary federal, state or local permits or licenses necessary for the project. SECTION IV Page 69 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 • SECTION IV — Technical Specifications 405-5.2. MATERIALS 405-5.2.1. PATCHING MIX Strong Seal, or approved equal, shall be used as a patching mix according to the manufacturer's recommendations and shall have the following minimum requirements: 1. Compressive Strength (ASTM C109) 15 min., 200 psi; 6 hrs., 1,400 psi 2. Shrinkage (ASTM C596) 28 days, 150 psi 3. Bond (ASTM C952) 28 days, 150 psi 4. Cement Sulfate resistant 735,000 psi 5. Density, when applied 105 +/- 5 pcf 405-5.2.2. INFILTRATION CONTROL Strong Plug, or approved equal, shall be used to stop minor water infiltration according to the manufacturer's recommendations and shall have the following minimum requirements: 1. Compressive strength (ASTM C109) 600 psi, 1 hr.; 1000 psi 24 hrs. 2. Bond (ASTM C952) 30 psi, 1 hr.; 80 psi, 24 hrs. 405-5.2.3. GROUTING MIX Strong -Seal Grout, or approved equal, shall be used for stopping very active infiltration and filling voids according to the manufacturer's recommendations. The grout shall be volume stable and have a minimum twenty-eight (28) day compressive strength of 250 psi and a one (1) day strength of 50 psi. 405-5.2.4. COATING MATERIAL • The resin -based material shall be used to form the sprayed structurally enhanced monolithic liner covering all interior surfaces of the structure, including benches and channels/troughs of manholes. The finished liner shall be SprayWall® as manufactured by Sprayroq, Inc. or approved equal and conform to the minimum physical requirements listed below. A minimum of 125 mil. coating thickness is required. • The physical requirements must be verified by an independent, certified, third party testing laboratory within the last five years and must be submitted with the bid package. Any bid package not including the verifiable, independent third -party testing shall be ruled non-responsive and will be rejected. 1. VOC Content (ASTM D2584) 0% 2. Compressive Strength, (ASTM D695) 18,000 psi 3. Tensile Strength, (ASTM D638) > 7,450 psi 4. Flexural Modulus, (ASTM D790) 735,000 psi 5. Adhesion to Concrete, (ASTM D4541/7234) >200 psi with substrate (concrete) failure 6. Chemical Resistance (ASTM D543/G20) immersion service for: • Municipal sanitary sewer environment • Sulfuric Acid, 30% • Sodium Hydroxide, 10% • Sodium Hypochlorite, 3% 7. Successful Pass: Sanitation District of L.A. County Coating Evaluation Study and SSPWC 210.2.3.3 (Greenbook "Pickle Jar" Chemical Resistance test) The initial flexural modulus of elasticity (short term) of the submitted resin material will be utilized with the long-term deformation percentage as determined by ASTM D2990 (see below) in the design equation outlined in ASTM 1216-09, Appendix X1. The value of the long-term flexural modulus of the proposed product will be certified by an independent, certified, third party testing lab, independent of the SECTION IV Page 70 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications Manufacturer and submitted with the bid package. [The definition of long-term value will be identified as initial flexural VER 01 w/Flat Wall 2015 Page 7 of 12 modulus of elasticity less the reduction in value caused by Creep over a fifty (50) year minimum period and verified by third party DMA testing (ASTM D2990).] All design submittals will include this certified third -party DMA testing (ASTM D2990) value in their respective design calculations for each structure being rehabilitated. Coating product physical properties shall be substantiated through submittal of accredited third -party testing results and shall be representative of the actual field applied product and cure mechanism(s) to be employed in the field. Polyurethane coating to be manually or spray applied to interior surfaces of exposed concrete above or below the typical flow line; specifically designed for accelerated cure and suitable for release of flow in less than 45 minutes at normal service temperatures or as otherwise detailed. 405-5.2.5. OTHER MATERIALS No other material shall be used with the mixes previously described without prior approval or recommendation from the manufacturer. 405-5.3. INSTALLATION AND EXECUTION 405-5.3.1. PREPARATION 1. All foreign material shall be removed from the manhole wall and bench using a high-pressure water spray (minimum 5,000 psi). Loose and protruding brick, mortar and concrete shall be removed using a mason's hammer and chisel and/or scraper. Fill any large voids with brick and quick setting patching mix. 2. Active leaks shall be stopped using quick setting specially formulated mixes according to the manufacturer's recommendations. When severe infiltration is present, drilling may be required in order to pressure grout using a cementitious grout. Manufacturer's recommendations shall be followed when pressure grouting is required. 3. Any bench, invert/channel/trough or service line repairs shall be made at this time using the quick setting mix and following the manufacturer's recommendations. 4. Any active flows shall be dammed, plugged, or diverted as required to ensure all liquids are maintained below or away from the surfaces to be coated until final applications are cured as recommended by the manufacturer. 5. The area between the corbel and the manhole frame and any other area that might exhibit movement or cracking due to expansion and contraction, shall be grouted with a flexible grout or gel (Sikadur 42 Grout Pak LE, Pro-Stik Butyl Sealant, or equal). A termination groove "key" cut into the substrate between the bottom of the manhole frame and concrete is recommended for placement of the flexible grout or gel. The "key" shall be a minimum 1/4" w x'/4" d, cut at a minimum 45° angle (60° maximum). 6. Prior to commencing surface preparation, Contractor shall inspect all surfaces specified to receive the coating and notify city, in writing, of any noticeable disparity in the site, structure or surfaces which may interfere with the work, use of materials or procedures as specified herein. 405-5.3.2. APPLICATION Application procedures shall conform to the recommendations of the protective coating manufacturer, including material handling, mixing, environmental controls during application, safety, and spray equipment. The spray equipment shall be specifically designed to accurately ratio and apply the specified protective coating materials and shall be regularly maintained and in proper working order. SECTION IV Page 71 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 • • • SECTION IV — Technical Specifications The protective coating material must be spray applied by a Certified Applicator of the protective coating manufacturer. Specified surfaces shall be coated by spray application of a solvent -free, 100% solids, rigid polyurethane structural lining as further described herein. Airless spray application equipment approved by the coating manufacturer shall be used to apply each coat of the protective coating. The air source is to be filtered to completely remove all oil and water. If necessary, subsequent top coating or additional coats of the protective coating should occur as soon as the basecoat becomes tack free, no later than the recoat window for the specified products. Additional surface preparation procedures will be required if this recoat window is exceeded. The roughness of the substrate will dictate the thickness needed to create the monolithic liner and eliminate any opportunity for voids in the coating. The minimum value for coating thickness shall be a minimum 125 mils. Coating product(s) shall interface with adjoining construction materials/components throughout the manhole structure to effectively seal and protect substrates from attack by corrosive elements and to ensure the effective elimination of infiltration into the sewer system. Termination points of the coating product(s) shall be made at the manhole frame and corbel joint (or other man way as is present), and a minimum of 1" interfacing within each pipe penetrating the structure. The entire bench and invert/channel/trough will be thoroughly coated noting that the invert/channel/trough area will be sprayed in a manner that provides a gradual slope through the structure while achieving 125 mils. thickness coverage. 405-5.4. TESTING & ACCEPTANCE Coating system thickness shall be inspected to ensure compliance with the specifications herein. 1. During application a wet film thickness gauge, meeting ASTM D4414 - Standard Practice for Measurement of Wet Film Thickness of Organic Coatings by Notched Gages, shall be used. Measurements shall be taken, documented, and attested to by Contractor for submission to the city. 2. After the coating product(s) have cured in accordance with manufacturer recommendations, coating system thickness may be measured according to SSPC-PA 9 - Measurement of Dry Coating Thickness on Cementitious Substrates Using Ultrasonic Gages. High voltage holiday detection for coating systems installed in corrosive environments, when it can be safely and effectively employed, shall be performed to ensure monolithic protection of the substrate. After the coating product(s) have cured in accordance with manufacturer recommendations, all surfaces shall be inspected for holidays in accordance with NACE RPO 188-99 Discontinuity (Holiday) Testing of New Protective Coatings on Conductive Substrates or ASTM D4787 Standard Practice for Continuity Verification of Liquid or Sheet Linings Applied to Concrete Substrates. All detected holidays shall be marked and repaired according to the coating product(s) manufacturer's recommendations. 1. Test voltage shall be a minimum of 100 volts per mil of coating system thickness. 2. Detection of a known or induced holiday in the coating product shall be confirmed to ensure proper operation of the test unit. 3. All areas repaired shall be retested following cure of the repair material(s). 4. In instances where high voltage holiday detection is not feasible a close visual inspection shall be conducted, and all possible holidays shall be marked and repaired as described above. 5. Documentation of areas tested, equipment employed, results, and repairs made shall be submitted to the city by the Contractor. Adhesion of the coating system to the substrate shall be confirmed in a minimum of 10% of the manholes coated, or for large structures once every 1000 square feet of coated area. After the coating product(s) have cured in accordance with manufacturer recommendations, testing shall be conducted in accordance with SECTION IV Page 72 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications ASTM D7234 Pull -Off Adhesion Strength of Coatings on Concrete Using Portable Pull -Off Adhesion Testers. City's Project Manager shall select the manholes/areas to be tested. 1. For each test manhole a minimum of three 20 mm dollies shall be affixed to the coated surface; one at the cone/corbel area, one at the midsection and one near the bottom of the structure. 2. For larger structures a minimum of three 20 mm dollies shall be affixed to the coated surface at random locations within each 1000 square foot area or as otherwise agreed upon. 3. The adhesive used to attach the dollies to the coating shall be rapid setting with tensile strengths in excess of at least twice the anticipated failure point (generally 1000 psi) and permitted to cure in accordance with manufacturer recommendations. The coating and dollies shall be adequately cleaned and prepared to receive the adhesive. Failure of the dolly adhesive shall be deemed a non - test and require retesting. 4. Prior to performing the pull test, the coating shall be scored to the substrate, or within 10 mils of the substrate surface, by mechanical means without disturbing the dolly or coating system bond within the test area. 5. Two of the three adhesion pulls in each test area shall exceed 200 psi and shall include substrate adhered to the back of the dolly or no visual signs of the coating product in the test hole. Pulls tests with results between 150 and 200 psi may be acceptable if more than 50 percent of the substrate in the test area is adhered to the dolly. 6. Should a structure, or area, fail to achieve two successful pulls as described above, additional testing shall be performed at the discretion of the Owner or Project Engineer. Any areas detected to have inadequate bond strength shall be evaluated by the city. Further bond tests may be performed in that area to determine the extent of potentially deficient bonded area and repairs shall be made by Contractor. 7. All adhesion testing shall be performed by qualified personnel using calibrated equipment as specified by the applicable ASTM standard(s). 8. All adhesion testing shall be documented and submitted in a consistent format detailing location, test values, description of the failure point/mode, scoring method employed, adhesive used, cure time of coating and adhesive and other data as deemed necessary by the city. 9. All adhesion test locations shall be repaired by the Contractor at no cost to the city. 10. Visual inspection shall be made by the city's agent and/or Inspector. Any deficiencies in the finished coating affecting the performance of the coating system or the operational functionality of the structure shall be marked and repaired according to the recommendations of the coating product(s) manufacturer. 405-6. INTERNAL MANHOLE CORBEL SEALING SYSTEM This specification shall govern all work to spray/apply a monolithic polyurea material to the frame and adjacent corbel surfaces of brick, concrete or any other construction material. The work covered by this item includes but is not limited to furnishing all labor, equipment, materials and supervision, and performing all work necessary to seal the manhole as specified herein or equal to the manhole through the frame joint area and the area above the manhole corbel/cone. Described are procedures for manhole/frame cleaning preparation, application of material and testing. The applicator must be approved, trained and certified as having successfully completed factory training. The applicator/contractor shall furnish all labor, equipment and materials for applying the product directly to the manhole and frame joint with a minimum of 6 -inch overlap on each surface and a minimum thickness of 125 mils. All aspects of the installation shall be in accordance with the manufacturer's recommendations and with the following specifications: 1. The removal of any rust or loose and unsound material. SECTION IV Page 73 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications 2. Preparing the manhole corbel/cone and frame to provide a clean, dry, sound and monolithically smooth surface 3. The spray application of a Solvent -free polyurea coating to be applied to specified thickness. 405-6.1. SUBMITTALS The following items shall be submitted: 1. Technical data sheet, including ASTM test results indicating the product conforms to and is suitable for its intended use per these specifications. 2. Safety Data Sheet for the product (SDS). 3. Project specific guidelines and recommendations. 4. Applicator Qualifications: a. Manufacturer certification that the Applicator has been trained in the handling, mixing and application of the products to be used. b. Certification that the equipment to be used for applying the products has been approved by the protective coating manufacturer and Applicator personnel have been trained and certified for proper use of the equipment. c. Written document providing three (3) years of experience and five (5) recent references of Applicator indicating successful application of a 100% solids high -build solvent -free coating by spray application. d. Proof of any necessary federal, state, or local permits or licenses necessary for the project. 405-6.2. MATERIALS • 405-6.2.1. PATCHING MIX Strong Seal, or approved equal, shall be used as a patching mix according to the manufacturer's • recommendations and shall have the followin minimum requirements: 1. Compressive Strength (ASTM C109) 15 min., 200 psi; 6 hrs.; 1,400 psi 2. Shrinkage (ASTM C596) 28 days, 150 psi 3. Bond (ASTM C952) 28 days, 150 psi 4. Cement Sulfate resistant 5. Density, when applied 105 +/- 5 pcf 405-6.2.2. INFILTRATION CONTROL Strong Plug, or approved equal, shall be used to stop minor water infiltration according to the manufacturer's recommendations and shall have the following minimum requirements: 1. Compressive strength (ASTM C109) 600 psi, 1 hr.; 1000 psi 24 hrs. 2. Bond (ASTM C952) 30 psi, 1 hr.; 80 psi, 24 hrs. 405-6.2.3. COATING MATERIAL Manhole seal shall be designed to prevent leakage of water into the manhole through the frame joint area and the area above the manhole cone including all extensions to the corbel area. The seal shall remain flexible allowing for the repeated vertical or horizontal movements of the frame due to frost lift, ground movement or the thermal movement of pavements. The final coating shall be made no less than 125 mils. of corrosion resistant aromatic or approved equal. The product shall have a minimum elongation of 800%. Final liner shall have a minimum tensile strength of 3250 psi. The manhole sealing system shall conform to the physical requirements of ASTM D412. SECTION IV Page 74 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications The physical requirements must be verified by an independent, certified, third party testing laboratory within the last five years and must be submitted with the bid package. Any bid package not including the verifiable, independent third -party testing shall be ruled non-responsive and will be rejected. 405-6.3. INSTALLATION AND EXECUTION 405-6.3.1. PREPARATION 1. All foreign material shall be removed from the manhole wall and bench using a high-pressure water spray (minimum 5,000 psi). Loose and protruding brick, mortar and concrete shall be removed using a mason's hammer and chisel and/or scraper. Fill any large voids with brick and quick setting patching mix. 2. All patching materials shall be cured prior to the installation. Preparation of the frame surface shall include sandblasting (minimum of 70 CFM) and an acetone wet wipe to ensure a clean surface as required by manufacturer on uncoated substrate. 3. If coating is to be on top of SprayWall, or Raven 405, then termination points need to be cut which are 1/4" x'/a" cut on 45° angle at top and bottom of application, then sanding of the SprayWall, or Raven 405, with 40 grit paper, cleaned and an application of Lords 7701 is required prior to application to ensure adhesion. 4. Prior to commencing surface preparation, Contractor shall inspect all surfaces specified to receive the coating and notify city, in writing, of any noticeable disparity in the site, structure or surfaces which may interfere with the work, use of materials or procedures as specified herein. 405-6.3.2. APPLICATION Application procedures shall conform to the recommendations of the polyurea coating manufacturer, including material handling, mixing, environmental controls during application, safety, and spray equipment. The spray equipment shall be specifically designed to accurately ratio and apply the specified protective coating materials and shall be regularly maintained and in proper working order. The polyuria coating material must be spray applied by a Certified Applicator of the coating manufacturer. Airless spray application equipment approved by the coating manufacturer shall be used to apply each coat of the protective coating. The air source is to be filtered to completely remove all oil and water. If necessary, subsequent top coating or additional coats of the polyurea coating should occur as soon as the basecoat becomes tack free, no later than the recoat window for the specified products. Additional surface preparation procedures will be required if this recoat window is exceeded. 405-6.3.3. TESTING & ACCEPTANCE Coating system thickness shall be inspected to ensure compliance with the specifications herein. 1. During application a wet film thickness gauge, meeting ASTM D4414 - Standard Practice for Measurement of Wet Film Thickness of Organic Coatings by Notched Gages, shall be used. Measurements shall be taken, documented, and attested to by Contractor for submission to the city. 2. After the coating product(s) have cured in accordance with manufacturer recommendations, coating system thickness may be measured according to SSPC-PA 9 - Measurement of Dry Coating Thickness on Cementitious Substrates Using Ultrasonic Gages. 3. Visual inspection shall be made by the city's agent and/or Inspector. Any deficiencies in the finished coating affecting the performance of the coating system or the operational functionality of the structure shall be marked and repaired according to the recommendations of the coating product(s) manufacturer. The contractor shall warrantee proper adhesion of the coating material to the frame and corbel/cone for a minimum of ten (10) years. SECTION IV Page 75 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications • 406. SMOKE AND DYE TESTING 406-1. GENERAL PROTOCOL Conduct smoke testing of gravity sewers for defects and identify manholes which could not be located, and all new structures not shown on GIS. Smoke and Dye testing will be completed using the following Protocols: Smoke testing will provide detailed information on wet weather inflow sources to the sanitary sewer. In order to identify collection system defects and illicit connections, non-toxic smoke will be forced into the sewer by high-capacity blower capable of achieving a minimum of 1,750 cfin of airflow. Any break in the sewer will allow the smoke to escape provided the smoke machine generates sufficient pressure. One line segment will be tested at one time with plugging. The maximum length of sewer to be smoke tested in a single setup shall be 400 linear feet per blower. Dual blower smoke testing shall be performed for pipe sections over 400 linear feet with a maximum of 800 linear feet. Smoke testing shall not be performed during or following weather conditions that may impair detecting escaping smoke (i.e. very windy, rainy, or high groundwater conditions, etc.) Smoke testing will not be performed on surcharged lines. In case of surcharged lines, the selected Contractor will contact the city and identify the issue. Once the surcharge has been eliminated, the city will contact the selected Contractor to re -smoke the test area. Smoke testing will document when smoke does not travel the entire length of piping, or when smoke is not detected at the roof stack of connecting buildings. In these cases, CCTV inspection (by others) will be required of both mainline and lateral piping. When a defect is identified as being a potential significant inflow source it will be recommended for dye testing. The smoke shall be non-toxic, odorless, and non -staining. A Safety Data Sheet shall be submitted and approved by city prior to the commencement of smoke testing. Prior to testing, the selected Contractor shall submit a schedule outlining test dates and locations to the city, three weeks prior to commencing the smoke testing. The selected Contractor shall prepare Smoke Testing notices (English & Spanish) advising residents and local authorities of the smoke testing program. The notices shall be approved by the city prior to distribution. Extra copies of the notices will be provided to the city for distribution to other city agencies, including the Fire Department, Police Department, Emergency Services and others. The selected Contractor shall distribute smoke testing notices to residences in the project area including the local fire and police precincts, approximately 48-72 hours in advance of the smoke testing. For large facilities such as schools or hospitals, a log will be maintained that documents the property manager's notification of planned smoke testing activities. A local Contractor's telephone number will be provided for those individuals with questions or for anyone requiring special assistance. Field personnel will be uniformed and will conspicuously display identification badges. Private individuals requesting additional identification will be asked to contact the city and crews shall carry a letter from the city authorizing the holder of the letter to perform the work described. Each day the fire department and other affected agencies will be notified of the crew location since smoke may enter homes through defective plumbing. 406-2. REPORTING Field results shall be documented in an Excel spreadsheet and on printed maps. The Excel spreadsheet shall include the following information: a. defect and photo number b. address and locations of defects c. type of defect found d. is defect public or private e. address of residences that did not smoke during testing and residents' houses that were smoked with defect description (if possible) SECTION IV Page 76 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications f. address of residences that did not have a cleanout plug(s) or lids and or in low-lying areas g. manholes ID on those with no manhole inserts, with debris, or in low-lying areas h. any defective sewer mains found in the field. The printed and digital maps shall include the following: a. boundary of the test area b. sanitary sewer line segments tested c. location and boundary of blower setups d. locations of defects with defect number and photo of defect e. address of residences that did not smoke during testing (plumbing roof vent: negative) and residences that smoke in house f. ID numbers for manhole missing water -tight manhole inserts g. location of smoking storm sewer catches basins The field documentation will include: a. sketched of the location and nature of each system defect b. pertinent information for prioritizing repair of the defects c. information needed to assess the best mitigation method d. color digital photographs will be taken to document defects during smoke testing e. location of defect will be measured from permanent objects (corner of house, light pole, etc.). In addition to the standard documentation procedure, each smoke testing crew will be equipped with a computer tablet which is `blue -toothed' to a GPS receiver. The crew can see their location on the downloaded `cloud -based' map and as inflow sources are identified photographs will be taken to document each defect and an X, Y coordinate value will be assigned to each image. As each defect image is automatically uploaded to the `cloud -based' map a defect type code will be attached to the image. Each inflow source or defect can then be displayed on the map and each defect type is assigned a different symbol/color/indicator. This form of documentation allows for comprehensive QA/QC of each completed smoke test and assurance that no defect is left unrecorded. The following is an overview of the required smoke testing process and reporting. 1. Field review the area selected area and note on the map all "hundred block" addresses. 2. Distribute smoke notice to all homes, businesses, schools, police and Fire & Rescue, etc. In addition, Fire & Rescue will be notified of any proposed smoke testing activities forty-eight to seventy-two hours prior to initiation. 3. During the initial field review, identify all types of businesses, specifically any doctors' offices, hospitals, schools, retirement homes (communities), assisted living facilities (ALFs), or any other establishment that may need special consideration and handling during the actual smoke test. Strict consideration and coordination with customers who have sensitive needs must be adhered to, some of whom will not be included on any smoke testing schedule as the nature of their business, such as hospitals, is far too delicate. 4. Twenty -Four hours minimum must expire from the issuance of smoke testing notices to allow all affected to prepare for the testing. For special exceptions, such ALFs and persons with health problems living at home, etc., direct in person of telephone contact shall be made if at all possible. 5. On the day of the testing, the selected portion of the study area will be identified and all street names and related hundred block addresses will be given to the police and fire department/emergency personnel for the area where the testing will occur. UNDER NO CIRCUMSTANCES WILL THE AREA SELECTED FOR THAT DAY'S TESTING BE MODIFIED TO INCLUDE ADDITIONAL WORK UNLESS THE POLICE & FIRE DEPARTMENT/EMERGENCY PERSONNEL HAVE BEEN NOTIFIED FIRST. The name and ID number of the fire department person contacted will be documented on the appropriate form. SECTION IV Page 77 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 • • • SECTION IV — Technical Specifications The fire department/emergency personnel will be provided the exact locations and specific time frames of where and when the tests will be performed. 6. Multi -day scheduling with one-time reporting to the police and fire department/emergency personnel will not be permitted. 7. The city's Project Manager will be notified on a daily basis with the same information. 8. Should the fire department/emergency personnel respond to the target area during the actual smoke testing, all testing will cease immediately and the Smoke Testing Team's field supervisor in charge will contact the fire unit responding to answer any questions that the fire department officer may have. 9. All testing activity will cease when any resident complains of smoke entering their establishment. Smoke Testing Team's field personnel will then attempt to isolate where the smoke is entering the establishment and make the occupant aware of what the problem may be. All defective plumbing found inside should be documented appropriately for future reference. The occupant will be advised to have the defect repaired by a licensed plumber. 10. During the actual smoke testing, Smoke Testing Team field personnel will scout the area for smoke escaping from ground sources, roof vents, storm drain structures, etc. All sources of Rainfall Dependent Infiltration/Inflow will be photographed, measured, drawn, and documented accordingly with addresses, data, and sketches. The smoke test form will identify which sewer segment is being tested by its component identification in the city's GIS database. 11. All defects encountered will also be recorded using handheld tablets 'blue tooth' to a GPS receiver. The tablet will have access to the city's wastewater collection system GIS which will be overlaid on a digital ortho map and the GPS unit will allow the smoke test team member to see his location on the map in real time and allow for the accurate recording of a defect's type and location. Each defect image taken will be geocoded to a specific location and the information will be stored electronically for future use. It is understood that the city staff members may accompany the selected Contractor's field staff during the smoke testing initiative to gain a better understanding of how to quantify potential inflow volumes from the smoke defects recorded and how to compare the smoke testing defect results to the previously recorded flow data. It is further understood that the selected Contractor's staff will install cleanout plugs and storm water manhole inflow dishes (provided by the city) concurrently with the smoke testing operations. The selected Contractor will develop a `Smoke Testing Results' spreadsheet that identifies each pipe section tested and the results of the test, whether positive or negative. A separate spreadsheet: `Smoke Testing Defects', will be prepared that identifies all defects encountered during the smoke testing activity. This spreadsheet will contain a column which identifies the surface area associated with each defect, and if there is a need to conduct dye water testing/flooding. 406-3. DYE INVESTIGATION The results of the smoke testing may not always clearly or positively indicate the source of a sanitary sewer interconnection or defect. Further investigation may be required to fully define the I/1 sources or defects under the following conditions: 1. Smoke injected into the sanitary sewer is seen in storm sewer catch basins. This may be caused by defective catch basin laterals in the vicinity of the sanitary sewer (if the sanitary sewer has open joints, cracks or breaks). Dye testing may be needed to determine if the catch basin is connected to the sanitary sewer. CCTV (by others) of the sanitary sewer may be needed to identify the point of the smoke exfiltration. 2. Smoke does not freely pass from one manhole to the next, or vent from property's roof stack/ roof plumbing vent, during the sanitary sewer smoke testing. CCTV (by others) of the sanitary sewer/lateral may be needed to identify sewer blockages or pipe sags. SECTION IV Page 78 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications Upon completion of the initial smoke testing within a service area, the selected Contractor will submit a list of locations that require further investigation to the city. Upon approval from the city, the city may request the selected contractor to accompany a city diagnostic crew to further investigate the inconclusive smoke test results. Techniques employed by the city may include dye testing, CCTV inspections (by others) manhole/catch basin inspection, sewer line lamping (by others), and storm sewer cleaning (by others). Where initial smoke test results warrant further investigation as approved by the city, a non-toxic dye approved by the city will be used to investigate specific potential interconnections. Contractor shall submit the SDS for all dyes used. Storm sewer cross -connections and area drains that are suspected of being connected to the sanitary sewer will be positively identified using the dye tracer procedure. Laterals suspected of having significant leaks or breaks will also be investigated. Field documentation, including sketches showing the location of all tests conducted and digital photographs, where feasible, will be used to record findings. Internal pipeline inspection will determine the exact source of the suspected interconnection and establish the best abatement option. The following identifies the dye water protocols to be implemented. 406-3.1. DYE WATER TRACING Private/Public sector dye water tracing will be conducted by introducing a small quantity of liquid dye concentrate into suspect sources such as downspouts, area drains, patio drains, window well drains, and driveway drains, and then introducing a sufficient volume of clean water to locate the source's discharge point. During each tracing, sanitary sewers, storm drains, and curb lines located downstream of the sources shall be monitored for signs of dyed water. The quantity of dye concentrate and water used will vary depending on pipe size and the quantity of flow and debris in each line section. A report will be prepared for each location where dye water tracing has been performed. The report will identify where the dye water was introduced and its' susceptibility for entering the wastewater collection system. Photos will be taken of where the dye water is introduced and where it is recorded discharging into the downstream wastewater collection system manhole. CCTV inspection equipment (by others) will be utilized to identify exactly where the dye water is entering the wastewater collection system piping. 406-3.2. DYE WATER FLOODING Dye water flooding results will be documented for each location where the storm drainage system is flooded. Each dye water flood report will identify the section of wastewater gravity piping being tested, the location(s) where the storm water system piping was isolated and flooded, photographs of each setup and CCTV inspection results (by others) identifying the location(s) where dye water was identified entering the wastewater collection system. The following information will also be documented; evidence of dyed water in manholes downstream from the ponding area, stream crossing, or other suspected sources where the dyed water is placed, and time of travel from contributing source to the manhole sampled, and the concentration of the dyed water observed; The Field Inspection Procedures for Dyed Water Flooding are as follows: 1. A mixture of water and any approved dye coloring substance will be introduced to the identified source. Dye water team inspectors will be stationed immediately downstream on the local sanitary and storm sewer lines. Observations, whether positive or negative, will be documented appropriately. Whenever possible the dyed water point of exit will be documented by CCTV inspection equipment (by others). 2. Prior to any dye testing, the appropriate city staff shall be notified of the specific location of testing and what adjacent waterways may be affected when the dye water is released into the storm drainage system. SECTION IV Page 79 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 • • • SECTION IV — Technical Specifications Fire hydrants used to supply the water source needed will be opened slowly and closed in the same manner. A flow restrictive device shall be used on the hydrant to prevent discoloration problems. Should the water be running cloudy or dirty after use, the fire hydrant shall be left open at a slow pace until the water clears. If long term draining is required, the Dye Water Team shall notify the city. 406-4. MEASUREMENT AND PAYMENT Measurement shall be the number of linear feet smoke tested and each occurrence of dye water tracing and dye water flooding. 406-5. BASIS OF PAYMENT Payment shall be based upon the unit price per linear foot for smoke testing as measured above and each occurrence of dye water tracing and dye water flooding, which shall be full compensation for all work described in this section of the specifications and shall include all materials, equipment, and labor necessary to perform the smoke and dye testing. SECTION IV Page 80 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications 500 SERIES: POTABLE AND RECLAIMED WATER MAINS, FIRE LINES AND APPURTENANCES 501. SCOPE The Contractor shall furnish all plant, labor, materials, and equipment to perform all operations in connection with the construction of potable water mains, fire lines, reclaimed water mains and appurtenances including clearing, excavation, trenching, backfilling and clean up. All materials identified and specified in this section shall be NSF 61 and ISO 9001 compliant. 502. MATERIALS 502-1. GENERAL Materials, equipment, and supplies furnished and permanently incorporated into the project shall be of the best quality in every respect and shall be constructed and finished to high standards of workmanship. Materials shall be suitable for service intended, shall reflect modern design and engineering, and shall be fabricated in a first-class workmanlike manner. All materials, equipment and supplies shall be new and shall have not been in service at any time previous to installation, except as required in tests or incident to installation. Machined metal surfaces, exposed bearings and glands shall be protected against grit, dirt, chemical corrosion and other damaging effects during shipment and construction. All materials shall be tested in accordance with the applicable Federal, ASTM or AWWA Specification and basis of rejection shall be as specified therein. Certified copies of the tests shall be submitted to the Engineer of Record with each shipment of materials. Engineer of Record shall certify and submit all material test results to the city Project Manager within 10 calendar days of performing test(s). 502-2. PIPE MATERIALS AND FITTINGS 502-2.1. DUCTILE IRON PIPE Ductile iron pipe shall conform to the requirements of ANSUAWWA C151/ A21.51, latest revision. The minimum thickness class for underground pipe shall be Thickness Class 51 for 4 -inch pipe or greater, 3" ductile iron water mains or service lines are not allowed, Thickness Class 50 for 6 -inch through 12 -inch pipe and Pressure Class 250 for 16 -inch pipe and larger. Flanged pipe shall have a minimum thickness class of Class 53. Pipe thickness class or pressure class, wall thickness and working pressure shall conform to the fol owin table: Size Thickness Class (TC) Pressure Class (PC) Thickness (In.) Rated Water Working Pressure (PSI) 4" TC51 0.26 350 6" TC50 0.25 350 8" TC50 0.27 350 12" TC50 0.31 350 16" PC250 0.31 250 20" PC250 0.33 250 SECTION IV Page 81 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 • • • SECTION IV — Technical Specifications 24" PC250 0.37 250 30" PC250 0.42 250 36" PC250 0.47 250 Pipe larger than 8 -inches in diameter or pipes which are deeper than 10 -feet shall be ductile iron only, for open cut installations. The City Engineer reserves the right to require the use of ductile iron in sizes 4 -inch through 12 -inch when needed due to laying conditions or usage. Pipe shall have a minimum rated water working pressure of 250 psi and shall be furnished in laying lengths of 20 feet or less, unless specifically shown otherwise on the Drawings. All piping and fittings shall be new and unused, no refurbished piping or fittings shall be accepted. Ductile iron pipe shall be used for all hydrant installations, large meter sets 3" or larger and for fire line installations from the main to the backflow preventer. Fittings: Fittings for bends, tees, crosses, etc. from 4 -inch through 36 -inch in size installed on ductile iron pipe shall be either mechanical joint, restrained joint or flanged joint as indicated on the Drawings and shall have a minimum working pressure of 250 psi. Fittings shall be cast ductile iron and shall conform to ANSUAWWA C110, ANSI/AWWA C111 and ANSUAWWA C153, latest revisions for flanged and mechanical joint pipe. Fittings for compact ductile iron cast fittings in accordance with ANSUAWWA C153/A 21.53, latest revision with mechanical joint bells or ductile iron cast fittings in accordance with ANSI/AWWA C110/A 21.10, latest revision with mechanical joint bells. Fittings shall be coated and lined as indicated on the Drawings, in the manner specified below for ductile iron pipe. The rubber gaskets for flanged, mechanical, and push -on joints shall be as described below. The working pressure minimum rating shall be 350 psi for 4 -inch to 24 -inch fittings. Fittings larger than 24 -inch shall be pressure rated to 250 psi minimum. Fittings shall be designed to withstand without bursting a hydrostatic test of three times the rated water working pressure. All fittings shall have a date code cast into the fitting in addition to the pressure rating and material code. Ductile iron fittings shall be coated and lined in accordance with requirements of ANSI/AWWA C104/A21.4. Mechanical joint glands shall be ductile iron in accordance with ANSI/AWWA C111/A 21.11. When reference is made to ANSI/AWWA Standards, the latest revisions shall apply. Only those fittings and accessories that are of domestic (USA) manufacture shall be acceptable. Push -On Joints: Push -on -joints shall be used for straight pipe lengths only. No fittings with push -on -joints shall be allowed. Pipe using push -on joints shall be in strict accordance with AWWA C111 and ANSI A21.11, latest revision. Jointing materials shall be provided by the pipe manufacturer and installation shall be in strict accordance with the manufacturer's recommended practice. The gaskets for push -on pipe joints shall be made of EPDM rubber. Push -on joints shall be as listed in the City of Clearwater Approved Products List, or an equal approved by the city. Mechanical Joints: Jointing materials for mechanical joints shall be provided by the pipe and fitting manufacturer. Materials assembly, bolting and gaskets shall be in strict accordance with ANSI/AWWA C111 and ANSI/AWWA C110/ A 21.10 and ANSI/AWWA C153/ A 21.53, latest revisions. Tee head bolts and nuts for underground mechanical joint ductile iron fittings shall be manufactured of CORTEN, high strength, low alloy, corrosion resistant steel in accordance with ASTM A242, or an equal approved by the Engineer. The gaskets for mechanical joints shall be made of EPDM rubber. Flanged Joints: Bolt circle and bolt holes for flanges shall be drilled and faced to match ANSI B16.1, Class 125, with any special drilling and tapping as required to insure correct alignment and bolting. All accessory hex -head bolts and nuts and full faced gaskets for each joint size shall be furnished as a flange accessory package. SECTION IV Page 82 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications 1. Gaskets: Full face, Toruseal gaskets, or approved equal shall be used for flanged pipe connections. Gaskets shall be suitable for a water pressure of 350 psi at a temperature of 180F. The gaskets for flanged joints shall be made of EPDM rubber. 2. Bolts and Nuts for Flanges: Bolts and nuts for flanges shall be Type 316 stainless steel conforming to ASTM A193, Grade B8M for bolts and ASTM A194, Grade 8M for nuts. The nuts shall have a hardness that is lower than that of the bolts and washers by a difference of 50 Brinnell hardness to prevent galling during installation. 3. Flanges shall be long -hub type screwed tightly on pipe by machine at the foundry prior to facing and drilling. Flange machine surfaces shall be coated with rust inhibitor immediately after facing and drilling. Field assembled screwed on flanges are prohibited. 502-2.1.1. MANUFACTURED RESTRAINED JOINTS FOR DUCTILE IRON PIPE Restrained Pipe Joints and Fittings: Thrust restraint for buried piping shall be provided by restrained joints. Concrete thrust blocks shall not be acceptable. Pipe joints and fittings shall be restrained in accordance with the Drawings and the requirements of this Specification. It is intended that, at a minimum, all fittings shall be restrained. In cases where the calculated required length of restrained pipe is not evenly divisible by nominal laying lengths of pipe, the total required length of restrained pipe shall be rounded up to the next closest nominal length that is evenly divisible by the standard laying length. A. Manufactured Restrained Joints: Manufactured restrained joints shall be manufacturer's standard specifically modified push -on type joints with joint restraint provided by ductile iron retainer rings joined together by corrosion -resistant, high strength steel tee head bolts and nuts or with joint restraint provided by a welded -on retainer ring and a split flexible ring assembled behind the retainer ring. Gaskets for manufactured restrained pipe joints shall be made of EPDM rubber. Manufactured restrained joints shall be as listed as an equal approved by the city. B. Gripping -Type Gasket Restraint: Gripping -type gaskets may be used for ductile iron pipe 12 -inches in size and smaller, when approved by the city. This type of restrained joint shall be the manufacturer's standard push -on type joint with joint restraint provided by a specially designed gasket with high strength stainless steel gripping elements which have sharp teeth on its inner surface for gripping the spigot end of the pipe joint. The gripping type gasket shall be made of EPDM rubber. The gripping type gasket manufacturer's joint restraint shall only be considered for use on pipe sizes from 4 -inch to 12 -inch. Gripping type gasket restraints shall be as listed in the City of Clearwater Approved Products List, or an equal approved by the city. C. Manufactured restrained joint pipe and fittings shall be ductile iron only and shall comply with applicable portions of this Specification. Manufactured restrained joints shall be capable of deflection during assembly. Deflection shall not exceed 50 percent of the manufacturer's recommendations. D. Tee head bolts and nuts for restrained joints shall be manufactured of CORTEN, high strength, low alloy, corrosion resistant steel in accordance with ASTM A242, or an equal approved by the Engineer. 502-2.1.2. ALTERNATE MECHANICALLY RESTRAINED JOINTS FOR DI PIPE Thrust restraint for buried piping shall be provided by restrained joints. Concrete thrust blocks shall not be acceptable. When prior approval is obtained from the Engineer, ductile iron pipe and fittings with mechanical joints or ductile iron pipe with push -on joints may be restrained using a follower gland or ring which includes a restraining mechanism. Joint restraints shall have a working pressure rating of 350 psi for 3 -inch to 16 -inch ductile iron pipe, 250 psi for 18 -inch to 36 -inch ductile iron pipe, with a minimum pressure SECTION IV Page 83 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 • • • SECTION IV — Technical Specifications rating safety factor of 2 to 1. The restraint shall be accomplished by multiple gripping wedges incorporated into a follower gland meeting the requirements of ANSI/AWWA C 110/A21.10. 502-2.1.2.1. Restraints for Ductile Iron Pipe with Mechanical Joint Fittings Joint restraints for ductile iron pipe to mechanical joint fittings shall be MEGALUG: Series 1100 restraints by EBAA Iron, or an approved equal listed in the City of Clearwater Approved Products List. When actuated during installation, the restraining device shall impart a multiple wedging action against the pipe wall, which increases resistance as internal pressure in the pipeline increases. A. The restrained joint shall maintain flexibility after installation. Glands shall be manufactured of ductile iron conforming to ASTM A536 and restraining devices shall be of heat-treated ductile iron with a minimum hardness of 370 BHN. The gland shall have standard dimension and bolting patterns for mechanical joints conforming to ANSI/AWWA C111 and C153, latest revisions. The restraining wedges shall have twist -off nuts to insure proper torquing. B. Tee head bolts and nuts shall be manufactured of corrosion -resistant, high strength, low alloy CORTEN steel in accordance with ASTM A242. C. No other retainer gland type device will be acceptable. After installation prior to backfilling, all parts of the joint restraint system shall be coated with coal tar epoxy equal to Carbolise Bitumastic No. 300-M. 502-2.1.2.2. Restraints for Ductile Iron Pipe with Push -on Joints Joint restraints for ductile iron push -on pipe joints 4 -inch to 36 -inch shall be constructed of ductile iron conforming to ASTM A536 and shall have a working pressure for 350 psi for 4 -inch to 16 -inch and 250 psi for 18 -inch and larger fittings. Restraint shall be accomplished by a wedge action restraint ring on the spigot joined to a split ductile iron ring behind the bell and the two rings connected by restraint rods and nuts. Torque limiting twist off nuts shall be used to ensure proper actuation of the restraining wedges. The restraints shall be MEGALUG® Series 1700 restraint harnesses as manufactured by EBAA Iron or an approved equal. A. The restrained joint shall maintain flexibility after installation. Restraint rings shall be manufactured of ductile iron conforming to ASTM A536 and the ring restraining wedge devices shall be of heat-treated ductile iron with a minimum hardness of 370 BHN. The restraining wedges shall have twist -off nuts to insure proper torquing. B. Restraint rods and nuts shall be manufactured of corrosion -resistant, high strength, low alloy CORTEN steel in accordance with ASTM A242. C. No other restraint harness type device will be acceptable. After installation prior to backfilling, all parts of the joint restraint system shall be coated with coal tar epoxy equal to Carboline Bitumastic No. 300-M. 502-2.1.3. Ductile Iron Pipe Installed with Steel Casings General: All pipe placed within steel casings shall be push -on joint ductile iron pipe restrained by the use of mechanical bell restraints as specified above in Section 502-2.1.2.2. The rods for the bell restraints shall be double nutted to prevent over -belling of the joint during push -in of the carrier pipe into the casing. The carrier pipe shall have properly sized casing spacers installed on the pipe so that the pipe will be centered within the casing. Each end of the casing shall be properly sealed to prevent the intrusion of soil, water, or debris within the casing itself. It shall be double sealed by brick and cement mortar and include a casing end seal with stainless steel bands as shown on in the engineering construction standards. Cement -Mortar Interior Lining (Potable or Reclaimed Water): Ductile iron pipe, fittings, and specials shall be cement lined in accordance with ANSI/AWWA C 104, latest edition, "Cement -Mortar Lining for Ductile Iron and Gray Iron Pipe and Fittings for Water". The cement lining shall have standard thickness SECTION IV Page 84 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications and, after curing, the lining shall have a seal coat of bituminous material in accordance with ANSUAWWA C104/A21.4 80, latest revision and shall be listed by ANSUNSF Standard 61 for potable water contact. Pipe Labeling: Pipe manufacturer shall label in large legible lettering on the exterior of the pipe the type of pipe interior lining. Exterior Coatings for Buried Pipe: Ductile iron pipe, fittings, and specials to be installed underground shall be coated on the exterior at the factory with one coat, 1 mil DFT, of asphaltic coating per AWWA C151, C110 and C153. All clamps, bolts, nuts, studs, and other uncoated parts of joints for underground installation shall be coated with coal tar epoxy prior to backfilling. Coal tar epoxy shall be equal to Carboline Bitumastic No. 300-M. Exterior Coating for Exposed Pipe: Ductile iron pipe, fittings, and specials to be installed aboveground shall be furnished with a shop applied primer on the exterior. All above ground ductile iron pipe and fitting installations shall be painted in the field with an epoxy -epoxy -urethane system coating from an approved coating manufacturer, color: Safety Blue for potable water, Pantone Purple for reclaimed water or Safety Green for wastewater. 502-2.1.4. POLYETHYLENE ENCASEMENT FOR BURIED DUCTILE IRON PIPE Polyethylene tube encasement shall be provided and installed for all buried ductile iron pipe segments and fittings for corrosion protection as specified herein. Both material and installation procedures shall be in accordance with ANSUAWWA C105/ A21.5-10. Polyethylene encasement material shall be manufactured with UV inhibitors. The polyethylene encasement shall be color coded as follows: A. Potable Water Service — Blue Polyethylene Encasement. B. Reclaimed Water Service — Pantone Purple Polyethylene Encasement. C. Wastewater Service — Green Polyethylene Encasement. The polyethylene encasement shall be a minimum of 8 mils thick and shall be certified by the manufacturer to provide suitable protection of pipe installation in corrosive soil. All pipe joints shall consist of a minimum of one foot of polyethylene overlap onto the adjacent pipe at both ends. All overlap material shall be secured in place with at least two wraps of 1 -inch wide x 8 mils thick polyethylene adhesive tape. Any slack liner material along the pipe barrel shall be taken up by folds secured in-place with adhesive tape. Repair any rips, punctures, or other damage to polyethylene with tape or by patching. All valves, fittings and specialty items shall be jointed with proper overlaps and fastening as described above. Prepare openings for service taps, air -reliefs, etc., by making a cut in the polyethylene and temporarily folding back the edges. After installation is completed, replace the polyethylene and repair the cut with polyethylene adhesive tape. Care shall be taken during backfilling so that no damage will occur to the polyethylene encasement. In general, backfilling shall be done in accordance with AWWA Standard C 600. The Contractor shall install polyethylene encasement in accordance with all liner and pipe manufacturer recommendations. Polyethylene encasement shall be required for below ground installations of ductile iron pipe and fittings where the installed ductile iron utility pipe will be located less than 10 feet from a gas main. 502-2.2. POLYVINYL CHLORIDE (PVC) PIPE Each length of PVC pipe shall bear identification that will remain legible during normal handling, storage and installation such as the name or trademark of the manufacturer, the location of the manufacturing plant, SECTION IV Page 85 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 • • • SECTION IV — Technical Specifications and the class or strength classification of the pipe. All PVC pipe shall bear the NSF -DW seal. Each length of pipe shall also bear and so designate the testing agency that verified the suitability of the pipe material for potable water service. The markings shall be plainly visible on the pipe barrel. This required identification shall be factory applied by the manufacturer. Pipe which is not marked clearly with the required identification is subject to rejection. All rejected pipe shall be promptly removed from the project site by the Contractor. PVC pipe is approved for underground installations only. Polyvinyl Chloride (PVC) Pipe 4 -inch through 8 -inch shall be in accordance with ANSI/AWWA C900, DR18, latest revision and the American Society for Testing & Materials for the PVC Resin Compound conforming to ASTM Specification D1784. Pipe shall have gasketed integral bell ends and shall be homogeneous throughout and be free of visible cracks, holes, foreign material, blisters, or other visible deleterious faults. Pipe shall be designed for maximum working pressure of not less than 235 psi and with not less than a sustained hydrostatic pressure of 470 psi for a safety factor of 2 to 1 for AWWA C900 pipe. Polyvinyl Chloride Pipe shall be manufactured to the same outside diameter (O.D.) as Ductile Iron Pipe only. Pipe larger than 8 -inches in diameter or pipes which are deeper than 10 -feet shall be ductile iron only. The City Engineer reserves the right to require the use of ductile iron in sizes 4 -inch through 8 -inch when needed due to laying conditions or usage. Pipe dimension ratio, working pressure and laying length shall conform to the following table: Size Dimension Ratio (OD/Thick.) Rated Water Working Pressure (PSI) Laying Length (Ft) 4 18 235 20 6 18 235 20 8 18 235 20 12 18 235 20 Bell and Spigot Pipe Joints: Pipe joints shall be gasketed, push -on type made with integral bell and spigot pipe ends in accordance with ASTM D3139, latest revision. The bell shall consist of an integral thickened wall section designed to be at least as strong as the pipe wall. The bell shall be supplied with factory glued rubber ring gasket which conforms to the manufacturer's standard dimensions and tolerances. The gasket shall meet the requirements of ASTM F477 "Elastomeric Seals (Gaskets) for Joining Plastic Pipe" and shall be manufactured of EPDM elastomeric material. PVC pipe shall be approved by the Engineer and the Owner or approved equal. Integral Pipe Color: All PVC pipe for potable water mains, reclaimed water mains and wastewater force mains shall be extruded or fabricated with an integral color in the PVC material. The integral color for the PVC pipe shall be as follows: A. Potable Water: PVC pipeline color - Blue. B. Reclaimed Water: PVC pipeline color — Panton Purple C. Wastewater: PVC pipeline color — Green The use of white or any other color pipe for potable water, reclaimed water or wastewater service shall be prohibited. Fittings: Fittings for PVC pressure pipe shall be ductile iron fittings with restrained mechanical joint ends, linings and coatings as specified in Section 502-2.1 for ductile iron fittings. Restrained Joints for PVC Pipe: Thrust restraint for buried piping shall be provided by restrained joints. Concrete thrust blocks shall not be acceptable. Thrust restraints shall be used at all valves, tees, bends, and other fittings for the Restrained Joint PVC pipe and Push -on Joint PVC pipe. Where indicated on the Drawings, to prevent pipe joints and fittings from separating under pressure, pipe joints and fittings for PVC pipe shall be restrained as follows: SECTION IV Page 86 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications A. PVC pipe bell and spigot push -on joints, adjacent to restrained fittings, shall be restrained using a harness type restraint device. The harness restraint shall be split to enable installation of the restraint after the spigot has been installed into the bell. The restraint unit shall consist of a split ring that fits behind the bell, a split restraint ring that installs on the spigot and a number of clamping bolts to connect the other two parts. The restraining device shall consist of multiple individually activated gripping wedges or a series of serrations to grip the pipe and maximize restraint capability in conjunction with a sufficient number of clamping bolts connecting the retainer on the bell side of the joint pipe to the restraint ring on the other side to hold the spigot. The restraining device and components shall be manufactured of high strength ductile iron meeting ASTM A536, Grade 65- 42-10. Clamping bolts and nuts shall be manufactured of corrosion resistant high strength, low alloy CORTEN steel meeting the requirements of ASTM A242. The restraint device shall be the EBBA Iron MEGALUG° Series 1500 TD Restrainer or an equal. B. Mechanical joint fittings used with PVC pipe shall be restrained with the EBBA Iron MEGALUG° Series 2000 PV Restrainer or an equal approved. The restraining device shall consist of a retainer gland such that it can replace the standard mechanical joint gland and can be used with the standard mechanical joint bell conforming to ANSI/AWWA C111/A21.11 and ANSI/AWWA C153/A21- 53. The restraining device shall have a pressure rating equal to that of the PVC pipe on which it is used. Twist off nuts, sized same as the tee -head bolts shall be used to insure proper actuating of restraining devices. The restraining gland shall be manufactured of high strength ductile iron meeting ASTM A536, Grade 65-42-10. The tee head bolts and nuts, and the clamping bolts and nuts, shall be manufactured of corrosion resistant high strength, low alloy CORTEN steel meeting the requirements of ASTM A242. 502-2.2.1. RESTRAINED JOINT PVC PIPE (DIRECTIONAL BORE) Restrained Joint PVC pipe and couplings used for directional bores shall be made from un -plasticized PVC compounds having a minimum cell classification of 12454-B, as defined in ASTM D1784 (latest edition). All compounds shall qualify for a Hydrostatic Design Basis (HDB) rating of 4000 psi for water at 73.4°F, in accordance with the requirements of ASTM D2837 (latest edition latest edition). Blue pipe (safety blue paint color) shall be supplied for the potable water system and purple pipe (pantone 522C paint color) shall be supplied for the reclaimed water system as specified in Section 502-2.2. Nominal outside diameters and wall thickness of PVC pipe shall conform to the requirements of AWWA C900 for pipe sizes between 4 and 16 -inches. Nominal outside diameters and wall thickness of 4" PVC pipe shall conform to the requirements of ASTM D2241 (latest edition). PVC pipe shall be furnished in sizes 4" (Pressure Rating 250 psi, DR17), 4" (Class 305, DR -14) and 6" and 8" (Class 235, DR -18). Pipe shall be furnished in standard laying lengths of 20 ft. + 1 in. PVC pipe used for directional bores shall be joined using a restrained joint coupling system or ring restraint with Rieber Gasket meeting the requirements of ASTM F477, latest edition. Pipe and/or couplings shall be designed as an integral system and shall be provided by a single manufacturer for maximum reliability and interchangeability. Assembled joints shall meet the leakage test requirements of ASTM D3139 (latest edition). No external pipe -to -pipe restraining devices which clamp onto or otherwise damage the pipe surface as a result of point -loading shall be permitted. Maximum allowable axial jacking loads for the pipe shall be provided by the pipe manufacturer. The Contractor shall provide and utilize appropriate instrumentation that the Engineer shall monitor, to ensure that the jacking loads never exceed 80% of the maximum allowable axial jacking loads allowed by the pipe manufacturer. Only experienced personnel shall be used to install pipe. If used, coupling edges shall be beveled to reduce drag force when pipe is installed by directional bore or Micro tunneling. Assembly of joints shall be in strict accordance with the manufacturer's written instructions. Manufacturer/Product: Certain Teed Certa-Lok C-900, no approved equal. SECTION IV Page 87 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV —Technical Specifications • 502-2.3. HIGH DENSITY POLYETHYLENE (HDPE) PIPE This Section includes materials and methods of installation of high-density polyethylene pipe (HDPE) and fittings for water, reclaimed water, and wastewater utility use as required and as specified herein. For point repairs only if the flow cannot be stopped the use of stiffeners is allowed. The high density, very high molecular weight polyethylene pipe shall be made from a HDPE material having a minimum material designation code of PE4710 and shall conform to AWWA C906, latest revision. The material shall meet the requirements of ASTM D3350 and shall have a minimum cell classification of PE445574C/E. In addition, the pipe shall be listed as meeting NSF -61. HDPE pipe shall have outside diameter sizes matching ductile iron pipe (DIPS) and shall have the minimum wall thickness and dimension ratio (DR) as shown on the Drawings for a particular installation. Minimum pressure ratings for HDPE pipe shall be 250 psi DR 9 and 200 psi for DR -11. The DR rating or the minimum pipe wall thickness of the pipe for a particular HDD installation shall be as called out on the Drawings. The polyethylene compound shall be suitably protected against degradation by ultraviolet light by means of carbon black, well dispersed by pre -compounding in a concentration of not less than 2 percent. The pipe manufacturer shall be listed and in good standing with the Plastic Pipe Institute as meeting the recipe and mixing requirements of the resin manufacturer for the resin used to manufacture the pipe. Pipe shall be manufactured by Performance Pipe (Chevron), JM Eagle or an approved equal. HDPE pipe shall be manufactured and identified by color based on the type of utility service. HDPE pipe and tubing less than 6 -inch in size shall be manufactured entirely in the required color. For HDPE pipe 6 - inch and greater, color coding shall be accomplished either through an exterior surface entirely of the required color or through striping. The color coding shall be permanently co -extruded on the pipe exterior surface as part of the pipe's manufacturing process. The pipe shall be manufactured as one solid color per • the applicable service color or shall be black in color with three (3) permanent solid color stripes, per the applicable service color, extruded into the piping material. The colored stripes shall appear on three (3) sides of the pipe, run the entire length of the pipe, and each stripe shall be no less than 1 -inch wide. Painting HDPE pipe to accomplish color coding shall not be permitted. The pipe identification color coding based on the intended Type of Utility Service shall be as follows: 1. Sewer — green (safety green paint color) 2. Water — blue (safety blue paint color) 3. Reclaimed water — purple (pantone 522C paint color) In addition to the identification color being co -extruded, HDPE Pipe shall have been continuously marked by the manufacturer with permanent printing with the following information at a minimum: A. Nominal Size (Inches). B. Dimension Ratio (DR). C. Pressure Rating (psi). D. Trade Name. E. Material Classification (PE4710). F. Plant, Extruder and Operator Codes. G. Resin Supplier Code. H. Date Produced; and I. HDPE pipe used for potable water mains shall bear the NSF Seal of Approval. 502-2.3.1. MECHANICAL JOINT ADAPTERS (MJ ADPATERS) Mechanical Joint Adapter Fittings shall have a material designation code of PE4710, and a minimum Cell Classification of PE445474C/E. Mechanical Joint Adapters can be made to ASTM D3261 or if machined, must meet the requirements of ASTM F2206. MJ Adapters shall have a pressure rating equal to the pipe • SECTION IV Page 88 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications unless otherwise specified on the plans. Markings for molded or machined MJ Adapters shall be per ASTM D3261. Where shown on the drawings, 4 -inch and larger transitions to mechanical joint fittings and valves shall be ductile iron mechanical joint. Connection to the mechanical joint fittings shall be accomplished using a mechanical joint adapter kit. The mechanical joint adapter fitting shall be fused onto the pipe and shall result in a restrained joint with a pressure rating no less than 150 psi. The D.I./HDPE mechanical joint adaptor shall consist of: 1. A molded or fabricated HDPE mechanical joint transition fitting. 2. A mechanical joint rubber gasket fabricated of EPDM. 3. A mechanical joint restraining gland. The restraining gland shall be manufactured of high strength, ductile iron meeting ASTM A536, Grade 65-42-10. 4. The tee head bolts and nuts shall be manufactured of corrosion resistant high strength, low alloy CORTEN steel, meeting the requirements of ASTM A242. 502-2.3.2. BUTT FUSION PROCESS AND INSTALLATION The pipe shall be joined by the butt fusion procedure outlined in ASTM F2620 or PPI TR -33. All fusion joints shall be made in compliance with the pipe or fitting manufacturer's recommendations and shall be butt -welded flush to the outside diameter of the pipe. Joints shall provide axial pullout resistance. Fusion joints shall be made by qualified fusion technicians per PPI TN -42. A record or certificate of training for the fusion operator must be provided to the Engineer that documents training to the fundamentals of ASTM F 2620. All HDPE fusion equipment operators shall be qualified to perform pipe joining. Fusion equipment operators shall have current, formal training on all fusion equipment employed on the project and shall be certified by the pipe supplier/manufacturer. Training records for qualified fusion technicians shall be submitted to the Engineer for review. Training received more than two years prior to operation with no evidence of activity within the past 6 months shall not be considered current. When the fusion machine operator is employed by the HDPE pipe and fusion machine supplier, the supplier shall maintain an ISO 9001 Certified Quality Management System. Sections of HDPE shall be joined into continuous lengths on the job site above ground and butt fused in strict accordance with pipe manufacturer's recommendations. The finished pipe assembly shall be pressure tested prior to insertion underground. All HDPE pipe shall be cut, fabricated, and installed in strict conformance with the pipe manufacturer's recommendations. Joining, laying, and pulling of polyethylene pipe shall be accomplished by personnel experienced in working with high density polyethylene pipe. The pipe supplier shall certify in writing to the Engineer that the Contractor is qualified to join, lay, and pull the pipe or representative of the pipe manufacturer shall be on site to oversee the pipe joining. Expenses for the representative shall be paid for by the Contractor. The butt fused joint shall have a zero -leak rate under the following conditions: A. External pressure up to 60 psi from bentonite injection, slurry system operation, or groundwater head. B. Internal hydrostatic pressure testing of 150 psi. The Contractor shall obtain from the pipe manufacturer a certificate of compliance to the effect that the pipe and fittings supplied for this Contract have been inspected at the plant and that they meet the requirements of these specifications. The Contractor shall submit these certificates to the Engineer prior to installation of the pipe materials. All pipe and fittings shall be subjected to visual inspection at time of delivery and before they are lowered into the trench to be laid. Joints or fittings that do not conform to these SECTION IV Page 89 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 • SECTION IV — Technical Specifications specifications will be rejected and must be removed immediately by the Contractor. The entire product of any plant may be rejected when, in the opinion of the city, the methods of manufacture fail to secure uniform results, or where the materials used are such as to produce inferior pipe or fittings. Each joint fusion shall be recorded and logged by an electronic monitoring device (data logger) affixed to the fusion machine. Joint data shall be submitted as part of the As -Built record information, in accordance with this Technical Specification. Butt Fusion Machines: Only appropriately sized, and outfitted fusion machines that have been approved by the pipe supplier shall be used for the fusion process. Fusion machines must incorporate the following properties, including the following elements: A. Heat Plate: Heat plates shall be in good condition with no deep gouges or scratches within the pipe circle being fused. Plates shall be clean and free of any contamination. Heater controls shall properly function, and cord and plug shall be in good condition. The appropriately sized heat plate shall be capable of maintaining a uniform and consistent heat profile and temperature for the size of pipe being fused, per the pipe supplier's recommendations. B. Carriage: Carriage shall travel smoothly with no binding at less than 50 psi. Jaws shall be in good condition with proper inserts for the pipe size being fused. Insert pins shall be installed with no interference to carriage travel. C. General Machine: Overview of machine body shall yield no obvious defects, missing parts, or potential safety issues during fusion. D. Data Logger: The current version of the pipe supplier's recommended and compatible software shall be used. Protective case shall be utilized for the hand-held wireless portion of the unit. Data Logger operations and maintenance manual shall always be with the unit. If fusing for extended periods of time, an independent 110V power source shall be available to extend battery life. E. Joint Recording: Each fusion joint shall be recorded and logged by an electronic monitoring device (data logger) connected to the fusion machine. The fusion data logging and joint report shall be generated by software developed specifically for the butt -fusion of thermoplastic pipe. The software shall register and/or record the parameters required by the manufacturer and these Specifications. Data not logged by the data logger shall be logged manually and be included in the Fusion Technician's joint report. Required Auxiliary Equipment: Other equipment specifically required for the butt fusion process shall include the following: A. Pipe rollers shall be used for support of pipe on either side of the fusion machine. B. A weather protection canopy that allows full machine motion of the heat plate, fusion assembly and carriage shall be provided for fusion in inclement and /or windy weather. C. Fusion machine operations and maintenance manual shall always be kept with the fusion machine. D. Facing blades specifically designed for cutting HDPE pipe. The pipe shall be installed in a manner that does not exceed 70 percent of the recommended maximum bending radius of the pipe. When the pipe is installed by pulling in tension, 75 percent of the recommended Safe Pulling Force, according to the pipe supplier, shall not be exceeded. Joint Fusion Bead Removal: Contractor shall trim and remove the butt fusion beads from the inside and the outside of the HDPE pipe at the butt fused joint following joint fusing. without disrupting pipe service. The restraints shall be manufactured by EBAA Iron Series 1500 or 1600 or approved equal. SECTION IV Page 90 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications 502-2.4. PIPING IDENTIFICATION SYSTEM 502-2.4.1. EXTERIOR MARKINGS FOR BURIED PIPE All ductile iron and polyvinyl chloride pressure pipelines installed by open cut shall receive a color -coded continuous self-adhesive vinyl tape, installed by the contractor, with the width and located as indicated below. Pipe tape striping shall be in the color required for the service as specified below. A. Tane Striae Markin,? Locations: Up to 4 -inch diameter pipe (1 location) 3 -inch wide tape placed at center -top of pipe. 6 to 16 -inch diameter pipe (2 locations) 6 -inch wide tape placed on both sides, top half of pipe. 20 -inch and larger diameter pipe (3 locations) 6 -inch wide tape placed on both sides' top half of pipe with a third stripe centered along top of pipe. B. Color of Tane Striae Markin : Potable Water Marking Stripe Tape Blue with Black or White Lettering, "POTABLE WATER MAIN" or similar wording. Reclaimed Water Marking Stripe Tape Purple with White or Yellow Lettering, "RECLAIMED WATER MAIN" or similar wording Force Main Marking Stripe Tape Green with Black or White Lettering, "WASTEWATER FORCE MAIN" or similar wording 502-2.4.2. LOCATION DETECTION WIRE: A. Location Detection Wire for Open -Cut Pipeline Installations: All ductile iron and polyvinyl chloride pressure pipelines installed by open cut shall be laid with two (2) strands of Location Detection Wire applied to the pipe. The detection wire shall be continuous, high strength copper clad steel (HS -CCS) 10 gauge AWG wire insulated with 30 mil thick high molecular weight — high density polyethylene (HMW -HDPE) insulation with a minimum break load of 684 pounds and specifically designed for use in open cut installations, equal to "1030 -HS High Strength Tracer Wire" manufactured by Copperhead Industries, LLC, or an approved equal. Each wire shall be continuous with splices made only by spicing connectors manufactured by the wire manufacturer equal to "LSC1030C Snake BiteTM Locking Connectors" as manufactured by Copperhead Industries, LLC or an approved equal. The 2 wires shall be taped to the top of each joint of pipe with about 5 -feet between each piece of tape, with a minimum of 3 taping locations for each 20 - foot length of pipe. The tape used shall be 3M Scotch Rap All -Weather Corrosion Protection Tape, polyvinyl chloride backing with rubber adhesive, 4 -inches wide or Engineer Approved Equal. Following installation of the pipeline including backfill and compaction, the Contractor shall perform a second 12 -volt DC electrical continuity test on each of the two (2) tracer wires. B. Location Detection Wire for Horizontal Directional Drilling Pipeline Installations: All polyvinyl chloride or HDPE pressure pipe installed by directional drilling methods shall be installed with three (3) insulated tracer wires. The three (3) tracer wires shall be attached at 120 -degree locations around the pipe to help ensure continuity of at least one wire subsequent to the HDD installation. The tracer wire shall be continuous, extra high strength copper clad steel (EHS-CCS) 10 gauge AWG wire insulated with 45 mil thick high molecular weight — high density polyethylene (HMW -HDPE) insulation with a minimum break load of 2,032 pounds and specifically designed for use in directional drilling installations, equal to "1045-EHS Solo Shot EHS, Extra High Strength Tracer Wire" manufactured by Copperhead Industries, LLC, or an approved equal. SECTION IV Page 91 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 • • • SECTION IV — Technical Specifications Continuity shall be maintained in the wire along the entire length of the pipe installed by HDD. No splices shall be allowed for each wire attached to the HDD pipeline unless approved by the city or the Engineer. If approved, permanent splices shall be made using wire connectors approved for underground applications with splices made only by spicing connectors manufactured by the wire manufacturer equal to "LSC 1030C Snake BiteTM Locking Connectors" as manufactured by Copperhead Industries, LLC or an approved equal. If splices are approved by the city or the Engineer, all miscellaneous splicing components shall be furnished, installed, and tested by the Contractor and witnessed by the city or the Engineer. At a minimum, the location detection wires shall be attached to the pipe with nylon wire ties, with ties located at 5 -foot intervals, as shown in the Standard Details. The Contractor may suggest other methods of attachment, with the approval of the city or the Engineer. Prior to installation of the pipeline into the bore hole, the Contractor shall perform a 12 -volt DC electrical continuity test on each of the three (3) wires during the aboveground pressure test. Following installation of the pipeline into the bore hole, the Contractor shall perform a second 12 -volt DC electrical continuity test on each of the three (3) tracer wires. Failure of continuous continuity for at least one of the three tracing wires attached to the HDD pipeline, at the discretion of the city or the Engineer, shall be cause for rejection of the HDD installation, resulting in the abandonment and reinstallation of the directionally drilled pipeline. The HDD tracer wires shall be spliced twelve (12) inches below grade to three (3) 10 -gauge tracer wires, as specified above for open cut installations, and brought up in the valve boxes at the ends of each HDD line segment. The splices shall be made only by methods per the tracer wire manufacturer's recommendations and by splicing connections manufactured by the tracer wire manufacturer. The splicing connectors shall be the "LSC1030C SnakeBiteTM Locking Connector" as manufactured by Copperhead Industries, LLC, the Direct Bury Lug as manufactured by DryConn®, or an approved equal. C. Color of Location Detection Wires: The insulation color for the wire shall match the color for the pipes intended service as follows: 1. Potable Water Mains — Blue Insulation. 2. Reclaimed Water Mains - Panton Purple Insulation. 3. Wastewater Force Mains — Green Insulation. D. Termination of the Location Detection Wires: The tracer wires shall be secured to all valves, tees and elbows. It is to be installed at every valve box through a 2 -inch PVC pipe to 18 -inches above the top of the concrete slab. The 2 -inch PVC pipe shall be the same length as the adjustable valve box, and the 2 -inch PVC pipe shall be plugged with a 2 -inch removable brass plug with recessed square nut 502-2.4.3. WARNING TAPE: In addition, all underground pipelines installed by open -cut methods shall be buried with identification tape installed over the centerline of the pipe at a depth of 1.0 foot below finished grade. The identification tape shall be as follows: A. Identification tape shall be manufactured of reinforced polyethylene film with a minimum overall thickness of 4 mils and shall have a 0.35 mil thick magnetic metallic foil core. The tape shall be highly resistant to alkalis, acids, and other destructive agents found in soil. Tape width shall be 3 - inches and shall have background color specified below, imprinted with black letters. Imprint shall be as specified below and shall repeat itself a minimum of once every 2 -feet for entire length of tape. Tape shall be Terra Tape Sentry Line, or an approved equal. B. Tape background colors and imprints shall be in accordance with the followine table: Tape Imprint Background Color Imprint Color "Caution — Potable Water Main Buried Below" Blue Black SECTION IV Page 92 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications "Caution — Reclaimed Water Main Buried Below" Purple White "Caution — Wastewater Force Main Buried Below" Green Black 502-2.5. RESTRAINED JOINT COUPLINGS Restrained Joint Pipe Couplings: Restrained joint pipe couplings used to join and restrain two pieces of plain end pipe shall be sized to suit the outside diameter of the pipe ends to be jointed with restrained ends. Transition couplings shall be used to join pipes of different outside diameters. Pipe couplings shall be bolted type with ASTM A536 ductile iron middle ring and end followers. Coatings: All ductile iron parts of the coupling shall be coated on the interior and exterior with a fusion bonded thermosetting epoxy coating, applied electrostatically prior to assembly, and complying with AWWA C550 with a 12 -mil nominal coating thickness. The coating shall be equal to Mega -Bond as manufactured by EBBA Iron, Inc., or an approved equal. Gaskets: Gaskets for the coupling shall be wedge type manufactured of EPDM resilient rubber. Bolts: Torque limiting nuts and gripping restraint wedges shall be manufactured of corrosion resistant, low alloy, high strength steel. Threaded restraint rods and hexagonal nuts shall be manufactured of high strength, Type 316 stainless steel. Bolts and nuts shall conform dimensionally to ANSI/AWWA C111, latest revision. Approved Manufacturer: Restrained joint couplings shall be Series 3800 as manufactured by EBBA Iron, Inc., or an approved equal. 502-3. GATE VALVES General: Gate valves shall open by turning to the left (counterclockwise), when viewed from the stem. When fully open, gate valves shall have a clear, unobstructed waterway equal to the nominal diameter of the pipe. All internal valve components shall be removable from the valve bonnet without removing the valve body from the pressure main. Operating nut or hand wheel shall have an arrow cast in the metal indicating the direction of opening. Each valve shall have the manufacturer's distinctive marking, pressure rating and year of manufacture cast on the body. Prior to shipment from the factory, each valve shall be tested by applying to it a hydrostatic pressure equal to twice the specified working pressure. Hydrostatic and leakage tests shall be conducted in strict accordance with ANSI/AWWA C500 or ANSI/AWWA C509, latest revisions, whichever is applicable. Only gate valve sizes 4 -inch and larger shall be acceptable. Large Gate Valves: Gate valves with nominal sizes from 4- to 12 -inches shall conform to ANSI/AWWA C509, latest revision, and shall be designed for a minimum working pressure of 250 psi differential pressure with zero leakage. Gate valves with nominal sizes from 16- to 36 -inches shall conform to AWWA C515, latest revision, and shall be designed for a working pressure of 250 psi differential pressure with zero leakage. Valves shall be ductile iron body resilient wedge type with Nitrile rubber 0 -ring stem seals. Stems shall be sealed with three (3) 0 -rings. The top two 0 -rings shall be replaceable with the valve fully open and subject to the full rated working pressure. 0 -rings in a cartridge shall not be allowed. All cast ferrous components of the gate valve including the valve body, wedge, bonnet and stuffing box shall be constructed of ductile iron in conformance with ASTM A536. The valve stem shall be manufactured of manganese bronze in accordance with ASTM B763 and the wedge nut shall be manufactured of bronze in accordance with ASTM B584. The valve stem shall have an integral thrust collar; two-piece stem collars shall not be acceptable. The valve shall have Delrin thrust washers above and below the thrust collar to assist in the operation of the valve. Valve wedge shall be symmetrical and constructed to assure uniform seating pressure between the wedge seat circumference and body seating surface, providing a complete seal at the rated pressure with flow from either direction. Resilient wedge of the valve shall be formed by a special corrosion and chloramine SECTION IV Page 93 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 • SECTION IV — Technical Specifications resistant, EPDM synthetic elastomer which is permanently bonded to and completely encapsulates the ductile iron valve disc. The wedge nut shall be independent of the wedge and held in place on three sides by the wedge to prevent possible misalignment. All bolting materials for buried gate valves shall be Type 304 stainless steel with hexagonal shaped heads with dimensions conforming to ANSI B18.2.1; metric bolting materials shall not be allowed. Gate valves shall be NSF 61 listed. Resilient wedge type gate valves shall be as listed in the City of Clearwater Approved Products List, or an equal approved by the city. Valve End Joints: All gate valves shall have either mechanical joints per ANSI/AWWA C111/A21.11 or restrained joints as specified above for ductile iron or PVC pipe for underground service, or flanged ends, Class 125 per ANSI B16.1, for above ground service or valves in vaults to fit the pipe run in which they are to be used. Gate valves installed on push -on joint pipe shall have mechanical joint ends unless otherwise specified. Gate Valve Operators: Unless otherwise shown on the Drawings or specified herein, gate valves shall have non -rising stems. Buried gate valves shall be furnished with a 2 -inch square AWWA standard nut operator with a valve box and cover. All buried gate valves shall be installed in the vertical position only. Buried gate valves 16 -inches and larger in nominal size installed vertically shall be provided with a spur gear box, valve operator. The spur gear shall be an EXEECO 1S-5 to IS -10 spur gear, depending on the valve size, with a gear ratio not more than 2:1. Gate valves located aboveground or inside structures shall be furnished with a rising stem and a handwheel operator which shall have an arrow cast in the metal indicating the direction of opening. Gate valves used as isolation valves for double check valve backflow preventers for fire lines or reduced pressure back flow preventers shall be of the open screw and yoke (OS&Y) design with rising stems and with a handwheel operator. Gate valves larger than 16 -inches in nominal size shall be provided with a smaller gate valve bypass sized by the gate valve manufacturer. Interior Valve Lining: Interior of the valve body shall be lined with a fusion bonded or thermo-setting epoxy coating in accordance with AWWA C550, latest revision. Lining shall be holiday -free, NSF 61 approved, with a minimum thickness of 16 mils. Surfaces shall be clean, dry, and free from rust and grease before lining. Exterior Valve Coatings: All exterior surfaces of iron body gate valves shall be clean, dry, and free from rust and grease before coating. For buried service, the exterior ferrous parts of all valves shall be coated at the factory with coal tar epoxy with a minimum total finish dry film thickness of 20 mils. Prior to back filling, all uncoated nuts, bolts, glands, rods, and other parts of joints shall be coated in the field with coal tar epoxy equal to Carboline Bitumastic No. 300-M. For valves installed above -ground, the exterior ferrous parts of all valves shall be shop primed at the factory with one coat, minimum dry film thickness of 4 mils, of a rust -inhibitive universal epoxy primer. Primer shall be suitable for finish paint specified. Following installation, above -ground valves shall be finish painted in accordance with city Construction Standards. Two Inch (2") diameter gate valves or smaller are not allowed. These should be approved ball valves. Three Inch (3") diameter valves are not allowed. 502-4. VALVE BOXES Furnish, assemble, and place a valve box over the operating nut for each buried valve. The valve box shall be designed to prevent the transmission of surface loads directly to the valve or piping. Valve boxes shall be of the adjustable screw-type of suitable length with an interior diameter of not less than 5-1/4 inches. The valve boxes shall be manufactured of cast iron and shall be of the three-piece design SECTION IV Page 94 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications including a bottom section, middle section and top section with cover. The bottom section shall have a flange at the bottom having sufficient bearing area to prevent settling. The cast iron cover shall be cast with the applicable service; "WATER", markings for potable water mains, "RECLAIMED" marking for reclaimed water mains or "SEWER", markings for wastewater force mains. The top section shall be adjustable for elevation and shall be set to allow equal movement above and below finished grade. The castings shall be manufactured of clean, even grain, gray cast iron conforming to ASTM A48, Class 30B for Gray Iron Castings; and shall be smooth, true to pattern, free from blow holes, sand holes, projections, and other harmful defects. The seating surfaces of both the cover and the top section shall be machined so that the cover will not rock after it has been seated. The valve boxes shall be coated inside and outside with an asphaltic coating prior to machining, so that the machined seating surfaces will be free of any coating. Valve extension stems shall be provided for all buried valves when the valve operating nut is deeper than 3 feet below final grade. Valve boxes and their installation shall be included in the bid price for valves. Refer to City Standard Detail Index 402; Sheet 1 of 3 & Sheet 2 of 3 for potable water valve pad detail, and City Standard Detail Index 502; Sheet 1 of 3 & Sheet 2 of 3 for reclaimed water valve boxes and pad detail. 502-5. HYDRANTS Fire hydrants shall be dry barrel, break away type with 5 -1/4 -inch minimum main valve opening and shall comply with AWWA C502, latest revision, for a 150 -psi working pressure and shall also be UL/FM listed. All hydrants shall be hydrostatically tested at the factory in accordance with AWWA C502, latest revision. Hydrants shall be the compression type, closing with line pressure. The main valve shall be solid encapsulated EPDM rubber. The main valve stem shall be Type 304 or higher -grade stainless steel and manufactured in two sections with a breakable coupling. The main hydrant valve shall open left (counterclockwise). Hydrants shall be fully bronze mounted with all working parts of bronze. Valve seat ring shall be threaded bronze and shall screw into a bronze retainer insert in the hydrant shoe, with 0 -rings to seal the barrel from leakage of water in the shoe. All interior working parts of the hydrant, including the seat ring, shall be removable through the top of the hydrant to allow repairs without disturbing the barrel of the hydrant after it has been installed. A dirt shield shall be provided to protect the operating mechanism from grit buildup and corrosion due to moisture. A thrust washer shall be supplied between the operating nut and stem lock nut to facilitate operation. The hydrant operating nut shall be of one-piece bronze or ductile iron construction and open counterclockwise. Operating nut shall be a No. 7, 1 -1/2 -inch, pentagonal shaped nut. The operating threads shall be totally enclosed in an operating chamber, separated from the hydrant barrel by a rubber 0 -ring stem seal and lubricated by a grease or an oil reservoir. Fire hydrants shall be the traffic model breakaway type, with the barrel made in at least two sections bolted together, of ample length for 3-1/2 foot depth of bury with necessary extensions to place the safety break flange located approximately 2 -inches above finished grade. Breakaway bolts shall not be approved. The fire hydrant shall be provided with a 6 -inch mechanical joint epoxy lined elbow. The hydrant shall be provided with two, 2 -1/2 -inch hose nozzles and one, 4 -1/2 -inch pumper nozzle, all having National Standard hose threads. All nozzles shall have caps attached by stainless steel chains. Hose nozzle cap nuts shall be 1 -1/2 -inch AWWA standard pentagonal shape. Nozzles shall be of the tamper resistant, 1/4 -turn type with 0 -ring seals or threaded into upper barrel. Nozzles shall be retained with a stainless-steel locking device. The hydrant shall be cast with no drain or weep holes or the drain or weep holes shall be permanently plugged by the manufacturer. All bolts, nuts and studs for fire hydrants shall be Type 316 stainless steel. Fire hydrant base, lower barrel and 6 -inch elbow shall be epoxy coated inside and outside. Upper barrel shall have an interior epoxy coating with the exterior coated with an epoxy primer and a two-part SECTION IV Page 95 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 • SECTION IV — Technical Specifications polyurethane top coating. Fire hydrant upper barrel exterior colors shall have National Standard Yellow, UV resistant enamel, polyurethane, or fusion bonded epoxy. Approved Fire Hydrants: Only those fire hydrants listed in the City of Clearwater Approved Products List, shall be used in extension to or replacement of the city's potable water system: Absolutely no substitutions for fire hydrants shall be allowed without the approval of the city Engineering Department. All shipments of fire hydrants to the project site shall be palletized, securely anchored to the pallet(s) and delivered by delivery trucks with mechanical, motorized tailgates for receipt by the Contractor. All hydrant assemblies shall be provided with an auxiliary 6 -inch resilient seated gate valve for isolation so that the water to the hydrant may be shut off without the necessity of closing any other valve in the distribution system. Gate valves for fire hydrant installations shall be as specified above in Section 502-2.7. Piping used from the water main tee to the fire hydrant shall be 6 -inch ductile iron pipe only. Ductile iron pipe shall be in accordance with Section 502-2.1. The fire hydrant assembly shall be provided with anchoring hydrant fittings including a locked hydrant tee with split gland to provide the locking together of the entire assembly for joint restraint. Hydrants shall be restrained by using bolted mechanical swivel -type connecting joints from the hydrant tee through to the hydrant. Restraining mechanical joint glands on hydrants shall be used only where hydrant runout length precludes the use of swivel joint connectors. Restrained joints shall absorb all thrust and prevent movement of the hydrant. If used, mechanical restrained joints shall comply with Section 502-2.1.2 of these Technical Specifications. All fire hydrants shall be provided with a fiber mesh reinforced concrete shear pad with dimensions as shown in the Drawings. Fire hydrants shall be located in the general location as shown on the Drawings. Final field location of all hydrants shall be as required by the city. All hydrants shall be located no less than 6 -feet and no more than 10 -feet from the curb or edge of pavement of the adjacent roadway. Fire hydrants shall be located in a manner to provide complete accessibility and separated from any and all obstructions such as utility poles, posts, walls, etc., by a distance of at least five feet, measured from the centerline of the fire hydrant to the nearest physical feature, which may obstruct access or view of any fire hydrant, unless otherwise required by the Owner. All fire hydrants located within FDOT rights-of-way shall conform to FDOT clear zone requirements. In order to minimize any inconvenience to property owners, new fire hydrants shall be installed at or near side property lines. Fire hydrants shall be installed such that the 4 -1/2 -inch pumper nozzle faces the street or driveway, unless otherwise directed by the Fire Department or the Owner's representative. No hydrants shall be installed on the reclaimed water system unless approved by the city Engineering Department. 502-6. SERVICE SADDLES/ POLYETHYLENE SERVICE LINES Service Saddles: Service saddles shall have ductile iron bodies in accordance with ASTM A536, latest revision, with double stainless-steel straps. Ductile iron body shall have a fusion bonded nylon coating with a minimum thickness of 12 mils. Straps shall be Type 304 stainless steel with premium grade Type 304 L stainless steel bolts and Type 304 stainless steel washers and nuts. The nuts shall be Teflon coated. The gasket material shall be an EPDM elastomeric compound resistant to degradation by oil, natural gas, acids, alkalis, most aliphatic fluids, and chloramines. The outlet of the saddle shall have female NPT threads. Approved service saddles shall be as listed in the City of Clearwater Approved Products List, or an equal approved by the city. SECTION IV Page 96 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications Service saddles shall be used on all service taps on water main pipelines 4 -inch in size and larger. The largest service connection allowable for a 4 -inch main shall be a 1 -1/2 -inch tapped connection. Service saddles shall be used on all 2 -inch service connections on water main pipelines 6 -inch and larger. Taps larger than 2 -inch in size shall require using a tapping sleeve as specified below in Section 502-12. Corporation Stops: Corporation stops shall be all bronze bodies with an all bronze ball and Teflon seats, in accordance with AWWA C800. Inlet and outlet threads shall have NPT threads. Corporation stops shall be as listed in the City of Clearwater Approved Products List, or an equal approved by the city. Polyethylene Service Lines: All polyethylene service lines require stiffeners must be approved by the city and manufactured by Mars Company, Ocala, FL 34483. 3" service lines are not allowed. Refer to reclaimed water Standard Detail Index 501 Sheet 2 of 2. 502-7. BACKFLOW PREVENTERS The city owns and maintains all backflow prevention devices that are installed within their system. Therefore, any and all devices must be purchased from the city and installed by city work forces. Backflow prevention devices that are installed on customer's service lines at the point of delivery (service connection) shall be of a type in accordance with AWWA C511, latest edition for Reduced Pressure Principle Backflow Prevention Devices or AWWA C506, latest edition for Double Check Valve Assembly Backflow Prevention Devices. Two (2) different types of backflow prevention devices are allowed. The type of device, and when required, shall be determined by the degree of hazard presented to the municipal water system from possible backflow of water within the customer's private system, as determined by the city Utility Engineering Department. The two types of backflow prevention devices allowed are: 1. Double Check Valve Assembly Backflow Prevention Device: a device composed of two (2) single, independently acting, approved check valves, including tightly closing shutoff valves located at each end of the assembly and suitable connections for testing the water tightness of each check valve. 2. Reduced pressure principle backflow prevention device: a device containing a minimum of two (2) independently acting, approved check valves, together with an automatically operated pressure differential relief valve located between the two check valves. The unit must include tightly closing shutoff valves located at each end of the device, and each device shall be fitted with properly located test cocks. a. Reduced -pressure principle back flow preventers shall include an integral sensing system that will automatically open a relief valve whenever the differential pressure between the inlet supply and the reduced pressure zone drops to 2 psi. The relief valve shall remain open until a positive pressure differential of 2 psi is re-established. If pressure upstream of the first check valve drops to atmospheric or below, the relief valve shall remain fully open providing an internal air gap between the first check valve and the water level in the reduced pressure zone. The unit shall also be constructed such that any minor leakage of the second check valve will result in visible flow from the relief valve, even if the first check valve is totally disabled. 502-8. TAPPING SLEEVES AND LINESTOPS Tapping valves and tapping sleeves shall be installed where shown on the drawings to make "wet" taps into existing potable water, reclaimed water mains or wastewater force mains. Tapping valves shall only be installed in the vertical position. SECTION IV Page 97 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 • • • SECTION IV — Technical Specifications Tapping Sleeves for Taps 4 -inch to 12 -inch in Size: Fabricated all stainless steel body tapping sleeves to tap pipelines 4 -inch through 30 -inch in size with outlet tap sizes ranging from 4 -inches through 12 -inches, shall have heavy welded ASTM A240, Type 304 stainless steel body; Type 304 stainless steel bolts, Grade 8 per ASTM A194, epoxy coated; Type 304 stainless steel nuts, Grade 8 per ASTM A194, fluoropolymer coated; and a 3/4 -inch Type 304 stainless steel test plug. The tapping sleeve, unless otherwise specified shall have a 18-8 Type 304 stainless steel outlet flange which meets the requirements of ANSI/AWWA C228 Class SD, ANSI 150 LB drilling recessed for tapping valve per MSS-SP60. The tapping sleeve gasket shall be EPDM rubber. Stainless steel body tapping sleeves shall be as listed in the City of Clearwater Approved Products List, or an equal approved by the city. Mechanical Tapping Sleeves for Taps Larger Than 12 -inch in Size: Mechanical joint split tapping sleeves shall be ductile iron capable of withstanding a 250 -psi working pressure or the pipe rated working pressure, whichever is greater. The tapping flange for the sleeve shall have a groove that shall mate to the raised lip on the tapping valve flange. Gaskets shall be vulcanized EPDM resilient rubber material. All tapping connections for "size on size" taps shall utilize mechanical joint tapping sleeves only. The tapping sleeve shall be provided by the same manufacturer as the tapping valve. Bolts and nuts for the tapping sleeve split flange connection shall be Type 316 stainless steel conforming to ASTM A193, Grade B8M for bolts and ASTM A194, Grade 8M for nuts. The nuts shall be fluoropolymer coated and have a hardness that is lower than that of the bolts and washers by a difference of 50 Brinnell hardness to prevent galling during installation. All interior and exterior surfaces of the mechanical joint split tapping sleeves shall be clean, dry, and free from rust and grease before coating. The interior and exterior surfaces of all mechanical joint split tapping sleeves shall be coated at the factory with fusion bonded or thermo-setting epoxy coating with a minimum total finish dry film thickness of 16 mils. Tapping Valves: Tapping valves are special gate valves designed to mate to the flange of a mechanical tapping sleeve with a mechanical joint outlet connection. The tapping flange of the valve shall have a raised lip that will mate with the grooved flange of the tapping sleeve flange. The tapping valve shall have an oversized diameter waterway to allow passage of the tapping machine cutter assembly, without sustaining damage to the valve. Each tapping valve shall have the manufacturer's distinctive marking, pressure rating, the words" Ductile Iron" or "DI", and year of manufacture cast on the body. Prior to shipment from the factory, each valve shall be tested by applying to it a hydrostatic pressure equal to twice the specified working pressure. Hydrostatic and leakage tests shall be conducted in strict accordance with ANSI/AWWA C509, latest revision. Resilient -seated type tapping valves shall be as listed in the City of Clearwater Approved Products List, or an equal approved by the city. A. Tapping valves with nominal sizes from 4- to 12 -inches shall conform to ANSI/AWWA C509, latest revision, and shall be designed for a minimum working pressure of 250 psi. Tapping valves with nominal sizes from 16 inches and larger shall conform to AWWA C515, latest revision, and shall be designed for a working pressure of 250 psi. Valves shall be ductile iron body, resilient wedge type with Nitrile rubber 0 -ring stem seals. Stems shall be sealed with three (3) O -rings. The top two O -rings shall be replaceable with the valve fully open and subject to the full rated working pressure. O -rings in a cartridge shall not be allowed. All cast ferrous components of the tapping valve including the valve body, wedge, bonnet and stuffing box shall be constructed of ductile iron in conformance with ASTM A536. The valve stem shall be manufactured of manganese bronze in accordance with ASTM B763 and the wedge nut shall be manufactured of bronze in accordance with ASTM B584. The valve stem shall have an integral thrust collar; two-piece stem collars shall not be acceptable. The valve shall have Delrin thrust washers above and below the thrust collar to assist in the operation of the valve. Valve wedge shall be symmetrical and constructed to assure uniform seating pressure between the wedge seat circumference and body seating surface, providing a complete seal at the rated pressure with flow from either direction. Resilient wedge of the valve shall be formed by a special corrosion and chloramine resistant, EPDM synthetic elastomer which is permanently bonded to and completely encapsulates the ductile iron valve disc. SECTION IV Page 98 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications The wedge nut shall be independent of the wedge and held in place on three sides by the wedge to prevent possible misalignment. All bolting materials for buried tapping valves shall be Type 316 stainless steel, as specified below, with hexagonal shaped heads with dimensions conforming to ANSI B18.2.1; metric bolting materials shall not be allowed. Tapping valves shall be NSF 61 listed. B. Tapping Valve Ends: All tapping valves shall have a special flange with a raised lip to mate with the groove in the tapping sleeve flange and a mechanical joint end on the discharge side of the valve. C. Tapping Valve Connection Bolting: Bolts and nuts for the tapping valve flange connection shall be Type 316 stainless steel conforming to ASTM A193, Grade B8M for bolts and ASTM A194, Grade 8M for nuts. The nuts shall be fluoropolymer coated and have a hardness that is lower than that of the bolts and washers by a difference of 50 Brinnell hardness to prevent galling during installation. Jointing materials for the mechanical joint valve end and the mechanical joint tapping sleeve ends shall be in strict accordance with ANSI/AWWA C111 and ANSI/AWWA C153, latest revisions. Tee head bolts and nuts for the mechanical joint ends shall be manufactured of CORTEN, high strength, low alloy, corrosion resistant steel in accordance with ASTM A242, or an equal approved by the Engineer and the Owner. D. Tapping Valve Operators: Tapping gate valves shall have non -rising stems and shall open by turning to the left (counterclockwise), when viewed from the stem. Tapping valves shall be furnished with a ductile iron 2 -inch square AWWA standard nut operator with an arrow cast into the metal indicating the direction of opening. Tapping valves 16 -inches and larger in nominal size shall be provided with a spur gear box, valve operator. The spur gear shall be an EXEECO IS -5 to IS -10 spur gear, depending on valve size, with a gear ratio not more than 2:1. E. Interior Tapping Valve Linings: The interior of the tapping valve body shall be lined with a fusion bonded or thermo-setting epoxy coating in accordance with AWWA C550, latest revision. Lining shall be holiday -free, NSF approved, with a minimum thickness of 16 mils. Surfaces shall be clean, dry, and free from rust and grease before lining. F. Exterior Tapping Valve Coatings: All exterior surfaces of tapping valves shall be clean, dry, and free from rust and grease before coating. The exterior ferrous parts of all tapping valves shall be coated at the factory with fusion bonded or thermo-setting epoxy coating with a minimum total finish dry film thickness of 16 mils. Prior to back filling, all uncoated nuts, bolts, glands, rods, and other parts of joints shall be coated in the field with two coats of coal tar epoxy equal to Carboline Bitumastic No. 300-M. 502-9. LINE STOPPING ASSEMBLIES Specialty line stop fittings shall be used for applications where it is necessary to isolate a section of pipe without interrupting service. The Contractor shall provide a submittal which clearly identifies the materials used for line stop applications. Sleeves used to line -stop existing mains shall be provided and installed at locations as shown on the Drawings or as required for construction of the new force main tie-in to an existing force main. Line - stopping sleeve shall be steel fusion epoxy coated body with stainless steel bolts, nuts, and washers. Contractor shall determine the outside diameter of the existing main prior to ordering sleeve. The back (bottom) section shall be solid and designed within an outside diameter range specific to the pipe it is being installed on. The front (top) section will also be full encirclement design with a welded installed nozzle and flange outlet. Line stop fitting sleeves shall be the high strength type having a wide body, made of a minimum material strength of A-283 grade steel, ASTM A-36 Steel or equal, which conforms to and reinforces the pipe. The sleeve shall have as a minimum 7/8 -inch wide gasket of Nitrile Butadiene Rubber (NBR, Buna-N) per ASTM D2000 with hydro activated lip, captured in a recessed groove around the outlet. Bolts, nuts and washers shall be 3/4 -inch stainless steel 18-8 type 304. A 3/4 -inch forged steel test outlet will be placed SECTION IV Page 99 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 • SECTION IV — Technical Specifications into the nozzle branch outlet, at the factory, for the purposes of site pressure testing after the fitting has been installed around the pipe. Tapping sleeves and line stops shall be installed in accordance with the manufacturer's recommendations for the specified model. The fitting may not be retrofitted in any way after being installed on the pipe. The Contractor shall be responsible for ensuring that the fitting is properly restrained. The line -stopping equipment shall consist of a resilient sealing element, which shall be attached to and transported by a plug inserted perpendicularly into the pipe. The linear actuator shall extend and retract the Line -Stopper into and out of the pipe. When retracted from the pipe, the element and inserter shall be contained within the stopper housing. The hollow cylindrical sealing element shall be molded of natural rubber. The lower interior chamber of the element shall be enlarged into a hemispherical cavity to allow symmetrical deformation into sealing conformity with the bore of the pipe. The linear actuator shall be hydraulic and shall have a self-contained hand operated pump. The actuator shall exert a force sufficient to perpendicularly deform the cylindrical element into axially symmetrical sealing contact with the bore of the pipe. Design of actuator shall provide adequate stroke and means to continually align the line -stop bullet stopping assemblies in sizes 4 -inch thru 20 -inch with pressure rating to 250 psig. Equalization of pressure across the sealed element shall not be required to retract the element from the pipe. No equalization fittings shall be required downstream of the line -stopper. Line -stopping equipment must be capable of function and acceptance of multiple stopper heads and shall be compatible with existing system fittings. 502-10. BLOW OFF HYDRANTS • Hydrant Blow offs are not allowed. • 503. CONSTRUCTION 503-1. MATERIAL HANDLING 1. Care shall be taken in loading, transporting, and unloading to prevent damage to the pipe or fittings and their respective coatings. Pipe, fittings, valves, hydrants, and accessories shall be loaded and unloaded by lifting with hoists or skidding so as to avoid shock or damage. Under no circumstances shall such materials be rolled off the carrier or dropped. Unloading shall be done by lifting with a forklift or crane using straps and a spreader bar. Pipe handled on skidways shall not be skidded or rolled against pipe already on the ground. 2. Pipe shall be stored on level ground, preferably turf or sand, free of sharp objects which could damage the pipe. Stacking of the pipe shall be limited to a height that will not cause excessive deformation of the bottom layers of pipes. Pipe shall be stacked no higher than 6 -feet high on the project site for safety reasons. Where necessary, due to ground conditions, the pipe shall be stored on wooden sleepers, suitably spaced and of such width as not to allow deformation of the pipe at the point of contact with the sleeper or between supports. 3. The interior surfaces of valves and piping shall be kept free of dirt and debris. 4. Pipe and fittings which require the protection from UV, such as PVC or HDPE pipe, shall be covered and protected in accordance with manufacturer instructions. 5. Pipe shall be so handled that the coating and lining will not be damaged. If, however, any part of the coating or lining is damaged, the repair shall be made by the Contractor at their expense in a manner satisfactory to the Engineer. SECTION IV Page 100 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications 6. In distributing the material at the site of the work, each piece shall be unloaded opposite or near the place where it is to be laid in the trench. 7. All materials shall be subject to inspection and approved by the Engineer after delivery; and no broken, cracked, misshapen, imperfectly coated or otherwise damaged, unsatisfactory or defective material shall be used. 8. All material found during the progress of the work to have cracks, flaws, or other defects shall be rejected and promptly removed from the site. 9. If damage occurs to any pipe, fittings, valves, hydrants or water main accessories in handling, the damage shall be immediately brought to the Engineer's attention. The Engineer shall prescribe corrective repairs or rejection of the damaged items. 503-2. PIPE LAYING 503-2.1. INSPECTION PRIOR TO INSTALLATION All pipe, fittings, valves, and other material shall be subject to inspection and approval by the Engineer and the City after delivery and prior to installation. If damage occurs to any pipe, fittings, valves, hydrants or accessories in handling, the damage shall be immediately brought to the Engineer's attention. The Engineer shall prescribe corrective repairs or rejection of the damaged items. No broken, cracked, imperfectly coated, or otherwise damaged or unsatisfactory material shall be installed. When a defect or crack is discovered, the injured or defective piece shall not be installed and shall be removed from the project site. All homing marks shall be checked for proper length to not allow a separation or over homing of connected pipe. Homing marks incorrectly marked on pipe shall result in rejection of pipe and removal from the site at the Contractor's expense. 503-2.2. GENERAL INSTALLATION REQUIREMENTS General: Excavation, backfill, and compaction shall conform to the provisions of Section 201-2. — Excavation, Backfilling and Compaction for Utilities. Upon satisfactory installation of the pipe bedding material as specified in Section 201-2. — Excavation, Backfilling and Compaction for Utilities, a continuous trough for the pipe barrel and recesses for the pipe bells or couplings shall be excavated by hand digging. When the pipe is laid in the prepared trench, true to line and grade, the pipe barrel shall receive continuous, uniform support and no pressure will be exerted on the pipe joints from the trench bottom. Proper implements, tools, and facilities satisfactory to the Engineer shall be provided and used by the Contractor for the safe and convenient performance of the work. All pipe, fittings, valves, and hydrants shall be carefully lowered into the trench piece by piece by means of a derrick, ropes, or other suitable tools or equipment in such a manner as to prevent damage to materials and protective coatings and linings. Under no circumstances shall materials be dropped or dumped in the trench. Pipe, fittings, valves, and accessories shall be installed as shown or indicated on the Drawings. All joint lubricant compounds shall be NSF approved. Water in Excavations: Water shall not be allowed in the trenches while underground pipes are being laid and/or tested. All pipe shall be laid "in the dry". Installation of potable water pipes, reclaimed water pipes or wastewater force main pipes shall not proceed in the trench until the trench has been properly dewatered and prepared. Refer to Section 203, Dewatering for dewatering requirements for the installation of pipelines. No pipe shall be laid when, in the opinion of the Engineer, trench conditions are unsuitable. Water shall not be allowed in the trenches while the pipes are being laid and/or tested. The Contractor shall not open more trench than the available pumping facilities are able to dewater the trench to the satisfaction of the Engineer or the city's Inspector. The Contractor shall assume responsibility for legally disposing of all water so as not to injure or interfere with the normal drainage of the area in which he is working. In no case SECTION IV Page 101 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 • • SECTION IV — Technical Specifications shall the pipelines being installed be used as drains for such water, and the ends of the pipe shall be kept properly and adequately plugged during construction by the use of approved stoppers and not by improvised equipment. All necessary precautions shall be taken by the Contractor to prevent the entrance of mud, sand, or other obstructing matter into the pipelines. If on completion of the work any such materials have entered the pipelines, it must be cleaned as directed by the Engineer and the city's Inspector so that the entire system will be left clean and unobstructed. The Contractor shall not leave trenches open overnight. Pipe Bedding: The Contractor shall provide pipe bedding material in accordance with the Standard Details on the Drawings and Section 201-2. — Excavation, Backfilling and Compaction for Utilities. The Contractor shall hand -grade bedding to proper grade ahead of pipe laying operation. Bedding shall provide a firm, unyielding support along the entire pipe length. If the trench has been excavated below the required depth for pipe bedding material placement, the Contractor shall fill the excess depth with pipe bedding material to the proper grade. The Contractor shall excavate bell holes at each joint to permit proper assembly and inspection of the entire joint. Pipe Cradle: Upon satisfactory installation of the pipe trench as specified in Section 201-2. — Excavation, Backfilling and Compaction for Utilities and the pipe bedding, a continuous trough for the pipe barrel and recesses for the pipe bells or couplings shall be excavated by hand digging so that when the pipe is laid in the prepared trench, true to line and grade, the pipe barrel shall receive continuous, uniform support and no pressure will be exerted on the pipe joints or pipe bell from the trench bottom. Cleanliness: Mud, silt, gravel, and other foreign material shall be kept out of the pipe and off the jointing surface. The interior of the pipes shall be thoroughly cleaned of all foreign material before being gently lowered into the trench and shall be kept clean during laying operations by means of plugs or other methods accepted by the Engineer and the city. During suspension of work for any reason at any time, a suitable watertight plug shall be placed in the end of the pipe last laid to prevent mud or other foreign material from entering the pipe. Connections to Existing Utilities: All connections to existing piping systems shall be made as shown or indicated on the Drawings after consultation and cooperation with the city Utility Department. Some such connections may have to be made during off-peak hours (late night or early morning). Pipe Joint Deflection: Whenever it is desirable to deflect pipe joints to avoid obstructions or to maintain required alignment, the amount of the joint deflection shall not exceed 50 percent of the maximum limits allowed by the pipe manufacturer for ductile iron pipe. No bending or joint deflection of PVC pipe shall be permitted at any time. Changes in horizontal and vertical alignment of PVC pipe shall be achieved by use of fittings only. Pipe Installation: In preparation for pipe installation, placement (stringing) of pipe should be as close to the trench as practical on the opposite side of the trench from the excavated material. All pipe and fittings shall be carefully examined for cracks and other defects while suspended above the trench immediately before installation in final position. Spigot ends shall be examined with particular care as this area is the most vulnerable to damage from handling. Pipe laying shall proceed with the bell ends of the pipe pointing in the direction of the work progress unless directed otherwise by the Engineer. Where pipe is laid on a grade of 10 percent or greater, the laying shall start at bottom and shall proceed upward with the bell ends of the pipe pointing upgrade. Before pipe is joined, gaskets shall be cleaned of all dirt and stones and other foreign material. The spigot ends of the pipe and/or pipe gaskets shall be lubricated lightly with an NSF approved lubricant as specified by the pipe manufacturer and approved by the Engineer and the city. No sulfur based joint compound shall be used. Sufficient pressure shall be applied to the pipe to properly seat the spigot end into the bell of the previously laid pipe. Any damage to the pipe due to over-exertion shall be repaired at the Contractor's expense All damaged pipe shall be removed for the Project site. SECTION IV Page 102 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV—Technical Specifications Pipe and fittings shall be laid accurately to the lines and grades indicated on Drawings or required. The depth of cover over the pipeline shall vary to provide uniform gradient or slope to the pipe, whether grading is completed or proposed at time of pipe installation. Where grades for the pipeline are not indicated on the Drawings, maintain a uniform depth of cover with respect to finish grade. As each length of pipe is placed in the trench, the spigot end shall be centered in the bell and the pipe forced home and brought to correct line and grade. The pipe shall be secured in place with approved backfill material tamped under it except at the bells. Precautions shall be taken to prevent dirt from entering the joint space. All pipe laid shall be retained in position to maintain alignment and joint closure until sufficient backfill has been completed to adequately hold the pipe in place. Care shall be taken to ensure a good alignment both horizontally and vertically and to give the pipe a firm bearing along its entire length. Any pipe which has its grade or joint disturbed after laying shall be taken up and relayed. All pipe and fittings shall be cleared of sand, dirt, and debris before laying. All precautions shall be taken to prevent sand, dirt, or other foreign material from entering the pipe during installation. If necessary, a heavy, tightly woven canvas bag of suitable size shall be placed over each end of the pipe before lowering into the trench and left there until the connection is made to the adjacent pipe. Any sand, dirt, or other foreign material that enters the pipe shall be removed from the pipe immediately. During pipe laying operations, no debris, tools, clothing or other materials shall be placed into the pipe interior. Interior of all pipe and fittings shall be kept clean after installation until accepted in the complete Work. Any time that pipe installation is not in progress, the open ends of pipe shall be closed by a watertight plug or other method approved by the Engineer and the city Inspector. Plugs shall remain in pipe ends until all water is removed from the trench. No pipe shall be installed when trench conditions are unsuitable for such work, including standing water, excess mud, or rain. Thrust Restraint: A. General: Thrust restraint shall be accomplished by piping restrained joints or mechanical restraining devices. B. Required Length of Restrained Joints: The length of restrained joints required shall be in accordance with the lengths shown on the Plan and Profile Drawings. The restrained joint lengths listed in the Restrained Joint Pipe Tables in the Drawings are absolute minimum lengths required and may not reflect the actual length of restrained joints required for a particular fitting arrangement or situation. C. Concrete Trust Blocks: Concrete thrust blocks shall not under any circumstances be allowed on the Project for thrust restraint at fittings. D. Concrete Trust Collars: Concrete thrust collars shall be used under extraordinary circumstances when approved by the Engineer and the city. If thrust collars are used, they shall conform to the details shown on the Drawings and shall be constructed of Class I concrete, which shall have a minimum compressive strength of 3,500 psi at 28 days. No pipeline work shall be accomplished adjacent to a thrust collar until the concrete has reached its full compressive strength and can handle the required thrust restraint. Initial Backfill: A. After pipe has been laid, inspected, and found satisfactory, sufficient backfill shall be placed along the pipe barrel to hold the pipe securely in place while conducting the preliminary hydrostatic test. No backfill shall be placed over the joints until the preliminary test is satisfactorily completed, leaving them exposed to view for the detection of visible leaks. B. Upon satisfactory completion of the preliminary hydrostatic test, backfilling and compaction of the trench shall be completed. SECTION IV Page 103 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 • • • SECTION IV —Technical Specifications Location Detection Wire: Refer to the city Standard Detail Drawings for wire location and installation notes. Location Detection Wires shall be installed for all potable water mains, reclaimed water mains and wastewater force mains. For open cut installation the two (2) detection wires shall be attached generally at the three o'clock and nine o'clock positions on the pipe with nylon pipe straps or tape located at 5 -foot intervals for each 20 -foot length of pipe. The wire shall be installed through valve boxes, valve vaults, air release valve enclosures, etc., and provide sufficient excess (12 -inches minimum) such that a loop in the wire can be raised above ground level. An energy source shall be attached to each of the wires to energize each wire to facilitate location of the wire and pipe using a metal detector. Prior to acceptance, the Contractor shall demonstrate to the Engineer and the city Inspector that each of the wires is continuous and unbroken through the complete run of the pipe by performing a continuity test of the 10 gauge location detection wires for the entire length of the potable water main, the reclaimed water main or the wastewater force main at each valve test station box. The test shall also include energizing each of the wires and locating the entire run of pipe with the Engineer and the city Inspector present. Underground Identification Tape: Install a continuous underground utility identification tape for all underground potable water mains, reclaimed water mains and wastewater force mains installed by open - cut methods. The identification tape shall be installed over the centerline of the pipe at a depth of 12 -inches below finished grade. Aboveground and Exposed Piping: Piping shall be cut accurately to measurements established at the job site and shall be worked into place without springing or forcing, properly clearing all equipment access areas and openings. Changes in sizes shall be made with appropriate reducing fittings. Pipe connections shall be made in accordance with the details shown and manufacturer's recommendations. Open ends of pipelines shall be properly capped or plugged during installation to keep dirt and other foreign material out of the system. Pipe supports and hangers shall be provided where indicated or as required to ensure adequate support of the piping. All above ground piping shall be painted with the appropriate color. 503-2.3. INSTALLATION OF DUCTILE IRON PIPE Handling and Cutting Pipe: A. Care shall be taken in handling, cutting, and laying ductile iron pipe and fittings to avoid damaging the pipe and interior cement mortar lining, scratching, or marring machined surfaces, and abrasion of the exterior pipe coating. All cracked pipe and fittings shall be removed at once from the Work. B. Pipe cutting shall be done by skilled workmen in a neat workmanlike manner without creating damage to the pipe and interior lining and to leave a smooth end at right angles to the axis of the pipe. Cut ends shall be square and rough edges of ductile iron pipe shall be ground smooth. For push -on joint connections, the cut end shall be beveled to prevent gasket damage during joint assembly. Interior lining and exterior coatings of the pipe shall be repaired at cut ends per the manufacturer's instructions prior to joint assembly. Laying Ductile Iron Pipe and Fittings: A. Bedding for Ductile Iron Pipe: Minimum bedding requirements shall be Type 3 as defined in ANSUAWWA C600, latest revision. Provide proper bedding required, in accordance with thickness class of pipe being laid, restrained joints required and depth of cover. At a minimum the pipe shall be bedded in compacted 4 -inch thick select fill and backfilled and compacted to the top of the pipe to a minimum of 95% Modified Proctor. Proper pipe laying conditions shall be in accordance with ANSUAWWA C150 and C151, latest revisions, and ANSUAWWA C600, latest revision. B. All ductile iron pipe and fittings shall be laid in accordance with American Water Works Association Standard ANSI/AWWA C600, latest revision, entitled "Standard for Installation of Ductile -Iron Water Mains and Their Appurtenances ", with the following sections specifically applying: SECTION IV Page 104 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV—Technical Specifications 1. Section 3.3 - Pipe Installation. 2. Section 3.4 - Joint Assembly. C. Polyethylene tube encasement shall be installed for all buried ductile iron pipe segments and fittings for corrosion protection. Installation procedures shall be in accordance with AWWA C105/ANSI A21.5-10, latest revision, entitled Polyethylene Encasement for Ductile Iron Pipe Systems, Section 4.4 - Installation. Ductile Iron Pipe Joints: A. General: The joints of all pipelines shall be made leak tight. The particular joint used shall be approved by the Engineer and the city Inspector prior to installation. Where shown on the Drawings or where, in the opinion of the Engineer or the city Inspector, settlement or vibration is likely to occur, all pipe joints shall be bolted mechanical joint type with mechanical restraints, push -on joints with mechanical restraints or manufactured restrained joint type as specified above, or as indicated on the Drawings. All lumps, blisters, and excess coating shall be removed from the bell and spigot end of each pipe, and the outside of the spigot and the inside of the bell shall be wire brushed and wiped clean and dry and free from oil and grease before the pipe is laid. Pipe joints shall be made up in accordance with the manufacturer's recommendations. B. Mechanical Restrained Joints: All types of mechanical joint and push -on joint pipes with mechanical restraints shall be laid and jointed in full conformance with manufacturer's recommendations, which shall be submitted to the Engineer and the city Inspector for review and approval before work is begun. Only specially trained and skilled workmen shall be permitted to makeup mechanical restrained joints. Torque wrenches, set as specified in AWWA Standard C111, shall be used; or spanner type wrenches not longer than specified therein may be used with the permission of the Engineer and the city Inspector. The gasket shall be inserted, and the joint surfaces cleaned and lubricated with soapy water before tightening the bolts to the specified torque. C. Manufactured Restrained Joints: Manufactured restrained joints shall be provided where indicated on the Drawings. Joint assembly shall be made in strict accordance with the manufacturer's instructions, which shall be submitted to the Engineer or the city Inspector for review and approval before commencing work. D. Flanged Joints: Flanged joints shall be made up by inserting the gasket between the flanges. The threads of the bolts and the faces of the gaskets shall be coated with suitable lubricant immediately before installation. Joints shall be fitted so that the contact faces bear uniformly on the gasket. 1. Bolt holes of flanges shall straddle the horizontal and vertical centerlines of the pipe. Clean flanges by wire brushing before installing flanged fittings. Clean flange bolts and nuts by wire brushing and lubricate bolts with oil and graphite. 2. Insert the nuts and bolts (or studs), finger tighten, and progressively tighten diametrically opposite bolts uniformly around the flange to the proper tension. 3. Execute care when tightening joints to prevent undue strain upon valves, pumps, backflow preventers and other equipment. If flanges leak under pressure testing, loosen, or remove the nuts and bolts, reset or replace the gasket, re- install or re -tighten the bolts and nuts, and re -test the joints. Joints shall be watertight; no leaks shall be allowed. 503-2.4. INSTALLATION OF POLYVINYL CHLORIDE (PVC) PIPE Storage and Handling of PVC Pipe: PVC pipe shall be delivered to the site in unbroken bundles packaged in such manner as to provide protection against damage. When possible, pipe should be stored at the job site in the unit packages until ready for use. Packaged units shall be handled using a forklift or a spreader bar with fabric straps. Packaged units shall not be stacked at the job site higher than two units high. SECTION IV Page 105 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 • • SECTION IV — Technical Specifications When it is necessary to store PVC pipe for long periods of time, exposure to direct sunlight shall be prevented by covering the pipe with an opaque material. Adequate air circulation above and around the pipe shall be provided as required to prevent excessive heat accumulation. PVC pipe shall not be stored close to heat sources of hot objects such as heaters, fires, boilers, or engine exhaust. Pipe gaskets shall be protected from excessive exposure to heat, direct sunlight, ozone, oil, and grease. The interior and all sealing surfaces of pipe, fittings, and other appurtenances shall be kept clean and free of dirt and foreign matter. Care shall be taken in handling and laying pipe and fittings to avoid severe impact blows, crushing, abrasion damage, gouging, or cutting. Pipe shall be lowered, not dropped, from trucks or into trenches. All cracked, damaged, or defective pipe and fittings, or any length of PVC pipe having a gouge, scratch, or other permanent indentation of more than 10 percent of the wall thickness in depth, shall be rejected and removed at once from the Work and replaced with new acceptable pipe. Field Cutting PVC Pipe: Field cutting of pipe shall be done in a neat workmanlike manner without creating damage to the pipe. The pipe shall be cut square with a fine-toothed hand or power saw or other cutter or knife designed for use with plastic pipe. Prior to cutting, the pipe shall be marked around its entire circumference or a square -in vise shall be used to ensure the pipe end is cut square. Remove burrs by smoothing edges with a knife, file, or sandpaper. Field Cutting Bell and Spigot PVC Pipe: Bevel the cut end of the pipe using a pipe beveling tool, wood rasp, or portable sander to prevent damage to the gasket during joint assembly. A factory -finished beveled end should be used as a guide to ensure proper beveling angle and correct depth of bevel. Round off any sharp edges on the leading edge of the bevel with a knife or file. The Contractor shall provide a seat homing mark on the field cut pipe in accordance with the pipe manufacturer's written instructions. Laying PVC Bell and Spigot Pipe: A. Pipe Bedding: Bedding for PVC pipe shall be as specified in Section 201-2. — Excavation, Backfilling and Compaction for Utilities using granular pipe bedding material. B. All PVC pipe shall be laid in accordance with the pipe manufacturer's published installation guide, the AWWA Manual of Practice No. M23 "PVC Pipe - Design and Installation" and the Uni-Bell Plastic Pipe Association installation recommendations. PVC Pipe Joint Assembly for Rubber Gasketed Bell and Spigot Pipe: A. The PVC bell and spigot joint shall be assembled in accordance with the pipe manufacturer's installation instructions, ASTM D2774, and AWWA Manual M23. Clean the interior of the bell, the gasket, and the spigot of the pipe to be jointed with a rag to remove any dirt or foreign material before assembling. Inspect the gasket, pipe spigot bevel, gasket groove, and sealing surfaces for damage or deformation. B. Lubricate the spigot end of the pipe with an NSF approved lubricant supplied or specified by the pipe manufacturer for use with gasketed PVC pipe in potable water systems. The lubricant should be supplied as specified by the pipe manufacturer and shall be NSF approved. After the spigot end is lubricated, it must be kept clean and free of dirt and sand. If dirt and sand adhere to the lubricated end, the spigot must be wiped clean and re -lubricated. C. Insert the spigot into the bell so that it contacts the gasket uniformly. Align the pipe sections and push the spigot end into the bell until the manufacturer's reference mark on the spigot is flush with the end of the bell. The pipe should be pushed into the bell using a bar and wood block. The joint shall not be assembled by "stabbing" or swinging the pipe into the bell, nor shall construction machinery be used to push the pipe into the bell. After joining the pipe, a metal feeler gauge shall be used to verify that the joint gasket is properly located. D. If undue resistance to insertion of the spigot end is encountered or if the reference mark does not reach the flush position, disassemble the joint and check the position of the gasket. If the gasket is twisted or pushed out of its seat, inspect the components, repair, or replace damaged items, clean SECTION IV Page 106 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV—Technical Specifications the components, and repeat the assembly steps. Be sure the pipe is in proper alignment during assembly. If the gasket was not out of position, check the distance between the spigot end and the reference mark and relocate the mark if it is out of position. E. Restrained joints for PVC pipe shall be provided where indicated on the Drawings. Joint assembly shall be made in strict accordance with the joint restraint manufacturer's instructions, which shall be submitted to the Engineer and the city for review and approval before commencing work. 503-2.5. DIRECTIONAL BORING INSTALLATION The work of this Section includes all labor, machinery, construction equipment and appliances required for installation of high-density polyethylene (HDPE) pipe or Certa-Loc PVC pipe below the ground using directionally controlled horizontal drilling equipment and methods. All directional boring methods and equipment shall be approved by the Engineer and the city before any work shall be permitted. All directional boring and pipe installation methods shall be performed in a good workmanlike and safe manner. Horizontal Directional Drilling (HDD) is a construction method consisting of drilling a small diameter pilot hole within the designed tolerances for radius requirements, followed by enlargement of the hole by back reaming to accommodate the utility pipeline. 503-2.5.1. GENERAL REQUIREMENTS The overall work scope shall include, but not be limited to steerable directional boring equipment, boring pits and equipment, sheeting, location signs as required, maintenance of traffic and miscellaneous appurtenances to complete the entire Work as shown on the Contract Drawings, and restoration. Directional boring operations shall be performed within the right-of-way and/or easements shown on the Drawings. The HDD Contractor shall assume full responsibility for his methods of construction, the stability and accuracy of the drilled and reamed hole and pits constructed by him, and all costs for damages resulting from any failure thereof and be solely responsible for the safety of the pits and related structures, and personnel engaged in underground construction throughout the duration of the work. The general dimensions, arrangement and details for the drilled pilot hole and entry and exit pits to be constructed shall be as indicated on the approved Shop Drawings. Methods of excavation, equipment and procedures for the HDD operation and pits shall be selected to provide adequate working space and clearances for the work to be performed. Utility Protection: Utility lines and structures indicated on the Drawings, which are to remain in service, shall be protected from any damage. Where utility lines or structures not shown on the Drawings are encountered, Contractor shall report them to the city and the Engineer before proceeding with the Work. All utilities within 10 feet of the drill pilot bore, back ream or utility carrier pipe installation will be exposed through a soft -dig "pot -hole" or other opening, in accordance with appropriate utility locate laws and regulations, to ensure, through visual inspection, that the drill, reamer or utility carrier pipe has caused no damage to the utility and maintains adequate clearance. All potholes to locate existing utilities shall be sealed with an excavatable grout to avoid a possible flow path for the HDD drilling mud. Prior to commencing drilling operations, positively locate and stake all existing utility pipelines, cables, storm sewers, or other underground facilities which are located within 10 feet of the designed drilled path. All work covered by these Technical Specifications shall be performed in accordance with the applicable local, state and federal codes and laws which pertain to such work and supplemental regulations which are contained in these Technical Specifications. SECTION IV Page 107 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications At all times when construction is not in progress, watertight plugs shall be installed in all pipe ends and openings, either following aboveground pipe fusing and storage before pipe pulling or following underground installation after pipe pull back. 503-2.5.2. SUBMITTALS The Contractor shall prepare a detailed schedule for the work and submit it to the Engineer and the city for approval. The schedule shall include all major tasks to be performed, including but not limited to the following: pipe delivery; rig mobilization and setup; pipe assembly; pilot hole drilling; reaming; pressure testing the pipe before installation; pipe pulling; pressure testing and pigging/flushing the pipe after installation; disinfection of potable water pipelines; anticipated work hours for each task, daily work hours and dates anticipated for each task. At least 10 days prior to mobilization of equipment, the Contractor shall submit a detailed installation plan to the city and the Engineer for review and approval. The plan shall also include a detailed Plan and Profile of the bore plotted at a scale no smaller than 1 -inch equals 20 feet horizontally and 1 -inch equals 4 feet vertically. The Contractor shall include a site plan of the entrance and exit pits, the pipe lay down area and equipment staging. Traffic control plans for entry pit, exit pit, and pipe lay down area if different than what is indicated on the Roadway Traffic Control Plan Drawings. Submit pipe, fittings, specials, joint restraint systems, adapters and couplings shop drawings including complete dimensions including length, internal diameter, pressure rating and wall thickness; maximum allowable deflection of the pipe; detailing; mechanical connections; and necessary accessories for manufacture, transportation, storage, handling, and installation. Submit pipe assembly procedures including: 1. Descriptions of procedures means and methods for storing, fabricating, handling, transporting, and protecting pipe segments. 2. Calculations of stresses and longitudinal strains developed in pipe during handling and installation. 3. Description of controls to safeguard that the allowable pulling forces will not be exceeded during the installation. 4. Description of procedures for lifting pipe. 5. Calculations showing allowable lifting configurations so allowable stresses will not be exceeded. 6. Welding procedures for high density polyethylene pipe. Submit a description of procedures, methods and materials that will be used to repair pipe or pipe joints damaged during installation. Submit a description of methods and materials that will be used to correct leaks in pipe or pipe joints. Equipment Submittal: Contractor shall submit manufacturer and specifications of directional drilling equipment to be used to ensure that the equipment will be adequate to complete the project. Submittal shall demonstrate that anticipated pullback forces do not exceed the tensile strength of the HDPE pipe with a minimum factor of safety of 2.0. Include calculations prepared by a Professional Engineer licensed in the State of Florida demonstrating maximum allowable pullback forces for this installation / material combination. Drilling Plan Submittal: Contractor shall submit a Drilling Plan including: Drilling Operations, Reaming Operations, Estimated Pullback Loads, Drilling Fluids Management, Safety Plan, and a Contingency Plan. A. Drilling Operations submittal shall include: 1. The number and size of construction crew, hours to be worked, pilot hole drilling procedure, reaming procedure, method of tracking and controlling the drilling head, method of verifying pipe location for as -built drawing and schedule for completing major activities. SECTION IV Page 108 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications 2. Provide a 2 -inch x 34 -inch layout drawing(s), scale 1 -inch = 20 feet, indicating location of the entry, exit pits, and fluid storage pits, location of fused pipe before pulling (shall not block access to private property), location and type of fusion equipment, storage of waste fluid, and fluid recycling plan (if used). 3. Spoil handling, separation and disposal. 4. Provide a detail of the planned bore path and the method of monitoring and controlling the speed, line, grade, and rate of fluids delivery. 5. Include the sequence, size and description of each reamer and the capabilities of each through the type of soils anticipated to be encountered in the project area. 6. The Contractor shall maintain the alignment and minimum radii as detailed on the plan sheets and as specified herein. 7. The drill plan should include a final swabbing of the bore path prior to pipe pullback. 8. Contractor shall not proceed with work until Drilling Plan is approved by the Engineer and the city. B. Reaming Operations submittal shall include the required bore hole size for pullback of the pipeline. The Reaming Operation Plan shall be submitted for review prior to initiation of construction. C. Estimated Pullback Loads submittal shall include: 1. The Contractor shall submit to the Engineer an estimate of the anticipated pullback loads that will be required to install the pipe. 2. Contractor shall include the calculated buoyant force or buoyant weight of the pipe and proposed method for counterweighting or ballasting the pipe during pullback. a. Calculation shall be based on anticipated density of the drilling fluid(s) to be used. b. Any counterweight or ballast pipe placed inside the pipe shall be free from any dirt, grease, oil, or other contaminants that may prevent proper disinfection. D. Drilling Fluids Management submittal shall include: 1. Submit MSDS sheets for drilling fluid additives proposed, demonstrating they are non- hazardous. 2. Proposed mix design for each specific geological strata or formation anticipated during drilling of the bore path. 3. Estimate of drilling fluids and quantities to be utilized during each reaming pass. 4. Delivery volume and pressure for each reaming pass and the proposed method for monitoring. 5. Details of the drilling fluid/soil slurry solids separation, recycling or disposal plan that will describe the equipment and capacities for separation and recirculation. a. If direct vacuum excavation of the slurry is selected, the disposal site shall be identified, and copies of all required permits shall be presented to the Engineer. b. The Contractor shall submit a written plan that details the estimated quantity of slurry to be vacuum excavated and provide substantiation that there is sufficient equipment to adequately pump or shuttle the slurry to and from the disposal site(s) as required to maintain a near continuous drilling and pipe pull-back. 6. The Contractor shall submit to the Engineer a contingency plan for a quick response team to address inadvertent fluid discharges to the surface (frac-outs). In the event that a drilling fluid fracture, inadvertent returns or loss of returns occurs during pilot hole drilling operations, Contractor shall cease drilling, wait at least 30 minutes, inject a quantity of drilling fluid with a viscosity exceeding 120 seconds as measured by a March funnel and then wait another 30 minutes. If mud fractures or returns loss continues, Contractor will cease operations and notify the Engineer and the city. The Engineer, the city and the Contractor will discuss additional options and the Work will then proceed accordingly. Repair and clean-up of damages associated with frac-outs will be resolved in a timely fashion as directed by the city at the Contractor's expense. SECTION IV Page 109 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 • • SECTION IV — Technical Specifications E. Safety Plan submittal: The Contractor shall be responsible for securing a safe worksite that meets all Federal, State, and Local government codes. A project safety and contingency plan which shall include but shall not be limited to drilling fluid containment and cleanup procedures, equipment and plan for compromised utility installations including electrical and power lines, potable water, reclaimed water, wastewater, storm water and any other subsurface utility. F. Contingency Plan submittal: Contractor shall submit contingency plans to address procedures to be employed in the event the following may occur: 1. Obstruction encountered during drilling or reaming. 2. Broken drill pipe. 3. Collapsed or buckled carrier pipe or casing pipe. 4. HDD fails to advance or fails to respond to steering actions. 5. Alignment deviation is outside allowable limits. 6. Installation (pull back) forces reach 75% of the max allowable forces. 7. Ground settlement/heaving exceed allowable limits set by the Engineer and the city. Project Records and As -Built Drawings submittals shall include the following: A. Fusion joint data and fusion technician data indicating conformance with this Technical Specification and applicable standards. This will include fusion joint warranty information and recommended project specific fusion parameters, including criteria logged and recorded by data logger. B. Certified copies of test reports of factory tests for the pipe to be inserted into the bore hole prepared by HDD methods required by the applicable standards and this Technical Special Provision. Report shall include at minimum include following information: 1. Dimensional Checks 2. Pipe Burst 3. Flattening 4. Extrusion Quality (Acetone Immersion) C. Project Records: Maintain a complete set of project records. Maintain a daily activity log during Horizontal Directional Drilling operations. Log shall accurately record entire workday. These documents shall include but not be limited to: 1. Start and finish time of each section of drill pipe for pilot hole drilling and reaming. 2. For pilot hole drilling, drill bit location at least every 10 ft. along the drill path. Mark the as -built drawings on a daily basis with drilling progress. 3. General description of ground condition drilled. 4. Details and perceived reasons for delays greater than one hour other than normal breaks and shift changes. 5. Details of any unusual conditions or events. As -built Drawings: Maintain at the construction site a set of field drawings for recording the pilot hole as - built conditions. Plot as -built conditions on the field drawings, including the location in plan and elevation of the pilot hole. 503-2.5.3. QUALITY ASSURANCE AND COORDINATION OF WORK HDD Contractor's Experience: Any horizontal directional drilling operations 16" or larger diameter installation shall be conducted by an experienced HDD Contractor. The HDD Contractor shall have minimum of five years of experience constructing horizontal directional drills for pipelines of the same or larger diameter and the same or greater lengths. A responsible representative of the HDD Contractor and the city must be present at all times during a directional drilling operation. A responsible representative as specified herein is defined as a person experienced in the type of Work being performed and who has authority to represent the Contractor in a routine decision making capacity concerning the manner and method of carrying out the Work. SECTION IV Page 110 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications Qualifications and Experience of Contractor Personnel: The Contractor shall employ skilled, experienced superintendent(s), drill rig operators, and key personnel. A competent and experienced superintendent representing the HDD Contractor, that is thoroughly familiar with the equipment and type work to be performed, must always be in direct charge and control of their operation. In all cases the superintendent shall be continually present at the job site during the actual directional drilling. The superintendent(s) and drill rig operators shall each have at least three years of successful experience using the HDD process, on at least five (5) projects with similar or greater diameters, pull back length and ground conditions. The superintendent(s), drill rig operator, and key personnel shall demonstrate successful completion of at least five (5) projects where pipe was installed with horizontal directional drilling techniques. The Contractor shall furnish resumes of the superintendent(s), drill rig operator(s) and other key personnel. Personnel experience records should include project names, locations, pull back lengths, ground conditions, pipe materials, project description, city project number, Engineer, and references with names, addresses and telephone numbers. The superintendent, drill rig operator(s) and other key personnel listed in the submittal shall be on-site during all construction related activities required for HDD installation. A responsible representative of the HDD Contractor and the city shall be present at all times during the directional drilling operation. A responsible representative as specified herein is defined as a person experienced in the type of Work being performed and who has authority to represent the Contractor in a routine decision making capacity concerning the manner and method of carrying out the Work. The HDD Contractor shall always have a sufficient number of competent workers on the job to ensure the directional bore is made in a timely and satisfactory manner. Adequate personnel for carrying out all phases of the actual drilling operation must be on the job site from the beginning through the completion of the work. The Contractor shall use certified HDPE pipe welding and fusion operators. The certifications of these individuals shall be made available prior to construction. HDPE pipe welding and fusion operators shall be certified by the pipe manufacturer prior to commencement of pipe welding and fusing operations. The equipment used in directional boring, also known as horizontal directional drilling, shall be of adequate commercial size and satisfactory working condition for safe operation, and may be subject to approval by the city or at the discretion of the Engineer. Such approval, however, shall not relieve the Contractor of the responsibility for making a satisfactory installation meeting the criteria set forth herein. Only workmen experienced in directional boring operations shall be used in performing the Work. The Contractor shall provide all structures, safety equipment, and professional services required to provide for the health and safety of the general public and of personnel involved in directional boring work in accordance with the requirements of the regulatory agencies having jurisdiction The Contractor shall take all measures necessary to protect surrounding public and private property, adjacent buildings, roads, drives, sidewalks, and appurtenances from damage due to directional boring work. Responsibility and payment for correction of such damage shall be the sole responsibility of the Contractor and at no additional cost to the city. The HDD operation is to be operated in a manner to eliminate the discharge of water, drilling mud, and cuttings to nearby water bodies or to the land areas involved during the construction process. If inadvertent spills to nearby water bodies occur, the Contractor shall immediately provide environmental controls and cleanup to the satisfaction of, and at no additional expense to the city. Best Management Practices (BMP's) for erosion control within the Contractor's work area shall be implemented and maintained at all times during drilling and back -reaming operations to prevent siltation and turbid discharges in excess of State Water quality Standards pursuant to Rule 62-302, F.A.C. Methods shall include but are not limited to the immediate placement of turbidity containment devices such as turbidity screen, silt containment fence, hay bales, and earthen berms, etc. to contain the drilling mud. SECTION IV Page 111 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV —Technical Specifications • 503-2.5.4. HDD PIPE PRODUCTS The horizontal directional drilling shall only use Certa-Loc PVC or butt -welded HDPE pipe which meets the requirements specified in Section 502. Refer to Section 502-2.4. for the HDPE Butt Fusion Process and installation procedures for HDD installations. 503-2.5.5. GENERAL HDD INSTALLATION CONSIDERATION The Contractor shall furnish all equipment and materials required, including but not limited to the following: 1. Drilling equipment (Drilling rig, drill head, drill pipe, drilling control system, pipe pull heads, pipe rollers). 2. Water pumps, hoses, fittings, storage tanks, vacuum truck(s), filters, hay bales, and silt fences, as required. 3. Drilling fluids containment, collection, cleaning and disposal equipment, and materials. 4. Fuel and lubricants. 5. Bentonite and related mixing equipment. 6. All hydrostatic testing equipment and materials. 7. Side booms, cranes, backhoes, trucks and other equipment and materials necessary to load and unload pipe, and to support and smoothly transition the pipe while being pulled into the reamed hole. All equipment used in the horizontal directional drilling operation shall have the built-in capacity, stability and necessary safety features required to fully comply with the Technical Specifications and requirements of this section without showing evidence of undue stress or failure, and shall otherwise be in sound operating condition. Backup equipment, sufficient spares and replacement items shall be required where job site conditions indicate that severe damage to the roadway or a hazardous condition may result in the event of an equipment breakdown and where the condition of the equipment to be used indicates that routine component replacement or repair will likely be necessary during the drilling operation. If equipment breakdowns or other unforeseen stoppages occur and forward motion of the directional cutting head is halted at any time other than for reasons planned in advance (addition of drill stems, etc.), the bore hole shall remain filled with Bentonite slurry and the slurry shall be recirculated periodically. If an existing utility is damaged, pavement cutting for inspection may be approved by the roadway authority (state, county or city) and the city representative after consideration of all pertinent facts indicates that such action would offer the most practical solution to the problem for all parties concerned. Any such authorized pavement opening shall be repaired according to appropriate regulatory agency's specifications and requirements. No cutting of the pavement will be allowed on interstate or other limited access roadways unless approved by FDOT. The boring tool shall have a steering capability and have an electronic tool detection system. The position of the tool during operation shall be capable of being determined accurately both horizontally and vertically. 503-2.5.6. HDD DRILLING EQUIPMENT AND DRILLING FLUID General: The directional drilling equipment shall consist of a directional drilling rig of sufficient capacity to perform the bore(s) and pullback of the pipe(s), a drilling fluid mixing and delivery system of sufficient capacity to successfully complete the crossing, a drilling guidance system to accurately guide boring operations, a vacuum truck or mud separation plant of sufficient capacity to handle the drilling fluid volume, and trained and competent personnel to operate the system. All equipment shall be in good, safe operating condition with sufficient supplies, materials and spare parts on hand to maintain the system in good working SECTION IV Page 112 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications order for the duration of this project. All required equipment shall be included per the emergency and contingency plan as submitted per these Technical Specifications. Drilling Rig: A. The directional drilling machine shall consist of a hydraulically powered system to rotate, push and pull drill pipe while delivering a pressurized fluid mixture to a steerable drill head. The machine shall be anchored to withstand the pulling, pushing and rotating forces required to complete the project. B. The drilling rig hydraulic system shall be self-contained with sufficient pressure and volume to power drilling operations. Hydraulic system shall be free of leaks. C. The drilling rig shall have a system to monitor and record maximum pull-back forces during pull- back operations. D. The drilling rig shall be grounded during drilling and pullback operations. There shall be a system to detect electrical current from the drilling string and an audible alarm that automatically sounds when an electrical current is detected. Drill Head: A. The horizontal directional drilling equipment shall produce a stable fluid filled bore hole with the use of a steerable drill head. B. The system shall be able to control the depth and direction of the pipe. C. Drill head shall contain all necessary cutters and fluid jets for the operation and shall be of the appropriate design for the soil or rock being drilled. Drill Pipe: Drill pipe shall be constructed of high quality 4130 seamless tubing, Grade D or better, with threaded box and pins. Tool joints should be hardened to 32-36 RC. Drill pipe shall be capable of drilling the design drill path and of pulling back the HDPE pipe. Drilling Fluid System: A. Drilling Fluid (Mud): 1. Drilling Fluid shall be a high-quality bentonite drilling fluid or equivalent to ensure hole stabilization, cuttings transport, bit and electronics cooling and hole lubrication to reduce drag on the drill pipe and the product pipe. Oil based drilling fluids or fluids containing additives that can contaminate the soil or ground water shall not be considered acceptable substitutes. Composition of the fluid must comply with all applicable local, state and federal environmental regulations. 2. Drilling fluid shall be composed of clean potable water and the appropriate additive(s) for the fluid to be used. Water shall be from a clean potable source and shall meet the mixing requirements of the manufacturer. Reclaimed water shall not be considered an acceptable alternative to potable water. 3. Potable water shall be obtained from a metered city Water Utility construction service connection paid for by the Contractor. The contractor shall follow all city Water Utility Department requirements regarding backflow prevention, service water metering, and cross connection control. 4. The water and additives shall be mixed thoroughly to assure the absence of any clumps or clods. No hazardous additives may be used. 5. Drilling fluid shall be maintained at a viscosity sufficient to suspend cuttings and maintain the integrity of bore wall(s). 6. Drilling fluid shall be disposed of off-site in accordance with local, state and federal requirements and/or permit conditions. Disposal of drilling fluids shall be in compliance with environmental regulations, right-of-way and workspace agreements and permit requirements. SECTION IV Page 113 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 • • • SECTION IV —Technical Specifications 7. No additional chemicals or polymer surfactants shall be allowed to be added to the drilling fluid as submitted for this project without written consent of the city and the Engineer. B. Drilling Fluid Mixing System: 1. A self-contained, closed, drilling fluid mixing system shall be of sufficient size to mix and deliver drilling fluid for the project. 2. The drilling fluid reservoir tank shall be a minimum of 1,000 gallons. 3. The mixing system shall be able to ensure thorough mixing of the drilling fluid. The drilling fluid reservoir tank shall be sized for adequate storage of the fluid. 4. The mixing system shall continually agitate the drilling fluid during drilling operations. C. Drilling Fluid Delivery and Recovery System: 1. The mud pumping system shall have a minimum variable capacity of 35 to 500 gpm and the capability of delivering the drilling fluid at a constant minimum pressure of 1200 psi. 2. The delivery system shall have filters or other appropriate in-line equipment to prevent solids from being pumped into the drill pipe. 3. Used drilling fluid and drilling fluid spilled during drilling operations shall be contained and disposed of in a legal manner at approved solid waste landfills. The use of spill containment measures shall be maintained around drill rigs, drilling fluid mixing system, entry and exit pits and drilling fluid recycling system (if used) to prevent spills into the surrounding environment. Pumps, vacuum truck(s), and/or storage of sufficient size shall be in place to contain excess drilling fluid. 4. A closed-loop drilling fluid system and a drilling fluid cleaning system should be used to the extent practical, depending upon project size and conditions. Under no circumstances shall drilling fluid that has escaped containment (i.e. inadvertent returns) be reused in the drilling system. Pipe Pull Heads: A. Pipe pull heads shall be utilized that employ a positive through -bolt design assuring a smooth wall against the pipe cross-section at all times. B. Pipe pull heads shall be specifically designed for use with high density polyethylene (HDPE) pipe or PVC fusible pipe as appropriate and shall be as recommended by the pipe supplier. Drilling Control System: A. Calibration of the electronic detection and control system shall be verified prior to the start of the bore. B. The drilling head shall be remotely steerable by means of an electronic or magnetic detection system. The drilling head location shall be monitored in three dimensions, X, Y and Z: 1. Distance along the baseline, X. 2. Offset from the baseline, Y, and. 3. Depth of bore, Z. C. The guidance system shall be capable of tracking at all depths up to 50 feet and in any soil condition, including hard rock. It shall enable the driller to guide the drill head by providing immediate information on the tool face, azimuth (horizontal direction), and inclination (vertical direction). The guidance system shall be accurate and calibrated to the manufacturer 's specifications of the vertical depth of the borehole at sensing position at depths up to 50 feet and accurate to 2 -feet horizontally. D. Point of rotation of the head shall also be monitored. Pipe Rollers: Pipe rollers shall be used for pipe assembly and during final product pull back. SECTION IV Page 114 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications 503-2.5.7. PREPARATION AND MOBILIZATION FOR HDD OPERATIONS Do not commence directional drilling until all required submittals have been approved by the Engineer and the city. Do not begin drilling until all pipe and special items for drilling have been delivered. All drilling operations shall be accomplished during daylight hours and shall not begin after the hour pre- established as the latest starting time that will allow completion during daylight hours. Planned nighttime work will generally not be allowed unless stipulated in the special conditions of the city's Agreement. In emergency situations, or where delay would increase the likelihood of a failure, nighttime work may be allowed to complete the drilling operations. Mobilize all necessary personnel, equipment, and materials to construct an entry area for drilling operations. Provide appropriate supports to maintain safe working conditions; ensure stability of the entry, exit, settlement, and containment pits; minimize loosening, deterioration and disturbance of the surrounding ground. The drilling site shall contain the horizontal directional drilling rig, drill pipe storage racks, water and slurry pumps, slurry mixing tank, cuttings separation equipment, primary settlement and containment pits, dry storage area for bentonite, crane or lifting equipment, and site office. The pipe launcher/roller system (or equal) shall be constructed in the specified area. The pipe lay down area shall be as determined in conjunction with the Engineer and the city and shall be used to facilitate the installation of the pipeline. 503-2.5.8. ENVIRONMENTAL REQUIREMENTS Provide equipment and procedures to maximize the recirculation of drilling mud and to minimize waste. Provide solids control and fluid cleaning equipment of a configuration and capacity that can process surface returns and produce drilling fluid suitable for reuse. Inadvertent surface returns or "frac-outs" of drilling fluid that is accessible on land must be cleaned up immediately and the surface area washed and returned to original condition. All drilling fluids, spoils and separated material will be disposed of in compliance of state and local environmental regulations. If the amount of surface returns exceeds that which can be contained and collected using small sumps, drilling operations shall be discontinued until surface return volumes can be brought under control. Equipment and materials for cleanup and contingencies must be provided and stored at all HDD sites. Construction related activities involving fuels and lubricants such as vehicle refueling and equipment maintenance, including the draining and pumping of lubricants shall be conducted at a minimum distance of 50 feet from surface water bodies, drainage ditches or swales, drainage pathways and storm water collection structures to eliminate contamination in case of a spill. Any fuels, drilling fluids, or lubricants spilled shall be cleaned up immediately and comply with all FDEP requirements. Contractor shall provide sanitation and garbage facilities on both sides of the HDD operation. Wastes shall be transported offsite for disposal. Immediately upon completion of work, all rubbish and debris shall be removed from the job site. All construction equipment and implements of service shall be removed and the entire area involved shall be left in a neat, clean, and acceptable condition approved by the city. 503-2.5.9. DRILLING OPERATIONS Supply all necessary drilling equipment for completing the HDD installation as shown on the approved Shop Drawings. SECTION IV Page 115 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 • • • SECTION IV — Technical Specifications The plan and profile for the horizontal directional drilling operation shall be in accordance with the approved Shop Drawings. Drill entrance and exit angles shall be as shown on the approved Shop Drawings. Drilling Tolerances: A smoothly curved pilot hole shall follow the designated centerline of the pipe profiles as shown on the Drawings. The directional tolerance of the holes will be as follows: A. Deviations from, and corrections to, the design centerline of the HDD pipeline construction shall not exceed 2 percent in depth per 100 feet horizontal or a lesser rate determined by the structural characteristics of the selected pipe and jointing system. B. The as -built variance from the designed bore path shall not exceed plus or minus 1 -foot in the vertical plane and plus or minus 2 -feet in the horizontal plane. 503-2.5.10. HDD INSTALLATION General: The Contractor shall install the HDPE pipe by the horizontally drilled, directionally controlled method of construction. Instrumentation: The Contractor shall always provide and maintain instrumentation which shall accurately locate the pilot hole position in the X, Y and Z axes relative to the ground surface and measure drill string axial and torsional loads. Drilling fluid flow rate and pressure shall also be monitored. The Contractor shall maintain and provide to the city Inspector and the Engineer access to the data generated by the downhole survey tools. Drilling Guidance and Pullback: A. Pipe installed by horizontal directional drilling shall be located as shown on the Drawings. The Contractor shall plot the actual horizontal and vertical alignment and the depth of the pilot bore at intervals not exceeding 10 feet. Deviations between the recorded position of the drill string and the specified position of the drill string shall be documented and immediately brought to the attention of the Engineer. This "as -built" plan and profile shall be updated as the pilot bore is advanced. At the completion of the pilot hole, the Contractor shall provide the coordinates of the pilot hole as specified. B. The Contractor shall provide and use on land, a separate steering system employing a ground survey grid system, equal to "Tru -Tracker". C. The Contractor shall have accurate working gauges which register tensile force being used to pull the pipeline back through the reamed borehole. If, during the pipeline pulling process, this force reaches 75 percent of the allowable load for the pipeline, the Engineer shall be notified immediately, and the Contractor shall prepare to initiate the contingency plan provided within the approved Project submittals. Logs shall be kept referencing all forces exerted on the pipeline during the installation. D. The Contractor shall provide adequate pipe supports/rollers along the stringing area (for both entry and exit pits) to support the required length of pipe for each location. The rollers shall be comprised of a non-abrasive material arranged in a manner to provide support to the bottom and bottom quarter points of the pipeline allowing for free movement of the pipeline during pullback. E. The pipe entry area shall be graded to provide support for the pipe to allow free movement into the borehole. The pipe shall be guided in the borehole to avoid deformation of, or damage to the pipe. The pipe shall be installed in a manner which will not cause upheaval, settlement, cracking, movement, or distortion of surface features. F. During pullback operations, the Contractor shall monitor roller operation and use side booms if required to assist movement of the pipe and to avoid damage to the pipe. G. Cease installation operations if damage to the pipe occurs. Damage to the pipe shall be repaired immediately. Pulling operations shall not resume until the pipe has been repaired. SECTION IV Page 116 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications H. Pipe pullback shall be planned to occur continuously until complete, except for stoppages planned in the course of the operation such as drill rod removal or if damage to the pipe is observed during pullback that needs to be repaired before continuing. Contractor shall implement necessary buoyancy control as stated in the approved HDD Method and Work Plan. Location Detection Wire for HDD Pipeline Installations: Refer to Section 502-2.5.2. B. for specifications regarding material and installation of Location Detection Wires for HDD installations. 503-2.5.11. DRILLING MUD AND CUTTINGS The horizontal directional drilling operation shall be conducted in a manner to eliminate the discharge of water, drilling mud, and cuttings to areas not involved in the construction process. The Contractor shall immediately contain and clean-up any inadvertent drilling fluid returns. The Contractor shall also provide equipment and procedures to maximize the recirculation or reuse of drilling mud to minimize waste disposal. Disposal of water, drilling fluids, drilling mud, cuttings, and muck shall be the Contractor's responsibility. Disposal of waste materials shall be in a legal manner at approved solid waste landfills. 503-2.5.12. REAMING AND PULLBACK Reaming: Reaming operations shall be conducted at the discretion of the Contractor. Choosing to simultaneously ream and pull back the pipe is at the discretion and the sole risk of the Contractor. All provisions herein relating to simultaneous reaming and pulling back operations shall also pertain to reaming operations. A. Prior to pulling pipe, enlarge pilot hole to the diameter identified in the reaming procedure submittal. The Contractor shall ream the borehole to a minimum of 12 -inches larger than the outside diameter of the pipe or 1.5 times the outside diameter of the pipe, whichever is less, using the appropriate tools. Complete a swab pass if necessary. B. Ream at rates consistent with the drilling equipment and mud system selected. C. Continue to monitor the drilling fluid viscosity and density to reduce the potential for frac-out. Pulling Loads: The Contractor shall be responsible for determining safe pulling loads required for proper installation. Such loads shall be minimized to prevent failure of the pipeline during installation. Once pullback operations have commenced, operations shall continue without interruption until the pipe is completely pulled into the borehole. During pullback operations, the Contractor shall not apply more than the maximum safe pipe pull pressure at any time. A break away head rated at the maximum safe pull pressure shall be utilized. Torsional Stress: A properly sized and fully operational swivel shall be installed between the reaming assembly at the end of the drilling pipe and the pipeline to restrict torsional stress from being transmitted to the pipeline. Ballast: The pipeline must be filled with water (ballasting) as installation proceeds, to prevent buckling and reduce buoyancy. Pull Section Support: The pipe section shall be supported as it proceeds during pull back so that it moves freely. 503-2.5.13. PIPELINE PROTECTION Protect the interior of the pipe from entry of foreign matter until the installation is complete and accepted. Contractor shall video record the inside of the pipe after it has been installed and verify that no cracks, breaches, gouges, holes, etc. have occurred during pullback that would decrease the integrity of the pipe. SECTION IV Page 117 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications • 503-2.5.14. PIPELINE CLEANING Following installation of the pipeline installed by HDD, the pipeline shall be hydraulically cleaned and flushed as specified in Section 504 of these Technical Specifications. • • 503-2.5.15. PIPELINE TESTING Pressure Testing: Hydrostatically test pipe before and after installation in accordance with ASTM F2164 - Field Leak Testing of Polyethylene Pressure Piping Using Hydrostatic Pressure and Section 505. of these Technical Specifications. A. Test Duration: The total test time including initial pressurization, initial expansion, and time at test pressure, must not exceed a total of 8 hours. If the test is not completed due to leakage, equipment failure, etc., the test section shall be depressurized and allowed to "relax" for a minimum of 8 hours before it is brought back up to test pressure. The test procedure consists of initial expansion phase and leakage test phase. B. Initial Expansion Phase: During the initial expansion phase, the test section is pressured to the test pressure and enough make-up water is added each hour for a total of three hours to return to test pressure. C. Leakage Test Phase: The leakage test phase immediately follows the initial expansion phase. The test section shall be brought back up to the test pressure and remain at that pressure for 4 -hours in duration. At the end of the 4 -hour test time period, the test section shall be within +/-2 psig of the test pressure with zero leakage (no water added). D. Zero Leakage: The portion of the HDD pipeline to be hydrostatically tested with HDPE butt fused joints shall have zero leakage for the entire 4 -hour leakage test duration for the HDD pipe section to have passed the leakage test. Test Pressure: The test pressure for the HDD pipeline shall be 150 psi for potable water and reclaimed water or 100 psi for wastewater. The Contractor shall furnish all materials, equipment, and labor required for making pressure and leakage tests. Tests shall be performed in the presence of the Engineer and the city Inspector. 503-2.5.16. DISINFECTION FOR HDD POTABLE WATER PIPELINES Final disinfection for potable water pipelines installed by HDD, following cleaning, flushing and pipeline testing, shall be in accordance with Section 506. of these Technical Specifications. 503-2.5.17. CITY ACCEPTANCE If the finished installation of the HDD is not satisfactory to the city, the Engineer or other jurisdictional entity, due to any of the following: the pipe alignment being outside of the specified limits of +1.0 foot of the coordinates for the entry or exit points stated on the Drawings; failure to pass the leakage or pressure tests; or internal damage to the pipeline; the pipeline shall be abandoned, fully pressure grouted in place, in accordance with the jurisdictional authority, and an alternate installation shall be constructed. The abandoned pipeline shall be properly shown on Record Drawings to be submitted following conclusion of the construction work. If the HDD pipeline construction is to provide an HDPE casing pipe for a carrier utility pipe, casing spacers shall not be permitted inside the HDPE casing pipe. If the HDD installation is for a casing pipe, the Contractor shall end -seal the annular space between the casing pipe and the carrier pipe using concrete brick and mortar which shall extend at least 8 -inches into the casing pipe. To secure the ends of the casing and to preclude the entrance of water and soil into the casing, the casing ends shall be completely sealed to be watertight with a neoprene rubber seal specifically manufactured for that purpose. The neoprene end seal shall be attached to the casing and the carrier pipe SECTION IV Page 118 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications with Type 304 stainless steel bands. The casing end seals shall be constructed to be basically watertight to preclude the intrusion of groundwater into the casing. Casing end seals shall be equal to Cascade Water Works Model CCES or an approved equal listed in the City of Clearwater Approved Products List. The Engineer shall inspect the installed pipe ends for roundness and/or damage. Evidence of significant surface scratching shall be brought to the attention of the Engineer. Gouges or excessive surface damage of more than 10 percent of the wall thickness will be grounds to abandon the bore and have the Contractor re - drill another pipeline at no cost to the city. The city shall be provided with test logs from the Contractor indicating the actual maximum pull loads, maximum deflection angle encountered during the pulling operation and the actual X, Y and Z coordinates of the pipe centerline at a maximum of every 10 feet horizontally of the HDD pipe for review as part of final acceptance. Contractor shall review the internal video of the HDD installation and report any deficiencies to the Engineer and the city. A copy of the video shall be provided to the city as part of the Record Documents submittal for the completed and accepted Work. 503-2.5.18. REPAIR Pipes damaged during handling or installation shall be pushed or pulled out or repaired in-place using replacement sections and butt fusion welds recommended by the pipe manufacturer following methods described in the approved submittal. 503-2.5.19. CLEANUP AND REPAIR Following the installation, remove all equipment, material, drilling mud and waste from both work area ends of the HDD installation. The project site shall be returned to a condition equal to or better than the pre -construction condition of the site. All excavations will be backfilled and compacted to 98% maximum dry density under roadways and hardscape, or to 95% maximum dry density for all other areas and shall be graded to original contours. Compaction Testing shall be performed in accordance with Section 201-2.9 — Backfill and Compaction of these Technical Specifications. All pavement and hardscape shall be repaired per applicable jurisdictional standards, excess materials shall be removed from the site, and disturbed areas shall be re -landscaped. All drilling fluid shall be properly disposed of per these Technical Specifications and all applicable jurisdictional laws. Areas or facilities disturbed or damaged during construction shall be restored to original or better condition with new materials prior to the completion of construction unless specifically identified on the Drawings to be modified. This includes areas or facilities outside or inside the roadway rights-of-way, previous construction activities being done as part of this Project, and ancillary roadways, retention ponds, landscaping, signage, billboards, utility boxes and equipment, utility poles, and utility lines. 503-3. SETTING OF VALVES, HYDRANTS AND FITTINGS 503-3.1. GENERAL Valves, hydrants, fittings, plugs and caps shall be set and joined to pipe in the manner specified above for installation of pipe. 503-3.2. Fittings The weight of ductile iron fittings shall not be carried by the pipe on which they are installed. The fitting shall be supported by a concrete cradle as shown on the standard details. Concrete used for supports shall SECTION IV Page 119 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 • • • SECTION IV —Technical Specifications have a minimum compressive strength of 3,500 psi at 28 days. Concrete for the support cradle shall be poured against undisturbed soil. All glands, clamps, bolts, nuts, studs, and other uncoated parts of fitting joints for underground installation shall be coated with two coats, 10 mils DFT per coat, of coal tar epoxy equal to Carboline Bitumastic No. 300-M. 503-3.3. VALVES Valves for potable water mains and reclaimed water mains shall be located within the street rights-of-way lines unless shown otherwise on the plans. All valves shall be installed adjacent to the tee in all cases, not to exceed 18 -inches from the main line. Valves of the size and type shown on the Drawings shall be set plumb and installed at the locations indicated on the Drawings. Valves shall be installed in accordance with the manufacturer's written installation and operation instructions; with the approved shop drawing submittals; and with the details shown on the Drawings. Buried valves shall be installed such that they are supported properly in their respective positions, free from distortion and strain with a concrete cradle as shown on the Standard Details. Concrete used for supports shall have a minimum compressive strength of 3,500 psi at 28 days. Concrete for the support cradle shall be poured against undisturbed soil. Valves shall be installed such that their weight is not borne by piping or equipment that are not designed to support the weight of the valve. Exposed aboveground valves shall be supported with fabricated piping supports so that the weight of the valve is not carried by the pipeline. Install gate valves with the operating stem in the vertical position. Valves shall be carefully inspected during installation; they shall be opened wide and then tightly closed and the various nuts and bolts shall be tested for tightness. Special care shall be taken to prevent any foreign material from becoming lodged in the valve seat. Check and adjust all valves for smooth operation. Aboveground Valves: For aboveground flanged valves, clean iron flanges by wire brushing before installing the valves. Clean stainless-steel flange bolts and nuts lubricate threads with a fluoropolymer coating to prevent galling and tighten nuts uniformly and progressively. Flanged joints shall be watertight; no leaks shall be allowed. Buried Valves: For buried valves, a valve box shall be centered accurately over the operating nut and the entire assembly shall be plumb. Extensions or risers for valve boxes shall be an integral part of the box. No cut sections of ductile iron or PVC pipe shall be used to extend the valve box to its proper height. The tops of valve boxes shall be adjusted to the proper elevation as specified below and as shown on the Drawings. Care shall be taken while constructing valve boxes to ensure that valve stems are vertical and the cast iron valve box has been placed centered and plumb over the valve stem nut of the valve with base bearing on compacted fill and the top flush or above fmal grade, as specified below. Valve boxes shall have sufficient bracing to maintain alignment during backfilling. When installation is complete, no pressure shall be exerted by the valve box on either the valve or the pipe. The Contractor shall remove any sand or undesirable trash or debris from valve box interior prior to final inspection. A. In paved areas, tops of valve box covers shall be set 1/4 -inch below pavement. Following paving operations, a 24 -inch square shall be neatly cut in the pavement around the box and the paving removed. The top of the box shall then be adjusted to the proper elevation and a 24 -inch square by 6 -inch thick concrete pad poured around the box cover. Concrete pads in traffic areas shall be reinforced with No. 4 reinforcement bars as shown on the Drawings. Concrete for the pad shall be 3,500 psi compressive strength at 28 days. B. In unpaved areas, tops of valve box covers shall be set 2 inches above finished grade. After the top of the box is set to the proper elevation, a 24 -inch square by 6 -inch thick concrete pad shall be SECTION IV Page 120 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV —Technical Specifications poured around the box cover. Concrete for the pad shall be 3,500 psi compressive strength at 28 days. C. The concrete pad for the valve box cover shall have a 3 -inch diameter, brass identification disc embedded in the concrete surface as shown on the Drawings. The brass identification disc shall have the information as shown on the Drawings neatly engraved, not stamped, on it. Refer to City Standard Detail Index No. 402; Sheet 1 of 3 & Sheet 2 of 3 for potable water valve pad detail, and City Standard Detail Index No. 502; Sheet 1 of 3 & Sheet 2 of 3 for reclaimed water valve box and pad detail. Hydrostatic Testing: Valves shall be tested hydrostatically, concurrently with the pipeline in which they are installed. Protect or isolate any parts of valves, operators, or control and instrumentation systems whose pressure rating is less than the pressure used for the pressure test(s). If valve joints leak during pressure testing, loosen or remove the nuts and bolts, reseat or replace the gasket, reinstall or retighten the bolts and nuts, and hydrostatically retest the joints. Coating Repair: Following installation of buried valves, repair any scratches, marks and other types of surface damage, etc., with a coating equal to the original coating supplied by the manufacturer. Prior to backfilling, all nuts, bolts, and other parts of the valve joints shall be coated with two coats, 10 mils DFT per coat, of coal tar epoxy equal to Carboline Bitumastic No. 300-M. 503-3.4. FIRE HYDRANTS Hydrants shall be located as shown or as directed so as to provide complete accessibility and minimize the possibility of damage from vehicles or injury to pedestrians. Each hydrant shall be connected to the potable water main with a 6 -inch ductile iron branch tee with flow controlled by an independent 6 -inch mechanical joint gate valve for isolation at the branch of the water main tee. If the fire hydrant is placed greater than 20 -feet from the main, an additional 6 -inch mechanical joint valve shall be installed at the hydrant location and shall be included in the hydrant assembly cost. The fire hydrant valve cannot be located anywhere within the hydrant ductile iron pipe branch line to circumvent the requirement of using two valves. Refer to City Standard Detail Index 409, for potable water hydrants. All fire hydrants shall stand plumb and shall have their nozzles parallel with, or at right angles to, the curb, with the pumper nozzle facing the curb. Fire hydrants shall be set to the established grade, with nozzles as shown or as directed by the Engineer. Hydrostatic Testing: Fire hydrants shall be tested hydrostatically, concurrently with the pipeline in which they are installed. If the hydrant mechanical joints leak during pressure testing, loosen or remove the nuts and bolts, reseat or replace the gasket, reinstall or retighten the bolts and nuts, and hydrostatically retest the joints. Coating Repair: Following installation of buried portions of the hydrants, repair any scratches, marks and other types of surface damage, etc., with a coating equal to the original coating supplied by the manufacturer. Prior to backfilling, all buried nuts, bolts, and other parts of the hydrant mechanical joints shall be coated with two coats, 10 mils DFT per coat, of coal tar epoxy equal to Carboline Bitumastic No. 300-M. Reclaimed Water System: No hydrants shall be installed on the reclaimed water system unless approved by the city's Engineering Department. 503-3.5. ANCHORAGE Movement of all plugs, caps, tees, bends, etc., unless otherwise specified shall be prevented by attaching approved mechanical restraining rings or glands and installed per manufacturer's recommendations. SECTION IV Page 121 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 • SECTION IV —Technical Specifications Hydrants shall be held in place with restrained swivel joints. Restraining mechanical joint glands on hydrants may be used where hydrant run out length precludes the use of hydrant connecting swivel joints. Where special anchorage is required, such anchorage shall be in accordance with details shown on the plans. 503-4. CONNECTIONS TO EXISTING POTABLE WATER OR RECLAIMED WATER LINES The Contractor shall coordinate making connection of the new mains to mains which are in service at the time of construction with the city. All potable water or reclaimed water main connections, regardless of new or existing pipe size, to existing potable water or reclaimed water mains shall be made by the Contractor only after the connection procedure and his Work scheduling has been reviewed and approved by the Engineer and the city Engineering Department. The Contractor shall submit a written request to the Engineer and the city Engineering Department a minimum of 5 working days prior to scheduling said connections. The request shall outline the following. A. Location of points of connection, fittings to be used, and method of flushing and disinfection, if applicable. B. Estimated construction time for said connections. The Engineer and the city Engineering Department shall review the Contractor's submittal within 3 working days after receiving it and inform the Contractor regarding approval or denial of his request. If this request is rejected by the city, the Contractor shall resubmit his request modifying it in a manner acceptable to the city. Connections to existing potable water or reclaimed water mains shall only be made following completion • of new potable water or reclaimed water main cleaning operations and successful completion of pressure and leakage testing and disinfection clearance of the new potable water main. The Contractor shall not connect to existing facilities unless the Engineer and a representative of the city are present. All connections shall only be made on the agreed upon date and time. If the Contractor does not initiate and complete the connection work in the agreed upon manner, the Contractor shall be required to reschedule the said connection by following the procedure outlined above. Operation of all existing potable water or reclaimed water system valves shall be the responsibility of the city's personnel only. At no time shall the Contractor operate any existing system valves. System valves shall be defined as any valve which has main pressure against either side of the valve. The Contractor shall notify the city to request that a valve be operated, at least 5 days prior to the time operation is required. Upon satisfactory completion of all hydrostatic testing of the new potable water or reclaimed water pipeline, and disinfection of the new potable water pipeline, remove restrained joint caps from both ends of the new pipeline, close main line isolation valves on the existing main, cut and drain the existing main and swab all pipe and fittings for the connection to be installed on the new main with 10 percent hypochlorite solution. The connection of the new main to the existing main shall be made as swiftly as possible and any water collected in the ditch shall be pumped out and kept below the level of the pipe bottom. Following connection and make-up of all fittings, the new pipeline shall then be placed into service by the city's operating personnel. In the event any existing customers will be without potable water while a connection is being made, the Contractor shall notify the city's Inspector 72 hours prior to disconnection. The city Utility Department shall notify the affected customer(s) when the water will be turned off and when the service is estimated to be resumed. In some instances, these connections may have to be made at late night or early morning hours. • No user shall be without potable water service for more than three hours, unless approved otherwise by the city. SECTION IV Page 122 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications 504. PIPELINE CLEANING Following installation of the potable water or reclaimed water pipelines, the pipelines shall be cleaned using a combination of hydraulic cleaning using poly -pig swabbing devices and full bore flushing as specified below. 504-1. PIPELINE PIGGING All pipelines shall be hydraulically cleaned utilizing multiple pass operations with a polypropylene swabbing device, also referred to as "pigging" operations, of the piping system. Between successive operations, the pig diameter shall increase, and the pig material shall stiffen. Poly pigs shall be blown elastomer polyurethane with open cell -type construction having a material density suitable for use within the system to be cleaned. Pipe cleaning poly pigs shall have a parabolic nose, crisscross coated with a resilient peripheral surface that engages the inner cylindrical wall of the pipe to maintain a sliding seal. Pipe cleaning poly pigs shall be able to pass through a reduction of a minimum of sixty-five percent (65%) of the original cross-sectional area of the pipe and shall be bi-directional. Cleaning procedures shall conform to the Poly Pig manufacturer's recommendations. The Contractor shall provide pig launching and retrieval points for the pipeline cleaning, as required. The poly pig cleaning operation shall be completed prior to connection of the new potable water main or reclaimed water main to an existing potable water main or reclaimed water main. Passage of cleaning poly pigs through the system shall be constantly monitored, controlled, and all poly pigs entered into the system shall be individually marked and identified so that the exiting of the poly pigs from the system can be confirmed. Cleaning of the pipeline system shall be done in conjunction with the initial filling of the system for the hydrostatic testing. The line to be cleaned shall only be connected to an existing potable water or reclaimed water distribution system at a single connection point. Only the city's operating personnel shall operate the supply valve from the existing potable water or reclaimed water distribution system. The Contractor shall locate and open all new in-line valves beyond the point of connection on the pipeline to be cleaned during the swabbing operation. At the receiving or exit point for the poly pig, the Contractor is responsible for creating a safe environment for collection of debris, water, and the swab. The Contractor shall provide for the protection of surrounding personnel and property and the safe retrieval of the poly pig. Temporary blowoffs may be required for the purpose of flushing mains. Temporary blowoffs shall be installed as close as possible to the ends of the main being flushed. Blowoffs installed on the main shall be the same diameter as the main. Temporary blowoffs shall be removed and plugged after the main is flushed. The city Utility Department shall be notified at least 72 hours prior to pigging and flushing mains. Cleaning and flushing shall be accomplished by propelling the poly pig down the pipeline to the exit point with potable or reclaimed water, depending on the type of main being cleaned. Flushing shall continue until the water is completely clear and poly pig is retrieved. A. Re -apply a series of individual poly pigs in varying diameters and/or densities as required, to attain proper cleanliness of pipeline. B. Pigging speed shall range between two and five feet per second. SECTION IV Page 123 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications • 504-2. FINAL PIPELINE FLUSHING Following the pigging process for cleaning the pipeline, the length of new water main shall be final flushed with a full -bore clean water flush with a flushing velocity of at least 2.5 fps. The time required for the final full bore flush shall be based on the time needed at the required flushing velocity to provide one complete turnover of the quantity of water in the pipeline based on the length and diameter of water main being flushed. • • Blowoffs and temporary drainage piping used for flushing shall not be discharged into any gravity sewer or pumping station wet well. The Contractor shall obtain prior approvals from the Engineer and the city as to the methods and locations of flushing water discharge. At the discretion of the city, full bore water flushing may not be required for a particular water main based on the size of the main being cleaned and the quantity of water usage required for a full bore water flush. Following the pigging and flushing process, pressure testing of the pipeline shall be completed in accordance with Section 505 below. 505. TESTS 505-1. HYDROSTATIC PIPELINE TESTING General: The Contractor shall perform hydrostatic pressure and leakage tests on all newly laid pressure pipes, fittings and valves for potable water mains and reclaimed water mains. After installation of the water mains, complete with all associated appurtenances including service taps, all sections of newly laid water main shall be subject to a hydrostatic pressure test as described below. Standard: AWWA C600, Section 4, with the exceptions required herein. The Contractor shall furnish all closure pieces in the pipe as required. All equipment required for the hydrostatic pressure test shall be furnished by the Contractor and shall include, but not be limited to, graduated containers, pressure gauges, meters, testing taps and valves, hydraulic pressure pumps, suitable hoses and piping and any other equipment needed to hydrostatically test the pipelines. Hydrostatic tests shall be conducted on all newly laid potable water main or reclaimed water main pipes, fittings, and valves including any branch lines to the curb. Tests shall be made between valves not exceeding 2,000 feet. The Contractor may conduct a preliminary hydrostatic test after the trench has been partially backfilled with the joints left exposed for an initial leakage test for his inspection and informational purposes only. The hydrostatic testing for acceptance shall only be conducted after the trenches have been completely backfilled and compacted as specified. Test new pipelines which are to be connected to existing pipelines by isolating the new line from the existing line by means of pipe caps, special flanges, or blind flanges. After the new line has been successfully tested, remove temporary caps or blind flanges and connect to the existing piping. The Engineer and the city's Inspector shall be present during all inspection, pressure, and leakage testing for the results to be considered acceptable for the city's acceptance of the new potable water main or reclaimed water main system. Successful passage of both the pressure test and the leakage test is required before acceptance by the city. The hydrostatic pressure and leakage testing described herein is intended for non -butt -welded jointed pipe with gasketed joints. Where any section of the piping contains concrete thrust collars, do not proceed with the pressure test until at least 10 days after the concrete has been poured. If high -early cement is used for the concrete thrust collars, the time may be reduced to three (3) days, if the Engineer and the city Engineering Department SECTION IV Page 124 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications both concur that the concrete has cured and reached adequate strength. When testing cement mortar -lined piping, fill the pipe to be tested with water and allow it to soak for at least 48 hours to absorb water before conducting the pressure test. Each section of pipe to be tested shall be slowly filled with water and the specified test pressure shall be applied by means of a pressure pump connected to the pipe in a satisfactory manner. Before applying the specified test pressure, all air shall be expelled from the pipe as described below. If defective pipes, fittings or valves are discovered in consequence of this pressure test, all such items shall be removed and replaced by the Contractor with sound new material, the pipe shall be re -cleaned and the pressure test shall be repeated until satisfactory results are obtained. Provisions of AWWA C-600, where applicable, shall apply. Hydrostatic Pressure Test: A. Test Pressure: Potable Water Mains -150 psi; Reclaimed Water Mains —150 psi; Wastewater Force Mains —150 psi. Apply and maintain the test pressure by means of a hydraulic pressure pump. The test pressure shall be maintained ±2 psig throughout the entire test period. B. Test Duration: 2 -hours. If during the test, the integrity of the tested line is in question, the Engineer or the city's Inspector may require an additional pressure test. C. Air Release Requirements: Tapping saddles and corporation cocks at least 3/4 -inch in diameter, pipe riser and angle globe valves shall be installed by the Contractor at each dead-end and at all high points in the main to bleed all air from the water main to be tested. D. Zero leakage and no pressure loss shall be allowed for the pressure pipe being tested. Visible Leakage: All visible leaks evident at the ground surface shall be repaired and leakage eliminated. Leakage Repair: Repairs to leaks shall be completed in strict accordance with the pipe manufacturer's written recommendations. Repair and retest any pipes showing leakage. Damage or Defects: Any exposed pipe, fittings, valves, hydrants, and joints shall be examined during the test. Any damage or defects that are discovered shall be replaced with new material at no additional cost to the city. The test shall be repeated until no damage or defects are discovered. 505-2. NOTICE OF TEST The Contractor shall give the city's Project Manager and/or Representative forty-eight (48) hours advance notice of the time when the installation is ready for hydrostatic testing. City inspector/CEI shall certify and submit all hydrostatic pressure and leakage testing results to the city Project Manager within 10 days of performing test(s). 506. DISINFECTION AND TESTING Before the new potable water system is put into operation, all new potable water mains and appurtenances and any item of new construction with which the water comes into contact, shall be thoroughly disinfected in accordance with AWWA C651. This section includes materials and procedures for disinfection of water mains by the continuous feed method. 506-1. DISINFECTION MATERIALS Dry Calcium Hypochlorite: High test granular calcium hypochlorite (HTH) used as the chlorinating agent shall contain between 65 to 70 percent of available chlorine by weight. The dry calcium hypochlorite shall be stored in a cool, dry, and dark environment, prior to its use, to minimize deterioration. Sodium Hypochlorite Solution: Sodium hypochlorite solution used as the chlorinating agent shall be obtained fresh and shall have a minimum concentration of 10 percent by weight available chlorine. To SECTION IV Page 125 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 • • • SECTION IV —Technical Specifications minimize degradation, sodium hypochlorite solution shall be stored in opaque, closed polypropylene containers, isolated from contact with any metals and out of direct sunlight. The solution shall be stored in covered (as dark as possible) areas and as cool as possible, prior to use on the jobsite. Sodium hypochlorite solution is highly corrosive. Therefore, the Contractor shall use this chlorinating agent with caution and per the recommendations of the sodium hypochlorite solution manufacturer. Chlorine Residual Test Kit: To measure chlorine concentration, provide and use a mid-range total chlorine test kit with a digital titrator, using sodium thiosulfate as the titrant. Maintain fresh reagents for the test kit and maintain all components of the kit in good working order available for immediate testing of chlorine residuals at the point of sampling. 506-2. FLUSHING SYSTEM Prior to pressure testing and application of the disinfection agent for disinfection, all pipelines shall be hydraulically cleaned utilizing multiple pass operations with a polypropylene swabbing device, also referred to as "pigging" operations, of the piping system, followed by full bore flushing. Flushing shall continue until a clean, clear stream of water flows from the hydrants. Where hydrants are not available for flushing, such flushing shall be accomplished at the installed blow off devices generally at the ends of the lines. Cleaning and flushing prior to pressure testing and disinfection shall be in accordance with Section 504 of these Technical Specifications. 506-3. FINAL DISINFECTION PROCEDURE FOR POTABLE WATER MAINS Before any portion of a new potable water piping system is to be placed into service, it shall be disinfected; and proper disinfection shall be demonstrated by bacteriological testing conducted in accordance with "Standard Methods for Examination of Water and Sewage" for the coli -aerogenes group, by a commercial laboratory approved by the FDEP, and acceptable to the Engineer and the city, or may be completed by the Pinellas County Health Department. All pipe, fittings, valves, and all other appurtenances installed for use in potable water pipelines shall be disinfected prior to being placed in service. Disinfection procedures shall be approved by the Engineer and the city and shall be in conformance with ANSI/AWWA C651, latest revision. Contractor shall comply with all General Notes on the Drawings and special requirements that are included with the FDEP permit related to disinfection and clearance of new potable water mains. Pipe subjected to contaminating materials shall be treated in a manner approved by the Engineer and the city. Should such treatment fail to remove contaminants from the pipe, contaminated sections of pipe shall be replaced with new uncontaminated pipe. Only potable water from an existing city water main shall be used for disinfection and final flushing of new potable water pipelines. The potable water shall be obtained as described below in Section 508 of these Technical Specifications. Disinfection Procedure: Disinfection of a completed potable water pipeline shall be accomplished using the following procedure: A. All water piping, fittings, valves, and appurtenances shall be disinfected with a chlorine solution with a sufficient concentration such that the initial chlorine concentration in the water line shall be a minimum of 75 mg/1 available chlorine, at any point in the line, and that a chlorine residual of not less than 30 mg/1 remains in the water, at any point in the line, after standing 24 hours in the pipeline. The contact period may be longer than 24 -hours, if required by the city or the Engineer SECTION IV Page 126 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications before it is flushed out. All valves in the lines being disinfection shall be opened and closed several times during the contact period. B. Chlorine may be applied to the water pipeline as a liquid 10% sodium hypochlorite solution, or as a mixture of water and high-test calcium hypochlorite. The Contractor shall assume responsibility for safe handling of chlorinating agents and shall meet requirements of OSHA and other regulatory agencies for safe handling of chlorinating agents. C. The dry high-test calcium hypochlorite (HTH) may be used to make up a high concentration chlorine solution which will be used for disinfection. The hypochlorite solution to be used for disinfection should be mixed based on the HTH manufacturer's recommendations. Under no circumstances will undiluted, dry calcium hypochlorite be placed in the pipeline to be disinfected. D. The chlorine solution, either 10% sodium hypochlorite or a calcium hypochlorite mixed solution, shall be metered into the pipeline with a small metering pump. E. Disinfection of Valves, Blind Flanges and Appurtenances: Swab exposed interior surfaces of valves and blind flanges with a 10% sodium hypochlorite solution prior to installation and bolting in place. F. Disinfection of Tapping Sleeves, Tapping Valves and Line Stops: Flush exterior of pipe with potable water after removal of existing coating. Swab exterior of pipe and interior of tapping, sleeve, tapping valve and line stop valve with a 10% sodium hypochlorite solution. Disinfect per AWWA C651, Section 4.8. After completion of tapping and line stopping, swab interior of pipe, valves, and faces of flanges to be connected to bypass piping with a 10% sodium hypochlorite solution. G. Disinfection of Connections to Existing Pipelines: Disinfect isolation valves, pipe, and appurtenances per AWWA C651, Section 4.7. Flush with potable water until discolored water, mud, and debris are eliminated. Swab interior of pipe and fittings with a 10% sodium hypochlorite solution. Following disinfection procedures, flush with potable water again until water is free of chlorine odor. H. Water from the existing, in-service water line shall be made to flow at a constant, slow rate into the water line to be disinfected. A jumper connection from the existing potable water main to the new water main, utilizing a reduced pressure principle backflow preventer approved by the city, shall be used to obtain water for disinfection. Chlorine solution shall be injected or pumped at a regulated rate into the new main, at a point not more than 10 feet downstream from the beginning of the new water main. The method of tapping the water main for the chlorine injection point and the location of the tap shall be approved by the Engineer and the city. I. Proportion the two rates so that the chlorine concentration in the pipeline is maintained at a minimum concentration of 75 mg/L. Check the concentration at points downstream during the filling to ascertain that sufficient chlorine is being added. J. Chlorine solution shall be circulated in the water main by opening the water control valve and systematically manipulating valves, fire hydrants and blowoffs. K. Water service lines, if applicable, shall be disinfected in a similar manner as that for water mains, including corrective measures, by methods acceptable to the Engineer and the city. L. Chlorine solution shall remain in the water lines for not less than 24 -hours, but longer than 24 - hours, if directed by the Engineer or the city. M. Extreme care shall be exercised at all times to prevent concentrated chlorine solution from entering existing water mains. If methods of disinfection used by the Contractor differ materially from those outlined above, such methods shall be in accordance with directives of the Florida State Board of Health and all methods employed shall have the approval of that agency. SECTION IV Page 127 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications • 506-4. FLUSHING AND RESIDUAL CHLORINE TESTS After 24 -hours, or when approved by the Engineer and the city, the free residual chlorine concentration in the water line at the pipe extremity sample points shall be checked to make sure the free residual chlorine concentration is at least 30 mg/1; if not, the water lines shall be re -disinfected as described above. Final flushing of lines with potable water may proceed after 24 hours, or when approved by the Engineer and the city, provided the free residual chlorine analysis is satisfactory at 30 mg/L or above. Flushing shall be continued until a chlorine residual test shows that the pipelines contain only the normal chlorine residual in the feed potable water, not less than 0.2 ppm nor more than 3.0 ppm. Residual chlorine test shall be in accordance with standard methods using a standard DPD test kit. Prior to flushing water with high chlorine concentrations, obtain approvals from the Engineer and the Owner as to the methods and locations of discharge. City inspector/CEI must certify and submit all residual chlorine test results to the city Project Manager within 10 days of performing test(s). 506-5. BACTERIALOGICAL TESTS Following disinfection and thorough flushing of the water lines, as specified herein, the Contractor, and/or the city Public Utilities Department Water Division (or the Engineering Department), shall furnish all labor and materials required to obtain samples of water from the potable water line, at established remote sampling points approved by the FDEP, properly collected in suitable sterilized containers obtained from the Pinellas County Health Department or an analytical laboratory approved by the city and certified by the Florida State Board of Health for bacterial examination in accordance with AWWA C651. Proper techniques and procedures shall be used to collect the water samples to avoid outside contamination resulting in a false positive coliform result. Definite instructions as to the collection and shipment of bacteriological samples shall be secured from the laboratory prior to sample collection and shall be followed in all respects. Two (2) series of successive samples shall be obtained at each established sampling point in accordance with AWWA C651, Section 5.1, to obtain a bacteriological quality test result to demonstrate the absence of coliform bacteria in each separate section of the pipeline being tested after chlorination, flushing and refilling. Each test series will require two samples at each sampling point. The period between each series of samples shall be a minimum of 24 -hours. Samples shall be delivered by the Contractor to the County Health Department or the approved analytical laboratory for bacteriological examination within 6 hours of obtaining the samples. Samples shall be collected in conformance with the County Health Department standards and lab testing schedule. Prior to collecting samples, the Contractor shall notify the Engineer and the city, who will have representatives present during bacteriological sample collection. Collect at least one set of samples from every 1,000 feet of the new water main and line stopping insertion point, plus one set from the end of the line and at least one set from each branch. At each connection to an existing pipeline, take two additional samples. Bacteriological test results will be available approximately 48- to 72 -hours after samples have been submitted to the testing laboratory. If test results are unsatisfactory, the Contractor shall immediately re - chlorinate and retest the water lines as described above and proceed with such corrective measures as are necessary to secure disinfected lines. All services shall be re -chlorinated if the lines are re -chlorinated. The water lines shall be re -disinfected and re -tested, at the Contractor's expense, until approved by the Engineer, the city, and the Pinellas County Health Department or FDEP, as applicable. At satisfactory completion of the bacteriological test requirements, potable water pipelines shall be placed into service in a manner approved by the Engineer and the city Engineering Department. Complete the pipeline where temporary disinfection or test facilities were installed. Potable water mains shall not be SECTION IV Page 128 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications placed into service until all requirements of the State and Pinellas County Public Health Departments are met, and the Letter of Clearance is obtained from the Florida Department of Environmental Protection (FDEP). The Contractor shall notify the Engineer and the city at least 72 hours prior to placing potable water pipelines into service. The city Inspector/CEI shall certify and submit all bacteriological test results to the city Project Manager within 10 days of performing the test(s) as required by the Florida Department of Environmental Protection. 507. CORRECTION OF NON -CONFORMING WORK All non -conforming work shall be repaired or replaced by the Contractor at no additional expense to the city. Non -conforming work shall be defined as failure to adhere to any specific or implied directive of this Project Manual and/or the drawings, including but not limited to paid not laid straight, true to the lines and grades as shown on the drawings, damaged or unacceptable materials, misalignment or diameter ring deflection in pipe due to bedding or backfilling, visible or detectable leakage and failure to pass any specified test or inspection. 508. OBTAINING WATER FOR FLUSHING AND TESTING The potable water supply shall be protected with an air gap or a reduced pressure principle backflow preventer approved by the city if potable water is used for flushing and testing. Only potable water shall be use for flushing and pressure testing of potable water pipelines. Reclaimed water may be used for flushing and pressure testing of reclaimed water lines or wastewater force mains. The city will provide the water required for city Projects. The Contractor shall coordinate with the city for a temporary construction water service connection, intended for usage during flushing and testing. For private development projects the Contractor will need to obtain temporary potable water service during construction, the Contractor shall be required to pay for the installation and for the water used. The piping, fittings, backflow preventer, and appurtenances required for the temporary construction water service shall be supplied by the city of Clearwater. 509. MEASUREMENT AND PAYMENT 509-1. GENERAL Bids must include all sections and items as specified herein and as listed on the Bid Form. Payment for the work of constructing the project will be made at the unit price or lump sum payment for the items of work as set forth in the Bid, which payment will constitute full compensation for all labor, equipment, and materials required to complete the work. No separate payment will be made for the following items and the cost of such work shall be included in the applicable pay items of work unless otherwise specified: • Clearing and grubbing • Excavation, including necessary pavement removal • Shoring and/or dewatering • Structural fill • Backfill • Grading • Tracer wire • Refill materials • Joint materials SECTION IV Page 129 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 • SECTION IV — Technical Specifications • Tests and sterilization • Appurtenant work as required for a complete and operable system. 509-2. FURNISH AND INSTALL WATER MAINS 509-2.1. MEASUREMENT The quantity for payment shall be the actual number of feet of pipe of each size and type satisfactorily furnished and laid, as measured along the centerline of the completed pipeline, including the length of valves and fittings. 509-2.2. PAYMENT Payment of the applicable unit price shall be full compensation for furnishing all plant, labor, materials and equipment, and constructing the water mains completely and ready for operation. 509-3. FURNISH AND INSTALL FITTINGS 509-3.1. MEASUREMENT The quantity for payment will be the actual number of size and type of ductile iron fittings satisfactorily furnished and installed. 509-3.2. PAYMENT IIIPayment of the applicable unit price shall be full compensation for furnishing all plant, labor, materials, and equipment required to furnish and install ductile iron fittings. • 509-4. FURNISH AND INSTALL GATE VALVES COMPLETE WITH BOXES AND COVERS 509-4.1. MEASUREMENT The quantity for payment shall be the number of gate valves of each size satisfactorily furnished and installed. 509-4.2. PAYMENT Payment of the applicable unit price for each size shall be full compensation for furnishing all labor, materials, and equipment and installing the gate valve complete with valve box and cover, concrete pad and valve disc, including any jointing materials and any restraint devices required. 509-5. FURNISH AND INSTALL FIRE HYDRANTS 509-5.1. MEASUREMENT The quantity for payment shall be the number of fire hydrants satisfactorily furnished and installed. The only hydrants allowed to be installed in the city utilities system are listed in Section 502-5 of these Technical Specifications. No exceptions. SECTION IV Page 130 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications 509-5.2. PAYMENT Payment of the applicable unit price shall be full compensation for furnishing all labor, materials and equipment and installing the fire hydrant assembly complete including all necessary anchor tees, swivel - type thrust anchorage, 6 -inch ductile iron pipe between the main and the fire hydrant and gate valve(s) and valve boxes and covers, concrete pad(s) and valve disc(s) on the hydrant branch line and , including any jointing materials and any restraint devices required. SECTION IV Page 131 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV —Technical Specifications • 600 SERIES: STORMWATER 601. RAISING OR LOWERING OF STORM DRAINAGE STRUCTURES Storm Drainage Structures shall be raised or lowered as indicated on the plans or as indicated by the Engineer. 601-1. BASIS OF PAYMENT Payment, unless covered by a bid item, shall be included in the cost of the work. 602. UNDERDRAINS The Contractor shall construct sub -surface drainage pipe as directed in the Scope of Work and detail drawings contained in the Project construction plans. In general, underdrain pipe shall be embedded in a bed of #6 FDOT aggregate, located behind the back of curb and aggregate surface covered with a non- degradable fibrous type filter material. A #57 aggregate may be used in lieu of #6 if it is washed and screened to remove fines. The aggregate may be stone, slag, or crushed gravel. Unless otherwise noted on the plans, underdrain pipe shall be eight inches (8") in diameter, polyvinyl chloride pipe, in conformance with ASTM F758 "Standard Specification For Smooth Wall PVC Underdrain Systems for Highways" latest revision, minimum stiffness of 46 in conformance with ASTM D2412, perforations in conformance with AASHTO M-189 described in FDOT Section 948-1.5 or latest revision and in conformance with ASTM • D3034 - SDR 35. Alternate acceptable underdrain pipe material is Contech A-2000 which is a rigid PVC pipe that exceeds ASTM Specifications D1784, minimum cell classification of 12454B or 12454C, manufactured per ASTM F949 -93a, minimum pipe stiffness of 50 psi, with 110 evidence of splitting, cracking or breaking when pipe is tested in accordance with ASTM D2412 at 60% flatting and with a double gasket joint. Underdrain pipe placed beneath existing driveways and roadways shall be non -perforated pipe with compacted backfill. All poly -chloride pipe which has become deteriorated due to exposure to ultraviolet radiation shall be rejected. Where ductile iron pipe is specified, pipe material shall be the same as specified for potable water pipe in these technical specifications. All underdrain aggregate shall be fully encased in a polyester filter fabric "sock" (Mirafi® 140-N or approved equal) per the construction detail drawings. Filter aggregate for underdrains shall be as specified in the FDOT Standard Specifications, Section 901 — Coarse Aggregate, and shall be either #6 or #57. If #57 is used, it must be washed and screened to remove fines. The aggregate may be stone, slag, or crushed gravel. • 602-1. BASIS OF MEASUREMENT Measurement shall be the number of linear feet of eight inch (8") Sub -drain in place and accepted. 602-2. BASIS OF PAYMENT Payment shall be based upon the unit price per linear foot for underdrain as measured above, which shall be full compensation for all work described in this section of the specifications and shall include all materials, equipment, and labor necessary to construct the underdrain (specifically underdrain pipe, SECTION IV Page 132 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications aggregate and filter fabric). Underdrain clean -outs, sod, driveway, road and sidewalk restoration shall be paid by a separate bid item. 603. STORM SEWERS All storm drainpipe installed within the city shall be steel reinforced concrete unless otherwise approved by the City Engineer. Said pipe shall comply with Section 430 of FDOT Standard Specifications. All reinforced concrete pipe joints shall be wrapped with Mirafi® 140N filter fabric or equivalent (as approved by the City Engineer). The cost for all pipe joint wraps shall be included in the unit price for the pipe. All pipe, just before being lowered into a trench, is to be inspected and cleaned. If any difficulty is found in fitting the pieces together, this fitting is to be done on the surface of the street before laying the pipe, and the tops plainly marked in the order in which they are to be laid. No pipe is to be trimmed or chipped to fit. Each piece of pipe is to be solidly and evenly bedded, and not simply wedged up. Before finishing each joint, some suitable device is to be used to find that the inverts coincide, and pipe is clear throughout. 603-1. TESTING AND INSPECTION The Contractor shall take all precautions to secure a watertight sewer under all conditions. The work under this Section shall include the internal video recording of new stormwater drainage pipes and drainage structures. The Contractor shall provide the city with a video of the completed stormwater drainage system, and a written report. The Contractor shall pump down and clean the pipes and drainage structures, to the satisfaction of the city, prior to video recording. The video shall be of the standard DVD format, in color, with all the pertinent data and observations recorded as audio on the DVD. The data should include: 1. An accurate recorded footage of the pipe lengths. 2. The drainage structure number and pipe size. 3. The run of the pipe and direction of flow (i.e. from S-1 to S-2). 4. Details of structural defects, broken pipes, sags, dips, misalignments, obstructions, and infiltration. The written report shall include the four (4) items listed previously. All visual and video recording inspections shall be completed by the Contractor and be in accordance with Section 430-4.8 of FDOT Standard Specifications. Any deficient or damaged pipe discovered during the video recording process shall be the responsibility of the Contractor to repair or replace at their own expense within the contractual duration. As a complement to the video report, the Contractor shall also provide digital photos of areas of concern in electronic (computer CD/DVD) and hard copy form (in color). All known pipe breaks or those breaks discovered after the video inspection shall be repaired by the Contractor regardless of the test allowances. Faulty sections of drainage pipes or drainage structures rejected by the Engineer shall be removed and re-laid by the Contractor. Sections of pipe that are repaired, re-laid or replaced shall be accompanied with a corresponding post construction video inspection at the Contractor's expense. In all cases that a leak is found, re -inspection shall be required at the Contractor's expense, to confirm that the problem has been resolved. 603-2. BASIS OF PAYMENT Payment shall be the unit price per linear foot for storm sewer pipe in place and accepted, measured along the centerline of the storm sewer pipe to the inside face of exterior walls of storm manholes or drainage SECTION IV Page 133 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 • • SECTION IV — Technical Specifications structures and to the outside face of endwalls. Said unit price includes all work required to install the pipe (i.e. all materials, equipment, filter fabric wrap, gravel bedding if needed for stabilization, labor, and incidentals, etc.). 604. STORM MANHOLES, INLETS, CATCH BASINS OR OTHER STORM STRUCTURES For details on specific design of a type of storm structure refer to city of Clearwater Standards Details Index Numbers 201 to 236. When required, inlets, catch basins or other structures shall be constructed according to the plans and applicable parts of these Technical Specifications, Sections 301, 302, 303 and 202, and as approved by the Engineer. Said structures shall be protected from damage by the elements or other causes until acceptance of the work. 604-1. BUILT UP TYPE STRUCTURES Built up type manholes shall be constructed of brick with cast iron frames and covers as shown on city of Clearwater Standard Details Index Numbers 201. Invert channels shall be constructed smooth and semicircular in shape conforming to inside of adjacent sewer section. Changes in direction of flow shall be made in a smooth curve of as large a radius as possible. Changes in size and grade of channels shall be made gradually and evenly. Invert channels shall be built up with grout. The storm structure floor outside of channels shall be made smooth and sloped toward channels. Manhole steps shall not be provided. Joints shall be completely filled, and the mortar shall be smoothed from inside of the manholes. The entire exterior of brick manholes shall be plastered with a skim coat of one-half inch (1/2") of mortar. Brick shall be laid radially with every sixth course being a stretcher course. In cases where a storm pipe extends inside a structure, the excess pipe will be cut off with a concrete saw and shall not be removed with a sledgehammer. 604-2. PRECAST TYPE Precast manholes shall be constructed as shown on city of Clearwater Standards Details Index 202. The manhole base shall be set on a pad of dry native sand approximately five inches (5") thick to secure proper seating and bearing. Precast Manholes and Junction Boxes: The Contractor may substitute precast manholes and junction boxes in lieu of cast in place units unless otherwise shown on the plans. Precast Inlets will not be acceptable. When precast units are substituted, the construction of such units must be in accordance with ASTM C478, or the standard specifications at the manufacturer's option. Precast structures must also meet the requirement that on the lateral faces, either inside or outside, the distance between precast openings for pipe or precast opening and top edge of precast structure be no less than wall thickness. A minimum of four courses of brick will be provided under manhole ring so that future adjustment of manhole lid can be accommodated. Manhole steps shall not be provided. SECTION IV Page 134 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications 604-3. BASIS OF PAYMENT Payment for Junction Boxes, Manholes or other structures shall be on a unit basis. 605. GABIONS AND MATTRESSES 605-1. MATERIAL 605-1.1. PVC COATED WIRE MESH GABIONS & MATTRESSES 605-1.1.1. GABION & MATTRESS BASKETS Gabion and mattress baskets units shall conform to ASTM A975, be of non -raveling construction and fabricated from a double twist by twisting each pair of wires through three half turns developing the appearance of a triple twist. The galvanized wire core shall have a diameter of 0.106 inches. 605-1.1.2. PVC (POLYVINYL CHLORIDE) COATING The coating shall be gray in color and shall have a nominal thickness of 0.0216 inches but not less than 0.015 inches in thickness. The protective PVC plastic shall be suitable to resist deleterious effects from exposure to light, immersion in salt or polluted water and shall not show any material difference in its initial compound properties. The PVC compound is also resistant to attack from acids and resistant to abrasion. The PVC coating shall be extruded and adhere to the wire core prior to weaving. The PVC coated wire shall be woven into a double twisted hexagonal mesh having uniform openings of 3 1/4 inches by 4 '/2 inches. The overall diameter of the mesh wire (galvanized wire core plus PVC coating) shall be 0.146 inches. Selvedge and reinforcing wire shall be of heavily galvanized wire core, 0.134 inches in diameter, coated with PVC and having an overall diameter (galvanized wire core plus PVC coating) of 0.174 inches. Lacing and connecting wire shall be of soft tensile strength (75,000 PSI max), heavily galvanized wire core, 0.087 inches in diameter, coated with PVC and having an overall diameter (galvanized wire core plus PVC coating) of 0.127 inches. The use of alternate wire fasteners shall be permitted in lieu of tie wire providing the alternate fastener produces a four (4) wire selvedge joint with a strength of 1200 lbs. per linear foot while remaining in a locked and closed condition. Properly formed interlocking fasteners shall be spaced from 4 to 6 inches and have a minimum 3/4 square inch inside area to properly confine the required selvedge wires. 605-1.1.3. GABION AND MATTRESS FILLER MATERIAL The filler stone shall be from a source approved by the Engineer before delivery is started. Representative preliminary samples of the stone shall be submitted by the contractor or supplier for examination and testing by the Engineer. The stone shall have a minimum specific gravity of 2.3 and be of a quality and durability sufficient to insure permanency in the structure. The individual stones shall be free of cracks, seams, and other defects that would tend to promote deterioration from natural causes, or which might reduce the stones to sizes that could not be retained in the gabion or mattress baskets. All filler material shall be uniformly graded between 4 inch and 8 inch (equivalent spherical diameter) and shall be angular in form. Rounded stones shall not exceed 10% of the stone, by weight and 70% of the stone, by weight, shall exceed the largest dimension of the mesh opening. Crushed concrete shall not be used for filler material. 605-1.1.4. GEOTEXTILE FABRIC Fabric shall conform to the latest edition of FDOT Standard Specifications, Section 985. SECTION IV Page 135 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV —Technical Specifications • 605-2. PERFORMANCE Gabions and Reno Mattresses shall be installed according to the manufacturer's recommendations and as shown on the Drawings. Fabrication of gabion baskets shall be in such a manner that the sides, ends, lid and diaphragms can be assembled at the construction site into rectangular baskets of the sizes specified and shown on the Drawings. Gabions and mattresses shall be of single unit construction; the base, lid ends and sides shall be either woven into a single unit or one edge of these members connected to the base section of the gabion in such a manner that the strength and flexibility at the connecting point is at least equal to that of the mesh. Where the length of the gabion and mattress exceeds one and one-half its horizontal width, they shall be equally divided by diaphragms of the same mesh and gauge as the mattresses shall be furnished with the necessary diaphragms secured in proper position on the base so that no additional tying is required at this juncture. The wire mesh is to be fabricated so that it will not ravel. This is defined as the ability to resist pulling apart at any of the twists or connections forming the mesh when a single wire strand in a section of mesh is cut. • • Each gabion or mattress shall be assembled by tying all untied edges with binding wire. The binding wire shall be tightly looped around every other mesh opening along seams so that single and double loops are alternated. A line of empty gabions shall be placed into position according to the contract drawings and binding wire shall be used to securely tie each unit to the adjoining one along the vertical reinforced edges and the top selvedges. The base of the empty gabions placed on top of a filled line of gabions shall be tightly wire to the latter at front and back. To achieve better alignment and finish in retaining walls, gabion stretching is recommended. Connecting wires shall be inserted during the filling operation in the following manner: Gabions shall be filled to one third full and one connecting wire in each direction shall be tightly tied to opposite faces of each cell at one third height. The gabion shall then be filled to two thirds full and one connecting wire in each direction shall be tightly tied to opposite face of each cell at one two third height. The cell shall then be filled to the top. Filler stone shall not be dropped more than twelve inches (12") into the gabions and mattresses. Geotextile fabric shall be installed at locations shown in the Drawings. The surface to receive the cloth shall be prepared to a relatively smooth condition free of obstructions which may tear or cut the cloth. The panel shall be overlapped a minimum of 30 inches and secured against movement. Cloth damaged or displaced during installation, gabion work, or backfill shall be replaced or repaired to the satisfaction of the Engineer at the contractor's expense. The work shall be scheduled so that the fabric is not exposed to ultraviolet light more than the manufacturer's recommendations or five days, whichever is less. In wet conditions, a base shall be established by spreading and compacting #57 stone prior to placement of geotextile fabric and gabions or mattresses. SECTION IV Page 136 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications 700 SERIES: STREETS AND SIDEWALKS 701. RESTORATION OR REPLACEMENT OF DRIVEWAYS, CURBS, SIDEWALKS AND STREET PAVEMENT Driveways, sidewalks, and curbs destroyed or damaged during construction shall be replaced with the same type of material that was destroyed or damaged, or to existing city Standards, whichever provides the stronger repair. All street pavement destroyed or damaged shall be replaced with the same type of material, to existing city Standards, unless the existing base is unsuitable as determined by the Engineer, then the base shall be replaced with city approved material. All replaced base shall be at least eight inches (8") compacted thickness, or same compacted thickness as the base destroyed plus two inches (2") and compacted to 98% of maximum density per AASHTO T-180. Refer to Standard Detail Index 104. Unless called for in the proposal as separate bid items, cost of the above work including labor, materials and equipment required shall be included in the bid price per linear foot of main or square yard of base. The bid price for street pavement, restoration or replacement when called for in the proposals, shall include all materials, labor and equipment required to complete the work, and shall be paid for on a square yard basis. When replacement is over a trench for utilities, the area of replacement shall be limited to twice the depth of the cut plus twice the inside diameter of the pipe. All necessary restoration exceeding this footprint will be at the Contractor's expense. The bid price for restoration or placement of driveways, curbs and sidewalks, when called for in the proposals, shall include all materials, labor and equipment required to complete the work and shall be paid for on the basis of the following units: Driveways, plant mix - per square yard: concrete - per square foot; curbs - per linear foot; sidewalk four inches (4") or six inches (6") thick - per square foot. Concrete walks at drives shall be a minimum of six inches (6") thick and be reinforced with 6/6 X 10/10 welded wire mesh. The Contractor shall notify the Construction Inspector a minimum of twenty-four (24) hours in advance of all driveway, curb, sidewalk and street restoration and replacement work. 702. ROADWAY BASE AND SUBGRADE 702-1. BASE This specification describes the construction of roadway base and subgrade. The Contractor shall refer to Section IV, Section 101 "Scope of Work" of the city's Contract Specifications for additional roadway base and subgrade items. Roadway base shall be eight inches (8") compacted minimum thickness unless otherwise noted on the plans or directed by the Engineer. The subgrade shall be twelve inches (12") compacted minimum thickness with a minimum Limerock Bearing Ratio (LBR) of 40 unless otherwise noted on the plans or directed by the Engineer. The Contractor shall obtain from an independent testing laboratory a Proctor and an LBR for each type material. The Contractor shall also have an independent testing laboratory perform all required density testing. Where unsuitable material is found within the limits of the base, Section IV, Section 204 - Unsuitable Material Removal of the city's Technical Specifications will apply. Once the roadway base is completed, it shall be primed that same day (unless otherwise directed by the Engineer) per Section 300 ofFDOT's Standard Specifications. Repairs required to the base that result from a failure to place the prime in a timely manner shall be done to the city's satisfaction, and at the Contractor's expense. No paving of the exposed base can commence until the city approves the repaired base. The cost for placement of prime material shall be included in the bid item for base. SECTION IV Page 137 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 • SECTION IV — Technical Specifications The Contractor shall notify the Project Inspector a minimum of twenty-four (24) hours in advance of all base and subgrade placement or reworking. The following base materials are acceptable: 1. Shell Base: Shell base shall be constructed in accordance with the latest edition of Sections 200 and 913 of FDOT's Standard Specifications and shall have a minimum compacted thickness as shown on the plans. The shell shall be FDOT approved. The cost of the prime coat shall be included in the bid item price for base. 2. Limerock Base: Limerock base shall be constructed in accordance with Sections 200 and 911 of FDOT 's Standard Specifications and shall have a minimum compacted thickness as shown on the plans. The limerock shall be from a FDOT approved certified pit. The cost of the prime coat shall be included in the bid item price for base. When used, Contractor is required to submit documentation certifying the materials were obtained from a FDOT certified pit. 3. Crushed Concrete Base: Crushed concrete base shall be constructed in accordance with the latest edition of Sections 204 and 901 of FDOT's Standard Specifications and shall have a minimum compacted thickness as shown on the plans. The crushed concrete material shall be FDOT approved. The Contractor shall provide certified laboratory tests on gradation to confirm that the crushed concrete base material conforms to the above specifications. The LBR shall be a minimum of 100. LBR and gradation tests shall be provided to the city by the Contractor once a week for continuous operations, or every 1000 tons of material, unless requested more frequently by the City Engineer or designee. The cost of the prime coat shall be included in the bid item price for base. 4. Superpave Asphalt Base: Full depth asphalt base shall be constructed in accordance with the latest edition of Section 234 of FDOT 's Standard Specifications and shall have a minimum compacted thickness as shown on the plans. The cost for preparation, placement, and compaction shall be included in the per ton unit cost for asphalt unless otherwise noted in the project scope and plans. The cost of the tack coat shall be included in the bid item price for asphalt or base. 5. Reclaimed Asphalt Pavement Base: Reclaimed asphalt pavement (RAP) base shall be constructed in accordance with the latest edition of Section 283 of FDOT's Standard Specifications and shall have a minimum compacted thickness as shown on the plans. As per FDOT Section 283, RAP material shall be used as a base course only on non -limited access paved shoulders, shared use paths, or other non -traffic bearing applications. The cost for preparation, placement, and compaction shall be included in the per ton unit cost for asphalt unless otherwise noted in the project scope and plans. The cost of the tack coat shall be included in the bid item price for asphalt or base. 702-1.1. BASIS OF MEASUREMENT FOR BASE AND REWORKED BASE The basis of measurement shall be the number of cubic yards of base in place and accepted as called for on the plans. The maximum allowable deficiency shall be a half-inch (1/2"). Areas deficient in thickness shall either be fixed by the Contractor to within acceptable tolerance, or if so, approved in writing by the City Engineer, may be left in place. No payment, however, will be made for such deficient areas that are left in place. 702-1.2. BASIS OF PAYMENT FOR BASE AND REWORKED BASE The unit price for base shall include: all materials, roadbed preparation, placement, spreading, compaction, finishing, prime, base, subgrade (unless the plans specify a separate pay item), stabilization, mixing, testing, equipment, tools, hauling, labor, and all incidentals necessary to complete the work. Payment for asphalt base shall be included in the per ton unit cost for asphalt unless otherwise noted in the project scope and plans. SECTION IV Page 138 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications 702-2. SUBGRADE All subgrade shall be stabilized and constructed in accordance with the latest edition of Sections 160 and 914 of FDOT's Standard Specifications unless otherwise noted herein. All subgrade shall have a minimum compacted thickness of 12" unless otherwise shown on the plans or directed by the Engineer. If limerock is used, it shall also meet the requirements of Section 911 of FDOT's Standard Specifications. Where unsuitable material is found within the limits of the subgrade, Section IV, Section 204 - Unsuitable Material Removal of the city's Contract Specifications will apply. The extent of said removal shall be determined by the Engineer in accordance with accepted construction practices. The Contractor is responsible for clearing, grading, filling, and removing any trees or vegetation in the roadbed below the subgrade to prepare it per the plans. The cost of this work shall be included in the unit price for base or subgrade. The Contractor shall obtain from an independent testing laboratory the bearing value of the subgrade after the materials are mixed for the stabilized subgrade and provide the results to the Engineer. 702-2.1. BASIS OF MEASUREMENT The basis of measurement shall be the number of cubic yards of stabilized subgrade in place and accepted as called for on the plans. The maximum allowable deficiency for mixing depth shall be per the latest edition of Section 161-6.4 of FDOT's Standard Specifications. Acceptable bearing values shall be per the latest edition of Section 160-7.2 of FDOT's Standard Specifications. Areas deficient in thickness or bearing values shall either be corrected by the Contractor to within acceptable tolerance, or if so, approved in writing by the City Engineer, may be left in place. No payment, however, will be made for such deficient areas that are left in place. 702-2.2. BASIS OF PAYMENT The unit price for subgrade shall include roadbed preparation, placement, spreading, compaction, finishing, testing, stabilizing, mixing, materials, hauling, labor, equipment and all incidentals necessary to complete the work. If no pay item is given, subgrade shall be included in the bid item for base. 703. ASPHALTIC CONCRETE MATERIALS This specification is for the preparation and application of all asphaltic concrete materials on roadway surfaces unless otherwise noted. 703-1. ASPHALTIC CONCRETE 703-1.1. AGGREGATE All aggregates shall be obtained from an approved FDOT source and shall conform to the latest edition of Sections 901 through 915 of FDOT's Standard Specifications. 703-1.2. BITUMINOUS MATERIALS All bituminous materials shall conform to the latest edition of Section 916 of FDOT's Standard Specifications. SECTION IV Page 139 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV —Technical Specifications • 703-2. HOT BITUMINOUS MIXTURES - PLANT, METHODS, EQUIPMENT & QUALITY ASSURANCE • • The plant and methods of operation used to prepare all asphaltic concrete and bituminous materials shall conform to the requirements of Section 320 of FDOT's Standard Specifications. Unless otherwise noted, all acceptance procedures and quality control/assurance procedures shall conform to the requirements of Section 330 of FDOT's Standard Specifications. The city shall have the right to have an independent testing laboratory select, test, and analyze, at the expense of the city, test specimens of any or all materials to be used. The results of such tests and analyses shall be considered, along with the tests or analyses made by the Contractor, to determine compliance with the applicable specifications for the materials so tested or analyzed. The Contractor hereby understands and accepts that wherever any portion of the work is discovered, as a result of such independent testing or investigation by the city, which fails to meet the requirements of the Contract documents, all costs of such independent inspection and investigation as well as all costs of removal, correction, reconstruction, or repair of any such work shall be borne solely by the Contractor. Payment reductions for asphalt related items shall be determined by the following: 1. Density per FDOT's Standard Specifications. 2. Final surface or friction course tolerances per FDOT's Standard Specifications. 3. Thickness will be determined from core borings. Deficiencies of /4" or greater shall be corrected by the Contractor, without compensation, by either replacing the full thickness for a length extending at least twenty-five feet (25') from each end of the deficient area, or when the Engineer allows for an overlay per FDOT's Standard Specifications. In addition, for excesses of one-quarter inch (1/4") or greater, the Engineer will determine if the excess area shall be removed and replaced at no compensation, or if the pavement in question can remain with payment to be made based on the thickness specified in the contract. The Contractor shall notify the Project Inspector a minimum of twenty-four (24) hours in advance of the placement of all asphalt. 703-3. ASPHALT MIX DESIGNS AND TYPES All asphalt mix designs, acceptance procedures and quality control/assurance procedures shall conform to the requirements of the latest edition of Sections 330 and 334 of FDOT Standard Specifications. All asphalt mix designs shall be approved by the Engineer prior to the commencement of the paving operation. Reclaimed asphalt pavement (RAP) material may be substituted for aggregate in the asphaltic concrete mixes up to 25% by weight. 703-4. ASPHALT PAVEMENT DESIGNS AND LAYER THICKNESS All asphalt pavement designs shall conform to the following FDOT requirements: • Type SP/Spec 334-1 • Type FC/Spec 337-8 • Type B/Spec 234-8 • ATPB/287-8 703-5. GENERAL CONSTRUCTION REQUIREMENTS The general construction requirements for all hot bituminous pavements (including limitations of operations, preparation of mixture, preparation of surface, placement and compaction of mixture, surface SECTION IV Page 140 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications requirements, correction of unacceptable pavement, Quality Control Testing, etc.) shall be in accordance with Section 330 of FDOT's Standard Specifications(latest edition). 703-6. CRACKS AND POTHOLE PREPARATION 703-6.1. CRACKS Cracks in roadway pavement shall be repaired prior to the application of asphaltic concrete by the following steps: 1. All debris to be removed from cracks by compressed air or other suitable method. 2. Apply a multiple layered application of bituminous binder and fine aggregate, as appropriate to the depth of the crack until the void of the crack is completely filled to the level of the surrounding roadway surface. 3. If application of asphaltic concrete is not to begin immediately after crack repair, cracks are to be sanded to prevent vehicular tracking. 4. Payment for crack filling shall be included in the unit price for asphaltic concrete. 703-6.2. POTHOLES Potholes shall be repaired prior to the application of asphaltic concrete by the following steps: 1. All debris is to be removed from potholes by hand, sweeping, or other suitable method. 2. A tack coat is to be applied to the interior surface of the pothole. 3. The pothole is to be completely filled with asphaltic concrete, and thoroughly compacted. 4. Payment for pothole preparation shall be included in the unit price for asphaltic concrete. 703-7. ADJUSTMENT OF MANHOLES AND APPURTANENCES The necessary adjustments of sanitary sewer and storm drain manholes and appurtenances shall be accomplished by the Contractor. The Contractor shall be paid on a per unit basis for each item. Refer to Section 401-2 of these Technical Specifications for additional information. The use of manhole adjustment risers is acceptable under the following conditions: 1. The riser shall meet or exceed all FDOT material, weld, and construction requirements. 2. The riser shall consist of an A-36 hot rolled steel meeting or exceeding the minimum requirements of ASTM A36. 3. The riser shall be a single piece with a stainless-steel adjustment stud and shall have a rust resistant finish. 4. The use of cast iron or fiberglass risers is not permitted. In addition, the installation of each riser shall be per manufacturer's specifications. Each manhole shall be individually measured, and each riser shall be physically marked to ensure that the proper riser is used. Also, the ring section shall be cleaned, and a bead of chemically resistant epoxy applied to the original casting, prior to installation of the riser. It is the Contractor's responsibility to ensure that the manholes are measured, the risers are physically marked, the ring sections are thoroughly cleaned, and that the epoxy is properly applied prior to installation of each riser. If risers are not used, the adjustment of manholes shall be accomplished by the removal of pavement around manhole, grade adjustment of ring and cover, and acceptable replacement and compaction of roadway materials prior to paving. A full depth backfills using asphalt is acceptable. The use of Portland cement for backfill is not acceptable. SECTION IV Page 141 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 • • • SECTION IV —Technical Specifications All manhole and valve box adjustments shall be accomplished prior to the application of final asphaltic concrete surface. Unless otherwise noted in the specs or on the plans, the paving operation shall occur within seven (7) calendar days from the completion of the adjustment. On arterial roadways, the manholes are to be ramped with asphalt during the time period between initial adjustment and final resurfacing. Water and gas valves, sewer cleanouts, valve boxes, tree aeration vents, etc., will be adjusted by the Contractor with the cost for this work to be included in the unit cost of the asphalt. Care must be taken around said appurtenances to ensure that they are not paved over. It is the Contractor's responsibility to inform the owners of all utilities of impending work and coordinate their adjustments, so they are completed prior to the scheduled paving. 703-8. ADDITIONAL ASPHALT REQUIREMENTS 1. All impacted radius returns within project limits shall be paved unless otherwise directed by the Construction Inspector or Engineer, with payment to be included in the per ton bid item for asphalt. 2. All pavement markings impacted by placement of asphalt shall be replaced prior to the road being open to traffic unless otherwise noted in the contract scope and plans. 3. All project related debris shall be hauled off the job site by the Contractor in a timely manner and at their own expense in conformance with all regulatory requirements. 4. The Contractor shall pay particular attention to sweeping when paving. Prior to paving, all construction areas shall be swept with a Municipal type sweeper (either vacuum or mechanical type) that picks up and hauls off, dust and dirt. The sweeper must be equipped with its own water supply for pre -wetting to minimize dust. Moreover, the Contractor shall sweep debris off from sidewalks, driveways, curbs and roadways each day before leaving the job site. 5. The application of tack and prime coats (either required or placed at the Engineer's discretion) shall be placed per Section 300 of FDOT's Standard Specifications. Tack shall also be applied to the face of all curbs and driveways. The cost (including heating, hauling, and applying) shall be included in the per ton bid item for asphalt, unless otherwise noted in the project scope and plans. 6. Leveling course and spot patching shall be applied to sections of the road as noted on the plans, or as directed by the Engineer, per Section 330 of FDOT's Standard Specifications. The cost shall be included in the per ton unit cost for asphalt, unless otherwise noted in the project scope and plans. 7. If an asphalt rubber binder is required, it shall conform to the requirements of Section 336 of FDOT's Standard Specifications. 8. On all streets with curb and gutter, the final compacted asphalt shall be one-quarter inch (1/4") above the lip or face of said curb per City Standard Detail Index 101. 703-9. BASIS OF MEASUREMENT Basis of measurement will be the number of tons of asphaltic concrete completed, in place and accepted. Truck scale weights will be required for all asphaltic concrete used. The scales must be calibrated and certified by an independent party and carry a state certification. 703-10. BASIS OF PAYMENT Payment shall be made at the contract unit price for asphaltic concrete surface as specified and measured above. This price shall include all materials, preparation, hauling, placement, tack and/or prime coat either required or placed at Engineer's discretion, leveling, spot patching, filling of cracks, pothole repair, sweeping, debris removal, labor, equipment, tools, and incidentals necessary to complete the asphalt work in accordance with the plans and specifications. SECTION IV Page 142 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications 704. ADJUSTMENT TO THE UNIT BID PRICE FOR ASPHALT When this Section applies to the contract, the unit bid price for asphalt will be adjusted in accordance with the following provisions: 1. Price adjustment for asphalt shall only be made when the current FDOT Asphalt Price Index varies more than ten percent (10%) from the bid price at the time of the bid opening. 2. The Bituminous Material Payment Adjustment Index published monthly by the FDOT shall be used for the adjustment of unit prices. This report is available on FDOT's internet site. The address is: https://www.fdot.gov/construction/fuel-bit/fuel-bit.shtm For additional information, call FDOT at (850) 414-4252. 3. The FDOT Payment Adjustment Index in effect at the time of the bid opening will be used for the initial determination of the asphalt price. 4. The FDOT Payment Adjustment Index in effect at the time of placement of the asphalt will be used for payment calculation. 5. The monthly billing period for contract payment will be the same as the monthly period for the FDOT Payment Adjustment Index. 6. No adjustment in bid prices will be made for either tack coat or prime coat. 7. No price adjustment reflecting any further increases in the cost of asphalt will be made for any month after the expiration of the allowable contract time. 8. The city reserves the right to make adjustments for decreases in the cost of asphalt. 705. ASPHALT DRIVEWAYS New driveways or existing asphalt driveways that must be altered for project construction shall be constructed or replaced in accordance with the specifications for paving the street with the exception that the base shall be six inches (6"). Remove only enough to allow adequate grade for access to the street. Use Section 703 Asphaltic Concrete, of these Technical Specifications, as specified for the street paving. When the finished surface of the existing drive is gravel, replacement shall be of like material. Payment shall be the same as Asphalt Driveways. 705-1. BASIS OF MEASUREMENT Measurement shall be the number of square yards of Asphalt Driveways in place and accepted. 705-2. BASIS OF PAYMENT Payment shall be the unit price per square yard for Asphalt Driveways as measured above, which price shall be full compensation for all work described in this section of the specifications and shall include all materials, equipment, tools, labor and incidentals necessary to complete the work. 706. CONCRETE CURBS Concrete Curbs shall be constructed to the line, grade and dimensions as shown on the plans. Unless otherwise noted, all concrete curbs shall have fiber mesh reinforcement and have a minimum strength of 3000 psi at 28 days. Expansion joints shall be placed at intervals not to exceed a hundred feet (100') and scored joints shall be placed at intervals not to exceed ten feet (10'). In addition, all the requirements of these city Technical Specifications Sections 301, 302 and 303 shall also apply. The Contractor shall notify the Project Inspector a minimum of twenty-four (24) hours in advance of the placement of all concrete curbs. SECTION IV Page 143 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 • SECTION IV — Technical Specifications The fmished surface must have a reasonably uniform texture, must be within 1/4 inch of a true profile grade, and must have no deviation in excess of 1/4 inch from a straight edge applied to the pavement perpendicular to the centerline. Areas varying from a true surface in excess of the above stated tolerance may be accepted without correction if the Engineer determines that they were caused by preexisting conditions which could not reasonably have been corrected by the milling operations. Any unsuitable texture or profile, as determined by the Engineer, must be corrected by the Contractor at no additional expense to the city. 706-1. BASIS OF MEASUREMENT The basis of measurement shall be linear feet of curb in place and accepted. 706-2. BASIS OF PAYMENT Payment shall be the unit price per linear foot of curb, which price shall be full compensation for all work described in this and other applicable parts of the specifications and shall include all materials, equipment, tools, labor and incidentals necessary to complete the work. 707. CONCRETE SIDEWALKS AND DRIVEWAYS 707-1. CONCRETE SIDEWALKS Concrete sidewalks shall be constructed to the line, grade and dimensions as shown on the plans or herein specified. Unless otherwise noted, all concrete sidewalks shall have fiber mesh reinforcement and have a minimum strength of 3000 psi at 28 days. Unless otherwise specified, all concrete sidewalks shall have a minimum width of four feet (4'). Concrete sidewalks shall have a minimum thickness of four inches (4"), except at driveway crossings where a minimum thickness of six inches (6") is required. Also, 6/6 X 10/10 welded wire mesh reinforcement is required for all sidewalk that crosses driveways. The welded wire mesh shall be positioned in the middle to upper third of the placement. No compensation shall be given if the welded wire mesh is not properly placed. Expansion joints shall be placed at intervals of not more than 100 hundred feet and scoring marks shall be made every five feet (5'). Concrete shall be poured only on compacted subgrade prepared in accordance with Section 702 of these Technical Specifications. In addition, all the requirements of Sections 301, 302 and 303 of these Technical Specifications shall also apply. 707-2. CONCRETE DRIVEWAYS Concrete driveways, whether new construction or replacement, shall be a minimum of six inches (6") in thickness with 6/6 x 10/10 welded wire mesh reinforcement and a minimum horizontal distance between expansion joints of no less than four feet (4') measured in any direction. The welded wire mesh shall be positioned in the middle to upper third of the placement. No compensation shall be given if the welded wire mesh is not properly placed. Concrete shall be poured only on compacted subgrade prepared in accordance with Section 702 of these Technical Specifications. In addition, all the requirements of Sections 301, 302 and 303 of these Technical Specifications shall also apply. The Contractor shall notify the Project Inspector a minimum of twenty-four (24) hours in advance of the placement of all concrete sidewalks and driveways. SECTION IV Page 144 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications 707-3. CONCRETE CURB RAMPS The contractor is responsible for constructing ADA compliant concrete curb ramps per the plans and installing detectable warning surfaces on said ramps as called for in the plan set. Concrete curb ramps and detectable warning surfaces are to be constructed per FDOT Standards and Specifications. 707-4. BASIS OF MEASUREMENT The basis of measurement shall be the number of square feet of four inch (4") concrete sidewalk, six inch (6") concrete sidewalk, and six inch (6") concrete driveways in place and accepted. 707-5. BASIS OF PAYMENT Payment shall be the unit price per square foot for each item as measured above, which shall be full compensation for all work described in this section and other applicable parts of the specifications and shall include all materials, equipment, tools, welded wire mesh where required, labor and incidentals necessary to complete the work. 708. MILLING OPERATIONS 708-1. EQUIPMENT, CONSTRUCTION & MILLED SURFACE Unless otherwise noted in the specs, plans or this Section, the milling operation shall be performed in accordance with Section 327 of FDOT 's Standard Specifications. The Contractor shall notify the city Project Manager a minimum of twenty-four (24) hours in advance of all milling. 708-2. ADDITIONAL MILLING REQUIREMENTS The following are the additional milling requirements: A. If the milling machine is equipped with preheating devices, the Contractor is responsible to secure any necessary permits, and for complying with all local, state and federal environmental regulations governing operation of this type of equipment. B. All milled surfaces must be repaved within seven (7) days from the time it was milled, unless otherwise noted in the contract documents. C. Prior to paving, all milled areas shall be swept with a Municipal type sweeper either of the vacuum or the mechanical type that picks up and hauls off, dust and dirt. The sweeper must be equipped with its own water supply for pre -wetting to minimize dust. Moreover, the Contractor shall sweep debris off of sidewalks, driveways and curbs in addition to the roadways before leaving the job site. D. In cases where concrete valley swales are present, the adjoining pavement shall be milled to allow for the new asphalt grade to be flush with the concrete surface. E. The Contractor shall be responsible for removing any asphalt that remains in the curb line and/or median curbs after the milling operation of a street is complete. The cost of this removal shall be included in the bid item for milling. F. All radius returns on streets to be milled shall also be milled unless otherwise directed by the Engineer, with payment to be included in the bid item for milling. G. Any leveling or base replacement required after milling shall be applied to sections of the road as noted on the plans, or directed by the Engineer, per Section 330 ofFDOT's Standard Specifications The cost shall be included in the per ton unit cost for asphalt, unless otherwise noted in the project scope and plans. SECTION IV Page 145 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV —Technical Specifications H. Any roadway base material exposed as a result of the milling operation shall be primed that same day (unless otherwise directed by the Engineer) per Section 300 of FDOT's Standard Specifications. Repairs required to said base that result from a failure to place the prime in a timely manner shall be done to the city's satisfaction, and at the Contractor's expense. No paving of the exposed base can commence until the city approves the repaired base. The cost of said prime shall be included in the bid item for milling. I. Prior to the placement of asphalt, the face of all curbs and driveways shall be tacked after the milling operation is complete. 708-3. SALVAGEABLE MATERIALS Unless otherwise specified, all salvageable materials resulting from milling operations shall remain the property of the city. The transporting and stockpiling of salvageable materials shall be performed by the Contractor. The Contractor shall contact the city Project Manager to schedule delivery of material at least 48 hours prior to starting work. 708-4. DISPOSABLE MATERIALS All surplus materials not claimed by the city shall become the responsibility of the Contractor. The Contractor shall dispose of the material in a timely manner and in accordance with all regulatory requirements in areas provided by the Contractor at no additional expense to the city. 708-5. ADJUSTMENT AND LOCATION OF UNDERGROUND UTILITIES All private utilities and related structures requiring adjustment shall be located and adjusted by their owners at the owner's expense. city -owned utilities and structures shall be located by the Owner/City and adjusted by the contractor. The Contractor shall arrange their schedule to allow utility owners the time required for such adjustments (minimum 48 hours' notice per State Statute). All utility adjustments shall be completed prior to the commencement of milling and resurfacing operations. 708-6. ADJUSTMENT OF UTILITY MANHOLES The necessary adjustments of sanitary sewer and stormwater utility manholes and appurtenances shall be accomplished by the Contractor in accordance with Section IV, Sections 703-7 of the city's Technical Specifications. 708-7. TYPES OF MILLING There are two types of milling used by the city: A. Wedge — This will consist of milling a six foot (6') wide strip along the curb line of the pavement adjacent to the curb so the new asphalt will align with the original curb height and pavement cross section. B. Full Width — This will consist of milling the entire roadway (i.e. curb line/edge of pavement to curb line/edge of pavement). All existing horizontal and vertical geometry shall remain unless otherwise indicated or approved by the Engineer. SECTION IV Page 146 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications 708-8. MILLING OF INTERSECTIONS Intersections, as well as other areas (including radius returns) are to be milled and repaved to restore and/or improve the original drainage characteristics. Said work should extend approximately fifty (50) feet from the low point of the existing swale. 708-9. BASIS OF MEASUREMENT The quantity to be paid for will be the area milled, in square yards, completed and accepted. 708-10. BASIS OF PAYMENT The unit price for milling shall include: all materials, preparation, hauling, transporting and stockpiling of salvageable materials, disposal of all surplus material, any required milling of radius returns and intersections, prime and/or tack coat either required or placed at Engineer's discretion, removal of asphalt from curbs, sweeping, labor, equipment, and all incidentals necessary to complete the milling in accordance with the plans and specifications. SECTION IV Page 147 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications • 800 SERIES: TRAFFIC SIGNALS, SIGNS AND MARKINGS • • 801. TRAFFIC SIGNAL EQUIPMENT AND MATERIALS All traffic signal work shall be performed per FDOT's Standard Specifications Sections 603 through 699, unless otherwise specified in the contract documents and plans. This specification includes, but is not limited to, the following items: all necessary equipment, materials, guaranties, acceptance procedures, signal timings, field tests, grounding, conduit, signal and interconnect cable, span wire assemblies, pull and junction boxes, electrical power service assemblies, poles, signal assemblies, pedestrian assemblies, inductive loop detectors, pedestrian detectors, traffic controller assemblies, controller cabinets and accessories, removal of existing traffic signal equipment, and internally illuminated signs. All traffic signal installations shall be mast arms and conform to the requirements of FDOT's Mast Ann Assembly standard and shall be signed and sealed by a professional engineer registered in the State of Florida. All mast arm calculations, as well as the geotechnical report, shall also be signed and sealed by a professional engineer registered in the State of Florida. All mast arm colors shall be determined and approved by the city's Traffic Engineering Division prior to ordering from the manufacturer. All traffic signal indicators for vehicles and pedestrians shall be LEDs and, approved by both the city's Traffic Engineering Division and FDOT. In addition to this, all pedestrian signal indicators shall utilize countdown features. Contractor changes to the operation of an existing signal is prohibited unless directed by the city's Traffic Engineering Division. All damaged inductive loop detectors shall be restored by the contractor per FDOT Index 17781. 801-1. BASIS OF MEASUREMENT AND PAYMENT The basis of measurement and payment shall be specified in the contract documents and/or plans and shall include all equipment, preparation, materials, testing and incidentals required to complete the work per the plans. 802. SIGNING AND MARKING All signing and marking work shall be performed per most current FDOT's Standard Specifications, unless otherwise specified in the contract documents and plans. This specification includes the following work: RPM's (Section 706), painted traffic stripes and markings (Section 710), thermoplastic stripes and markings (Section 711) and tubular delineators/flex posts (Sections 705 and 972). The Contractor is responsible to ensure that striping is correctly placed. Errors in striping or markings shall be "blacked -out" with paint, unless otherwise directed by the Engineer. No payment will be made for these incorrect or "blacked -out" areas. Omissions in striping or markings shall be corrected to the city's satisfaction prior to any payment being made. The Contractor is responsible for restoring all striping in paint and reflective beading per the FDOT indices mentioned above. The city's Traffic Engineering department shall follow up with thermoplastic striping at a later date unless otherwise specified. SECTION IV Page 148 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications 802-1. BASIS OF MEASUREMENT AND PAYMENT The basis of measurement and payment shall be specified in the contract documents and/or plans and shall include all equipment, preparation, materials, and incidentals required to complete the work per the plans. 803. ROADWAY LIGHTING All roadway lighting shall be constructed per most current Sections 715 and 992 of FDOT's Standard Specifications, unless otherwise specified in the contract documents and plans. 803-1. BASIS OF MEASUREMENT AND PAYMENT The basis of measurement and payment shall be specified in the contract documents and/or plans and shall include all equipment, materials, testing, and incidentals required to complete the work per the plans. SECTION IV Page 149 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV —Technical Specifications IP 900 SERIES: LANDSCAPING/RESTORATION 901. WORK IN EASEMENTS OR PARKWAYS Restoration is an important phase of construction, particularly to residents affected by the construction progress. The Contractor will be expected to complete restoration activities within a reasonable time following primary construction activity. Failure by the Contractor to accomplish restoration within a reasonable time shall be justification for a temporary stop on primary construction activity or a delay in approval of partial payment requests. Reasonable care shall be taken for existing shrubbery. Contractor shall replace all shrubbery removed or disturbed during construction. No separate payment shall be made for this work. The Contractor shall make provision and be responsible for the supply of all water, if needed, on any and all phases of the contract work. The Contractor shall not obtain water from local residents or businesses except as the Contractor shall obtain written permission. 902. GENERAL PLANTING SPECIFICATIONS 902-1. IRRIGATION 902-1.1. DESCRIPTION • A. The work specified in this Section consists of the installation of an automatic underground irrigation system as shown or noted in the plans. Provide all labor, materials, equipment, services and facilities required to perform all work in connection with the underground sprinkler irrigation system as indicated on the drawings and/or specifications. Work noted as "NIC", "existing", or "by others" is not included in this pay item. B. The irrigation plans are schematic in nature. Valves and pipes shall be located in the turf/landscape areas except at road/paving crossings. All piping under paving shall be sleeved. Changes in the irrigation system layout shall be modified with the approval of the Engineer. • 902-1.1.1. QUALITY ASSURANCE A. The irrigation work shall be installed by qualified personnel or a qualified irrigation subcontracting company that has experience in irrigation systems of similar size, scope, mainline, system pressure, controls, etc. B. All applicable ANSI, ASTM, FEDSPEC Standards and Specifications, and all applicable building codes and other public agencies having jurisdiction upon the work shall apply. C. Workmanship: All work shall be installed in a neat, orderly, and responsible manner with the recognized standards of workmanship. The Engineer reserves the right to reject material or work which does not conform to the contract documents. Rejected work shall be removed or corrected at the earliest possible time at the Contractor's expense. D. Operation and Maintenance Manuals: The Contractor shall prepare and deliver to the Engineer within ten (10) calendar days prior to completion of construction a minimum of three (3) hard cover binders, with three rings and a USB with the electronic design files (including the irrigation As Builts), containing the following information: 1. Index sheet stating the Contractor's address and business telephone number, twenty-four (24) hour emergency phone number, person to contact, list of equipment with name(s) and address(es) of SECTION IV Page 150 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications local manufacturer's representative(s) and local supplier where replacement equipment can be purchased. 2. Catalog and part sheet on every material and equipment installed under this contract. 3. Complete operating and maintenance instructions on all major equipment. 4. Provide the Engineer and the city maintenance staff with a written the Operations Manual and "hands on" training for major equipment and show evidence in writing to the Engineer at the conclusion of the project that this service has been rendered. a. Four-hour instruction (minimum) for the Irrigation Zones equipment operation and maintenance. b. Two-hour instruction (minimum) for automatic control valve operation and maintenance. 902-1.1.2. PROJECT CONDITIONS A. The Contractor shall coordinate the work with all other trades, all underground improvements, the location and planting of trees and all other planting. Verify planting requiring excavation of twenty- four -inch (24") diameter and larger with the Engineer prior to installation of main lines. B. Provide temporary irrigation at all times to maintain plant materials during the construction period. C. The Contractor is responsible to maintain the work area and equipment until final acceptance by the Engineer. Repairs and replacement of equipment broken, stolen, or missing as well as regular maintenance operations shall be the obligation of the Contractor. D. The Contractor shall submit a traffic control plan (per FDOT specifications) to the Engineer prior to initiating construction on the site. The Contractor shall be responsible for the maintenance of traffic signs, barriers, and any additional equipment to comply with the FDOT standards and to ensure the safety of its employees and the public. 902-1.1.3. WARRANTY A. The Contractor(s) shall warrant the irrigation system components to give satisfactory service for one (1) year period from the date of acceptance by the Engineer and the city. Should any problems develop within the warranty period due to inferior or faulty materials, the Contractor shall be corrected at no expense to the city. 902-1.2. PRODUCTS 902-1.2.1. GENERAL A. All materials throughout the system shall be new and in perfect condition. No deviations from the specifications shall be allowed except as noted. 902-1.2.2. PIPING A. The irrigation system pipe shall be as stated herein and shall be furnished, installed and tested in accordance with these specifications. B. All pipe is herein specified to be Polyvinyl Chloride (PVC) Pipe, 1120, Schedule 40, conforming to ASTM D2665 and D1785. C. All nipples, pipe connections, bushings, swing joints, connecting equipment to the mainline is required to be threaded Polyvinyl Chloride (PVC) Pipe, Schedule 80 per detail drawings. 902-1.2.3. PIPE FITTINGS A. All pipe fittings for Schedule 40 PVC pipe shall be as follows: Fittings shall conform to the requirements of ASTM D2466, Standard Specification for Polyvinyl Chloride (PVC) Plastic Pipe Fittings, Schedule 80. All fittings shall bear the manufacturer's name or trademark, material designation, size, applicable IPS schedule and NSF seal of approval. The connection of mainline pipe SECTION IV Page 151 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 • SECTION IV — Technical Specifications to the automatic control valve shall be assembled with threaded Schedule 80 fittings and threaded Schedule 80 nipples. 902-1.2.4. PVC PIPE CEMENT AND PRIMER A. Provide solvent cement and primer for PVC solvent weld pipe and fittings as recommended by the manufacturer. Pipe joints for solvent weld pipe to be belled end. Submit to the city Project Manager for approval. The solvent that cement that should be used is 303 PVC Cement Regular Clear. B. Purple primer shall be applied after the pipe and fittings have been cut and cleaned. The Primer shall be of contrasting color and be easily recognizable against PVC pipe. The purple primer cleaner for PVC is 8800. 902-1.2.5. THREADED CONNECTIONS A. Threaded PVC connections shall be made using Teflon tape or Teflon pipe sealant. 902-1.2.6. GATE VALVES 902-1.2.6.1. MANUAL GATE VALVES TWO INCHES (2") AND SMALLER A. Provide the following, unless otherwise noted on Drawings: 1. 200-250 psi Ball Valve 2. Nibco Brass Body Construction, female threaded on both sides, sized appropriately to source pipe - with Teflon Ball Seals 3. Slip/Threaded Coupler 4. Schedule 80 Nipple III 902-1.2.6.2. GATE VALVES TWO AND A HALF INCHES (2'/2") AND LARGER A. Provide the following, unless otherwise noted on Drawings: 1 AWWA-0509 2. 200 lb. O.W.G. 3. Cast Iron body - ASTM A 126 Class B 4. Deep socket joints 5. Rising stem 6. Bolted bonnet 7. Double disc 8. Equipped with two inches (2") square operating key with tee handle B. Provide two (2) operating keys for gate valve three inches (3") and larger. The "street key" shall be five feet (5') long with a two inch (2") square operating nut. • 902-1.2.7. SLEEVES A. Sleeves: (Existing by city of Clearwater) 1. The Contractor shall verify the location of all existing sleeves as shown on the roadway, utility and/or irrigation plans and notify the Engineer of any discrepancies. B. Schedule 80 or higher, sized two (2) times the diameter of pipe to be sleeved 902-1.2.8. REMOTE CONTROL VALVES A. The electric globe remote control valve shall be a solenoid actuated; balance -pressure across -the - diaphragm type capable of having a flow rate per manufacturer's recommendations with a pressure loss not to exceed 6.1 pounds per square inch (psi). The valve pressure rating shall not be less than 150 psi. Submit to the city Project Manager for approval. SECTION IV Page 152 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV —Technical Specifications B. The valve body and bonnet shall be constructed of high impact weather resistant plastic, stainless steel, and other chemical/UV resistant materials. The valve's one-piece diaphragm shall be of durable santoprene material with a clog resistant metering orifice. C. The valve body shall have a one -inch (1"), 1 1/2", 2", 3" (FNPT) inlet and outlet or a one -inch (1") female threaded inlet and outlet for threaded connections. D. The valve construction shall be as such to provide for all internal parts to be removable from the top of the valve without disturbing the valve installation. E. The valve shall be as manufactured by Irritrol or approved equal. Any valve that is 3" or larger than must submit to the city Project Manager for approval. F. Identify all control valves using Aluminum or Bronze metal I.D. tags numbered to match drawings. G. All electric valves to have gate valves on source side of each valve. 902-1.2.9. VALVE BOXES A. For electronic irrigation valves use a Brooks #36 concrete valve box with #36-T cast iron traffic bearing cover or approved equal. B. For wire splices and gate valves use a Carson with T cover (Heavy Duty) ten inch (10") circular valve box with #181015 cover comparable to Brooks or approved equal. The color of the lids need to be Panton 522C if reclaimed. 902-1.2.10. AUTOMATIC CONTROL TIMER A. The irrigation controller (control module) shall be programmable by a separate transmitter device only. The program shall be communicated to the Control Module from the Field Transmitter via an infrared connection. The controller shall be of a module type which may be installed in a valve box underground. The controller shall function normally if submerged in water and the communication from the transmitter shall function if submerged in water. B. The control module shall be housed in an ABS plastic cabinet and shall be potted to insure waterproof operation. The control module shall have two mounting slots for screws allowing the module to be securely mounted inside a valve box. C. The controller shall operate on one nine volt (9V) alkaline battery for one full year regardless of the number of stations utilized. The controller shall operate 1, 2, or 4 stations either sequentially or independently. D. The controller shall have three (3) independent programs with eight (8) start times each, station run time capability from one (1) minute to twelve (12) hours in one (1) minute increments, and a seven (7) day calendar. The controller shall turn on stations via latching solenoids installed on the valves. Manual operations shall be initiated by attaching the Field Transmitter to the Control Module and programming a manual start. The controller shall be capable of manual single station or manual program operation. E. The controller shall be as manufactured by Rain Bird Sprinkler Mfg. Corp., Glendora, California USA. Submit to the city Project Manager for approval. 902-1.2.11. FIELD TRANSMITTER A. The irrigation controller shall be programmable by a separate transmitter device (Field Transmitter) only. The Field Transmitter shall communicate to the Control Module via an infrared connection or over air. The Field Transmitter shall be water resistant and housed in ABS plastic and have a removable, reversible protective sheath. The Field Transmitter shall operate on one nine volt (9V) alkaline battery. B. The Field Transmitter shall have a large LCD screen and a seven -key programming pad. A beep sound shall confirm every key stroke. The screen shall automatically turn off after one minute when not in use. C. The Field Transmitter shall be capable of programming an unlimited number of UNIK Control Modules or A/C placed times, whichever is applicable. SECTION IV Page 153 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 • SECTION IV — Technical Specifications D. The Field Transmitter shall be as manufactured by Rain Bird Sprinkler Mfg. Corp., Glendora, California USA. E. Field transmitter to be provided to city Parks and Recreation at time of acceptance of project. F. Submit to the city Project Manager for approval. 902-1.3. EXECUTION 902-1.3.1. GENERAL INSTALLATION REQUIREMENTS A. Before work is commenced, hold a conference with the Engineer to discuss general details of the work. B. Verify dimensions and grades at job site before work is commenced. C. During the progress of the work, a competent superintendent and any assistants necessary shall be on site, all satisfactory to the Engineer. This superintendent shall not be changed, except with the consent of the Engineer. The superintendent shall represent the Contractor in Contractor's absence and all directions given to the superintendent shall be as binding as if given to the Contractor. D. Obtain and pay for all irrigation and plumbing permits and all inspections required by outside authorities. E. All work indicated or notes on the Drawings shall be provided whether or not specifically mentioned in these Technical Specifications. F. No irrigation piping or any irrigation component shall be installed in a retention pond bottom or slopes or passing through retention pond. No piping shall be 12" from top of bank. G. If there are ambiguities between the Drawings and Specifications, and specific interpretation or clarification is not issued prior to bidding, the interpretation or clarification will be made only by the Engineer, and the Contractor shall comply with the decisions. In the event the installation contradicts the directions given, the installation shall be corrected by the Contractor at no additional cost. H. Layout of sprinkler lines shown on the Drawing is diagrammatic only. Location of sprinkler equipment is contingent upon and subject to integration with all other underground utilities. Contractor shall employ all data contained in the Contract Documents and shall verify this information at the construction site to confirm the manner by which it relates to the installation. I. Do not proceed with the installation of the sprinkler system when it is apparent that obstructions or grade differences exist or if conflicts in construction details, legend, or specific notes are discovered. All such obstructions, conflicts, or discrepancies shall be brought to the attention of the Engineer. J. The disturbance of existing paving will not be permitted. Install all required sleeving prior to roadway base installation. 902-1.3.2. EXCAVATING AND BACKFILLING 902-1.3.2.1. TRENCHING - GENERAL A. Dig sides of trenches straight(vertically). Provide continuous support for pipe on bottom of trenches. Lay pipe to uniform grade. Trenching excavation shall follow layout indicated on Drawings. B. Maintain six inch (6") horizontal and minimum clearance between sprinkler lines and between all lines of other trades. C. Do not install sprinkler lines directly above another line of any kind. D. Maintain six inch (6") vertical minimum between sprinkler lines which cross at angles of 45° to 90°. E. Exercise care when excavating, trenching, and working near existing utilities. 902-1.3.2.2. BACKFILLING A. All pressure supply lines (mainline) shall have eighteen inches (18") of fill placed over the pipe. B. Initial backfill on all lines shall be of a fine granular material with no foreign matter larger than one half inch (%2"). C. Compact backfill according to Section 125 of FDOT Standard Specifications. SECTION IV Page 154 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications D. Do not, under any circumstances, use equipment or vehicle wheels for compacting soil. E. Restore grades and repair damages where settling occurs before landscape installation begins. F. Compact each layer of fill with approved equipment to achieve a maximum density per AASHTO T180. Under landscaped areas, compaction shall not exceed 95% of maximum density. G. Compaction shall be obtained by the use of mechanical tampers or approved hand tampers. When hand tampers are used, the materials shall be deposited in layers not more than six inches (6") thick. The hand tampers shall be suitable for this purpose and shall have a face area of not more than 100 square inches. Special precautions shall be taken to prevent damage to the irrigation system piping and adjacent utilities. 902-1.3.2.3. ROUTING OF PIPING A. Routing of pressure and non -pressure piping lines are indicated diagrammatically on Drawings. B. Coordinate specimen trees and shrubs with routing of lines. 1. Planting locations shall take precedence over sprinkler and piping locations. 2. Report to Engineer and/or city any major deviation from routing indicated. C. Conform to Drawings layout without offsetting the various assemblies from the pressure supply line. D. Layout all systems using an approved staking method and maintain the staking of approved layout. 902-1.3.3. INSTALLATION 902-1.3.3.1. WATER SUPPLY A. Connections to the water sources shall be at the approximate locations indicated on the Drawings. Make minor changes caused by actual site conditions without additional cost to the city. 902-1.3.3.2. ASSEMBLIES A. Routing or pressure supply lines as indicated on Drawings is diagrammatic only. Install lines and required assemblies in accordance with details on Drawings. B. Do not install multiple assemblies on plastic lines. Provide each assembly with its own outlet. When used, the pressure relief valve shall be the last assembly. C. Install all assemblies in accordance with the respective detail Drawings and these Technical Specifications. D. Plastic pipe and threaded fittings shall be assembled using Teflon tape, applied to the male threads only. 902-1.3.3.3. SLEEVES: (EXISTING BY CITY OF CLEARWATER) A. The Contractor shall verify the location and size of all existing sleeves as shown on the roadway, utility and/or irrigation plans and notify the Engineer of any discrepancies before work begins. 902-1.3.3.4. PLASTIC PIPE A. Install plastic pipe in accord with manufacturer's recommendations. B. Prepare all welded joints with manufacturer's cleaner prior to applying solvent. 1. Allow welded joints as least fifteen (15) minutes setup/curing time before moving or handling. 2. Partially center load pipe in trenches to prevent arching and shifting when water pressure is on. 3. Do not permit water in pipe until a period of at least four (4) hours has elapsed for solvent weld setting and curing, unless recommended otherwise by solvent manufacturer. C. Curing 1. When the temperature is above 80°F, allow soluble weld joints at least twenty-four (24) hours curing time before water is introduced under pressure. D. Flushing the system: 1. After all sprinkler pipelines and risers are in place and connected, open the control valves and flush out the system with a full head of water. E. Installing piping under existing pavement: SECTION IV Page 155 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications 1. Piping under existing pavement may be installed by jacking & boring. Refer to Section 503-2.3. of these Technical Specifications. 2. Secure permission from the city Landscape Architect before cutting or breaking any existing pavement. All repairs and replacements shall be approved by city and shall be accomplished at no additional cost. 902-1.3.3.5. CONTROLLERS A. Install all automatic controllers as shown in the plans. 1. The location of all controllers shall be approved by the city's Project Manager and/or Representative prior to installation. 902-1.3.3.6. REMOTE CONTROL VALVES A. Install at final grade. Set in turf areas whenever possible. B. Install valves in turf areas in a plumb position with twenty-four inch (24") minimum maintenance clearance from other equipment, three feet (3') minimum from edges of sidewalks, buildings, and walls, and no closer than seven feet (7') from the back of curb or edge of pavement along roadways. C. Contractor shall adjust the valve to provide the proper flow rate or operating pressure for each sprinkler zone. 902-1.3.3.7. GATE VALVES A. Install where indicated and with sufficient clearance from other materials for proper maintenance. B. Check and tighten valve bonnet packing before backfilling. C. Install in 10" round, Carson Heavy Duty valve box or approved equal (Pantone 522C if reclaim). • 902-2. LANDSCAPE • 902-2.1. GENERAL 902-2.1.1. REQUIREMENTS OF REGULATORY AGENCIES A. Comply with Federal, State, Local, and other duly constituted authorities, and regulatory agencies, without additional cost to the city in matters pertaining to codes, safety, and environmental matters. B. Any permits for the installation or construction of any of the work included under the contract, which are required by any of the legally constituted authorities having jurisdiction, shall be arranged for by the Contractor and paid for directly by the Contractor, unless otherwise agreed upon in writing. 902-2.1.2. SCOPE OF WORK A. All provisions of Contract, including General and Special Provisions and Plans, apply to the work specified in this Section. The Scope of Work includes everything for and incidental to executing and completing all landscape work shown on the Plans, Schedules, Notes and as specified herein. B. Furnish and provide all labor, plants and materials tools and equipment necessary to prepare the soil for plantings, to install and care for all plant materials (including finish grading if necessary); to remove and/or transplant existing plants if indicated; to furnish, plant, fertilize, guy and brace, water, mulch and prune all new plant materials; and to execute all other Work as described herein or indicated on the Plans. C. Work under this Section shall include labor and materials for final grading and raking to prepare the site for sodding, sprigging, or seeding, so finished lawn or playing field will appear even and uniform, will drain adequately, and will comply with the intent of the landscape drawings. D. Initial maintenance of landscape materials as specified in this document. SECTION IV Page 156 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications 902-2.1.3. QUALITY ASSURANCE A. Landscape work shall be contracted to a single firm specializing in landscape work, who shall in turn subcontract no more than 40% of the work specified. All subcontractors under the control of the Contractor involved in the completion of the landscape work, shall be made known to the city and the city Landscape Architect prior to their commencement of work on the project. B. All work of this Section shall conform to the highest standard of landscape practices. C. The Plant Material Schedule included with these Plans is provided only for the Contractor's convenience; it shall not be construed as to conflict or predominate over the Plans. If conflict between the Plans and Specifications exists, submit to the city Project Manager for approval. D. During this work, the Contractor shall be responsible for maintaining safety among persons in their employ in accordance with the standards set by The Occupational Safety and Health Act of 1970 (and all subsequent amendments). City and city Landscape Architect shall be held harmless from any accident, injury or any other incident resulting from compliance or non-compliance with these standards. E. The Contractor shall cooperate with and coordinate with all other trades whose work is built into or affects the work in this Section. F. All appropriate utility companies and agencies shall be contacted 72 hours prior to excavation. Call "One Call"/ "Sunshine 811" at 8-1-1; "Sunshine 811" administrative offices may be reached at (800) 638-4097. G. The Contractor shall carefully examine the site and all existing conditions affecting the work, such as: soil, obstructions, existing trees, utilities, etc. Report any conditions in conflict with the work to the Landscape Architect. 902-2.1.4. SUBMITTALS A. The Contractor is required to submit prior to the expiration of the required maintenance period, two (2) copies of typewritten instructions recommending procedures to be established by the Contractor for maintenance of landscape work for a period of one (1) year. B. Furnish unit prices for all plant materials and inert materials, including labor for all specified work. 902-2.1.5. ALTERNATES, ADDITIONS, DELETIONS, SUBSTITUTIONS A. If there are additions/alternates included in these Plans and Specifications, the Contractor must propose prices to accomplish the work stated as additions/alternates at the time of bidding. B. The city, through their Project Manager, reserves the right to add or deduct any of the work stated herein without rendering the Contract void. C. The Contractor must have written approval by the city Project Manager for any substitutions not previously agreed to in the purchase agreement: installation without approval is entirely at the Contractor's risk. D. All material acquired through additions or substitutions shall be subject to all conditions and warranties stated herein. 902-2.1.6. ABBREVIATIONS/DEFINITIONS O.A. or HT.: The over-all height of the plant measured from the ground to the natural, untied state of the majority of the foliage, not including extreme leaves, branches or fronds. C.T.: Clear trunk is measured from the ground to the bottom of the first leaf or frond stem with no foliage from ground to specified height. For example, on Canary Island Date Palms or similar, the clear trunk measurement includes the "nut" at the base of the fronds. SECTION IV Page 157 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 • • • SECTION IV —Technical Specifications C. W: Clear wood is measured from the ground to the bottom of the base of the lowest leaf sheath or boot, trimmed in a natural manner. For example, on Canary Island Date Palms or similar, the clear wood measurement does not include the "nut" at the base of the fronds. SPR.: Spread, branches measured in natural untied position to the average crown diameter, not including extreme leaves, branches, or fronds. ST. TR.: Straight trunk. MIN.: Minimum. GAL.: Gallon container size, i.e., 1 gallon, 3 -gallon, 7 gallons, etc. O.C.: On center, distance between plant centers. DIA.: Diameter. LVS.: Leaves. D.B.H.: Diameter or caliper of main trunk of tree as measured at breast height at 4-1/2 feet above grade. CAL.: Caliper, the outside diameter of up to a four -inch tree is measured six inches above grade, larger trees are measured at 12 inches above grade. B&B: Balled and burlapped in accordance with horticultural standards of the American Association of Nurserymen. PPP: Plants per pot. FG: Field grown. STD.: Standard, single, straight trunk. Owner: To be known as that entity which holds title or control to the premises on which the work is performed. Owner's Representative: Owner's on-site representative shall be responsible for approval of quantity and quality of materials specified and execution of installation. Contractor: Shall refer to that person or enterprise commonly known as the Landscape Contractor. Landscape Architect: This person or firm is the responsible representative of the Owner who produces the landscape Plans and Specifications. 902-2.1.7. PRODUCT DELIVERY, STORAGE, AND HANDLING 902-2.1.7.1. PLANT MATERIALS A. Use Florida Grades and Standards (most current edition) for all plant materials within these Technical Specifications. B. Provide container -grown or, if appropriate, freshly dug trees and shrubs. Do not prune prior to delivery. Do not bend or bind trees or shrubs in such a manner as to damage bark, break branches or destroy natural shape. Provide protective covering during delivery. If plant delivery is made in open vehicles, the entire load shall be suitably covered. C. All plants are to be handled at all times so that roots or root balls are adequately protected from sun, cold, or drying winds. No root balls for trees and container plants that have been cracked or broken shall be planted except upon special approval. Plants shall not be pulled by the tops or stems, nor handled in a rough or careless manner at any time. D. Trees shall be dug with adequate root balls, burlapped, and wire bound if needed. Root pruning to be done a minimum of four (4) weeks before removal from the field and planting at the site. Root balls SECTION IV Page 158 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications may not be encased in "grow bags" or other synthetic material, except plastic shrink wrap for transport only. E. Palms shall be planted within twenty-four (24) hours of delivery. F. Deliver trees and shrubs after preparations for planting have been completed and plant immediately. If planting is delayed more than 6 hours after delivery, set trees and shrubs in shade, protect from weather and mechanical damage, and cover to keep the roots moist. G. Label all plants of each variety with a securely attached waterproof tag bearing legible designation of botanical and common name. H. Time delivery so that sod will be placed within twenty-four (24) hours after stripping. Protect sod against drying and breaking by covering palettes of sod or placing in a shaded area. 902-2.1.8. JOB CONDITIONS 902-2.1.8.1. ACCEPTANCE OF JOB CONDITIONS. A. The Contractor shall examine the sub -grade, verify elevations, observe the conditions under which work is to be performed and notify the city Landscape Architect or Project Manager in writing of unsatisfactory conditions prior to beginning work. Do not proceed with the work until unsatisfactory conditions have been corrected in a manner acceptable to the city Landscape Architect. Start of work shall indicate acceptance of conditions and full responsibility for the completed work. B. Proceed with and complete the landscape work as rapidly as portions of the site become available, working within the seasonal limitations for each kind of landscape work and following the approved schedule. If seasonal limitations apply, notify the city Landscape Architect for adjustments to the Schedule. C. Determine locations of all underground utilities and review for conflicts with planting procedures before plant installations begin. D. When adverse conditions to plant growth are encountered, such as rubble fill, drainage conditions or obstruction, the Contractor shall notify the city Landscape Architect in writing for change approval before work is performed E. Plant trees and shrubs after final grades are established and prior to sod installation or seeding lawns. Protect existing lawn, trees, and promptly repair all damages from planting operations that is satisfactory and approved by the city. 902-2.1.8.2. SCHEDULING OF WORK A. The work shall be carried out to completion with the utmost speed. Immediately upon award of contract, the Contractor shall prepare a construction schedule and furnish a copy to the city's Project Manager and/or the city Landscape Architect for approval. The Contractor shall carry out the work in accordance with the approved schedule. B. If the Contractor incurs unforeseen costs, such as overtime hours, holidays, etc., in order to complete the work within the time stated in the Contract, and/or to maintain the progress schedule, all said costs shall be borne by the Contractor at no additional cost to the city. C. The city's Project Manager and/or Representatives may request work stoppage in writing. Upon written request from the city's Project Manager, the Landscape Contractor shall suspend delivery of material and stop all work for such a period as deemed necessary by the city of Clearwater, the city's Project Manager, or the General Contractor, with respect to any additional costs which may result from work stoppage. 902-2.1.8.3. UTILITIES A. The Contractor shall perform work in a manner which will avoid conflicts with utilities. Hand excavate, as required, to minimize possibility of damage to underground utilities. Maintain grade stakes set by others until removal is mutually agreed upon by all parties concerned. SECTION IV Page 159 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 1111 902-2.2. PRODUCTS 902-2.2.1. MATERIALS • • SECTION IV — Technical Specifications 902-2.2.1.1. PLANT MATERIALS: NOMENCLATURE A. Plant species, sizes, etc., shall be per Plans and Specifications on Plant Material Schedule. Nomenclature is per Manual of Cultivated Plant, Standard Encyclopedia of Horticulture, L.H. Bailey, or Standardized Plant Names Dictionary, American Joint Committee on Horticultural Nomenclature (latest editions) or conforms with names accepted in the nursery trade. The scientific and common name both need to be provided for each plant materials. 902-2.2.1.2. PLANT MATERIALS: QUALITY ASSURANCE A. Use Florida Grades and Standards (latest edition) for all plant materials within these Technical Specifications. B. Provide healthy, vigorous stock grown under climatic conditions similar to conditions in the locality of the project. Plants shall have a habit of growth that is normal for the species and be sound, healthy, vigorous, and free from insects, pests or their eggs, plant diseases, defects and injuries. Plants shall be well branched and densely foliated when in leaf and shall have healthy, well-developed root systems. C. Trees shall be heavily branched or, in the case of palms, be heavily leafed. Some plant materials may be collected stock with the approval of the Landscape Architect. Tree species must have a single main trunk (central leader), unless otherwise stated. Trees that have the main trunk forming a "Y" shape or parallel branching are not acceptable. D. Plant materials shall be specified and shall be Florida #1 or better as to shape and quality for the species as outlined in Grades and Standards for Nursery Plants Part I and II, Florida Department of Agriculture and Consumer Services (latest edition). E. The city Landscape Architect reserves the right to inspect plant materials either at the place of growth or at the project site prior to planting for compliance with requirements for name, variety, size, quality, or designated area. F. Landscape materials shall be shipped with certificates of inspection as required by governmental authorities. The Contractor shall comply with all governing regulations that are applicable to landscape materials. G. Do not make substitutions. If specified landscape material is not available, submit to the Landscape Architect proof of it being non -available. In such event, if the Landscape Architect designates an available source, such shall be acquired from designated source. When authorized, a written change order for substitute material will be made by adjustment to Contract amount. H. Height and/or width of trees shall be measured from ground up; width measurement shall be normal crown spread of branches with plants in the normal position. This measurement shall not include immediate terminal growth. All measurements shall be taken after pruning for specified sizes. All trees and shrubs shall conform to measurements specified in the plant material schedule, except that plant material larger than specified may be used with the approval of the city Landscape Architect, with no increase to the Contract price. Plant materials shall not be pruned prior to delivery. I. Plant Material shall be symmetrical, typical for variety and species. Plants used where symmetry is required shall be matched as nearly as possible. J. Balled and burlapped plants shall have firm, natural balls of earth of sufficient diameter and depth to encompass the feeding root system necessary for full development of the plant and to conform with the standards of the American Association of Nurserymen. Root balls and tree trunks shall not be damaged by improper binding and B & B procedures. Only natural biodegradable burlap will be acceptable. K. Container -grown plants may be substituted for balled and burlapped plants or vice -versa provided the quality is equal or better than specified and the Landscape Architect approves the substitution. SECTION IV Page 160 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications L. Container -grown stock shall have been grown in containers for at least four months, but not over two years. If requested, samples must be shown to prove no root bound condition exists. 902-2.2.1.3. GRASSES: SOD OR SEED A. Sod or seed (as/if specified) shall be a certified species as stated on the Plan. Solid sod shall be of even thickness and with a good root structure, 95% free of noxious weed, freshly mowed before cutting, and pest and disease free when laid. It must not be stacked more than twenty-four (24) hours before laying and it must be grown in soil compatible to that in which it will be installed. Sod must be kept moist prior to and after installation through the acceptance of the project. B. Sod shall be laid side to side with no gaps and all at level grade, so no scalping occurs. Contractor will make changes as deemed necessary by the city before acceptance of work. C. Seed shall be delivered to the site in unopened bags with certification tags in place. Purity, germination and weed content shall be as certification requirements. 902-2.2.1.4. MULCH A. Mulch shall be as specified in the plans B. Install mulch to an even depth of three inches (3") before compaction, as shown in the PLANTING DETAILS in the plans. 902-2.2.1.5. STAKES AND GUYS A. Use the University of Florida Urban Tree Foundation Planting Details and Specifications Staking details. Use the latest edition of the Staking Details from the Urban Tree Foundation (http://urbantree.org/details staking.shtml) B. For single trunk palms, stakes shall be cut from 2" x 4" pressure treated (p.t.) stock, with a minimum of three (3) stakes per palm. Batten consisting of 5 layers of burlap and 5 - 2" x 4" by 16" wood connected with two — three-quarter inch (3/4") steel bands shall be used around the palm trunk. Submit to the city Project Manager for approval. C. Other tree staking systems may be acceptable if approved. 902-2.2.1.6. PLANTING SOIL A. Unless stated on the plans or in the specifications, install plant material in tilled and loosened native soil backfill. It is the responsibility of the Landscape Contractor to test, prior to planting and at no additional cost to the city, any soils which may be unsuitable for the vigorous growth of plants. Unsuitable conditions shall be reported to the Landscape Architect immediately in writing. B. When required, planting soil media shall be provided by the Contractor and shall consist of one-third (1/3) peat and two-thirds (2/3) sandy loam, with no lumps over one inch (1"). C. Backfill and clean fill dirt provided by the Contractor shall be in a native, friable soil with known analysis and composition that is like soil makeup. There must be slight acid reaction to the soil (about 6.0 — 6.5 pH) with no excess of calcium or carbonate, and it shall be free from weeds, clay, stones, stumps, roots and toxic substances or any other materials that might be harmful to plant growth or a hindrance to grading, planting, and maintenance procedures and operations. No heavily organic soil, such as muck or peat shall be used as fill dirt. 902-2.2.1.7. TREE PROTECTION A. Wood fencing shall be 2" x 4" pressure treated stock with flagging on horizontal members. Space vertical members six feet (6') to eight feet (8') on center. The barricade shall be placed so as to protect the critical protection zone area, which is the area surrounding a tree within a circle described by a radius of one foot (1') for each inch of the tree's diameter at breast height DBH (four and one half feet) above grade. SECTION IV Page 161 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications • 902-2.2.1.8. ROOT BARRIER SYSTEM A. Submit to city Project Manager and Landscape Architect for approval (if applicable). 902-2.2.1.9. PACKAGED MATERIALS A. Deliver packaged materials in containers showing weight, analysis and name of manufacturer. Protect materials from deterioration during delivery and while stored at the site. 902-2.2.1.10. PESTICIDES A. Pesticides shall be only approved, safe brands applied according to manufacturer's directions. • • 902-2.3. EXECUTION 902-2.3.1. PREPARATION 902-2.3.1.1. OBSTRUCTIONS BELOW GROUND A. It shall be the responsibility of the Contractor to locate and mark all underground utilities, irrigation lines and wiring prior to commencement of the work. B. If underground construction, utilities, or other obstructions are encountered in excavation of planting areas or pits, the city Project Manager and Landscape Architect shall be immediately notified to select a relocated position for any materials necessary. 902-2.3.1.2. GRADING AND PREPARATION FOR PLANT MATERIALS A. All proposed landscape areas containing existing turf grass or weeds shall be treated with mutually agreed on herbicide per manufacturer's specifications. All proposed landscape areas adjacent to water bodies shall be treated with "Rodeo" or approved equal per the manufacturer's specifications. B. New plant materials will not be installed until 98% weed/turf eradication has been achieved. More than one application may be required to produce an acceptable planting bed. C. Pre -emergent herbicides are not a substitute for spray treatment of "Rodeo" or approved equal and may be used only with the written approval of the Landscape Architect. D. Should any plant material in the same or adjacent beds be damaged by these chemicals, the same size, quantity, and quality of plants shall be immediately replaced by the Contractor at no cost to the city. E. Any necessary corrections or repairs to the finish grades shall be accomplished by the Contractor. All planting areas shall be carefully graded and raked to smooth, even fmish grade, free from depressions, lumps, stones, sticks or other debris and such that they will conform to the required finish grades and provide uniform and satisfactory surface drainage without puddling. F. The Contractor shall remove debris (sticks, stones, rubbish) over one- and one-half inches (1 %s") in any dimension from individual tree, shrub and hedge pits and dispose of the excavated material off the site. 902-2.3.1.3. PREPARATION FOR ANNUAL BED PLANTING A. Prepare native subgrade by rototilling or loosening by hand methods. Spread three inches (3") of one- third (1/3) Florida peat and two-thirds (2/3) sandy, or other approved organic soil amendment over the full length and width of planting area for annuals. Rototill organic layer six inches (6") to eight inches (8") into the native soil. Grade the planting bed by "crowning' to ensure that surface drainage, percolation, and aeration occur at rapid rates. 902-2.3.1.4. PREPARATION FOR SEEDING AND SOD AREAS A. All proposed sod areas containing existing turf grass or weeds shall be treated with Monsanto's "Round -Up" per manufacturer's specifications. All proposed sod areas adjacent to water bodies shall be treated with "Rodeo" per the Manufacturer's Specifications. SECTION IV Page 162 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications B. Limit preparation to areas which will be planted promptly after preparation. Loosen sub -grade of seed and sod areas to a minimum depth of four inches (4"). C. Immediately prior to any turf work, the Contractor shall finish grade the soil to a smooth, even surface assuring positive drainage away from buildings and the subsequent turf flush to the tops of adjacent curbs and sidewalks. The surface shall be sloped to existing yard drains. D. Moisten prepared seed and sod areas before planting if soil is dry. Water thoroughly and allow surface moisture to dry before planting lawns. Do not create a muddy soil condition. 902-2.3.2. INSTALLATION 902-2.3.2.1. BERM CONSTRUCTION (IF SPECIFIED) A. Install berms at location and design shown on Plans and at the height and slope indicated. Height stated is for finished berm with soil at natural compaction. B. Exact location and configuration of berms may require modification to allow proper drainage; such changes will be coordinated with the Landscape Architect. C. If shown on the Plan, construct berms using clean sandy loam fill dirt which is well -drained, free of rocks, roots, or other debris, with a soil pH of an acid Nature (about 6.0 - 6.5). No heavily organic soil, such as muck or peat shall be used in berm construction. 902-2.3.2.2. LAYOUT OF PLANT MATERIALS A. Unless otherwise stipulated, plant materials shall be approximately located per the plans by scale measurements using established building, columns, curbs, screen walls, etc., as the measuring reference point. Slight shifting may be required to clear wires, prevent blockage of signage, etc. B. Shrubs and ground covers shall be located and spaced as noted on the plant material schedule C. Leave an eighteen -inch (18") (450 millimeters) borders of mulched space between outer leaves of installed plant material and the bed line, curb, or building foundation wall for all plant sizes. D. Any necessary "minor" adjustments in the layout of planting shall be made by the Contractor with the approval of the city Project Manager and Landscape Architect in order to conform as nearly as possible to the intent of the Plans. 902-2.3.2.3. PLANTING PROCEDURES A. All shrubs, trees and ground covers or vines shall be planted in pits having vertical sides and being circular in outline. Planting pit shall be two (2) times the width of the root ball. B. Plants shall be set straight or plumb, in the locations shown, planted "high" withl 0% of the root ball height above the surrounding grade. C. Native soil shall be used in back -filling plant pits or as specified. The Contractor shall be responsible for providing additional soil for building tree saucers. D. When balled and burlapped plants are set, undisturbed native soil shall be left under the base of the root ball to prevent voids. Backfill loosened native soil around the sides of the root ball. Remove the top 4 four inches (4") (100 millimeters) of burlap wire, and all tie -down material from the root ball. Do not remove these materials from the bottom of the root ball. Thoroughly water -in before bringing the back- fill up to the proper grade. Use the Florida Grades and Standards (latest edition). Failure to comply is cause for rejection. E. Containerized plants shall be installed with undisturbed native soil left under the base of the root ball to prevent voids. Planting pit shall be three (3) to five (5) times the width of the root ball. Backfill tilled and loosened native soil around the sides of the root ball. Thoroughly water -in before bringing the backfill up to the proper grade. F. Plant spacing shall be "on center" and varies with the different plant species. Space each variety of plant equally in the planting areas. Shrubs and ground cover adjacent to straight or curved edges shall be triangular - spaced in rows parallel to those edges. Plant a minimum of eighteen inches (18") from the back of the curb to the outside edge of the plant. SECTION IV Page 163 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications • 902-2.3.2.4. SODDING A. During periods of drought, sod shall be watered sufficiently at its origin to moisten the soil adequately to the depth to which it is to be cut. B. Solid sod shall be laid tightly with closely abutting staggered joints with an even surface edge and sod edge, in a neat and clean manner to the edge of all the paving and shrub areas. Cut down soil level to one inch (1") to one- and one-half inches (1-1/2") below top of walks prior to laying sod. C. Within two (2) hours after installing sod and prior to rolling, irrigate the sod. Sufficient water shall be applied to wet the sod thoroughly and to wet the sod to a depth of two inches (2") (50 millimeters). Watering shall be done in a manner that will avoid erosion due to the application of excessive quantities, and the watering equipment shall be a type that will prevent damage to the finished sod surface. Watering shall be repeated as necessary to keep sod moist until rooted to subgrade. D. The sod shall be pressed firmly into contact with the sod bed using a turf roller or other approved equipment so as to eliminate air pockets, provide a true and even surface and insure knitting without any displacement of the sod or deformation of the surfaces of sodded areas. After the sodding operation has been completed and rolled, the edges of the area shall be smooth and conform to the grades indicated. E. If, in the opinion of the Landscape Architect, top dressing is necessary after rolling, clean silica sand shall be used to fill voids. Evenly apply sand over the entire surface to be leveled, filling-in dips and voids and thoroughly washing into the sod areas. F. On slopes 3:1 or steeper, and as required, a geotextile fabric shall be installed per manufacturer's specifications prior to placing sod. The sod shall be fastened in place with suitable wooden pins or by other approved method. 902-2.3.2.5. SEEDING A. Seed shall be installed per the specifications of the State of Florida Department of Transportation. See plan for type of seed. 902-2.3.2.6. TREE GUYING, BRACING AND STAKING A. Use the latest edition of the Staking Details from the Urban Tree Foundation (http://urbantree.org/details staking.shtml). Submit to the city Project Manager for approval. B. Contractor shall remove all tree guying, staking, and bracing from trees 1 year after the date of final acceptance of the landscape work. 902-2.3.2.7. MULCHING A. All planting beds shall be weed -free prior to mulching. B. All plant beds and tree rings shall be mulched evenly with a three inch (3") layer (before compaction) of 1.5" round pine bark nuggets or brown shredded hard wood mulch, or other mulch as specified on the Plans or General Notes. Submit to the city Project Manager for approval. C. Mulch shall not be placed against the trunks of plant materials or foundations of buildings. Maintain a minimum six-inch (6") clearance for trees and shrub trunks and a minimum six-inch (6") clearance for the walls of buildings. 902-2.3.2.8. CLEAN-UP A. During landscape work, store materials and equipment where directed by the city. B. The Contractor shall promptly remove any materials and equipment used on the job, keeping the area neat at all times. Upon completion of all planting, dispose of all excess soil and debris leaving pavements and work areas in safe and orderly condition. C. The clean-up of the site shall include the removal and proper disposal of the tree guying, staking, and bracing materials as described in specifications. No pruning should be done by the contractor, but can be done by the landscape contractor. • • SECTION IV Page 164 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications 902-2.3.2.9. PROTECTION A. The Contractor shall provide safeguards for the protection of workmen and others on, about, or adjacent to the work, as required under the parameters of the Occupational Safety and Health Administration (OSHA) standards. B. The Contractor shall protect the city's and adjacent property from damage. C. The Contractor shall protect the landscape work and materials from damage due to landscape operations. Maintain protection during installation and maintenance periods. D. The Contractor shall provide protection (tree barricades) for all existing trees and palms as specified. 902-2.3.2.10. REPAIR OF DAMAGES A. The Contractor shall repair all damage caused by their operations to other materials, property, or trades to a level equal in quality to the existing condition prior to damage. B. The Contractor shall be held responsible for all damage done by their work or employees to other materials or trades' work. Patching and replacement of damaged work may be done by others, at the city's direction, but the cost of same shall be paid by the Contractor who is responsible for the damage. 902-2.3.3. MAINTENANCE A. The Contractor shall maintain all plant materials in a first-class condition from the beginning of landscape construction until Final Acceptance. B. Operations: 1. Maintenance shall include, but not be limited to, watering of turf and planting beds, mowing, fertilizing, cultivation, weeding, pruning, disease and pest control, replacement of dead materials, straightening, turf or planter settlement corrections, replacement of rejected materials, staking and guying repair and tightening, wash-out repairs and regrading, and any other procedures consistent with the good horticultural practice necessary to insure normal, vigorous and healthy growth of all work under the Contract. Mowing shall be consistent with the recommended height per the University of Florida Cooperative Extension Service. 2. Within the warranty period, the Contractor shall notify the city of any maintenance practices being followed or omitted which would be detrimental to the healthy, vigorous growth of the landscape. 3. The Contractor shall be responsible for the final watering of not less than one inch (1") of water for all planted materials before leaving the site. 902-2.3.4. INSPECTION, REJECTION, AND ACCEPTANCE 902-2.3.4.1. INSPECTION A. Upon completion of the installation, the Contractor will notify the city or the city's Project Manager that the job is ready for inspection. Within fifteen (15) days of notifications, the installation will be inspected by the Landscape Architect. A written and/or graphic inspection report will be sent to the city and/or Landscape Contractor. 902-2.3.4.2. REJECTION AND REPLACEMENT A. The Landscape Architect shall be final judge as to the suitability and acceptability of any part of the work. Plant material will be rejected if it does not meet the requirements set forth in the Plans and Specifications. B. Replace any rejected materials immediately or within fifteen (15) days and notify the Landscape Architect that the correction has been made. 902-2.3.4.3. ACCEPTANCE A. After replacement of rejected plant material, if any, have been made, and completion of all other correction items, the city or Project Manager will accept the project in writing. SECTION IV Page 165 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 • • SECTION IV —Technical Specifications B. Upon Final Acceptance, the city assumes responsibility for maintenance within the terms of the Contract. Acceptance will in no way invalidate the Contractor's warranty period. C. The Contractor's warranty period will begin after final acceptance of the project by the Owner. 1. If evidence exists of any lien or claim arising out of or in connection with default in performance of this Contract, the city shall have the right to retain any payment sufficient to discharge such claim and all costs in connection with discharging such claim. 2. Where the Specifications call for any stipulated item or an "approved equivalent", or in words to that effect, the Contractor shall indicate the price of the type and species specified in the proposal, giving the price to be added or deducted from their Contract price. The final selection rests with the city or their representative. 3. Where plants installed do not meet specifications, the city reserves the right to request plant replacement or an appropriate deduction from the Contract amount to compensate for the value not received from the under -specified plant materials. No additional compensation will be made to the Contractor for plants installed that exceed specifications. 902-2.3.5. WARRANTY A. The Contractor shall warranty all palms and trees furnished under this contract for a period of one (1) year and all shrubs for a period of six (6) months. Material which is either dead or in poor health during this period or at completion will be replaced at no charge to the city. Should any of the plant materials show 50% or more defoliation during the warranty period, due to the Contractor's use of poor quality or improper materials or workmanship, the Contractor upon notice, shall replace without delay same with no additional cost to the city. Should any plant require replacing, the new plant shall be given the equal amount of warranty. 903. SODDING Unless otherwise noted herein, the Contractor shall place all sod, either shown on the plans or at the direction of the Engineer, in conformance with the latest editions of Sections 575, 981, 982 and 983 of FDOT's Standard Specifications. The area for sod application shall be loosened and excavated to a suitable depth and finished to a grade compatible with existing grass and structures. Sod shall be placed with edges in contact and shall be compacted to uniform finished grade with a sod roller immediately after placement. In sloped areas, the sod shall be graded and placed so as to prohibit erosion and undermining of the adjacent sidewalk. No sod that has been cut for more than seventy-two (72) hours can be used. The city shall be notified in advance by 2 business days and reserves the right to view and inspect the sod before installation. A city Project Manager shall inspect the sod at the site once delivered and will not be allowed to be laid until approved. The sod shall be thoroughly watered immediately after placement. The Contractor shall continue to water sod as needed and/or directed by the Engineer as indicated by sun exposure, soil, heat, and rain conditions, to establish and assure growth, until termination of the contract. Dead sod, or sod not acceptable to the Engineer, shall be removed and replaced by the Contractor at no additional compensation. Any questions concerning the type of existing sod shall be determined by the Engineer. Unless otherwise noted on the plans, payment for sod (including labor, equipment, materials, placement, rolling, watering, etc.) shall be included in other bid items. Payment for these associated bid items may be withheld until the Contractor provides the city a healthy, properly placed stand of grass. When this work is given as a separate bid item, it shall cover all labor, equipment and materials, (including water) required for this work and shall be paid for on the basis of each square foot in place and accepted. No payment for sod shall be made until the Contractor provides the city a healthy, properly placed stand of grass. SECTION IV Page 166 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications 904. SEEDING Seed, or seed and mulch, shall only be used when specified for certain demolition projects. The seed and/or mulch shall be placed as called for on the plans in the following manner. The area to be seeded shall be brought to the required line and grade, fertilized, and seeded in basic conformance with FDOT's Standard Specifications Sections 570, 981, 982 and 983. However, no wildflower seed shall be used, and Argentine Bahia Seed shall be used instead of Pensacola Bahia. No sprigging will be required. Also, the addition of 20 lb. of Rye Seed (to total 60 lb. of seed per acre) will be required during the stated periods. It is also required that the Contractor maintain said seed until growth is assured. When this work is given as a bid item, the item shall cover all labor, material, equipment (including water), required for this work, and shall be paid for on the basis of each square yard in place and accepted. If called for on the plans, but not shown as a bid item, then the cost of such work as stated above shall be included in the cost of other work. 905. LAWN MAINTENANCE SPECIFICATIONS 905-1. SCOPE To remove trash and debris from landscape and paved area; maintenance and fertilization of plant beds and landscape materials; maintenance, repair, and operation of irrigation systems; ornamental pest control; palm pruning; maintenance of traffic; and the cleaning of hard surfaces at designated areas. The Contractor is to work with the city in coordinating maintenance activities and reporting irregularities in the work zone. The Contractor(s) will provide the labor and materials required to maintain the specified landscaped street areas including: • Traffic safety and Maintenance of Traffic. • Trash and debris removal from the job site. • Removal of weeds in landscaped areas and hard surfaces. • Proper trimming and pruning of landscape plants and palms • Proper fertilization and pest control of landscape and palms (may be subcontracted). • Irrigation service and repair. • Mulch replacement. • Cleaning of hard surfaces; and the • Reporting of irregularities at the job site. 905-2. SCHEDULING OF WORK The Contractor(s) shall accomplish all landscape maintenance required under the contract between the hours of 7:00 a.m. and 6:00 p.m. Monday through Saturday, excluding observed holidays. The city may grant, on an individual basis, permission to perform contract maintenance at other hours. All work shall be completed in a continuous manner, such as cleanup, weeding, trimming, etc., be completed before leaving the job site. SECTION IV Page 167 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications • 905-3. WORK METHODS 905-3.1. MAINTENANCE SCHEDULING The Contractor(s) will adhere to a work schedule provided by the city (see Level of Service). Any variations to that schedule, requested by either party, must be approved, either verbally or in writing by an authorized representative of the other party. 905-3.2. DUTIES PER SERVICE VISIT The Contractor(s) shall provide the following service at each scheduled visit to the designated location: 905-3.2.1. LITTER AND DEBRIS Remove trash and debris from the project site. Proper disposal of collected trash and debris is the Contractor's responsibility. Extraordinary amounts of debris caused by hurricanes, tornadoes, vandalism, etc., would be the responsibility of the city to clean up. The Contractor should report such accumulations of debris when they are encountered. Bids for the extraordinary cleanup from the Contractor would be considered. Work sites should be left in a clean and neat appearance upon completion. All debris from pruning process is to be removed from the job site and disposed of by the Contractor. 905-3.2.2. VISUAL CHECK The site should be checked for irregularities, such as irrigation leaks, vehicle damage, dead or damaged plant material, vandalism, etc., which should be reported to the city within twenty-four (24) hours after providing the service. • 905-3.2.3. PLANT TRIMMING AND PALM PRUNING All plant material should be trimmed in a manner that promotes the natural shape and mature size of the particular species. Trimming should be performed at intervals that will maintain plants in a neat appearance. Trimming should be performed to promote fullness of the plants, while maintaining height restrictions in Clear Sight Zones as established on the landscape plans. Plants shall be kept trimmed to the back of curb. Brown foliage shall be removed from Liriope. Palm pruning to be performed at least once per year, preferably in late June or July following flower formation, consistent with the following specification. 1. PHOENIX SPECIES (CANARY DATE, INDIA DATE, PYGMY DATE, ETC.): Remove all descending fronds, to the base of the frond; all parallel and ascending fronds are to remain in order to leave a full, rounded head; seed heads may remain, but remove old faded heads that are encountered in the pruning process; and remove loose frond boots; remove vegetation, such as strangler figs, Brazilian Pepper, Asparagus fem, etc., growing in the frond boots or on the trunk. Provide the rounded, classic cut on all Medjool palm boots. No climbing spikes allowed on palms. 905-3.2.3.1. TRAFFIC CONTROL • Proper and safe work zones in vehicular traffic areas are to be set up and maintained by the Contractor, according to the approved Maintenance of Traffic specifications. 905-3.2.3.2. PEDESTRIAN SAFETY Contractor is responsible for maintaining safe work zones in areas where pedestrian and park users are present. The city reserves the right to limit the hours of operation in certain high pedestrian use areas. SECTION IV Page 168 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications 905-3.2.4. WEED REMOVAL IN LANDSCAPED AREA Weeds should be removed on a regular basis in order to keep them from being visibly noticeable. Weed control with the use of appropriate herbicides is allowable, given they are properly applied by a certified applicator. Herbicide damage to landscape material will be remedied by Contractor at their expense. 905-3.2.5. MULCH CONDITION Should be maintained at a thickness that will discourage weed growth as well as help retain soil moisture, usually three inches (3"). 905-3.2.6. IRRIGATION SERVICE AND REPAIR Should be performed at each visit to assure the system's proper operation and timing. Drip tubing should be kept covered with mulch. Timer should be checked for proper time of day and operating schedule. Leaks or breaks in the system should be repaired before the next scheduled system running time. 905-3.2.7. LAWN AND ORNAMENTAL PEST CONTROL Should be performed by a properly licensed and certified applicator to keep pest populations at a less than damaging level. Landscape materials lost to or extensively damaged by pests will be replaced by the Contractor at the Contractor's expense. Diazinon products are not to be used on city properties. 905-3.2.8. PALM FERTILIZATION Apply three (3) pounds of Magnesium sulfate and one pound of Potassium evenly, per tree, across the root zone (typically within the dripline), annually in early February. 905-3.2.9. FREEZE PROTECTION The city will provide a freeze/frost protection fabric for the Contractor to install over freeze/frost sensitive plants (Lantana and Pentas). The covering material will be stored at a city facility. Contractor will remove the covering material from storage and install over the sensitive plants, securely fastening edges of the material to the ground per manufacturer's directions. The city will furnish metal pins needed for securing fabric to the ground. The city will notify the Contractor one (1) day or twenty-four (24) hours minimum prior to the need to protect plant material. After uses, the Contractor will prepare the fabric for storage and return it to the designated city facility. Protective covering shall be removed the following aftemoon or remain in place as directed by the city. The city shall notify the Contractor by 11:00 a.m. about removing the cover or keeping it in place due to continued freezing temperatures. The city may cancel the freeze protection event at any time prior to the end of the scheduled installation day (5:00 p.m.) The Contractor will be compensated for the number of hours mobilization or on-site work at the contracted rate per man- hour unit price. The Contractor shall provide a unit price for the installation and removal of the covering fabric on a per event basis, as well as an hourly rate per employee required. The city and Contractor will coordinate appropriate irrigation operations with weather conditions. Should freeze/frost damage occur, the Contractor shall perform remedial work as per unit basis, as directed by the city. 906. LEVEL OF SERVICE The Project Site is to be serviced weekly. Repairs to damage or vandalism to be made within seven (7) working days of reported irregularity. Weekly visits should occur no closer than six (6) and no further than ten (10) calendar days apart. SECTION IV Page 169 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications • 907. COMPLETION OF WORK Within twenty-four (24) hours of completing work, notify the city Project Manager either in writing of said completion and request the substantial completion letter. • • 908. INSPECTION AND APPROVAL Upon receiving notification from the Contractor, the city shall inspect the serviced location the following business day. If, upon inspection, the work specified has not been completed, the city shall contact the Contractor to indicate the necessary corrective measures. The Contractor will be given forty-eight (48) hours from this notification to make appropriate corrections. If the work has been completed successfully then the city will pay for services billed. 909. SPECIAL CONDITIONS 1. This location will be newly installed and under warranty by the installer for a twelve (12) month period on plants, trees, and palms. Landscape installer will coordinate irrigation operation with the Maintenance contractor to assure adequate irrigation to the landscape materials. Installer will also be responsible for the untying of palm heads/fronds as they feel appropriate. 2. All listed acreage or square footage figures are estimates. 3. All work shall be performed in a good and workmanlike manner, consistent with trade practices and standards which prevail in the industry. 4. The Contractor shall be responsible for damage to any plant material or site feature caused by the Contractor or their employees. The Contractor shall be notified in writing of the specific nature of the damage and cost of repair. The city shall, at its option, invoice the Contractor for the payment, or reduce by the amount of the repairs on the next regular payment to the Contractor. 5. Occasionally circumstances (standing water, prolonged inclement weather, parked vehicles, etc.) may make all or portions of a location unserviceable during the regular schedule. The Contractor shall notify the city Supervisor of such occurrences and shall schedule to perform the required work to the location as soon as the pertaining circumstances are relieved. 910. TREE PROTECTION 910-1. TREE BARRICADES A. A protective barrier shall be placed around all protected trees and palms prior to land preparation or construction activities within or adjacent to the work zone, including all staging and/or lay down areas. Protective barriers shall be installed as follows: 1. At or greater than the full dripline of all species of Mangroves and Cabbage Palms. 2. At or greater than the full dripline or all protected native pine trees and other conifer species. 3. At or greater than two-thirds (2/3) of the dripline of all other protected species 4. At or greater than the full dripline of trees within a specimen tree stand. B. Protective barriers are to be constructed using no less than two-inch (2") lumber for upright posts. Upright posts are to be at least four feet (4') in length with a minimum of one foot (1') anchored in the ground. Upright posts are to be placed at a maximum distance of eight feet (8') apart. Horizontal rails are to be constructed using no less than one -inch (1") by four -inch (4") lumber and shall be securely attached to the top of the upright post. The city's Project Manager must approve any variation from the above requirements. SECTION IV Page 170 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV — Technical Specifications C. Whenever a protective barrier is required, it shall be in place until all construction activity is terminated. The area within the barrier limits shall remain undisturbed by any activity during construction. Native ground cover and understory vegetation existing within the barriers shall remain throughout construction. Exotic plant species may only be removed by manual labor utilizing hand tools or by other means if authorized in writing by the city's Project Manager D. Prior to the erection of any required protective barrier, all surface foreign material, trash or debris shall be removed from the area enclosed by the barrier, and after erection of the barrier no such material or litter shall be permitted to remain within the protected area. No equipment, chemicals, soil deposits or construction materials shall be placed within such protective barriers. E. No signs, building permits, wires, or other attachments of any kind shall be attached to any protected tree or palm. F. At all times, due care shall be taken to protect the critical root zone of trees protected by this section, and root pruning requirements shall apply to such trees. 910-2. ROOT PRUNING A. Where proposed construction improvements involve excavation and/or impacts to the critical root zone of protected trees, the Contractor shall be required to have an International Society of Arboriculture (ISA) certified arborist perform, or directly supervise root pruning to reduce the impacts of construction. The critical root zone is equivalent to the tree's dripline. Prior to any clearing, grubbing or excavation activities, the affected roots must be severed by clean pruning cuts at the point where grubbing or excavation impacts the root system. Roots can be pruned utilizing specified root pruning equipment designed for that purpose or by hand digging a trench and pruning roots with a pruning saw, chain saw, or other equipment designed for tree pruning. Root pruning by trenching equipment or excavation equipment is strictly prohibited. Roots located in the critical root zone that will be impacted by construction activities shall be pruned to a minimum depth of eighteen inches (18") below existing grade or to the depth of the proposed impact if less than eighteen inches (18") from existing grade. Any questions should be addressed to the city's Project Manager. B. Root pruning shall only be performed by or under the direct supervision of an International Society of Arboriculture (ISA) certified arborist. C. Any proposed root pruning trenches shall be identified on site (i.e. staked or painted) inspected and approved by the city's Project Manager and/or Representative prior to actual root pruning. D. Root pruning shall be performed as far in advance of other construction activities as is feasible, but at a minimum shall be performed prior to ANY impacts to the soil. Associated tree protection measures should be implemented upon completion of said root pruning. E. If there is a likelihood of excessive wind and/or rain exceptional care shall be taken on any root pruning activities. F. Root pruning shall be limited to a minimum of ten inches (10") per one inch (1") of the trunk diameter from the tree base. Any exception must be approved by the city's Project Manager prior to said root pruning. G. Roots shall be cut cleanly, as far from the trunk of the tree as possible. Root pruning shall be done to a minimum depth of eighteen inches (18") from existing grade, or to the depth of the disturbance if less than eighteen inches (18"). H. Root pruning shall be performed using a root cutting machine specifically designed for this purpose. Alternate equipment or techniques must be approved by the city's Project Manager, prior to any work adjacent to trees to be preserved. I. Root pruning shall be completed, inspected, and accepted prior to the commencement of any excavation or other impacts to the critical root zones of trees to be protected. J. Excavations in an area where root are present shall not cause the tearing or ripping of tree roots. Roots must first be cleanly severed prior to continuing with the excavation or tunneled around to prevent damage to the root. SECTION IV Page 171 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 • • • SECTION IV — Technical Specifications K. Tree roots shall not be exposed to drying out. Root ends shall be covered with native soil or burlap and kept moist until final backfill or final grades has been established. L. When deemed appropriate (e.g., during periods of drought) the city Project Manager may require a temporary irrigation system be utilized in the remaining critical root zones of root pruned trees. M. When underground utility lines are to be installed within the critical root zone, the root pruning requirement may be waived if the lines are installed via tunneling or directional boring as opposed to open trenching. 910-3. PROPER TREE PRUNING A. All tree pruning and/or root pruning on existing trees to remain shall only be performed by or under the direct supervision of an International Society of Arboriculture (ISA) certified arborist. Furthermore, all tree work shall conform to the American National Standards Institute (ANSI) 2001, American National Standard for tree care operations — Tree, Shrub, and other Woody Plant Maintenance — Standard practices (pruning) ANSI A-300. B. Proper pruning techniques for all lateral branches of protected trees are required. Flush cuts (pruning cuts that remove the branch collar) and stub cuts (cuts that leave a stub on the tree) are improper techniques. Any protected tree that has been improperly pruned will not be recognized as a tree left on the project in a healthy growing condition and will require replacement consistent with the current City Code of Ordinances and Community Development Code. C. No protected tree shall have more than thirty percent (30%) of its foliage removed. D. No protected tree shall be topped, hat racked, or lion tailed. Any protected tree that has been improperly pruned will not be recognized as a tree left on the project in a healthy growing condition and will require replacement consistent with the current City Code of Ordinances and Community Development Code. E. Tree Trunks and limbs shall be protected. The use of tree spikes or other devices that damage trunk and bark tissue on protected trees shall be prohibited. Any protected tree that has been damaged in such a manner will not be recognized as a tree left on the project in a healthy growing condition and will require replacement consistent with the current City Code of Ordinances and Community Development Code. 911. IRRIGATION SYSTEM DESIGN The requirements for Irrigation System Design are the following: A. The application rate must not exceed the ability of the soil to absorb and retain the water applied during any one application. B. The design operating pressure must not be greater than the available source pressure. C. The design operating pressure must account for peak use times and supply line pressures at final buildout for the entire system. D. Distribution devices and pipes should be designed for optimum uniform coverage. The first and last distribution device should have no more than a 10% difference in flow rate. This usually corresponds to about a 20% difference in pressure. E. "Head to head" placement of sprinklers to achieve 100% coverage. F. Flexibility must exist to meet a site's peak water requirements and allow for the modification of the system's operation to meet seasonal irrigation changes or local restrictions. G. Distribution equipment (such as pop -ups, rotors, bubblers and drip) in a given zone must have the same precipitation rate. H. Turf and landscape areas should be zoned separately based on plant water requirements. Bubblers, drip, rotors and pop -ups will all be on separate zones. I. All water delivery devices (heads, tree bubblers, valves) shall be free of buried obstructions 8-10" below each device to be acceptable. SECTION IV Page 172 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 SECTION IV —Technical Specifications J. Install valves in Turf areas where possible K. Install all irrigation heads at finish grade unless approved by Parks and Rec. before installation. L. The design package should include a general irrigation schedule with recommendations and instructions on modifying the schedule for local climatic and growing conditions. M. If required by plant species, the design should account for the need to leach out salt buildup from poor quality water. N. Water supply systems (such as wells and pipelines) should be designed for varying control devices, and backflow prevention. O. Water conveyance systems should be designed with thrust blocks and air release valves, such that flow velocity is 5 feet per second or less. P. Pipelines should be designed to provide the system with the appropriate pressure required for maximum irrigation uniformity. Q. Pressure regulating or compensating equipment must be used where the system pressure exceeds the manufacturer's recommendations. R. Equipment with check valves must be used in low areas to prevent low head drainage. S. A rain -sensing device must be used to automatically shut off system when raining. T. Non -planted areas, including impervious surfaces should not be irrigated. U. The city of Clearwater, Parks and Beautification must approve irrigation plan before irrigation construction begins. 912. IRRIGATION SYSTEM INSTALLATION The requirements for Irrigation System Installation are the following: A. Only qualified specialists under the direct supervision of a "Certified Irrigation Designer" or a "Certified Irrigation Contractor" should install the irrigation system. Certifications are through "The Irrigation Association". B. The construction must be consistent with the design. C. The designer must approve any design changes before construction. D. Construction and materials should meet existing standards and criteria. E. Mainline — To be laid with tracking wire / tape firmly attached throughout project. Leave 18" of excess cable at terminal ends in 6" round valve boxes. See Parks and Rec Irrigation Spec page for type. F. Sleeve size will be 2 times the diameter of pipe to be sleeved. Example 1.5" feed pipe dia. = 3" sleeve diameter. G. Acceptable safety practices must be followed during construction. H. All underground cables, pipes and other obstacles should be identified, and their locations flagged. I. Obtain all permits before construction. J. Always give the city Engineering and Parks & Recreation Department a copy of the As -Built plans, operating manuals, warranties, and written instructions on how to change the irrigation system's timers/clock/controllers. K. At the end of construction, the site must be cleaned of all construction materials. SECTION IV Page 173 of 173 Updated 6/2/2021 Section IVa SUPPLEMENTAL TECHNICAL SPECIFICATIONS These Supplemental Technical Specifications amend or supplement the Technical Specifications Section IV. All provisions of these Contract Documents that are not so amended or supplemented remain in full force and effect. Table of Contents: Division 01— General Requirements 01010 Summary of Work 01014 Work Sequence 01025 Measurement and Payment 01300 Submittal Procedures 01310 Construction Progress Schedule • 01380 Photographs and Videos 01450 Equipment and System Performance and Operational Testing 01605 Product Storage and Handling Requirements 01710 Final Cleanup 01720 Project Record Documents 01730 Operation and Maintenance Data 01790 Demonstration and Training 01999 Reference Forms Division 02 — Site Work 02050 Demolition 02145 Temporary Sewer Bypassing Division 03 — Concrete 03600 Grout 03900 Concrete Rehabilitation • Division 05 — Metals 05502 Anchors to Concrete Division 09 — Finishes 09900 Coating Systems Division 11— Equipment 11103 FRP Slide Gates 11220 Membrane Disc Diffusers Division 15 — Mechanical 15062 Ductile Iron Pipe 15096 Pipe Hangers and Supports 15110 Eccentric Plug Valves • • • • • • Phillip Michael Walker. Professional Engineer, State of Florida. License No. 83415 Phillip Walker This by Philp Michael Wahas been lker, PE PE signone /0/291202and 1ed 1. Oct 29 2021 9:25 AM Printed copies of this document are not considered signed and sealed and the signature must be verified on any electronic copies. Division 01 — General Requirements 01010 Summary of Work 01014 Work Sequence 01025 Measurement and Payment 01300 Submittal Procedures 01310 Construction Progress Schedule 01380 Photographs and Videos 01450 Equipment and System Performance and Operational Testing 01605 Product Storage and Handling Requirements 01710 Final Cleanup 01720 Project Record Documents 01730 Operation and Maintenance Data 01790 Demonstration and Training 01999 Reference Forms Division 02 — 02050 02145 Division 09 — 09900 Division 11 11103 11220 Division 15 15062 15096 15110 Site Work Demolition Temporary Sewer Bypassing Finishes Coating Systems — Equipment FRP Slide Gates Membrane Disc Diffusers — Mechanical Ductile Iron Pipe Pipe Hangers and Supports Eccentric Plug Valves Adarsh B. Shah, Professional Engineer, State of Florida, License No. 79948 This item has been digitally signed and sealed by Adarsh B. Shah, PE on 10/29/2021, Printed copies of this document are not considered signed and sealed and the signature must be verified on any electronic copies. Division 03 03600 03900 Division 05 — 05502 — Concrete Grout Concrete Rehabilitation Metals Anchors to Concrete Adarsh Shah Oct 29 2021 10:08 AM • • • • SECTION 01010 SUMMARY OF WORK PART 1 - GENERAL 1.01 SCOPE A. This Section describes the project in general and provides an overview of the extent of the work to be performed under this Contract. Detailed requirements and extent of work is stated in the applicable Specification sections. The Contractor shall, except as otherwise specifically stated herein or in any applicable parts of the Contract Documents, provide and pay for all necessary design engineering and construction labor, materials, equipment, tools, and other facilities and services including labor effort required for permitting necessary for proper execution, testing, and completion of the work under this Contract. All work performed under this contract is subject to the completion requirements and milestones outlined in the contract. B. The Work generally includes the following improvements to the Marshall St. Water Reclamation Facility (WRF) Aeration Basins 4-13: replacement of the process control slide gates, the removal of accumulated grit from the bottom of each basins, repair of damages to the diffused air system (inclusive of only the diffusers, connecting piping, and supports), and minor structural repairs as shown on the Drawings. C. Within the Aeration Basins, several existing process control slide gates are inoperable and may be stuck in their current position. At minimum, Aeration Basins 8-11 have the slide gates stuck in the closed position and are therefore effectively offline. The Contractor should also expect leaks around the seals of the existing slide gates and existing weirs. D. On May 2nd, 2019 the City drained Aeration Basin No. 9 to observe the existing condition of the gates, weirs, drain, diffusers, and standing grit. The following observations were made, which are included herein for the Contractor's information: 1. The existing slide gates on the upstream side of Basin 9 were fully closed and successfully holding water, with the exception of minor dripping from the gates. 2. The downstream weir was not holding water and was leaking from the bottom of the weir. 01010-1 Summary of Work December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT 3. The water in Basin No. 9 was drained to the level of the top of the diffusers. No accumulated grit was observed above the level of the top of the diffusers. E. Key Record Drawings and conceptual bypassing information is included in attachments to the specifications. 1.02 SPECIFICATIONS A. The Specifications included in these Contract Documents establish the performance and minimum quality requirements for materials and equipment and the minimum standards for the quality of the workmanship and appearance. Generally, there has been no attempt to separate the Specification sections into groups for the work of separate subcontractors, or for work to be performed by the various trades. Should there be any question as to the interpretation of any particular Specification section or part of Specification section, such question should be directed to the City and City's Representative prior to the submittal of a proposal for the work under this Contract. B. It is the intent of City to obtain a complete, satisfactory set of improvements under this project. Any items of labor, equipment or materials which may be reasonably assumed as necessary to accomplish this end shall be supplied whether or not they are specifically stated herein. 1.03 DESCRIPTION OF WORK A. The Work generally includes the following improvements to the Marshall St. Water Reclamation Facility (WRF) Aeration Basins 4-13: replacement of the process control slide gates, the removal of accumulated grit from the bottom of each basins, repair of damages to the diffused air system (inclusive of only the diffusers, connecting piping, and supports), and minor structural repairs as shown on the Drawings. B. Care must be taken during construction to avoid damaging existing utilities and associated infrastructure within the work area. C. Wastewater bypass operations and coordination with the City or its representative will be required throughout the course of the construction. 1.04 CONSTRUCTION ACTIVITIES A. Contractor shall provide City's Representative a minimum of 14 -calendar days advanced written notice of any requested change in utilities operations or bypass requirements and shall obtain the City's Representative written approval before scheduling this work. 01010-2 Summary of Work December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • • B. No overtime costs shall be incurred by the City due to scheduled nighttime construction activities. The Contractor shall incorporate these activities into its normal operating schedule (i.e. regular 40 -hour work week). PART 2 - PRODUCTS (NOT USED) PART 3 - EXECUTION (NOT USED) END OF SECTION 01010-3 Summary of Work December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT SECTION 01250 MEASUREMENT AND PAYMENT PART 1 - GENERAL 1.01 SCOPE OF WORK A. Unless otherwise specifically stated elsewhere herein, the Contractor shall include in the bid all shop drawing preparation, materials, electrical supply, fuel, lubricants, chemicals, temporary equipment, temporary wiring, and furnish all labor, tools and equipment for performing all activities and operations necessary to complete the work under this contract, and also all in full payment for all loss or damages arising from the nature of work, or from the action of the elements or from unforeseen difficulties which may be encountered during the prosecution of the work until final completion and final acceptance by the City. Any material considered not suitable shall be immediately replaced by the Contractor with suitable material and no extra compensation will be allowed. B. Payment for all work completed under this Contract shall be made in accordance with the provisions of the General Conditions on the basis of the specific provisions of this section of the Specifications. C. The format for Payment Requests shall be as directed by the Owner's Representative. This shall include the level of breakdown and grouping of payment items. D. All work shall be in accordance with the Technical Specifications. E. Except where specifically indicated for payment in the following Pay Item descriptions, no separate payment will be made for the following items and the cost of such work, as needed, shall be included in the applicable contract pay items of work. 1. Excavation, including necessary pavement/slab removal; 2. Dewatering and disposal of surplus water including well point dewatering as required by the specifications or as directed by the Owner's Representative; 3. Backfill; 4. Grading; 01250-1 Measurement and Payment December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • • • • 5. Temporary facilities and controls during construction such as water/sanitary facilities, and environmental protection, unless specifically provided for in a pay item; 6. Cleanup; 7. Metered potable water in locations where reclaimed water is available from the City, there will be no charge for reclaimed water used; 8. Any material or equipment required, installed and/or used for the tests; 9. Maintaining the existing quality of service during construction; 10. Repair and/or cleaning of storm sewers, inlets & catch basins damaged or filled with sediment during construction; 11. Repair of damaged utility lines (gas, sewer, water, communications, or other); 12. Color photographs and audio/video construction record; 13. Providing the services of an independent testing laboratory for materials and compaction testing, and testing as required by the specifications; 14. Cost to reproduce drawings, specifications, shop drawings, and reports for the Contractor's use and for submissions to the City; 15. Temporary fencing; 16. Dust Control; 17. Noise suppression measures; 18. Utility locating by SUE or other methods of location; 19. Bracing/support of utility poles as required by the Owner; 20. All other appurtenant work as required for a complete and operable system. 1.02 MEASUREMENT All labor, materials and work performed for permitting and construction of the Work shall be included in the aggregate price entered in the Proposal for each bid item, except for unit price items. Payment of unit price items shall be determined by multiplying the unit price by the actual measurements of the completed items, in place, ready for service and accepted by City. 01250-2 Measurement and Payment December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT 1.03 PAYMENT ITEMS A. GENERAL Progress payments will be made monthly, by the City, as specified in the General Conditions. Each application for payment shall be submitted with a copy of "As - Built" drawings, to date, as well as an updated schedule for the project. It is the intent of the City to obtain in the Bidder's Proposal, at the time of bid, a complete price for all work shown or reasonably inferred from the Drawings and Specifications. B. NONPAYMENT FOR REJECTED OR UNUSED PRODUCTS Payment will not be made for following: 1. Disposal and replacement of rejected material. 2. Quantities of material wasted or disposed of in a manner not specified in the Contract Documents. 3. Defective Work not accepted by the City. 4. Material remaining on hand after completion of Work. C. PARTIAL PAYMENT FOR INSTALLED ITEMS PRIOR TO ACCEPTANCE Full payment for unit price items shall not be made until the item has been fully inspected and Contractor as-builts reviewed and approved. 1.04 RETAINAGE A. A ten -percent (10%) retainage shall initially be withheld on all monthly progress payments as defined in the Agreement. 1.05 FINAL APPLICATION FOR PAYMENT A. Final payment shall be subject to the conditions and requirements included in the General Conditions and all others included in the Contract. PART 2 - PRODUCTS (NOT USED) 01250-3 Measurement and Payment December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • • • PART 3 — EXECUTION 3.01 MOBILIZATION AND DEMOBILIZATION - Bid Item No. 1 1. Measurement: Measurement for payment of mobilization costs shall be on a lump sum basis, but the cost shall not exceed five percent (5%) of the proposed Total Contract Price. 2. Payment: Payment for Mobilization shall be full compensation for all costs associated with initiating the project shall include the obtaining of all permits, insurance, and bonds; moving to the site of all materials and equipment; equipment and material storage; furnishing and installing all materials as required for the proper performance and completion of the WORK, including demobilization. Payment for mobilization will be made on an incremental basis in accordance with the following: Percent of Contract Amount Earned Allowable Percent of the Lump Sum Price for Mobilization and Demobilization 5 40 50 75 70 90 100 100 3.02 PROCESS CONTROL GATES - Bid Item No. 2 1. Measurement: Measurement for payment for furnishing and installing process control gates shall be on a per each unit basis. 2. Payment: Payment for the installation of the process control gates shall be full compensation for performing all necessary labor, materials, equipment, transportation, and other work shown on the Drawings, including but not limited to submittals; manufacturer engineering; demolition of the existing slide gates, repair of existing concrete walls to prepare them for new gate anchorage; slide gate mechanical actuator; handheld valve operator; repair and/or replacement of existing equipment damaged during construction; and all materials, labor, tools, appurtenances and supervision necessary for the proper completion of the Work included in the Contract Documents. 01250-4 Measurement and Payment December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT 3.03 DRAINAGE PIPING - Bid Item No. 3 1. Measurement: Measurement for payment for furnishing and installing drainage piping by open cut method of construction shall be made on a lump sum basis. Percentage complete will be calculated based upon progress of construction of associated individual items in accordance with the breakdown in the approved schedule of values. 2. Payment: Payment for the installation of the drainage piping shall be full compensation for performing all necessary labor, materials, equipment, transportation, and other work shown on the Drawings and in strict accordance with the appropriate specifications including but not limited to submittals; shop testing; pipe materials, fittings and glands, restrained joints and appurtenances to restrain the pipe, gaskets, bolts and appurtenances; valves, coatings, valve box, identification tag, concrete valve pad, riser; bedding materials; marking tape; the location and protection of existing utilities; poly -wrap; the repair and/or replacement of all existing utilities damaged during construction; re -grading; temporary pavement as necessary; surface restoration (including, but not limited to, sod, and asphalt replacement not specifically included in other pay items herein); connections to existing utilities; disposal of waste materials, surplus fill and construction debris; infiltration/exfiltration or air testing; and the furnishing of all tools, equipment, labor, supervision, and materials necessary to construct the pipelines, specified or required for the proper completion of the work included in the Contract Documents; as shown on the Drawings; and as specified herein. Full payment shall only be made for pipe for which testing has been completed and record drawings approved. 3.04 STRUCTURAL PATCH REPAIRS - Bid Item No. 4 1. Measurement: Measurement for payment of structural patch repair costs shall be on a per square foot patched basis. 2. Payment: Payment of the unit price bid shall be made based on the verified number of patches repaired at the time of the pay application. Costs include all labor and materials associated with patch repairs. Each repair location shall show no signs of leakage after seven (7) calendar days prior to payment. 3.05 CRACK REPAIR/T-BEAM REPAIRS - Bid Item No. 5 1. Measurement: Measurement for payment of crack repair/T-Beam Repairs costs shall be on a per linear foot of crack basis. 2. Payment: Payment of the unit price bid shall be made based on the verified length of crack repaired at the time of the pay application. Costs include all labor and materials associated with concrete crack repairs. 01250-5 Measurement and Payment December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • • • 3.06 MEMBRANE DISC DIFFUSER REPLACEMENT - Bid Item No. 6 1. Measurement: Measurement for payment for the replacement of membrane disc diffusers shall be on a per each basis. 2. Payment: Payment of the unit price bid shall be made based on the quantity of diffusers replaced at the time of the pay application. Upon drainage of the aeration basins, the Contractor shall identify membrane diffuser and retainer ring assemblies that require repair and/or replacement and meet with the City's Representative to confirm quantities for each basin prior to repair/replacement. Costs include all labor and materials associated with replacing damaged air piping diffusers. 3.07 AIR PIPING AND APPURTENANCES REPLACEMENT - Bid Item No. 7 1. Measurement: Measurement for payment for the replacement of air piping shall be on a per linear foot basis. 2. Payment: Payment of the unit price bid shall be made based on the linear feet of air distribution pipe replaced at the time of the pay application. Upon drainage of the aeration basins, the Contractor shall identify air piping and fittings that require repair and/or replacement and meet with the City's Representative to confirm quantities for each basin prior to repair/replacement. Costs include all labor and materials associated with replacing damaged air piping and fittings. 3.08 AIR PIPING SUPPORT REPLACEMENT - Bid Item No. 8 1. Measurement: Measurement for payment for the replacement of air piping supports shall be on a per each basis. 2. Payment: Payment of the unit price bid shall be made based on the quantity of air piping supports replaced at the time of the pay application. Upon drainage of the aeration basins, the Contractor shall identify air piping and fittings that require repair and/or replacement and meet with the City's Representative to confirm quantities for each basin prior to repair/replacement. Costs include all labor and materials associated with replacing damaged air piping supports. 3.09 GRIT REMOVAL - Bid Item No. 9 1. Measurement: Measurement for payment for grit removal costs shall be on a per cubic yard removed basis. 2. Payment: Payment of the unit price bid shall be made based on the cubic yards of grit removed, decanted, and deposited in an on-site City -Owned receptacle to be coordinated during the pre -construction meeting. Costs include all labor and materials associated with removing accumulated grit, decanting the grit to remove excess water, and delivery to an on-site City -Owned receptacle. 01250-6 Measurement and Payment December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT 3.10 BYPASS PUMPING - Bid Item No. 10 1. Measurement: Measurement for payment for bypass pumping costs shall be on a lump sum basis. Percentage complete will be calculated based upon progress of construction of associated individual items in accordance with the breakdown in the approved schedule of values. 2. Payment: Payment for bypass pumping shall be full compensation for performing all necessary labor, materials, equipment, transportation, and other work shown on the Drawings and in strict accordance with the appropriate specifications including but not limited to submittals; shop testing; bypass pumps and associated equipment; fuel; pipe materials, fittings and glands, gaskets, valves, the location and protection of existing utilities; the repair and/or replacement of all existing utilities damaged during construction; surface restoration (including, but not limited to, sod, and asphalt replacement as required to repair areas damaged by bypass pumping operations not specifically included in other pay items herein); disposal of waste materials, and the furnishing of all tools, equipment, labor, supervision, and materials necessary to conduct bypass pumping operations, specified or required for the proper completion of the work included in the Contract Documents; as shown on the Drawings; and as specified herein. 3.11 OWNER'S CONTINGENCY (10%) - Bid Item No. 11 1. Measurement and Payment: Owner's contingency will be a lump sum of 10% of the Construction Subtotal to be used at the City's discretion to allocate funds for unanticipated costs associated with this project. Approved contingency requests will require submission of justifiable cost and materials. END OF SECTION 01250-7 Measurement and Payment December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • • • • • SECTION 01300 SUBMITTAL PROCEDURES PART 1 - GENERAL 1.01 SUBMITTALS A. Submittals covered by these requirements include manufacturers' information, shop drawings, test procedures, test results, samples, requests for substitutions, and miscellaneous work-related submittals. Submittals shall also include, but not be limited to, all mechanical, electrical and electronic equipment and systems, materials, reinforcing steel, fabricated items, and piping and conduit details. The Contractor shall furnish all drawings, specifications, descriptive data, certificates, samples, tests, methods, schedules, and manufacturer's installation and other instructions as specifically required in the contract documents to demonstrate fully that the materials and equipment to be furnished and the methods of work comply with the provisions and intent of the contract documents. 1.02 CONTRACTOR'S RESPONSIBILITIES A. GENERAL 1. The Contractor shall be responsible for the accuracy and completeness of the information contained in each submittal and shall assure that the material, equipment or method of work shall be as described in the submittal. The Contractor shall verify that all features of all products conform to the specified requirements. Submittal documents shall be clearly edited to indicate only those items, models, or series of equipment, which are being submitted for review. All extraneous materials shall be crossed out or otherwise obliterated. The Contractor shall ensure that there is no conflict with other submittals and notify the Construction Manager in each case where his submittal may affect the work of another contractor or the Owner. 2. The Contractor shall coordinate submittals with the work so that work will not be delayed. He shall coordinate and schedule different categories of submittals, so that one will not be delayed for lack of coordination with another. No extension of time will be allowed because of failure to properly schedule submittals. The Contractor shall not proceed with work related to a submittal until the submittal process is complete. This requires that submittals for review and comment shall be returned to the Contractor stamped "No Exceptions Taken" or "Make Corrections Noted." 01300-1 Submittal Procedures December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT 3. The Contractor shall certify on each submittal document that he has reviewed the submittal, verified field conditions, and complied with the contract documents. 4. The Contractor may authorize in writing a material or equipment supplier to deal directly with the Construction Manager or with the Owner with regard to a submittal. These dealings shall be limited to contract interpretations to clarify and expedite the work. 1.03 CATEGORIES OF SUBMITTALS A. GENERAL 1. Submittals fall into three general categories; a. Action Submittals - Action Submittals require review and response by the Engineer before the Contractor proceeds with incorporating the equipment, materials, or procedure addressed in a submittal into the work. Review comments for Action Submittals, and the subsequent actions of the Contractor based on the review comments, shall conform to REVIEW ACTION requirements specified in this section. b. Informational Submittals- Informational Submittals are examined to verify that the information has been furnished as specified. If the information has not been furnished as specified the submittal will be returned marked "MAKE CORRECTIONS NOTED" and any deficiencies will be noted. If the information has been furnished as specified the submittal will be returned marked "RECEIPT ACKNOWLEDGED". CSI's informational submittals are similar to what BC formerly called PRODUCT DATA. Note: BC Testing Requirements can be either Action or Information Submittals. c. Closeout Submittals — Closeout Submittals consist of documentation that is not available for review at the time Action Submittals are submitted for review or documentation that is typically generated or furnished following incorporation of the equipment, materials, or procedure into the work. Closeout submittals include spare parts inventory listing, spare parts, extra stock materials, special tools and other materials or components that are furnished separate from the installed and completed work. Closeout Submittals require review and response by the Engineer. Closeout Submittal requirements are not satisfied until they have been reviewed and returned marked "NO EXCEPTIONS TAKEN" or "MAKE CORRECTIONS NOTED". BC places Record Drawings and O&M submittals and Spare Parts within the 01300-2 Submittal Procedures December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • t • • CLOSEOUT SUBMITTAL category. This is a change as BC used to include Spare Parts in Part 3. 2. At the beginning of work, the Construction Manager will furnish the Contractor lists of those submittals specified in the project manual. Two separate lists will be provided: submittals for review and comment and product data (submittals) for information only. B. SUBMITTALS FOR REVIEW AND COMMENT: 1. All submittals except where specified to be submitted as product data for information only shall be submitted by the Contractor to the Construction Manager for review and comment. C. SUBMITTALS (PRODUCT DATA) FOR INFORMATION ONLY: 1. Where specified, the Contractor shall furnish submittals (product data) to the Construction Manager for Information only. Submittal requirements for operation and maintenance manuals, which are included in this category, are specified in Section 01730. 1.04 TRANSMITTAL PROCEDURE A. GENERAL: 1. A separate form shall be used for each specific item, class of material, equipment, and items specified in separate, discrete sections, for which the submittal is required. Submittal documents common to more than one piece of equipment shall be identified with all the appropriate equipment numbers. Submittals for various items shall be made with a single form when the items taken together constitute a manufacturer's package or are so functionally related that expediency indicates checking or review of the group or package as a whole. 2. A unique number, sequentially assigned, shall be noted on the transmittal form accompanying each item submitted. Original submittal numbers shall have the following format: "XXX"; where "XXX" is the sequential number assigned by the Contractor. Resubmittals shall have the following format: "XXX -Y"; where "XXX" is the originally assigned submittal number and "Y" is a sequential letter assigned for resubmittals, i.e., A, B, or C being the 1st, 2nd, and 3rd resubmittals, respectively. Submittal 25B, for example, is the second resubmittal of submittal 25. B. DEVIATION FROM CONTRACT: 01300-3 Submittal Procedures December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT 1. If the Contractor proposes to provide material, equipment, or method of work which deviates from the project manual, he shall indicate so under "deviations" on the transmittal form accompanying the submittal copies. C. SUBMITTAL COMPLETENESS: 1. Submittals which do not have all the information required to be submitted, including deviations, are not acceptable and will be returned without review. 1.05 REVIEW PROCEDURE A. GENERAL: 1. Submittals are specified for those features and characteristics of materials, equipment, and methods of operation which can be selected based on the Contractor's judgment of their conformance to the specified requirements. Other features and characteristics are specified in a manner which enables the Contractor to determine acceptable options without submittals. The review procedure is based on the Contractor's guarantee that all features and characteristics not requiring submittals conform as specified. Review shall not extend to means, methods, techniques, sequences or procedures of construction, or to verifying quantities, dimensions, weights or gages, or fabrication processes (except where specifically indicated or required by the project manual) or to safety precautions or programs incident thereto. Review of a separate item, as such, will not indicate approval of the assembly in which the item functions. 2. When the contract documents require a submittal, the Contractor shall submit the specified information as follows: a. (1) one copy of all submitted information plus one reproducible original of all information shall be transmitted with submittals for review and comment. b. Unless otherwise specified, one copy of all submitted information shall be transmitted with submittals (Product Data) for information only. B. SUBMITTALS FOR REVIEW AND COMMENT: 1. Unless otherwise specified, within (21) calendar days after receipt of a submittal for review and comment, the Construction Manager shall review the submittal and return 1 copy of the marked -up reproducible original noted in 1 above. The reproducible original will be retained by the Construction Manager. The returned submittal shall indicate one of the following actions: 01300-4 Submittal Procedures December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • a. If the review indicates that the material, equipment or work method complies with the project manual, submittal copies will be marked "NO EXCEPTIONS TAKEN." In this event, the Contractor may begin to implement the work method or incorporate the material or equipment covered by the submittal. b. If the review indicates limited corrections are required, copies will be marked "MAKE CORRECTIONS NOTED." The Contractor may begin implementing the work method or incorporating the material and equipment covered by the submittal in accordance with the noted corrections. Where submittal information will be incorporated in O&M data, a corrected copy shall be provided. c. If the review reveals that the submittal is insufficient or contains incorrect data, copies will be marked "AMEND AND RESUBMIT." Except at his own risk, the Contractor shall not undertake work covered by this submittal until it has been revised, resubmitted and returned marked either "NO EXCEPTIONS TAKEN" or "MAKE CORRECTIONS NOTED." d. If the review indicates that the material, equipment, or work method does not comply with the project manual, copies of the submittal will be marked "REJECTED - SEE REMARKS." Submittals with deviations which have not been identified clearly may be rejected. Except at his own risk, the Contractor shall not undertake the work covered by such submittals until a new submittal is made and returned marked either "NO EXCEPTIONS TAKEN" or "MAKE CORRECTIONS NOTED." C. Submittals (product data) for information only: 1. Such information is not subject to submittal review procedures and shall be provided as part of the work under this contract and its acceptability determined under normal inspection procedures. 1.06 EFFECT OF REVIEW OF CONTRACTOR'S SUBMITTALS: 1. General: 2. Review of contract drawings, methods of work, or information regarding materials or equipment the Contractor proposes to provide, shall not relieve the Contractor of his responsibility for errors therein and shall not be regarded as an assumption of risks or liability by the Construction Manager or the Owner, or by any officer or employee thereof, and the Contractor shall have no claim under the contract on account of the failure, or partial failure, of the method of work, material, or equipment so reviewed. A mark of "NO EXCEPTIONS TAKEN" or "MAKE 01300-5 Submittal Procedures December 2020 Marshall St WIRE Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT CORRECTIONS NOTED" shall mean that the Owner has no objection to the Contractor, upon his own responsibility, using the plan or method of work proposed, or providing the materials or equipment proposed. END OF SECTION 01300-6 Submittal Procedures December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • • SECTION 01310 CONSTRUCTION PROGRESS SCHEDULE PART 1 - GENERAL 1.01 SCOPE A. This section specifies the procedures for preparing and revising the critical path method construction schedule used for planning and managing construction activities. The schedule provides a basis for determining the progress status of the project relative to specific dates and completion time. 1.02 DESCRIPTION A. The Contractor shall provide a graphic construction schedule prepared by the critical path method of analysis. The critical path schedule shall be prepared from estimates of the required duration and sequence for each item of work and function to be performed. A general guide for preparing such a schedule is contained in "The Use of CPM in Construction, A Manual for Contractors," published by the Associated General Contractors of America. B. Tabulation and analysis of the work schedule shall be performed by computer using a commercially available critical path software program. C. In addition to the capability to produce tabular reports, the computer software shall plot the construction schedule after the Contractor has produced it in a draft form as required by paragraph 1.03 Submittal Procedures. D. The schedule shall depict all significant construction activities and all items of work listed in the breakdown of contract prices submitted by the Contractor in accordance with the General Conditions of the Contract Documents. The dependencies between activities shall be indicated so that it may be established what effect the progress of any one activity has on the schedule. E. No activity on the schedule shall have a duration longer than 21 days or assigned value greater than $100,000, except activities comprising only fabrication, and delivery may extend for more than 21 days. Activities which exceed these limits shall be divided into more detailed components. The schedule duration of each activity shall be based on the work being performed during the normal 40 -hour workweek with allowances made for legal holidays and normal weather conditions. • 1.03 SUBMITTAL PROCEDURES 01310-1 Construction Progress and Schedule December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT A. Within 20 days after the date of Notice to Proceed, the Contractor shall complete a construction schedule conforming to paragraph 1.02 Description and representing in detail all planned procurement and on-site construction activities. The schedule shall be prepared on reproducible paper and may be in draft form with legible freehand lines and lettering. Upon completion of the schedule, the Contractor shall submit the original and two copies to the Construction Manager in accordance with Section 01300. B. Within 7 days after receipt of the submittal, the Construction Manager shall review the submitted schedule and return one copy of the marked -up original to the Contractor. If the Construction Manager finds that the submitted schedule does not comply with specified requirements, the corrective revisions will be noted on the submittal copy, returned to the Contractor for corrections and resubmitted as specified in Section 01300. 1.04 SCHEDULE REVISIONS A. Revisions to the accepted critical path construction schedule may be made only with written approval of the Contractor and Owner. Changes in timing for activities which are not on the critical path may be modified with written agreement of the Contractor and Onwer. A change affecting the contract value of any activity, the timing of any activity on the critical path, the completion time and specific dates as specified in the Contract Documents, and work sequencing (Section 01014) may be made only in accordance with applicable provisions of the General Conditions of the Contract Documents. 1.05 PROJECT STATUS UPDATE A. Project status review and update shall be provided each month as specified in the General Conditions of the Contract Documents. END OF SECTION 01310-2 Construction Progress and Schedule December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • • SECTION 01380 PHOTOGRAPHS AND VIDEO PART 1 - GENERAL 1.01 DESCRIPTION The City requires photographs and color video/audio DVDs to provide a comprehensive record to document conditions prior to construction as well as during construction. The photographs and video/audio DVDs are intended for use as documentation of pre - construction conditions and in ascertaining the extent of any damage that may have occurred as a result of the Contractor's operations, and are for the protection of the City and the Contractor. They shall be a means of determining whether, and to what extent, damage occurred during or after the execution of the Contract work. 1.02 SCOPE OF WORK A. Furnish all labor, materials, equipment and furnish high quality color audio/video DVD recording of the Project site surface pre -construction conditions as specified herein including entire area of aeration basins 4 - 13. The photographs shall be submitted and organized electronically in folders (titled by the segments of work. The files shall indicate the date, name of the work, and the location prior to commencement of construction. No construction shall start until pre -construction audio/video DVD recording and photography is complete. B. Furnish to the City one original and one copy of a continuous high quality color audio/video DVD recording of surface conditions both within, and 100 ft. outside, the Limits of Construction, as shown on the Drawings. The recording(s) shall be taken prior to any construction activity. Still digital photos of critical items such as existing deficiencies in roadways, buildings, or landscaped areas shall also be made a part of the DVD recording. C. The City and City's Representatives reserve the right to reject the audio/video DVD recording because of poor quality, unintelligible audio, or uncontrolled pan or zoom. Any DVD recording rejected by the City and Engineer shall be re-recorded at no additional cost to the City. Under no circumstance shall construction begin until the City has received and accepted the audio/video DVD(s). Video and Photos DVD will include date/time stamps. Time must be accurate and continuously displayed on the video record. D. A qualified, established audio/video DVD recording and photography firm knowledgeable in construction practices and experienced in audio/video DVD and photography recording of construction projects shall perform the recording. If requested, the videographer shall provide examples of work and/or references. 01380-1 Photograph and Video December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT PART 2 PRODUCTS 2.01 PRODUCTS A. Digital video and photographs shall be in color. Photographs shall have a minimum 10 Megapixel resolution. Digital photos shall be JPEG (*.jpg) format. Cell phone cameras shall not be used for photographs. Construction video shall be in high definition (HD), minimum of 720P. B. Provide two copies of digital photographs and video on two separate DVDs. C. Provide photographs and video before construction. Provide photographs during and after construction. D. Views and Quantities Required: A minimum of 50 photographs clearly showing project status and key elements of construction is required each month. E. Deliver electronic images to the City's Representative within 5 business days of request. PART 3 EXECUTION 3.01 PRE -CONSTRUCTION AUDIO/VIDEO AND PHOTOGRAPHS A. Audio/video and photographs DVD storage devices shall be commercial grade DVD -R 9.4 GB double -sided, single -layer storage devices, at minimum. Properly identify all storage devices (DVDs and cases) by DVD number, location, project name, property owner name, and other information that City deems appropriate. The photographs shall be organized electronically in folders. The files shall indicate the date, name of work, and the location where the photograph was taken. B. A record of the contents of each DVD, including audible video files and still photos, shall be supplied by a run sheet identifying each segment in the recording location, including the roll number, recording start- and stop -times, point starting from, traveling direction, and ending destination point. C. Furnish a continuous high quality color audio/video DVD recording of existing surface conditions within a minimum of 100 ft. beyond the Limits of Construction shown on the Drawings. Conduct the DVD recording prior to beginning construction activities. D. All recording will be done during daylight hours. No recording shall be performed if weather is not acceptable, such as rain, fog, etc. 01380-2 Photograph and Video December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • E. It is the intent of this coverage to accurately and clearly document and define pre- existing, post -construction, and/or during construction conditions to minimize the potential for construction claims. Physically mark the excavation areas with highly visible fluorescent paint prior to audio/video DVD recording. The markings shall include stationing information. F. Each DVD shall begin with a verbal description of the current date, the City's name, Project or Contract name and number, Contractor's name, and location information such as street name, segments of work, station number, direction of travel, viewing side, etc. Translucent information must appear on the video recording's viewing screen. This information will consist of the date and time of the recording. The date information must contain the month, day, and year of the recording. The audio shall be captured with a separate microphone to minimize ambient noises. G. Video system shall have capability of producing hard copy prints of selected individual still frames. H. Audio shall be recorded at the same time as the video recording and provide the same information as on the video log sheet. Special commentary will be given for unusual conditions of buildings, sidewalks and curbing, foundations, trees and shrubbery, etc. • I. All recording shall be performed by a videographer accompanied by the City and reviewed prior to construction. J. All DVDs and cases shall bear labels with the following information: 1. DVD Number 2. City's Name 3. Date of Recording 4. Project Name and Number 5. Location of Recording/Segment of Work K. All original DVDs, plus one (1) duplicate of each, shall be provided to the City. The Contractor may keep a copy for his/her own records. 3.04 DURING AND POST CONSTRUCTION DIGITAL PHOTO REQUIREMENTS A. Photographs shall be from locations to illustrate the condition of construction and the state of progress adequately. 01380-3 Photograph and Video December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT B. The Contractor shall provide before and after photographs of each portion of the site. The below -ground facilities shall include all equipment, walls, floor, piping, supports, and entrance. At major location photographs shall include before, during, and after photographs. C. Catalog and manage Electronic "snap -shots" and images of photographs in a secure digital photo management system capable of being linked to the project schedule and document management database. Add captions, descriptions, and key words. Transfer a copy of all "snap -shots" and photos with their related notes, keywords, captions, and activity IDs to the Engineer weekly and also with the monthly pay application. Of particular interest are unexpected subsurface conditions, utility conflicts and unique installations required due to field conditions. END OF SECTION 01380-4 Photograph and Video December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • SECTION 01450 EQUIPMENT AND SYSTEM PERFORMANCE AND OPERATIONAL TESTING PART 1 - GENERAL 1.01 DESCRIPTION A. This section contains requirements for the Contractor's performance in documenting testing work required under this contract. In addition, this section contains requirements the for the Contractor's performance during installed performance testing of all mechanical, electrical, and instrumentation, equipment and systems, provided under this contract and all equipment furnished by the Owner. This section supplements but does not supersede specific testing requirements found elsewhere in this project manual. 1.02 SUBMITTALS A. Submittal material, to be submitted in accordance with Section 01300, shall consist of the following: 1. A complete description of the Contractor's plan for documenting the results from the test program in conformance with the requirements of paragraph 2.02 Documentation Plans, including: 2. Sample forms for documenting the results of field pressure and performance tests. 3. Preoperational check-out procedures, reviewed and approved by the respective equipment manufacturers. 4. Detailed testing plans, setting forth step-by-step descriptions of the procedures proposed by the Contractor for the systematic testing of all equipment and systems installed under this contract. 5. A schedule and subsequent updates, presenting the Contractor's plan for testing the equipment and systems installed under this contract. 6. A schedule establishing the expected time period (calendar dates) when the Contractor plans to commence operational testing of the completed systems, along with a description of the temporary systems and installations planned to allow operational testing to take place. 01450-1 Equipment and System Performance and Operational Testing December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT PART 2 PRODUCTS 2.01 GENERAL A. The Contractor shall prepare test plans and documentation plans as specified in the following paragraphs. The Engineer will not witness any test work for the purpose of acceptance until all test documentation and calibration plans and the specified system or equipment test plans have been submitted and accepted. 2.02 DOCUMENTATION A. Documentation Plans: The Contractor shall develop a records keeping system to document compliance with the requirements of this Section. Calibration documentation shall include identification (by make, manufacturer, model, and serial number) of all test equipment, date of original calibration, subsequent calibrations, calibration method, and test laboratory. Equipment and system documentation shall include date of test, equipment number or system name, nature of test, test objectives, test results, test instruments employed for the test and signature spaces for the Engineer's witness and the Contractor's Project Manager. A separate file shall be established for each system and item of equipment. These files shall include the following information as a minimum: 1. Metallurgical tests 2. Factory performance tests 3. Accelerometer recordings made during shipment 4. Field calibration tests 5. Field pressure tests 6. Field performance tests 7. Field operational tests Section 01999 contains samples showing the format and level of detail required for the documentation forms. The Contractor is advised that these are samples only and are not specific to this project nor to any item of equipment or system to be installed under this contract. The Contractor shall develop test documentation forms specific to each item of equipment and system installed under this contract. Acceptable documentation forms for all systems and items of equipment shall be produced for review by the Engineer as a condition precedent to the Contractor's 01450-2 Equipment and System Performance and Operational Testing December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • receipt of progress payments in excess of 50 percent of the contract amount. Once the Engineer has reviewed and taken no exception to the forms proposed by the Contractor, the Contractor shall produce sufficient forms, at his expense, to provide documentation of all testing work to be conducted as a part of this contract. B. Test Plans: The Contractor shall develop test plans detailing the coordinated, sequential testing of each item of equipment and system installed under this contract. Each test plan shall be specific to the item of equipment or system to be tested. Test plans shall identify by specific equipment or tag number each device or control station to be manipulated or observed during the test procedure and the specific results to be observed or obtained. Test plans shall also be specific as to support systems required to complete the test work, temporary systems required during the test work, subcontractors' and manufacturers' representatives to be present and expected test duration. As a minimum, the test plans shall include the following features: 1. Performance testing of each individual item of mechanical equipment. Performance tests shall be selected to duplicate the operating conditions described in the project manual. 2. System tests designed to duplicate, as closely as possible, operating conditions described in the project manual. 3. Test plans shall contain a complete description of the procedures to be employed to achieve the desired test environment. As a condition precedent to receiving progress payments in excess of 75 percent of the contract amount, or in any event, progress payments due to the Contractor eight weeks in advance of the date the Contractor wishes to begin any testing work (whichever occurs earliest in the project schedule), the Contractor shall have submitted all test plans required for the systematic field performance and operational tests for all equipment and systems installed under this contract. Once the Engineer has reviewed and taken no exception to the Contractor's test plans, the Contractor shall reproduce the plans in sufficient number for the Contractor's purposes and an additional ten copies for delivery to the Engineer. No test work shall begin until the Contractor has delivered the specified number of final test plans to the Engineer. C. Testing Schedule: The Contractor shall produce a testing schedule setting forth the sequence contemplated for performing the test work. The schedule shall be in bar chart form, plotted against calendar time, shall detail the equipment and systems to be tested, and shall be coordinated with the Contractor's construction schedule 01450-3 Equipment and System Performance and Operational Testing December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT specified in Section 01310. The schedule shall show the contemplated start date, duration of the test and completion of each test. The test schedule shall be submitted no later than 4 weeks in advance of the date testing is to begin. The Engineer will not witness any testing work for the purpose of acceptance until the Contractor has submitted a schedule to which the Engineer takes no exception. The test schedule shall be updated weekly, showing actual dates of test work, indicating systems and equipment testing completed satisfactorily and meeting the requirements of this project manual. 2.03 SYSTEM AND EQUIPMENT PERFORMANCE TESTS A. Each item of mechanical equipment installed under this contract shall be tested to demonstrate compliance with the performance requirements of this project manual. Each mechanical and piping system installed or modified under this contract shall be tested in accordance with the requirements of this project manual. 2.04 OPERATIONAL TESTS A. Once all equipment and systems have been tested individually, the Contractor shall fill all systems except wastewater, scum sludge and other wastewater derived systems with the intended process fluids. Wastewater -derived process systems shall be filled with water. After filling operations have been completed, the Contractor shall operate all systems for a continuous period of not less than 5 days, simulating actual operating conditions to the greatest extent possible. The Contractor shall install temporary connections, bulkheads and make other provisions to recirculate process fluids or otherwise simulate anticipated operating conditions. During the operational testing period, the Contractor's Project Manager and testing team shall monitor the characteristics of each machine and system and report any unusual conditions to the Engineer. 2.05 PRODUCT DATA A. Product data, to be provided in accordance with Section 01300, shall be the original and three copies of all records produced during the testing program. 2.06 GENERAL A. The Contractor's quality control manager shall organize teams made up of qualified representatives of equipment suppliers, subcontractors, the Contractor's independent testing laboratory, and others, as appropriate, to efficiently and expeditiously calibrate and test the equipment and systems installed and constructed under this contract. The objective of the testing program shall be to demonstrate, to the Engineer's complete satisfaction, that the structures, systems, and equipment constructed and installed under this contract meet all performance requirements and the facility is ready for the commissioning process to 01450-4 Equipment and System Performance and Operational Testing December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • • commence. In addition, the testing program shall produce baseline operating conditions for the Owner to use in a preventive maintenance program. 2.07 CALIBRATION OF FIXED INSTRUMENTS A. Calibration of analysis instruments, sensors, gages, and meters installed under this contract shall proceed on a system -by -system basis. No equipment or system performance acceptance tests shall be performed until instruments, gages, and meters to be installed in that particular system have been calibrated and the calibration work has been witnessed by the Engineer. B. All analysis instruments, sensors, gages, and meters used for performance testing shall be subject to recalibration to confirm accuracy after completion, but prior to acceptance of each performance test. 2.08 PERFORMANCE TESTS A. Performance tests shall consist of the following: 1. Pressure and/or leakage tests. 2. Piping and individual component testing as described in Division 40. 3. Preoperational checkout for all mechanical equipment. Preoperational check-out procedures shall be reviewed and approved by the respective equipment manufacturers. 4. Initial operation tests of all mechanical equipment and systems to demonstrate compliance with the performance requirements of this project manual. In general, performance tests for any individual system shall be performed in the order listed above. The order may be altered only on the specific written authorization of the Engineer after receipt of a written request, complete with justification of the need for the change in sequence. B. Pressure And Leakage Tests: Pressure and leakage tests shall be conducted in accordance with applicable portions of Division 15. All acceptance tests shall be witnessed by the Engineer. Evidence of successful completion of the pressure and leakage tests shall be the Engineer's signature on the test forms prepared by the Contractor. C. Preoperational Tests: 1. Preoperational tests shall include the following: 2. Alignment of equipment using reverse dial indicator method. 01450-5 Equipment and System Performance and Operational Testing December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT 3. Pre-operation lubrication. 4. Tests per the manufacturers' recommendations for prestart preparation and preoperational check-out procedures. D. Functional Tests: 1. General: Once all affected equipment has been subjected to the required preoperational check-out procedures and the Engineer has witnessed and has not found deficiencies in that portion of the work, individual items of equipment and systems may be started and operated under simulated operating conditions to determine as nearly as possible whether the equipment and systems meet the requirements of these specifications. If available, plant effluent may be employed for the testing of all liquid systems except gaseous, oil, or chemical systems. If not available, potable water shall be employed as the test medium. Test media for these systems shall either be the intended fluid or a compatible substitute. The equipment shall be operated a sufficient period of time to determine machine operating characteristics, including noise, temperatures and vibration; to observe performance characteristics; and to permit initial adjustment of operating controls. When testing requires the availability of auxiliary systems such as looped piping, electrical power, compressed air, control air, or instrumentation which have not yet been placed in service, the Contractor shall provide acceptable substitute sources, capable of meeting the requirements of the machine, device, or system at no additional cost to the Owner. Disposal methods for test media shall be subject to review by the Engineer. During the functional test period, the Contractor shall obtain baseline operating data on all equipment with motors greater than 1 horsepower to include amperage, bearing temperatures, and vibration. The baseline data shall be collected for the Owner to enter in a preventive maintenance system. Test results shall be within the tolerances set forth in the detailed specification sections of this project manual. If no tolerances have been specified, test results shall conform to tolerances established by recognized industry practice. Where, in the case of an otherwise satisfactory functional test, any doubt, dispute, or difference should arise between the Engineer and the Contractor regarding the test results or the methods or equipment used in the performance of such test, then the Engineer may order the test to be repeated. If the repeat test, using such modified methods or equipment as the Engineer may require, confirms the previous test, then all costs in connection with the repeat test will be paid by the Owner. Otherwise, the costs shall be borne by the Contractor. Where the results of any functional test fail to comply with the contract requirements for such test, then such repeat tests as may be necessary to 01450-6 Equipment and System Performance and Operational Testing December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • achieve the contract requirements shall be made by the Contractor at his expense. The Contractor shall provide, at no expense to the Owner, all power, fuel, compressed air supplies, water, and chemicals, all labor, temporary piping, heating, ventilating, and air conditioning for any areas where permanent facilities are not complete and operable at the time of functional tests, and all other items and work required to complete the functional tests. Temporary facilities shall be maintained until permanent systems are in service. 2. Retesting: If under test, any portion of the work should fail to fulfill the contract requirements and is adjusted, altered, renewed, or replaced, tests on that portion when so adjusted, altered, removed, or replaced, together with all other portions of the work as are affected thereby, shall, unless otherwise directed by the Engineer, be repeated within reasonable time and in accordance with the specified conditions. The Contractor shall pay to the Owner all reasonable expenses incurred by the Owner, including the costs of the Engineer, as a result of repeating such tests. 3. Post-test Inspection: Once functional testing has been completed, all machines shall be rechecked for proper alignment and realigned, as required. All equipment shall be checked for loose connections, unusual movement, or other indications of improper operating characteristics. Any deficiencies shall be corrected to the satisfaction of the Engineer. All machines or devices which exhibit unusual or unacceptable operating characteristics shall be disassembled and inspected. Any defects found during the course of the inspection shall be repaired or the specific part or entire equipment item shall be replaced to the complete satisfaction of the Engineer at no cost to the Owner. 2.09 OPERATIONAL TESTS A. The Contractor shall provide system operation testing. After completion of all performance testing and certification by the Engineer that all equipment complies with the requirements of the specifications, the Contractor shall fill all process units and process systems, except those employing domestic water, oil, air, or chemicals, with plant effluent water. All domestic water, oil, air, and chemical systems shall be filled with the specified fluid. B. Upon completion of the filling operations, the Contractor shall circulate water through the completed facility for a period of not less than 48 hours, during which all parts of the system shall be operated as a complete facility at various loading 01450-7 Equipment and System Performance and Operational Testing December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT conditions, as directed by the Engineer. The operational testing period shall commence after this initial period of variable operation. The operational testing period shall be 5 continuous days. Should the operational testing period be halted for any reason related to the facilities constructed or the equipment furnished under this contract, or the Contractor's temporary testing systems, the operational testing program shall be repeated until the specified continuous period has been accomplished without interruption. All process units shall be brought to full operating conditions, including temperature, pressure, and flow. C. As -built documents specified in Section 01730 of facilities involved shall be accepted and ready for turnover to the Owner at the time of operational testing. PART 3 EXECUTION (NOT USED) END OF SECTION 01450-8 Equipment and System Performance and Operational Testing December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • SECTION 01605 PRODUCT STORAGE AND HANDLING REQUIREMENTS PART 1 - GENERAL 1.01 DAMAGE A. Equipment, products and materials shall be shipped, handled, stored, and installed in ways which will prevent damage to the items. Damaged items will not be permitted as part of the work except in cases of minor damage that have been satisfactorily repaired and are acceptable to the Engineer. 1.02 PIPE A. Pipe and appurtenances shall be handled, stored, and installed as recommended by the manufacturer. Pipes with paint, tape coatings, linings or the like shall be stored to protect the coating or lining from physical damage or other deterioration. Pipes shipped with interior bracing shall have the bracing removed only when recommended by the pipe manufacturer. • PART 2 EQUIPMENT • 2.01 PACKAGE AND MARKING A. All equipment shall be protected against damage from moisture, dust, handling, or other cause during transport from manufacturer's premises to site. Each item or package shall be marked with the number unique to the specification reference covering the item. B. Stiffeners shall be used where necessary to maintain shapes and to give rigidity. Parts of equipment shall be delivered in assembled or subassembled units where possible. 2.02 IDENTIFICATION (NOT USED) 2.03 SHIPPING A. Bearing housings, vents and other types of openings shall be wrapped or otherwise sealed to prevent contamination by grit and dirt. 01605-1 Product Storage and Handling Requirements December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT B. Damage shall be corrected to conform to the requirements of the contract before the assembly is incorporated into the work. The Contractor shall bear the costs arising out of dismantling, inspection, repair and reassembly. 2.04 STORAGE A. During the interval between the delivery of equipment to the site and installation, all equipment, unless otherwise specified, shall be stored in an enclosed space affording protection from weather, dust and mechanical damage and providing favorable temperature, humidity and ventilation conditions to ensure against equipment deterioration. Manufacturer's recommendations shall be adhered to in addition to these requirements. B. Equipment and materials to be located outdoors may be stored outdoors if protected against moisture condensation. Equipment shall be stored at least 6 inches above ground. Temporary power shall be provided to energize space heaters or other heat sources for control of moisture condensation. Space heaters or other heat sources shall be energized without disturbing the sealed enclosure. 2.05 PROTECTION OF EQUIPMENT AFTER INSTALLATION A. After installation, all equipment shall be protected from damage from, including but not limited to, dust, abrasive particles, debris and dirt generated by the placement, chipping, sandblasting, cutting, finishing and grinding of new or existing concrete, terrazzo and metal; and from the fumes, particulate matter, and splatter from welding, brazing and painting of new or existing piping and equipment. As a minimum, vacuum cleaning, blowers with filters, protective shieldings, and other dust suppression methods will be required at all times to adequately protect all equipment. During concreting, including finishing, all equipment that may be affected by cement dust must be completely covered. During painting operations, all grease fittings and similar openings shall be covered to prevent the entry of paint. Electrical switchgear, unit substation, and motor load centers shall not be installed until after all concrete work and sandblasting in those areas have been completed and accepted and the ventilation systems installed. END OF SECTION 01605-2 Product Storage and Handling Requirements December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • • • SECTION 01710 FINAL CLEANUP PART 1 - GENERAL 1.01 GENERAL At the completion of work and immediately prior to final inspection, cleaning of the entire project shall be accomplished according to the following provisions: 1. The Contractor shall thoroughly clean, sweep, and wash all work and equipment provided under the Contract. The cleaning shall leave the structures and site in a complete and finished condition to the satisfaction of the City's Representative. 2. Should the Contractor not remove rubbish or debris or not clean the site as specified, the City reserves the right to have the cleaning done at the expense of the Contractor. 3. In preparation for substantial completion, a final inspection of sight -exposed interior and exterior surfaces, shall be conducted. 4. Grease, dust, dirt, stains, labels, and other foreign materials shall be removed from sight -exposed interior and exterior finished surfaces. 5. The Contractor shall dispose of all work materials, including both excess repair product and waste materials, at an off-site location. END OF SECTION 01710-1 Final Cleanup December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT SECTION 01720 PROJECT RECORD DOCUMENTS PART 1 - GENERAL 1.01 REQUIREMENTS INCLUDED A. Maintain at the site for the City one record copy of: 1. Drawings. 2. Specifications. 3. Requests for Information. 4. Work Change Directives, Requests for Cost Proposals. 5. Change Orders and other Modifications to the Contract. 6. Engineer's Field Orders or written instructions. 7. Approved Shop Drawings, Working Drawings and Samples. 8. Detailed Progress Schedule, Monthly Updates. 1.02 MAINTENANCE OF DOCUMENTS AND SAMPLES A. Store documents onsite apart from documents used for construction. 1. Provide files and racks for storage of documents. 2. Provide locked cabinet of secure storage space for storage of samples. B. File documents and samples in accordance with CSI format. C. Maintain documents in a clean, dry, legible condition and in good order. Do not use record documents for construction purposes. D. Make documents available at all times for inspection by the City's Representative. E. As a pre -requisite for monthly progress payments, the Contractor is to exhibit the currently updated "record documents" for review by the City's Representative and City. 1.03 RECORDING A. Label each document "PROJECT RECORD" in neat large printed letters. B. Record information concurrently with construction progress. 1. Do not conceal any work until required information is recorded. C. Drawings: Legibly mark to record actual construction. 01720-1 Project Record Documents December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • D. Specifications and Addenda; legibly mark each Section to record: 1. Manufacturer, trade name, catalog number, and supplier of each product and item of equipment actually installed. 2. Changes made by Field Order or by Change Order. 1.04 AS -BUILT DRAWINGS A. As -built drawings shall be maintained by the Contractor in strict accordance with the specifications herein. B. Payment Applications will not be approved if the As -built drawings are not kept current and will not be approved until the As -built drawings show completely all information required and are current. C. The final Payment Application shall not be accepted by the City until the As -built drawings are approved for conformance to the minimum requirements. The City's acceptance of the Contractor's As -built drawings does not relieve the Contractor of the sole responsibility for the accuracy or completeness of the As - built drawings. D. All deviations shall be highlighted on the As -built drawings using a "cloud". If any revisions to the original plans required a CHANGE ORDER, the "cloud" shall include the CHANGE ORDER number. E. The Contractor shall submit all As -built drawings after review and approval by the City and City's Representative in digital electronic format (PDF) along with one set of marked up drawings. F. The Record Drawings will be submitted in PDF format on the conformed drawings submitted to the Contractor. 1.05 SUBMITTAL A. At contract close-out, deliver Record Documents to the City's Representative for review. B. Contractor Final Record Drawings: (2) Printed full size drawing sets; and a CD with the Original Field Mark-ups in PDF format. C. Accompany submittal with transmittal letter in duplicate, containing: 1. Date. 2. Project title and number. 3. Contractor's name and address. 4. Title and number of each Record Document. 01720-2 Project Record Documents December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT 5. Signature of Contractor or his authorized representative. 1.06 WARRANTIES, GUARANTEES, BONDS, AND CERTIFICATES MANUAL A. The Contractor shall provide all warranties, guarantees, bonds, certificates, and similar documents, including those customarily provided by manufacturers and suppliers. END OF SECTION 01720-3 Project Record Documents December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • SECTION 01730 OPERATIONS AND MAINTENANCE INSTRUCTIONS PART 1 - GENERAL 1.01 SCOPE OF WORK A. Prepare Operations and Maintenance (0 & M) Manuals covering all equipment and systems provided under this Contract. B. Instruct City personnel in the operation and maintenance of equipment provided under this Contract. C. This Section covers the services of the manufacturer's representatives and special coordinating services required of the Contractor that shall apply during construction, facilities startup, and training of City personnel for facilities operation. D. The Contractor shall inform all subcontractors and manufacturers of the requirements herein and include the following services in his costs for the work specified in these Contract Documents. Where a minimum amount of time is stated in the Technical Specifications for manufacturer's services, any additional time required to perform the specified services shall be at no additional cost to the City. 1.02 SUBMITTALS A. Prepare 0 & M sections for equipment and systems when such equipment and systems, and Shop Drawings and technical data therefore, are approved. Following receipt of the Engineer's approval of the final Shop Drawing submittal, and not later than 30 days before the delivery, submit, in triplicate, a draft of the complete 0 & M Manual for review and approval of Engineer. These O&M manuals shall cover all ancillary equipment and any existing equipment required for operating the new equipment. B. Simultaneously with the Application for Payment of Retainage, deliver to the Engineer five sets of the approved 0 & M Manuals complete with all corrections determined appropriate during draft submittal, training together with all required certificates for incorporation in the Manuals. The Payment Application for Retainage release will not be processed until receipt of the finalized 0 & M Manuals by Engineer. 01730-1 Operation and Maintenance Data December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT 1.03 FORM, FORMAT AND SUBMITTALS CONTENTS A. Operations and Maintenance Manuals will be used for training of and use by City personnel in the operation and maintenance of the various systems. Prior to the start-up of the system, the Contractor shall arrange training seminars for City operation and maintenance personnel using these Manuals as the basis for instructions in all procedures involving operations and maintenance. B. The Contractor shall furnish the City with one set of any special tools required for servicing for each type of equipment actually furnished. C. Prepare data in the form of an instructional manual for use by City personnel. D. Format 1. Size: 8V2 in. x 11 inch 2. Paper: 20 -pound minimum, white, for typed pages. 3. Text: Manufacturer's printed data or neatly typewritten 4. Plans a. Provide reinforced punched binder tab, bind in with text 5. Fold larger plans to the size of the text paper 6. Provide fly -leaf for each separate product, or each piece of operating equipment a. Provide typed description of product, and major component parts of equipment b. Provide indexed tabs 7. Cover and spine: Identify each volume with typed or printed title "Operating and Maintenance Instructions". The title shall be clearly visible on both the front cover and the binder spine 8. List 9. Title of Project 10. Identify of separate structure as applicable 11. Identity of general subject matter covered in the manual 12. Electronic copies in PDF format of the requirements noted herein. 01730-2 Operation and Maintenance Data December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • • • E. Binders 1. Commercial quality three-ring binders with durable and cleanable plastic covers. 2. Maximum Ring Size: As required (Minimum 11/2 -inches). F. Content of Manual: Neatly typewritten table of contents, arranged in a systematic order. 1. Contractor, name of responsible principal, address and telephone number. 2. A list of each product required to be included, indexed to the content of the volume. 3. List, with each product, the name, address and telephone number of: a. Subcontractor or installer b. Maintenance contractor, as appropriate c. Identify the area of responsibility of each d. Local source of supply for parts and replacement e. Identify each product by product name and other identifying symbols as set forth in Contract Documents G. Product Data 1. Include only those sheets which are pertinent to the specific product. 2. Annotate each sheet to: a. Clearly identify the specific product or part installed b. Clearly identify the data applicable in the installation c. Delete references to inapplicable information H. Plans 1. Supplement product data with plans as necessary to clearly illustrate: a. Relations of component part of equipment and system b. Control wiring, schematic wiring, and flow diagram 01730-3 Operation and Maintenance Data December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT 2. Coordinate plans with information in Project Record Documents to assure correct illustration of completed installation. I. Written text, as required to supplement product data for the particular installation. 1. Organize in a consistent format under separate headings for different procedures. 2. Provide a logical sequence of instructions for each procedure. J. Copy of each warranty, bond, and service contract issued. Provide information sheet for personnel, with the following information: 1. Proper procedures in the event of failure. 2. Instances which might affect the validity of warranties or bonds. 1.04 MANUAL FOR EQUIPMENT AND SYSTEMS A. Content, for each unit of equipment and system, as appropriate. 1. Description of unit and component parts a. Function, normal operating characteristics, and limiting conditions b. Performance curves, engineering data and tests c. Complete nomenclature and commercial number of all replaceable parts 2. Operating procedures a. Start-up, break-in, routine and normal operating instructions b. Regulation, control, stopping, shut -down, and emergency instructions c. Special operating instructions 3. Maintenance procedures a. Routine operations b. Guide to "trouble shooting" c. Disassembly, repair, and reassembly d. Alignment, adjusting, and checking 01730-4 Operation and Maintenance Data December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • • • • 4. Servicing and lubrication schedule: List of lubricants required. 5. Manufacturer's printed operations and maintenance instructions. 6. Original manufacturer's parts list, illustration, as plans and diagrams required for maintenance. a. Predicted life of parts subject to wear. b. Items recommended to be stocked as spare parts. 7. As -installed control diagrams by controls manufacturer. 8. Each contractor's coordination plans. As -installed color coded piping diagrams. 9. Charts of valve tag numbers, with the location and function of each valve. 10. List of original manufacturer's spare parts, manufacturer's current prices, and recommended quantities to be maintained in storage. 11. Other data as required under pertinent sections of specifications. B. Content, for each electric and electronic system, as appropriate. 1. Description of system and component parts a. Function, normal operating characteristics, and limiting conditions b. Performance curves, engineering data and tests c. Complete nomenclature and commercial number of replaceable parts 2. Operations procedures a. Routine and Normal Operations Instructions b. Sequences Required for Synchronizing c. Special Operations Instructions 3. Maintenance procedures a. Routine operations b. Guide to "trouble -shooting" 01730-5 Operation and Maintenance Data December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT c. Disassembly, repair and reassembly d. Adjust and checking 4. Manufacturer's printed operating and maintenance instructions. 5. List of original manufacturer's spare parts, manufacturer's current prices, and recommended quantities to be maintained in storage. 6. Other data as required under pertinent sections of specifications. C. Prepare and include additional data when the need for such data becomes apparent during instruction of personnel. D. Additional requirements for operating and maintenance data: The respective sections of Specifications. 1.05 SUBMITTAL OF MANUALS A. Three (3) draft hard copies and 2 CD's of the complete operating and maintenance manual, as mentioned in Part 1.02 A, shall be submitted for review by the Engineer after approval of all Shop Drawings and not later than 30 days before the delivery. Two copies will be returned back to the Contractor within 30 days after receipt by the Engineer. B. Submit five (5) hard copies, as mentioned in Part 1.02 B, and 3 CD's of final Operations and Maintenance Manuals at least 15 days prior to the payment application for retainage release. 1.06 POSTED OPERATING INSTRUCTIONS A. General: Operating instructions and diagrams shall be prepared for posting near the equipment. Posted operating instructions shall be photographic or equal non - fading reproductions framed under glass encased in non -discoloring plastic and shall be mounted in location directed. Copies of the posted operating instructions shall also be used with the Operations and Maintenance Manuals as a basis in training employees in the operation and maintenance of systems and related equipment installed. B. Contents: Posted operating instructions shall consist of simplified, consolidated equipment, control and power diagrams graphically representing the entire system and actual equipment installed, including concise written instructions on how to start and 01730-6 Operation and Maintenance Data December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • stop systems, what settings and conditions are to be observed and what control adjustments are to be made or maintained by the operator. 1.07 TRAINING A. The Contractor shall train the City in the operation and maintenance of all mechanical equipment and systems. B. Coordination shall be maintained with the Engineer in the development of training techniques and materials. Sixty days prior to start up, submit for approval the proposed training schedule and scope of materials and techniques. C. Training shall not commence until the final operations and maintenance manual has been submitted to the City. 1.08 MANUFACTURER'S NAMEPLATES A. Each major component of equipment to have manufacturer's name, address, model number, and rating on a plate securely affixed in a conspicuous place. Nameplate of a distributing agent will not be acceptable in lieu of manufacturer's nameplate. B. Nameplate shall be die -stamped, engraved, or etched to guarantee long term legibility. Nameplate shall be brass, bronze, aluminum, or stainless steel as required for corrosion resistance in the environment where the equipment is located. 1.09 GUARANTY/WARRANTY A. The Contractor shall guarantee that all new equipment has the capacity specified and that it will operate without excess noise or vibration. B. Copies of factory warranties on all equipment furnished shall be submitted with the above described, with the written guarantee, and included in maintenance manuals. 1.10 MANUFACTURER'S SERVICES A. DEFINITIONS: 1. Construction Period: Time period from the Contractor's equipment purchase order date to the date of certification from the manufacturer that the equipment is installed correctly and is ready for startup and operation. 2. Startup Period: a. Startup of equipment in the existing facility includes coordinated operation of the facilities by the Contractor, his subcontractors, 01730-7 Operation and Maintenance Data December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT City operating personnel, and manufacturer's representatives for equipment items and systems. b. Startup of equipment shall be considered complete when, in the opinion of the Engineer, the unit has operated successfully for seven continuous days without significant interruption. This 7 -day period is in addition to any training sessions, functional tests, or performance tests specified elsewhere. 3. Operational Test: a. Operational test consists of operation for 30 days of uninterrupted automatic operation of the completed lighting system. b. Units failing to meet the criteria in (a.) above shall be adjusted by the Contractor and re -tested until they meet the guaranteed rated conversion. 4. Operation Period: The operation period for equipment shall be considered initiated when the unit has been successfully started up as defines under paragraph "Startup Period" and successfully passes its Performance Demonstration Test. 5. Man -Day: Equals one person for eight hours straight time, exclusive of Saturday, Sunday, or holidays. B. FULFILLMENT OF SPECIFIED MINIMUM SERVICES: Only those manufacturer's services receiving prior approval by the Engineer shall act to fulfill the specified minimum man -day requirements for such manufacturer's services. All requests to the Engineer for prior approval shall: 1. Be in writing 2. Be submitted not less than 10 calendar days prior to the providing of the subject services 3. State the services to be provided 4. State the reason(s) why the timing of the service is appropriate Requests made to the Engineer less than 10 calendar days prior to the providing of manufacturer's services may not receive consideration and response prior to the times the services are provided. The Contractor is advised that the Engineer reserves the right to disapprove the above requests for fulfillment of the specified minimum man -day requirements. All responses to the Contractor, approving or disapproving requests for prior approval, will be in writing. Visits of 01730-8 Operation and Maintenance Data December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • • • manufacturers and their representatives to the jobsite or training classroom without prior approval as provided herein will not act to fulfill the specified minimum man -day requirements. C. Services During Construction 1. General: Competent and experienced technical representatives shall represent the manufacturers of all equipment and systems as many days as may be necessary to resolve assembly or installation problems at the worksite which are attributable to, or associated with, the equipment furnished. This requirement applies to manufacturers of all equipment furnished, whether or not specifically set forth in the Technical Specifications. 2. Manufacturer's Certificate of Proper Installation: Where called for in the Technical Specifications, the manufacturer's representative shall provide a certificate stating that the equipment or system has been installed in accordance with the manufacturer's recommendation and has been inspected by a manufacturer's authorized representative, that it has been serviced with the proper initial lubricants, that applicable safety equipment has been properly installed, and that the proper electrical and mechanical connections have been made. D. Performance Testing and Startup Services 1. Where performance testing and startup services are called for in the Specifications, or when technical assistance is necessary due to any malfunction of the equipment or system furnished, the manufacturer's representative shall provide such service. The Contractor shall also conduct and/or assist with final performance and demonstration testing, as required by the Specifications. These services shall continue until such time as the applicable equipment or system has been successfully tested for performance and has been accepted by City for full-time operation. 2. The equipment cannot be adequately performance tested until after all its ancillary equipment and controls have also been put into operation. E. Contractor Responsibilities During Startup 1. Designate and provide one or more persons to be responsible for coordination and expediting startup duties. The person or persons shall be present during all pre -startup meetings and shall be available to City personnel at all times during the startup period. 01730-9 Operation and Maintenance Data December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT 2. When startup has commenced, the Contractor shall schedule his remaining work so as not to interfere with or delay the completion of startup. The Contractor shall support the startup activities with adequate staff to prevent delays, process upsets, etc. This staff shall include, but not be limited to, major equipment and system manufacturers' representatives, subcontractors, electricians, instrumentation personnel, millwrights, pipefitters, plumbers, etc. 3. Where startup services are called for in the Specifications, the Contractor shall supply and coordinate the specified manufacturers' services for the startup period. 4. Conduct equipment startup and field performance tests on all equipment, systems, and subsystems. These tests shall meet all requirements specified in other sections of the Contract Documents. 5. Be responsible for the safety and well-being of all personnel under Contractor's employ. 6. Be responsible for adjustments, repairs, and corrections necessary to complete startup. 7. Items of equipment, systems, and subsystems which were not adequately or successfully tested prior to startup must be tested after startup. F. Training of City Personnel 1. Where called for in the Specifications, the manufacturer's representative shall provide detailed instructions to the City's personnel for operation and maintenance of the specified equipment. These training services shall include pre -startup classroom and onsite equipment instruction and/or post -startup classroom and onsite equipment instruction, as stated in the Specifications. 2. City requires that the Contractor video-tape the training sessions and provide the video (DVD) to the engineer. 3. Procedure: a. Designate and provide one or more persons to be responsible for coordinating and expediting training duties. The person or persons shall be present at all training meetings with the City. b. Submit to the City a Complete Installation Schedule, to be used by the City for scheduling the training of operating personnel by 01730-10 Operation and Maintenance Data December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • • • equipment manufacturers. This schedule shall list the estimated completion dates for the installation of all equipment and systems requiring the services of manufacturers' representatives, as stated in the Specifications. c. Submit the Complete Installation Schedule not less than 30 calendar days prior to the time the associated equipment is delivered to the site. d. Coordinate the pre -startup training periods with the City operating personnel, and manufacturer's representatives. All pre -startup training shall be started no sooner than 14 days prior to the actual unit startup. e. Where post -startup training is called for in the Specifications, supply and coordinate the specified manufacturers services and Contractor personnel for post -startup training of City operating personnel. PART 2 - PRODUCTS (NOT USED) 111 PART 3 - EXECUTION (NOT USED) END OF SECTION 01730-11 Operation and Maintenance Data December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT SECTION 01790 DEMONSTRATION AND TRAINING PART 1 - GENERAL 1.01 DESCRIPTION A. This section contains requirements for training the Owner's personnel, by persons retained by the Contractor specifically for the purpose, in the proper operation and maintenance of the equipment and systems installed under this contract. 1.02 QUALITY ASSURANCE A. Where required by the detailed specifications, the Contractor shall provide on-the- job training of the Owner's personnel. The training sessions shall be conducted by qualified, experienced, factory -trained representatives of the various equipment manufacturers. Training shall include instruction in both operation and maintenance of the subject equipment. 1.03 SUBMITTALS A. The following information shall be submitted to the Engineer in accordance with the provisions of Section 01300. The material shall be reviewed and accepted by the Engineer as a condition precedent to receiving progress payments in excess of 50 percent of the contract amount and not less than 3 weeks prior to the provision of training. 1. Lessons plans for each training session to be conducted by the manufacturer's representatives. In addition, training manuals, handouts, visual aids, and other reference materials shall be included. 2. Subject of each training session, identity and qualifications of individuals to be conducting the training, and tentative date and time of each training session. PART 2 - PRODUCTS 2.01 GENERAL A. Where specified, the Contractor shall conduct training sessions for the Owner's personnel to instruct the staff on the proper operation, care, and maintenance of the equipment and systems installed under this contract. Training shall take place at the site of the work and under the conditions specified in the following 01790-1 Demonstration and Training December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • paragraphs. Approved operation and maintenance manuals shall be available at least 30 days prior to the date scheduled for the individual training session. 2.02 LOCATION A. Training sessions shall take place at the site of the work in the administration building. 2.03 LESSON PLANS A. Formal written lesson plans shall be prepared for each training session. Lesson plans shall contain an outline of the material to be presented along with a description of visual aids to be utilized during the session. Each plan shall contain a time allocation for each subject. B. One complete set of originals of the lesson plans, training manuals, handouts, visual aids, and reference material shall be the property of the Owner and shall be suitably bound for proper organization and easy reproduction. The Contractor shall furnish ten copies of necessary training manuals, handouts, visual aids and reference materials at least 1 week prior to each training session. 2.04 FORMAT AND CONTENT A. Each training session shall be comprised of time spent both in the classroom and at the specific location of the subject equipment or system. As a minimum, training session shall cover the following subjects for each item of equipment or system: 1. Familiarization a. Review catalog, parts lists, drawings, etc., which have been previously provided for the plant files and operation and maintenance manuals. b. Check out the installation of the specific equipment items. c. Demonstrate the unit and indicate how all parts of the specifications are met. d. Answer questions. 2. Safety a. Using material previously provided, review safety references. b. Discuss proper precautions around equipment. 3. Operation 01790-2 Demonstration and Training December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT a. Using material previously provided, review reference literature. b. Explain all modes of operation (including emergency). c. Check out Owner's personnel on proper use of the equipment. 4. Preventive Maintenance a. Using material previously provided, review preventive maintenance (PM) lists including: b. Reference material. c. Daily, weekly, monthly, quarterly, semiannual, and annual jobs. d. Show how to perform PM jobs. e. Show Owner's personnel what to look for as indicators of equipment problems. 5. Corrective Maintenance a. List possible problems. b. Discuss repairs --point out special problems. c. Open up equipment and demonstrate procedures, where practical. 6. Parts a. Show how to use previously provided parts list and order parts. b. Check over spare parts on hand. Make recommendations regarding additional parts that should be available. 7. Local Representatives a. Where to order parts: name, address, telephone. b. Service problems: 1) Who to call. 2) How to get emergency help. 8. Operation and Maintenance Manuals a. Review any other material submitted. b. Update material, as required. 01790-3 Demonstration and Training December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • 2.05 VIDEO RECORDING: A. The Contractor will retain the services of a commercial video taping service to record each training session. After taping, the material will be edited and supplemented with professionally produced graphics to provide a permanent record. The Contractor shall advise all manufacturers providing training sessions that the material will be video taped and shall make available to the Contractor's video taping contractor such utility services and accommodation as may be required to facilitate the production of the video tape record. PART 3 - EXECUTION 3.01 SUMMARY A. Acceptable operation and maintenance manuals for the specific equipment shall be provided to the Owner prior to the start of any training. Video taping shall take place concurrently with all training sessions. B. The following services shall be provided for each item of equipment or system as required in individual specification sections. Additional services shall be provided, where specifically required in individual specification sections. 1. As a minimum classroom equipment training for operations personnel will include: a. Using slides and drawings, discuss the equipment's specific location in the plant and an operational overview. b. Purpose and plant function of the equipment. c. A working knowledge of the operating theory of the equipment. d. Start-up, shutdown, normal operation, and emergency operating procedures, including a discussion on system integration and electrical interlocks, if any. e. Identify and discuss safety items and procedures. f. Routine preventative maintenance, including specific details on lubrication and maintenance of corrosion protection of the equipment and ancillary components. g. Operator detection, without test instruments, of specific equipment trouble symptoms. h. Required equipment exercise procedures and intervals. 01790-4 Demonstration and Training December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT i. Routine disassembly and assembly of equipment if applicable (as judged by the Owner on a case-by-case basis) for purposes such as operator inspection of equipment. 2. As a minimum, hands-on equipment training for operations personnel will include: a. Identify location of equipment and review the purpose. b. Identifying piping and flow options. c. Identifying valves and their purpose. d. Identifying instrumentation: e. Location of primary element. f. Location of instrument readout. g. Discuss purpose, basic operation, and information interpretation. h. Discuss, demonstrate, and perform standard operating procedures and round checks. i. Discuss and perform the preventative maintenance activities. j. Discuss and perform start-up and shutdown procedures. k. Perform the required equipment exercise procedures. 1. Perform routine disassembly and assembly of equipment if applicable. m. Identify and review safety items and perform safety procedures, if feasible. 3. Classroom equipment training for the maintenance and repair personnel will include: a. Theory of operation. b. Description and function of equipment. c. Start-up and shutdown procedures. d. Normal and major repair procedures. 01790-5 Demonstration and Training December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • e. Equipment inspection and troubleshooting procedures including the use of applicable test instruments and the "pass" and "no pass" test instrument readings. f. Routine and long-term calibration procedures. g. Safety procedures. h. Preventative maintenance such as lubrication; normal maintenance such as belt, seal, and bearing replacement; and up to major repairs such as replacement of major equipment part(s) with the use of special tools, bridge cranes, welding jigs, etc. 4. Hands-on equipment training for maintenance and repair personnel shall include: a. Locate and identify equipment components. b. Review the equipment function and theory of operation. c. Review normal repair procedures. d. Perform start-up and shutdown procedures. e. Review and perform the safety procedures. f. Perform Owner approved practice maintenance and repair job(s), including mechanical and electrical adjustments and calibration and troubleshooting equipment problems. END OF SECTION 01790-6 Demonstration and Training December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT SECTION 01999 REFERENCE FORMS The forms listed below and included in this section are referenced from other sections of the project manual: Form No. Title 01300-A 01660-A 01730-A 01730-B 01730-C 09900-A 11000-A 11000-B 11000-C 11002-A 11060-A 16000-A 16000-B 16000-C 16000-D 16000-E 16000-F 16000-G 16000-H 16000-I 16000-J 16000-K 16000-L 17000-A 17000-B 17000-C 17000-D 17000-E 17000-F 17000-G 17000-H 17000-I 17000-J 17000-K Submittal Transmittal Form Equipment Test Report Form Operation and Maintenance Transmittal Form Equipment Record Form Equipment Record Form Coating System Inspection Checklist Manufacturer's Installation Certification Form Manufacturer's Instruction Certification Form Unit Responsibility Certification Form Rigid Equipment Mount Installation Inspection Checklist Motor Data Form Wire and Cable Resistance Test Data Form Installed Motor Test Data Form Dry Transformer Test Data Form Motor Control Center Test Form Medium Voltage Motor Starter Test Form Medium Voltage Switchgear Test Form Protective Relay Test Form Low Voltage Switchgear Test Form Medium Voltage Load Interrupter Switch Test Form Liquid -Filled Transformer Test Form Automatic Transfer Switch Test Form Neutral Grounding Resistor Test Loop Wiring and Insulation Resistance Test Data Form Control Circuit Piping Leak Test Form Controller Calibration Test Data Form Panel Indicator Calibration Test Data Form Recorder Calibration Test Data Form Signal Trip Calibration Test Data Form Field Switch Calibration Test Data Form Transmitter Calibration Test Data Form Miscellaneous Instrument Calibration Test Data Form Individual Loop Test Data Form Loop Commissioning Test Data Form 01999-1 Reference Forms December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • 01300-A. SUBMITTAL TRANSMITTAL FORM SUBMITTAL TRANSMITTAL Submittal Description: Submittal No:' Spec Section: We are sending you Remarks: 0 Attached 0 Under separate cover via 0 Submittals for review and comment 0 Product data for information only Item Routing Sent Received OWNER: Contractor/CM Reviewer initials Review comments attached PROJECT: CM/Engineer Engineer/CM CONTRACTOR: CM/Contractor We are sending you Remarks: 0 Attached 0 Under separate cover via 0 Submittals for review and comment 0 Product data for information only Item Copies Date Section No. Description Review actions Reviewer initials Review comments attached eNote: NET = No exceptions taken; MCN = Make corrections noted; A&R = Amend and resubmit; R = Rejected Attach additional sheets if necessary. Contractor Certify either A or B: 0 A. We have verified that the material or equipment contained in this submittal meets all the requirements, including coordination with all related work, specified (no exceptions). 0 B. We have verified that the material or equipment contained in this submittal meets all the requirements specified except for the attached deviations. No. Deviation 1See paragraph 01300-4.0 A, Transmittal Procedure. 01999-2 Reference Forms December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT Certified by: Contractor's Signature 01999-3 Reference Forms December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • Page 1 of 3 • 01660-A. EQUIPMENT TEST REPORT FORM NOTE: This example equipment test report is provided for the benefit of the Contractor and is not specific to any piece of equipment to be installed as a part of this project. The example is furnished as a means of illustrating the level of detail required for the preparation of equipment test report forms for this project. • • Equipment Name: Equipment Number: Specification Ref: Location: CITY OF SAMPLE EXAMPLE WATER TREATMENT PLANT STAGE IV EXPANSION PROJECT ABC Construction Company, Inc., General Contractor XYZ Engineering, Inc., Construction Manager EQUIPMENT TEST REPORT Sludge Pump 2 P25202 11390 East Sedimentation Basin Gallery Reference Forms Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) 01999-4 December 2020 City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT Contractor Construction Manager Verified Date Verified Date PREOPERATIONAL CHECKLIST Mechanical Lubrication Alignment Anchor bolts Seal water system operational Equipment rotates freely Safety guards Valves operational Hopper purge systems operational Sedimentation tank/hopper clean O&M manual information complete Manufacturer's installation certificate complete Electrical (circuit ring -out and high -pot tests) Circuits: Power to MCC 5 Control to HOA Reference Forms Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) 01999-4 December 2020 City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT Page 2 of 3 01999-5 Reference Forms Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) December 2020 City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT Contractor Construction Manager Verified Date Verified Date Indicators at MCC: Red (running) Green (power) Amber (auto) Indicators at local control panel Wiring labels complete Nameplates: MCC Control station Control panel Equipment bumped for rotation Piping Systems Cleaned and flushed: Suction Discharge Pressure tests Temporary piping screens in place Instrumentation and Controls Flowmeter FE2502F calibration Calibration Report No. Flow recorder FR2502G calibrated against transmitter VFD speed indicator calibrated against independent reference Discharge overpressure shutdown switch calibration Simulate discharge overpressure Shutdown FUNCTIONAL TESTS Mechanical Motor operation temperature satisfactory Pump operating temperature satisfactory Unusual noise, etc? Pump operation: 75 gpm/50 psig Measurement: Flow: Pressure: Test gage number: Alignment hot Dowelled in Remarks: 01999-5 Reference Forms Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) December 2020 City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • • Page 2 of 3 RECOMMENDED FOR BENEFICIAL OCCUPANCY Construction Manager Date ACCEPTED FOR BENEFICIAL OCCUPANCY Owner's Representative Date 01999-6 Reference Forms December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT Contractor Construction Manager Verified Date Verified Date Contractor Construction Manager Verified Date Verified Date Electrical Local switch function: Runs in HAND No control power in OFF Timer control in AUTO Overpressure protection switch PS2502C functional in both HAND and AUTO Overpressure protection switch PS2502C set at 75 psig PLC 2500 set at 24-hour cycle, 25 min ON OPERATIONAL TEST 48-hour continuous test. Pump cycles as specified, indicators functional, controls functional, pump maintains capacity, overpressure protection remains functional, hour meter functional RECOMMENDED FOR BENEFICIAL OCCUPANCY Construction Manager Date ACCEPTED FOR BENEFICIAL OCCUPANCY Owner's Representative Date 01999-6 Reference Forms December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT 01730-A. OPERATION AND MAINTENANCE TRANSMITTAL FORM • Date: Submittal No:2 To: Contract No: Spec. Section: Submittal Description: From: Attention: Remarks: 2See paragraph 01300-4.0 A, Transmittal Procedure. 01999-7 Reference Forms Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) December 2020 City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • Checklist Contractor Construction manager Satisfactory N/A Accept Deficient 1. Table of contents 2. Equipment record fomes 3. Manufacturer information 4. Vendor information 5. Safety precautions 6. Operator prestart 7. Start-up, shutdown, and postshutdown procedures 8. Normal operations 9. Emergency operations 10. Operator service requirements I 11. Environmental conditions 12. Lubrication data 13. Preventive maintenance plan and schedule 14. Troubleshooting guides and diagnostic techniques 15. Wiring diagrams and control diagrams 16. Maintenance and repair procedures 17. Removal and replacement instructions 18. Spare parts and supply list 19. Corrective maintenance man-hours 20. Parts identification 21. Warranty information 22. Personnel training requirements 23. Testing equipment and special tool information Remarks: 2See paragraph 01300-4.0 A, Transmittal Procedure. 01999-7 Reference Forms Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) December 2020 City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • • • Contractor's Signature 01999-8 Reference Forms December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT 01730-B. EQUIPMENT RECORD FORM EQUIP DESCRIP EQUIP LOC EQUIP NO. SHOP DWG NO. DATE INST COST MFGR MFGR CONTACT MFGR ADDRESS PHONE VENDOR VENDOR CONTACT VENDOR ADDRESS PHONE RECOMMENDED SPARE PARTS PART NO QUAN PART NAME COST Reference Forms Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) ELECTRICAL NAMEPLATE DATA MAINTENANCE REQUIREMENTS DWMQS SERIAL NO. ID NO. MODEL NO. FRAME NO. A Hours AMP HZ PH RPM SF DUTY CODE INSL. CL DES TYPE NEMA DES C AMB TEMP RISE RATING MISC. MECHANICAL NAMEPLATE DATA EQUIP MAKE SERIAL NO. ID NO. MODEL NO. FRAME NO. HP RPM CAP SIZE TDH IMP SZ BELT NO. CFM PSI ASSY NO. CASE NO. MISC LUBRICANTS: RECOMMENDED: ALTERNATIVE: MISC. NOTES: RECOMMENDED SPARE PARTS PART NO QUAN PART NAME COST Reference Forms Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) ELECTRICAL NAMEPLATE DATA EQUIP MAKE SERIAL NO. ID NO. MODEL NO. FRAME NO. HP V AMP HZ PH RPM SF DUTY CODE INSL. CL DES TYPE NEMA DES C AMB TEMP RISE RATING MISC. MECHANICAL NAMEPLATE DATA EQUIP MAKE SERIAL NO. ID NO. MODEL NO. FRAME NO. HP RPM CAP SIZE TDH IMP SZ BELT NO. CFM PSI ASSY NO. CASE NO. MISC 01999-9 December 2020 City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • • EQUIP DESCRIP EQUIP LOC EQUIP NO. SHOP DWG NO. DATE INST COST MFGR MFGR CONTACT MFGR ADDRESS PHONE VENDOR VENDOR CONTACT VENDOR ADDRESS PHONE MAINTENANCE REQUIREMENTS D W M Q S A Hours Reference Forms Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) 01999-10 December 2020 City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT 09900-A COATING SYSTEM INSPECTION CHECKLIST Project Name Owner General Contractor (GC) Coating System Manufacturer (CSM) Coating System Applicator (CSA) Area or Structure Location within Structure Coating System (eg E-1) Coating Type (eg Epoxy, etc.) 1 * :ri�Y'✓ '� .�#`�.a qs ?":."k' r" Completion of cleaning and substrate decontamination prior to abrasive blast cleaning. ..,y,, 9_ � GC QC �* ."�`°F. k' 3E r f �:� mg w„a. ''�" ws; '.^,ata '� �� #u „i+ '��-^: CSM QC CSA QC 2 Installation of protective enclosure of structure or area and protection of adjacent surfaces or structures that are not to be coated. GC QC CSM QC CSA QC 3 Completion of ambient condition control in structure or building area and acceptance of ventilation methods in structure or Area. GC QC CSM QC CSA QC 4 Completion of Surface Preparation for Substrates to Be Coated. GC QC CSM QC CSA QC 5 Completion of Primer Application. GC QC CSM QC CSA QC • 01999-11 • • 6 • Completion of Concrete Repairs If Required and Related Surface Preparation Rework Prior to Coating System Application. • GC QC • CSM QC CSA QC 7 Completion of Concrete Filler/ Surface Application to Concrete. GC QC CSM QC CSA QC 8 Completion of First Finish Coat Application and of Detail Treatment at Transitions or Terminations. GC QC CSM QC CSA QC 9 Completion of Second Finish Coat Application and of Detail Treatment at Transitions and Terminations. GC QC CSM QC CSA QC 10 Completion of Full and Proper Cure of Coating System. GC QC CSM QC CSA QC 11 Completion of Testing of Cured Coating System including Adhesion, Holiday (Continuity) Testing and Dry Film Thickness. GC QC CSM QC CSA QC 12 Completion of Localized Repairs to GC QC Coating System Following Testing. CSM QC CSA QC 01999-12 Final Acceptance of Coating System Installation Including Final Clean - Up Complying with Specification Requirements and the CSM's Quality Requirements. GC QC CSM QC CSA QC • 01999-13 • • • 11000-A. MANUFACTURER'S INSTALLATION CERTIFICATION FORM • • Contract No: Specification section: Equipment name: Contractor: Manufacturer of equipment item: The undersigned manufacturer of the equipment item described above hereby certifies that he has checked the installation of the equipment and that the equipment, as specified in the project manual, has been provided in accordance with the manufacturer's recommendations, and that the trial operation of the equipment item has been satisfactory. Comments: Date Manufacturer Signature of Authorized Representative Date Contractor Signature of Authorized Representative 01999-14 11000-B. MANUFACTURER'S INSTRUCTION CERTIFICATION FORM Contract No: Specification section: Equipment name: Contractor: Manufacturer of equipment item: The undersigned manufacturer certifies that a service engineer has instructed the wastewater treatment plant operating personnel in the proper maintenance and operation of the equipment designated herein. Operations Check List (check appropriate spaces) Start-up procedure reviewed Shutdown procedure reviewed Normal operation procedure reviewed Others: Maintenance Check List (check appropriate spaces) Described normal oil changes (frequency) Described special tools required Described normal items to be reviewed for wear Described preventive maintenance instructions Described greasing frequency Others: Date Manufacturer Signature of Authorized Representative Date Signature of Owner's Representative Date Signature of Contractor's Representative 01999-15 • • 11000-C. UNIT RESPONSIBILITY CERTIFICATION FORM (Project Title) CERTIFICATE OF UNIT RESPONSIBILITY for Specification Section (Section title) In accordance with paragraph 11000-1.02 C of the contract documents, the undersigned manufacturer of driven equipment ("manufacturer") accepts unit responsibility for all components of equipment furnished to the Project under specification Section , and for related equipment manufactured under Sections , , and . We have reviewed the requirements for Sections 11000 (and 11050 where applicable) and all sections referencing this (these) section(s), including but not limited to drivers, supports for driving and driven equipment and all other specified appurtenances to be furnished to the Project by manufacturer. And, we have further reviewed, and modified as necessary, the requirements for associated variable speed drives and motor control centers. We hereby certify that all specified components are compatible and comprise a functional unit suitable for the specified performance and design requirements whether or not the equipment was furnished by us. We will make no claim nor establish any condition that problems in operation for the product provided under this specification Section are due to incompatibility of any components covered by this Certificate of Unit Responsibility. Nor will we condition or void any warranty for the performance of the product of this specification Section due to incompatibility of any components covered under this Certificate of Unit Responsibility. Our signature on this Certificate of Unit Responsibility does not obligate us to take responsibility for, nor to warrant the workmanship, quality, or performance of related equipment provided by others under spec f cation Sections, , and obligation to warranty all equipment provided by us shall remain unaffected. . Our Notary Public Name of Corporation Commission expiration date Address Seal: By: Duly Authorized Official Legal Title of Official Date: 01999-16 11002-A. RIGID EQUIPMENT MOUNT INSTALLATION CHECKLIST (CLIENT, PROJECT NAME) Equipment Tag No.: Date: Grout Product Name and Type: Grouting System Manufacturer: Grouting Application Contractor: General Contractor: Step 1: Verify Equipment Anchor Installation Conformance to Equipment Pad Details Name: Date // Contractor Rep. Name: Name: Construction Manager Millwright Step 2: Completion of Cleaning and Concrete Substrate Preparation Prior to Grouting Name: Date //_ Contractor Rep. Name: Name: Construction Manager Grouting Contractor Rep. Name: Grout Manufacturer's Technical Rep. Step 3: Equipment Leveling Name: Date / / Contractor Rep. Name: Name: Construction Manager Millwright 01999-17 • • • Step 4: Installation of Protection of Adjacent Surfaces or Structures NOT TO BE GROUTED Name: Date //_ Contractor Rep. Name: Name: Construction Manager Grouting Contractor Rep. Name: Grout Manufacturer's Technical Rep. Step 5: Preparation and Construction of Forms and Epoxy Grout Filling Standpipes Name: Date //_ Contractor Rep. Name: Name: Construction Manager Grouting Contractor Rep. Name: Step 6: Grout Manufacturer's Technical Rep. Completion of Ambient Condition Control in Structure or Building Area and Acceptance of Ambient Conditions as They Apply to Application and Curing Requirements for the Grouting System Name: Date / / Contractor Rep. Name: Date / / Grouting Contractor Rep. Name: Date / / Grout Manufacturer's Technical Rep. Name: Date / / Construction Manager 01999-18 Step 7: Name: Date / / Name: Name: Step 8: Name: Name: Name: Name: Step 9: Name: Name: Name: Name: Epoxy Grout Installation Contractor Rep. Name: Construction Manager Grouting Contractor Rep. Grout Manufacturer's Technical Rep. Completion of Full and Proper Cure of Epoxy Grout Contractor Rep. Grouting Contractor Rep. Grout Manufacturer's Technical Rep. Construction Manager Date / / Date / / Date / / Date / / Completion of Localized Repair of Grout Voids Contractor Rep. Grouting Contractor Rep. Grout Manufacturer's Technical Rep. Construction Manager Date / / Date / / Date / / Date / / 01999-19 • • • Step 10: Final Acceptance of Grouting System Installation Including Final Clean -Up of the Work Site Complying with All Specification Requirements and the GSM's Quality Requirements Name: Date _/ / Contractor Rep. Name: Date / / Grouting Contractor Rep. Name: Date / / Grout Manufacturer's Technical Rep. Name: Date / / Construction Manager • • 01999-20 11060-A. MOTOR DATA FORM Equipment Name: Equipment No(s): Project Site Location: Nameplate Markings Mfr: Mfr Model: Frame: °C (NEMA MG1-12.41,42) Horsepower: Volts: If Yes: Phase: Volts RPM: ■ No Service Factor: FLA: LRA: Frequency: Amb Temp Rating: °C Time rating: Design Letter: (NEMA MG1-10.35) (NEMA MG -1.16) KVA Code Letter: Insulation Class: The following information is required for explosion -proof motors only: A. Approved by UL for installation in Class , Div , Group B. UL frame temperature code (NEC Tables 500-8B) The following information is required for all motors 1/2 horsepower and larger: A. Guaranteed minimum efficiency (Paragraph 11060-2.04 G) B. Nameplate or nominal efficiency Data Not Necessarily Marked on Nameplate Type of Enclosure: Enclosure Material: Temp Rise: °C (NEMA MG1-12.41,42) Space Heater included? If Yes: Watts Volts • Yes ■ No Type of motor winding over -temperature protection, if specified: Provide information on other motor features specified: 01999-21 • A. WIRE AND CABLE RESISTANCE TEST DATA FORM • • Wire or Cable No.: Temperature, °F: Location of Test Insulation resistance, megohms 1. 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7 CERTIFIED Date Contractor's Representative WITNESSED Date Owner's Representative 01999-22 16000-B. INSTALLED MOTOR TEST FORM Motor Equipment Number: Date of test: Equipment Driven: MCC Location: Motor Nameplate Markings: • Mfr Ambient temp OF Resistance: Insulation resistance phase -to -ground megohms: Phase A HP Phase B Volts Phase C Phase Current at Full Load: Phase Current, amps Phase Current, amps Phase °C Current, amps Thermal Overload Device: Manufacturer/catalog # (NEMA 1-10.35) Amperes Code letter Circuit breaker (MCP) setting: Insulation class Motor Nameplate Markings: • Mfr Mfr Model Frame HP Volts Phase RPM Service factor** Amps Freq Ambient temp rating °C Time rating Design letter** (NEMA 1-10.35) (NEMA MG -1.16) Code letter Insulation class **Required for 3-phase squirrel cage induction motors only. CERTIFIED Date Contractor's Representative WITNESSED Owner's Representative 01999-23 Date • • • 16000-C. DRY TRANSFORMER TEST DATA FORM (Note: Use Data Form for dry type transformers with voltage rating of 600 Vac or less and sizes to 167 kVA single phase and 500 kVA three phase. Use NETA Test Forms and Test Procedures for higher voltages and larger transformers.) Equipment Tag No.: Temperature Rating: Description/Location: Feeder size/Source: Primary Voltage: Secondary Voltage: Winding Connection: A. VISUAL INSPECTION Transformer Inspection Pass Fail Note 1. Nameplate data as specified Primary Winding to ground A GRD 2. Mechanical condition B a. Free of dents and scratches b. Anchored properly GRD c. Shipping brackets removed Secondary Winding to ground with * N -G Bond removed a GRD d. Spacing from wall per nameplate b 3. Grounding * a. Equipment grounding GRD b. System grounding Primary Winding to Secondary Winding A a B. INSULATION -RESISTANCE TESTS: Perform tests with calibrated megohmeter. Apply 1000 Vdc test voltage for 60 seconds and record readings in megohms at 30 -seconds and 60 -seconds intervals. Test Group Resistance between 30 -second reading 60 -second reading Absorption Ratio Index 60 -sec. / 30 -sec. Primary Winding to ground A GRD B GRD C GRD Secondary Winding to ground with * N -G Bond removed a GRD b GRD c GRD Primary Winding to Secondary Winding A a B b C c Submit resistance readings to the Construction Manager immediately after the tests that are less than the manufacturer's recommended value or less than 10 -megohms. Record the Absorption Ratio Index values for future reference. Ratio must be 1.0 or greater, with infinity (co) equal to 1.0. Contractor Representative Certified: Date Owner Representative Witnessed: Date 01999-24 16000-D. MOTOR CONTROL CENTER TEST FORM Equipment No.: Ambient room temperature: Location: A. MECHANICAL CHECK: All bolted connections either bus to bus or cable to bus shall be torqued to the manu- facturer's recommendations. B. ELECTRICAL TESTS: 1. Measure insulation resistance of each bus section phase to phase and phase to ground for 1 minute using a megohmmeter at 1000 volts. Test results (megohms) Phase Phase A -GRD A -B B -GRD B -C C -GRD C -A 2. Set the circuit breaker in the starter unit to comply with the requirements of NEC, Article 430-52 and Table 430-152. 3. Motor overload heater elements shall be sized and installed based on the actual nameplate full load amperes of the motor connected to the starter. CERTIFIED Date Contractor's Representative WITNESSED Date Owner's Representative 01999-25 • • 16000-E. MEDIUM VOLTAGE MOTOR STARTER TEST FORM • • Equipment No.: Location: Room Temperature: The protective devices shall be set in accordance with the specification before the tests are performed. 1. Measure contact resistance (micro-ohms) Phase: A B C Contacts shall be replaced if resistance exceeds 50 micro-ohms. 2. Perform an insulation resistance test (1000 volts DC for 1 minute). Phase A B C Pole to ground megohms Across open pole megohms Pole to pole AB BC CA megohms 3. Perform minimum pickup voltage tests on trip and close coils. 4. Motor RTDs shall be tested by using a hot oil bath. The temperature at which the sensor trips shall be recorded for each RTD. 5. The Contactor shall be tripped by operation of each protective device. 01999-26 16000-F. MEDIUM VOLTAGE SWITCHGEAR TEST FORM Equipment No.: Location: Room Temperature: The protective devices shall be set in accordance with the specification before the tests are performed. 1. Measure contact resistance (micro-ohms) Phase: A A B C C Pole to ground Contacts shall be replaced if resistance exceeds 50 micro-ohms. 2. Perform an insulation resistance test (1000 volts DC for 1 minute). Phase A B C Pole to ground megohms Across open pole megohms Pole to pole AB BC CA megohms 3. Perform minimum pickup voltage tests on trip and close coils. 4. Verify the instrument transformer ratios. Check the transformer's polarity electrically. 5. The Contactor shall be tripped by operation of each protective device. 01999-27 • • 16000-G. PROTECTIVE RELAY TEST FORM Location: Switchgear Breaker No.: Protective Relay Description: The protective relays shall be tested in the following manner: 1. Each protective relay circuit shall have its insulation resistance tested to ground. 2. Perform the following tests on the specified relay setting: a. Pickup parameters on each operating element. b Timing test shall be performed at three points on the time dial curve. c. Pickup target and seal -in units. IIIThe results shall be recorded and signed. A copy shall be given to the Construction • Manager in accordance with paragraph 16000-1.05 B. 01999-28 16000-H. LOW VOLTAGE SWITCHGEAR TEST FORM Equipment No.: Location: Room Temperature: The protective devices shall be set in accordance with the specification before the tests are performed. 1. Measure contact resistance (micro-ohms). Phase: A A B C C Pole to ground Contacts shall be replaced if resistance exceeds 50 micro-ohms. 2. Perform an insulation resistance test (1000 volts DC for 1 minute). 1 Phase A B C Pole to ground megohms Across open pole megohms Pole to pole AB BC CA megohms 3. Minimum pickup current shall be determined by primary current injection. 4. Long time delay shall be determined by primary injection at three hundred percent (300%) pickup current. 5. Short time pickup and time delay shall be determined by primary injection of current. 6. Instantaneous pickup current shall be determined by primary injection. 7. Trip unit reset characteristics shall be verified. 8. Auxiliary protective devices, such as ground fault or under voltage relays, shall be activated to ensure operation of shunt trip devices. 01999-29 • • • • 16000-I. MEDIUM VOLTAGE LOAD INTERRUPTER SWITCH TEST FORM Equipment Number: Location: Date: • • 1. Measure switch blade resistance (micro-ohms). Phase: A A B C C Pole to ground Contacts shall be replaced if resistance exceeds 50 micro-ohms. 2. Perform an insulation resistance test (1000 volts DC for 1 minute). Phase A B C Pole to ground megohms Across open pole megohms Pole to pole AB BC CA megohms The results shall be recorded and signed. A copy shall be given to the Construction Manager in accordance with paragraph 16000-2.06 B. CERTIFIED Date Contractor's Representative WITNESSED Date Owner's Representative 01999-30 16000-J. LIQUID -FILLED TRANSFORMER TEST FORM Equipment Number: Location: Date/Weather Conditions: A. Perform the "Insulation -Resistance Test" and "Dielectric Absorption Test" using Form 16000-C, Dry Transformer Test Data Form. B. Perform an applied voltage (low frequency dielectric) test in accordance with ANSI C57.12.90, paragraph 10.5, Applied Voltage Test. Applied voltage levels shall be 75 percent of recommended factory test levels or recommended test levels of ANSI C57.12.00, Table 5. C. Insulating oil shall be sampled and shall be laboratory tested for the following: 1. Dielectric strength. 2. Acid neutralization. 3. Interfacial tension. 4. Color. 5. Power factor. D. Perform a turns ratio test between the windings for all tap positions. E. The temperature and pressure switches shall be tested using a hot oil bath and air pump. F. The results shall be recorded and signed by the Contractor and Construction Manager. A copy shall be given to the Construction Manager in accordance with paragraph 16000-2.06 D. Any readings which are abnormal to ANSI industry standards shall be reported to the Construction Manager. 01999-31 • • • • 16000-K. AUTOMATIC TRANSFER SWITCH TEST FORM • • Equipment Number: Location: Date: 1. Perform an insulation resistance test (1000 volts DC for 1 minute): Phase A B C Pole to ground megohms Pole to pole AB BC CA megohms 2. Perform the following operations and initial: a. Manual transfer b. Loss of normal power; sec delay c. Return to normal power; sec delay The results shall be recorded and signed. A copy shall be given to the Construction Manager in accordance with paragraph 16000-2.06 B. CERTIFIED Date Contractor's Representative WITNESSED Date Owner's Representative 01999-32 16000-L. NEUTRAL GROUNDING RESISTOR TEST Equipment No.: Location: The pickup and time delay setting on the ground fault relay shall be set in accordance with Section 16431. 1. The transformer neutral insulation resistance shall be measured with and without the grounding resistor connected to insure no parallel ground paths exist. 2. The protective relay pickup current shall be determined by injecting test current into the current sensor. The pickup current should be within 10 percent of the dial setting. Record the dial setting and actual pickup tie. 3. The relay timing shall be tested by injecting 150 and 300 percent of pickup current into the current sensor. The relay timing shall be in accordance with the manufacturer's published time -current characteristic curves. Record the relay timing at 150 and 300 percent of pickup current. 4. The circuit interrupting device shall be operated by operating the relay. The results shall be recorded and signed by the Contractor and Construction Manager. A copy shall be given to the Construction Manager in accordance with paragraph 16000-2.06 B. 01999-33 • IIII17000-A. LOOP WIRING AND INSULATION RESISTANCE TEST DATA FORM • • Loop No.: List all wiring associated with a loop in table below. Make applicable measurements as indicated after disconnecting wiring. Wire No. Panel Tie Field TB Continuity Resistancea Insulation Resistanceb Cond./ Cond. Cond./ Shield Shield/ Gnd. Shield/ Cond. Cond./ Gnd. Shield/ Shield A -- (A/SH) B (A/B) — C (A/C) — D (ND) -- etc. NOTES: a. Continuity Test. Connect ohmmeter leads between wires A and B and jumper opposite ends together. Record resistance in table. Repeat procedure between A and C, A and D, etc. Any deviation of +2 ohms between any reading and the average of a particular run indicates a poor conductor, and corrective action shall be taken before continuing with the loop test. b. Insulation Test. Connect one end of a 500 volt megger to the panel ground bus and the other sequentially to each completely disconnected wire and shield. Test the insulation resistance and record each reading. CERTIFIED Date Contractor's Representative WITNESSED Date Owner's Representative 01999-34 17000-B. CONTROL CIRCUIT PIPING LEAK TEST FORM Loop No.: List tubing associated with loop in table below. Make applicable measurements after isolating any air consuming pilots from circuit. Tube No. Tubing Equivalent Length of 1/4 -Inch Coppera Test Period (seconds) Permitted Pressure Drop (psi)b Measured Pressure Drop (psi) A B C D etc. NOTES: a. Convert actual tubing and air motor volume to equivalent 1/4 -inch copper tubing. b. Pressure drop shall not exceed 1 psi per hundred feet 1/4 -inch tubing per 5 seconds. CERTIFIED Date Contractor's Representative WITNESSED Date Owner's Representative 01999-35 • • • III17000-C. CONTROLLER CALIBRATION TEST DATA FORM • • Tag No. and Description: Make & Model No.: Serial No.: Input: Process Variable (PV) Scale: Output: Output Scale: PV Scale Calibration % of Range Input Expected Reading Actual Reading % Deviation 0 Actual Reading Expected Reading Actual % Dev. Output 50 % Dev. (0%) 100 % Deviation Allowed: (50%) Connect output to PV for following tests: Set Point (SP) Indicator Accuracy Output Meter Accuracy Controller Accuracy SP PV Reading Expected % Dev. Actual Reading Expected Reading Actual % Dev. Output Output % Dev. (0%) (50%) (100%) % Deviation Allowed: % Deviation Allowed: % Deviation Allowed: CERTIFIED Date Contractor's Representative WITNESSED Owner's Representative 01999-36 Date 17000-D. PANEL INDICATOR CALIBRATION TEST DATA FORM Tag No. and Description: Make & Model No.: Serial No.: Input: Scale: Range: PV Scale Calibration % of Range Input Expected Reading Actual Reading % Deviation 0 50 100 % Deviation Allowed: CERTIFIED Date Contractor's Representative WITNESSED Date Owner's Representative 01999-37 • • 17000-E. RECORDER CALIBRATION TEST DATA FORM • • Tag No. and Description: Make & Model No.: Serial No.: Input: Chart: Scale: Range: % of Range Input Expected Reading Actual Reading % Deviation 0 50 100 % Deviation Allowed: CERTIFIED Date Contractor's Representative WITNESSED Date Owner's Representative 01999-38 17000-F. SIGNAL TRIP CALIBRATION TEST DATA FORM Tag No. and Description: Make & Model No.: Serial No.: Input: Scale: Range: Set Point(s): After setting set point(s), run signal input through entire range and calculate deadband. Set Point Incr. Input Trip Point Decr. Input Trip Point Calc. Deadband Required Deadband CERTIFIED Date Contractor's Representative WITNESSED Owner's Representative 01999-39 Date • Ill17000-G. FIELD SWITCH CALIBRATION TEST DATA FORM Tag No. and Description: Make & Model No.: Serial No: Input: Range: Set Point(s): Simulate process variable (flow, pressure, temperature, etc.) and set desired set point(s). Run through entire range of switch and calculate deadband. Set Point Incr. Input Trip Point Decr. Input Trip Point Calc. Deadband Required Deadband CERTIFIED Date Contractor's Representative • WITNESSED Date Owner's Representative 01999-40 17000-H. TRANSMITTER CALIBRATION TEST DATA FORM Tag No. and Description: Make & Model No.: Serial No.: Input: Output: Range: Scale: Simulate process variable (flow, pressure, temperature, etc.) and measure output with appropriate meter. % of Range Input Expected Reading Actual Reading % Deviation 0 50 100 % Deviation Allowed: CERTIFIED Date Contractor's Representative WITNESSED Date Owner's Representative 01999-41 • • • III17000-I. MISCELLANEOUS INSTRUMENT CALIBRATION TEST DATA FORM • • (For instruments not covered by any of the preceding test forms, the Contractor shall create a form containing all necessary information and calibration procedures.) CERTIFIED Date Contractor's Representative WITNESSED Date Owner's Representative 01999-42 17000-J. INDIVIDUAL LOOP TEST DATA FORM Loop No.: Description: (Give complete description of loop's function using tag numbers where appropriate.) P&ID No.: (Attach copy of P&ID.) a. Wiring tested: (Attach test form 17000-A) b. Instrumentation tubing/piping tested: (Attach test form 17000-B) c. Instruments calibrated: (Attach test forms 17000-C through I) d. List step-by-step procedures for testing loop parameters. Test loop with instruments, including transmitters and control valves, connected and functioning. If it is not possible to produce a real process variable, then a simulated signal may be used with the Construction Manager's approval. CERTIFIED Date Contractor's Representative WITNESSED Date Owner's Representative 01999-43 • • 17000-K. LOOP COMMISSIONING TEST DATA FORM • • Loop No.: a. Loop tested: (Attach test form 17000-J) b. Controlled or connected equipment tests confirmed: c. Give complete description of loop's interface with process. d. With associated equipment and process in operation, provide annotated chart trace of loop response to changes in set points for verification of performance. This chart should demonstrate 1/4 -amplitude damping as output adjusts to set point change. Show set points, starting and finishing times on chart, as well as any other pertinent data. Connect 2 -pen recorder to process variable (PV) and to controller output. Use 1 inch/second chart speed. Pen 1 - PV - Connections: Pen 2 - Output - Connections: CERTIFIED Date Contractor's Representative WITNESSED Date Owner's Representative 01999-44 SECTION 02050 DEMOLITION PART 1 - GENERAL 1.01 SCOPE This section specifies all labor, materials, equipment, and incidentals, as shown, specified, and required for demolitions, removal and disposal work. Included, but not limited to, are demolitions and removals of existing materials, equipment, or work necessary to install the work for this Contract as shown and specified and to connect same with existing work in an approved manner. Demolition includes structural concrete, foundations, walls, doors, windows, structural steel, metals, masonry, attachments, appurtenances, piping, electrical and mechanical equipment, paving, curbs, walks, fencing, and similar existing facilities. Contractor shall pay for all landfill disposal fees. Contractor shall conduct site visit to determine extent of work and the problems anticipated to perform the work. The Engineer did not perform a survey of asbestos containing materials or lead based paints during the design efforts. However, the Contractor shall include in their scope a limited survey to determine if asbestos containing materials or lead based paint is present. This survey shall be performed between the period of the Notice to Proceed and the Notice to Commence. The results of this survey shall be provided to the City and shall be performed by a competent and certified specialist in this type of work. The Contractor will be required to use this information to show the City the presence or the lack of asbestos containing materials and lead based paints in the demolition to be performed. 1.02 SUBMITTALS Submittals shall be made in accordance with Section 01300. In addition, the following specific information shall be provided: A. Contractor shall develop and submit demolition plan within 14 days of the Notice to Proceed which includes a demolition schedule and detail methods to use on each item to be demolished. The demolition plan shall take into consideration any appurtenances that is to remain in service until the proposed replacement is in installed, accepted, and operational. B. Qualifications of the firm contracted by the Contractor to perform the survey for asbestos containing materials and lead based paint. C. Results of the survey for asbestos containing materials and lead based paint. PART 2 - PRODUCTS (NOT USED) 02050-1 Demolition December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • • • PART 3 - EXECUTION • • 3.01 GENERAL A. All materials and equipment removed from existing site work shall become the property of Contractor, except for those items that the City chooses to salvage. All materials and equipment that the City identifies to be salvaged shall be carefully removed by Contractor so as not to be damaged and shall be cleaned and stored on or adjacent to the site in a protected place specified by the Engineer. B. The Contractor shall dispose of all demolition materials, equipment, debris, and all other items not marked by the City to salvage, off site and in conformance with all existing applicable laws and regulations. C. Use water sprinlding, temporary enclosures, and other suitable methods to limit amount of dust and dirt rising and scattering to the lowest practical level. Comply with governing regulations pertaining to environmental protection. 3.02 DEMOLITION AND REMOVAL A. STRUCTURES Demolition and removal of structures consist of removal of abandoned superstructures, foundation walls, footings, slabs and any other structures. Excavations caused by existing foundations shall be cleared of waste, debris and loose soil, and refilled as specified. Remove structures to the lines and grades shown, unless otherwise directed by the Engineer. Where no limits are shown the limits shall be 4 inches outside the item to be installed. The removal of masonry beyond these limits shall be at the Contractor's expense and these excess removals shall be reconstructed to the satisfaction of the Engineer with no additional compensation to Contractor. Where depth of removal is not shown, remove structures to 12 -inches below existing footing elevation and backfill to the original grade. B. MECHANICAL AND YARD PIPING Mechanical and yard piping removals shall comply with applicable mechanical and civil Drawings and Specifications. When existing underground piping is to be altered or removed, the remaining piping shall be properly capped. Abandoned underground piping shall be drained (water inside the demolished pipe shall be collected and not spilled onto the ground) and 02050-2 Demolition December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT removed. Contractor shall coordinate with the City for proper disposal of the drained water at the facility. C. ELECTRICAL Electrical removals shall comply with applicable electrical Drawings and Specifications. 3.03 SALVAGE The Contractor may salvage for their use any equipment or material scheduled for demolition that the City does not request to be salvaged. The City shall identify items that the City wants salvaged five (5) days prior to any salvage or demolition work. During the course of the Work, the Engineer may determine that certain piping and valving which is scheduled for demolition may be re -used. The Contractor shall propose to the Engineer to salvage portions of the Work scheduled for demolition that in the opinion of the Contractor is reusable and good condition. The Contractor shall retain from the contract value 10% of the cost of the material salvaged as if it were purchased new; and the City shall receive a credit in the amount of 90% of the cost of the new item which did not need to be purchased. The Engineer shall have the final decision on whether a piece of equipment, valving or piping may be re -used. In the instance of re -use, the Contractor shall coat to new in accordance with Section 09900. Valving, piping and equipment submittals and purchases shall be preceded by an evaluation by the Contractor and the Engineer of the equipment, piping and valving scheduled for demolition. 3.04 ALTERATIONS AND CLOSURES Alterations shall conform to all Contract Documents and the directions and approvals of the Engineer. Alterations resulting in openings in existing concrete slabs, ceilings, masonry walls shall be closed and sealed, as shown or otherwise directed by Engineer. The work shall be keyed into the existing work in a manner approved by Engineer. In general, use the same or matching materials as the existing adjacent surface. The finished closure shall be a smooth, tight, sealed, permanent closure acceptable by Engineer. 3.05 CLEAN-UP Contractor shall remove from the site all debris resulting from the demolition operations as it accumulates. Upon completion of the work, all materials, equipment, waste, and all debris shall be removed, and premises shall be left clean, neat and orderly. END OF SECTION 02050-3 Demolition December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • • • • • SECTION 02145 TEMPORARY SEWER BYPASSING PART 1 - GENERAL 1.01 SCOPE A. Under this item the Contractor is required to furnish all materials, labor, equipment, power, maintenance, etc. to implement a temporary bypass system for the purpose of diverting the existing flow around the work area for the duration of the project. B. The design, installation, and operation of the temporary bypassing system shall be the Contractor's responsibility. The Contractor may employ the services of a subcontractor to demonstrate to the Engineer that they specialize in the design and operation of temporary bypass systems. The vendor consulted during the design phase was Sunbelt Rentals, Inc., but alternative pump rental vendors may be used provided that they meet all requirements of the specifications. The vendor shall provide references of projects of a similar size and complexity as this project performed within the past five years. The bypass system shall meet the requirements of all codes and regulatory agencies having jurisdiction. The Contractor is responsible for all fines associate with potential spills that are the result of temporary bypass operations. C. The Contractor shall be familiar with the existing structures and existing in channel flow splitters, aeration equipment, electrical equipment and gates and weirs for the purposes of developing a detailed bypassing plan. Temporary removal of existing equipment and infrastructure may be required to accommodate bypass operations. See Appendix A for Record Drawings of the existing aeration basins. Appendix B includes conceptual bypassing information for the Contractor's reference. 1.02 SUBMITTAL REQUIREMENTS A. The Contractor shall submit to the Engineer detailed plans and descriptions outlining the sequence of bypassing, necessary equipment, method of operation and all provisions and precautions to be taken by the Contractor regarding the bypass of the wastewater flows. This plan must be specific and complete, including schedules, locations, anticipated fuel consumption, elevations, capacities of equipment, hydraulic calculations, materials and all other incidental items necessary and/or required to ensure proper protection of the facilities, including protection of the access and bypass pumping locations from damage due to the discharge flows, and compliance with the requirements and permit conditions specified in these Contract Documents. No construction shall begin 02145-1 Temporary Sewer Bypassing December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT until all provisions and requirements have been reviewed and accepted by the Engineer. B. The plan shall include but not be limited to details of the following: 1. Staging areas for pumps; 2. Identify areas that will require temporary removal of floor grating, handrail, air piping or other existing equipment and identify temporary safety measures to be implemented to protect City operations staff; 3. Bypass pump sizes, capacity, number of each size to be on site and power requirements, pump curves showing pump operating range shall be submitted; 4. Proposed temporary bypass piping layout; 5. Operation plan for maintaining continuous pump operations and emergency backup; 6. Fuel storage, containment, anticipated consumption, and management; 7. Method of noise control for each pump and/or generator; 8. Pump and water level monitoring capabilities and method of automatic alarm notification system; 9. Coffer dams, sandbags, and/or other means of physical isolating or containing flows; 10. Alternate bypass plan as developed by the Contractor. PART 2 - PRODUCTS 2.01 EQUIPMENT REQUIREMENTS A. All pumps used shall be fully automatic self -priming units that do not require the use of foot -valves or vacuum pumps in the priming system. 02145-2 Temporary Sewer Bypassing December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • • • B. The Contractor shall provide the necessary stop/start controls for each pump inclusive of a floatation triggered on-off system for automatic operation based on influent flow rates. The system shall be equipped with an alarm system to alert the Contractor and City Operations staff in case of a failure with ample response time for the Contractor to prevent an overflow. The Contractor or pump rental subcontractor shall provide an operator to be present at all times while the pumps are bypassing plant flow. C. The Contractor shall include two stand-by pumps to be maintained on site. Back- up pumps shall be on-line, isolated from the primary system by a valve. D. Bypass Piping — In order to prevent the accidental spillage of flows all discharge systems shall be temporarily constructed of rigid pipe with positive, restrained joints. All pipe shall be 150 -psi rated. Discharge hose will only be allowed in short sections and by specific permission from the Engineer. Piping shall only be installed as shown on the approved bypass plan. 2.02 DESIGN REQUIREMENTS A. Bypass pumping systems shall have minimum capacities as indicated in Table 1 below. Figure 2-1 shows the Basin numbers and the normal flow path. The Contractor shall provide all pipeline plugs, pumps of adequate size to handle peak flow, and temporary discharge piping to ensure that the total flow through the aeration basins can be safely diverted around the section under construction. The bypass pumping system will be required to be operated 24 hours per day. B. The Contractor shall have adequate standby equipment available and ready for immediate operation and use in the event of an emergency or breakdown. One standby pump for each size pump utilized shall be installed at the mainline flow bypassing locations, ready for use in the event of primary pump failure. C. The bypass pumping system shall be capable of bypassing the flow around the work area and of releasing any amount of flow up to full available flow into the work area as necessary for satisfactory performances of work. D. The Contractor shall make provisions for peak conditions that will increase normal daily flow. Table 1— Bvaass Capacities Location Wastewater Flow Capacity min -max _ 8m) Aeration Basin 4-5 20,800-46,530 Aeration Basins 6-13 4 basins shall be online and operational at all times to manage 20,800-46,530. *See Figure 2-1 for existing flow conditions at the time of this writing 02145-3 Temporary Sewer Bypassing December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT Ex. Weirs (10 total) Ex. Slide Gates (30 total) Project Area ® Aeration Basin # Flow Arrow Offline Channel Figure 2-1 Existing Flow Conditions 02145-4 Temporary Sewer Bypassing Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) December 2020 City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • • PART 3 - EXECUTION 3.01 PERFORMANCE REQUIREMENTS A. It is essential to the operation of the existing facility that there is no interruption in the flow of wastewater throughout the duration of the project. To this end, the Contractor shall provide, maintain and operate all temporary facilities such as dams, plugs, pumping equipment (both primary and back-up units as required), conduits, all necessary power, and all other labor and equipment necessary to intercept the sewage flow before it reaches the point where it would interfere with his work, carry it past his work, and return it to the nearest practical location within the aeration basins downstream of his work. B. The design, installation, and operation of the temporary systems shall be the Contractor's responsibility. The bypass system shall meet the requirements of all codes and regulatory agencies having jurisdiction. C. The Contractor shall provide all necessary means to safely convey the wastewater beyond the work area. The Contractor will not be permitted to stop or impede the main flows under any circumstances. The contractor shall repair, at his own expense, any damage to existing facility caused by bypass pumping. D. The Contractor shall maintain wastewater flow around the work area in a manner that will not cause damage to the existing basins and channels and that will protect public and private property from damage and flooding. E. The Contractor shall protect water resources, wetlands and other natural resources. F. Any leak or spill associated with the bypass pump or piping shall be contained by the Contractor and shall not extend beyond the immediate work area. Contractor shall submit a spill containment plan to the City. Spill containment plan must be approved by the City prior to Construction. 3.02 TESTING (NOT USED) 3.03 MAINTENANCE SERVICE A. The Contractor shall ensure that the temporary pumping system is properly maintained and a responsible operator shall be readily available at all times when pumps are operating. 3.04 EXTRA MATERIALS 02145-5 Temporary Sewer Bypassing December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT A. Spare parts for pumps and piping shall be kept on site as required by the vendor/pump manufacturer. B. Adequate hoisting equipment for each pump and accessories shall be maintained on the site. 3.05 PRECAUTIONS A. Contractor is responsible for locating any existing utilities in the area the Contractor selects to locate the bypass pipelines. The Contractor shall locate his bypass pipelines to minimize any disturbance to existing utilities and shall obtain approval of the pipeline locations from the City and the Engineer. All costs associated with relocating utilities and obtaining all approvals shall be paid by the Contractor. B. During all bypass pumping operations, the Contractor shall protect the existing facility from damage inflicted by any equipment. The Contractor shall be responsible for all physical damage to the existing facility caused by human or mechanical failure. 3.06 INSTALLATION AND REMOVAL A. Plugging or blocking of wastewater flows shall incorporate a primary and secondary plugging device. When plugging or blocking is no longer needed for performance and acceptance of work, it is to be removed in a manner that permits the sewage flow to slowly return to normal without surge, to prevent surcharging or causing other major disturbances downstream. B. When working inside the aeration basins or common conveyance channels, the Contractor shall exercise caution and comply with OSHA requirements when working in confined spaces. END OF SECTION 02145-6 Temporary Sewer Bypassing December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • • • SECTION 03600 GROUT PART 1 - GENERAL 1.01 DESCRIPTION This section specifies grout for slide and weir gate frames, equipment bases and uses other than masonry. 1.02 QUALITY ASSURANCE A. QUALITY CONTROL BY OWNER The Owner will provide the services of a field Inspector for quality assurance. B. QUALITY CONTROL BY CONTRACTOR If a product other than those listed below is proposed and test data is not available from the supplier to demonstrate equivalence to the specified grout, then to demonstrate equivalence with the grout properties of the specified product, the Contractor shall provide the services of an independent testing laboratory which complies with the requirements of ASTM E329. The testing laboratory shall sample and test the proposed grout materials. Costs of testing laboratory services shall be borne by the Contractor. C. REFERENCES: This section contains references to the following documents. They are a part of this section as specified and modified. Where a referenced document contains references to other standards, those documents are included as references under this section as if referenced directly. In the event of conflict between the requirements of this section and those of the listed documents, the requirements of this section shall prevail. Unless otherwise specified, references to documents shall mean the documents in effect at the time of Advertisement for Bids or Invitation to Bid (or on the effective date of the Agreement if there were no Bids). If referenced documents have been discontinued by the issuing organization, references to those documents shall mean the replacement documents issued or otherwise identified by that organization or, if there are no replacement documents, the last version of the document before it was discontinued. Where document dates are given in the following listing, references to those documents shall mean the specific document version associated with that date, regardless of whether the document has been superseded by a version with a later 03600-1 Grout December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT date, discontinued or replaced. Reference Title ASTM C230 ASTM C307 ASTM C531 ASTM C579 ASTM C882 ASTM C942 ASTM C1107 ASTM C1181 COE CRD -C611 COE CRD -C621 IBC Standard Specification for Flow Table for Use in Tests of Hydraulic Cement Standard Test Method for Tensile Strength of Chemical - Resistant Mortar, Grouts, and Monolithic Surfacings Standard Test Method for Linear Shrinkage and Coefficient of Thermal Expansion of Chemical -Resistant Mortars, Grouts, Monolithic Surfacings, and Polymer Concretes Standard Test Methods for Compressive Strength of Chemical -Resistant Mortars, Grouts, Monolithic Surfacings and Polymer Concretes Standard Test Method for Bond Strength of Epoxy -Resin Systems Used with Concrete by Slant Shear Standard Test Method for Compressive Strength of Grouts for Preplaced-Aggregate Concrete in the Laboratory Packaged Dry, Hydraulic -Cement Grout (Non -shrink) Standard Test Methods for Compressive Creep of Chemical -Resistant Polymer Machinery Grouts Flow of Grout for Preplaced Aggregate Concrete Specification for Non -shrink Grout International Building Code, 2009 edition 1.03 SUBMITTALS The following information shall be provided in accordance with Section 01300: 1. Complete product literature and installation instructions for epoxy grout (all uses) and cementitious non -shrink grout. 2. Current ICC Evaluation Service report for adhesives used for dowel and anchor setting. 3. Installer certification in accordance with ACl/CRSI Adhesive Anchor Installer Certification Program for installers of horizontal or upwardly inclined adhesive anchors. PART 2 - PRODUCTS 03600-2 Grout December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • 2.01 CEMETITIOUS NON -SHRINK GROUT Cementitious non -shrink non-metallic aggregate grout shall be Five Star Products, Inc. Five Star Grout, BASF Masterflow 928, Sika Corporation SikaGrout 212, Hi -Flow Grout by Euclid Chemical Company, or equal. 2.02 EPDXY GROUT FOR EQUIPMENT MOUNTING: Epoxy grout for equipment mounting shall be a non-cementitious, resin based, multi- component formulation. Epoxy grout shall be flowable, with shrinkage minimized to achieve minimum 98% effective bearing area. Acceptable products include: BASF Masterflow 648 CP Plus; Sikadur 42 by Sika Corporation; E3 -G by Euclid Chemical Company; or equal. 2.03 ADHESIVE FOR DOWEL AND ANCHOR SETTING Adhesive for setting dowels and anchoring connection/base plate bolts shall be an injectable two -component epoxy adhesive. Adhesive shall be approved for the intended use per the product ICC Report. Adhesive shall be HIT -RE 500-V3 by Hilti or approved equal (equivalent product must have ICC approval for use in cracked concrete in areas with high seismic risk). PART 3 - EXECUTION 3.01 CEMENTITIOUS NONSHRINK GROUT Non -shrink, cementitious, nonmetallic aggregate grout shall be used for column base plates, structural bearing plates, and all locations where the general term "non -shrink grout" is indicated on the drawings. Use of this grout to support the bearing surfaces of machinery shall be as detailed on the Drawings for specific locations or pieces of equipment. If guidance is not provided in locations noted above, use of non -shrink grout for equipment mounting shall be limited to equipment less than 25 horsepower or 750 pounds. Grout shall be placed and cured in accordance with manufacturer's instructions. Non -shrink cementitious grout shall not be used as a surface patch or topping. Non -shrink cementitious grout must be used in confined applications only. 3.02 EPDXY GROUT FOR EQUIPMENT MOUNTING Prepare concrete surfaces of equipment pads as indicated in details on the Drawings and as required by the epoxy grout manufacturer. Epoxy grout for equipment mounting shall be placed and cured in accordance with the requirements of equipment specifications, details on the Drawings, and in strict conformance with manufacturer's recommendations. 3.03 CONCRETE REPAIR MORTAR 03600-3 Grout December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT Concrete repair materials and procedures shall be submitted for review to the Engineer and shall be accepted prior to commencement of the repair work. Follow all manufacturer's instructions, including those for minimum and maximum application thickness, surface preparation and curing. Add aggregate as required per manufacturer's recommendations. Any deviations from the manufacturer's instructions shall be submitted for review to the Engineer and shall be accepted prior to commencement of the work. END OF SECTION 03600-4 Grout December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • SECTION 03900 CONCRETE REHABILITATION PART 1 - GENERAL 1.01 DESCRIPTION This section specifies rehabilitation of the existing concrete walkway beams for existing Aeration Basin No. 4 to Basin No. 13 due to spalls and cracks. A. Scope: 1. The Contractor shall provide all labor, materials, equipment, and incidentals as shown, specified, and required to repair or rehabilitate, as required, all existing concrete shown or indicated in the Contract Documents as being repaired or rehabilitated. Contractor is responsible to provide temporary shoring and formwork designs, stamped and signed by a Professional Engineer registered to practice in Florida, as required to complete the repairs. B. Coordination: 1. Review installation procedures under this and other Sections and coordinate the Work that must be installed with or before repair and rehabilitation of concrete. The Contractor, in conjunction with the Engineer, shall determine the extent of cracked or deteriorated concrete to be rehabilitated and/or resurfaced. A summary of the work to be performed shall be submitted to the Engineer for review, and such summary shall be approved by the Engineer prior to commencement of the Work. 2. Demolition of existing coating and deteriorated concrete surfaces shall be in general conformance with the Contract Drawings and these specifications. Anticipated depths of concrete demolition are shown on the Contract Drawings. If differing conditions are encountered, they will be addressed by the Engineer via change order during construction of the project. The Contractor shall be prepared to saw cut and chip out deteriorated concrete using hand tools and cleaning based on the Engineer's review in the field. 1.02 QUALITY ASSURANCE A. REFERENCES: • This section contains references to the following documents. They are a part of this section as specified and modified. Where a referenced document contains 03900-1 Concrete Rehabilitation December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT references to other standards, those documents are included as references under this section as if referenced directly. In the event of conflict between the requirements of this section and those of the listed documents, the requirements of this section shall prevail. Unless otherwise specified, references to documents shall mean the documents in effect at the time of Advertisement for Bids or Invitation to Bid (or on the effective date of the Agreement if there were no Bids). If referenced documents have been discontinued by the issuing organization, references to those documents shall mean the replacement documents issued or otherwise identified by that organization or, if there are no replacement documents, the last version of the document before it was discontinued. Where document dates are given in the following listing, references to those documents shall mean the specific document version associated with that date, regardless of whether the document has been superseded by a version with a later date, discontinued or replaced. Reference Title ASTM C 109-90 (Modified) ASTM A 185-85 ASTM C 348-91 ASTM C 469-87 ASTM C 157 (Modified) ASTM C 666-91 ASTM C 882-87 (Modified) ASTM C 1202-91 Test Method for Compressive Strength of Hydraulic Cement Mortars Specification for Steel Welded Wire Fabric, Plain, for Concrete Reinforcement Test Method for Flexural Strength of Hydraulic Cement Mortars Test Method for Static Modulus of Elasticity and Poisson's Ratio of Concrete in Compression Test Method for Drying Shrinkage of Mortar Containing Portland Cement Test Method for Resistance of Concrete to Rapid Freezing and Thawing Test Method for Bond Strength of Epoxy Resin Systems Used with Concrete Electrical Indication of Resistance to Chloride Ion Penetration 1.03 SUBMITTALS A. B. Action Submittals: 1. Manufacturer's product data to verify conformance with this section. 2. Beam identification and location of reinforcing section loss more than 25 % cross section area. 3. Contractor's concrete repair summary. 4. Concrete repair plan based on site condition. Informational Submittals: Submit the following: 03900-2 Concrete Rehabilitation December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • 1. Manufacturer's Instructions: Manufacturer's recommended procedures for installing materials proposed for use. 2. Site Quality Control Submittals: Results of specified Site quality control testing. 3. Special Procedure Submittals: When requested by the Engineer, submit information on methods for supporting during demolition and repair Work existing structures, pipes, and other existing facilities affected by the Work. 1.04 PRODUCT DELIVERY, STORAGE AND HANDLING A. Delivery and Handling of Materials: 1. Clearly mark on containers manufacturer's name and label, name or title of material, manufacturer's stock number, and date of manufacture. 2. Handle materials carefully to prevent inclusion of foreign matter. 3. Do not open containers or mix components until necessary preparatory work has been completed and application Work is to start immediately. B. Storage of Materials: 1. Store only approved materials at the Site. • PART 2 - PRODUCTS 2.01 REPAIR MORTAR A. Hand applied repair mortar Repair mortar shall be Sika SikaTop-122 Plus, Sika SikaTop-123 Plus, or approved equal. Where the least dimension of the placement in width or thickness exceeds four inches, extend repair mortar by adding aggregate as recommended by repair mortar manufacturer. Repair mortar when cured shall produce the following properties: 1. Compressive Strength (ASTM C 109) 2. Flexural Strength (ASTM C 293) 3. Tensile Adhesion Strength (ASTM C 882, modified) 4. Drying Shrinkage (ASTM C 157, modified) 03900-3 Minimum, 1 -day 2,000 psi; 28 -day 6,000 psi Minimum, 28 -day 1,500 psi Minimum, 28 -day 2,000 psi Maximum 0.05% shrinkage @ 28 days. 1 in. x 1 in. x 11.25 in. prism, air cured Concrete Rehabilitation December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT 5. Modulus of Elasticity 2.94 million psi maximum @ 28 days (ASTM C 469) B. Form and Pour repair mortar 1. 2. 3. 4. Repair mortar shall be Sika SikaTop 111 Plus, SikaGrout 328 or approved equal. Extend repair mortar by adding aggregate as recommended by repair mortar manufacturer. Repair mortar when cured shall produce the following properties: Compressive Strength Minimum, 1 -day 2,500 psi; (ASTM C 109) 28 -day 6,500 psi Flexural Strength (ASTM C 293) Minimum, 28 -day 1,300 psi Tensile Adhesion Strength Minimum, 28 -day >500 psi (ASTM C 882, modified) Drying Shrinkage (ASTM C 157, modified) 5. Modulus of Elasticity (ASTM C 469) 2.02 WIRE FABRIC Wire fabric, where shown on the Contract Drawings, shall be Type 304 welded steel mesh, 4 in. x 4 in. spacing, 12 gauge. Placement pins shall be Type 304. Maximum 0.05% shrinkage @ 28 days. 1 in. x 1 in. x 11.25 in. prism, air cured 3x106 psi maximum @ 7 days in Compression 2.03 CURING Curing of repair mortar and non -shrink grout shall be in accordance with manufacturer's recommendations, except that minimum cure period shall be three days. 2.04 REBAR COATING A. System Description: System for repair of exposed reinforcing steel shall consist of two components: an initial application of corrosion inhibitor and subsequent application of protective slurry mortar. B. Corrosion Inhibitor: 1. Corrosion inhibitor shall penetrate the hardened concrete surface and form a protective layer on reinforcing steel. 03900-4 Concrete Rehabilitation December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • 2. Products and Manufacturers: Provide one of the following: a. Sika FerroGard 903, by Sika Corporation. b. Or equal. C. Protective Slurry Mortar: 1. Material shall be two -component, polymer -modified, cementious waterproofing and protective slurry mortar. Provide two coats at coverage of 50 square feet per gallon per coat. 2. Products and Manufacturers: Provide one of the following: a. Sikatop Seal 107, by Sika Corporation. b. Or equal. 2.05 CRACK INJECTION MATERIALS A. Structural Crack Repair System: 1. Epoxy for Injection: Low -viscosity, high -modulus moisture insensitive type. 2. Products and Manufacturers: Provide one of the following: a. Sikadur 35, Hi Mod L.V. and Sikadur 31, Hi -Mod Gel, by Sika Corporation. b. Dural 335, by Euclid Chemical Company. c. Or equal. PART 3 - EXECUTION For all cracks to be repaired in walkway beams, prior to injecting the cracks all loose and damaged concrete shall be removed using chipping hammers or hydro blasting. Contractor shall use caution to reduce micro fractures. Once all loose and damaged concrete is removed, cracks shall be injected using structural crack repair System of this specification. After crack repairs are completed the concrete repair mortar shall be applied per Repair Mortar of this specifications. Provisions allow for a spray or trowel applied mortar as well as a "form and pour" mortar. All repair mortar will be top coated with a filler/surfacer and then a high performance coating. The underlying repair mortars, filler/surfaces, bonding agents, rust inhibitive coatings, etc. must be all be compatible. 3.01 INSPECTION A. Examine areas and conditions under which the repair Work is to be installed and notify the Engineer in writing of conditions detrimental to proper and timely completion of the Work. Do not proceed with the Work until unsatisfactory conditions have been corrected. Provide temporary support to existing walkway beams during entire repair operation. 03900-5 Concrete Rehabilitation December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT 3.02 SURFACE PREPARATION Surface Preparation: Surface preparation shall conform to recommendations of repair mortar Manufacturer. 1. Initial Surface Preparation: Remove by chipping, abrasive blasting, or hydro blasting all laitance, foreign material, and unsound concrete from entire area to be repaired. Further roughen surface as specified in this Section. Where non -shrink grout or repair mortar is used, perform additional surface preparation, if any, recommended by product manufacturer. 2. Wetting Procedure: Where repair concrete, shotcrete, or cement grout is used, and bonding agent is not required, or where repair mortar or non -shrink grout manufacturer recommends wet or saturated surface, perform the following: a. Continuously apply water for at least four hours to surface being repaired. Where large surface areas are to be repaired, use fog -spray nozzles, mounted on stands, in sufficient number so that entire surface to be repaired is contacted by fog spray cloud. b. Prevent concrete from drying until after repair is completed. Re -wet surfaces not yet repaired using water sprays at least a daily; should more than four days elapse without re -wetting surfaces not yet repaired, repeat the original saturating procedure. c. Remove standing water in areas to be repaired before placing repair material. Provide means to remove excess water from structure. 3. Preparation for Epoxy Bonding Agent: Where repair material manufacturer recommends use of epoxy -bonding agent, conform to recommendations of both repair material manufacturer and bonding agent manufacturer. Repair and rehabilitate isolated areas of exposed reinforcing bars in accordance with this Section. If extensive areas of reinforcing steel are uncovered after removal of deteriorated concrete, the Engineer will determine the repair methods required. If existing bars are cut through, cracked, or cross sectional area is reduced by more than 25 percent from original, immediately notify the Engineer. Upon completion of removal of deteriorated concrete, notify the Engineer in writing. Allow two weeks for the Engineer to evaluate the surface, perform any required testing, determine if additional concrete shall be removed, and to develop special repair details (if any) required. Remove loose, broken, softened, and acid -contaminated concrete by abrasive blasting and chipping to sound, uncontaminated concrete or as reviewed in the field by the Engineer. Remove all coatings and a minimum of 1/4 in. of existing concrete facing and continue removal as required to expose sound aggregate. Substrate should have a minimum amplitude of 1/4 in. Limit the size of chipping hammers to 151b. to reduce micro fractures. 03900-6 Concrete Rehabilitation December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • Saw -cut perimeter of the area to be repaired to a minimum depth of 1/4 in for shallow repairs and 1" for deep repairs or local patches. Do not cut existing steel reinforcement. Where reinforcing steel with active corrosion is encountered, comply with the following: 1. Abrasive blast reinforcing steel to remove rust, scale and contaminants to achieve a white metal finish. 2. If any portion of the reinforcing steel is exposed, chip out behind the reinforcing to a 1 in. minimum depth. Thoroughly abrade the roughened surface and exposed reinforcement to remove all bond - inhibiting materials such as: rust, dirt, loose chips, and dust. Maintain substrate in a saturated, surface dry condition. 3.03 MESH When applying product in repairs greater than 10 lineal feet in the longest direction or in overlays at depths of 1 in. to 1-1/2 in. or greater and for overhead applications of the same size, provide a stainless-steel mesh that is firmly anchored to the properly prepared substrate. Locate the mesh no closer than 3/8 in. and no more than 1 in. from the fmished surface, using spacers and concrete anchors. A minimum cover of mortar over the mesh should be 3/8 in. 3.04 APPLICATION A. REPAIR MORTAR : Mix repair mortar in accordance with manufacturer's recommendations. 1. Maintain substrate in a saturated, surface -dry condition. For hand applications, a bond coat is required. Apply repair mortar by low pressure wet spraying or hand troweling on vertical or overhead surfaces in depths ranging from 3/8 in. to 2 in. For repairs of greater depth, the Contractor has the option to form and pour or to use multiple lifts providing a layered patch. 2. Repair mortar can be applied on vertical applications up to a 2 in. depth per lift. For multiple passes, place succeeding lifts after repair mortar has developed initial set. Scarify the surface of the first lift to ensure integral bond between successive layers. Minimum Thickness: a. Install repair mortar to not less than minimum thickness recommended by manufacturer, and not less than 1/2 -inch. b. Where removal of deteriorated concrete results in repair thickness of less than minimum required thickness to return to original concrete surface in isolated areas totaling less than ten percent of total repair 03900-7 Concrete Rehabilitation December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT surface area, remove additional concrete to obtain at least the required minimum thickness. c. Where surface area with repair thickness less than minimum required thickness exceeds ten percent of total repair area, notify the Engineer. d. Provide repair mortar so that minimum cover over existing reinforcing steel is two inches. Do not place repair mortar creating locally raised areas. 3. Level surface of repair mortar using a float or screed. Apply final finish when mortar has begun to stiffen using a wooden, plastic, or synthetic sponge float or trowel. 4. Place repair mortar to an even, uniform plane to restore concrete member to its original surface. Out -of -plane tolerance shall be such that the gap between 12 -inch long straight edge and repair mortar surface does not exceed 1/8 -inch, and gap between a four -foot long straight edge and repair mortar surface shall not exceed 1/4 -inch. 5. Cure fresh mortar to protect from premature evaporation. Cure either by keeping the surface moist with water as mortar surface has hardened, for a minimum of seven days, or, apply two coats of a curing compound with first coat immediately after completing finishing operations and second coat about 24 hours later. B. STRUCTURAL CRACK REPAIR SYSTEM If proper penetration of crack cannot be achieved, submit to the Engineer a proposed alternate approach for modifying the specified injection procedure to properly seal the crack. If modification of the proposed procedure is required to fill the cracks, submit said modification in writing to the Engineer for acceptance prior to proceeding. Adhere to all limitations and cautions for the epoxy resin adhesive in the manufacturers current printed literature. In new concrete and in concrete cracked as a result of the Contractor's operations, perform modifications to crack injection procedure and fully repair the crack without additional cost to the Owner or extension of the Contract Times. 1. Mixing the epoxy resin adhesive for sealing the cracks & porting devices per manufacturer's recommendation. 2. Placement procedure: a. The epoxy resin adhesive for sealing the cracks & porting device: Set the porting devices as required by the equipment manufacturer. Spacing of the porting devices shall be accomplished as required to achieve the travel of the epoxy resin for the pressure injection grouting between ports and fill the cracks to the maximum. On structures open on both sides, provide porting devices on opposite 03900-8 Concrete Rehabilitation December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • sides at staggered elevations. Apply the mixed epoxy resin adhesive for sealing over cracks and around each porting device to provide an adequate seal to prevent the escape of the epoxy resin adhesive for the injection grouting. Where required by the Engineer, apply the epoxy resin adhesive for sealing in such a manner that minimal defacing or discoloration of the substrate shall result. b. The epoxy resin adhesive for the pressure injection grouting: 1) Manual: Load the mixed epoxy resin adhesive for grouting into a disposable caulking cartridge or bulk -loading caulking gun. Inject the prepared cracks with a constant pressure in order to achieve maximum filling & penetration without the inclusion of air pockets or voids in the epoxy resin adhesive. Begin the pressure injection at the widest part of the crack being injected and continue until there is the appearance of epoxy resin adhesive at an adjacent port, thus indicating travel. When travel is indicated, the decision to discontinue or continue the pressure injection from that port should be made by the Contractor based on his experience, with the approval of the Engineer. Continue procedure until pressure injectable cracks have been filled. 2) Automated: Dispense the epoxy resin adhesive for grouting under constant pressure in accordance with procedures recommended by the equipment manufacturer as required to achieve maximum filling and penetration of the prepared cracks without the inclusion of air pockets or voids in the epoxy resin adhesive. The pressure injection of single or multiple ports, by use of a manifold system, is possible. This decision should be made by the Contractor, with the approval of the Engineer. Continue the approved procedure until all pressure injectable cracks have been filled. C. REPAIR OF EXPOSED REINFORCING 1. Remove, by abrasive blasting or hydro blasting, all corrosion, foreign materials, and unsound concrete from area to be repaired. 2. Surface shall be visually dry before applying corrosion inhibitor. Liberally apply corrosion inhibitor to achieve coverage of 100 square feet per gallon in two or more coats, by allowing corrosion inhibitor to soak into substrate. Time between coats shall be the longer of: one hour, or as recommended by corrosion inhibitor manufacturer. Apply using rollers, brushes, or hand - pressure spray equipment. 03900-9 Concrete Rehabilitation December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT 3. After applying fmal coat of corrosion inhibitor, minimum cure time of 24 hours is required. 4. Provide high-pressure wash to surfaces to be repaired to remove filmy residue from corrosion inhibitor. 3.05 CLEANING After the crack repair products has cured porting devices shall be removed as required by the Engineer. Clean the substrate in a manner to produce a finish appearance acceptable to the Owner. Leave finished work and work area in a neat, clean condition without evidence of spillovers onto adjacent areas. 3.06 SITE QUALITY CONTROL A. The Contractor shall provide: 1. Verification of section loss of existing reinforcing as required by the Engineer. 2. All labor, material, and equipment required, including rods, molds, thermometer, calipers, and all other incidentals required, subject to approval by the Engineer. 3. All necessary storage, curing, and transportation required for testing. 4. The Contractor will be charged for cost of additional testing and investigation, if any, for Work performed that is not in accordance with the Contract Documents or is otherwise defective. B. Site Tests of Cement -based Grouts and Repair Mortar: 1. Obtain compression test specimens during construction from first placement of each type of mortar or grout, and at intervals thereafter as selected by the Engineer, to verify compliance with the Contract Documents. The Contractor shall employ and pay for services of testing laboratory for Site quality control testing. 2. Compression tests and fabrication of specimens for repair mortar and non - shrink grout will be performed in accordance with ASTM C109. Set of three specimens will be made for each test. Tests will be made at seven days, 28 days, and additional time periods as deemed appropriate by the Engineer. 3. Material, already placed, failing to conform to the Contract Documents, is defective. END OF SECTION 03900-10 Concrete Rehabilitation December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • • • SECTION 05502 ANCHORS TO CONCRETE PART 1 - GENERAL 1.01 DESCRIPTION This section specifies anchor systems; bolts and all -thread rods used to attach structural elements and equipment to concrete [and concrete masonry]. Included are cast -in-place and post -installed anchors; adhesive systems, limited use expansion (wedge type) anchors, nuts and washers. Cast -in-place anchor bolts are specified as hot -dip galvanized or Type 316 stainless steel; all -thread rods are Type 316 stainless steel. 1.02 QUALITY ASSURANCE/QUALITY CONTROL A. QUALITY ASSURANCE BY OWNER: Special inspection of anchor bolts shall be performed by the Special Inspector under contract with the Owner and in accordance with IBC Chapter 17. B. REFERENCES This section contains references to the following documents. They are a part of this section as specified and modified. Where a referenced document contains references to other standards, those documents are included as references under this section as if referenced directly. In the event of conflict between the requirements of this section and those of the listed documents, the requirements of this section shall prevail. Reference Title ACI 318 ASTM A193 ASTM A194 ASTM A320 ASTM A563 Building Code Requirements for Structural Concrete Alloy -Steel and Stainless Steel Bolting Materials for High - Temperature or High Pressure Service and Other Special Purpose Applications Carbon and Alloy Steel Nuts for Bolts for High Pressure or High -Temperature Service Alloy -Steel Bolting Materials for Low -Temperature Service Carbon and Alloy Steel Nuts 05502-1 Anchors to Concrete [and Masonry] December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT Reference Title ASTM F593 ASTM F594 ASTM F844 ASTM F1554 [IBC 2009 [CBC Stainless Steel Bolts, Hex Cap Screws and Studs Stainless Steel Nuts Washers, Steel, Plain (Flat), Unhardened for General Use Anchor Bolts, Steel, 36, 55, 105-ksi Yield Strength International Building Code with local ammendments] California Building Code with local ammendments] 1.03 SUBMITTALS Provided the following submittals in accordance with Section 01300: 1. Anchor bolt placement plans. 2. Anchor bolt, nut, and washer material information, including material certifications. 3. Where required here -in or by other sections of the Contract Documents, submit record copy of design calculations and details showing the required diameter, length, embedment, edge distance, confinement, anchor reinforcement, anchor bolt sleeves, connection redesign, and other conditions, stamped and signed by a Professional Engineer currently registered in the state of Florida. [Calculations shall comply with the provisions of ACI 318 Appendix D.] Calculations will not be reviewed by the Engineer and calculations will not be returned to the Contractor 4. Submit record copy of proof loading test results within five days after test. 5. Product Data: a. ICC Evaluation Service Reports for post -installed adhesive type anchors and expansion (wedge type) anchors when allowed. Products shall be ICC approved for use in cracked concrete. b. Product data indicating load capacity charts/calculations. c. Chemical resistance. d. Temperature limitations. 05502-2 Anchors to Concrete [and Masonry] October 2019 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • • • e. Manufacturers written installation instructions. PART 2 - PRODUCTS 2.01 GENERAL Anchor bolt holes in equipment support frames shall not exceed the bolt diameters by more than 1/4 inch. Minimum anchor bolt diameter shall be 1/2 inch. [Anchor bolts for equipment mounting and vibration isolation systems shall be provided as specified in Sections 11002 and 11021, respectively.] Tapered washers shall be provided where mating surface is not square with the nut. When cast -in-place anchors are specifically indicated, post -installed anchors set in holes drilled in the concrete after the concrete is placed will not be permitted unless specifically requested by the Contractor and approved by the Engineer. 2.02 MATERIALS Anchor bolt materials shall be as specified in the following table: Material Specification Stainless Steel Anchor Bolts Stainless Steel Threaded Rods Stainless Steel Nuts and Washers Carbon Steel Anchor Bolts High -Strength Carbon Steel Anchor Bolts Carbon Steel Nuts and Washers Concrete Adhesive Anchors ASTM A193 or A320, Type 316 ASTM F593, Type 316 ASTM A194 Heavy Hex Nuts and Washers (ASTM F594 Heavy Hex Nuts at Adhesive Anchors), Type 316 ASTM F1554, Grade 36 — Hot Dip Galvanized ASTM F1554, Grade 55, Weldable per Supplementary Requirement S1 — Hot Dip Galvanzied ASTM A563 and F844 — Heavy Hex Hilti "HIT -RE 500-V3", Simpson "SET -XP", or equal — Type 316 stainless steel Anchors to Concrete [and Masonry] Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) 05502-3 December 2020 City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT Material Specification Masonry Adhesive Anchors Masonry Expansion (wedge) Anchors* Concrete Expansion (wedge) Anchors * Hilti "HIT-HY 150 MAX", Simpson "SET", or equal — Type 316 stainless steel Hilti "KWIK BOLT 3", or equal — Type 316 stainless steel Hilti "KWIK BOLT TZ", or equal, Type 316 stainless steel *Post installed anchors shall always be an adhesive type anchor system except when Contractor makes a request for a specific application and Engineer approves. 2.03 STAINLESS STEEL FASTENER LUBRICANT (ANTI -SEIZING) A. Anti -seizing Lubricant for Stainless Steel Threaded Connections: 1. Suitable for wastewater supply. 2. Formulated to resist washout. 3. Acceptable Manufacturers are Bostik, Saf-T-Eze, or equal. 2.04 ANCHOR BOLT SLEEVES A. Provide anchor bolt sleeves as required by equipment manufacturer's design for minor location adjustment. 1. High density polyethylene plastic of single unit construction with deformed sidewalls such that the concrete and grout lock in place. 2. The top of the sleeve shall be self -threading to provide adjustment of the threaded anchor bolt projection. 3. Acceptable Manufacturers are Contec, Wilson, or equal. 2.05 DESIGN Anchor bolts for equipment shall be designed by the equipment manufacturer to include seismic and wind forces when applicable. 05502-4 Anchors to Concrete [and Masonry] October 2019 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • PART 3 - EXECUTION 3.01 GENERAL A. Anchor bolts shall be cast- in-place where indicated. B. Grouting of anchor bolts using plastic sleeves with non -shrink or epoxy grout, where required by equipment manufacturer's design, shall be in accordance with Section 03600. C. The threaded end of anchor bolts and all -thread rod shall be long enough to project through the entire depth of the nut and if too long, shall be cut off at t/2 -inch beyond top of nut and ground smooth. 3.02 CAST -IN-PLACE ANCHOR BOLTS Anchor bolts to be embedded in concrete shall be placed accurately and held in correct position using templates while the concrete is placed. After anchor bolts have been embedded, their threads shall be protected by grease and the nuts run on. Provide anchor bolts with sufficient length to provide for a minimum 1 0 -inch embedment (below any grout pad) unless noted to be longer based on the equipment manufacturer's design. 3.03 ADHESIVE ANCHOR BOLTS Note that adhesive anchors shall not be substituted for anchor bolts which are specifically indicated to be cast -in-place. Use of adhesive anchors shall be subject to the following conditions: 1. Limit to locations where exposure, on an intermittent or continuous basis, to acid concentrations higher than 10 percent, to chlorine gas, or to machine or diesel oils, is extremely unlikely. 2. Limit to applications where exposure to fire or exposure to concrete or rod temperature above 120 degrees F is extremely unlikely. Overhead applications (such as pipe supports) shall not be allowed. 3. Approval from Engineer for specific application and from supplier of equipment to be anchored, if applicable. 4. Anchor diameter and material shall be per equipment manufacturer's specifications. Anchor shall be threaded or deformed full length of embedment and shall be free of rust, scale, grease, and oils. 05502-5 Anchors to Concrete [and Masonry] December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT 5. Embedment depth shall be as specified by the equipment manufacturer (minimum 6 inches). 6. Follow the anchor system manufacturer's written installation instructions. 7. Holes shall have rough surfaces created by using a hammer drill with carbide bit (core drilled holes are not allowed). 8. Holes shall be blown clean with oil -free compressed air and be free of dust or standing water prior to installation. 9. Concrete and air temperature shall be compatible with curing requirements of adhesives per adhesive manufacturer instructions. Anchors shall not be placed in when concrete temperature is below 25 degrees F. 10. Anchors shall be left undisturbed and unloaded for full adhesive curing period which is based on temperature of the concrete. 3.04 EXPANSION ANCHORS Expansion (wedge type) anchors shall not be substituted for cast -in-place anchor bolts or adhesive anchors unless approved by the Engineer for a specific application. Use of expansion anchors shall be subject to conditions 3 through 8 as specified above for adhesive anchors. Expansion anchors shall not be used in a submerged condition nor in mounting of equipment subject to vibration or cyclic motion. 3.05 REINFORCING STEEL CONFLICTS WITH POST -INSTALLED ANCHOR INSTALLATION A. When reinforcing steel is encountered in the drill path, slant drill to clear obstruction and provide beveled washer to match angle of anchor. Drill shall not be slanted more than 10 degrees. B. Where slanting the drill does not resolve the conflict, notify the Project Representative and resolve the conflict to the satisfaction of the Project Representative in consultation with the Engineer. C. Abandoned post -installed anchor holes shall be cleaned and filled with non -shrink grout and struck off flush with adjacent surface. D. The costs of determining and executing the resolution shall be borne by the Contractor. The determination and execution of the resolution shall not result in additional cost to the Owner. E. Reinforcing steel in masonry shall not be damaged. G. In order to avoid or resolve a conflict, locate embedded reinforcing steel using non-destructive methods and/or redesign the attachment. 05502-6 Anchors to Concrete [and Masonry] October 2019 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • 1. Redesign shall be done by the Contractor's Professional Engineer currently registered in the State of Florida. 2. Calculations and details for redesign shall be submitted for record purpose. END OF SECTION 05502-7 Anchors to Concrete [and Masonry] December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT SEASECTION 09900 TABLE OF CONTENTS PART 1 GENERAL 0 1.01 DESCRIPTION 0 A. SCOPE: 0 B. DEFINITIONS: 0 1.02 QUALITY ASSURANCE 3 A. REFERENCES• 3 B. STANDARDIZATION: 6 C. QUALITY CONTROL REQUIREMENTS• 7 D. INSPECTION AT HOLD POINTS 8 1.03 DELIVERY AND STORAGE 9 1.04 SUBMITTALS- 10 1.05 RESPONSIBILITIES OF THE CTR 11 A. COATING SYSTEM INSTALLATION TRAINING 12 B. COATING SYSTEM INSPECTION 12 C. FINAL REPORT 13 PART 2 PRODUCTS 14 2.01 MATERIALS 14 2.02 PRODUCT DATA 20 PART 3 EXECUTION 21 3.01 COATINGS 21 A. GENERAL: 21 B. SHOP AND FIELD COATS• 21 C. APPLICATION LOCATION REQUIREMENTS: 22 3.02 PREPARATION 22 A. GENERAL: 22 • • • • B. BLAST CLEANING: 23 C. SOLVENT CLEANING: 24 D. METALLIC SURFACES. 24 E. CONCRETE SURFACES. 25 F. MASONRY SURFACES. 27 G. FIBERGLASS REINFORCED PLASTIC (FRP) SURFACES: 27 3.03 APPLICATION 27 A. WORKMANSHIP: 27 B. COATING PROPERTIES, MIXING AND THINNING: 28 C. ATMOSPHERIC CONDITIONS: 29 D. CONCRETE SUBSTRATE TEMPERATURES AND DETAIL TREATMENT: 29 E. PROTECTION OF COATED SURFACES: 30 F. METHOD OF COATING APPLICATION: 30 G. FILM THICKNESS AND CONTINUITY: 30 H. SPECIAL REQUIREMENTS: 31 I. ELECTRICAL AND INSTRUMENTATION EQUIPMENT AND MATERIALS: 31 J. SOLUBLE SALT CONTAMINATION OF METALLIC SUBSTRATES: 32 3.04 CLEANUP 32 III3.05 COATING SYSTEM SPECIFICATION SHEETS (COATSPEC) 32 Coating System Identification: E-1 37 Coating System Identification: E -1-G 39 Coating System Identification: E-2 41 Coating System Identification: E-3 43 Coating System Identification: E-4 45 Coating System Identification: E-5 (NSF 61 certified) 47 Coating System Identification: E-6 (NSF 61 certified) 49 Coating System Identification: E-7 51 Coating System Identification: E-8 52 Coating System Identification: E-9 53 Coating System Identification: E -9-C 55 Coating System Identification: E-10 57 Coating System Identification: EF -1 58 Coating System Identification: EF -2 60 Coating System Identification: EA -1 62 Coating System Identification: EA -2 65 Coating System Identification: EA -3 69 Coating System Identification: EA -4 73 Coating System Identification: EA -5 77 Coating System Identification: EC -1 82 Coating System Identification: EU -1 90 III Coating System Identification: EU -1 -FRP 92 Coating System Identification: G 93 Coating System Identification: HH -1 94 Coating System Identification: HH -2 95 Coating System Identification: L-1 96 Coating System Identification: L-2 98 Coating System Identification: L-3 99 Coating System Identification: L-4 100 Coating System Identification: M-1 101 Coating System Identification: M-2 103 Coating System Identification: S-1 104 Coating System Identification: S-2 105 Coating System Identification: S-3 106 Coating System Identification: S-4 107 3.06 COATING SYSTEMS SCHEDULE (FINISH SCHEDULE) 108 3.07 INSPECTION AND TESTING BY OWNER 120 3.08 FINAL INSPECTION 121 • • • • SECTION 09900 COATING SYSTEMS PART 1 - GENERAL 1.01 DESCRIPTION A. SCOPE: This Section 09900 specifies coating systems, surface preparations, and application requirements for coating systems. B. DEFINITIONS: Specific coating terminology used in this Section 09900 is in accordance with definitions contained in ASTM D16, ASTM D3960, and the following definitions: 1. Abrasive: Material used for blast cleaning, such as sand, grit or shot. 2. Abrasive Blast Cleaning: Cleaning/surface preparation by abrasive propelled at high speed. 3. Anchor Pattern: Profile or texture of prepared surface(s). 4. ANSI: American National Standards Institute. 5. Bug Holes: Small cavities, usually not exceeding 15 mm in diameter, resulting from entrapment of air bubbles in the surface of formed concrete during placement and compaction. 6. Coating/Paint/Lining Thickness: The total thickness of primer, intermediate and/or finish coats. 7. Coating System Applicator (CSA): A generic reference to the specialty subcontractor or subcontractors retained by the Contractor to install the coating systems specified in this Section 09900. 8. Coating System Manufacturer (CSM): Refers to the acceptable coating system manufacturer, abbreviated as the CSM. 9. Coating System Manufacturer's Technical Representative(s) (CTR): Refers to the technical representative(s) of the acceptable Coating System Manufacturer and is abbreviated as CTR. 09900-0 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT 10. Dew point: Temperature of a given air/water vapor mixture at which condensation starts. 11. Dry Film Thickness (DFT): Depth of cured film, usually expressed in mils (0.001 inch). Use this definition as opposed to existing definition. 12. Drying Time: Time interval between application and curing of material. 13. Dry to Recoat: Time interval between application of material and ability to receive next coat. • 14. Dry to Touch: Time interval between application of material and ability to touch lightly without damage. 15. Feather Edging: Reducing the thickness of the edge of paint. 16. Feathering: Operation of tapering off the edge of a point with a comparatively dry brush. 17. Field Coat: The application or the completion of application of the coating system after installation of the surface at the site of the work. 18. Hold Point: A defined point, specified in this Section 09900, at which • work shall be halted for inspection. 19. Holiday: a discontinuity, skip, or void in coating or coating system film that exposes the substrate. 20. Honeycomb: Segregated condition of hardened concrete due to non - consolidation. 21. ICRI: International Concrete Repair Institute. 22. Incompatibility: Inability of a coating to perform well over another coating because of bleeding, poor bonding, or lifting of old coating; inability of a coating to perform well on a substrate. 23. Laitance: A layer of weak, non -durable concrete containing cement fines that is brought to the surface through bleed water because of concrete finishing and/or over -finishing. 24. Mil: 0.001 inch. 25. NACE: National Association of Corrosion Engineers. 09900-1 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT ID26. Overspray: Dry spray, particularly such paint that failed to strike the • • intended surface. 27. Pinhole: A small diameter discontinuity in a coating or coating system film that is typically created by outgassing of air from a void in a concrete substrate resulting in exposure of the substrate or a void between coats. 28. Pot Life: Time interval after mixing of components during which the coating can be satisfactorily applied. 29. Resurfacer/Resurfacing Material: A layer of cementitious and/or resin - base material used to fill or otherwise restore surface continuity to worn or damaged concrete surfaces. 30. Shelf Life: Maximum storage time for which a material may be stored without losing its usefulness. 31. Shop Coat: One or more coats applied in a shop or plant prior to shipment to the site of the work, where the field or finishing coat is applied. 32. Spreading Rate: Area covered by a unit volume of paint at a specific thickness. 33. SSPC: The Society for Protective Coatings. 34. Stripe Coat: A separate coat of paint applied to all weld seems, pits, nuts/bolts/washers and edges by brush. This coat shall not be applied until any previous coat(s) have cured and, once applied, shall be allowed to cure prior to the application of the subsequent coat(s). 35. Surface Saturated Dry (SSD): Refers to concrete surface condition where the surface is saturated (damp) without the presence of standing water. 36. Tie Coat: An intermediate coat used to bond different types of paint coats. Coatings used to improve the adhesion of a succeeding coat. 37. Touch -Up Painting: The application of paint on areas of painted surfaces to repair marks, scratches, and areas where the coating has deteriorated to restore the coating film to an unbroken condition. 38. TPC: Technical Practice Committee. 39. Volatile Organic Compound (VOC) Content: The portion of the coating that is a compound of carbon, is photochemically reactive, and evaporates 09900-2 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT during drying or curing, expressed in grams per liter (g/1) or pounds per gallon (lb/gal). 40. Immersion: Refers to a service condition in which the substrate is below the waterline or submerged in water or wastewater at least intermittently if not constantly. 41. Weld Splatter: Beads of metal scattered near seam during welding. 42. Wet Film Thickness (WFT): The primer or coating film's thickness immediately following application. Wet film thickness is measured in mils or thousandths of an inch (0.001 inch) and is abbreviated WFT. 1.02 QUALITY ASSURANCE A. REFERENCES: This section contains references to the following documents. They are a part of this section as specified and modified. Where a referenced document contains references to other standards, those documents are included as references under this section as if referenced directly. In the event of conflict between the requirements of this section and those of the listed documents, the requirements of this section shall prevail. Unless otherwise specified, references to documents shall mean the documents in effect at the time of Advertisement for Bids or Invitation to Bid (or on the effective date of the Agreement if there were no Bids). If referenced documents have been discontinued by the issuing organization, references to those documents shall mean the replacement documents issued or otherwise identified by that organization or, if there are no replacement documents, the last version of the document before it was discontinued. Where document dates are given in the following listing, references to those documents shall mean the specific document version associated with that date, regardless of whether the document has been superseded by a version with a later date, discontinued, or replaced. Reference Title ANSUASC 29.4 Exhaust Systems Abrasive Blasting Operations — Ventilation and Safe Practice ANSUNSF 61 ANSI B74.18 ASTM D16 Drinking Water System Components Health Effects Grading of Certain Abrasive Grain on Coated Abrasive Material Standard Terminology for Paint, Related Coatings, Materials, and Applications 09900-3 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • • • Reference Title ASTM D2200 (SSPC-VIS1) ASTM D3960 ASTM D4262 ASTM D4263 ASTM D4414 ASTM D4417 ASTM D4541 ASTM D4787 ASTM D5162 • ASTM D7234 ASTM E337 ASTM F1869 FS 595b ICRI 03732 NACE Publication 6D- 163 NACE Publication 6F- 163 NACE Publication 6G- 164 A NACE Standards NACE Standard RP0188 Pictorial Surface Preparation Standards for Painting Steel Surfaces Standard Practice for Determining Volatile Organic Compound (VOC) Content of Paints and Related Coatings Standard Test Method for pH of Chemically Cleaned or Etched Concrete Surfaces Standard Test Method for Indicating Moisture in Concrete by the Plastic Sheet Method Standard Practice for Measurement of Wet Film Thickness by Notch Gages Standard Test Methods for Field Measurement of Surface Profile of Blast Cleaned Steel Standard Test Methods for Pull -Off Strength of Coatings On Metal Substrates Using Portable Adhesion Testers Standard Practice for Continuity Verification of Liquid or Sheet Linings Applied to Concrete Substrates Standard Practice for Discontinuity (Holiday) Testing of Nonconductive Protective Coating on Metallic Substrates Standard Test Method for Pull -Off Adhesion Strength of Coatings on Concrete Using Portable Adhesion Testers. Standard Test Method for Measuring Humidity With a Psychrometer Standard Test Method for Measuring Moisture Vapor Emission Rate of Concrete Subfloor Using Anhydrous Calcium Chloride Federal Standard Colors Guideline for Selecting and Specifying Concrete Surface Preparation for Sealers, Coatings, and Polymer Overlays A Manual for Painter Safety Surface Preparation of Steel or Concrete Tank/Interiors Surface Preparation Abrasives for Industrial Maintenance Painting January 1988 Edition of the National Association of Corrosion Engineers, TPC. Standard Recommended Practice — Discontinuity (Holiday) Testing of New Protective Coatings on Conductive Substrates 09900-4 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT Reference Title NACE Standard RP0288 NACE Standard RP0892 NACE Publication TPC2 NAPF 500-03 NAPF 500-03-04 NAPF 500-03-05 OSHA 1910.144 OSHA 1915.35 SSPC SSPC-AB 1 SSPC-PA 1 SSPC-PA 2 SSPC-PA 9 SSPC-PA Guide 1 SSPC-PA Guide 3 SSPC-PA Guide 6 SSPC-PA Guide 11 SSPC SP1 SSPC SP2 SSPC SP3 SSPC SP5 SSPC SP6 SSPC SP7 SSPC SP10 SSPC SP11 Standard Recommended Practice, Inspection of Linings on Steel and Concrete Standard Recommended Practice, Linings Over Concrete in Immersion Service Coatings and Linings for Immersion Service Surface Preparation Standard for Ductile Iron Pipe and Fittings in Exposed Locations Receiving Special External Coatings and/or Special Internal Linings Abrasive Blast Cleaning for Ductile Iron Pipe Abrasive Blast Cleaning for Cast Ductile Iron Fittings Safety Color Code for Marking Physical Hazards Standards — 29CFR - Painting Paint Application Specification No. 1. Mineral and Slag Abrasives Shop, Field, and Maintenance Painting of Steel Measurement of Dry Coating Thickness with Magnetic Gages Measurement of Dry Coating Thickness on Cementitious Substrates Using Ultrasonic Gages Guide for Illumination of Industrial Painting Project A Guide to Safety in Paint Application Guide for Containing Debris Generated During Paint Removal Operations Guide for Coating Concrete Solvent Cleaning Hand Tool Cleaning Power Tool Cleaning White Metal Blast Cleaning Commercial Blast Cleaning Brush -Off Blast Cleaning Near -White Blast Cleaning Power Tool Cleaning to Bare Metal 09900-5 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • Reference SSPC SP12 • • SSPC SP13 SSPC-TR2 SSPC-TU-3 SSPC-TU-4 SSPC V2 Title SSPC-VIS 1 SSPC-VIS 3 SSPC-VIS 4 SSPC-VIS 5 WPCF Manual of Practice No. 17 Surface Preparation and Cleaning of Steel and Other Hard Materials by High and Ultra -High Pressure Water Jetting Prior to Recoating Surface Preparation of Concrete Wet Abrasive Blast Cleaning Overcoating Field Methods for Retrieval and Analysis of Soluble Salts on Substrates. Systems and Specifications: Steel Structures Painting Manual, Volume 2 Visual Standard for Abrasive Blast Cleaned Steel Visual Standard for Power and Hand — Tool Cleaned Steel Visual Standards (Waterjetting) Visual Standards (Wet Abrasive Blast Cleaning) Paints and Protective Coatings for Wastewater Treatment Facilities. Guide and Paint Application Specifications. B. STANDARDIZATION: Materials and supplies provided shall be the standard products of CSMs. Materials in each coating system shall be the products of a single CSM. The standard products of CSMs other than those specified may be acceptable when it is demonstrated to the Construction Manager that they are equal in composition, durability, usefulness, and convenience for the purpose intended. Requests for consideration of CSMs other than those specified in this Section 09900 will be considered, provided the following minimum conditions are met. Such requests are not a substitution for submittals after the alternative CSMs have been considered and accepted. 1. The proposed coating system shall use an equal or greater number of separate coats to achieve the required total dry film thickness. 2. The proposed coating system shall use coatings of the same generic type as that specified including curing agent type. 3. Requests for consideration of products from CSMs other than those specified in this Section 09900 shall include information listed in paragraph 09900-1.04, Items 1, 2, and 3, demonstrating that the proposed CSM's product is equal to the specified coating system. 09900-6 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT 4. The Contractor and the proposed alternative CSM shall provide a list of references for the proposed product where the coating of the same generic type has been applied. The reference list shall include the project name, city, state, owner, phone number of owner; coating system reference and number from this Section 09900; type of facility in which it was used, generic type, and year coating was applied. C. QUALITY CONTROL REQUIREMENTS: 1. The Contractor is responsible for the workmanship and quality of the coating system installation. Inspections by the Construction Manager or the CTR will not relieve or limit the Contractor's responsibilities. 2. The Contractor's methods shall conform to requirements of this specification and the standards referenced in this Section 09900. Changes in the coating system installation requirements will be allowed only with the written acceptance of the Construction Manager before work commences. 3. Only personnel who are trained by the CTR specifically for this contract or who are approved by the CSM specifically for this contract shall be allowed to perform the coating system installation specified in this Section 09900. 4. Contaminated, outdated, diluted materials, and/or materials from previously opened containers shall not be used. 5. For repairs, the Contractor shall provide the same products, or products recommended by the CSM, as used for the original coating. 6. The Contractor shall identify the points of access for inspection by the Owner or the Construction Manager. The Contractor shall provide ventilation, ingress and egress, and other means necessary for the Construction Manager's personnel to access safely the work areas. 7. The Contractor shall conduct the work so that the coating system is installed as specified and shall inspect the work continually to ensure that the coating system is installed as specified. Coating system work that does not conform to the specifications or is otherwise not acceptable shall be corrected as specified. 8. The Contractor shall complete the Coating System Inspection Checklist, Form 09900-A, included in Section 01999, for coating system installations. Follow the sequential steps required for proper coating 09900-7 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • • • system installation as specified and as listed in the Coating System Inspection Checklist. For each portion of the work, install the coating system and complete sign -offs as specified prior to proceeding with the next step. After completing each step as indicated on the Coating System Inspection Checklist, the Contractor shall sign the checklist indicating that the work has been installed and inspected as specified. 9. The Contractor shall provide written daily reports that present, in summary form, test data, work progress, surfaces covered, ambient conditions, quality control inspection test findings, and other information pertinent to the coating system installation. D. INSPECTION AT HOLD POINTS The Contractor shall conduct inspections at Hold Points during the coating system installation and record the results from those inspections on Form 09900-A. The Contractor shall coordinate such Hold Points with the Construction Manager such that the Construction Manager may observe Contractor's inspections on a scheduled basis. The Contractor shall provide the Construction Manager a minimum of two (2) hours of notice prior to conducting Hold Point Inspections. The Hold Points shall be as follows: 1. Environment and Site Conditions. Prior to commencing an activity associated with coating system installation, the Contractor shall measure, record, and confirm acceptability of ambient air temperature and humidity as well as other conditions such as proper protective measures for surfaces not to be coated and safety requirements for personnel. The acceptability of the weather and/or environmental conditions within the structure shall be determined by the requirements specified by the CSM of the coating system being used. 2. Conditions Prior to Surface Preparation. Prior to commencing surface preparation, the Contractor shall observe, record, and confirm that oil, grease, and/or soluble salts have been eliminated from the surface. 3. Monitoring of Surface Preparation. Spot checking of degree of cleanliness, surface profile, and surface pH testing, where applicable. In addition, the compressed air used for surface preparation or blow down cleaning shall be checked to confirm it is free from oil and moisture. 4. Post Surface Preparation — Upon completion of the surface preparation, the Contractor shall measure and inspect for proper degree of cleanliness and surface profile as specified in this Section 09900 and in the CSM's written instructions. 09900-8 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT 5. Monitoring of Coatings Application — The Contractor shall inspect, measure, and record the wet film thickness and general film quality (visual inspection) for lack of runs, sags, pinholes, holidays, etc. as the application work proceeds. 6. Post Application Inspection — The Contractor shall identify defects in application work including pinholes, holidays, excessive runs or sags, inadequate or excessive film thickness and other problems as may be observed. 7. Post Cure Evaluation — The Contractor shall measure and inspect the overall dry film thickness. The Contractor shall conduct a DFT survey, as well as perform adhesion testing, holiday detection, or cure testing as required based on the type of project and the specific requirements in this Section 09900 and/or in the CSM's written instructions. 8. Follow-up to Corrective Actions and Final Inspection. The Contractor shall measure and reinspect corrective coating work performed to repair defects identified at prior Hold Points. This activity also includes final visual inspection along with follow-up tests such as holiday detection, adhesion tests, and DFT surveys. 1.03 DELIVERY AND STORAGE Materials shall be delivered to the job site in their original, unopened containers. Each container shall be properly labeled. Materials shall be handled and stored to prevent damage to or loss of label. Labels on material containers shall show the following information: 1. Name or title of product. 2. CSM's batch number. 3. CSM's name. 4. Generic type of material. 5. Application and mixing instructions. 6. Hazardous material identification label. 7. Shelf life expiration date. Materials shall be stored in enclosed structures and shall be protected from weather and excessive heat or cold in accordance with the CSM's recommendations. Flammable materials shall be stored in accordance with state and local requirements. Containers shall be clearly marked indicating personnel safety hazards associated with the use of or exposure to the materials. 09900-9 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • • • Safety Data Sheets (SDS) for each material shall be provided to the Construction Manager. The Contractor shall store and dispose of hazardous waste according to federal, state and local requirements. This requirement specifically addresses waste solvents and coatings. 1.04 SUBMITTALS: Provide in accordance with Section 01300: 1. A copy of this specification section, with addendum updates included, and referenced and applicable sections, with addendum updates included, with each paragraph check -marked (✓) to indicate specification compliance or marked to indicate requested deviations from specification requirements or those parts which are to be provided by the Contractor or others. Check marks shall denote full compliance with a paragraph as a whole. If deviations from the specifications are indicated, and therefore requested by the Contractor, each deviation shall be underlined and denoted by a number in the margin to the right of the identified paragraph, referenced to a detailed written explanation of the reasons for requesting the deviation. The Construction Manager shall be the final authority for determining acceptability of requested deviations. The remaining portions of the paragraph not underlined shall signify compliance on the part of the Contractor with the specifications. Failure to include a copy of the marked -up specification sections, along with justification(s) for requested deviations to the specification requirements shall be cause for rejection of the entire submittal and no further submittal material will be reviewed. 2. CSM's current printed recommendations and product data sheets for coating systems including: a. Volatile organic compound (VOC) data b. Surface preparation recommendations. c. Primer type, where required. d. Maximum dry and wet -mil thickness per coat. e. Minimum and maximum curing time between coats, including atmospheric conditions for each. f. Curing time before submergence in liquid. g. Thinner to be used with each coating. h. Ventilation requirements. i. Minimum atmospheric conditions during which the paint shall be applied. j. Allowable application methods. k. Maximum allowable moisture content. 1. Maximum shelf life. 09900-10 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT 3. Affidavits signed and sealed by an officer of the CSM's corporation, attesting to full compliance of each coating system component with current and promulgated federal, state, and local air pollution control regulations and requirements. 4. Safety Data Sheets (SDS) for materials to be delivered to the job site, including coating system materials, solvents, and abrasive blast media. 5. List of cleaning and thinner solutions allowed by the CSMs. 6. Storage requirements including temperature, humidity, and ventilation for Coating System Materials as recommended by the CSMs. 7. CSM's detailed, written instructions for coating system treatment and graphic details for coating system terminations in the structures to be coated including pipe penetrations, metal embedments, gate frames, and other terminations to be determined from the contract drawings. This information shall also include detail treatment for coating system at joints in concrete. 8. The Contractor and CSA shall provide a minimum of five project references each including contact name, address, and telephone number where similar coating work has been performed by their companies in the past five years. 1.05 RESPONSIBILITIES OF THE CTR The Contractor shall retain or obtain the services of the CTR to be on site to perform the Contractor and/or CSA application training and to routinely inspect and verify in writing that the application personnel have successfully performed surface preparation, filler/surface application, coating system application, and Quality Control Inspection in accordance with this Section 09900 and to warrantable level of quality. This must include checking the required degree of cleanliness, surface pH for concrete substrates, surface profile of substrates, proper mixing of coating materials, application (including checking the wet and dry film thickness of the coating systems), proper cure of the coating systems, and proper treatment of coating systems at terminations, transitions, and joints and cracks in substrates. Refer to Paragraph 1.05 B. for further details on these CTR requirements. This inspection is in addition to the inspection performed by the Contractor in accordance with this Section 09900. 09900-11 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • • • A. COATING SYSTEM INSTALLATION TRAINING 1. Provide a minimum of 8 hours of classroom and off site training for application and supervisory personnel (both the Contractor's and CSA's). Provide training to a minimum of two supervisory personnel from the CSA and one supervisor from the Contractor. Alternatively, the CTR shall provide a written letter from the CSM stating that the application personnel (listed by name) who shall perform coating work are approved by the CSM without further or additional training. 2. One CTR can provide training for up to fourteen application personnel and three supervisory personnel at one time. The training shall include the following as a minimum: a. A detailed explanation of mixing, application, curing, and termination details. b. Hands-on demonstration of how to mix and apply the coating systems. c. A detailed explanation of the ambient condition requirements (temperature and humidity) and surface preparation requirements for application of the coating system as well as a detailed explanation of re -coat times, cure times, and related ambient condition requirements. d. When training is performed, the CTR shall provide a written letter stating that training was satisfactorily completed by the personnel listed by name in the letter. B. COATING SYSTEM INSPECTION While on site to routinely inspect and verify, the CTR shall perform the following activities to confirm acceptability and conformance with the specifications: 1. Inspect ambient conditions during various coating system installation at hold points for conformance with the specified requirements. 2. Inspect the surface preparation of the substrates where the coating system will terminate or will be applied for conformance to the specified application criteria. 3. Inspect preparation and application of coating detail treatment (for example, terminations at joints, metal embedments in concrete, etc.). 09900-12 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT 4. Inspect application of the filler/surface materials for concrete and masonry substrates. 5. Inspect application of the primers and finish coats including wet and dry film thickness of the coatings. 6. Inspect coating systems for cure. 7. Review adhesion testing of the cured coating systems for conformance to specified criteria. 8. Review coating system continuity testing for conformance to specified criteria. 9. Inspect and record representative localized repairs made to discontinuities identified via continuity testing. 10. Conduct a final review of completed coating system installation for conformance to the specifications. 11. Prepare and submit a site visit report following each site visit that documents the acceptability of the coating work in accordance with the CSM's recommendations. C. FINAL REPORT Upon completion of coating work for the project, the CTR shall prepare a final report. That report shall summarize daily test data, observations, drawings, and photographs in a report to be submitted in accordance with paragraph 09900-2.02. Include substrate conditions, ambient conditions, and application procedures, observed during the CTR's site visits. Include a statement that the completed work was performed in accordance with the requirements of this Section 09900 and the CSM's recommendations. 09900-13 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • • • PART 2 - PRODUCTS 2.01 MATERIALS Notwithstanding the listing of product names in this Section 09900, the Contractor shall provide affidavits, signed and sealed by an officer of the CSM's corporation, attesting to full compliance of each coating system component with current and promulgated federal, state, and local air pollution control regulations and requirements. No coatings shall be applied to a surface until the specified affidavits have been submitted and have been reviewed and accepted. Failure to comply with this requirement shall be cause for rejection and removal of such materials from the site. The following list specifies the material requirements for coating systems. Coating systems are categorized by generic name followed by an identifying abbreviation. If an abbreviation has a suffix number, it is for identifying subgroups within the coating system. Coating Systems E-5 and E-6 shall be NSF 61 certified. 09900-14 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT All of U.S. Except California Coating System Enoxv Coatings CSM First Coat(s) Finish Coat(s) E-1 PPG PMC Carboline International Paint/ICI * Sherwin Williams Tnemec Amerlock 2/400 Series Carboguard 890 Devran 224 HS Macropoxy 646 Series V69 Amerlock 2/400 Series Carboguard 890 Devran 224 Macropoxy 646 Series V69 E -1-G PPG PMC Carboline International Paint/ICI * Sherwin Williams Tnemec Amerlock 2/400 Series Carboguard 894 Devran 223/224HS Macropoxy 646 B67-600 Series V27 or V69 Amerlock 2/400 Series Carboguard 894 Devran 224HS Macropoxy 646 B67-600 Series V69 E-2 PPG PMC Carboline International Paint/ICI Sherwin Williams Tnemec Amerlock 2/400 Series Carboguard 890 Bar -Rust 236 Sea Guard 6000 Epoxy Ni 1-400 Series V27 or V69 Amerlock 2/400 Series Carboguard 890 Bar -Rust 236 Sea Guard 6000 Epoxy N11- 400 Series V69 E-3 PPG PMC Carboline International Paint/ICI Sherwin Williams Tnemec Amerlock 2/400 Series Carboguard 890 Bar -Rust 236 Sea Guard 6000 Epoxy N11-400 Series V69 Amerlock 2/400 Series Carboguard 890 Bar -Rust 236 Sea Guard 6000 Epoxy N11- 400 Series V69 E-4 PPG PMC Carboline International Paint/ICI Sherwin Williams Tnemec Amerlock 2/400 Series Carboguard 890 Bar -Rust 236 Macropoxy 646 Series V69 Amerlock 2/400 Series Carboguard 890 Bar -Rust 236 Macropoxy 646 Series V69 E-5 PPG PMC Amercoat 395FD Amercoat 395FD 09900-15 Coating Systems Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) December 2020 City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • • • • All of U.S. Except California Coating System CSM First Coat(s) Finish Coat(s) Carboline International Paint/ICI Sherwin Williams Tnemec Carboguard 691 Bar -Rust 233H Macropoxy 646 Series V69 Carboguard 691 Bar -Rust 233H Macropoxy 646 Series V69 E6 PPG PMC Carboline International Paint/ICI Sherwin Williams Tnemec Amercoat 395FD Carboguard 691 Tru -Glaze 4408 - WB Macropoxy 646 Series V69 Amercoat 395FD Carboguard 691 Tru -Glaze 4408 - WB Macropoxy 646 Series V69 E7 PPG PMC Carboline International Paint/ICI Sherwin Williams Tnemec Amercoat 385 Sanitile 120 Bar -Rust 236 Macropoxy 646 Series V69 Amercoat 385 Carboguard 890 Bar -Rust 236 Macropoxy 646 Series V69 E8 PPG PMC Carboline International Paint/ICI Sherwin Williams Tnemec Amercoat 385 Carboguard 1340 Prep and Prime (Gripper) Macropoxy 646 Series 201 Amercoat 385 Carboguard 1340 Tru -Glaze 4408 - WB Macropoxy 646 Series 201 E-9 PPG PMC Carboline International Paint/ICI Sherwin Williams Tnemec Amercoat 395 FD Carboguard 890 Bar -Rust 231 Sea Guard 6000 Epoxy N11-400 Series 104 Amercoat 395 FD Carboguard 890 Bar -Rust 231 Sea Guard 6000 Epoxy N11- 400 Series 104 E -9-C PPG PMC Carboline Intemational Paint/ICI Amercoat 395 FD Carboguard 890 Bar -Rust 231 Amercoat 395 FD Carboguard 890 Bar -Rust 231 Coating Systems Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) 09900-16 December 2020 City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT All of U.S. Except California Coating System CSM First Coat(s) Finish Coat(s) EA -2 Sherwin Williams Tnemec Sea Guard 6000 Epoxy N11-400 Series 104 Sea Guard 6000 Epoxy N11- 400 Series 104 E-10 PPG PMC Carboline International Paint/ICI Sherwin Williams Tnemec Amerlock 2/400 Series Carboguard 890 Bar -Rust 236 Macropoxy 646 Series V69 Amerlock 2/400 Series Carboguard 890 Bar -Rust 236 Macropoxy 646 Series V69 Specialty Epoxy Linings EA -1 Carboline Sauereisen Tnemec Plasite 4500S Sewergard 210S Series 435 Plasite 4500S Sewergard 210S Series 435 EA -2 Carboline Carboguard Sauereisen Tnemec Plasite 4500S Sewergard 210S Series 435 Filler Surfacer— Carboguard 510 Filler Surfacer - 209 HB Filler Surfacer — Series 218 Plasite 4500S Sewergard 210S Series 435 EA -3 Carboline Sauereisen Tnemec N/A N/A N/A Filler Surfacer— Carboguard 510 Filler Surfacer - 209 HB Filler Surfacer — Series 218 Plasite 5371 Sewergard 210T Series 434 Coating System CSM Primer Base Coat Glaze Coat EA -4 Carboline Sauereisen Tnemec N/A N/A N/A Plasite 5371 Sewergard 210T Series 434 Plasite 4500S Sewergard 210G Series 435 Coating System CSM Primer Filler/ Surfacer Base Coat w/Scim Cloth Saturation Coat w/Silica Sand Finish Coats EA -5 Tnemec Carboline Series 201 Semstone 110/110EP Series 218 Carboguard 510 Series 239 Semstone 145 Series 239 Semstone 145 Series 282 Semstone 145 09900-17 Coating Systems Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) December 2020 City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • All of U.S. Except California Coatin S stem CSM First Coat s Finish Coat s Elastomeric Coatings EC -1 Carboline Sherwin Williams Tnemec Carboguard 671 Corobond 100 Series 1 Polibrid 705 (2 coats) Envirolastic 170 (2 coats) Series 406 (2 coats) EC -2 Carboline Sherwin Williams Tnemec Carboguard 671 Corobond 100 Series V69 Polibrid 705 (2 coats) Envirolastic 520PW (2 coats) Series 264 *See CSM's Product Data Sheets for acceptable thinners for VOC compliance or do not thin. r.poxy r tooring bvstems Coating System CSM Primer Intermediate Coat Finish Coat EF -1 Stonhard Tnemec Stonhard Standard Primer Series 238 Stonshield Undercoat and Broadcoat Series 238 with Broadcoat Stoneshield Sealer Series 284 Clear EF -2 Stonhard Tnemec Stonhard Standard Primer Series 238 Stonclad GS Series 238 Stonkote GS -4 Series 280 Epoxy Polyurethane Grease G Texaco N/A 09900-18 Coating Systems Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) Rust Inhibitive Grease December 2020 City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT Primer Coat(s) Intermediate Coat(s) EU -1 PPG PMC Amercoat Amercoat 385 Amercoat 450H Carboline Carbozinc 859 Carboguard 890 Carbothane 134 VOC International Cathacoat 313 Devran 233 or 224HS Devthane 379 Paint/ICI Sherwin Williams Zinc Clad IV Macropoxy 646 Hi Solids Polyurethane Tnemec Series 90-97 Series V69 Series 1075 EU -1 -FRP PPG PMC Amerlock 2/400 Series Amershield VOC Carboline Carbocrylic 120 Carbothane 134 VOC International Devran 223/224 Devthane 378H Paint/ICI Sherwin Williams Macropoxy 646 High Solids Polyurethane Tnemec Series V27 Series 1075 Grease G Texaco N/A 09900-18 Coating Systems Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) Rust Inhibitive Grease December 2020 City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT All of U.S. Except California Coating System CSM First Coat(s) Finish Coat(s) Chevron N/A E.P. Roller Grease Hiah Heat HH -1 High Temperature Hi Temp 1027 1000 VS (any color) L-2 Coatings, Inc. Amercoat 220 Carbocrylic 120 Prep and Prime Gripper Sher Cryl HPA Series 1028 or 1029 Amercoat 220 Carbocrylic 3359 Ultrahide 250-1406 Sher Cryl HPA Series 1028 or 1029 HH -2 High Temperature Hi Temp 1027 1000 VS (black or aluminum) L-4 Coatings, Inc. Amercoat 148 Sanitile 120 Prepared Prime Gripper Prep Rite ProBlock Series 1028 or 1029 Amercoat 220 Sanitile 155 Ultrahide 250-1406 Sher Cryl HPA Series 1028 or 1029 Latex Acrylic L-1 PPG PMC Carboline International Paint/ICI Sherwin Williams Tnemec Amercoat 148 Carbocrylic 120 UH Gripper 3210 Loxon Acrylic Primer Series 1028 or 1029 Amercoat 220 Carbocrylic 3359 Dulux Pro 1406 Sher Cryl HPA Series 1028 or 1029 L-2 PPG PMC Carboline International Paint/ICI Sherwin Williams Tnemec Amercoat 220 Carbocrylic 120 Prep and Prime Gripper Sher Cryl HPA Series 1028 or 1029 Amercoat 220 Carbocrylic 3359 Ultrahide 250-1406 Sher Cryl HPA Series 1028 or 1029 L-3 PPG PMC Carboline International Paint/ICI Sherwin Williams Tnemec Amercoat 148 Carbocrylic 3359 DTM Devflex 4020 PF Procryl Primer Series 1028 or 1029 Amercoat 220 Carbocrylic 3359 DTM Dulux Pro 1406 Sher Cryl HPA Series 1028 or 1029 L-4 PPG PMC Carboline International Paint/ICI Sherwin Williams Tnemec Amercoat 148 Sanitile 120 Prepared Prime Gripper Prep Rite ProBlock Series 1028 or 1029 Amercoat 220 Sanitile 155 Ultrahide 250-1406 Sher Cryl HPA Series 1028 or 1029 09900-19 Coating Systems Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) December 2020 City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • All of U.S. Except California Coating System CSM Miscellaneous First Coat(s) Finish Coat(s) M-1 Carboline Carbowrap Priming Paste Tape A, B, or C (temp. dependent) S-1 Denso Denso Paste Densyl Tape S-2 Trenton Waxtape Primer #1 Wax Tape M-2 Carboline Carbomastic 15 Carbomastic 15 S-4 International Bar -Rust 231 (231K 9100) Bar -Rust 231 (231K 9100) Paint/ICI Sherwin Williams Epoxy Mastic Aluminum II Epoxy Mastic Aluminum II Tnemec Series 135 (1243) Series 135 (1243) Penetrating Stain *See CSM's Product Data Sheets for acceptable thinners for VOC compliance or do not thin. 2.02 PRODUCT DATA A. Prior to application of coatings, submit letter(s) from the CTR(s) identifying the application personnel who have satisfactorily completed training as specified in paragraph 09900-1.05 or a letter from the CSM stating that personnel who shall perform the work are approved by the CSM without need for further or additional training. 09900-20 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT CSM Primer Finish S-1 Carboline Intemational Paint/ICI Sherwin Williams Tnemec Carbocrete Sealer WB Groundworks H&C Acrylic Concrete Stain Series 617 Carbocrete Sealer WB Groundworks H&C Acrylic Concrete Stain Series 617 S-2 Tnemec Curecrete Chemical Company N/A N/A Series 636 Dur A Pell 20 Ashford Formula S-3 Tnemec N/A Series V626 Dur A Pell GS S-4 Tnemec Professional Products of Kansas N/A N/A Series V626 Dur A Pell GS PWS -15 Super *See CSM's Product Data Sheets for acceptable thinners for VOC compliance or do not thin. 2.02 PRODUCT DATA A. Prior to application of coatings, submit letter(s) from the CTR(s) identifying the application personnel who have satisfactorily completed training as specified in paragraph 09900-1.05 or a letter from the CSM stating that personnel who shall perform the work are approved by the CSM without need for further or additional training. 09900-20 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT B. Submit reports specified in paragraph 09900-1.02 C.10 and 09900-1.05 B.12 when the work is underway. C. Submit the Coating System Inspection Checklists, using Form 09900-A, included in Section 01999, for the coating work. D. CTR final report in accordance with paragraph 09900-1.05 C. PART 3 - EXECUTION 3.01 COATINGS A. GENERAL: Coating products shall not be used until the Construction Manager has accepted the affidavits specified in paragraph 09900-1.04 and 2.01, the Construction Manager has inspected the materials, and the CTR has trained the Contractor and CSA in the surface preparation, mixing and application of each coating system. B. SHOP AND FIELD COATS: 1. SHOP APPLIED PRIME COAT: Except as otherwise specified, prime coats may be shop -applied or field -applied. Shop -applied primer shall be compatible with the specified coating system and shall be applied at the minimum dry film thickness recommended by the CSM. Data sheets identifying the shop primer used shall be provided to the on-site coating application personnel. Adhesion tests shall be performed on the shop primer as specified in paragraph 09900-3.01B.3. Damaged, deteriorated and poorly applied shop coatings that do not meet the requirements of this Section 09900 shall be removed and the surfaces recoated. If the shop primer coat meets the requirements of this Section 09900, the field coating may consist of touching up the shop prime coat and then applying the finish coats to achieve the specified film thickness and continuity. 2. FIELD COATS: Field coats shall consist of one or more prime coats and one or more finish coats to build up the coating to the specified dry film thickness. Unless otherwise specified, finish coats shall not be applied until other work in the area is complete and until previous coats have been inspected. 3. ADHESION CONFIRMATION: The Contractor shall perform an adhesion test after proper cure in accordance with ASTM D3359 to demonstrate that (1) the shop applied prime coat adheres to the substrate, and (2) the specified field coatings adhere to the shop coat. Test results showing an adhesion rating of 5A on immersed surfaces and 4A or better 09900-21 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • on other surfaces shall be considered acceptable for coatings 5 mils or more in thickness (Method A). Test results showing an adhesion rating of 5B on immersed surfaces and 4B or better on other surfaces shall be considered acceptable for coating thicknesses less than 5 mils. C. APPLICATION LOCATION REQUIREMENTS: 1. EQUIPMENT, NONIMMERSED: Items of equipment, or parts of equipment that are not immersed in service, shall be shop primed and then finish coated in the field after installation with the specified or acceptable color. If the shop primer requires topcoating within a specified period, the equipment shall be finish coated in the shop and then touch-up painted after installation. If equipment removal and reinstallation is required for the project, touch-up coating work shall be performed in the field following installation. 2. EQUIPMENT, IMMERSED: Items of equipment, or parts and surfaces of equipment that are immersed when in service, with the exception of pumps and valves, shall have surface preparation and coating work performed in the field. Coating systems applied to immersed equipment shall be pinhole free. 3. STEEL WATER TANKS: The interior surfaces of steel water tanks or reservoirs shall have surface preparation and coating work performed in the field. D. Erect and maintain protective enclosures as stipulated per SSPC-Guide 6 Guide for Containing Debris Generated During Paint Removal Operations. 3.02 PREPARATION A. GENERAL: Surface preparations for each type of surface shall be in accordance with the specific requirements of each coating specification sheet (COATSPEC) and the following. In the event of a conflict, the COATSPEC sheets shall take precedence. Surfaces to be coated shall be clean and dry. Before applying coating or surface treatments, oil, grease, dirt, rust, loose mill scale, old weathered coatings, and other foreign substances shall be removed. Oil and grease shall be removed before mechanical cleaning is started. Where mechanical cleaning is accomplished by blast cleaning, the abrasive used shall be washed, graded and free from contaminants that might interfere with the adhesion of the coatings. 09900-22 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT The air used for blast cleaning shall be sufficiently free of oil and moisture so as not to cause detrimental contamination of the surfaces to be coated. Where deemed necessary by the Owner's representative, a NACE International certified coatings inspector, provided by the Owner, will inspect and approve surfaces to be coated before application of a coating. Surface defects identified by the inspector shall be corrected by the Contractor at no additional cost to the Owner. Cleaning and painting shall be scheduled so that dust and spray from the cleaning process shall not fall on wet, newly coated surfaces. Hardware, hardware accessories, nameplates, data tags, machined surfaces, sprinkler heads, electrical fixtures, and similar uncoated items which are in contact with coated surfaces shall be removed or masked prior to surface preparation and painting operations. Following completion of coating, removed items shall be reinstalled. Equipment adjacent to walls shall be disconnected and moved to permit cleaning and painting of equipment and walls and, following painting, shall be replaced and reconnected. B. BLAST CLEANING: When abrasive blast cleaning is required to achieve the specified surface preparation the following requirements for blast cleaning materials and equipment shall be met: 1. Used or spent blast abrasive shall not be reused on this project. 2. The compressed air used for blast cleaning shall be filtered and shall contain no condensed water and no oil. Moisture traps shall be cleaned at least once every four hours or more frequently as required to prevent moisture from entering the supply air to the abrasive blasting equipment. 3. Oil separators shall be installed just downstream of compressor discharge valves and at the discharge of the blast pot discharges. These shall be checked on the same frequency as the moisture traps as defined in item 2 above. 4. Regulators, gauges, filters, and separators shall be in use on compressor air lines to blasting nozzles times during this work. 5. An air dryer or desiccant filter drying unit shall be installed which dries the compressed air prior to blast pot connections. This dryer shall be used and maintained for the duration of surface preparation work. 09900-23 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • 6. The abrasive blast nozzles used shall be of the venturi or other high velocity type supplied with a minimum of 100 psig air pressure and sufficient volume to obtain the blast cleaning production rates and cleanliness/specified. 7. The Contractor shall provide ventilation for airborne particulate evacuation (meeting pertinent safety standards) to optimize visibility for both blast cleaning and inspection of the substrate during surface preparation work. 8. If, between final surface preparation work and coating system application, contamination of prepared and cleaned metallic substrates occurs, or if the prepared substrates' appearance darkens or changes color, recleaning by water blasting, reblasting and abrasive blast cleaning shall be required until the specified degree of cleanliness is reclaimed. 9. The Contractor is responsible for dust control and for protection of mechanical, electrical, and other equipment adjacent to and surrounding the work area. C. SOLVENT CLEANING: Any solvent wash, solvent wipe, or cleaner used, including but not limited to those used for surface preparation in accordance with SSPC SP -1 Solvent Cleaning and shall be of the emulsifying type which emits no more than 340 g/1 VOCs for AIM regions, 250 g/1 for CARB regions and 100 g/1 for SCAQMD regions, contains no phosphates, is biodegradable, removes no zinc, and is compatible with the specified primer. Clean white cloths and clean fluids shall be used in solvent cleaning. D. METALLIC SURFACES: Metallic surfaces shall be prepared in accordance with applicable portions of surface preparation specifications of the Society for Protective Coatings (SSPC) specified for each coating system. See Coat Spec for each coating system in this Section 09900. The profile depth of the surface to be coated shall be in accordance with the COATSPEC requirements in this Section measured by Method C of ASTM D4417. Blast particle size shall be selected by the Contractor to produce the specified surface profile. The solvent in solvent cleaning operations shall be as recommended by the CSM. Preparation of metallic surfaces shall be based upon comparison with SSPC- VIS1-89 (ASTM D2200), and as described in the Coat Spec for each coating system. If dry abrasive blast cleaning is selected and to facilitate inspection, the 09900-24 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT Contractor shall, on the first day of cleaning operations, abrasive blast metal panels to the standards specified. Plates shall measure a minimum of 8-1/2 inches by 11 inches. Panels meeting the requirements of the specifications shall be initialed by the Contractor and the Construction Manager and coated with a clear non -yellowing finish. One of these panels shall be prepared for each type of abrasive blasting and shall be used as the comparison standard throughout the project. Blast cleaning requirements for steel, ductile iron and stainless steel substrates are as follows: 1. Steel piping shall be prepared in accordance with SSPC SP -6 (Commercial Blast Cleaning) and primed before installation. Ductile iron piping surfaces including fittings shall be prepared in accordance with NAPF 500-03, NAPF 500-03-04, and NAPF 500-03-05. 2. Stainless steel surfaces shall be abrasive blast cleaned to leave a clean uniform appearance with a minimum surface profile of 1.5 to 2.5 mils that is uniform. 3. Remove traces of grit, dust, dirt, rust scale, friable material, loose corrosion products or embedded abrasive from substrate by vacuum cleaning prior to coating application. 4. Care must be taken to prevent contamination of the surface after blasting from worker's fingerprints, deleterious substances on workers' clothing, or from atmospheric conditions. 5. Ambient environmental conditions in the enclosure must be constantly monitored and maintained to ensure the degree of cleanliness is held and no "rust back" occurs prior to coating material application. E. CONCRETE SURFACES: 1. Inspection of concrete surfaces prior to surface preparation and surface preparation of concrete surfaces shall be performed in accordance with SSPC-SP13 (also called NACE 6). 2. Prepare substrate cracks, areas requiring resurfacing and perform detail treatment including but not limited to, terminating edges, per CSM recommendations. This shall precede surface preparation for degree of cleanliness and profile. 3. The surface profile for prepared concrete surfaces to be coated shall be evaluated by comparing the profile of the prepared concrete with the 09900-25 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • • • profile of graded abrasive paper, as described in ANSI B74.18 or by comparing the profile with the ICRI 03732 (surface profile replicas). Surface profile requirements shall be in accordance with the Coat Spec requirements and the CSM's recommendations. 4. Surface cleanliness of prepared concrete substrates shall be inspected after cleaning, preparation, and/or drying, but prior to making repairs or applying a coat in the coating system. If concrete surfaces are repaired, they shall be reinspected for surface cleanliness prior to application of the coating system. 5. Surface preparation of concrete substrates shall be accomplished using methods such as dry abrasive blast cleaning, high, or ultra high-pressure water blast cleaning in accordance with SSPC-SP-13. The selected cleaning method shall produce the requirements set forth below. a. A clean substrate that is free of calcium sulfate, loose coarse or fine aggregate, laitance, loose hydrated cement paste, and otherwise deleterious substances shall be achieved. Blast cleaning and other means necessary shall be used to open up air voids or bugholes to expose their complete perimeter. Leaving shelled over, hidden air voids beneath the exposed concrete surface is not acceptable. Concrete substrate must be dry prior to the application of filler/surface or coating system materials. Acceptable surface preparation must produce a concrete surface with a minimum pH of 8.0 to be confirmed by surface pH testing. If after surface preparation, the surface pH remains below 8.0, perform additional water blasting, cleaning, or abrasive blast cleaning until additional pH testing indicates an acceptable pH level. b. Following inspection by the Contractor of the concrete surface preparation, thoroughly vacuum clean concrete surfaces to be coated to remove loose dirt, and spent abrasive (if dry blast cleaning is used) leaving a dust free, sound concrete substrate. Debris produced by blast cleaning shall be removed from the structures to be coated and disposed of legally off site by the Contractor. 6. Should abrasive blast cleaning or high or ultrahigh pressure water blasting not remove degraded concrete, chipping or other abrading tools shall be used to remove the deteriorated concrete until a sound, clean substrate is achieved which is free of calcium sulfate, loose coarse or fine aggregate, laitance, loose hydrated cement paste, and otherwise deleterious 09900-26 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT substances. Concrete substrates must be dry prior to the application of filler/surfacers or coating system materials. 7. Surface cleanliness of prepared concrete substrates shall be inspected after cleaning, preparation, and/or drying, but prior to application of coating materials. If concrete surfaces are repaired, they shall be reinspected for surface cleanliness and required surface profile prior to application of the coating system. 8. Moisture content of concrete to be coated shall be tested in accordance with ASTM D4263, Standard Test Method for Indicating Moisture in Concrete by the Plastic Sheet Method and ASTM F 1869, Standard Test Method for Measuring Moisture Vapor Emission Rate of Concrete Subfloor Using Anhydrous Calcium Chloride. The ASTM D4263 plastic sheet test shall be conducted at least once for every 500 sq. ft. of surface area to be coated. The presence of any moisture on plastic sheet following test period constitutes a non -acceptable test. For concrete surfaces to be coated which are on the negative or back side of concrete walls or structures exposed to soils (back filled) or immersed and waterproofed, perform calcium chloride tests in accordance with ASTM F-1869 once for each 500 sq. ft. of surface area to be coated. Comply with CSM's written recommendations regarding acceptance/non-acceptance of moisture vapor emissions. F. MASONRY SURFACES: 1. Prepare masonry surfaces such as Concrete Masonry Units (CMU) to remove chalk, loose dirt, dried mortar splatter, dust, peeling, or loose existing coatings, or otherwise deleterious substances to leave a clean, sound substrate. 2. Be certain masonry surfaces are dry prior to coating application. If pressure washing or low-pressure water blast cleaning is used for preparation, allow the masonry to dry for at least 5 days under dry weather conditions or when the minimum ambient temperature is 70 degrees F prior to coating application work. G. FIBERGLASS REINFORCED PLASTIC (FRP) SURFACES: Prepare FRP surfaces by sanding to establish uniform surface roughness and to remove gloss from the resin in the FRP. Next, vacuum clean to remove loose FRP dust, dirt, and other materials. Next, solvent clean using clean white rags and allow solvent to evaporate completely before application of coating materials. 3.03 APPLICATION A. WORKMANSHIP: 09900-27 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • • 1. Coated surfaces shall be free from runs, drips, ridges, waves, laps, and brush marks. Coats shall be applied to produce an even film of uniform thickness completely coating corners and crevices. 2. The Contractor's equipment shall be designed for application of the materials specified. Compressors shall have suitable traps and filters to remove water and oils from the air. A paper blotter test shall be performed by the Contractor when requested by the Construction Manager to determine if the air is sufficiently free of oil and moisture so as not to produce deteriorating effects on the coating system. The amount of oil and moisture in spray air shall be less than the amount recommended by the CSM. Spray equipment shall be equipped with mechanical agitators, pressure gages, and pressure regulators, and spray nozzles of the proper sizes. 3. Each coat of coating material shall be applied evenly and sharply cut to line. Care shall be exercised to avoid overspraying or spattering paint on surfaces not to be coated. Glass, hardware, floors, roofs, and other adjacent areas and installations shall be protected by taping, drop cloths, or other suitable measures. III 4. Coating applications method shall be conventional or airless spray, brush or roller, or trowel as recommended by CSM. 5. Allow each coat to cure or dry thoroughly, according to CSM's printed instructions, prior to recoating. • 6. Vary color for each successive coat for coating systems when possible. 7. When coating complex steel shapes, prior to overall coating system application, stripe coat welds, edges of structural steel shapes, metal cut- outs, pits in steel surfaces, or rough surfaces with the primer coat. This involves applying a separate coat using brushes or rollers to ensure proper coverage. Stripe coat via spray application is not permitted. B. COATING PROPERTIES, MIXING AND THINNING: Coatings, when applied, shall provide a satisfactory film and smooth even surface. Glossy undercoats shall be lightly sanded to provide a surface suitable for the proper application and adhesion of subsequent coats. Coating materials shall be thoroughly stirred, strained, and kept at a uniform consistency during application. Coatings consisting of two or more components shall be mixed in accordance with the CSM's instructions. Where necessary to suit the conditions of the surface, temperature, weather and method of application, the coating may be 09900-28 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT thinned as recommended by the CSM immediately prior to use. The volatile organic content (VOC) of the coating as applied shall comply with prevailing air pollution control regulations. Unless otherwise specified, coatings shall not be reduced more than necessary to obtain the proper application characteristics. Thinner shall be as recommended by the CSM. C. ATMOSPHERIC CONDITIONS: Coatings shall be applied only to surfaces that are dry, and only under conditions of evaporation rather than condensation. Coatings systems shall not be applied during rainy, misty weather, or to surfaces upon which there is frost or moisture condensation. During damp weather, when the temperature of the surface to be coated is within 10 degrees F of the dew point, forced dehumidification equipment may be used to maintain a temperature of minimum 40 degrees F and 10 degrees F above the dew point for the surfaces to be coated, the coated surface, and the atmosphere in contact with the surface. These conditions shall be maintained for a period of at least 8 hours or as recommended by the CSM. Where conditions causing condensation are severe, dehumidification equipment, fans, and/or heaters shall be used inside enclosed areas to maintain the required atmospheric and surface temperature requirements for proper coating application and cure. D. CONCRETE SUBSTRATE TEMPERATURES AND DETAIL TREATMENT: 1. When the surface temperatures of the concrete substrates to be coated are rising or when these substrates are in direct sunlight, outgassing of air from the concrete may result in bubbling, pinhole formations, and/or blistering in the coating system. The application of the filler/surface and the coating system will only be allowed during periods of falling temperature. This will require that application of the filler/surface and coating system shall only occur during the cooler evening hours. Contractor shall include any cost for working outside of normal hours in the bid. Should bubbles, pinholes, or discontinuities form in the applied coating system material, they shall be repaired as recommended by the CSM. Should pinholes develop in the filler/surfacer material or in the first coat of the coating material, the pinholes shall be repaired in accordance with the CSM's recommendations prior to application of the next coat of material. Whenever pinholes occur, the air void behind or beneath the pinhole shall be opened up completely and then completely filled with the specified filler/surfacer material. Next, the coated area around the pinhole repair shall be abraded and the coating reapplied over that area. 09900-29 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • • • 2. Perform application detail work per CSM's current written recommendations and/or drawings. E. PROTECTION OF COATED SURFACES: Items that have been coated shall not be handled, worked on, or otherwise disturbed, until the coating is completely dry and hard. After delivery at the site, and upon permanent erection or installation, shop -coated metalwork shall be recoated or retouched with specified coating when it is necessary to maintain the integrity of the film. F. METHOD OF COATING APPLICATION: 1. Where two or more coats are required, alternate coats shall contain sufficient compatible color additive to act as indicator of coverage, or the alternate coats shall be of contrasting colors. Color additives shall not contain lead, or lead compounds, which may be destroyed or affected by hydrogen sulfide or other corrosive gas, and/or chromium. 2. Mechanical equipment, on which the equipment manufacturer's coating is acceptable, shall be touch-up primed and coated with two coats of the specified coating system to match the color scheduled. Electrical and instrumentation equipment specified in Divisions 16 and 17 shall be coated as specified in paragraph 09900-3.03 I. 3. Coatings shall not be applied to a surface until it has been prepared as specified. The primer or first coat shall be applied by brush to ferrous surfaces that are not blast -cleaned. Coats for blast -cleaned ferrous surfaces and subsequent coats for nonblast-cleaned ferrous surfaces may be either brush or spray applied. After the prime coat is dry, pinholes and holidays shall be marked, repaired in accordance with CSM's recommendations and retested before succeeding coats are applied. Unless otherwise specified, coats for concrete and masonry shall be brushed, rolled, or troweled. G. FILM THICKNESS AND CONTINUITY: 1. WFT of the first coat of the coating system and subsequent coats shall be verified by the Contractor, following application of each coat. 2. The surface area covered per gallon of coating for various types of surfaces shall not exceed those recommended by the CSM. The first coat, referred to as the prime coat, on metal surfaces refers to the first full paint coat and not to solvent wash, grease emulsifiers or other pretreatment applications. Coatings shall be applied to the thickness specified, and in 09900-30 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT accordance with these specifications. Unless otherwise specified, the average total thickness (dry) of a completed protective coating system on exposed metal surfaces shall be not less than 1.25 mils per coat. The minimum thickness at any point shall not deviate more than 25 percent from the required average. Unless otherwise specified, no less than two coats shall be applied. 3. In testing for continuity of coating about welds, projections (such as bolts and nuts), and crevices, the Construction Manager shall determine the minimum conductivity for smooth areas of like coating where the dry -mil thickness has been accepted. This conductivity shall be the minimum required for these rough or irregular areas. Pinholes and holidays shall be recoated to the required coverage. 4. The ability to obtain specified film thickness is generally compromised when brush or roller application methods are used and, therefore, more coats may need to be applied to achieve the specified dry film thickness. 5. For concrete substrates, the Contractor shall apply a complete skim coat of the specified filler/surfacer material over the entire substrate prior to application of the coating system. This material shall be applied such that all open air voids and bugholes in the concrete substrate are completely filled prior to coating application. H. SPECIAL REQUIREMENTS: Before erection, the Contractor shall apply all but the final finish coat to interior surfaces of roof plates, roof rafters and supports, pipe hangers, piping in contact with hangers, and contact surfaces that are inaccessible after assembly. The final coat shall be applied after erection. Structural friction connections and high tensile bolts and nuts shall be coated after erection. Areas damaged during erection shall be hand -cleaned or power -tool cleaned and recoated with primer coat prior to the application of subsequent coats. Touch-up of surfaces shall be performed after installation. Surfaces to be coated shall be clean and dry at the time of application. Except for those to be filled with grout, the underside of equipment bases and supports that have not been galvanized shall be coated with at least two coats of primer specified for system E-2 prior to setting the equipment in place. Provide coating system terminations at leading edges and transitions to other substrates in accordance with the CSM's recommendations or detail drawings. I. ELECTRICAL AND INSTRUMENTATION EQUIPMENT AND MATERIALS: Electrical and instrumentation equipment and materials shall be coated by the equipment manufacturer as specified below. 09900-31 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • 1. FINISH: Electrical equipment shall be treated with zinc phosphate, bonderized or otherwise given a rust -preventive treatment. Equipment shall be primed, coated with enamel, and baked. Minimum dry film thickness shall be 3 mils. Unless otherwise specified, instrumentation panels shall be coated with system E-1 for indoor mounting and system EU -1 for outdoor mounting. Before final acceptance, the Contractor shall touch up scratches on equipment with identical color coating. Finish shall be smooth, free of runs, and match existing finish. Prior to touching up scratches, Contractor shall fill them with an appropriate filler material approved by the CSM. 2. COLOR: Exterior color of electrical equipment shall be FS 26463 (ANSI/NSF 61) light gray. Interior shall be painted FS 27880 white. Nonmetallic electrical enclosures and equipment shall be the equipment manufacturer's standard grey color. Exterior color of instrumentation panels and cabinets mounted indoors shall be FS 26463 light gray; unless otherwise specified, exterior color for cabinets mounted outdoors shall be FS 27722, white. Cabinet interiors shall be FS 27880, white. J. SOLUBLE SALT CONTAMINATION OF METALLIC SUBSTRATES: Contractor shall test in accordance with SSPC-TU-4 metallic substrates to be coated that have been exposed to seawater or coastal air or to industrial fallout of particulate or other sources of soluble chlorides (such as wastewater exposure). If testing indicates detrimental levels of soluble salts, those in excess of 25 ppm, the Contractor shall clean and prepare these surfaces to remove the soluble salts. 3.04 CLEANUP Upon completion of coating, the Contractor shall remove surplus materials, protective coverings, and accumulated rubbish, and thoroughly clean surfaces and repair overspray or other coating -related damage. 3.05 COATING SYSTEM SPECIFICATION SHEETS (COATSPEC) Coating systems for different types of surfaces and general service conditions for which these systems are normally applied are specified on the following COATSPEC sheets. Surfaces shall be coated in accordance with the COATSPEC to the system thickness specified. Coating systems shall be as specified in paragraph 09900-3.06, Coating 09900-32 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18-0047-UTT System Schedule. In case of conflict between the schedule and the COATSPECS, the requirements of the schedule shall prevail. Coating Specification Sheets included in Table 09900A are included this paragraph 09900-3.05. 09900-33 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • • • Table 09900A Coating Specification Sheets Coating System ID Coating Material Surface Service Condition E-1 Epoxy Metal Interior; exterior, covered, not exposed to direct sunlight, non -corrosive exposure. E -1-G Epoxy Galvanized Steel Interior; exterior, covered non -corrosive exposure. Do not use in immersion service. E-2 Epoxy Metal Immersed, nonpotable; non -immersed, moderately corrosive environment, color required. E-3 Epoxy Concrete or Masonry Immersed, nonpotable; non -immersed, corrosive environment, color required. E-4 Epoxy Concrete, masonry, plaster, gypsum board Interior E-5 (NSF 61 certified) Epoxy Metal Interior potable water tanks and reservoirs and other metal components in contact with water being treated and stored for potable use. E-6 (NSF 61 certified) Epoxy Concrete Interior potable water tanks and reservoirs and other metal components in contact with water being treated or stored. E-7 Epoxy Plastic Interior; exterior covered, not exposed to direct sunlight. E-8 Clear epoxy Wood Interior E-9 Epoxy Metal Immersed, nonpotable; non -immersed, corrosive environment, color required. (Not for Biogenic Sulfide Corrosion areas.) E -9-C Epoxy Concrete or masonry Immersed, nonpotable; non -immersed, moderately corrosive environment, color required. (Not for Biogenic Sulfide Corrosion areas.) E-10 Polyamidoamine epoxy Metal or concrete Below grade (buried). EF -1 Amine Epoxy Broadcast Floor Concrete Floors Light duty, wheeled traffic, frequent foot traffic, mildly corrosive. Coating EF -2 Amine Epoxy Troweled Floor Coating Concrete Floors Heavy-duty, wheeled traffic, frequent foot traffic, wet and moderately corrosive. EA -1 Blended Amine Cured Epoxy Metal Immersed, nonpotable; non -immersed, corrosive environment, color not required especially for headspace environments that are corrosive due to biogenic sulfide corrosion. EA -2 Blended Amine Cured Epoxy Concrete or masonry Immersed, nonpotable; non -immersed, corrosive environment, color not required, new construction especially for headspace environments that are corrosive due to biogenic sulfide corrosion. Coating Systems Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) 09900-34 December 2020 City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT Coating System ID Coating Material Surface Service Condition EA -3 Blended Amine Cured Epoxy Concrete or Masonry Immersed, nonpotable; non -immersed, corrosive environment, color not required, new or existing construction, especially for headspace environments that are corrosive due to biogenic sulfide corrosion. EA -4 Blended Amine Cured Concrete or Masonry Non -immersed or immersed, very corrosive Epoxy — For Very Potable environment. Very high H2S conditions. Corrosive Conditions EA -5 Novolac Epoxy Lining Concrete Secondary containment for spills of HFS acid or ferric chloride. G Grease Metal Ferrous Metal: Ferrous metal surfaces shall be prepared in accordance with SSPC SP -1 (Solvent Cleaning.) HH -1 Proprietary Primer Plus Metal Temperature to 750 degrees F. Silicone Topcoat HH -2 Proprietary Primer Plus Metal Temperature to 1200 degrees F. Silicone Topcoat (black or aluminum only) L-1 Latex Concrete, masonry, plaster, gypsum board Interior and Exterior including existing exterior coated concrete. L-2 Latex PVC and CPVC pipe Exterior, direct sunlight exposure. L-3 Latex -Direct to Metal Ferrous Metal Interior or Exterior L-4 Latex Wood Interior M-1 Petrolatum based mastic or wax based wrapping tapes Metal Below grade (buried) or where little to no surface preparation can be performed on piping or structural steel. M-2 Epoxy mastic or equal Ferrous Metal Interior, corrosive environment, confined enclosures, where minimal surface preparation is possible. EU -1 Zinc -epoxy- polyurethane system Ferrous Metal Exterior, exposed to direct sunlight, moderately corrosive non -immersed. EU -1 -FRP Specialty Primer plus Exterior of FRP pipe and Exterior, exposed to direct sunlight, non - Polyurethane Finish tanks, etc. immersed. Coat EC -1 Hybrid Polyurethane Concrete or dense masonry where existing crack or joint movement is suspected of propagating through rigid cured epoxy coatings Service Condition: Interior or exterior, exposed to direct sunlight or not, corrosive (immersion pH 4.0 or lower and/or headspace pH 4.0 or lower and/or gaseous H2S concentrations between 10 and 150 ppm typically.) 09900-35 Coating Systems Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) December 2020 City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • • Coating System ID Coating Material Surface Service Condition EC -2 (NSF -61) Modified Polyurethane Concrete or dense masonry where existing crack or joint movement is suspected due to thermal conditions and would propagate through rigid epoxy coating systems and/or where Interior or exterior, submerged or non - submerged indirect sunlight — moderately corrosive. NSF -61 certification is required S-1 Penetrating acrylic stain, color required Concrete Non -immersed, exposure to moisture and sunlight. S-2 Silane/Siloxane or Blended Sealer Concrete Floors Wet, non -immersed, non -corrosive. Interior or exterior for waterproofing. S-3 RTV Silicone Rubber Based Sealer Concrete or Masonry Walls Exterior or Interior — Weathering Exposure, Non -Corrosive. S-4 Acrylic Co -polymer Blend Concrete Floors Wet, non -immersed, non -corrosive, interior for oil and water repellent. 09900-36 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT 3.05 COATING SYSTEM SPECIFICATION SHEETS (COATSPEC) Coating System Identification: E-1 Coating Material: Epoxy Surface: Metal Service Condition: Interior; exterior, covered, not exposed to direct sunlight, non -corrosive exposure. Surface Preparation: General: Ferrous Metal: Nonferrous and Galvanized Metal: Shop primed surfaces which are to be incorporated in the work shall be prepared in the field by cleaning surfaces in accordance with SSPC SP -2 (Hand Tool Cleaning). Damaged shop coated areas shall be cleaned in accordance with SSPC SP -5 (White Metal Blast Cleaning) to achieve a uniform surface profile of 2.0 to 2.5 mils and spot primed with the primer specified. Shop epoxy primed surfaces shall require light abrasive and vacuum cleaning blasting prior to receiving finish coats. Bare ferrous metal surfaces shall be prepared in accordance with SSPC SP -6 (Commercial Blast Cleaning) to achieve a uniform, surface profile of 2.0 to 2.5 mils. Ferrous metal with rust bleeding shall be cleaned in accordance with SSPC SP -1 (Solvent Cleaning). Areas of rust penetration shall be spot blasted to SSPC SP -10 (Near White Blast) (to achieve the 2.0- to 2.5 -mil surface profile) and spot primed with the specified primer. For ductile iron surfaces, refer to the requirements in paragraph 09900-3.02 D. Nonferrous and galvanized metal shall be prepared in accordance with SSPC SP -7 (Brush-off Blast Cleaning) to achieve uniform, minimum surface profile 1.0 to 1.5 mils. 09900-37 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • • 3.05 COATING SYSTEM SPECIFICATION SHEETS (COATSPEC) Coating System Identification: E-1 (continued) Application: Field General: Prime coat may be thinned and applied as recommended by the CSM, provided the coating as applied complies with prevailing air pollution control regulations. Ferrous Metal: Nonferrous and Galvanized Metal: Prime coats shall be an epoxy primer compatible with the specified finish coats and applied in accordance with the written instructions of the CSM. Nonferrous and galvanized metal shall be cleaned prior to the application of the prime coat in accordance with SSPC SP -1 (Solvent Cleaning). System Thickness: 10 mils dry film. Coatings: Primer: One coat at CSM's recommended dry film thickness. Finish: One or more coats at CSM's recommended dry film thickness per coat to achieve the specified system thickness. 09900-38 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT 3.05 COATING SYSTEM SPECIFICATION SHEETS (COATSPEC) Coating System Identification: E -1-G Coating Material: Epoxy Surface: Galvanized Steel Service Condition: Interior; exterior, covered, non -corrosive exposure. Do not use in immersion service. Surface Preparation: General: Galvanized Metal: Damaged galvanized steel areas with exposed ferrous metal and/or rusted shall be cleaned in accordance with SSPC SP -5 (White Metal Blast Cleaning) or Power Tool Cleaned to Bare Metal in accordance with SSPC-SP-11 to achieve a uniform 1.0- to 1.5-milprofile and spot primed with the primer specified. Nonferrous and galvanized metal shall be prepared in accordance with SSPC SP -7 (Brush-off Blast Cleaning) impart a 1- to 2-milprofile to the galvanized steel surfaces. Where this cannot be performed, prepare by abrading in accordance with SSPC-SP-3, Power Tool Cleaning to impart a 1.0- to 1.5 -mil profile uniformly to the galvanized steel surfaces. Application: Field General: Galvanized Metal: System Thickness: Prime coat may be thinned and applied as recommended by the CSM, provided the coating as applied complies with prevailing air pollution control regulations. Nonferrous and galvanized metal shall be cleaned prior to the application of the prime coat in accordance with SSPC SP -1 (Solvent Cleaning). 5 to 8 mils dry film. 09900-39 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • 3.05 COATING SYSTEM SPECIFICATION SHEETS (COATSPEC) Coating System Identification: E -1-G (continued) Coatings: Primer: One coat at CSM's recommended dry film thickness. Finish: One or more coats at CSM's recommended dry film thickness per coat to the specified system thickness. If the coated galvanized steel is to be exposed to ultraviolet light, apply one polyurethane top coat from coating system EU -1 over the second coat of the two epoxy coats specified. 09900-40 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT 3.05 COATING SYSTEM SPECIFICATION SHEETS (COATSPEC) Coating System Identification: E-2 Coating Material: Epoxy Surface: Metal Service Condition: Immersed, nonpotable; non -immersed, moderately corrosive environment, color required. Surface Preparation: Ferrous Metal: Nonferrous and Galvanized Metal: Ferrous metal surfaces shall be prepared in accordance with SSPC SP -5 (White Metal Blast Cleaning) to achieve a uniform surface profile of 2.0 to 2.5 mils. Damaged shop coating shall be cleaned in accordance with SSPC SP -5 (White Metal Blast Cleaning) and vacuum cleaning and spot primed with the primer specified. Shop epoxy primed surfaces shall require light abrasive blasting or abrading prior to receiving finish coats if the maximum recoat time for the primer has been exceeded. This cleaning must produce a uniform 1.0- to 1.5 -mil profile in the intact shop primer. For ductile iron surfaces, refer to the requirements in paragraph 09900-3.02 D. Nonferrous and galvanized metal shall be prepared in accordance with SSPC SP -7 (Brush-off Blast Cleaning) to achieve a uniform surface profile of 1.0 to 1.5 mils. Galvanized steel with this E-2 coating system shall not be used in immersion service in wastewater. Application: Field General: Prime coat may be thinned and applied as recommended by the CSM, provided the coating as applied complies with prevailing air pollution control regulations. Ferrous Metal: Prime coat shall be an epoxy primer compatible with the specified finish coats. 09900-41 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • 3.05 COATING SYSTEM SPECIFICATION SHEETS (COATSPEC) Coating System Identification: Nonferrous and Galvanized Metal: System Thickness: Coatings: Primer: Finish: E-2 (continued) Nonferrous and galvanized metal, non -immersed, shall be coated prior to the application of the prime coat with a grease emulsifying agent in accordance with the CSM's written instructions. Nonferrous metal to be immersed shall not be painted. Galvanized metal shall not be immersed even if it is painted. 16 mils dry film. One coat at CSM's recommended dry film thickness. Two or more coats at CSM's recommended dry film thickness per coat to the specified system thickness. 09900-42 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT 3.05 COATING SYSTEM SPECIFICATION SHEETS (COATSPEC) Coating System Identification: E-3 Coating Material: Epoxy Surface: Concrete or masonry Service Condition: Immersed, nonpotable; non -immersed, corrosive environment, color required. Surface Preparation: Concrete: Masonry: Concrete surfaces shall be allowed to cure for at least 28 days and allowed to dry to the moisture content recommended by the CSM before coating work proceeds. Moisture content may be tested by the Construction Manager with a Delmhorst Instrument Company moisture detector, or equal. Except as otherwise specified, loose concrete, form oils, surface hardeners, curing compounds, and laitance shall be removed from surfaces by abrasive blasting and chipping, and voids and cracks shall be repaired as specified in Section 03300. Surface preparation can be performed by abrasive blast cleaning or water blast cleaning and must achieve a uniform concrete surface profile of CSP3 in accordance with ICRI 03732. After cleaning, air voids or bugholes in the concrete shall be filled with a surfacer or block filler compatible with the specified primer and finish coats. Masonry surfaces shall be allowed to cure for at least 28 days after being constructed and be allowed to dry to the moisture content recommended by the CSM. Holes or other joint defects shall be filled with a material compatible with the primers and finish coats or shall be filled with masonry mortar that shall cure for at least 28 days. Loose or splattered mortar shall be removed by scraping and chipping. Masonry surfaces shall be cleaned with clear water by washing and scrubbing to remove foreign, loose, and deleterious substances. 09900-43 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • • 3.05 COATING SYSTEM SPECIFICATION SHEETS (COATSPEC) Coating System Identification: E-3 (continued) Muriatic acid shall not be used. After cleaning, masonry surfaces shall be sealed or filled with a sealer or block filler compatible with the specified primer. Application: Field System Thickness: Coatings: Primer: Finish: Apply filler/surfacer as recommended by CSM to fill bugholes and air voids or block texture, etc. leaving a uniformly filled surface that does not produce blowholes or outgassing causing pinholing of the coating system. Filler/surfacers shall dry a minimum of 48 hours prior to application of prime coat or as required by the CSM. Prime coat shall be thinned and applied as recommended by the CSM, provided the coating as applied complies with prevailing air pollution control regulations. Drying time between coats shall be as recommended by CSM. 15 mils dry film. One coat at CSM's recommended dry film thickness. Two or more coats at CSM's recommended dry film thickness per coat to the specified system thickness. 09900-44 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT 3.05 COATING SYSTEM SPECIFICATION SHEETS (COATSPEC) Coating System Identification: E-4 Coating Material: Epoxy Surfaces: Concrete, masonry, plaster, gypsum board. Service Condition: Interior Surface Preparation: Concrete: Concrete surfaces shall be allowed to age for at least 28 days and allowed to dry to the moisture content recommended by the CSM. Moisture content may be tested by the Construction Manager with a Delmhorst Instrument Company moisture detector, or equal. Loose concrete, form oils, surface hardeners, curing compounds and laitance shall be removed from surfaces, and voids and cracks shall be repaired as specified in Section 03300. Surface preparation shall produce a concrete surface profile of CSP -2 in accordance with ICRI 03732. After cleaning, air voids or bugholes in the concrete shall be filled with a surfacer or block filler compatible with the specified primer and finish coats. Masonry: Plaster: Masonry surfaces shall be allowed to age for at least 28 days. Holes or other joint defects shall be filled with mortar and repointed. Loose or splattered mortar shall be removed by scrapping and chipping. Masonry surfaces shall be cleaned with clear water by washing and scrubbing to remove foreign and deleterious substances. Muriatic acid shall not be used. After cleaning, exterior masonry surfaces shall be sealed or filled with a sealer or block filler compatible with the specified primer. Plaster surfaces shall be dry, clean, and free from grit, loose plaster, and surface irregularities. Cracks and holes shall be repaired with acceptable patching materials, keyed to existing surfaces, and sandpapered smooth. Surfaces shall be cleaned with clean water by washing and scrubbing to remove foreign and deleterious substances. 09900-45 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • • • 3.05 COATING SYSTEM SPECIFICATION SHEETS (COATSPEC) Coating System Identification: E-4 (continued) Application: Field System Thickness: Coatings: Primer: Finish: Block Filler shall be multiple component epoxy block filler or an acrylic based or waterborne epoxy based block filler and shall dry a minimum of 48 hours prior to primer application or as required by the CSM. Prime coat shall be thinned and applied as recommended by CSM, provided the coating as applied complies with prevailing air pollution control regulations. Drying time between coats shall be as recommended by CSM. 10 mils dry film, excluding block filler and sealer. One coat at CSM's recommended dry film thickness. One or more coats at CSM's recommended dry film thickness per coat to the specified system thickness. 09900-46 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT 3.05 COATING SYSTEM SPECIFICATION SHEETS (COATSPEC) Coating System Identification: E-5 (NSF 61 certified) Coating Material: Epoxy Surface: Metal Service Condition: Interior potable water tanks and reservoirs and other metal components in contact with water being treated and stored for potable use. Surface Preparation: Ferrous Metal: Nonferrous and Galvanized Metal: Ferrous metal surfaces shall be prepared in accordance with SSPC SP -5 (White Metal Blast Cleaning) to achieve a uniform surface profile of 2.0 to 2.5 mils. Shop primed surfaces which are to be incorporated in the work shall be prepared in the field by cleaning surfaces in accordance with SSPC SP -2 (Hand Tool Cleaning) or SSPC-SP-3 (Power Tool Cleaning). Damaged shop coating shall be cleaned in accordance with SSPC SP -5 (White Metal Blast Cleaning) and spot primed with the primer specified. Cleaning shall produce a surface profile of 2.0 to 2.5 mils. Shop epoxy primed surfaces shall require light abrasive blasting or abrading prior to receiving finish coats if the maximum recoat limit has been exceeded for the primer. This cleaning shall produce a uniform surface profile of 1.0 to 1.5 mils in the intact primer. Nonferrous and galvanized metal shall be prepared in accordance with SSPC SP -7 (Brush-off Blast Cleaning) to achieve a 1.0- to 1.5 -mil profile that is uniform. Application: Field General: Prime coat shall be thinned and applied as recommended by the CSM, provided the coating as applied complies with prevailing air pollution control regulations. Ferrous Metal: Prime coat shall be an epoxy primer compatible with the specified finish coats. 09900-47 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • • • • • 3.05 COATING SYSTEM SPECIFICATION SHEETS (COATSPEC) Coating System Identification: E-5 (NSF 61 certified) (continued) Nonferrous and Galvanized Metal: System Thickness: Coatings: Primer: Finish: Nonferrous and galvanized metal above the high water elevation shall be cleaned prior to the application of the prime coat in accordance with SSPC SP -1 (Solvent Cleaning). 10 mils dry film. One coat at the CSM's recommended dry film thickness. One or more coats at CSM's recommended dry film thickness per coat to the specified system thickness. 09900-48 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT 3.05 COATING SYSTEM SPECIFICATION SHEETS (COATSPEC) Coating System Identification: E-6 (NSF 61 certified) Coating Material: Epoxy Surface: Concrete Service Condition: Interior potable water tanks and reservoirs and other metal components in contact with water being treated or stored. Surface Preparation: Concrete: Masonry: Concrete surfaces shall be allowed to cure for at least 28 days and allowed to dry to the moisture content recommended by the CSM. Moisture content may be tested by the Construction Manager with a Delmhorst Instrument Company moisture detector, or equal. Except as otherwise specified, loose concrete, form oils, surface hardeners, curing compounds, and laitance shall be removed from surfaces by abrasive blasting and chipping, and voids and cracks shall be repaired as specified in Section 03300. Abrasive blast cleaning or water blast cleaning methods can be used and must produce a uniform concrete surface profile of a CSP -3 in accordance with ICRI 03732. After cleaning, air voids or bugholes in the concrete shall be filled with a surfacer or block filler compatible with the specified primer and finish coats. Masonry surfaces shall be allowed to cure for at least 28 days. Holes or other joint defects shall be filled with mortar and repointed and allowed to cure for 28 days or shall be filled with materials compatible with the primer and finish coats. Loose or splattered mortar shall be removed by scraping and chipping. Masonry surfaces shall be cleaned with clear water by washing and scrubbing to remove foreign and deleterious substances. Muriatic acid shall not be used. After cleaning, masonry surfaces shall be sealed or filled with a sealer or block filler compatible with the specified primer. 09900-49 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • • • 3.05 COATING SYSTEM SPECIFICATION SHEETS (COATSPEC) Coating System Identification: E-6 (NSF 61 certified) (continued) Application: Field System Thickness: Coatings: Primer: Finish: Surfacer or block filler shall dry a minimum of 48 hours prior to application of prime coat or as recommended by the CSM. Prime coat shall be thinned and applied as recommended by the CSM, provided the coating as applied complies with prevailing air pollution control regulations. Drying time between prime coat and finish coat shall be as recommended by CSM. 15 mils dry film. One coat at CSM's recommended dry film thickness. Two or more coats at CSM's recommended dry film thickness per coat to the specified system thickness. 09900-50 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT 3.05 COATING SYSTEM SPECIFICATION SHEETS (COATSPEC) Coating System Identification: E-7 Coating Material: Epoxy Surface: Plastic Service Condition: Interior; exterior covered, not exposed to direct sunlight. Surface Preparation: Plastic shall be prepared in accordance with SSPC SP -1 (Solvent Cleaning) and light sanding to produce a uniform surface roughness(uniform surface profile of 1.0 to 1.5 mils) on the plastic. Application: Field System Thickness: 5 mils dry film. Coatings: One or more coats at CSM's recommended dry film thickness per coat to the specified system thickness. 09900-51 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • 3.05 COATING SYSTEM SPECIFICATION SHEETS (COATSPEC) Coating System Identification: E-8 Coating Material: Clear epoxy Surface: Wood Service Condition: Interior Surface Preparation: Wood surfaces shall be cleaned of dirt, oil or other foreign substances with mineral spirits, scrapers, sandpaper or wire brush. Finished surfaces exposed to view shall be smoothed by planing or sandpapering. Millwork shall be sandpapered and given a coat of the specified exterior primer on sides before installation. Built-in surfaces of windowsills shall be double primed. Glazing rabbets and beads in exterior sash and doors shall be double primed. Small, dry, seasoned knots shall be surfaced scraped, sandpapered, and thoroughly cleaned and shall be given a thin coat of a clear knot sealer before application of the priming coat. Large, open, unseasoned knots, and beads or streaks of pitch shall be scraped off; however, if the pitch is still soft, it shall be removed with mineral spirits or turpentine, and the resinous area shall be coated with knot sealer prior to priming. After priming, holes and imperfections shall be filled with putty or plastic wood, colored to match the finish coat, allowed to dry and sandpapered smooth. Application: Field System Thickness: Coatings: Primer: Finish: Prime coat shall be thinned and applied as recommended by the CSM, provided the coating as applied complies with prevailing air pollution control regulations. 4 mils One coat at CSM's recommended dry film thickness. One or more coats at CSM's recommended dry film thickness per coat to the specified system thickness. 09900-52 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT 3.05 COATING SYSTEM SPECIFICATION SHEETS (COATSPEC) Coating System Identification: E-9 Coating Material: Epoxy Surface: Metal Service Condition: Immersed, nonpotable; non -immersed, corrosive environment, color required. (Not for Biogenic Sulfide Corrosion areas.) Surface Preparation: Ferrous Metal: Nonferrous and Galvanized Metal: Ferrous metal surfaces shall be prepared in accordance with SSPC SP -5 (White Metal Blast Cleaning) to achieve a uniform surface profile of 2.5 to 3.0 mils. Shop primed surfaces which are to be incorporated in the work shall be prepared in the field by cleaning surfaces in accordance with SSPC SP -2 (Hand Tool Cleaning) or SSPC-SP-3 (Power Tool Cleaning). Damaged shop coating shall be cleaned in accordance with SSPC SP -5 (White Metal Blast Cleaning) to achieve a uniform surface profile of 2.5 to 3.0 mils and spot primed with the primer specified. Shop epoxy primed surfaces shall require light abrasive blasting or abrading to achieve a uniform surface profile of 1.0 to 1.5 mils in the intact shop primer prior to receiving finish coats if the maximum recoat time for the primer has been exceeded. For ductile iron surfaces, refer to the requirements in paragraph 09900-3.02 D. Nonferrous and galvanized metal shall be prepared in accordance with SSPC SP -7 (Brush-off Blast Cleaning) to achieve a 1.5- to 2.0 -mil profile that is uniform. Galvanized steel with this E-2 coating system shall not be used in immersion service in wastewater. Application: Field General: Prime coat may be thinned and applied as recommended by the CSM, provided the coating as applied complies with prevailing air pollution control regulations. 09900-53 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • 3.05 COATING SYSTEM SPECIFICATION SHEETS (COATSPEC) Coating System Identification: E-9 (continued) Ferrous Metal: Prime coat shall be an epoxy primer compatible with the specified finish coats. Nonferrous and Galvanized Metal: Nonferrous and galvanized metal, non -immersed, shall be coated prior to the application of the prime coat with a grease emulsifying agent in accordance with the CSM's written instructions. Non-ferrous metal to be immersed shall not be painted. Galvanized metal shall not be immersed even if it is painted with this coating system. System Thickness: 15 to 20 mils dry film. Coatings: Primer: One coat at CSM's recommended dry film thickness. • Finish: Two or more coats at CSM's recommended dry film thickness per coat to the specified system thickness. • 09900-54 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT 3.05 COATING SYSTEM SPECIFICATION SHEETS (COATSPEC) Coating System Identification: E -9-C Coating Material: Epoxy Surface: Concrete or masonry Service Condition: Immersed, nonpotable; non -immersed, moderately corrosive environment, color required. (Not for Biogenic Sulfide Corrosion areas.) Surface Preparation: Concrete: Masonry: Concrete surfaces shall be allowed to cure for at least 28 days following initial concrete placement and allowed to dry to the moisture content recommended by the CSM before coating work proceeds. Moisture content may be tested by the Construction Manager with a Delmhorst Instrument Company moisture detector, or equal. Except as otherwise specified, loose concrete, form oils, surface hardeners, curing compounds, and laitance shall be removed from surfaces by abrasive blasting and chipping, and voids and cracks shall be repaired as specified in Section 03300. Cleaning can be performed using abrasive blast cleaning or water blast cleaning methods to produce a minimum concrete surface profile of CSP -3 in accordance with ICRI 03732. After cleaning, all air voids or bugholes in the concrete shall be filled with a surfacer or block filler compatible with the specified primer and finish coats. Masonry surfaces shall be allowed to cure for at least 28 days after being constructed and be allowed to dry to the moisture content recommended by the CSM. Holes or other joint defects shall be filled with a material compatible with the primers and finish coats or shall be filled with masonry mortar that shall cure for at least 28 days. Loose or splattered mortar shall be removed by scraping and chipping. Masonry surfaces shall be cleaned with clear water by washing and scrubbing to remove foreign and deleterious substances. 09900-55 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • • • 3.05 COATING SYSTEM SPECIFICATION SHEETS (COATSPEC) Coating System Identification: E -9-C (continued) Muriatic acid shall not be used. After cleaning, masonry surfaces shall be sealed or filled with a sealer or block filler compatible with the specified primer. Application: Field Apply filler/surfacer as recommended by CSM to fill bugholes and air voids or block texture, etc. leaving a uniformly filled surface that does not produce blowholes or outgassing causing pinholing of the coating system. Filler/Surfacers shall dry a minimum of 48 hours prior to application of prime coat or as required by the CSM. Prime coat shall be thinned and applied as recommended by the CSM, provided the coating as applied complies with prevailing air pollution control regulations. • Drying time between coats shall be as recommended by CSM. • System Thickness: Coatings: Primer: Finish: 16 to 20 mils dry film. One coat at CSM's recommended dry film thickness. Two or more coats at CSM's recommended dry film thickness per coat to the specified system thickness. 09900-56 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT 3.05 COATING SYSTEM SPECIFICATION SHEETS (COATSPEC) Coating System Identification: E-10 Coating Material: Polyamidoamine epoxy Surface: Metal or concrete Service Condition: Below grade (buried, exterior) in contact with soil Surface Preparation: Ferrous Metal: Ferrous metal surfaces shall be prepared in accordance with SSPC SP -5 (White Metal Blast Cleaning). Nonferrous Metal: Concrete: Application: System Thickness: Coating: Nonferrous and galvanized metal shall be prepared in accordance with SSPC SP -7 (Brush-off Blast Cleaning) to achieve a uniform surface profile of 2.0 to 2.5 mils. Concrete surfaces shall be allowed to age for at least 28 days and allowed to dry to the moisture content recommended by the CSM. Moisture content may be tested by the Construction Manager with a Delmhorst Instrument Company moisture detector, or equal. Except as otherwise specified, loose concrete and laitance shall be removed from surfaces by abrasive blasting and chipping, and voids and cracks shall be repaired as specified in Section 03300. Concrete surface preparation can be performed using abrasive blast cleaning or water blast cleaning methods and must achieve a concrete surface profile of CSP -3 in accordance with ICRI 03732. Field 16 mils Two or more coats at CSM's recommended dry film thickness per coat to the specified system thickness. 09900-57 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • • III3.05 COATING SYSTEM SPECIFICATION SHEETS (COATSPEC) Coating System Identification: EF -1 Coating Material: Epoxy Resin Based Floor Coating Surface: Concrete Floors • • Service Condition: For interior light duty applications light wheel traffic, mostly foot traffic, and mildly corrosive. Mainly for wear resistance, aesthetics, and cleanability. Non -slip texture can be varied depending on wetness of exposure. Test patches to be installed for deciding on level of non -slip texture required. Surface Preparation: Concrete floor slabs shall be allowed to age for at least 28 days and must meet a moisture vapor transmission rate of less than 3.0 lbs. of moisture per 24 hours per 1,000 SF in accordance with ASTM F1869. It is also essential that a well -sealed and intact vapor barrier has been installed beneath all slabs on grade to receive this floor coating system. Except as otherwise specified, loose concrete, curing compounds, and laitance shall be removed by abrasive blast cleaning or preferably by shotblasting. Surface preparation shall produce a clean sound concrete substrate with a concrete surface profile of CSP -6 minimum in accordance with ICRI 03732. Surface preparation shall be in accordance with SSPC-SP-13. Additionally, all coating termination and transition details shall be prepared in accordance with the CSM's standard detail drawings. This includes coating termination details, coating transitions at vertical and vertical to horizontal corners, coating terminations at joints, concrete crack treatment, pipe penetration treatment, coating terminations at metal embedments in the concrete substrate, and other details. The CSM's standard detail drawings shall be submitted for all such coating applications. If standard details are not available for a given detail treatment, the CSM shall be required to produce one at no additional cost to the owner, the engineer, or any other party. If wet abrasive or water blasting surface preparation methods were used, the concrete substrate shall be allowed to dry under warm conditions (minimum of 75 degrees F) 09900-58 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT Application: for at least 5 days prior to coating application. Following surface preparation work and dry -out, all surfaces to be coated shall be vacuum cleaned to remove all loose dirt, dust, or other loose materials. Carefully follow CSM's written instructions regarding mixing, thinning, application, recoat limitations (windows) and curing of coating materials. System Thickness: 125 mils dry film. Coatings: Primer Coat — Brush or roller apply at 6.0 — 10.0 mils DFT. Broadcast Applied Coat — Brush or roller catalyzed resin and broadcast aggregate to rejection (should achieve 100 to 105 mils DFT). Topcoat — brush or roller apply at 8.0 — 10.0 mils. Total System DFT = 125 mils Install all termination and transition details in accordance with the CSM's detail drawings. 09900-59 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • • • 3.05 COATING SYSTEM SPECIFICATION SHEETS (COATSPEC) Coating System Identification: EF -2 Coating Material: Epoxy Resin Based Floor Coating Surface: Concrete Floors • • Service Condition: For interior — heavy-duty exposure applications. Frequent, heavy wheeled traffic and moderately corrosive exposure conditions. Mainly for wear resistance, impact resistance, protection of concrete, and aesthetics. Non -slip texture can be varied as needed. Test patches to be installed for deciding on level of non -slip texture required. Surface Preparation: Concrete floor slabs shall be allowed to age for at least 28 days and must meet a moisture vapor transmission rate of less than 3.0 lbs. of moisture per 24 hours per 1,000 SF in accordance with ASTM F1869. It is also essential that a well -sealed and intact vapor barrier has been installed beneath all slabs on grade to receive this floor coating system. Except as otherwise specified, loose concrete, curing compounds, and laitance shall be removed by abrasive blast cleaning or preferably by shotblasting. Surface preparation shall produce a clean sound concrete substrate with a concrete surface profile of CSP -7 minimum in accordance with ICRI 03732. Surface preparation shall be in accordance with SSPC-SP-13. Additionally, all coating termination and transition details shall be prepared in accordance with the CSM's standard detail drawings. This includes coating termination details, coating transitions at vertical and vertical to horizontal corners, coating terminations at joints, concrete crack treatment, pipe penetration treatment, coating terminations at metal embedments in the concrete substrate, and other details. The CSM's standard detail drawings shall be submitted for all such coating applications. If standard details are not available for a given detail treatment, the CSM shall be required to produce one at no additional cost to the owner, the engineer, or any other party. If wet abrasive or water blasting surface preparation methods were used, the concrete substrate shall be allowed to dry under warm conditions (minimum of 75 degrees F) 09900-60 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT Application: System Thickness: Coatings: for at least 5 days prior to coating application. Following surface preparation work and dry -out, all surfaces to be coated shall be vacuum cleaned to remove all loose dirt, dust, or other loose materials. Carefully follow CSM's written instructions regarding mixing, thinning, application, recoat limitations (windows) and curing of coating materials. 250 mils dry film. Primer Coat — Brush or roller apply at 6.0 — 10.0 mils DFT. Trowel Applied Coat — Trowel apply to 230 — 236 mils. Topcoat — brush or roller apply at 8.0 —10.0 mils. Cumulative dry film thickness. Total System Thickness is 250 mils. Install all termination and transition details in accordance with the CSM's detail drawings. 09900-61 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • • III3.05 COATING SYSTEM SPECIFICATION SHEETS (COATSPEC) Coating System Identification: EA -1 Coating Material: Blended Amine Cured Epoxy Surface: Metal • • Service Condition: Immersed, nonpotable; non -immersed, corrosive environment, color not required especially for headspace environments that are corrosive due to biogenic sulfide corrosion. Surface Preparation: Ferrous Metal: Nonferrous and Galvanized Metal: Ferrous metal surfaces shall be prepared in accordance with SSPC SP -5 (White Metal Blast Cleaning) to achieve a uniform surface profile of 3.0 to 3.5 mils. Blast Cleaning shall produce a minimum surface profile of 3.0 mils. Shop primed surfaces which are to be incorporated in the work shall be prepared in the field by cleaning surfaces in accordance with SSPC SP -11 (Power Tool Cleaning to Bare Metal). Damaged shop coated areas shall be cleaned in accordance with SSPC SP -5 (White Metal Blast Cleaning) and spot primed with the primer specified. Shop epoxy primed surfaces shall require light abrasive blasting and blow down cleaning prior to receiving finish coats. Cast or ductile iron surfaces to be coated shall be abrasive blast cleaned to a clean, gray uniform metal appearance free of variations in color and loose materials. Ductile iron surfaces shall be prepared in accordance with paragraph 09900-3.02 D. Nonferrous and galvanized metal shall be prepared in accordance with SSPC SP -7 (Brush-off Blast Cleaning) to achieve a uniform surface profile of 2.0 to 2.5 mils. Galvanized metal should generally not be used in these environments. 09900-62 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT 3.05 COATING SYSTEM SPECIFICATION SHEETS (COATSPEC) Coating System Identification: EA -1 (continued) Application: Field General: Prime coat may be thinned and applied as recommended by the CSM, provided the coating as applied complies with prevailing air pollution control regulations. Ferrous Metal: System Thickness: Coatings: Primer: Finish: Testing: Drying time between coats shall be as specified by the CSM for the site conditions. If the maximum recoat time is exceeded, surface preparation shall require solvent washing, light abrasive blasting, or other procedures per CSM's instructions. If shop priming is required or field priming is necessary, the prime coat shall be an epoxy primer compatible with the specified coating system. Generally, the EA -1 coating system is self -priming and does not require a primer unless there is a special reason to prime the steel to hold the blast cleaning from rusting back. 30 to 40 mils dry film. One coat at CSM's recommended dry film thickness only if required by special circumstances. One or more coats at CSM's recommended dry film thickness per coat to the specified system thickness. Holiday detection shall be performed over 100% of the coated surface area to identify any holidays or pinholes that must be repaired. Pinhole and Holiday Repair Procedure: Pinholes and holidays identified by Holiday Detection shall be repaired as follows: • Using a pencil grinder, remove a'/2 -inch diameter area of the coating system material back to the ferrous metal substrate. The metal must be shiny. 09900-63 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • • • • • • Aggressively sand or abrade the intact coating system surface 2 inches around the complete periphery of the %2 -inch diameter removal area to produce a uniform 6 to 8 mils profile. • Vacuum clean the prepared area to remove all dust and dirt to achieve a clean, sound surface. Tape the peripheral area to prevent coating application onto unprepared surfaces. • Brush apply one coat of the finish coating material. Following proper recoat cure time, apply additional coats of the finish coating system to achieve 60 mils DFT at the coating removal area and feather the coating onto the roughened coated surfaces to form a neat repair outline. 09900-64 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT 3.05 COATING SYSTEM SPECIFICATION SHEETS (COATSPEC) Coating System Identification: EA -2 Coating Material: Blended Amine Cured Epoxy Surface: Concrete or masonry Service Condition: Immersed, nonpotable; non -immersed, corrosive environment, color not required, new construction especially for headspace environments that are corrosive due to biogenic sulfide corrosion. Surface Preparation: All coating termination and transition details shall be prepared in accordance with the CSM's standard detail drawings. This includes coating termination details, coating transitions at vertical and vertical to horizontal corners, coating terminations at joints, concrete crack treatment, pipe penetration treatment, coating terminations at metal embedments in the concrete substrate, and other details. The CSM's standard detail drawings shall be submitted for all such coating applications. If standard details are not available for a given detail treatment, the CSM shall be required to produce one at no additional cost to the owner, the engineer, or any other party. If wet abrasive or water blasting surface preparation methods were used, the concrete substrate shall be allowed to dry under warm conditions (minimum of 75 degrees F) for at least 5 days prior to coating application. Following surface preparation work and dry -out, all surfaces to be coated shall be vacuum cleaned to remove all loose dirt, dust, or other loose materials. 09900-65 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • • • • • 3.05 COATING SYSTEM SPECIFICATION SHEETS (COATSPEC) Coating System Identification: EA -2 (continued) Concrete: Masonry: Concrete surfaces shall be allowed to cure for at least 28 days and allowed to dry to the moisture content recommended by the CSM. Moisture content may be tested by the Construction Manager with a Delmhorst Instrument Company moisture detector, or equal. Except as otherwise specified, loose concrete, form oils, surface hardeners, curing compounds, and laitance shall be removed from surfaces by abrasive blasting and chipping, and voids and cracks shall be repaired as specified in Section 03300. Surface Preparation must open up all shelled over air voids or bugholes to expose fully the void's depth, width, and length. Concrete shall be abraded to achieve a uniform concrete surface profile of CSP -5 in accordance with ICRI 03732. After surface preparation has been accepted, a complete skim coat of the specified filler surfacer shall be applied over all concrete surfaces and all bugholes (air voids) shall be completely filled using this same material. The filler/surfacer material shall be applied as a complete parge coat of the substrate. If the parge coat (filler/surfacer material) is non -polymer modified, it must be brush blast cleaned following adequate cure per CSM's instructions to produce a uniform anchor pattern of CSP -4 in accordance with ICRI 03732 prior to coating application. Masonry surfaces shall be allowed to cure for at least 28 days. Holes or other joint defects shall be filled with mortar and repointed and allowed to cure for 28 days or shall be filled with a repair material compatible with the coating system that does not require hydration cure time. Loose or splattered mortar shall be removed by scrapping and chipping. Masonry surfaces shall be cleaned with clear water by washing and scrubbing to remove foreign and deleterious substances. 09900-66 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT 3.05 COATING SYSTEM SPECIFICATION SHEETS (COATSPEC) Coating System Identification: EA -2 (continued) Muriatic acid shall not be used. After cleaning, masonry surfaces shall be skim coated with a surfacer or block filler compatible with the specified coating system. Application: Field System Thickness: Coatings: Finish: Testing: Surfacer or filler shall be applied per CSM's recommendations prior to application of coating to fill all bugholes and voids and create a complete parge coat of the prepared substrate. This parge coat shall completely fill all bugholes and voids in the substrate, and will also completely cover the substrate unless specified otherwise above such filled voids by 1/8 inch (125 mils) of thickness. Drying time between coats shall be as specified by the CSM for the site conditions. If the maximum recoat time is exceeded, surface preparation shall require solvent washing, light abrasive blasting, or other procedures per CSM's instructions. 60 mils dry film in addition to the parge coat. One or more coats at CSM's recommended dry film thickness per coat to the specified system thickness. Holiday detection shall be performed over 100% of the coated surface area to identify any holidays or pinholes, which could compromise coating system performance. Holiday testing to be performed after application and adequate cure of the spray applied epoxy coating material. Holiday detection shall be performed in accordance with NACE RP0188. 09900-67 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • • • 3.05 COATING SYSTEM SPECIFICATION SHEETS (COATSPEC) Coating System Identification: EA -2 (continued) Pinhole and Holiday Repair Procedure: Pinholes and holidays identified by Holiday Detection shall be repaired as follows: • Using a grinder or other suitable power tool, remove the coating system at all pinholes or holidays in an area at least 2 inches in diameter or in both dimensions around the defect back to the concrete substrate. • Chip out and remove the concrete to expose the full dimensions in all three directions of the air void responsible for the defect. • Aggressively abrade or sand the intact coating system surface at least 3 inches beyond the removal area in all directions to produce a uniform 6- to 8 -mil profile in the intact coating system. • • Vacuum clean the prepared area to remove all dust, dirt, etc. leaving clean sound surfaces. • • Tape to mask the periphery of the prepared intact coating area to prevent coating repair application onto the prepared area. • Using a putty knife or other suitable tool, fill the opened void with the approved filler/surfacer material completely and strike -off. Allow to cure per CSM's recommendations. • Apply the coating system in the number of coats necessary to achieve the specified 60 mils DFT over the defect and coating removal area and feather the coating onto the abraded coated surfaces around the removal area to avoid a lip and to achieve a neat repair outline. Allow to cure properly. 09900-68 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -Ur 3.05 COATING SYSTEM SPECIFICATION SHEETS (COATSPEC) Coating System Identification: EA -3 Coating Material: Blended Amine Cured Epoxy Surface: Concrete or masonry Service Condition: Immersed, nonpotable; non -immersed, corrosive environment, color not required, new or existing construction, especially for headspace environments that are corrosive due to biogenic sulfide corrosion. Surface Preparation: All coating termination and transition details shall be prepared in accordance with the CSM's standard detail drawings. This includes coating termination details, coating transitions at vertical and vertical to horizontal corners, coating terminations at joints, concrete crack treatment, pipe penetration treatment, coating terminations at metal embedments in the concrete substrate, and other details. The CSM's standard detail drawings shall be submitted for all such coating applications. If standard details are not available for a given detail treatment, the CSM shall be required to produce one at no additional cost to the owner, the engineer, or any other party. If wet abrasive or water blasting surface preparation methods were used, the concrete substrate shall be allowed to dry under warm conditions (minimum of 75 degrees F) for at least 5 days prior to coating application. Following surface preparation work and dry -out, all surfaces to be coated shall be vacuum cleaned to remove all loose dirt, dust, or other loose materials. 09900-69 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • • • • • 3.05 COATING SYSTEM SPECIFICATION SHEETS (COATSPEC) Coating System Identification: EA -3 (continued) Concrete: Masonry: Concrete surfaces shall be allowed to age for at least 28 days and allowed to dry to the moisture content recommended by the CSM. Moisture content may be tested by the Construction Manager with a Delmhorst Instrument Company moisture detector, or equal. Except as otherwise specified, loose concrete, form oils, surface hardeners, curing compounds, and laitance shall be removed from surfaces by abrasive blasting and chipping, and voids and cracks shall be repaired as specified in Section 03300. Concrete shall be abraded also to achieve a uniform concrete surface profile of CSP 5 minimum. If the parge coat (filler/surfacer material) is non -polymer modified, it shall be brush blasted following adequate cure per the CSM's instructions to produce a uniform concrete surface profile of CSP -4 in accordance with ICRI 03732 prior to coating application. After cleaning, air voids or bugholes in the concrete shall be filled with a surfacer or block filler. The filler/surfacer material shall be applied as a complete parge coat of the substrate. For existing concrete that has been degraded, apply a skim coat of a surfacer or filler material to restore the substrate to a coatable condition. Be certain the filler surfacer material is compatible with the coating system. Masonry surfaces shall be allowed to age for at least 28 days. Holes or other joint defects shall be filled with mortar and repointed. Loose or splattered mortar shall be removed by scrapping and chipping. Masonry surfaces shall be cleaned with clear water by washing and scrubbing to remove foreign and deleterious substances. Muriatic acid shall not be used. After cleaning, masonry surfaces shall be sealed or filled with sealer or block filler compatible with the specified coating system. 09900-70 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT 3.05 COATING SYSTEM SPECIFICATION SHEETS (COATSPEC) Coating System Identification: Application: System Thickness: Coatings: Primer: Finish: Testing: EA -3 (continued) Field Surfacer or filler shall be applied and dry per CSM's recommendations prior to application of coating. Drying time between filler/surfacer and coating system shall be as specified by the CSM for the site conditions. If the maximum recoat time is exceeded, surface preparation shall require solvent washing, light abrasive blasting, or other procedures per CSM's instructions. The parge coat shall completely fill all bugholes and voids in the substrate and it will also completely cover the substrate unless specified otherwise above such filled voids by 1/8 inch of thickness. 125 mils dry film (or 1/8 inch) in addition to the parge coat. Self -priming. One coat at CSM's recommended dry film thickness — trowel applied. Holiday detection shall be performed over 100% of the coated surface area to identify any holidays or pinholes that could compromise coating system performance. Holiday detection shall be performed after adequate cure of the spray applied epoxy coating material. Holiday detection shall be performed in accordance with NACE RP0188. Pinhole and Holiday Repair Procedure: Pinholes and holidays identified by Holiday Detection shall be repaired as follows: • Using a grinder or other suitable power tool, remove the coating system at all pinholes or holidays in an area at least 2 inches in diameter or in both dimensions around the defect back to the concrete substrate. 09900-71 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • • • 3.05 COATING SYSTEM SPECIFICATION SHEETS (COATSPEC) Coating System Identification: EA -3 (continued) • Chip out and remove the concrete to expose the full dimensions in all three directions of the air void responsible for the defect. • Aggressively abrade or sand the intact coating system surface at least 3 -inches beyond the removal area in all directions to produce a uniform 6- to 8 -mil profile in the intact coating system. • Vacuum clean the prepared area to remove all dust, dirt, etc. leaving clean sound surfaces. • Tape to mask the periphery of the prepared intact coating area to prevent coating repair application onto the prepared area. • Using a putty knife or other suitable tool, fill the opened void with the approved filler/surfacer material completely and strike -off. Allow to cure per CSM's recommendations. • Apply the coating system in the number of coats necessary to achieve the specified 60 mils DFT over the defect and coating removal area and feather the coating onto the abraded coated surfaces around the removal area to avoid a lip and to achieve a neat repair outline. Allow to cure properly. 09900-72 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT 3.05 COATING SYSTEM SPECIFICATION SHEETS (COATSPEC) Coating System Identification: EA -4 Coating Material: Blended Amine Cured Epoxy Surface: Concrete or masonry Service Condition: Immersed, nonpotable; non -immersed, very corrosive environment, color not required, new or existing construction, especially for headspace environments that are very corrosive due to biogenic sulfide corrosion. Surface Preparation: All coating termination and transition details shall be prepared in accordance with the CSM's standard detail drawings. This includes coating termination details, coating transitions at vertical and vertical to horizontal corners, coating terminations at joints, concrete crack treatment, pipe penetration treatment, coating terminations at metal embedments in the concrete substrate, and other details. The CSM's standard detail drawings shall be submitted for all such coating applications. If standard details are not available for a given detail treatment, the CSM shall be required to produce one at no additional cost to the owner, the engineer, or any other party. If wet abrasive or water blasting surface preparation methods were used, the concrete substrate shall be allowed to dry under warm conditions (minimum of 75 degrees F) for at least 5 days prior to coating application. Following surface preparation work and dry -out, all surfaces to be coated shall be vacuum cleaned to remove all loose dirt, dust, or other loose materials. 09900-73 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • • • • 3.05 COATING SYSTEM SPECIFICATION SHEETS (COATSPEC) Coating System Identification: EA -4 (continued) Concrete: Masonry: Concrete surfaces shall be allowed to age for at least 28 days and allowed to dry to the moisture content recommended by the CSM. Moisture content may be tested by the Construction Manager with a Delmhorst Instrument Company moisture detector, or equal. Except as otherwise specified, loose concrete, form oils, surface hardeners, curing compounds, and laitance shall be removed from surfaces by abrasive blasting and chipping, and voids and cracks shall be repaired as specified in Section 03300. Concrete shall be abraded also to achieve a uniform concrete surface profile of CSP 5 minimum. If the parge coat (filler/surfacer material) is non -polymer modified, it shall be brush blasted following adequate cure per the CSM's instructions to produce a uniform concrete surface profile of CSP -4 in accordance with ICRI 03732 prior to coating application. After cleaning, air voids or bugholes in the concrete shall be filled with a surfacer or block filler. The filler/surfacer material shall be applied as a complete parge coat of the substrate. For existing concrete that has been degraded, apply a skim coat of a surfacer or filler material to restore the substrate to a coatable condition. Be certain the filler surfacer material is compatible with the coating system. Masonry surfaces shall be allowed to age for at least 28 days. Holes or other joint defects shall be filled with mortar and repointed. Loose or splattered mortar shall be removed by scrapping and chipping. Masonry surfaces shall be cleaned with clear water by washing and scrubbing to remove foreign and deleterious substances. Muriatic acid shall not be used. After cleaning, masonry surfaces shall be sealed or filled with sealer or block filler compatible with the specified coating system. 09900-74 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT 3.05 COATING SYSTEM SPECIFICATION SHEETS (COATSPEC) Coating System Identification: Application: System Thickness: Coatings: Primer: Troweled Coat: EA -4 (continued) Field Surfacer or filler shall be applied and dry per CSM's recommendations prior to application of coating. Drying time between filler/surfacer and coating system shall be as specified by the CSM for the site conditions. If the maximum recoat time is exceeded, surface preparation shall require solvent washing, light abrasive blasting, or other procedures per CSM's instructions. The parge coat shall completely fill all bugholes and voids in the substrate and it will also completely cover the substrate unless specified otherwise above such filled voids by 1/8 inch of thickness. 140 to 145 mils dry film in addition to the parge coat. Self -priming One coat at CSM's recommended dry film thickness — trowel applied. (125 mils) Finish (Glaze Coat): 15 to 20 mils dry. Testing: Holiday detection shall be performed over 100% of the coated surface area to identify any holidays or pinholes that could compromise coating system performance. Holiday detection shall be performed after application and adequate cure of the spray applied epoxy coating material. Holiday detection shall be performed in accordance with NACE RP0188. 09900-75 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • • • 3.05 COATING SYSTEM SPECIFICATION SHEETS (COATSPEC) Coating System Identification: EA -4 (continued) Pinhole and Holiday Repair Procedure: Pinholes and holidays identified by Holiday Detection shall be repaired as follows: • Using a grinder or other suitable power tool, remove the coating system at all pinholes or holidays in an area at least 2 inches in diameter or in both dimensions around the defect back to the concrete substrate. • Chip out and remove the concrete to expose the full dimensions in all three directions of the air void responsible for the defect. • Aggressively abrade or sand the intact coating system surface at least 3 -inches beyond the removal area in all directions to produce a uniform 6- to 8 -mil profile in the intact coating system. • • Vacuum clean the prepared area to remove all dust, dirt, etc. leaving clean sound surfaces. • Tape to mask the periphery of the prepared intact coating area to prevent coating repair application onto the prepared area. • Using a putty knife or other suitable tool, fill the opened void with the approved filler/surfacer material completely and strike -off. Allow to cure per CSM's recommendations. • Apply the coating system in the number of coats necessary to achieve the specified 60 mils DFT over the defect and coating removal area and feather the coating onto the abraded coated surfaces around the removal area to avoid a lip and to achieve a neat repair outline. Allow to cure properly. 09900-76 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT 3.05 COATING SYSTEM SPECIFICATION SHEETS (COATSPEC) Coating System Identification: EA -5 Coating Material: Novolac Epoxy Lining Surface: Concrete or masonry Service Condition: Chemical area process slabs, chemical loading and unloading areas, secondary spill containment areas for ferric chloride or 25% hydrofluoro-silicic acid. Surface Preparation: All coating termination and transition details shall be prepared in accordance with the CSM's standard detail drawings. This includes coating termination details, coating transitions at vertical and vertical to horizontal corners, coating terminations at joints, concrete crack treatment, pipe penetration treatment, coating terminations at metal embedments in the concrete substrate, and other details. The CSM's standard detail drawings shall be submitted for all such coating applications. If standard details are not available for a given detail treatment, the CSM shall be required to produce one at no additional cost to the owner, the engineer, or any other party. If wet abrasive or water blasting surface preparation methods were used, the concrete substrate shall be allowed to dry under warm conditions (minimum of 75 degrees F) for at least 5 days prior to coating application. Following surface preparation work and dry -out, all surfaces to be coated shall be vacuum cleaned to remove all loose dirt, dust, or other loose materials. 09900-77 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • • • 3.05 COATING SYSTEM SPECIFICATION SHEETS (COATSPEC) • • Coating System Identification: EA -5 (continued) Concrete: Concrete surfaces shall be allowed to cure for at least 28 days and allowed to dry to the moisture content recommended by the CSM. Moisture content may be tested by the Construction Manager with a Delmhorst Instrument Company moisture detector, or equal. Except as otherwise specified, loose concrete, form oils, surface hardeners, curing compounds, and laitance shall be removed from surfaces by abrasive blasting and chipping, and voids and cracks shall be repaired as specified in Section 03300. Surface Preparation must open up all shelled over air voids or bugholes to expose fully the void's depth, width, and length. Concrete shall be abraded to achieve a uniform concrete surface profile of CSP -5 in accordance with ICRI 03732. After surface preparation has been accepted, a complete skim coat of the specified filler surfacer shall be applied over all concrete surfaces and all bugholes (air voids) shall be completely filled using this same material. The filler/surfacer material shall be applied as a complete parge coat of the substrate. If the parge coat (filler/surfacer material) is non -polymer modified, it must be brush blast cleaned following adequate cure per CSM's instructions to produce a uniform anchor pattern of CSP -4 in accordance with ICRI 03732 prior to coating application. Application: Field Prime coat shall be applied as recommended by the CSM. Surfacers or filler materials shall be trowel applied per CSM's recommendations. Work surfacer/filler into all voids to displace air and fill bugholes. Surfacer/filler and prime coat thicknesses are in addition to the system thickness specified below. System Thickness: Primer: As recommended by the CSM. 09900-78 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT 3.05 COATING SYSTEM SPECIFICATION SHEETS (COATSPEC) Coating System Identification: EA -5 (continued) Surfacer/Filler: 1/16 -inch minimum thickness above plane of concrete to create a monolithic and pinhole free surface. Base Coat Floor Surfaces: Base Coat and Saturation Coat: Base Coat for Containment Wall and Base Surfaces: Base Coat General: Surfacer or filler shall be applied per CSM's recommendations prior to application of coating system to fill all bugholes and voids and create a coatable surface by being applied as a complete 1/8 inch thick parge coat. This is for containment walls, curbs and bases and not for floor surfaces. For floor surfaces, the base coat shall be applied at thickness recommended by CSM and broadcast with aggregate to create a non -slip surface (texture to be as recommended by the CSM). Following application of the broadcast aggregate and removal of all excess aggregates, the base coat will be applied to encapsulate the non -slip aggregate embedded. For trench or sump surfaces and unloading areas, the base coat shall be applied to the thickness recommended by the CSM and then scrim cloth shall be embedded in it. Next, the same material will be applied as a saturation coat to encapsulate fully the scrim cloth. This shall be applied to the thickness recommended by the CSM. For containment wall, curb, and equipment base surfaces shall be applied to the thickness recommended by the CSM. The basecoat will be an aggregate filled coating as will the saturation coat. Both shall be applied in strict accordance with the CSM's recommendations. The aggregate used in these coating systems for hydrofluorosilica aggregates resistant to the HFS or fully encapsulated with resin to prevent attack of the silica aggregate. Finish: The finish coat or coats shall be applied to the thickness recommended by the CSM. All coating system thicknesses are in addition to the parge coat. 09900-79 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • • • • • 3.05 COATING SYSTEM SPECIFICATION SHEETS (COATSPEC) Coating System Identification: EA -5 (continued) Testing: Holiday detection shall be performed over 100% of the coated surface area to identify any holidays or pinholes that must be repaired. Holiday detection to be performed after proper application and cure of the coating system. Holiday detection to be performed in accordance with NACE RP0188. Pinhole and Holiday Repair Procedure: Pinholes or holidays identified by Holiday Detection shall be repaired as follows: • Using a grinder or other suitable power tool, remove the coating system at all pinholes or holidays in an area at least 2 inches in diameter or in both dimensions around the defect back to the concrete substrate. • Chip out and remove the concrete to expose the full dimensions in all three directions of the air void responsible for the defect. • Aggressively abrade or sand the intact coating system surface at least 3 inches beyond the removal area in all directions to produce a uniform 6- to 8 -mil profile in the intact coating system. • Vacuum clean the prepared area to remove all dust, dirt, etc. leaving clean sound surfaces. • Tape to mask the periphery of the prepared intact coating area to prevent coating repair application onto the prepared area. • Using a putty knife or other suitable tool, fill the opened void with the approved filler/surfacer material completely and strike -off. Allow to cure per CSM's recommendations. • Apply the coating system in the number of coats necessary to achieve the specified finish coat thickness over the defect and coating removal area and feather the coating onto the abraded coated surfaces around the removal area to avoid a lip and to achieve a neat repair outline. Allow to cure properly. 09900-80 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT 3.05 COATING SYSTEM SPECIFICATION SHEETS (COATSPEC) Coating System Identification: EA -5 (continued) Curing time between coats shall be as specified by the CSM for the site conditions. If the maximum recoat time is exceeded, surface preparation shall require solvent washing, light abrasive blasting, or other procedures per CSM's instructions. Location System Thickness (mils dry film) FECL Receiving Station Slab 110-145 (with silica sand) Sump walls and floor 40 Storage Tank Secondary Containment Floor and other horizontal surfaces 60-75 Vertical Surfaces 40 Metering Pump Secondary Containment Floor and other horizontal surfaces 60-75 (with silica sand) Vertical Surfaces 40 09900-81 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • • • 3.05 COATING SYSTEM SPECIFICATION SHEETS (COATSPEC) Coating System Identification: EC -1 Coating Material: Hybrid Polyurethane • Surface: Concrete or dense masonry where existing crack or joint movement is suspected of propagating through rigid cured epoxy coatings. Service Condition: Surface Preparation: Interior or exterior, exposed to direct sunlight or not, corrosive (immersion pH 4.0 or lower and/or headspace pH 4.0 or lower and/or gaseous H2S concentrations between 10 and 150 ppm typically). All coating termination and transition details shall be prepared in accordance with the CSM's standard detail drawings. This includes coating termination details, coating transitions at vertical and vertical to horizontal corners, coating terminations at joints, concrete crack treatment, pipe penetration treatment, coating terminations at metal embedments in the concrete substrate, and other details. The CSM's standard detail drawings shall be submitted for all such coating applications. If standard details are not available for a given detail treatment, the CSM shall be required to produce one at no additional cost to the owner, the engineer, or any other party. If wet abrasive or water blasting surface preparation methods were used, the concrete substrate shall be allowed to dry under warm conditions (minimum of 75 degrees F) for at least 5 days prior to coating application. Following surface preparation work and dry -out, all surfaces to be coated shall be vacuum cleaned to remove all loose dirt, dust, or other loose materials. 09900-82 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT 3.05 COATING SYSTEM SPECIFICATION SHEETS (COATSPEC) Coating System Identification: EC -1 (continued) Concrete: Concrete surfaces shall be allowed to cure for at least 28 days and allowed to dry to the moisture content recommended by the CSM. Moisture content may be tested by the Construction Manager with a Delmhorst Instrument Company moisture detector, or equal. Except as otherwise specified, loose concrete, form oils, surface hardeners, curing compounds, and laitance shall be removed from surfaces by abrasive blasting and chipping, and voids and cracks shall be repaired as specified in Section 03300. Surface Preparation must open up all shelled over air voids or bugholes to expose fully the void's depth, width, and length. Concrete shall be abraded to achieve a uniform concrete surface profile of CSP -5 in accordance with ICRI 03732. After surface preparation has been accepted, a complete skim coat of the specified filler surfacer shall be applied over all concrete surfaces and all bugholes (air voids) shall be completely filled using this same material. The filler/surfacer material shall be applied as a complete parge coat of the substrate. If the parge coat (filler/surfacer material) is non -polymer modified, it must be brush blast cleaned following adequate cure per CSM's instructions to produce a uniform anchor pattern of CSP -4 in accordance with ICRI 03732 prior to coating application. Application: Field Surfacers or filler materials shall be applied per CSM's recommendations prior to application of prime coat to fill bugholes and voids. These materials must be compatible with the primers and finish coats. Prime coat shall be thinned and applied as recommended by the CSM, provided the coating as applied complies with prevailing air pollution control regulations. System Thickness: 35-50 mils dry film in addition to the parge coat. 09900-83 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • • 3.05 COATING SYSTEM SPECIFICATION SHEETS (COATSPEC) Coating System Identification: EC -1 (continued) Coatings: Primer: One coat at 2-3 mils dry film thickness Finish: One or more coats at CSM's recommended dry film thickness per coat to the specified system thickness. Testing: Holiday detection shall be performed over 100% of the coated surface area to identify any holidays or pinholes that must be repaired. Pinhole and Holiday Repair Procedure: Pinholes or holidays identified by Holiday Detection shall be repaired as follows: • Using a grinder or other suitable power tool, remove the coating system at all pinholes or holidays in an area at least 2 inches in diameter or in both dimensions around the defect back to the concrete substrate. • Chip out and remove the concrete to expose the full dimensions in all three directions of the air void responsible for the defect. • Aggressively abrade or sand the intact coating system surface at least 3 -inches beyond the removal area in all directions to produce a uniform 6- to 8 -mil profile in the intact coating system. • Vacuum clean the prepared area to remove all dust, dirt, etc. leaving clean sound surfaces. • Tape to mask the periphery of the prepared intact coating area to prevent coating repair application onto the prepared area. • Using a putty knife or other suitable tool, fill the opened void with the approved filler/surfacer material completely and strike -off. Allow to cure per CSM's recommendations. 09900-84 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT 3.05 COATING SYSTEM SPECIFICATION SHEETS (COATSPEC) Coating System Identification: EC -1 (continued) • Apply the coating system in the number of coats necessary to achieve the specified 35-50 mils DFT over the defect and coating removal area and feather the coating onto the abraded coated surfaces around the removal area to avoid a lip and to achieve a neat repair outline. Allow to cure properly. 09900-85 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • 3.05 COATING SYSTEM SPECIFICATION SHEETS (COATSPEC) • • Coating System Identification: Coating Material: Surface: Service Condition: Surface Preparation: EC -2 (NSF -61) Modified Polyurethane Concrete or Dense Masonry where existing crack or joint movement is suspected due to thermal conditions and would propagate through rigid epoxy coating systems and/or where NSF -61 certification is required. Interior or exterior, submerged or non -submerged indirect sunlight — moderately corrosive. All coating termination and transition details shall be prepared in accordance with the CSM's standard detail drawings. This includes coating termination details, coating transitions at vertical and vertical to horizontal corners, coating terminations at joints, concrete crack treatment, pipe penetration treatment, coating terminations at metal embedments in the concrete substrate, and other details. The CSM's standard detail drawings shall be submitted for all such coating applications. If standard details are not available for a given detail treatment, the CSM shall be required to produce one at no additional cost to the owner, the engineer, or any other party. If wet abrasive or water blasting surface preparation methods were used, the concrete substrate shall be allowed to dry under warm conditions (minimum of 75 degrees F) for at least 5 days prior to coating application. Following surface preparation work and dry -out, all surfaces to be coated shall be vacuum cleaned to remove all loose dirt, dust, or other loose materials. 09900-86 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT 3.05 COATING SYSTEM SPECIFICATION SHEETS (COATSPEC) Coating System Identification: EC -2 (NSF -61) (continued) Concrete: Concrete surfaces shall be allowed to cure for at least 28 days and allowed to dry to the moisture content recommended by the CSM. Moisture content may be tested by the Construction Manager with a Delmhorst Instrument Company moisture detector, or equal. Except as otherwise specified, loose concrete, form oils, surface hardeners, curing compounds, and laitance shall be removed from surfaces by abrasive blasting and chipping, and voids and cracks shall be repaired as specified in Section 03300. Surface Preparation must open up all shelled over air voids or bugholes to expose fully the void's depth, width, and length. Concrete shall be abraded to achieve a uniform concrete surface profile of CSP -5 in accordance with ICRI 03732. After surface preparation has been accepted, a complete skim coat of the specified filler surfacer shall be applied over all concrete surfaces and all bugholes (air voids) shall be completely filled using this same material. The filler/surfacer material shall be applied as a complete parge coat of the substrate. If the parge coat (filler/surfacer material) is non -polymer modified, it must be brush blast cleaned following adequate cure per CSM's instructions to produce a uniform anchor pattern of CSP -4 in accordance with ICRI 03732 prior to coating application. Application: Field Surfacer or filler shall be applied per CSM's recommendations prior to application of prime coat to fill bugholes and voids. These materials must be compatible with the primers and finish coats. Prime coat shall be thinned and applied as recommended by the CSM, provided the coating as applied complies with prevailing air pollution control regulations. System Thickness: 50-75 mils dry film. 09900-87 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • • • 3.05 COATING SYSTEM SPECIFICATION SHEETS (COATSPEC) Coating System Identification: EC -2 (NSF -61) (continued) Coatings: Primer: One coat at 3-5 mils dry film thickness Finish: One or more coats at CSM's recommended dry film thickness per coat to the specified system thickness. Testing: Holiday detection shall be performed over 100% of the coated surface area to identify any holidays or pinholes that must be repaired. Pinhole and Holiday Repair Procedure: Pinholes or holidays identified by Holiday Detection shall be repaired as follows: • Using a grinder or other suitable power tool, remove the coating system at all pinholes or holidays in an area at least 2 inches in diameter or in both dimensions around the defect back to the concrete substrate. • Chip out and remove the concrete to expose the full dimensions in all three directions of the air void responsible for the defect. • Aggressively abrade or sand the intact coating system surface at least 3 -inches beyond the removal area in all directions to produce a uniform 6- to 8 -mil profile in the intact coating system. • Vacuum clean the prepared area to remove all dust, dirt, etc. leaving clean sound surfaces. • Tape to mask the periphery of the prepared intact coating area to prevent coating repair application onto the prepared area. • Using a putty knife or other suitable tool, fill the opened void with the approved filler/surfacer material completely and strike -off. Allow to cure per CSM's recommendations. 09900-88 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT 3.05 COATING SYSTEM SPECIFICATION SHEETS (COATSPEC) Coating System Identification: EC -2 (NSF -61) (continued) • Apply the coating system in the number of coats necessary to achieve the specified 35-50 mils DFT over the defect and coating removal area and feather the coating onto the abraded coated surfaces around the removal area to avoid a lip and to achieve a neat repair outline. Allow to cure properly. 09900-89 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • 3.05 COATING SYSTEM SPECIFICATION SHEETS (COATSPEC) Coating System Identification: EU -1 Coating Material: Zinc -Epoxy -Polyurethane System Surface: Ferrous Metal Service Condition: Exterior, exposed to direct sunlight, moderately corrosive, non -immersed. Surface Preparation: General: Ferrous Metal: Galvanized Metal: Shop primed surfaces which are to be incorporated in the work shall be prepared in the field by cleaning surfaces in accordance with SSPC SP -2 (Hand Tool Cleaning). Damaged shop coated areas shall be cleaned in accordance with SSPC SP -3 (Power Tool Cleaning) and recoated with the primer specified. Bare ferrous metal surfaces shall be prepared in accordance with SSPC SP -6 (Commercial Blast Cleaning) 2.5 — 3.0. Ductile iron surfaces to be coated shall be abrasive blast cleaned in accordance with paragraph 09900-3.02 D. Ferrous metal with rust bleeding shall be cleaned in accordance with SSPC-SP-11 (Power Tool Cleaning to Bare Metal). Areas of rust penetration shall be spot blasted to SSPC SP -10 (Near White Blast) and spot primed with the specified primer. Damaged galvanized steel areas with exposed ferrous metal and/or rusted shall be cleaned in accordance with SSPC SP -5 (White Metal Blast Cleaning) or Power Tool Cleaned to Bare Metal in accordance with SSPC-SP-11 to achieve a uniform 1.0- to 1.5 -mil profile and spot primed with the primer specified. Nonferrous and galvanized metal shall be prepared in accordance with SSPC SP -7 (Brush-off Blast Cleaning) to impart a 1.0- to 2.0 -mil profile to the galvanized steel surfaces. Where this cannot be performed, prepare by abrading in accordance with SSPC-SP-3, Power Tool Cleaning to impart a 1.0- to 1.5 -mil profile uniformly to the galvanized steel surfaces. 09900-90 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT 3.05 COATING SYSTEM SPECIFICATION SHEETS (COATSPEC) Coating System Identification: EU -1 (continued) For EU -1 over galvanized steel, delete the zinc rich primer. Application: Field General: Ferrous Metal: System Thickness: Coatings: Primer: Intermediate: Finish: Prime coat may be thinned and applied as recommended by the CSM, provided the coating as applied complies with prevailing air pollution control regulations. Prime coats shall be a zinc rich epoxy or polyurethane primer compatible for use with urethane finish coats and applied in accordance with written instructions of the CSM or in the case of CARB or SCAQMD applications, prime with specified primer that is not zinc rich. In these cases, only a two -coat system is applied. 3 to 4 mils of zinc rich primer, one intermediate or primer epoxy coat at 5 to 6 mils and one finish coat of polyurethane at 2 to 3 mils DFT. One coat at CSM's recommended dry film thickness. One coat at CSM's recommended dry film thickness. One coat at CSM's recommended dry film thickness per coat to meet the specified system thickness. 09900-91 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • II) 3.05 COATING SYSTEM SPECIFICATION SHEETS (COATSPEC) Coating System Identification: EU -1 -FRP Coating Material: Specialty Primer plus Polyurethane Finish Coat Surface: Exterior of FRP Pipe and Tanks, etc. Service Condition: Exterior, exposed to direct sunlight, non -immersed. Surface Preparation: General: Clean to remove loose dirt, dust, or other contaminants. Prepare surfaces by sanding to produce roughness to achieve a uniform, minimum surface profile of 1.5 to 2.0 mils. Solvent clean thoroughly using solvent as recommended by the CSM. Thoroughly clean to remove loose debris by vacuum cleaning. Application: Field General: System Thickness: Coatings: Primer: Finish: Apply primer coat and thin as recommended by the CSM provided the coating applied complies with prevailing air pollution control regulations. Apply finish coat as recommended by the CSM. Primer to 2 to 4 mils and finish coat is 2 to 3 mils DFT. One coat at CSM's recommended dry film thickness. One coat at CSM's recommended dry film thickness per coat to meet the specified system thickness. 09900-92 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT 3.05 COATING SYSTEM SPECIFICATION SHEETS (COATSPEC) Coating System Identification: G Coating Material: Grease Surface: Metal Surface Preparation: Ferrous Metal: Ferrous metal surfaces shall be prepared in accordance with SSPC SP -1 (Solvent Cleaning). Application: Field Coating shall be applied with stiff brush, hand swab, or airless spray gun. System Thickness: 50 square feet per gallon Coating: One coat of grease coating 09900-93 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • 3.05 COATING SYSTEM SPECIFICATION SHEETS (COATSPEC) Coating System Identification: HH -1 Coating Material: Proprietary Primer plus Silicone Topcoat Surface: Metal Service Condition: Temperature to 750 degrees F. Surface Preparation: Metal surfaces shall be prepared in accordance with SSPC SP -10 (Near White Metal Blast Cleaning) to achieve a uniform surface profile of 2.0 to 2.5 mils. Application: System Thickness: Field Curing as required by CSM. 6.5 to 8.0 mils dry film Coating: Primer at 5 to 6 mils DFT plus one topcoat at 1.5 to 2.0 mils DFT. 09900-94 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT 3.05 COATING SYSTEM SPECIFICATION SHEETS (COATSPEC) Coating System Identification: HH -2 Coating Material: Proprietary Primer plus Silicone Topcoat (available in black or aluminum only) Surface: Metal Service Condition: Temperature to 1200 degrees F. Surface Preparation: Metal surfaces shall be prepared in accordance with SSPC SP -10 (Near White Metal Blast Cleaning) to achieve a uniform surface profile of 2.0 to 2.5 mils. Application: System Thickness: Field Curing as required by CSM. 6.5 to 8.0 mils dry film Coating: Primer at 5 to 6 mils DFT plus one topcoat at 1.5 to 2.0 mils DFT. 09900-95 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • 3.05 COATING SYSTEM SPECIFICATION SHEETS (COATSPEC) Coating System Identification: L-1 Coating Material: Latex Surfaces: Concrete, masonry, plaster, gypsum board. Service Condition: Interior and exterior including existing exterior coated concrete. • Surface Preparation: Concrete: Existing Coated Concrete: Masonry: Plaster: Concrete surfaces shall be allowed to age for at least 28 days and allowed to dry to the moisture content recommended by the CSM. Moisture content may be tested by the Construction Manager with a Delmhorst Instrument Company moisture detector, or equal. Loose concrete and laitance shall be removed from surfaces, and voids and cracks shall be repaired as specified in Section 03300. Remove all loose coating down to a sound substrate or intact, well -adhered existing coating by scraping or other means. Then, abrade all surfaces to achieve a 0.5- to 1.5 -mil uniform profile and vacuum clean to remove all loose dirt, paint chips, and dirt. Masonry surfaces shall be allowed to age for at least 28 days. Holes or other joint defects shall be filled with mortar and repointed. Loose or splattered mortar shall be removed by scraping and chipping. Masonry surfaces shall be cleaned with clear water by washing and scrubbing to remove foreign and deleterious substances. Muriatic acid shall not be used. After cleaning, masonry surfaces shall be filled with block filler compatible with the specified primer. Plaster surfaces shall be dry, clean, and free from grit, loose plaster, and surface irregularities. Cracks and holes shall be repaired with acceptable patching materials, keyed to existing surfaces, and sandpapered smooth. Surfaces shall be cleaned with clear water by washing and scrubbing to remove foreign and deleterious substances. After cleaning, surfaces shall be sealed with a compatible sealer. 09900-96 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT 3.05 COATING SYSTEM SPECIFICATION SHEETS (COATSPEC) Coating System Identification: L-1 (continued) Gypsum Wallboard: Tape joints and spackled nail heads shall be sanded smooth and dusted. Seal with PVA sealer for interior uses only. Application: Field System Thickness: Coatings: Primer: Finish: Sealer or filler shall dry a minimum of 48 hours prior to primer application. Drying time between coats shall be as recommended by CSM. 4 mils dry film. One coat at CSM's recommended dry film thickness. Two or more coats at CSM's recommended dry film thickness per coat to the specified system thickness. 09900-97 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • 3.05 COATING SYSTEM SPECIFICATION SHEETS (COATSPEC) Coating System Identification: L-2 Coating Material: Latex Surface: PVC and CPVC pipe. Service Condition: Exterior, direct sunlight exposure. Surface Preparation: Plastic pipe shall be cleaned with solvent compatible with the specified primer and sanded to roughen surfaces to achieve a uniform surface profile of 1.0 to 1.5 mils. Vacuum clean after sanding to remove all loose dust, plastic particles, and dirt. Application: System Thickness: Coatings: Primer: Finish: Field 3 mils dry film. One coat at CSM's recommended dry film thickness. One or more coats at CSM's recommended dry film thickness per coat to the specified system thickness. 09900-98 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT 3.05 COATING SYSTEM SPECIFICATION SHEETS (COATSPEC) Coating System Identification: L-3 Coating Material: Latex — Direct to Metal Surface: Ferrous Metal Service Condition: Interior or Exterior Surface Preparation: Ferrous Metals: Bare ferrous metal surfaces shall be prepared in accordance with SSPC SP -6 (Commercial Blast Cleaning) unless specified otherwise. Impart a 1.5- to 2.0 -mil profile to substrate. Nonferrous and Galvanized Metal: Application: System Thickness: Coatings: Primer: Finish: Ferrous metal with rust bleeding shall be cleaned in accordance with SSPC SP -1 (Solvent Cleaning). Areas of rust penetration shall be spot blasted to SSPC SP -10 (Near White Blast) and spot primed with the specified primer. Shop primed surfaces which are to be incorporated in the work shall be prepared in the field by cleaning surfaces in accordance with SSPC SP -2 (Hand Tool Cleaning) or SSPC-SP-3 (Power Tool Cleaning). Galvanized or nonferrous surfaces shall be prepared in accordance with SSPC SP -1 (Solvent Cleaning) after Brush Blast Cleaning in accordance with SSPC-SP-7. Field 6 to 8 mils dry film excluding sealer One coat at CSM's recommended dry film thickness. Two or more coats at CSM's recommended dry film thickness per coat to the specified system thickness. 09900-99 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • 3.05 COATING SYSTEM SPECIFICATION SHEETS (COATSPEC) Coating System Identification: L-4 Coating Material: Latex Surface: Wood Service Condition: Interior Surface Preparation: Wood surfaces shall be cleaned of dirt, oil or other foreign substances with mineral spirits, scrapers, sandpaper or wire brush. Finished surfaces exposed to view shall be smoothed by planing or sandpapering. Millwork shall be sandpapered and given a coat of the specified primer on all sides before installation. Built-in surfaces of windowsills shall be double primed. Glazing rabbets and beads in exterior sash and doors shall be double primed. Small, dry, seasoned knots shall be surfaced scraped, sandpapered, and thoroughly cleaned and shall be given a thin coat of an acceptable knot sealer before application of the priming coat. Large, open, unseasoned knots, and beads or streaks of pitch shall be scraped off; however, if the pitch is still soft, it shall be removed with mineral spirits or turpentine, and the resinous area shall be coated with knot sealer prior to priming. After priming, holes and imperfections shall be filled with putty or plastic wood, colored to match the finish coat, allowed to dry and sandpapered smooth. Application: System Thickness: Coatings: Primer: Finish: Field 4.0 mils dry film. One coat at CSM's recommended dry film thickness. Two or more coats at CSM's recommended dry film thickness per coat to the specified system thickness. 09900-100 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT 3.05 COATING SYSTEM SPECIFICATION SHEETS (COATSPEC) Coating System Identification: M-1 Coating Material: Petrolatum based mastic or wax based wrapping tapes. Surfaces: Metal Service Condition: Below grade (buried) or where little to no surface preparation can be performed on piping or structural steel. Surface Preparation: Application: Remove loose scale, rust, dirt, excessive moisture, or frost from the surface in accordance with SSPC SP -2 (Hand Tool Cleaning). All surfaces shall be hand rubbed or brushed with a priming paste recommended by the CSM. Sharp projections such as threads, irregular contours, or badly pitted areas shall receive a liberal amount of priming paste to ensure maximum protection of metal throughout. On irregular shaped surfaces, i.e., nuts, bolts, flanges, valves, etc., the Contractor shall use either of the following systems recommended by the CSM. A. Apply recommended mastic by hand in sufficient quantity to build an even contour over entire surface. The Contractor shall pay particular attention to ensure that folds and air pockets within the mastic layer are thoroughly pressed out prior to subsequent application of tape. OR: B. An extra layer of tape shall be cut and carefully molded around sharp projections, nuts, bolts, etc., before final application of tape, in order to meet specified system thickness. 09900-101 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • 3.05 COATING SYSTEM SPECIFICATION SHEETS (COATSPEC) Coating System Identification: M-1 (Continued) System Thickness: Tape shall be spirally wrapped with a 55 percent overlap and sufficient tension and pressure to provide continuous adhesion without stretching the tape. Edges of tape must be continuously smoothed and sealed by hand during wrapping. On vertical application, contractor shall begin at bottom and proceed upward creating a weatherboard overlap. Smooth contours shall have a minimum thickness of 50 mils while nuts, bolts, and sharp projections shall be 100 mils. Tape: Number and types of tape wraps shall be in accordance with the CSM's written instructions. 09900-102 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT 3.05 COATING SYSTEM SPECIFICATION SHEETS (COATSPEC) Coating System Identification: M-2 Coating Material: Epoxy mastic or equal Surface: Ferrous Metal Service Condition: Interior, corrosive environment, confined enclosures, where minimal surface preparation is possible. Surface Preparation: Ferrous Metal: All uncoated ferrous metal surfaces shall be prepared in accordance with SSPC SP -3 (Power Tool Cleaning), or SSPC-SP-11 (Power to Cleaning to Bare Metal) prior to assembly. Surface preparation to achieve a uniform surface profile of 2.0 to 2.5 mils. Shop primed ferrous metal surfaces and fabricated assemblies shall be clean and dry prior to the application of field coats. Following assembly, the Contractor shall smooth welds and prominences using power tools prior to the application of the field applied coatings. Application: Field General: System Thickness: Coatings: Prime: Finish: Prior to the application of field applied coatings, welds, back-to-back angles, sharp or rough edges and weld splatter shall be brushed with the specified prime coat and allowed to cure overnight. 15 mils dry film. One coat of the CSM's recommended dry film thickness. One or more coats of CSM's recommended dry film thickness per coat to the specified system thickness. 09900-103 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • 3.05 COATING SYSTEM SPECIFICATION SHEETS (COATSPEC) Coating System Identification: S-1 Coating Material: Penetrating acrylic stain, color required. Surface: Concrete Service Condition: Non -immersed, exposure to moisture and sunlight. Surface Preparation: Brush-off blast or industry standard acid etch or other preparation as approved by the CSM. Application: General: Coatings: System Thickness: Color Selection: Drying time between coats shall be as specified by the CSM for the site conditions. Minimum of two coats overall (coat as many times as required to achieve desired color). 200 square feet per gallon maximum or as recommended by the CSM. As approved by the Construction Manager consistent with neighborhood selection. The Contractor to price materials based on custom color. 09900-104 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT 3.05 COATING SYSTEM SPECIFICATION SHEETS (COATSPEC) Coating System Identification: S-2 Coating Material: Penetrating Water Repellent (Clear and Non -Film Building) Surface: Concrete Floors Service Condition: Exterior and Interior. Surface Preparation: Clean surfaces of all traces of dirt, dust, efflorescence, mold, salt, grease, oil, asphalt, laitance, curing compounds, paint, coatings, and other foreign materials by brush-off blast, water blasting, and/or chemical cleaners or other preparation as approved by the CSM. Concrete Application: Concrete surfaces shall be allowed to age for at least 28 days and allowed to dry to the moisture content recommended by the CSM. Moisture content may be tested by the Construction Manager with a Delmhorst Instrument Company moisture detector, or equal. Loose concrete and laitance shall be removed from surfaces, and voids and cracks shall be repaired as specified in Section 03300 General: Drying time before placing into service shall be as recommended by the CSM for site conditions. System Coverage: Follow CSM's recommendations. Color Selection: Clear. 09900-105 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • • 3.05 COATING SYSTEM SPECIFICATION SHEETS (COATSPEC) Coating System Identification: S-3 Coating Material: Penetrating Water Repellent (Clear & Non -Film Building) Surface: Concrete and Masonry Walls Service Condition: Exterior and Interior — For Anti -Graffiti Applications • • Surface Preparation: Clean surfaces of all traces of dirt, dust, efflorescence, mold, salt, grease, oil, asphalt, laitance, curing compounds, paint, coatings, and other foreign materials by brush-off blast, water blasting, and/or chemical cleaners or other preparation as approved by the CSM. Concrete Masonry: Application: Concrete surfaces shall be allowed to age for at least 28 days and allowed to dry to the moisture content recommended by the CSM. Moisture content may be tested by the Construction Manager with a Delmhorst Instrument Company moisture detector, or equal. Loose concrete and laitance shall be removed from surfaces, and voids and cracks shall be repaired as specified in Section 03300 Masonry surfaces shall be allowed to age for at least 28 days. Holes or other joint defects shall be filled with mortar and repointed. Loose or splattered mortar shall be removed by scraping and chipping. Masonry surfaces shall be cleaned with clear water by washing and scrubbing to remove foreign and deleterious substances. Muriatic acid shall not be used. General: Drying time before placing into service shall be as recommended by the CSM for site conditions. System Coverage: Follow CSM's recommendations. Color Selection: Clear. 09900-106 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT 3.05 COATING SYSTEM SPECIFICATION SHEETS (COATSPEC) Coating System Identification: S-4 Coating Material: Penetrating Oil and Water Repellent (Non -Film Forming) Surface: Concrete Floors Service Condition: Exterior and Interior. Surface Preparation: Clean surfaces of all traces of dirt, dust, efflorescence, mold, salt, grease, oil, asphalt, laitance, curing compounds, paint, coatings, and other foreign materials by brush-off blast, water blasting, and/or chemical cleaners or other preparation as approved by the CSM. Concrete Application: Concrete surfaces shall be allowed to age for at least 28 days and allowed to dry to the moisture content recommended by the CSM. Moisture content may be tested by the Construction Manager with a Delmhorst Instrument Company moisture detector, or equal. Loose concrete and laitance shall be removed from surfaces, and voids and cracks shall be repaired as specified in Section 03300. General: Drying time before placing into service shall be as recommended by the CSM for site conditions. Coatings: One coat, flood horizontal surface so coating ponds for at least 60 seconds. Broom over all puddles thoroughly until complete penetration is achieved System Thickness: Follow CSM's recommendations. Color Selection: Clear. 09900-107 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • • • • • 3.06 COATING SYSTEMS SCHEDULE (FINISH SCHEDULE) Specific coating systems, colors, and finishes for rooms, galleries, piping, equipment, and other items that are coated or have other architectural finishes are specified in the following coating system schedule. Unless otherwise specified in the coating system schedule, the word "interior" shall mean the inside of a building or structure, and the word "exterior" shall mean outside exposure to weather elements. Location Description Surface Coating System Identification Standard Color A. General: 1. Structural Steel, Metal Decking, and Galvanized Uncoated or E-2 All surfaces not specified by area or structure Acoustical Decking 2. Equipment and Metal Appurtenances a. Equipment, non immersed, unless otherwise specified 1) Indoors E-1 FS 25051 Blue 2) Outdoors EU -1 FS 20040 Brown b. Equipment, immersed, unless otherwise specified c. High temperature equipment operable at E-2 Beige 1) 200 to 750 degrees F HH -1 FS 26306 Grey 2) above 750 degrees F to 1200 degrees F HH -2 Aluminum or d. Existing equipment Black 1) Not damaged nor modified by work in this contract Uncoated -- 2) Damaged, exposed, or modified by work in this contract a) Indoors E-1 (see paragraph 09900-3.02) Match existing color b) Outdoors EU -1 without primer (see paragraph Match existing color e. Diffusers and grilles on coated surfaces, unless otherwise specified 09900-3.02) 1) Indoors E-1 Match background color 2) Outdoors f. Diffusers and grilles on uncoated surfaces, unless otherwise specified EU -1 Match background color 1) Indoors E-1 FS 25051 Blue Coating Systems Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) 09900-108 December 2020 City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT Location Description Surface Coating System Identification Standard Color 2) Outdoors g. Existing diffusers and grilles 1) Not damaged not modified by work in this contract 2) Damaged, exposed, or modified by work in this contract a) Indoors b) Outdoors h. Electrical switchgear panels, unit substations, motor control centers, power transformers, distribution centers, and relay panels; indoors and outdoors i. Instrumentation panels, graphic indicating panels, indicating and transmitting field panels, unless otherwise specified 1) Indoors 2) Outdoors j. Existing electrical and instrumentation panels 1) Not damaged by work in this contract 2) Damaged or exposed to outside surfaces by work in this contract a) Indoors b) Outdoors EU -1 Uncoated E-1 (see paragraph 09900-3.02 F) EU -1 without primer (see paragraph 09900-3.02 F) See paragraph 09900-3.03 I See paragraph 09900-3.03 I See paragraph 09900-3.03 I Uncoated E-1 (see paragraph 09900-3.02 F) EU -1 without primer (see paragraph 09900-3.02 F) 3. Conduit, Piping and Ductwork a. Ferrous, non-ferrous and galvanized piping, and appurtenant hangers and supports, non -immersed, unless otherwise specified. 1) Indoors — noncorrosive E-1 FS 20040 Brown Match existing color Match existing color ANSI 61 Grey (outside) FS 27880 White (inside) FS 26306 Grey (outside) FS 27880 White (inside) FS 27722 White (outside) FS 27880 White (inside) FS 26306 Grey FS 26306 Grey (Electrical) FS 27722 White (Instrumentation) FS 25051 Blue 09900-109 Coating Systems Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) December 2020 City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • • • • • Location Description Surface Coating System Identification 2) Outdoors — noncorrosive 3) Indoors — in corrosive environment 4) Buried piping b. Ferrous piping, appurtenant and supports, immersed c. Conduit, outlet and junction boxes, lighting transformers, lighting, communication and small power panels, control stations, piping, lagged ductwork, appurtenant hangers, clamps, and supports on coated surfaces, unless otherwise specified. 1) Indoors 2) Outdoors d. Conduit, outlets and junction boxes, lighting transformers, lighting, communication and small power panels, control stations, piping, lagged ductwork, appurtenant hangers, clamps and supports on uncoated surfaces, unless otherwise specified 1) Indoors 2) Outdoors e. Existing conduit, outlet and junction boxes, lighting transformers, lighting communication and small power panels, control stations, piping, lagged ductwork, appurtenant hangers, clamps, and supports 1) Not damaged nor modified by work in this contract 2) Damaged, exposed, or modified by work in this contract a) Indoors b) Outdoors f. Racked conduits and cable trays g. Insulated pipe jacketing h. Plastic, fiberglass and flexible conduit and piping 1) Unless otherwise specified 2) PVC and CPVC Piping EU -1 EA -1 M-1 or M-2 E-2 E-1 EU -1 E-1 EU -1 Uncoated E-1 (see paragraph 09900-3.02 F) EU -1 without primer (see paragraph 09900-3.02 F) Uncoated Uncoated Uncoated L-2 Standard Color FS 20040 Brown To be determined Not required To be determined Match background color Match background color FS 25051 Blue FS 20040 Brown Match existing color Match existing color FS 25051 Blue Coating Systems Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) 09900-110 December 2020 City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT Location Description Surface Coating System Identification a) Exposed to direct sunlight b) Not exposed to direct sunlight i. High temperature piping operable at 1) 200 to 750 degrees F 2) Above 750 degrees F to 1,200 degrees F j. Exposed ductwork, unless otherwise specified L-2 E-7 HH -1 HH -2 Uncoated Standard Color FS 25051 Blue FS 25051 Blue FS 26306 Grey Aluminum or Black 4. Concrete, Grout, Masonry and Plaster a. Immersed tank and channel walls and bottoms unless otherwise specified b. Outside concrete walls below grade common with dry area or room c. Walls and ceilings 1) Precast concrete or colored masonry 2) Outdoors, unless otherwise specified 3) Indoors, unless otherwise specified d. Concrete equipment bases unless otherwise specified e. Floors unless otherwise specified f. Existing coated surfaces. Uncoated Uncoated Uncoated E-4 E-4 S-2 L-1 FS 23617 Beige Match equipment color Match existing color. 5. Door and Door Frames a. Doors unless otherwise specified 1) Ferrous metal a) Indoors b) Outdoors 2) Aluminum 3) Other 4) Existing a) Not damaged by work in this contract b) Damaged, exposed, or modified by work in this contract (1) Indoors (2) Outdoors 09900-111 Coating Systems Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) E-1 EU -1 Uncoated Plastic laminate Uncoated E-1 (see paragraph 09900-3.02 F) EU -1 (see paragraph 09900-3.02 F) FS 20040 Brown FS 25051 Blue Formica 947 Brown Match existing color Match existing color December 2020 City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • • • • • Location Description Surface Coating System Identification Standard Color b. Door frames unless otherwise specified 1) Adjacent wall coated a) Indoors b) Outdoors 2) Adjacent wall uncoated a) Indoors b) Outdoors 3) Aluminum 4) Existing a) Not damaged by work in this contract b) Damaged, exposed , or modified by work in this contract (1) Indoors (2) Outdoors E-1 EU -1 E-1 EU -1 Uncoated Uncoated E-1 (see paragraph 09900-3.02 F) EU -1 without primer (see paragraph 09900-3.02 F) Match wall color Match wall color FS 20040 Brown FS 25051 Blue Match existing color Match existing color 6. Handrails, Gratings, Floor Plates, Manhole Covers, and Hatches a. Unless otherwise specified b. Existing 1) Not damaged by work in this contract 2) Damaged, exposed, or modified by work in this contract a) Indoors b) Outdoors Uncoated Uncoated E-1 (see paragraph 09900-3.02 F) EU -1 without primer (see paragraph 09900-3.02 F) Match existing color Match existing color 7. Metal Stairs, Ladders, Platforms, and Supports Except Tread and Grating a. Indoors b. Outdoors c. Existing 1) Not damaged nor modified by work in this contract 2) Damaged, exposed, or modified by work in this contract E-1 EU -1 Uncoated FS 25051 Blue FS 20040 Brown Coating Systems Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) 09900-112 December 2020 City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT Location Description Surface Coating System Identification Standard Color a) Indoors b) Outdoors 8. Aluminum Flashing, Light Standards, Supports, and Louvers Indoors and outdoors, unless otherwise specified E-1 (see paragraph 09900-3.02 F) EU -1 without primer (see paragraph 09900-3.02 F) Uncoated Match existing color Match existing color 9. Precast Concrete Metalwork Fasteners, anchors, supports, etc. EU -1 Match wall 10. Other a. Fire hydrants b. Flap gates c. Aluminum slide gates d. Sluice gates 1) Gate 2) Stem, except potable 3) Operator a) Indoors b) Outdoors e. Tanks 1) Steel tanks unless otherwise specified a) Inside of wash water or similar tanks b) Inside of sludge (open top) tanks c) Outside of tank (1) Indoors (2) Outdoors 2) Potable steel water storage tanks a) Inside of tank b) Outside of tank 3) Fiberglass tank f. Pipe, ductwork, equipment and appurtenances made from fiberglass, plastic, rubber, including flexible hose, conduit, and plastic coated tubing, in areas not exposed to view (indoors) (metal hangers and supports are coated with E-1) EU -1 EA -1 Uncoated G E-2 EU -1 E-2 E-9 E-1 EU -1 E-5 EU -1 Uncoated Uncoated FS 21302 Red Beige FS 25051 Blue FS 20040 Brown FS 25051 Blue FS 25051 Blue See Note 1 FS 25051 Blue 09900-113 Coating Systems Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) December 2020 City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • • • • • Location Description Surface Coating System Identification Standard Color g. Buried, sleeve -type and flanged pipe, couplings, valves, mechanical and electrical penetrations M-1 or M-2 Manufacturer's color B. Primary sedimentati on tanks and effluent channels 1. Drive chain, sprockets, and shafts of longitudinal and cross collectors G -- 2. Scum removers, collection equipment EA -1 3. Steel and cast iron below maximum water level (elevation [ ]) E-2 4. Effluent control valve a. Gate and stem b. Operator EA -1 EU -1 -- FS 20040 Brown 5. Concrete walls common with equipment gallery- noncorrosive. E-2 Beige 6. Concrete headspaces above max water level elevation 1 1 and 2'-0"below max. water level — corrosive. C. Aerated grit removal tank and supply channels 1. Scum removers, collection equipment. EA -1 -- 2. Steel and cast iron below maximum water level (elevation [ ]) Beige 3. Concrete headspaces above max water level elevation [ ] and 2'-0" below max. water level — E-2 corrosive D. Secondary and final sedimentati on tank including supply and effluent channels 1. Submerged equipment, including interior and exterior surfaces of sludge remover with center pier, sludge collectors, drive cage, and influent chamber baffle; scum skimmers; effluent collection brackets, weir trough and piping E-2 Beige 2. Steel bridge and sludge remover drive and equipment above maximum water level (elevation [ ]) (if not a covered structure) EU -1 FS 20040 Brown 3. Chains and gears G -- E. Aeration tanks including supply and effluent channels 1. Effluent water troughs and support brackets: a. Metals b. Concrete EA -1 EA -2 -- -- F. WAS thickener 1. Influent feed wells, drive cages, distribution weirs, and bottom sludge collectors E-9 Beige 2. Concrete: upper main wall 2'-0" below max. water level elevation [ ] and launder trough surfaces EA -2 or EC -1 3. Float collector arms, float troughs and float conveyors EA -1 -- Coating Systems Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) 09900-114 December 2020 City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT Location Description Surface Coating System Identification Standard Color 4. Air dissolution tank a. Inside b. Outside EA -1 EU -1 -- FS 25051 Blue G. Wet well 1. Piping and appurtenant hangers and supports above max. water level elevation [ 1 EA -1 -- 2. Piping and appurtenance hangars and supports below max. water level elevation [ 1 E-2 -- 3. Walls and ceiling above max. water level elevation 1 1 E -9-C -- 4. Walls and ceiling below max. water level elevation [ 1 E-2 -- H. Digesters 1. Inside and outside gas eductor tubes and tube supports EA -1 -- 2. Underside floating covers, inside gas domes, safety chambers, and seal pipes EA -1 -- 3. Within the floating cover including trusses, structural steel, roofing M-2 Manufacturer's standard color I. Sludge gas storage sphere 1. Inside EA -1 -- 2. Outside EU -1 FS 25051 Blue J. Influent structure 1. Bar screen housing a. Inside b. Outside EA -1 EU -1 -- FS 25051 Blue 2. Bar screen sluiceway EA -1 -- K. Administrat ion Building 1. Outdoors a. Equipment on roof b. Walls EU -1 Uncoated FS 25051 Blue -- 2. Room 5401 Lobby a. Floor b. Base c. Plaster walls d. Steel deck ceiling e. Steel roof trusses f. Doors g. Door frames Epoxy terrazzo Epoxy terrazzo L-1 L-3 L-3 L-3 L-3 National Mosaic Assoc. Std S109 NMAS S 109 FS 23617 Beige FS 23617 Beige FS 23617 Beige FS 20040 Brown FS 23617 Beige 3. Room 5402 Clerical Area a. Floor Epoxy terrazzo LAMAS S109 09900-115 Coating Systems Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) December 2020 City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • • • • • Location Description Surface Coating System Identification Standard Color b. Base c. Plaster walls d. Steel deck ceiling e. Steel roof trusses f. Doors g. Door frames h. Filing cabinets Epoxy terra77o L-1 L-3 L-3 L-3 L-3 Shop coated NMAS S109 FS 23617 Beige FS 23617 Beige FS 23617 Beige FS 20040 Brown FS 23617 Beige Steelcase Tan 4. Room 5403 Conference Room a. Floor b. Base c. Plaster walls d. Acoustical tile ceiling e. Doors f. Door frames g. Shelving and gables h. Tackboards i. Chalkboard Vinyl composite tile Plastic laminate L-1 Uncoated L-3 L-3 Plastic laminate To be determined Formic 879 Beige FS 23617 Beige Match wall color FS 20040 Brown FS 23617 Beige Formica 879 Beige Claridge Products 1104 Burnt Umber Claridge Products 14 Charcoal Brown 5. Room 5404 Stairwell a. Floor b. Base c. Treads and risers d. Plaster walls and ceiling e. Doors f. Door frames Vinyl composite tile Plastic laminate Vinyl composite Tile L-1 L-3 L-3 Amtico Ava-548 Formica 879 Beige Amtico Ava-548 FS 23617 Beige FS 20040 Brown FS 23617 Beige 6. Room 5405 Women's Wash Room a. Floor b. Base Epoxy terrazzo Epoxy terrazzo NMAS S109 NMAS S109 Coating Systems Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) 09900-116 December 2020 City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT Location Description Surface Coating System Identification Standard Color c. Wainscoat d. Plaster walls and ceiling e. Doors f. Door frames g. Toilet partition h. Vanity Ceramic tile L-1 L-3 L-3 Shop coated Plastic laminate 7. Room 5406 Men's Wash Room a. Floor b. Base c. Wainscoat d. Plaster walls and ceiling e. Doors f. Door frames g. Toilet partition Epoxy terrazzo Epoxy terrazzo Ceramic tile E-4 L-3 L-3 Shop coated Dallas Ceramic C-125 FS 23617 Beige FS 20040 Brown FS 23617 Beige Sanymetal 24 Blue Formica 879 Beige NMAS S109 NMAS S109 Dallas Ceramic DC -125 FS 23617 Beige FS 20040 Brown FS 23617 Beige Sanymetal 24 Blue 8. Room 5407 Plant Superintendent a. Floor b. Base c. Plaster walls d. Acoustical tile ceiling e. Doors f. Door frames g. Counters 1) Top 2) Door faces 3) Dead panels 4) Inside and shelving h. Upper cabinet Vinyl composite Tile Plastic laminate L-1 L-3 L-3 Plastic laminate Plastic laminate Plastic laminate L-4 Amtico Ava-548 Formica 879 Beige FS 23617 Beige Match wall color FS 20040 Brown FS 23617 Beige Formica 879 Beige Formica 947 Brown Formica 947 Brown FS 23617 Beige 09900-117 Coating Systems Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) December 2020 City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • • • Location Description Surface Coating System Identification Standard Color 1) Door faces 2) Inside and shelving Plastic laminate L-4 9. Room 5408 Shower Room a. Floor b. Base c. Wainscoat d. Plaster walls and ceiling e. Bench 1) Top 2) Steel frame f. Lockers Epoxy terrazzo Epoxy terrazzo Ceramic tile E-4 E-8 E-1 Shop coated Formica 947 Brown FS 23617 Beige NMAS S109 NMAS S109 Dallas Ceramic DC 125 FS 23617 Beige FS 20040 Brown To match Sanymetal 24 Blue 10. Room 5409 Laboratory a. Floor b. Base c. Plaster walls d. Acoustical tile ceiling e. Doors f. Door frames g. Counters 1) Tops 2) Door and drawer faces 3) Dead panels 4) Inside 5) Shelving 6) Bookshelves 7) Bookshelf gables h. Upper cabinets Epoxy terrazzo Epoxy terrazzo L-1 L-3 L-3 Plastic laminate Plastic laminate Plastic laminate L-4 Plastic laminate Plastic laminate Plastic laminate NMAS S109 NMAS S109 FS 23617 Beige Match wall color FS 20040 Brown FS 23617 Beige Formica 879 Beige Formica 947 Brown Formica 947 Brown FS 23617 Beige Formica 879 Beige Formica 879 Beige Formica 879 Beige Coating Systems Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) 09900-118 December 2020 City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT Location Description Surface Coating System Identification Standard Color 1) Gable faces Plastic laminate Formica 879 Beige 2) Inside L-4 FS 23617 Beige 3) Shelving Plastic laminate Formica 879 Beige i. Exhaust hood trim Plastic laminate Formica 947 Brown j. Dumbwaiter door Plastic laminate Formica 947 Brown Notes: 1. Owner will select color from coating manufacturer's list of EPA approved colors for potable water. 09900-119 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • 3.07 INSPECTION AND TESTING BY OWNER A. Inspection by the Owner or others does not limit the Contractor's or CSA's responsibilities for quality workmanship or quality control as specified or as required by the CSM's instructions. Inspection by the Owner is in addition to any inspection required to be performed by the Contractor. B. The Owner may perform, or contract with an inspection agency to perform, quality control inspection and testing of the coating work covered by this Section 09900. These inspections may include the following: 1. Inspect materials upon receipt to ensure that are supplied by the CSM. 2. Inspect to verify that specified storage conditions for the coating system materials, solvents and abrasives are provided. 3. Inspect and record findings for the degree of cleanliness of substrates. 4. Inspect and record the pH of concrete and metal substrates. 5. Inspect and record substrate profile (anchor pattern). 6. Measure and record ambient air and substrate temperature. 7. Measure and record relative humidity. 8. Check for the presence of substrate moisture in the concrete. 9. Inspect to verify that correct mixing of coating system materials is performed in accordance with CSM's instructions. 10. Inspect, confirm, and record that the "pot life" of coating system materials is not exceeded during installation. Inspect to verify that recoat limitations for coating materials are not exceeded. 11. Perform adhesion testing. 12. Measure and record the thickness of the coating system. 13. Inspect to verify proper curing of the coating system in accordance with the CSM's instructions. 14. Perform holiday or continuity testing for coatings that will be immersed or coatings that will be exposed to aggressively corrosive conditions. 09900-120 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18-0047-11f 3.08 FINAL INSPECTION A. Contractor shall conduct a final inspection to determine whether coating system work meets the requirements of the specifications. B. The Construction Manager will subsequently conduct a final inspection with the Contractor to determine the work is in conformance with requirements of the contract documents. C. Any rework required shall be marked. Such areas shall be recleaned and repaired as specified at no additional cost to the Owner. 09900-121 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • • • 2 " ,. b:a' : i..; .� ^'�'"�,,e'N` y X r ,: . e. _nw. ._'a v�k. .....: i P:.�'b`�M.� ., .� .^r., fir. M,... se ✓s. ri.....i,.�" v.,ii rMa _r_�' ^P4 .:F ,. Project Name: 4 'S`'� 'e *`�`k .i xt 'ys,4�3 Sik nb` � ' k r & e.ru w.n ,��c�,, ,��. . :mx ,.: a .n n. r. Owner •ek ' '�!" a�.� . �'�� W'." t 'S », h'�' a '�.n.RRar M".,'a'4' Coating System Manufacturer(CSM) Completion of cleaning and substrate decontamination prior to abrasive blast cleaning. General Contractor (GC) Coating System Applicator(CSA) Area or Structure Location within Structure Coating System (e.g. E-1) Coating Type (e.g. Epoxy, etc.) 2 " ,. b:a' : i..; .� ^'�'"�,,e'N` y X r ,: . e. _nw. ._'a v�k. .....: i P:.�'b`�M.� ., .� .^r., fir. M,... se ✓s. ri.....i,.�" v.,ii rMa _r_�' ^P4 .:F ,. i. t § $r,& : d, i , � �r c w '� �.. .. ^�.k , ... ,.+,r%�. GC QC 4 'S`'� 'e *`�`k .i xt 'ys,4�3 Sik nb` � ' k r & e.ru w.n ,��c�,, ,��. . :mx ,.: a .n n. r. r n . '� i , % '" "r*^ a �.+`� �,.,, 'S, � > 4 9• °t�,>.�." ^R?�, `„�.: 3i'4 b �..x . 1�,;�+` �.�a..., sP.�..wri�m,k '�`" .e' u. w •ek ' '�!" a�.� . �'�� W'." t 'S », h'�' a '�.n.RRar M".,'a'4' 1 Completion of cleaning and substrate decontamination prior to abrasive blast cleaning. CSM QC CSA QC CSA QC 2 Installation of protective enclosure of structure or area and protection of adjacent surfaces or structures that are not to be coated. GC QC CSM QC CSA QC 3 Completion of ambient condition control in structure or building area and acceptance of ventilation methods in structure or Area. GC QC CSM QC CSA QC 4 Completion of Surface Preparation for Substrates to Be Coated. GC QC CSM QC CSA QC 5 Completion of Primer Application. GC QC CSM QC 09900-122 Coating Systems Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) December 2020 City Project No. 1 8 -0047 -UT CSA QC 6 Completion of Concrete Repairs If Required and Related Surface Preparation Rework Prior to Coating System Application. GC QC CSM QC CSA QC 7 Completion of Concrete Filler/ Surface Application to Concrete. GC QC CSM QC CSA QC 8 Completion of First Finish Coat Application and of Detail Treatment at Transitions or Terminations. GC QC CSM QC CSA QC 9 Completion of Second Finish Coat Application and of Detail Treatment at Transitions and Terminations. GC QC CSM QC CSA QC 10 Completion of Full and Proper Cure of Coating System. GC QC CSM QC CSA QC 11 Completion of Testing of Cured Coating System including Adhesion, Holiday (Continuity) Testing and Dry Film Thickness. GC QC CSM QC CSA QC 12 Completion of Localized Repairs GC QC Coating Systems Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) • 09900-123 • December 2020 City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • to Coating System Following Testing. • • 13 Final Acceptance of Coating System Installation Including Final Clean -Up Complying with Specification Requirements and the CSM's Quality Requirements. GC QC CSM QC CSA QC END OF SECTION 09900-124 Coating Systems December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT SECTION 11103 FIBERGLASS REINFORCED PLASTIC (FRP) SLIDE GATES PART 1 - GENERAL 1.01 DESCRIPTION A. SCOPE This section specifies fabricated slide gates for control of wastewater flow and aeration basin isolation. The Contractor shall include two handheld valve operators as specified below. B. TYPE Fabricated slide gates shall be of composite fiberglass reinforced plastic (FRP) construction with gates, guides, and operators provided by one manufacturer. Gates shall have rising stems. C. DESIGN CONDITIONS Fabricated slide gates shall be designed for continuous exposure to wastewater and a marine environment. Fluid temperature is expected to range from 70 degrees F to 90 degrees F. Slide gates will be installed outdoors in direct contact with wastewater. D. OPERATING REQUIREMENTS Aeration Basin No. Gates type No. of Gates Gateb size, inch Design head, feet Bottom' seating Seating Unseating 4 W 3 72 x 63 6.4 6.6 FB 5 W 3 72 x 63 6.4 6.6 FB 6 W 3 72 x 60 4.7 4.9 FB 7 W 3 72 x 60 4.7 4.9 FB 8 W 3 72 x 60 4.7 4.9 FB 9 W 3 72 x 60 4.7 4.9 FB 10 W 3 72 x 60 4.7 4.9 FB 11 W 3 72 x 60 4.7 4.9 FB 11103-1 FRP Slide Gates Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) December 2020 City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • • • • • Aeration Basin No. Gatea type No. of Gates Gateb size, inch Design head, feet Bottom° seating Seating Unseating 12 W 3 72 x 60 4.7 4.9 FB 13 W 3 72 x 60 4.7 4.9 FB Notes: a C = channel -mounted, W = wall -mounted b Width by height. FB = flush bottom, J = J -seal on invert d Contractor to confirm seating and unseating head in the field. Information above is approximate. 1.02 REFERENCES This section contains references to the following documents. They are a part of this section as specified and modified. In case of a conflict between the requirements of this section and those of the listed documents, the requirements of this section shall prevail. Reference Title ASTM A193 ASTM A276 ASTM B584 ASTM D256 ASTM D570 ASTM D638 ASTM D695 ASTM D696 ASTM D790 ASTM D792 ASTM D1056 ASTM D2563-0 ASTM D2583 ASTM D2584 AWWA C-563 AWWA C-540 Stainless Steel Anchor Bolts Stainless Steel Bars Alloy 865 Manganese Bronze Izod Impact Strength Water Absorption Rate Tensile Strength Compressive Properties of Rigid Plastic Coefficient of Linear Expansion Flexural Properties Density and Specific Gravity at 230 C Polymer Grade Visual Defects Indentation Hardness Resin, Glass & Filler Content Fabricated Composite Slide Gates Power Actuating Devices - Slide Gates 11103-2 FRP Slide Gates December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT 1.03 SUBMITTALS The following information shall be submitted in accordance with the requirements of Section 01300: 1. Fabrication drawings with full dimensions. 2. Parts list with materials of construction. 3. Plan, cross section, and details showing proposed mounting for each size of gate. 4. Calculations verifying deflection of the slide, stem, sizing, and required operating force. 5. Special attention is called to paragraph 01450 which outlines specific testing submittal requirements by the Construction Manager on this project. The Owner will not accept testing on equipment without prior approval of these submittals. PART 2- PRODUCTS 2.01 ACCEPTABLE PRODUCTS FRP gates shall be manufactured by Plasti-Fab or approved equal. The manufacturer shall have five (5) years' experience in the production of substantially similar equipment and shall show evidence of satisfactory operation in at least 10 similar operations. 2.02 MATERIALS Materials for components shall be as follows: Component Material Frames Slides Rails and yokes Fasteners and anchor bolts Stems Flush bottom and "J" bulb seals J -Seal Clamping Bar and Fasteners ASTM A276, Type 316L, Stainless Steel Engineered Composite Fiber Reinforced Plastic ASTM A276, Type 316L, Stainless Steel ASTM A276, Type 316, Stainless Steel ASTM A276, Type 316L, Stainless Steel EPDM ASTM A276, Type 316L, Stainless Steel 11103-3 FRP Slide Gates December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • • • • Hand wheel FRP Resin Cast Iron, ASTM A-126, Class B. 2.03 EQUIPMENT FEATURES A. FRAME AND GUIDES The gate frame shall be a rigid, welded unit, composed of the guide rails, cross bars, and deadrails, with a clear opening sized per the gate dimension detail in the Plans. The gate frame shall be designed for face mounting as shown on the drawings and gate schedule. The guides shall be of T -316L stainless steel and shall have a slot suitable for mating with the gate body. Seals shall be frame mounted. The flush bottom resilient EPDM seal shall be mounted to the bottom member of the frame. The frame configuration shall be of the flush -bottom type and shall allow the replacement of the side seals without removing the gate frame from the wall. Where self-contained guides are extended above the operating floor level to form the bench stand upon which the lift mechanism is fastened, they must be suitably strong and rigid without the use of additional stiffening members. The arrangement of the yoke shall be such that the disc and stem can be removed without disconnecting the yoke. The yoke shall be sufficiently strong to support the lift forces when subjected to a load of 80 pounds pull on the operator. The manufacturer's shop welds, welding procedures and welders shall be qualified and certified in accordance with the requirement of the latest edition of AWS Sections D 1.1, 1.2, and 1.6. B. SLIDE Slide gate body shall be manufactured of fiberglass reinforced polyester totally encapsulating an internal reinforcing structure. Each gate shall be molded individually to the exact dimensions specified in the Contract Documents. Seams and joints in and on the body are not acceptable. Slide gates shall be manufactured of reinforced thermoset plastic. Gate body shall have UV Stabilizing pigment in the Resin to provide long-term protection from UV. The surface shall be resin rich to a depth of .010 inches to .020 inches (.25 - .51 mm) and reinforced with C -glass and/or polymeric fiber surfacing material. The surface shall be free of exposed reinforcing fibers. The composition of these layers shall be approximately 95% (by weight) resin. The remaining laminate shall be made up of copolymer composite and reinforcing fibers in a form, orientation and position to meet the mechanical requirements. 11103-4 FRP Slide Gates December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT Structural reinforcing shall be utilized to attain the necessary stiffness to meet deflection requirements and shall be well encapsulated to ensure against any permeation by water to the core areas. A T -316L stainless steel. stem mounting bracket shall fasten to the gate with through bolts. The through holes shall not pass through or be in contact with the internal mild steel reinforcing. Core material must be 100% resistant to decay and attack by fungus and bacteria and be resistant to hydrocarbons. C. STEM The stem diameter shall be capable of withstanding twice the rated output of the operator at 40 pounds pull and shall be supported such that 1/r ratio for the unsupported part of the stem shall not exceed 200. Stem guides shall be fabricated from stainless steel. Rising stem gates shall be provided with transparent plastic stem covers. The stem cover shall be provided with vent holes to minimize condensation. The stem covers shall be marked with `Open' and `Closed' position indicators. 2.04 OPERATORS Operators shall be handwheel type. Operators shall meet AWWA C561 specifications, except as otherwise specified, and shall be designed to meet the operating requirements specified in paragraph 11103-1.01 D. Clear plastic stem covers shall be provided as specified in AWWA C561, Section 4.4.13.6. On handwheel, manual operators, gears, and bearings shall be enclosed in a weatherproof housing, and pressure type fittings shall be provided for grease lubrication of the bearings and gears. A maximum effort of 40 pounds pull of the crank or handwheel shall operate the gate under the specified operating conditions. The crank or handwheel shall be able to withstand, without damage, an effort of 801b. Handheld valve operators shall be Wachs P-2 Handheld Valve Operator or approved equal. The valve operator shall be 110V without torque control, 0-20rpm with a max torque of 500 ft/lbs. The operator shall be either pedestal or bench mounted as specified. Pedestal type floor standards shall be the offset type of the standard type with wall mounting bracket. Pedestal or bench stands shall be cast iron or aluminum. The head of the pedestal or bench stand operator shall have a solid bronze, internally threaded operating nut. The operator shall be mounted on antifriction roller bearings. Cranks and handwheels shall be removable from the operator. 2.05 PRODUCT DATA The following information shall be provided in accordance with Section 01300: 11103-5 FRP Slide Gates December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • • • 1. Product information, charts, or graphs to verify that the product provided • meets the requirements set forth in the specification. 2. Affidavits of compliance in accordance with AWWA C501. 3. Operating and maintenance information as specified in Section 01730. PART 3 - EXECUTION 3.01 INSTALLATION AND TESTING The Contractor shall install and test the equipment in strict conformance with the manufacturer's recommendations unless otherwise specified. Installation shall be carried out by mechanics skilled in work of this kind. The fully assembled gates shall be shop inspected, tested for operation and leakage, and adjusted before shipping. There shall be no assembling or adjusting on the job sites other than the lifting mechanism. For purposes of this specification, field leakage tests shall be performed as specified in Section 6 of AWWA C501. Prior to testing and commissioning a test plan procedure shall be submitted and approved. The maximum allowable leakage rate shall be 0.10 gallons per minute per foot of seating perimeter for the seating and unseating heads specified. Field leakage tests shall be conducted with no head on one side of the gate being tested. END OF SECTION 11103-6 FRP Slide Gates December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT SECTION 11220 MEMBRANE DISC DIFFUSERS PART 1 - GENERAL 1.01 SCOPE OF WORK A. This section specifies membrane disc diffusers to replace the existing membrane disc diffusers in Aeration Basins 4-13. Aeration Basins 4-13 contain 9 -inch Sanitaire membrane disc diffusers, which were installed in 2009 to replace the original aeration diffusers. The layout drawings from the 2009 installation have been included in the Appendix for reference. This scope of work includes the following: • Repair of any broken or damaged membrane disc diffusers, air piping and supports that are encountered after draining the aeration basins. • Repair of any broken or damaged air piping or diffusers encountered in the upstream common channel between Aeration Basins 4 to 13. 1.02 REFERENCES A. This section contains references to the following documents. They are a part of this section as specified and modified. In case of conflict between the requirements of this section and those of the listed documents, the requirements of this section shall prevail. B. Unless otherwise specified, references to documents shall mean the documents in effect at the time of Advertisement for Bids or Invitation to Bid (or on the effective date of the Agreement if there were no Bids). If referenced documents have been discontinued by the issuing organization, references to those documents shall mean the replacement documents issued or otherwise identified by that organization or, if there are no replacement documents, the last version of the document before it was discontinued. Where document dates are given in the following listing, references to those documents shall mean the specific document version associated with that date, whether or not the document has been superseded by a version with a later date, discontinued or replaced. Reference Title ASTM D3915-99ae1 Standard Specification for Rigid Poly(Vinyl Chloride) (PVC) and Chlorinated Poly(Vinyl Chloride) (CPVC) Compounds for Plastic Pipe 11220-1 Membrane Disc Diffusers December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • • • and Fittings Used in Pressure Applications ASTM D3034-04 Standard Specification for Type PSM Poly(Vinyl Chloride) (PVC) Sewer Pipe and Fittings ASTM D1784-03 Standard Specification for Rigid Poly(Vinyl Chloride) (PVC) Compounds and Chlorinated Poly(Vinyl Chloride) (CPVC) Compounds ASTM D1785 -04a Standard Specification for Poly(Vinyl Chloride) (PVC) Plastic Pipe, Schedules 40, 80, and 120 ASTM D1171-99 Standard Test Method for Rubber Deterioration -Surface Ozone Cracking Outdoors or Chamber (Triangular Specimens) ASTM D412-98a(2002)el Standard Test Methods for Vulcanized Rubber and Thermoplastic Elastomers—Tension ASTM D2240-04 Standard Test Method for Rubber Property— Durometer Hardness ASTM D2466-02 Standard Specification for Poly(Vinyl Chloride) (PVC) Plastic Pipe Fittings, Schedule 40 ASTM D573-04 Standard Test Method for Rubber— Deterioration in an Air Oven ASTM A240/A240M-04ael Standard Specification for Chromium and Chromium -Nickel Stainless Steel Plate, Sheet, and Strip for Pressure Vessels and for General Applications ASTM A480/A480M-04a ASTM A554-03 ASTM A774/A774M-02 Standard Specification for General Requirements for Flat -Rolled Stainless and Heat -Resisting Steel Plate, Sheet, and Strip Standard Specification for Welded Stainless Steel Mechanical Tubing Standard Specification for As -Welded Wrought Austenitic Stainless Steel Fittings for 11220-2 Membrane Disc Diffusers December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT ASTM A778-01 General Corrosive Service at Low and Moderate Temperatures Standard Specification for Welded, Unannealed Austenitic Stainless Steel Tubular Products ASTM A276-04 Standard Specification for Stainless Steel Bars and Shapes ASTM A380 -99e1 Standard Practice for Cleaning, Descaling, and Passivation of Stainless Steel Parts, Equipment, and Systems ASTM 1869-95 Standard Specification for Rubber Rings for Asbestos -Cement Pipe AISI American Iron and Steel Institute Standards 1.03 QUALITY ASSURANCE A. Source Quality Control: 1. Fine bubble diffused aeration equipment shall be the product of one (1) manufacturer who shall be solely responsible for the design and provision of the equipment in conformance with this specification. 2. All components shall be specifically constructed for the specified service conditions and shall be integrated into the overall assembly by the fine bubble diffused aeration equipment manufacturer. 3. The manufacturer shall provide a complete and operable system for the equipment specified and shall be responsible for the design and inspection of the equipment furnished. 4. The fine bubble diffused aeration equipment manufacturer shall prepare all Shop Drawings and other submittals for all components furnished under this Section. B. Manufacturer's Qualifications: The manufacturer shall have a minimum of five years experience in the design and fabrication of substantially similar fine bubble diffused aeration equipment, and shall be able to show evidence of at least five installations in satisfactory operation for at least five years. Manufacturer shall be a qualified manufacturer of fine bubble diffused aeration equipment and shall have experience in designing and producing equipment of similar type, size and complexity. 11220-3 Membrane Disc Diffusers December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • • • • • C. Affidavit: The manufacturer shall submit an affidavit stating that the equipment, apparatus or process furnished will meet in every way the requirements set forth in this Specification. D. Equipment Warranty and Guarantee: In addition to the requirements of the General Conditions, the CONTRACTOR shall require the manufacturer to furnish a warranty valid through the warranty period to assure that any equipment specified herein which does not meet the performance requirements for the specifications, is repaired to the OWNER'S satisfaction or replaced with equipment that does meet the performance requirements of the specification. The warranty shall be for minimum period of one year from the date of final acceptance for the portion of work associated with the equipment specified herein. 1.04 SUBMITTALS A. Shop Drawings: Submit the following for approval: 1. Manufacturers' catalog cut sheets on all equipment. 2. Headloss curves for diffusers and orifices. 3. Cut sheets on anchor bolts with material of construction, applicable ASTM Standards, minimum recommended embedment, pull-out strength and suitability of adhesive for permanent below water application. Provide setting drawings, templates and directions for the installation of anchor bolts and other anchorages. Conform to the requirements of Section 05502, Anchors to Concrete for materials of construction for all components. 4. Proposed supports 5. All repair accessories required by the manufacturer for the repair of membrane disc diffusers and piping headers discovered to be broken or damaged after draining the basins. 6. Proposed piping repair materials B. Working Drawings: 1. Layout of diffuser grids including plans, sections, installation instructions and details. 2. Details: a. Pipe supports and anchor bolts. 11220-4 Membrane Disc Diffusers December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT C. Calculations: 1. Anchor bolt pull-out for manifold and distribution header supports. 2. Structural design of pipe supports including buoyant forces affecting supports. Include material specifications with yield and ultimate strengths for stainless steel items. D. Source Quality Control Testing: 1. Sampling plan. 2. Shop Test set-up and testing procedure for each test. 3. Test report including the above, specified limits, data, analysis and test results by lot numbers. 4. Include airflow versus dynamic wet pressure from the measured data. E. Oxygen Transfer and Headloss Tests: 1. Test Procedure: a. Sampling plan for test diffusers. b. Required test parameters including standard oxygen transfer efficiencies and headloss curves. c. Test set-up including test tank and instrumentation. d. Test procedure for data collection and analysis. e. Blank data log sheets. 2. Test Report: a. Test procedure. b. Instrument calibration data. c. Raw data. d. Dissolved oxygen concentration vs. time curves. e. Airflow calculations. f. Data analysis, sample calculations and test results. g. Oxygen transfer efficiency and headloss curves. F. Certified leakage test results for retainer ring and gasket joints. G. Proposed equipment and procedure for purging of air piping. H. Field test procedures and test results. I. Operation and Maintenance Manuals: 11220-5 Membrane Disc Diffusers December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • • • • • 1. Submit complete Installation, Operation and Maintenance Manuals, including, test reports, maintenance data and schedules, description of operation, and spare parts information. 2. Furnish Operation and Maintenance Manuals in conformance with the requirements of Section 01730, Operation and Maintenance Data. 3. Design Data: a. Minimum and maximum airflows per aeration tank. b. Estimated operating pressures versus airflow at top of droplegs. c. Suggested limit on pressure increase due to fouling of diffusers, prior to cleaning. d. Minimum and maximum recommended airflow per diffuser. 4. Start-up procedure. 5. Operational and Maintenance Procedures: a. Cleaning procedures for flexible membrane diffusers by bumping and by high pressure hosing. b. Visual inspection procedures for leaks in pipes and around diffusers. c. Visual inspection procedures for uniformity of airflow through the diffusers. d. Repair procedures for pipes, fittings, couplings and diffuser holders, including replacement. e. Instructions to install/remove orifice plugs in diffuser blanks. f. Purging of diffuser grids. g. Instructions for maintaining the diffusion equipment in an idle tank. The maintenance procedure, if based on continuous air purge, shall not cause temperatures greater than the rated temperatures of the components. 6. Appendices: a. Diffuser and orifice headloss curves. b. Standard oxygen transfer efficiency test curves. c. Summary of source quality control test results. d. Summary of field quality control test results. e. Cut sheets of equipment, where applicable, with names, addresses, e-mail addresses and telephone numbers of manufacturers. f. Layout shop drawings including all field modifications. g. Material specifications of all components. h. List of tools and spare parts actually furnished. J. List of Installations. The list shall include the names and persons to contact, phone numbers and locations. 11220-6 Membrane Disc Diffusers December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT 1.05 DELIVERY, STORAGE AND HANDLING A. Packing, Shipping, Handling and Unloading: 1. Deliver materials to the Site to ensure uninterrupted progress of the Work. Deliver anchor bolts and anchorage devices which are to be embedded in cast- in-place concrete in ample time to prevent delay of that Work. B. Storage and Protection: 1. Store materials to permit easy access for inspection and identification. Keep all material off the ground, using pallets, platforms, or other supports. Protect steel members and packaged materials from corrosion and deterioration. 2. Thermoplastic Items: a. Store thermoplastic pipe so as to prevent sagging or bending. b. Do not store thermoplastic pipe, fittings and specials in direct sunlight. 3. Diffusers: a. Adequately crate diffusers to protect from damage. 4. Stainless Steel Items: a. Protect all stainless steel pipes, fittings and other items from contamination during shipment and storage. C. Acceptance at Site: 1. All boxes, crates and packages shall be inspected by CONTRACTOR upon delivery to the Site. CONTRACTOR shall notify ENGINEER, in writing, if any loss or damage exists to equipment or components. Replace loss and repair damage to new condition in accordance with manufacturer's instructions. PART 2 - PRODUCTS 2.01 MANUFACTURERS A The Manufacturer of the fine bubble diffused aeration equipment shall be: 1. Sanitaire. 2. Approved equal demonstrated by the Contractor to meet all aspects of the plans and specifications. 2.02 FLEXIBLE MEMBRANE DISC DIFFUSERS A GENERAL 1. Furnish flexible membrane diffusers to replace existing as 11220-7 Membrane Disc Diffusers December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • • • • • determined in the field by the Engineer and the Contractor. 2. Membrane diffusers shall be suitable for on-off air supply and shall not permit backflow of wastewater into the air distribution headers when air supply is turned off. A portion of the membrane at center shall be blind which shall close the orifice in the support plate once the air is turned off. Also, the slits shall act as check valves which will close when air is turned off. 3. The membrane shall not blow out of the diffuser holder at the operating pressure. B. Membrane Discs: 1. Type: Perforated, one piece compression molded with a blind center portion and an integral sealing ring along the outer circumference. 2. Diameter: 9 -inch with minimum 0.41 square foot active area. 3. Membrane Thickness: 0.08 -inch, minimum 4. Membrane Material: Synthetic rubber compound, resistant to creep, having high modulus of elasticity, resistant to oils and ultraviolet light and suitable for sewage application. 5. Diffuser Membranes: Item Value/Units ASTM Base Polymer EPDM D573 UV Resistance Carbon Black Specific Gravity 1.25 or less Durometer — Minimum 58% ± 5% D2240 Modulus of Elasticity 500 psi D412 Ozone Resistance (72 hrs: 40°C pphm) No cracks @ 2X magnification D1171 Test A Tensile Strength 1200 psi D412 Elongation - % - Retained 70 hrs @ 100°C - minimum at break 75% Max 350% D573 D412 6. Perforations: Precision die -formed slits punched perpendicular to the membrane grain direction. C. Support Plates: 1. Type: Reinforced and contoured base plates with center holes as required. 2. Material: PVC with minimum two percent titanium dioxide. 3. Design Support Plates for the Following Loadings: a. Concentrated Live Load, as a Result of Someone Stepping onto the Diffuser: 250 lbs 11220-8 Membrane Disc Diffusers December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT b. Upward or Downward Pressure: Equivalent to submergence c. Factor of Safety: Two, minimum 2.03 DIFFUSER HOLDERS AND RETAINER RINGS A General: 1. Provide each diffuser holder with a control orifice and a retainer ring assembly for the diffuser. There shall be no leakage at the 0 -ring joint of the disc and retainer ring at ten psig internal pressure. 2. Submit certified leakage test results from previous tests. B. Nominal Size of Control Orifices: 1. For Membrane Diffusers: 13/64 inches C. Diffuser Holder and Retainer Rings: 1. Material: PVC, with minimum two percent titanium dioxide 2. Wall Thickness: 0.125 -inch, minimum 3. The retainer ring shall have a minimum of 2-1/2 complete threads for engagement and minimum 1/8 -inch by 1/8 -inch cross-section of threads. D. 0 -Ring Gaskets: 1. Material: EPDM or Polyisoprene conforming to ASTM D 2000 2. Temperature Rating: 0 to 225°F 2.04 PIPE SUPPORTS A General: 1. Provide replacement pipe supports for any damaged or broken air piping supports encountered after draining the aeration basins. 2. Provide positive means of preventing rotation of headers and manifolds when in operation. 3. Design supports to allow for complete removal of the aeration equipment from the tanks, except anchor bolts, to facilitate cleaning of tank floor. 4. The contact area of the pipe or the fitting with the clamp at the supports shall be checked for bearing stress at the applicable load, to be within the allowable limit for the pipe or the fitting. 5. Confirm that there will be no interference between the clamp and the diffuser pod as a result of design expansion or contraction of the headers. 6. Provide supports of varying heights to account for slopes in the floors of the aeration tanks. 7. Allow horizontal and vertical adjustments in the supports for 11220-9 Membrane Disc Diffusers December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • • • • • alignment and leveling. 8. Design all supports to allow for thermal expansion and contraction forces over a temperature range of 140°F and to minimize stress build up in the piping system. B. Design Requirements: 1. Design Loads for Fixed Supports: a. Uplift force equal to four times the buoyant force. b. Hydraulic thrust based on maximum operating pressure (assume tank to be close to empty). c. Friction force for resistance to expansion from sliding supports. d. Lateral forces on the distribution headers and manifolds due to velocity currents and momentum of wastewater flows within the aeration tanks. e. Other loads as expected. 2. Design Loads for Guide Supports: a. Uplift force equal to four times the buoyant force. b. Lateral forces on the distribution headers and manifolds due to velocity currents and momentum of wastewater flows within the aeration tanks. c. Frictional force created by movement of supported piping across the support. d. Other loads as specified. 3. Materials of Pipe Supports: a. Welded Components of Pipe Supports: Type 316 stainless steel. b. Non -Welded Components of Pipe Supports: Type 316 stainless steel. 4. Welding of Supports: a. Perform all welding in the shop. Field welding is not permitted. b. Provide full penetration welds free of cracks, overlap and cold laps. All welds shall be smooth. c. Weld Thickness: Equal to or greater than parent metal d. For grinding operations, use iron -free grinding wheels. 5. Clean and descale fabricated stainless steel items in accordance with ASTM A 380 and as specified below: a. Passivate stainless steel welded fabricated items by immersion in apickling solution of nitric acid and hydrofluoric acid. Acid concentrations, temperature and detention time shall be suitable for removal of oxidation and ferrous contamination without etching of surface. C. Perform a complete rinsing operation with clean water. 11220-10 Membrane Disc Diffusers December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT D Supports for Air Distribution Headers: 1. Fixed Support: a. Provide clamps, minimum 1.5 -inch wide by 0.109 -inch thick, self-limiting to prevent overstressing of the pipe. b. Size of Threaded Rods for Base Assembly: 1/2 -inch diameter, minimum c. Anchor Bolts: Adhesive type, 3/8 -inch diameter, minimum 2. Guide Supports: a. Provide minimum 1.5 -inch wide by 0.109 -inch thick contoured clamps, with chamfered leading edges to minimize binding under buoyant condition, and 1/8 -inch clearance around pipe to be self-limiting if clamp is overtightened. b. Size of Threaded Rods for Base Assembly: 5/16 -inch diameter, minimum c. Anchor Bolts: Adhesive type, 3/8 -inch diameter, minimum E Supports for Manifolds: 1. Guide Supports: a. Provide with minimum 2 -inch wide by 0.109 -inch thick contoured half clamps, with chamfered leading edges to minimize binding under buoyant condition, and 1/8 -inch clearance around pipe to be self-limiting if clamp is overtightened. Provide a cross angle of minimum 2 -inch by 2 - inch by 3/16 -inch size with slotted holes for pipe support. b. Threaded Rods for Base Assembly: 5/8 -inch diameter for 8 - inch or less manifold, 3/4 -inch diameter for 10 -inch or above manifold, minimum. c. Anchor Bolts: Adhesive type, 5/8 -inch diameter, minimum. d. Provide braces as required. 2.05 ANCHOR BOLTS FOR PIPE SUPPORTS A. General: 1. Type: Hilti, HIT HY 150 Injection Adhesive Anchors, or equal. 2. Design anchors for minimum ten times the calculated buoyant force. 3. Bolt Diameter: As specified. 4. Embedment: In accordance with the design requirements or manufacturer's recommended standard depth, whichever is greater. 5. Adhesive anchors shall be suitable for installation in drilled holes in concrete slab, which may not be completely dry and for permanent below water application. B. Material: 1. Anchor Bolts: Type 316 stainless steel, ASTM F 593. 11220-11 Membrane Disc Diffusers December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • • • • • 2. Nuts: Nylok-type locknuts, Type 316 stainless steel, ASTM F 594. 3. Plates and Washers: Type 316 stainless steel. 4. The bolts shall have rolled threads. C. Provide anti -seize compound, graphite free, for stainless steel nuts and bolts to prevent galling. Strength of the bolted joints shall not be affected by the use of anti- seize compound. 2.06 ASSEMBLY BOLTS A. Assembly bolts shall include all miscellaneous bolting above and below liquid, as required for flanged joints and couplings. B. Material: 1. Bolts: Type 316 stainless steel, ASTM F 593. 2. Nuts: Type 316 stainless steel, ASTM F 594. 3. Washers: Type 316 stainless steel. 4. The bolts shall have rolled threads. C. Provide anti -seize compound, graphite free, for stainless steel nuts and bolts to prevent galling. Strength of the bolted joints shall not be affected by the use of anti- seize compound. 2.07 TOOLS AND SPARE PARTS A. Two complete sets of any special tools required for normal operation and maintenance. B. Spare orifice plugs equivalent to five percent of the supplied diffusers. C. Retainer rings for installed blanks. D. Spare parts shall be packed in sturdy containers with clear indelible identification markings and shall be stored in a dry, warm location until transferred to the OWNER at the conclusion of the Project. 2.08 SOURCE QUALITY CONTROL — FLEXIBLE MEMBRANE DIFFUSERS A. General: 1. Submit a sampling plan and a test procedure at least two months prior to manufacturing. 2. The tests shall be witnessed by a qualified Registered Professional Engineer, who may be an employee of the manufacturer. 11220-12 Membrane Disc Diffusers December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT B. Tests Prior to Making Perforations: 1. Conform to the requirements of Military Standard 105E. 2. Primary Testing for Durometer: a. Lot Size: 3,201 — 10,000 a. Sample Size: 125 b. Conform to double sampling plans for normal inspection (Table IIIA), AQL: 4.0. 3. Secondary Testing for Tensile Strength, Modulus of Elasticity and Specific Gravity: a. Lot Size: 125, selected samples for primary testing. b. Sample Size: 5 c. Conform to double sampling plans for normal inspection (Table IIIA), AQL: 6.5. C. Tests after Making Perforations: 1. Dynamic Wet Pressure: a. Test 1 out of every 25 diffusers. b. Limit: 10 -psi, at 2.4 scfm per square foot of diffuser material. 2. Airflow Uniformity: a. Test one diffuser out of every 100 diffusers. b. Test Airflows: 0.5, 0.75 and 1.0 scfm c. Provide visual inspection to verify substantially uniform air distribution across the surface of the disc. D. Visually examine all diffusers to ensure they are free of defects. 2.09 SOURCE QUALITY CONTROL — OXYGEN TRANSFER AND HEADLOSS TESTS A. General: 1. Test flexible membrane diffusers one time only during manufacturing of the diffusers. 2. Conform to ASCE Standards and as specified herein. 3. All test measurements shall be taken with instruments calibrated in accordance with the instrument manufacturer's recommendations. Calibration shall be current in accordance with applicable standards. B. Test Set -Up: 1. Test Basin: a. Rectangular: Six -feet wide by 34 -feet long, minimum. 2. Diffuser Layout in Test Tank: a. Conform to proposed diffuser layout in aeration tank grids, for diffuser density, orifice size, height, and spacing of diffusers and rows. b. Confirm level of all diffusers to be within +1/4 -inch. 3. Diffuser Submergence: 7.36 feet 11220-13 Membrane Disc Diffusers December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • • • • 4. Side Water Depth: 8.17 feet 5. Instrumentation for Standard Oxygen Transfer Efficiency (SOTE) Tests: a. Minimum four dissolved oxygen (DO) probes geometrically distributed in the test tank. b. Instrumentation for dissolved oxygen vs. time measurement. c. Two airflow measuring devices and temperature and pressure measurement upstream of each flow meter. d. Thermometer in test tank to monitor water temperature. e. Instruments for barometric pressure, ambient temperature and relative humidity. f. Winkler test apparatus. 6. Instrumentation for Headloss Tests: a. Tap minimum two distribution headers at top to measure pressure. b. Provide a bubbler dip tube to measure submergence depth on the diffusers. c. Install water manometers or differential pressure transmitters (Yokogawa or equal, 0.2 percent accuracy) and pressure gages to read headloss across the diffusers and header pressures. C. Sampling of Flexible Membrane Test Diffusers: 1. Select test diffusers at random from already approved lots based on factory quality control testing. 2. Select test diffusers out of first ten percent diffusers manufactured for the Project. D. Standard Oxygen Transfer Efficiency Tests for Flexible Membrane Grids: 1. Determine standard oxygen transfer efficiencies for one test grid conforming to Tank 6, Grid B and D.O. Boost Tank, Grid B. 2. Perform three replicate test runs for each airflow rate. 3. The minimum oxygen transfer efficiencies in the test grid shall be as follows: a. Test Grid: 1) At 0.75 scfin/diffuser: 33 percent 2) At 1.05 scfm/diffuser: 30 percent 3) At 2.1 scfm/diffuser: 28 percent E. The measured oxygen transfer efficiencies shall show a rising trend towards lower airflows for the same diffuser density, that is, at lower airflow per diffuser the oxygen transfer efficiency shall be greater than the oxygen transfer efficiency measured at the higher airflow rate per diffuser. F. Oxygen Transfer Testing Procedure: 11220-14 Membrane Disc Diffusers December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT 1. Thoroughly clean the test basin prior to testing. 2. Fill the test basin with potable water. Maintain test water temperature between 15°C and 25°C. 3. Initial Check -Up: a. Test set-up. b. Calibration of all instruments. c. Test water temperature. d. Initial total dissolved solids of test water. e. An understanding of computer program being used for data collection and analysis. 4. Calibrate all DO probes and meters to the saturation value by Winkler Method. Recheck all DO probes at start of each new run. 5. Add cobalt chloride (CoCI 6H20) solution as a catalyst for soluble cobalt concentration of 0.1 to 0.5 mg/1. 6. Add technical grade anhydrous sodium sulfite solution to the test basin one hour after the addition of cobalt. Discharge sulfite solution into the test basin at two or more locations within five minutes. Add sufficient sodium sulfite to depress the dissolved oxygen concentration to below 0.5 mg/1 at all points in the test water. 7. Data Collection: a. Take minimum 40 DO readings versus time for each DO probe, till test basin reaches 98 percent saturation. Select data to allow approximate proportions of two-thirds of DO values from 20 to 86 percent of saturation and one-third of data from 86 to 98 percent of saturation. b. Airflow readings from two meters including inlet pressure and temperature. Take airflow measurements in the beginning, middle and end of each run. c. Water temperature. d. Ambient pressure, temperature and humidity. 8. Data Analysis: a. Use non-linear regression method to determine KLat for each DO probe. 11220-15 Membrane Disc Diffusers December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • • 1 • b. Adjust KLat to KLa20 , standard condition. Individual KLa20 value for each DO probe shall be within ±10 percent of the average. c. Adjust measured DO saturation value to standard condition. d. Calculate Standard Oxygen Transfer Rate (SOTR) as follows: SOTR (lbs/hr Where: C * sat20 W Pn W x E(KLa20 x C*sat20) Pn = Steady-state DO saturation corrected to 20°C and standard barometric pressure = Weight of water tested, millions of pounds = Number of probes in test basin. e. Calculate Standard Oxygen Transfer Efficiency (SOTE) as follows: SOTR X 100 Qs x 60 x 0.075 x 0.232 11220-16 Membrane Disc Diffusers December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT Where: Qs = 0.075 = 0.232 = Average standard air flow rate supplied to the test basin, scfm Standard weight of air, lbs/ft3 Weight fraction of oxygen in air 9. Discard results of the first run, considered as conditioning run. 10. Perform three test runs for each airflow as required. KLa20 for each run shall not vary more than ±10 percent of the average of the three replicate test runs. 11. Repeat tests at other airflows and draw SOTE curve at three airflows for each grid. 12. Collect water sample from test tank for testing for total dissolved solids. Total dissolved solids in the last test shall not exceed 1,500 mg/1. G. Headloss Tests: 1. Measure total headloss across the diffusers, including orifices and diffuser discs. Tap at least two distribution headers for measurement of pressure. Take readings at three airflows and draw overall headloss curves. 2. Measure pressure in distribution headers. PART 3 - EXECUTION 3.01 INSPECTION A. CONTRACTOR shall verify that structures, pipes and equipment are compatible. 3.02 INSTALLATION A. Manufacturer's representative shall check and approve the installation prior to operation. Manufacturer's representative shall field test and calibrate the equipment to assure that the system operates to the OWNER'S satisfaction. B. Install all aeration equipment in accordance with the manufacturer's instructions and recommendations and approved Shop Drawings. C. Use anti -seize compound for stainless steel nuts and bolts to prevent galling. D. Test for Level Installation of Diffusers: 1. During filling of each aeration basin with water, with water level near top of the diffusers, verify all diffusers to be level within plus or minus 1/4 -inch variation. 3.03 PURGING OF AIR PIPING 11220-17 Membrane Disc Diffusers December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • • • • • A. After installation of the aeration grids, but before the end caps on the distribution headers are installed, purge the entire system with high velocity air. Isolate each aeration grid and operate with air at a velocity in excess of 5,000 feet per minute to remove all potential clogging material from the piping system. After this blow-out procedure has been completed and approved by OWNER for a given grid, install end caps. The temperature of purge air shall not exceed the rated temperature of the diffuser system. 3.04 FIELD QUALITY CONTROL A. General: 1. Submit details of the test procedures for approval at least two months prior to the test. 2. Notify OWNER at least one week in advance of the scheduled test dates. 3. Provide all required gages, manometers, taps, pressure measuring devices and other incidentals required for field tests. Calibrate all instruments prior to the tests, in accordance with applicable standards. 4. If the equipment fails to pass the field tests, repair or replace the equipment and retest until it passes. All repairs or replacements shall be approved by OWNER. 5. CONTRACTOR shall coordinate with OWNER to fill and drain the aeration tanks and for hosing down as required. Water for filling and hosing down the tanks shall be provided by OWNER. 6. Test all grids, unless specified otherwise. B. Strength Testing of Pipe Supports: 1. Upon replacement of the supports and prior to installation of the piping, test minimum ten percent supports of each type. 2. The supports to be tested shall be chosen at random by OWNER who shall witness the tests. 3. Test anchor bolts at ten times the calculated buoyant force to which the anchor bolt will be subjected in normal operation. 4. Test support assembly at four times the calculated buoyant force to which the support assembly will be subjected in normal operation. 5. Each anchor bolt or support chosen for test shall be attached to a lever which shall be placed on a fulcrum. A static load shall be applied to the opposite end producing the required vertical extracting force on the anchor bolt or support. 6. No failure of the anchor bolts or deformation of the supports will be permitted at the test loads. C. Test for Anti -Rotation of Distribution Headers: 1. Select at least ten percent of header union joints at random for testing. The test equipment shall not cause any damage to the air 11220-18 Membrane Disc Diffusers December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT distribution headers. 2. Use a strap torque wrench to apply 80 foot pound torque and a strap wrench to resist the torque on two sides of the joint. 3. If the joint rotates, reassemble or replace the joint and retest for the required torque. 4. If more than ten percent of the tested joints fail, test all joints in the distribution headers. D. Leakage Test: 1. Submerge the diffuser grid by a few inches above the discs with effluent water. 2. Operate the grid at a total airflow based on 0.5, 2.0 and 4.0 scfm per diffuser. 3. Observe for leaks at the pipe joints, retainer rings, couplings and expansion joints. 4. No leaks are permitted. E. Operating Pressure Test: 1. Perform an operating pressure test on one grid of each size. 2. Fill aeration tank with non -potable water to the normal operating depth. 3. Measure pressure in dropleg at walkway level for each grid at maximum airflow. The pressure shall not exceed the calculated pressure based on submergence and the friction headloss. F. Uniform Air Distribution Test: 1. Fill the basin with non -potable water to a depth of a few inches above the diffusers. 2. Operate the grid at a total airflow based on 0.5, 0.75, 1.0 scfm per diffuser. 3. Air distribution shall be nearly even across the surface of the disc with no dead spots. 4. The bubble size shall be approximately equal. G. Mixing Test: 1. Perform mixing tests in Tank 6, Grid B, and D.O. Boost Tank, Grid B at minimum air supply of 0.15 scfm per square foot. 2. The mixing test shall be performed to verify that a variation in mixed liquor suspended solids concentration will be not more than L ten percent of the average value in each grid. 3. A minimum of ten samples at various basin locations and depths shall be analyzed for suspended solids using Standard Methods. The location and depth of sample points shall be as selected by ENGINEER AND OWNER prior to the start of the test. Using the data recorded, the average mixed liquor concentration shall be computed. The variation allowed above does not include analytical variation of sample analysis. CONTRACTOR shall have the samples tested by an EPA certified laboratory. 11220-19 Membrane Disc Diffusers December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • • • • • 3.05 MANUFACTURER'S SERVICES A. A factory trained representative shall be provided for installation supervision, start- up and test services and operation and maintenance personnel training services. The representative shall make a site visit to verify the completed repairs. Manufacturer's representative shall test operate the system in the presence of the OWNER and verify that the equipment conforms to the requirements. Representative shall revisit the Site as often as necessary until all trouble is corrected and the installation is entirely satisfactory. B. All costs, including travel, lodging, meals and incidentals, for additional visits shall be at no additional cost to the OWNER. END OF SECTION 11220-20 Membrane Disc Diffusers December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT SECTION 15062 DUCTILE IRON PIPE PART 1 - GENERAL 1.01 DESCRIPTION A. SCOPE This section specifies ductile iron pipe, ductile fittings and gaskets. Pipe material is identified on the Contract Drawings. 1.02 REFERENCES This section contains references to the following documents. They are a part of this section as specified and modified. Where a referenced document contains references to other standards, those documents are included as references under this section as if referenced directly. In the event of conflict between the requirements of this section and those of the listed documents, the requirements of this section shall prevail. Unless otherwise specified, references to documents shall mean the documents in effect at the time of Advertisement for Bids or Invitation to Bid (or on the effective date of the Agreement if there were no Bids). If referenced documents have been discontinued by the issuing organization, references to those documents shall mean the replacement documents issued or otherwise identified by that organization or, if there are no replacement documents, the last version of the document before it was discontinued. Where document dates are given in the following listing, references to those documents shall mean the specific document version associated with that date, regardless of whether the document has been superseded by a version with a later date, discontinued or replaced. Reference Title ANSI A21.52 ANSI B16.5 ASTM A716 ASTM C150 AWWA C104 (ANSI A21.4) AWWA C105-82 (ANSI A21.5-82) Ductile -Iron Pipe, Centrifugally Cast, in Metal Molds Pipe Flanges and Flanged Fittings Ductile -Iron Culvert Pipe Portland Cement Cement -Mortar Lining for Ductile- Iron and Gray -Iron Pipe and Fittings for Water Polyethylene Encasement for Ductile -Iron Piping Systems 15062-1 Ductile Iron Pipe Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) December 2020 City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • • • • Reference Title AWWA C110 (ANSI A21.10) AWWA C111 (ANSI A21.11) AWWA C115 (ANSI A21.15) AWWA C150 (ANSI A21.50) AWWA C151 (ANSI A21.51) AWWA C153 (ANSI A21.53) AWWA C600 AWWA C606 Ductile -Iron and Gray -Iron Fittings, 3 In. Through 48 In., for Water and Other Liquids Rubber -Gasket Joints for Ductile- Iron and Gray -Iron Pressure Pipe and Fittings Flanged Ductile -Iron and Gray -Iron Pipe With Threaded Flanges Thickness Design of Ductile -Iron Pipe Ductile -Iron Pipe, Centrifugally Cast, in Metal Molds or Sand - Lined Molds, for Water or Other Liquids Ductile -Iron Compact Fittings, 3 In. Through 12 In. for Water and Other Liquids Installation of Ductile -Iron Water Mains and Their Appurtenances Grooved and Shouldered Type Joints PART 2 - PRODUCTS 2.01 GENERAL Pipe design, materials and manufacture shall comply with the following documents: Item Document Thickness design Manufacturing requirements Water or other liquid Gas Gravity service pipe Joints Rubber gasket Threaded flange Fittings Water or other liquid Gas Cement mortar lining Polyethylene encasement AWWA C150 AWWA C151 ANSI A21.52 ASTM A716 AWWA C111 AWWA C115 AWWA C110/AWWA C153 ANSI A21.14 AWWA C104 AWWA C105 15062-2 Ductile Iron Pipe December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT 2.02 PIPE Unless otherwise specified, ductile iron pipe shall be minimum Pressure Class 350 and have nominal laying lengths of 18 or 20 feet. For grooved -end pipe and flanged end pipe, wall thickness shall be minimum Class 53 except where the specified pressure requires heavier pipe. Ductile iron pipe shall be by U.S. Pipe and Foundry Company, Inc.; American Cast Iron Pipe Company or equal. 2.03 GASKETS Unless otherwise specified, gasket stock shall be a synthetic rubber compound in which the elastomer is nitrile or neoprene. The compound shall contain not less than 50 percent by volume nitrile or neoprene and shall be free from factice, reclaimed rubber and other deleterious substances. Gaskets shall, in addition, comply with AWWA C111 for push -on and mechanical joints and with AWWA C606 for grooved end joints. 2.04 FITTINGS Unless otherwise specified, fittings shall conform to AWWA C110. Pipe fittings shall be ductile iron with pressure rating of 350 psi for 24 -in and smaller piping and 250 psi for 30 -in and larger piping. Fittings shall have the same pressure rating, as a minimum, of the connecting pipe. Ends shall be flanged, restrained mechanical joint, restrained push -on, or grooved to suit the conditions specified. Restrained joints shall be suitable for the specified pipe test pressure. All piping within the limits of project site under pressure shall be provided with restrained joints. The AWWA C153 compact ductile iron fittings in sizes 3 through 12 inches are an acceptable substitute for standard fittings unless otherwise specified. Long -radius elbows shall be provided where specified. Closures shall be made with mechanical joint ductile iron solid sleeves and shall be located in straight runs of pipe. Location of closures shall be subject to approval of the Engineer. 2.05 JOINTS A. UNRESTRAINED JOINTS (NOT USED) B. RESTRAINED JOINTS 1. GENERAL: Unless otherwise specified, restrained joints are required for all exposed and buried piping. Unless otherwise specified, restrained joints shall be flanged or grooved end for exposed service and restrained push -on for buried service. 2. PUSH -ON JOINTS: Restrained push -on joints shall be as specified in paragraph 15062-2.05 A.1., modified for restraint. Joints shall be the Flex -Ring or Lok -Ring Joint as manufactured by American Cast Iron Pipe Company, TR Flex Joint as manufactured by US Pipe, or equal. Restrained joints shall be capable of being deflected after full assembly. Joint assembly shall be in strict 15062-3 Ductile Iron Pipe December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • • • • • conformance with AWWA C600 and manufacturer's recommendations. No field cuts of restrained pipe are permitted without prior approval of the Engineer. 3. FLANGE ASSEMBLIES: Unless otherwise specified, flanges shall be ductile iron and shall be threaded -on flanges conforming to ANSI/AWWA A21.15/C 115 or cast -on flanges conforming to ANSI/AWWA A21.10/C 110. Flanges shall be adequate for a minimum of 250 psi working pressure. Bolt circle and bolt holes shall match those of ANSI B16.1, Class 125 flanges and ANSI B 16.5, Class 150 flanges. Where specified, flanges shall be threaded -on or cast -on flanges conforming to ANSI B16.1, Class 250. Unless otherwise specified, bolts and nuts for flange assemblies shall conform with paragraph 15085-2.01 C. Gaskets shall be as specified in paragraph 15085- 2.01 B. 4. GROOVED END JOINTS: Grooved end couplings shall conform to AWWA C606 and shall be Gustin-Bacon 500 Series, Victaulic Style 31, or equal with flush seal type gasket designed for ductile iron pipe. Unless otherwise specified, grooved end couplings shall be rigid joint for exposed service and flexible joint for buried service. Unless otherwise specified, bolts and nuts shall comply with paragraph 15062-2.05 D. 5. MECHANICAL JOINTS: Where specified, restrained mechanical joints shall be the positive restraint type. Mechanical joints with retainer glands are not acceptable. Set -Screw Mechanical Joints with retainer glands are not acceptable. Wedge -Action restraint (EBBA Megalug or equal) shall be pre -approved on a case-by-case by the Engineer via the submittal process. Wedge -Action restraint (EBBA Megalug or equal) connection to existing pipes shall be acceptable. Locked mechanical hydrant tees, bends and adapters are an acceptable substitute for anchoring fire hydrants and valves to the pipe main. C. BALL AND SOCKET FLEXIBLE JOINT PIPE Ball and socket flexible joint pipe shall be the boltless type and shall allow a maximum joint deflection of 15 degrees. Each joint shall be provided with a retainer lock to prevent rotation after assembly. Joints shall be the Flex -Lok Joint as manufactured by American Cast Iron Pipe Company, USIflex as manufactured by U.S. Pipe, or equal. D. BOLTS AND NUTS Corrosion -resistant bolts and on mechanical joint or flange joint pipe and fittings shall be 304 stainless steel conforming to ANSI B16.1. 2.06 PIPE COATING 15062-4 Ductile Iron Pipe December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT A. ASPHALTIC COATING Unless otherwise specified, pipe and fittings shall be coated with 1.0 mils thick bituminous coat in accordance with ANSI A21-51. B. POLYETHYLENE ENCASEMENT Where specified, pipe and fittings shall be wrapped with polyethylene film in tube form as specified in AWWA C105. All buried ductile iron pipe, fittings and restrained joints shall have a polyethylene wrap with a minimum 8 mils thickness and shall conform to ASTM specification D-1248. Wrap for wastewater transmission main shall be olive green and imprinted "WASTEWATER FORCE MAIN". When imprinted color coated polyethylene wrap is not available, color - coded polyethylene wrap can be used in conjunction with pipe ID tape. 2.07 PIPE LINING A. ASPHALTIC LINING (NOT USED) B. INTERIOR LINING 1. CEMENT MORTAR LINING: for all piping downstream of the Primary Clarifier Splitter Box, interior surfaces of pipe and fittings shall be cement mortar lined in accordance with AWWA C104. Cement shall be ASTM C 150, Type II or V, low alkali, containing less than 0.60 alkalies. 2. EPDXY LINING: For all piping upstream downstream of the Primary Clarifier Splitter Box, ductile iron pipe and fittings shall be lined with a ceramic -filled amine -cured epoxy, Protecto 401 by Induron. The lining thickness shall be 40 mils minimum. Application shall be performed by an applicator approved by the coating manufacturer, in accordance with manufacturer's instructions and under controlled conditions at the applicator's shop or the pipe manufacturer's plant. Applicator shall submit a certified affidavit of compliance with manufacturer's instructions and requirements specified herein. C. GLASS LINING (NOT USED) 2.08 PRODUCT DATA The following information shall be provided in accordance with Section 01300: 1. Shop drawings. 2. Alignment drawings. 15062-5 Ductile Iron Pipe December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • • • • 3. Certifications specified m the following documents: ANSI A21.14, paragraph 14-4.2 ANSI A21.52, paragraph 52-4.2 ASTM A716, paragraph 4.2 AW WA C110, paragraph 10-5.3 AWWA C111, paragraph 11-7.1 AWWA C115, paragraph 15-4.2 AWWA C151, paragraph 51-5.2 AWWA C153, paragraph 53-6.3 AWWA C606, paragraph 4.1.1.1 PART 3 - EXECUTION 3.01 INSTALLATION A. GENERAL Piping runs specified on the drawings shall be followed as closely as possible. Proposed deviations shall be submitted in accordance with Section 01300. Pipe shall be installed in accordance with AWWA C600. Connections to existing structures and manholes shall be made so that the finished work will conform as nearly as practicable to the requirements specified for the new manholes, including necessary concrete work, cutting and shaping. Concrete mortar shaping within any structure and manhole shall be as specified. B. ANCHORAGE Anchorage shall be provided as specified. Calculations and drawings for proposed alternative anchorage shall be submitted in accordance with Section 01300. 3.02 ACCEPTANCE TESTING Hydrostatic pressure tests shall be conducted in accordance with Section 4 of AWWA C600. The Contractor shall conduct the tests in the presence of the Engineer. 15062-6 Ductile Iron Pipe December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT 3.03 POLYETHYLENE LINING (NOT USED) 3.04 POLYETHYLENE TUBE Polyethylene encasement shall be used for all buried ductile iron pipe, fittings, and restrained joints. Installation of polyethylene shall be as specified in AWWA C 105 and these specifications. Pipe, fittings, valves and couplings shall be wrapped. Fittings that require concrete backing shall be wrapped prior to placing the concrete. The polyethylene tube seams and overlaps shall be wrapped and held in place by means of a 2 -inch wide plastic backed adhesive tape. The tape shall be Polyken No. 900 (polyethylene), Scotchwrap No. 50 (polyvinyl), or equal. The tape shall be such that the adhesive shall bond securely to both metal surfaces and polyethylene film. Bedding and initial backfill for polyethylene wrapped pipe shall be a well -graded granular material which will not cut or damage the polyethylene tube during placement and backfilling. Sharp angular material over 0.5 inch shall not be used with polyethylene encasement. END OF SECTION 15062-7 Ductile Iron Pipe December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • • • SECTION 15096 PIPE HANGERS AND SUPPORTS PART 1 - GENERAL 1.01 DESCRIPTION A. SCOPE: This section specifies hangers and supports for all piping systems. This section does not include pipe supports for fire sprinlder systems, pipe anchors, guides or seismic restraints. B. OPERATING CONDITIONS: The hangers and supports specified in this section are provided to resist pipe loads occurring primarily in the downward (gravity) direction. For the purpose of pipe hanger and support selection, this section establishes pipe support classifications based on the operating temperatures of the piping contents. Pipe support classifications are as follows: 1. Hot Systems A - 1. 120 degrees F to 450 degrees F A - 2. 451 degrees F to 750 degrees F A - 3. Over 750 degrees F 2. Ambient Systems B. 60 degrees F to 119 degrees F 3. Cold Systems C - 1. 33 degrees F to 59 degrees F C - 2. -20 degrees F to 32 degrees F 1.02 REFERENCES This section contains references to the following documents. They are a part of this section as specified and modified. Where a referenced document contains references to other standards, those documents are included as references under this section as if referenced directly. In the event of conflict between the requirements of this section and those of the listed documents, the requirements of this section shall prevail. 15096-1 Pipe Hangers and Supports December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT Unless otherwise specified, references to documents shall mean the documents in effect at the time of Advertisement for Bids or Invitation to Bid (or on the effective date of the Agreement if there were no Bids). If referenced documents have been discontinued by the issuing organization, references to those documents shall mean the replacement documents issued or otherwise identified by that organization or, if there are no replacement documents, the last version of the document before it was discontinued. Where document dates are given in the following listing, references to those documents shall mean the specific document version associated with that date, regardless of whether the document has been superseded by a version with a later date, discontinued or replaced. Reference Title AISC Manual of Steel Construction FEDSPEC WW -H -171e-78 MFMA-2-91 MSS SP -69-91 MSS SP -58-93 American Institute of Steel Construction, Manual of Steel Construction, Allowable Stress Design - 9th Ed. Hangers and Supports, Pipe Metal Framing Standards Publication Pipe Hangers and Supports - Selection and Application Pipe Hangers and Supports - Materials, Design and Manufacture PART 2 - PRODUCTS 2.01 ACCEPTABLE PRODUCTS Standard pipe supports and components shall be manufactured by B -Line, Carpenter & Patterson, Kin -Line, Grinnell, Michigan, Pipe Shields Incorporated, Superstrut, Unistrut, or equal. Pipe support components shall conform to the requirements of MSS SP -69 and FEDSPEC WW -H -171e. Pipe support materials shall conform to the requirements of MSS SP -58. Metal framing system components shall conform to the metal framing manufacturers' Association Standard MFMA-2. 2.02 MATERIALS A. GENERAL: Unless otherwise specified, pipe hangers and supports, structural attachments, fittings and accessories shall be hot -dip or mechanically galvanized after fabrication. Nuts, bolts and washers may be zinc -plated except for those subject to moisture or corrosive atmosphere, which shall be type 304 stainless steel. 15096-2 Pipe Hangers and Supports December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • • • B. PIPE HANGERS AND SUPPORTS: 1. TYPE 1 - CLEVIS PIPE HANGER: Clevis hangers shall be carbon steel with configuration and components equivalent to MSS and FEDSPEC Type 1. a. Steel pipe (insulated) - shall be B -Line B3100, Grinnell Fig. 260, or equal, with insulation shield. b. Steel pipe (uninsulated) - shall be B -Line B3100, Grinnell Fig. 260, or equal. c. Cast and ductile iron pipe - shall be B -Line B3102, Grinnell Fig. 590, or equal. d. Copper pipe (uninsulated) - shall be B -Line B3104 CT, Grinnell Fig. CT -65, or equal. e. Copper pipe (insulated) - shall be B -Line B3100, Grinnell Fig. 260, or equal, with insulation shield. f. Plastic pipe - shall be B -Line B3100 C, Carpenter & Patterson Fig. 100PVC, or equal. 2. TYPE 2 - "J" PIPE HANGER: Hangers shall be carbon steel with configuration and components equivalent to MSS Type 5. a. Steel pipe - shall be B -Line B3690, Grinnell Fig. 67, Michigan model 418, or equal. b. Copper and plastic pipe - shall be Michigan model 419, Unistrut J 1205N series, or equal. 3. TYPE 3 - DOUBLE BOLT PIPE CLAMP: Pipe clamp shall be carbon steel, with configuration and components equivalent to MSS and FEDSPEC Type 3. a. Steel pipe (insulated) - shall be B -Line B3144, Grinnell Fig. 295, or equal, with insulation shield. Insulation shield is optional for hot and ambient systems. b. Steel pipe (uninsulated) - shall be B -Line B3144, Grinnell Fig. 295, or equal. 15096-3 Pipe Hangers and Supports December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT c. Copper pipe (insulated only) - shall be B -Line B3144, Grinnell Fig. 295, or equal, with insulation shield. 4. TYPE 4 - ADJUSTABLE ROLLER HANGER: Rollers shall be cast iron, yoke and cross bolt shall be carbon steel. Configuration and components shall be equivalent to MSS Type 43 and FEDSPEC Type 44. a. Steel pipe (insulated) - shall be B -Line B3110, Grinnell Fig. 181, or equal, with insulation shield. b. Steel pipe (uninsulated) - shall be B -Line B3110, Grinnell Fig. 181, or equal. c. Copper pipe (insulated only) - shall be B -Line B3110, Grinnell Fig. 181, or equal, with insulation shield. d. Plastic pipe - shall be B -Line B3110, Grinnell Fig. 181, or equal. 5. TYPE 5 - SINGLE PIPE ROLL: Rollers and sockets shall be cast iron, cross rod shall be steel. Configuration and components shall be equivalent to MSS Type 41 and FEDSPEC Type 42. a. Steel pipe (insulated) - shall be B -Line B3114, Grinnell Fig. 171, or equal, with insulation shield. b. Steel pipe (uninsulated) - shall be B -Line B3114, Grinnell Fig. 171, or equal. c. Plastic pipe - shall be B -Line B3114, Grinnell Fig. 171, or equal. 6. TYPE 6 - FRAMING CHANNEL PIPE CLAMP: Pipe clamps shall be steel with galvanized finish and material thickness as listed below: a. Steel pipe (uninsulated) - Pipe size 3/8 inch and 1/2 inch shall be 16 gage; 3/4 inch through 1 1/4 inches shall be 14 gage; 1 1/2 inches through 3 inches shall be 12 gage; 3 1/2 inches through 5 inches shall be 11 gage; 6 and 8 inches shall be 10 gage; Michigan model 431, Powerstrut PS 1100, Unistrut P 1109 series, or equal. b. Steel pipe (insulated) - Pipe clamp shall be as described in paragraph 15096-2.02 B.6.a with insulation shield. c. Copper (uninsulated) and plastic pipe - Pipe size 3/8 inch and 1 inch shall be 16 gage; 1-1/4 inches and 1-1/2 inches shall be 14 gage; 2 inches through 3 inches shall be 12 gage; 4 inches shall be 11 gage; 15096-4 Pipe Hangers and Supports December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • • • • clamp shall be copper -plated, plastic coated or lined with dielectric material; Michigan model 432, Powerstrut PS 1200, Unistrut P 2024C and P 2024PC series, or equal. d. Copper pipe (insulated) - Pipe clamp shall be as described in paragraph 15096-2.02 B.6.a with insulation shield. 7. TYPE 7 - U -BOLT: U -bolts shall be carbon steel with configuration equivalent to MSS and FEDSPEC Type 24. a. Steel pipe (uninsulated) - shall be Grinnell Fig. 137, B -Line B3188, or equal. b. Steel pipe (insulated) - shall be Grinnell Fig. 137, B -Line B3188, or equal, with insulation shield. c. Cast and ductile iron pipe - shall be Grinnell Fig. 137, B -Line B3188, or equal. d. Copper pipe (uninsulated) - shall be Carpenter & Patterson Fig. 222 CT, B -Line B3501 CT, Grinnell Fig. 137C, or equal. e. Copper pipe (insulated) - shall be Grinnell Fig. 137, B -Line B3188, or equal, with insulation shield. f. Plastic pipe - shall be Grinnell Fig. 137C, Michigan model 151, B - Line B3188 C, or equal. 8. TYPE 8 - ADJUSTABLE PIPE ROLL SUPPORT: Rollers and sockets shall be cast iron, cross rod and support rods shall be carbon steel. a. Steel pipe (insulated) - shall be B -Line B3122, Grinnell Fig. 177, or equal, with insulation shield. b. Steel pipe (uninsulated) - shall be B -Line B3122, Grinnell Fig. 177, or equal. c. Copper pipe (insulated only) - shall be B -Line B3122, Grinnell Fig. 177, or equal, with insulation shield. d. Plastic pipe - shall be B -Line B3122, Grinnell Fig. 177, or equal. 9. TYPE 9 - WELDED PIPE STANCHION: Minimum material thickness shall be standard schedule carbon steel pipe, cut to match contour of the pipe elbow. Use of this support shall be limited to ambient systems only. 15096-5 Pipe Hangers and Supports December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT 10. TYPE 10 - PIPE STANCHION SADDLE: Saddles and yokes shall be carbon steel and comply with MSS Type 37 and FEDSPEC Type 38. a. Steel pipe (insulated) - shall be Carpenter & Patterson Fig. 125, B - Line B3090, or equal, with insulation shield. b. Steel pipe (uninsulated) - shall be Carpenter & Patterson Fig. 125, B - Line B3090, or equal. c. Cast and ductile iron pipe - shall be Carpenter & Patterson Fig. 125, B -Line B3090 NS, or equal. d. Copper pipe (uninsulated) - shall be Carpenter & Patterson Fig. 125, B -Line B3090, or equal, with insulation shield or lined with dielectric material. e. Copper pipe (insulated) - shall be Carpenter & Patterson Fig. 125, B - Line B3090, or equal, with insulation shield. f. Plastic pipe - shall be Carpenter & Patterson Fig. 125, B -Line B3090, or equal. 11. TYPE 11 - OFFSET PIPE CLAMP: Pipe clamp shall be carbon steel with configuration and components as specified and shall be of standard design manufactured by a pipe hanger component manufacturer. a. Steel pipe (insulated) - shall be B -Line B3148, Grinnell Fig. 103, or equal, with insulation shield. b. Steel pipe (uninsulated) - shall be B -Line B3148, Grinnell Fig. 103, or equal. c. Cast and ductile iron pipe - shall be B -Line B3148 NS, Grinnell Fig. 103, or equal. d. Copper pipe (insulated) - shall be B -Line B3148, Grinnell Fig. 103, or equal, with insulation shield. e. Copper pipe (uninsulated) - shall be B -Line B3148, Grinnell Fig. 103, or equal, lined with dielectric material. f. Plastic pipe - shall be B -Line B3148, Grinnell Fig. 103, or equal. 15096-6 Pipe Hangers and Supports December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • • • 12. TYPE 12 - RISER CLAMP: Riser clamp shall be carbon steel with configuration and components equivalent to MSS and FEDSPEC Type 8. a. Steel pipe (insulated) - shall be B -Line B3373, Grinnell Fig. 261, or equal. • • b. Steel pipe (uninsulated) - shall be B -Line B3373, Grinnell Fig. 261, or equal. c. Cast and ductile iron pipe - shall be B -Line B3373, Grinnell Fig. 261, or equal. d. Copper pipe (insulated) - shall be B -Line B3373 CT, Grinnell Fig. CT -121, Michigan model 511, or equal. e. Copper pipe (uninsulated) - shall be B -Line B3373 CT, Grinnell Fig. CT -121, Michigan model 511, or equal. f. Plastic pipe - shall be B -Line B3373, Grinnell Fig. 261c, or equal. 13. TYPE 13 - FRAMING CHANNEL PIPE STRAP: Pipe strap shall be carbon steel, with configuration equivalent to MSS Type 26. a. Steel pipe (uninsulated) - shall be Superstrut No. C -708-U, Powerstrut PS 3126, Kin -Line No. 477, or equal. b. Steel pipe (insulated) - shall be Superstrut No. C -708-U, Powerstrut PS 3126, Kin -Line No. 477, or equal, with insulation shield. c. Copper pipe (uninsulated) - shall be Superstrut No. C -708-U, Powerstrut PS 3126, Kin -Line No. 477, or equal, with insulation shield or lined with dielectric material. d. Copper pipe (insulated) - shall be Superstrut No. C -708-U, Powerstrut PS 3126, Kin -Line No. 477, or equal, with insulation shield. e. Plastic pipe - shall be Superstrut No. C -708-U, Powerstrut PS 3126, Kin -Line No. 477, or equal. C. RACK AND TRAPEZE SUPPORTS: 1. GENERAL: Unless otherwise specified, trapeze and pipe rack components shall have a minimum steel thickness of 12 gage, with a maximum deflection 1/240 of the span. 15096-7 Pipe Hangers and Supports December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT 2. TYPE 20 - TRAPEZE PIPE SUPPORT: Trapeze pipe support cross members shall be framing channel as specified in paragraph 15096-2.02 E.S. Flat plate fittings shall be 1 5/8 -inch square carbon steel of standard design manufactured by framing channel manufacturer, Unistrut P2471, B -Line B202-2, or equal. 3. TYPE 21 - PIPE RACK SUPPORT: Post and cross members shall be framing channel as specified in paragraph 15096-2.02 E.S. Pipe rack fittings shall be carbon steel, of standard design manufactured by framing channel manufacturer. 90 -degree fittings shall be gusseted Unistrut P2484, B -Line B844, or equal. Post base fittings shall be as specified in paragraph 15096- 2.02 D.S. D. STRUCTURAL ATTACHMENTS: 1. TYPE A - MALLEABLE IRON CONCRETE INSERT: Concrete inserts shall be malleable iron and comply with MSS and FEDSPEC Type 18. Grinnell Fig. 282, Carpenter & Patterson Fig. 108, or equal. 2. TYPE B - SIDE BEAM BRACKET: Bracket shall be malleable iron and comply with MSS Type 34 and FEDSPEC Type 35. Grinnell Fig. 202, B - Line B3062, or equal. 3. TYPE C - MALLEABLE BEAM CLAMP WITH EXTENSION PIECE: Clamp and extension piece shall be malleable iron, tie rod shall be steel. Beam clamp shall comply with MSS and FEDSPEC Type 30. Grinnell Fig. 218 with Fig. 157 extension piece, B -Line B3054, or equal. 4. TYPE D - STEEL BEAM CLAMP WITH EYE NUT: Beam clamp and eye nut shall be forged steel. Configuration and components shall comply with MSS and FEDSPEC Type 28. Grinnell Fig. 292, Carpenter & Patterson Fig. 297, or equal. 5. TYPE E - FRAMING CHANNEL POST BASE: Post bases shall be carbon steel, of standard design manufactured by framing channel manufacturer. Single channel: Unistrut P2072A, B -Line B280, or equal. Double channel: Unistrut P2073A, B -Line B281, or equal. 6. TYPE F - WELDED BEAM ATTACHMENT: Beam attachment shall be carbon steel and comply with MSS and FEDSPEC Type 22. B -Line B3083, Grinnell Fig. 66, or equal. 7. TYPE G - WELDED STEEL BRACKET: Bracket shall be carbon steel and comply with MSS Type 32 and FEDSPEC Type 33 for medium welded 15096-8 Pipe Hangers and Supports December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT 11, • • • bracket. Heavy welded bracket shall comply with MSS Type 33 and FEDSPEC Type 34. • • 8. TYPE H - CAST IRON BRACKET: Bracket shall be cast iron, Carpenter & Patterson Fig. 340, or equal. 9. TYPE J - ADJUSTABLE BEAM ATTACHMENT: Beam attachment shall be carbon steel, Carpenter & Patterson Fig. 151, B -Line B3082, or equal. 10. TYPE K - DOUBLE CHANNEL BRACKET: Wall channel shall be single channel framing channel as specified in paragraph 15096-2.02 E.S. Cantilever bracket shall be a carbon steel double framing channel assembly, Unistrut P2542 through P2546, B -Line B297-12 through B297-36, or equal. 11. TYPE L - SINGLE CHANNEL BRACKET: Wall channel shall be single channel framing channel as specified in paragraph 15096-2.02 E.S. Cantilever bracket shall be a carbon steel single framing channel assembly, Unistrut P2231 through P2234, B -Line B198-6, B198-12, B196-18 and B196-24, or equal. 12. TYPE M - WALL MOUNTED CHANNEL: Wall channel shall be single channel framing channel as specified in paragraph 15096-2.02 E.S. 13. TYPE N - PIPE STANCHION FLOOR ATTACHMENT: Baseplate shall be carbon steel with 1/2 inch minimum thickness. Anchor bolt holes shall be 1/16 inch larger than the anchor bolt diameter. The space between the baseplate and the floor shall be filled with nonshrink grout. E. ACCESSORIES: 1. HANGER RODS: Rods shall be carbon steel, threaded on both ends or continuous threaded and sized as specified. 2. WELDLESS EYE NUT: Eye nut shall be forged steel and shall comply with MSS and FEDSPEC Type 17. Eye nut shall be Grinnell Fig. 290, B - Line B3200, or equal. 3. WELDED EYE ROD: Eye rod shall be carbon steel with eye welded closed. Inside diameter of eye shall accommodate a bolt diameter 1/8 inch larger than the rod diameter. Eye rod shall be Grinnell Fig. 278, B -Line B3211, or equal. 4. TURNBUCKLE: Turnbuckle shall be forged steel and shall comply with MSS and FEDSPEC Type 13. Turnbuckle shall be Grinnell Fig. 230, B - Line B3202, or equal. 15096-9 Pipe Hangers and Supports December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT 5. FRAMING CHANNEL: Framing channel shall be 1 5/8 inches square, roll formed, 12 -gage carbon steel. Channel shall have a continuous slot along one side with in -turned clamping ridges. Single channel: Unistrut P1000, B - Line B22, or equal. Double channel: Unistrut P1001, B -Line B22A, or equal. Triple channel: Unistrut P1004A, B -Line B22X, or equal. 2.03 THERMAL PIPE HANGER SHIELD Thermal shields shall be provided at hanger, support and guide locations on pipe requiring insulation. The shield shall consist of an insulation layer encircling the entire circumference of the pipe and a steel jacket encircling the insulation layer. The thermal shield shall be the same thickness as the piping system insulation specified in Section 15250, where applicable. The standard shield shall be used for hot systems and the vapor barrier shield shall be used for cold systems. Stainless steel band clamps shall be used where specified to ensure against slippage between the pipe wall and the thermal shield. A. STANDARD SHIELD: 1. INSULATION: a. Hydrous calcium silicate, high density, waterproof b. Compressive strength: 100 psi average c. Flexural strength: 75 psi average d. K factor: 0.38 at 100 degrees F mean e. Temperature range: 20 degrees F to 500 degrees F 2. STEEL JACKET: Galvanized steel. Gage shall be the manufacturer's standard supplied for the given pipe size. 3. CONNECTION: Shield shall have butt connection to pipe insulation. Steel jacket and insulation shall be flush with end. B. VAPOR BARRIER SHIELD: 1. INSULATION: a. Hydrous calcium silicate, high density, waterproof b. Compressive strength: 100 psi average c. Flexural strength: 75 psi average d. K factor: 0.38 at 100 degrees F mean e. Temperature range: 20 degrees F to 500 degrees F 2. STEEL JACKET: Galvanized steel. Gage shall be the manufacturer's standard supplied for the given pipe size. 15096-10 Pipe Hangers and Supports December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0049 -UT • • • • 3. CONNECTION: Shield shall have butt connection to pipe insulation. Insulation shall extend 1 inch each side of steel jacket for vaportight connection to pipe insulation vapor barrier. 2.04 PRODUCT DATA Hanger and support locations and components shall be indicated on the piping layout drawings required by paragraph 15050-2.04. PART 3 - EXECUTION 3.01 HANGER AND SUPPORT LOCATIONS The Contractor shall locate hangers and supports as near as possible to concentrated loads such as valves, flanges, etc. Locate hangers, supports and accessories within the maximum span lengths specified in the project manual to support continuous pipeline runs unaffected by concentrated loads. At least one hanger or support shall be located within 2 feet from a pipe change in direction. • The Contractor shall locate hangers and supports to ensure that connections to equipment, tanks, etc., are substantially free from loads transmitted by the piping. Where piping is connected to equipment, a valve, piping assembly, etc., that will require removal for maintenance, the piping shall be supported in such a manner that temporary supports shall not be necessary for this procedure. • Pipe shall not have pockets formed in the span due to sagging of the pipe between supports caused by the weight of the pipe, medium in the pipe, insulation, valves and fittings. 3.02 INSTALLATION Welded and bolted attachments to the building structural steel shall be in accordance with the requirements of the AISC Manual of Steel Construction. Unless otherwise specified, there shall be no drilling or burning of holes in the building structural steel. Hanger components shall not be used for purposes other than for which they were designed. They shall not be used for rigging and erection purposes. The Contractor shall install items to be embedded before concrete is poured. Fasten embedded items securely to prevent movement when concrete is poured. 15096-11 Pipe Hangers and Supports December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT Embedded anchor bolts shall be used instead of concrete inserts for support installations in areas below water surface or normally subject to submerging. The Contractor shall install thermal pipe hanger shields on insulated piping at required locations during hanger and support installation. Butt joint connections to pipe insulation shall be made at the time of insulation installation in accordance with the manufacturer's recommendations. Hanger and support components in contact with plastic pipe shall be free of burrs and sharp edges. Rollers shall roll freely without binding. Finished floor beneath Type N structural attachments and framing channel post bases shall be roughed prior to grouting. Grout between base plate and floor shall be free of voids and foreign material. Baseplates shall be cut and drilled to specified dimensions prior to welding stanchions or other attachments and prior to setting anchor bolts. Plastic or rubber end caps shall be provided at the exposed ends of all framing channels that are located up to 7 feet above the floor. 3.03 ADJUSTMENTS The Contractor shall adjust hangers and supports to obtain required pipe slope and elevation. Shims made of material that is compatible with the piping material may be used. Stanchions shall be adjusted prior to grouting their baseplates. END OF SECTION 15096-12 Pipe Hangers and Supports December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • • • • • SECTION 15110 ECCENTRIC PLUG VALVES PART 1 - GENERAL 1.01 DESCRIPTION This section specifies eccentric plug valves. 1.02 QUALITY ASSURANCE A. REFERENCES This section contains references to the following documents. They are a part of this section as specified and modified. Where a referenced document contains references to other standards, those documents are included as references under this section as if referenced directly. In the event of conflict between the requirements of this section and those of the listed documents, the requirements of this section shall prevail. Unless otherwise specified, references to documents shall mean the documents in effect at the time of Advertisement for Bids or Invitation to Bid (or on the effective date of the Agreement if there were no Bids). If referenced documents have been discontinued by the issuing organization, references to those documents shall mean the replacement documents issued or otherwise identified by that organization or, if there are no replacement documents, the last version of the document before it was discontinued. Where document dates are given in the following listing, references to those documents shall mean the specific document version associated with that date, regardless of whether the document has been superseded by a version with a later date, discontinued or replaced. Reference Title ANSI B16.1 ASTM A126 ASTM A276 ASTM A436 ASTM A536 Cast Iron Pipe Flanges and Flanged Fittings Class 25, 125, 250, and 800 Gray Iron Castings for Valves, Flanges, and Pipe Fittings Stainless and Heat -Resisting Steel Bars and Shapes Austenitic Gray Iron Castings Ductile Iron Castings B. PROOF OF DESIGN TESTS 15110-1 Eccentric Plug Valves Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT December 2020 The Contractor shall furnish the Engineer three certified copies of a report from an independent testing laboratory certifying successful completion of proof -of -design testing conducted in accordance with AWWA C504, Section 5.2, except that where the word "disc" appears in the standard, it is understood to mean "plug." In lieu of testing the valves at an independent testing laboratory, proof -of -design testing may be performed at the valve manufacturer's laboratory, but must be witnessed by a representative of a qualified independent testing laboratory, and all test reports must be certified by the laboratory representative. Proof -of -design testing shall have been performed on not less than three 6 -inch diameter valves, with all three test units demonstrating full compliance with the test standards. Failure to satisfactorily complete the test shall be deemed sufficient evidence to reject all valves of the proposed make or manufacturer's model number. PART 2 - PRODUCTS 2.01 MATERIALS Materials of construction shall be as follows: Component Material Body Plug Plug facing Body seats Less than 3 inches 3 inches and larger General Service: Cast iron, ASTM A126, Class B Cast iron, ASTM A126, Class B, or cast iron ASTM A436 (Ni -resist), or ductile iron, ASTM A536 General service: Neoprene or Buna-N DG -combined services (Piping system 4A): Viton (FKM) Cast iron, ASTM A126, Class B Stainless steel, ASTM A276, Type 304 or nickel Packing General service: Buna V -flex Lining The interior ferrous surfaces of all plug valves shall have a factory applied fusion bonded epoxy lining in accordance with the manufacturer's specifications to a minimum of 20 mils thickness. Materials specified are considered the minimum acceptable for the purposes of durability, strength, and resistance to erosion and corrosion. The Contractor may propose alternative materials for the purpose of providing greater strength or to meet required stress limitations. However, alternative materials must provide at least the same qualities as those specified for the purpose. 15110-2 Eccentric Plug Valves December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • • • • • 2.02 MANUFACTURE A. ECCENTRIC PLUG VALVES Valves shall be straight -flow, eccentric, non -lubricated resilient plug type suitable for driptight, bi-directional shutoff at the specified valve design pressure. Port areas for the valve shall be at least 100 percent of the adjacent full pipe area and shall be capable of passing solids two-thirds of pipe size. Valve body seats consisting of nickel for valves 3 inches and larger shall be constructed of a welded -in overlay of not less than 90 percent pure nickel or be a one piece 304 stainless steel ring. Upper and lower journal bearings shall be replaceable, sleeve -type, corrosion resistant, and permanently lubricated. Packing shall be self-adjusting chevron type replaceable without disassembling the valve. B. END CONNECTIONS Valves 3 inches and smaller shall have threaded ends. Valve flange drilling for valves larger than 3 inches shall be per ANSI B16.1, Class 125 or 250 as required. Grooved -end valves may be provided with grooved -end piping systems. C. MANUAL OPERATORS Valves 4 inches and smaller shall be provided with a lever type manual operator. Valves larger than 4 inches shall be provided with totally enclosed worm gear operators. Where specified, manual operators shall have an adjustable stop. All operator components shall be sized for the valve design pressure in accordance with AWWA C504, Section 4.5. D. MANUFACTURERS: The following candidate manufacturers are considered capable of producing equipment and/or products that will satisfy the requirements of this Section. This statement, however, shall not be construed as an endorsement of a particular manufacturer's products, nor shall it be construed that named manufacturers' standard equipment or products will comply with the requirements of this Section. Candidate manufacturers include DeZurik and Milliken, or equal, modified to provide the specified features. 2.03 PRODUCT DATA The following information shall be provided in accordance with Section 01300: 1. Manufacturer's product data. 2. Proof -of -design test reports specified in paragraph 15110-1.03 B. 15110-3 Eccentric Plug Valves December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT PART 3 - EXECUTION 3.01 INSTALLATION Unless otherwise specified, valves shall be provided with the seat downstream away from flow. Valves at tank connections shall be installed with seat away from tank. Valves on pump discharge lines shall be installed with seat adjacent to the pump. On services with grit and sand, valves shall be installed with seat upstream against flow. 3.02 IDENTIFICATION TAGS All plug valves installed on the digester U-tube overflow assemblies shall be tagged with stainless steel tags affixed with stainless steel wire. Valve tags shall describe valve function and normal position (e.g. "U-tube Drain" - Normally Closed), in % " minimum letters stamped into tag. END OF SECTION 15110-4 Eccentric Plug Valves December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • • • APPENDIX • • OTHER PROJECT DOCUMENTATION Table of Contents EXISTING RECORD DRAWINGS 1 BYPASSING CONCEPT 2 APPENDIX i Updated 6/20/2018 APPENDIX—OTHER PROJECT DOCUMENTATION EXISTING RECORD DRAWINGS • • • APPENDIX 1 Updated 6/20/2018 • • Project #: 07 -0003 -UT Project Name: MARSHALL STREET APCF PROCESS AIR SYSTEM UPGRADE Job: 2008027 CD No. 2011-05 Consultant: PREPARED BY MALCOLM PIRNIE. SEE 2009041(MCKIM&CREED) Comments: SEE PAGE G-1 - COVER SHEET FOR SHEET INDEX MARSHALL STREET PLANT Engineering Document Name Use Job # INDEX OF DRAWINGS 06311. 40331 OCR • 1.1331/10 31•113444110113 MO NM 0-4 COMO relait 14430 I, IMMO 1133 RON ▪ 0131313033 MOM IONS MO 6194 M-3 Man 430•3I CO•1•X•301 MOO WA. ▪ 00.413:41 VMS -3 VII34 MAN ki-▪ 0 AMMO IMP AMMON 13300 43-331331. 133•33 311131 MO WAIN RAO 3 34-3113.01. wiles Kelt. 0334161. WILLOW 0313:4•3•1 43.433 714.74 40333 733•3I 00.3.31. IVO MC 11301333 b1-14 PP WOW 1/40:3 OVA MP =WI 0314101334. 341 ma. 3•111131•••131,304 3t43 WU. $4.4 01119.7 DIMS KV 1 11.47•333 MVO 0•1313.3011 NOM • DON. 341 0.1.311.43 01310.13103 .04131 303414 301,30•311 MIMI Olt Lii• WORM MC OA LK MOON • 3111140.334 11.64111.43 • MM. •3332410 KAI. MAN 43-311343.341 43/031 0.1.1404. 40•111 3,4 1•1•3430333 33334,3031/ man xe Nan ILY/0341 aarriguonxiKnox 431143•• MIX 33401131 4.03420 UMW 481 %WM 33.11011 303•313-3 OL40343. DM= 033430. AMT. 133143 4,3 NO 0130103. 1:4M3131 11340473,34011 31•43 34. 4413.31, COMM U- rwater Public Works Administration 100 S. Myrtle Avenue, Clearwater, Florida 33756 MARSHALL STREET APCFPROCESS A/R SYSTEM UPGRADE PROJECT LOCATION AARP Project No. 07-0003—UT RECORD DRAWINGS AUGUST 2010 RECORD DRAWING 33 134. 3043 1:v=44.43). 70"3!"4=1 4Orrant,nth; 340449 MACOAI P2/ C. PREPARED BY: MAR (MAI PIRNIE CERTIFICATE OF AUTHORIZATION NO. 67 1300 E. 8TH AVE.. 5,0.1 F-100 TAMPA, FLORIDA 33605 PHONE FAX (8) 248-6900 (813) 248 8085 MP PROJECT NO., 5817-002 CARLTON SEREEITE PEA 63640 CITY OFFICIALS Frank Hibbard John Doran George N. Cretekos Carlen Petersen Paul F. Gibson Mayor Seat 1 Vice Mayor Seat 2 Council Member -Seat 3 Council Member -Seat 4 Council Member -Seat 5 William B. Home II City Manager Michael D. Quillen, P.E. City Engineer Approved By Date Approved • • • 067.05 N OR ----HI • • GENERAL KEY GENERAL ABBREVIATIONS GENERAL NOTES L. POND V BLOWER NEW EOUIPNENT, P19940, STRUCTURE. ETC III 104E NEW BURIED EQUIPMENT, PIPING, STRUCTURE. ETC T 90' BEND EXISTING STRUCTURE P` 45' BEND EXISTING EQUIPMENT, PIPING SJ CROSS EXISTING BURIED PIPING CENTERLINE HOSE BIBB EASEMENT FIRE HYDRANT PROPERTY UNE •F0 FLOOR DRAIN CTI AREA DRAIN SPOT ELEVATION SCO CLEANOUT EXISTING SPOT ELEVATION U.F• UTILITY POLE FENCE U L1 A 4TU1Y a LIGHT POLE EXISTING FENCE m ELECTRIC UNITY BOX SO.EN0D VALVE ELLIPTICAL CORRUGATED PLUG VALVE METAL PIPE GLOBE VALVE ELEC— OVERHEAD ELEC. LINES BALL VALVE BUTTERFLY VALVE CHECK VALVE DUCKBILL CV GATE VALVE PRESSURE REUEF VALVE AIR RELEASE VALVE UNION REDUCER PIPING ELBOW, 90' TURNED DOWN PIPING ELBOW, 90' TURNED UP PIPING TEE, OUTLET TURNED DOWN PIPING TEE, OUTLET TURNED UP DRAINAGE FLOW ARROW PROPOSED PIPING WITH DIRECTION OF FLOW PLUG OR CAP BUND FLANGE STRAINER II , MECHANICS JOINT (MJ) FLANGE JOINT (FAC) ® WELDED JOINT —(— PIPE JOINT (SINGLE UNE) ezo SPLIT FLEXIBLE COUPLING SPLIT HARNESSED FLEXIBLE COUPLING R --ER] HARNESSED FLANGED COUPLING ADAPTER I--#-�> FLANGED COUPLING ADAPTER yyH--H.i--O EXPANSION JOINT EIIr F_ t J HARNESSED EXPANSION JOINT WALL SLEEVE W/MECHAIICAL SEAL BUND FLANGE ELECTRICAL ACTUATOR O APPROX ARV BF BFP BEV BLDG CAV CO CCT( CONC CONT CV D.C. DEG OR ' a DIA DIP ECC EJ EL EP EX/EXIST FCV FES FF FLGO CAV H -H INV LF AT APPROXIMATELY AIR RELEASE VALVE BUND FLANGE BAC( FLOW PREVENTOR BUTTERFLY VALVE 6000)06 CENIEIBUNE COMBINATION AIR VALVE CLEAN OUT CYPRESS CREEK TRANSMH510N MAIN CONCRETE CONTINUATION CHECK VALVE DOUBLE CONTAINMENT DEGREE DUCTILE IRON DIAMETER OUCT1E IRON PIPE ECCENTRIC EXPANSION JOINT ELEVADCS EDGE OF PAVEMENT EXISTING FLOW CONTROL VALVE FLARED END SECTION RNISHED FLOOR FLANGE GALVANIZED HAND HOLE INVERT UNEAR FOOT RECORD DRAWING hem - 4 :Loot. �44 :.'Ine°.e Sow w p.m. toNxfo M .. in 1I M'..NR to .ert1. am .carol. N N MALCOLM PIMNE, NC. big./(D . L MAO MAXIMUM MES METERED END SECTION MH MANHOLE MM MINORUM MJ MECHANICAL JOINT NTS NOT TO SCALE NO OR / NUMBER 0/F OUTSIDE FACE PCCP PRESTRESSED CONCRETE CYLINDER PIPE PCUD PASCO COUNTY UTUTES DEPARTMENT PRV PRESSURE RELEASE VALVE PVC POLYVINYL CHLORIDE R/RAD RADIUS RCP REINFORCED CONCRETE PIPE RED REDUCER REINF REINFORCEMENT RECD REWIRED RJ RESTRAINED JOINT RWGV RESUAIT WEDGE GATE VALVE SS STAINLESS STEEL T/ TCP OF T.O.P TCP OF PIPE 106 TOP OF BANK T05 TOE OF SLOPE TS TAP SLEEVE TVP TYPICAL ULP UTILITY UGHT POLE UN UNDER DRAIN 4ON UNLESS 01NERVASE NOTED WP WATER TREATMENT PLANT W/ WITH WAIF MELDED WIRE FABRIC MMm1A1ELY FOL0WED NOTE 10 PROCEED. CONTRACTOR SMALL SUBMIT 910P DRAWI105 FOR TIE BLOWERS. URr09[RS J0• BUTTERFAT VALVE ANO 30'X30• means S1EL TEE MTH 10• SDE aVE1. ALL WARN PERFORMED MOLL BEM FULL COMPUNKE MITI THE REQUIREMENTS OF 0TY a CLEARWAMIEN 00FUCTS OCCUR KU 5 REDEEM DOWER. NA W100)19 ON THACMES ESE ORANNN0S/SPEOFICASINSOICWTIONS AND REGULATORY CRITERIA 144E MORE STRINGENT REWRDIENT STALL PREVAA 114E CONTRACTOR }TALL VERBALLY I MIO MY COwUCT TO M 11104106 OF TIE CONSTRUCTER INSPECTOR MMEOATO.Y, FOILOMED BY 4.1 OFFICIAL MBTIEN NGIIMATON MINN 24 HWS. 114E CONSTRUCTION INSPECTOR SHALL FORWARD TO THE 0)04I R. 2. EM110 U1LITY =ATONE SIZES AND ELEVATIONS WENN ON TE OAMIg9 ARE AMEND/ATE AND ARE 111E70ED CELT 10 NOCATE 1111 EMIENCE OF SUCH UTILITIES IN 11E MEAS SOWN. B EFORE PROCEEDING MTI TE RMS TIE CONTRACTOR SHALL FELD VERPY UM, LOCATIONS AND N011FY TE ENGINEER OF AR1 Og0EPMDO. 3. ALL U1NMS 9INL BE P601001ED PROM ma DAMNS AS A RE5KT OF TIE WON PALMED N 1118 CANIRACT. IT SHALL BE DIE RESPONSBLUTY OF THE CONTRACTOR TO REPAIR AND/OR REPLACE ANY DAMAGED UTUMS TO 1)11 SATISFACTION Of THE OMIER AT TIE CONRACIOR'S EXP00 A. FELD VERIFY ALL DOSING DIMENSIONS AND ELEVATIONS. 3 (e) DENOTES am 910441 ELEVATIONS 10 BE DETERMINED ACCORORO TO COSTING CDNOITONB FURNISED 6. ANTED LOCATION OF CASTING STRUCTURES PORNO AM EQUIPMENT N BASED ON DIE RFOIMATOM OBTAINED FROM RECORD DRAMAS. TE CONTRACTOR SHAM FIELD 0DNFY TER COOITICWN3 PRIOR TO LEMMA MY STRUCTURE PIPING OR EQUIPMENT. 7. WHEN CONFLICTS OCCUR BETWEEN REQUIREMENTS SHOWN ON TER OM1190S/S 104910ATON9 AND REGULATORY CNIENA THE MORE STRNTEHT REQUIREMENT SCOL NAVAL B. THE 011344001 SHALL BE RESPONSIBLE FOR 0117U61I0 AND PAYING FOL ROMEO PERMITS THAT KRUAM TO M CONTRACTED MORE. SUCH PER915 SMALL BE OBTAINED BY THE CONTRACTOR PRIOR 10 BEGNNNG WORN ON THE PORTON OF DIE PROECT RWRN° SAID PERMITS. O. 1R CONTRACTOR SHALL BE RESPONSIBLE FOR WANING AREA FOR STORAGE OF MATERIALS AND EQUIPMENT. SECURITY OF CONSTRUCTOR MOMENT AND OAIF3RAI4 }HALL R TE 6EspotasU1Y G 114E CONTRACTOR. 10. ORAS*5 600Al= COMA= 111[ CONTRACT INE TORMIINOSTOR �AND/OR TTY BE TIE OWER. ORIGINAL MOTION 11. CONTRACTOR SHALL MAINTAIN ACCESS TO ALL FACILITES AT ALL TRINES N0 SEANCE ROAD SHALL BE TAXER COT or 3E6MLE EXCEPT 10 ACCOMPLISH WORT REQUIRED UNDER 1)61 CONTRACT ND THEN ONLY AFTER M ALTERNATE METIW OF ACCESS APPROVED BY THE ORM HAS BEEN FRONTED. 12. THE MORN NEW= HOER 1)09 CONTRACT SHALL BE CONDUCTED M SUCH A MAMWR TO P ORT NORM& OPERATIONS Of THE FACILITY AT ALL TME9. 13 IT SNL BE THE CONTRACT 61 REWPONSBMTY TO SMD MNG 06 OTIEDWSE PLUG DO91M0 AND PROPOSED WON AS REWIRED 10 PEEP 1E FACILITY N OPE3ATIQU. 14. AT TEES DUERO 191 NON *ALUM UNDER 015 CONTRACT, IT SMALL BE NECESSARY 10 S UT DOWN CRTNN OPERATING MINS IN TIE FACILITY, ALL REQUIRED STSIER OR PARER. snow SHU100MN9 MALL BE COMMA= MIH. AND 10HEDU.ES AT TIMES EATABLE TO TIE OMER R AND 61 ACCORDANCE MM THE SPECIFICATIONS 15. TEMPORARY MIENS SHALL RATAN M PUCE UNTIL ME SUCCESSFUL OPERATION OF NEW MIENS IS YENNED. 16. TIE CONTRACTOR SHALL NOTE THAT GRIT MAY HAVE ACCUMULATED N THE TARNS CONTRACTOR SHALL FURNISH ALL XEQ59ARY WOR, MATERIALS AND EQUIPMENT, N0.UON0 AUMUARY EQUIPMENT, R NECESSARY 10 REMOVE AND DISPOSE a ALL OMT FROM 1 E TANKS PATIENT FOR GRT REMOVAL RIND DEPOSAL MILL BE N ACCORDANCE us SECTION 0971. PIPE SUPPORT NOTES 1. FOR FLIED RPE SADDLES SEE RTA ON SHEET 14-17. 2. FOR SLIDING PPE SUPPORTS SEE 9EQRCATOR 15050 3 FOR FORCES ASSOCIATED MTN RPE SUPPORTS SEE SHEET M-17 a. FOR SUPPORT DETAILS REFER TO STRUCTURAL DRAWINGS. PIPE SUPPORT LEGEND (F) FT® SADDLE (9) SUMO MOLE SECTION AND DETAIL KEY HATCH LEGEND SRR ON SECTION ANON SECTION NUMBER L9 OUT FROM SECTION AF: ., NZ, SECTION NUMBER SHEET ON WHICH SECTION I5 SHOWN DETAIL NUMBER SHEET ON WHICH DETAIL IS SHOWN OR CUT FROM f. l RECORD DRAWINGS «N w, 0" 1./21)_. or, OKolip op. prygo, p.a. urn LIA REVISION WTI CITY OF CLEARWATER, FLORIDA ENGINEERING DEPARTMENT loo s. Myrtle Ave. Clearwater, FI 33758 PCL BB 63640TON rn LEGEND ABBREVIATIONS AND NOTES R... 410 GRATING CONCRETE IN 5EC5ON GROUND SURFACE DEMOIJ5ON ""'"""re "OSS wn. MON[ M"'" "N/A mr0/A a+a 3[17002 .e.. 6001 2008 eFnM[-OD.eMe '' 4-4 Orr OkOOda Urn 04/1. MECCAS BAR SCRFENS RAW 5 WAGE H 1 RECORD DRAWING P...e o E.e.:: wro... I accurate In all ...o.«a SALMI.. PAWL INC. R«.Rpc Iv. R, a' BA Af R�NTEPUNP Sr• ON AG III VA EV SLUDGE (RAS) (METER IJ TWASTE AC S. 5.." ." L RECYCLE (IR) r v TRATE aECRCU1( - ME IFR AERATION ANSSE 4NOxIC TANKS 5 ANOXIC OXIC RCAERATION )r AERA'�ON rANRS-� TANKS TANKS AERtiTIDN i00 000 F- 00 00. L PRESS ATE WATER RECYCLE 70 D OE RL TANKS RO- W LIEN PRESS SLUDGE DEWATERING • 0 O 0_r -` DISPOSAL or ocwATEaEo SLUDGE RECORD DRAWINGS NaNISO I— ,-ED CSS NOW vs. StD • REVISION CITY OF CLEARWATER, FLORIDA ENGINEERING DEPARTMENT 100 S. Myrtle Ave. Clearwater, Fl 337561300 01.1 ott NAIET-700 teTENA ENOMRS CARLTON SEa0ETTE P.E. 0, 63640 EXISTING PROCESS FLOW DIAGRAM N.a.. tiN "*".-Das o1-0`0 w.. NONE ewa.m..N/A ""4/* en 6811002 K. NONE APRIL 3008 1111O0A-00A0w0 P -O • Yb 0' 1 Z i < If) Z ,r 8 . 8 E (I) w w o rx a_ — o 0 z z 1--= Y - w u") o_ g BENCHMARK 417 THESE CONTRACT DRAMINGS ARE BASED ON 100 1908 RECORD PRIMARY ORA0NGSMMICH 91018E0 AN ESAABUSHED BENCHMARK ON THE TANKS OF 13.4 FEET. BENCHMARK ESTABUSNED BY THE BASE SURVEYOR AT IRIS SAME LOCATION IS SHOWN AS 12.18 NA ET BASED ON THE NORTH AMERICAN DET RR DATUM OF 1900 ( VD 00). TIE CONTRACTOR SHALL NOTE THE ORERENCE IN ELEVADONS BETWEEN nw Ina NECESSARY AAND DJUBTENTS. THE S ESTABUSMED BENCHMARK AND MAKE INE FOR ENLARGED PLA SEE SHEET M-18 S FOR ENLARGED PLAN SEE SHEET M-4 FOR ENLARGED PLAN SEE SHEET 0-7 T E NCt Bw a;Nc 4 t FOR SOURCED PLAN SEE SHEET M-9 s,„fs - i, N, -,N,..„, ttti-..,( t -N., , .,N'Nx,.--, N ,--,, •- .. -.._ r---..0. \ \ , I \ \,,A� �� t�2,,,-))1 7----_,_.._aaaaaa GOESTER t UEWA D SENA SLUDGE TENON Rr GENERAL NOTE INSURANCE MAP, DATED MAANCE WITH NE Y 117, L 2�EMERGENCY 100 -YR ROOD ELEVATION Y (FEND) RIFLOOD NE FACILITY IS ELEVATION 10 FEET. RECORD DRAWINGS YAW. ST Mai N IED .w.N 1255 men B • REVISION CITY OF CLEARWATER, FLORIDA ENGINEERING DEPARTMENT 100 S. Myrtle Ave. Clearwater, Fl 33756 ISM AK WIT f-100 WO. itte.001 33000 CARLTON SER., P.E. 5 63840 ISI SURGED RAN BEE OCT 10_2 EXISTING SITE PLAN JJC i aria, ♦ Low a RAS SLUDGE FLOW L RECORD DRAWING otoo. Nowmo to too NON. En gn.x "a. MALCOLM RRMIE. INC D.H.0/4160 a✓ ''''""11/A N/A o n 4017002 APRIL 2000 NiNN-MI.aA • • • • • RECORD DRAWING pr.. contract boo, Piet owe =V7.7A to Os *Dram ono room* in co tr•Derta PALOCOI RaNa. INC. SPLIT FLEXILE COLIPUNO (fl5) e00 1 1 SECTION SCALE: 1/e - qi7 SECTION SCALE: I/4* WATCH LINE. FOR CONTINUATICN SEE SHEET W-15 OWER $,ROODIA( DO _J PPE SUPPORT (TOY) STA 30' INIERLADITIPLELOW (LOCATAZI‘Z1,44;;4) (5) 54 FLANGED SPOOL PIECE SPLIT FLEXIBLE COUPUNC (POE) PPE FABRICATED JORNICIT TEE W/ 10. ONE OUTLET CONNECT TO IC/ AW er sew' FLEXIBLE COUPLING (RE) 30. RIX BEND RESTRAINED FUSSER EXPANSION JONT SITE PLAN SCALE. T/e - r -o^ RECORD DRAWINGS WPM 1.44 awe. a C55 REVISION CITY OF CLEARWATER, FLORIDA ENGINEERING DEPARTMENT (OS S. Myrtle Ave, Clearwater, Fl 33756 CORIDOCAll or AUTMONIZAION T"Inorbtr 110011973 Cattlurrret OW D. Wm noL OWE 1 -tor 11••••., (LOMA Moe CARLTON SERRETIT P.E. P 63640 mouse Ie. AIR OEMIELISTI .12. SW PT./TEAM MOW EL - 4.00 42.. SECTION SCALE: NONE 40. DO I FltDrOCD 0.00* 0*30"0U0010 );T 0!Ftr .5.1000fit .;DOI READ44.00ti nnOrtSI DEMOLITION PLAN SCALE: 1/e - 1•-o* DISCHARGE HEADER PLANS AND SECTIONS KEY PLAN Ea.MMME4 SCALE: 1/A* 1. -0 - :0 "css 4". 5517002 =2= pr. a.m. woo. (4. MELLO, # .7}1 PA It CLOSED CLOSED "TOL 3UILDING CONTROL 3VILGNG INSTALL ABOVE GRADE BLOWER PIPING JW'TNpI BVa DING RELOCATED BLOWN NO. S •� ME MOTES) +• n �• ,r - _ ._ - _ CLOSED T I f • CLOSED �, ,; Fo aLovhR a. AI 1 f • lagi 31 "11111 --/: c. oc.r -0 3Lowe- - - i TEMP / a LL rid, .4,' .MOW MAW N . nR ppad . . TEMPORARYT.AD BUUOI_AD / K L_ GENERAL NOTES t. FW CONSTRUCTION CONSTRAINTS, REFER TO SECPGN 01143 FABRICATE SOX30' TEE NIM 10' 4GE WIET. INT .• INTAKE DIM U.L ABOVE GRADE 30' AR HEADER PIPE iii ,_ .°e v • NOTES V LEOFTC WW O ip oati A. +wy[ oPwr. u.+[ w+NP*-y ` NOGREETNC WRING 1ENPORARY SXUi[IOMNSOA L \ 1EMPWART BULKNEAO W B MIL PWYEMnEXE nmDtt w p.. av°= / NOTES. t INSTALL NEW BLOWER NOS. 2 AND 3 wIM ASSOLATEO PIPING AND APPURTENANCES. 2 INSTALL NEW OVERREAD DISWARCE LO OWEREFEED PgRE. -, i' 1. REMOVE EXISTING EQUIPMENTTO LOCATED IN AREA OF iTMN. BLOWER. y ]o s BLOWER EI. A . S. RECALIBRATE BLOWER FEEDER FREABLR - — - - • • AND DISC AR TVA BLOWER N 1O 1FMPWARV LOCAIGN. CLOSE INTARE ARD DISCHARGE WAVES 2 INSTALL TEMPORARY PPNO AND AWURTENANCES ANO CONNECT TEMPERA/TY B OWER TO EASIxO 20 -INCH DISCHARGE PPE. 3. POWER AND CGNTRCL CONWCT BACK TO ME JUNCTION C 2. WMARG EPSING BLOWER INRSK2, PAD$ AND DISCHARGE PPINC AGE BLOWERS 2 ARO ], J. REMOVE AND SALVAGE BLOWER i2. t NANO 9AF OVERLOADS FW BLOWER AND SOU° STATE {,PROVIDE WRING FOR BLOWER NOS. 2 AND 3 FROM NEW MOTOR TO ME E%15150 SOFT START. BREWER. AND NEW BLOWER _ 1 0 AND PROVIDE TEMPORARY POWER AND CONTROLS TO ME BOXESE RELOCATED BLOWER #3. SEE WAMNOS E-2 AND 0-3. 4. RE -ALIGN. STARTUP AND TEST TEMPORARY BLOWER. S. FABRICATE TEMPORARY BUUTHEAD. RLAERAPON TANKS - - REAERATION TANKS •' CON1RCL PANEL. SEE DRAWNGS E-2 AND __ SB. INTAKE SHALL BE NAFCO MODEL 21240-1300 W EQUAL = STAGE 1 YLIERAPON TANKS 't STAGE 2 T00000IIOC TANKS �' STAGE 3 rrOASED REMOVE AND ASP a ]) SALVAGE BLOWER n ON AOL R IRNO EXST v CCLosfD (rP OI 3) CON TROL B ILmluc ST CLOSED ttosf o a) cGNI O. BUILDING ..... • ° b • � --� • f ,/o • I gl_ ° e 7t 1 r �RetocArcp D uw:.i No. 3 / L r • WO III y o PLO R e , w.111 410 / �F � rROLotnTEc IN L a ,ow- J • • M. eor dinM /'1Ll1L/l Kiiii/1 • _ II• I- n' W ap� ELpLL C l"x 7 ° I, BIy II¢ kW fr.. SEE NOR S, /40 • / —IE"A � `--. RECORD DRAWING PPM the Tills drawl, Wen. NTAt s•VUCTAT. NOTES: 1. 501T111DOWl AND INSTALL FABRICATED 2. CLOSE 2A' VALVES W EXISTING CUT IN PREFABRICATED 30'.30' IFF DISCHARGE VAES FW BLOWER NW. WITH 10' SLOE OUTLET 2 AND 3 XE -AVON START UP AND TEST NEW BLOWER NOS 2 AND J NTANS STRUCTURE NOTES �� AFTER • ACCEPTANCE A T RIRINA G ANpWAR�OWA X0.51 WTI ASSOCIATED BLOAfl No I 2. %RUNTDOAN AND CONNECT BLOWER N0. 1 °PION w+M Pin sant,- GTO NEW PPNC XEAOER J NTH TEMPORARY BLOWER IN SERVICE. REMOVE TEMPORARY BULKHEAD -.r STRI:CILlY •tnr /� ANOx 9NApE pP[ N11011x °+°'x9150 m • ° .elanP+'mK"nve°'oa(�)% �M.)a En e. ea« not .o-r°m Inu e°.InR nu+e. MALCOAT RRNIE INC. I LO 01 $I 6I TNI. e. A UPON SUCCESSFUL START UP AND >D' 13 TESTING OF BLOWER NOS. 2 AND 3• + REMOVE AND SALVAGE BLOWER F. BLOWER FEEDER BREAKER AND / �.--JO° SFv A SOLID i x�'+ {�__.� � / SWD STATE OVERLOADS FOR TEMPORARY BLOWER AND RECAUBRAIE INN CONNECT TO /-SC" y 1, iFR--; NOTES' x ' . L REMOVE AND SALVAGE TEMPORARY BLOWER. _._ 5. UPON SUCCESSFUL STMT UP AND r ., p' RFV TESTING OF BLOWER NOS. 2 AND 3, " _ OEMWSN EASING RING AND PNRTWANCES ASSOCIATED WITH EASING BLOWER NO. T. l ` C' ) S PROVIDE POSER AND @C WRING FROM NEW BONER NO 1 MOTOR TO EASING JUNCTION BOX AND NEW BLOWER CONTROL PANEL SEE - • DRAWINGS E-2 AND E-3, of y 2. REMOVE ALL 1E4PWARY RANG. J. REMOVE TEMPORARY INTAKE STRUCTURE. A. CEMAND REMAINING EASING PIPING IN - CON1RW — INKS T E •ON TANKS B. RE -ALIGN, STARTUP AND TEST BLOWER n STEP. SWT AND CAP SETS AT WALL. SEE AL RATION TAWS I STRUCTURAL SHEETS FOR DETAILS. RLL EXISTING BURIED 02' PIPE NTH SAND PRIOR TO CAPPING. ON ANKs STAGE 4 ELN TANKS STAGE 5 - STAGE 6 RECORD DRAWINGS '�' CITY OF CLEARWATER. FLORIDA ENGINEERING DEPARTMENT TDO S. Myrtle Ave. l Clearwater. Fl 33756 •�����yy �� �•�y'• f TAWA OLSEN ANN CARLTGN SFRRETTE PE. IP B3B%o PROCESS AIR BLOWER CONSTRUCTION STAGING DIAGRAM M"" " JJC NW'R"I - V °"'� 0 CSS a q -0003 -OT "w" I.W" 11 A W.NW."N/A ""'OWN/A 5111002 "" "�A "°""1001 YI-BWLEWS "-' °15 0 0 01 0 55 BnO °O"PYO� on p.m .wUWEE2A ABNW .W REVISION P WW err P.M ••2DA ea. rt. B RPP MW • • • • • • REMOVE M. AN PIPING SEE ENLARGED PLAN c.014.11.1IS SHEET FOR PROPOSED WORM REMO.! r MP LEOS CF 6 (TANKS MELRam ran ON V PIPING /i�77Tf1. l`//{{// DEMOUSN TO EXIST. Ir AIR PIPING CHIT CF TANKS AND 2) %//Air// FI / i P W/#1/ 137 CORD DRAWINGS I" " IED DEMOLITION PLAN 1416 ~ n CNN REVIS1ON SEE ENLARGED UPPER PLAN ON THIS SHEET FOR PROPOSED WORN REMOVE DIFFUSER SYSTEM TIP. TANKS 1-3 N.>oE.R "wE tr AIR C E. I.f.o SEE ENLARGED LOWR PLAN ON SHEET M-5 FOR PROPOSED MRN CITY OF CLEARWATER, FLORIDA ENGINEERING DEPARTMENT 100 S. Myrtle Ave. Clearwater. F) 33756 SPUN FLEXIBLE nxn COUPLING (FXF) Ir PROCESS MR BELOW RAIJSWAV L -L - -- 13RW ------ ... — PE NATISER VV.) - 0' PROCESS OR BELOW WALNWAV 4— _ (B) PIPE HANGER (TIP.) SPOT FLEXIBLE COUPLING (MT) ENLARGED UPPER PLAN 0 SCALE 1/4.' I' -O• OM U �w ENLARGED PLAN 2 0 2 SCALE /2" CMLTOM smart P.E. R 63440 ��MMRECORD DRAWING K em E• woin.e1.3.1 contra «dem not •M. be oseq,a0 PRO °CPU MALCOLM PINIE, NC. O. SVClw AERATION TANKS 1-3 UPPER PLAN 10' WV 714-1-7 KEY PLAN IV 2006 Da o"CRS .x.". N/A MiTN1-SN 3 -UT sa 661)002 Ore DapPla 10•01111. p poly Pi • Urn UN w 1,o• Ma= MANIFOLD 10 OOP LEG eomectleN (TN.)- - ENLARGED LOWER PLAN Leasit IC 3 L RECORD DRAWING NACOUI PNOeE. MC. 6p1. Spiel l0 •� KEY PLAN RECORD ORA [NOS IED CSS PROACI 60.006 CITY OF CLEARWATER, FIARIDA ENGINEERING DEPARTMENT 100 S. Myrtle Ave. Clearwater, FI 33756 PO 01 1.01190666 6 0_01006 33005 P.Eon SERRETTE .! 63600 AERATION TANKS 1-3 LOWER PLAN w.a1C N/A ° css 07 -00003 -UT APRIL 2003 Dal PLID2 6017001-000. NAM • REVISION • • • • • 'tfi" 4R C EL 2' H1U OO E�14,00 '—+" HEADC:1 P, P SUPPORT BRACOET r E_. '5.00 RAIL C MALCOLM PIRML MC. NOTES: I. AFTER REMOVAL OF EXIST. PIPE SUPPORTA CONTRACTOR SHALL REPAIR EXIS¶NO TANK R. SURFACE IN ACCORDANCE WTO THE CONTRACT DOCUMENTS PAYMENT SMALL SE IN ACCORDANCE NMI SECTION 01271. SECTION SCALE: 3/8" - 1'-0" SCALE: /8" . 1.-H" Aft HANGER RECORD DRAWINGS LED .. Nn CSS S0 re waiiP REVISION CITY OF CLEARWATER, FLORIDA ENGINEERING DEPARTMENT 100 S. Myrtle Ave. Clearwater, FI 33758 !moi CARLTON SEM, P.E. R S3040 AERATION TANKS 1-3 SECTIONS nIV wRe nN/A Ni uz 2004 CSS m e N/A MITN2-201. 017 -0003 -UT 5417002 MIMS 1.1 1417,1 RECORD DRAWING 1114 drokwino roMels "men from mho MALCOLM PIRRE. NC. OMellb\La „c JOG Fma W N/A IV 'N/A CSS A 581700 W. N/A 008 MINTON 507.0.40 —t8' C EL. 122 REMOVE AIR DIFFUSER GRID TYPICAL FOR TANKSD4 AND 5 - ti rrrrrr'/// rt �/4--//4/2, 1// //f It'I SEL:-CON*ANF^ h: iv GAT_ Eh CUT AND REMOVE 10.AIR'RIPNGAS NECESSARY TO INSTALL FLOW METER IMO VS ASSEMBLY 4GOORONATE YRIN LINE TAPPSEE 41EET G -A DEMOLITION PLAN 1E1 RFD. TE --TMP NO' E -er JW C EL Y.SO eI0CV GNANNE, Aft w SEE UPPER PUN OR LOWER PLAN ON THIS SHEET FOR PROPOSED WORK UPPER PLAN ( SCALE tie' MR HEADER (TMP.) (BY DIFFUSER MANUFACTURER) RECORD DRAWINGS LED ...NA IT OW a To MOM/ olisaft Orr REVISION - -B- -8-- - - -$ -8- C LOWER PLAN 2 0 e CITY OF CLEARWATER, FLORIDA ENGINEERING DEPARTMENT 100 S. Myrtle Ave. Clearwater, Fl 33756 -B- $-- klAihr F N SESERRATE.E.E. 5. 5: 63610 k STARS LOE- i_.—� KEY PLAN AERATION TANKS 4 AND 5 UPPER AND LOWER PLANS On P.M IdgaVa • • • • • • 30 . --0•4107;571///e4 1*.$--- C.• !4.0 ,.,_.....,=i==.4 -9 1 I , 1 :: I ! -.1•—r 72' , 1 ',...! =1. TO.RIN DEMOLISH EMISIING 6- VALVE V OVP NI.W2E;Ac0.-- r-sc Cr,) Trt- JR0,6L IRE NOR IN" W.WtCdN 8' MOTORIZED REV Eaning.41=P.al SECTION SCALE: 1/4" 1* -0* 2 0 011,13,[11 Oe 0 RECORD DRAWING L onstruct. and norm pr•por. NT IN lUC from .larnallon pc.. to 6npinee• to be complete and accurate In oll nePeCte. MALCCUI FIRNIE INC. NOTES: 1. CONTRACTOR SHALL COORDINATE TIN NE DIFFUSER MANUFACTURER TO DETERMINE WE EXTENT OF PIPE ODACtIllON. 2. AFTER REMOVAL OF EXISTING PIPE SUPPORTS. CONTRACTOR SMALL REPAIR EXISTING TANK FLOOR SURFACES IN ACCORDANCE VAN NE CONTRACT DOCUMENTS PATTAENT SMALL BE IN ACCORDANCE VAN SECTION 01271. 3. FOR CONNECTION TO EXISTING PIPE CONTRACTOR SHALL DINER OSLO A FLANGE OR FIGXPE WOO. PIECE TO NE EXISTING PIPE ON STEER SIDE OF THE MANSION JOINT. (SI REPAIR DOSING GRAM° X,._PW4.0Y2.0r-/WOW '4",40109144004/-/~// SECTION SCALE: I/N" 2 0 8 SCALE 1/4" SECTION SCALE: 1/4' = 1-0" 19251!TMI RECORD DRAWINGS 1=1:11•11111111=21011•11 CITY OF CLEARWATER, FLORIDA ENGINEERING DEPARTMENT 100 S. Myrtle Ave. Clearwater, Fl 33756 fl COMO. OF Avnamturox No. 07 NOEPEP9Orr MO IL PH MG OM F-100 TAY, M1OFIVA MOO CARLTON IERRETIE P.E. S R3640 AERATION TANKS 4 AND 5 SECTIONS Viiii1E111111..1111111110112111Mit4X1IRIIII IFSM1111111201relliiNI!IMI n/A on POMP iamb, .33.11 Oen DEMOUSH AIR DIFFUSER GRID TYPICAL FOR AERATION TANKS 6-13 (SEE sEcnoNs FOR PIPE SIZES) _ I ORE -.40.0 I i TANKS -.••ffl1flLFF0b b ° ' p. 1000 ! OtC,LLE 0.* 10o CF 00011.14 soeji — a4-LlIT AND axv5 HI /7 ev) t,0 I 1 ; I 1 LT - 1 -1 ; ? / ; / - „. • • / / ;,----- _ - -_---.• / / 'gee --,_ j TAW, No. ,0 '400 No. 6 ,I. h! )1, J 1_ [ 'II ir I. - ----, 7--"1 r ir I I ; I ; ; 1 HL 4 , 115j461 ? 4., pc I TOP or 00005 I I 'FA:Di:P(70'2 17.3, 41500 ' I *NM 11164,44 ; w -1, '1017T SINR5 AU S CON: 5,05_1; CUT AND REMOVE 10- MR PIPING AS NECESSARY TO INSTALL FLOW METER AND VALVE ASSEMBLY (TOP. FOR TANKS 6-13) COORDINATE NM USE TAPPING, SEE SHEET 0-4 DEMOLITION PLAN BO EL. 650 I 0004 ILOCK C.A. EL 210C 000.1 0 0,01 0000001 00010.0 IOEIL 0/i 6 C E. 450 RECORD DRAWING drawing reNcm changes from ter,:nn'iniZnta:71.:,",=7: ;7.747' e, tn. c.w.o.. oom•oc;o,c/.....;.q.) to IN compNt• and occixoN . cor MALCOLM RIME. INC. altbka 602- KEY PLAN RECORD DRAWINGS aww. css,T REVISION CITY OF CLEARWATER, FLORIDA ENGINEERING DEPARTMENT GOD S. Myrtle Ave, Clearwater, Fl 33756 =MGM Cr 0.01.0201,30 00. 07 W09101017 PPARCSIIPT. LWONGEWL MOWS • CM0YLTANTS IWO L Mt WIT r-190 IWAPA. nava 30005 CARLON SERRETTE P.C.63640 AERATION TANKS 6 THROUGH 13 DEMOLITION PLAN "Iv "e°`°"css tP I3gr200 1111;02 -WO DWG 0*4000 W -B • • • • • • N. SI ,..71..17787C1N VID.DCD ON tEr CAR 1OPWLWDoS OPE-INOST TANKS I hi - v744- 7:NKS-10- 8,37 4' AR HEADCR In?. TANKS 6-43) / 6' DROP LEG MP OP TANKS 6-13) (Tsi. roa TANKS 0.-0 91 _77-1 •1111 J )11' 11 TASK No 8 TANK No 7 ° — — ) ORCP LEG (11.1. OF TANKS 6-13) MANIFOLD (rD,.) I \ f. sCr.OF TANKS 311 1 I ,S&O( 8411 (1 IN EA ,ANK.rs- P31 11k, aitk. ra: 10. Uir i I 4 11:o ,11.0 788 — OF (LA.. 0411 CONC S'=‘, UPPER AND LOWER PLAN RECORD DRAWINGS LED Ns.. K7 055 WS_ REVISION CITY OF CLEARWATER. FLORIDA ENGINEERING DEPARTMENT 100 S. Myrtle Ave. Clearwater, Fl 33758 42131111.11.7 Ar1143102•TION 0161.10411NT M.10100131.0. 31,11N1V010 • 110.00.11.TONTS 1300 VII A. VAR r-100 11.000133.06 ',a:L.00 IF 11/ CARLTON SERRETTE P.E. 63610 = = 01, 10 -- _ twatees_151E7r,L= .3 :a e• ,,EATE;EN ON TANK *ANN: L ir OS C F. A SO AERATION TANKS 6 THROUGH 13 UPPER AND LOWER PLAN KEY PLAN IV 'N/A 747.1.2006 CSS *":47401-310.0MG 07 -0003 -UT 5817002 I eT 67 COORDINATE MTH HOT TAPPING SUBCONTRACTOR FOR CONSTRUCT. SEE SHEET 0-4 ffeW EE NOTE 2 DEMOLISH AR 0RUSER GRD (TIP. SERMON TANKS 6-13) F) 10' COUPLING 10' EFS ST. MOTORIZED INV 0'61.006 ME106 07,100, I 016-67017 061E SECTION SCALE: 1/4' • 1'-0" SCALE: 1/4" - Y-0' (5) SPOT FLEXIBLE COUPUNG (F0E) ST X t REDUCER /4"4094'. REPAIR (1001100 GRATSD E." RED. -6 EL P11E YANO f/D�((/ilP/y) > SECTION SCALE: 1/4' • 1'-0' Irk 252ei SCALE: 3/4" - 1'-0' SECTION SCALE: 1/4' • 1'-0' PRY SUPPORT (TTP.) (67 DIFFUSER MANUFACTuRER) 13117 3' ODNC. WALKWAY 3" GRAZING 2 SCALE: 1/4' - I'-0• 10" X 6" RED. CROSS o 6 EL. 14.17 e'X t' REDUCER (TM.) SECTION SCALE: 1/4" - 1'-0" RECORD DRAWINGS • CSS 0/ o DOOM REVISIO CITY OF CLEARWATER, FLORIDA ENGINEERING DEPARTMENT 100 S. Myrtle Ave. Clearwater, Fl 33756 N0 67 NM E. CON AVE WE i-100 ROWS 13.105 CARLTON SERRETTE P.E. i 53640 • • ,--EL. 13.00 SPLIT FLEXIBLE COUPUNO (FXExtt➢.) - 4" PROCESS AIR MANIFOLD (ELEVATION BY DIFFUSER UFACTURER) U 2 0 e SCALEI® PIPE SUPPORT (M.) (LOCATION AND SPACING BY DIFFUSER MANUFACIORER) RECORD DRAWING L a•.;TE. MALCOM PNTNIE, INC. IAM 8h4(, NOTE: 1. CONTRACTOR MALI COCRDINATE 0410 THE DIFFUSER MANUFACTURER TO DETERNNE THE EXTENT OF RPE DEMOUT0N. 2. AFTER REMOVAL OF EXISTING PIPE SUPPORTS, CONTRACTOR 500*, REPAIR EMS4NG TANK 7LWR SURFACE IN OOCUMENIS. PA4ENT S10 NAON111 6E TRACIN ACCORDANCE MUT SECDCN 01271. 10" 5 550. CROSS iC D <. . 2,7 / — AERATION TANKS 6 THROUGH 13 SECTIONS SPLIT FLEXIBLE COUPLING (FXE0TYP.) PRDCE55 MR MANIFOLD (4544*110N BY DIFFUSER FACTURER) 2 0 19511 SCALE, I/O' • 1'-0" JJC WINO H/A •P•. N/A 055 41/6 !617002 1006176 0600.0 NW. P. r_ I SIM OM • • • • KNOW AR ORPYSEIE GRID (TTP. CP 4) LO oo IX .. AEIA CON -ANA 3 ,,, /, / / / / / '''/' / / / / RC - 7 i. ':I ! RE -AERATION TANK N0. a 0 OW �eATae wALA DEMOLITION PLAN IMO 0 L AT AIR MEADER (TAP. ALL RE -AERATION TANKS) (SPACING AND LOCATES BY pWNSER MANUA'ACTURER) PPS SUPPORT (VW) (ST 01PPUYR MANUFACTURER) I- -e UPPER PLAN e SCALE: I/e• - 1.-0I�/21. 1.-0• • PROCESS IR MANIFOLD L LOWER PLAN a 0 e SCALE, Ip• - 1.-0. -aA*,L w•_ RECORD DRAWING 11. dm./ r41,404 enanpso Ina pre..4 to ma ' •Ork.d1.R,.ina MALCOLM MRNIC, INC. AI,Slav( A ,oz NOTES. 1. EXACT DIMENSION TO BE DETERMINED IN ME FlFLD. RECORD DRAWINGS w. n LED ... N INS mar wow mworte REVISION 0111 CITY OF CLEARWATER. FLORIDA ENGINEERING DEPARTMENT 100 S. Myrtle Ave. Clearwater, Fl 33755 K. 47 IN4070‘011 13CO3 011.1 AW. WIT F -1C0 ROCA SAN CARLTON EE'RETTE P.E. P: 63640 RE—AERATION TANKS UPPER AND LOWER PLANS ww LaO Nae" "IV """""CSS 0) -0003 -UT wn. x/A w,m "N/A Na m N/A e.o- Se11oo3 .PN. N/A i moa lar4oa-au.0.0 j 1. WALL QeS E'L..5 a -- ' ta.83- TYPE OAR/TB PIPE 3 11 BNACKET 5 EL. -2.5 SCALE: 3/8• - I.-0• RECORD DRAWINGS LED Rav r ISS 8n0 none 11411 • REVISI CITY OF CLEARWATER, FLORIDA ENGINEERING DEPARTMENT 100 S. Myrtle Ave. Clearwater, Fl 33756 RECORD DRAWING mu Pa.. reheats nInneee nem the durine constniction and heft Nen Wenn. Wermollon he Ineer E by n,Luen w(.^le N .I. ntmaz by? xw MALCOLM PIRWE INC. On. 01I41[0 P �% NOTE: 1. TOP OF DIFFUSERS SHALL RE 0.81' ABOVE TANK BOTTOM, COORDINATE FINAL PLACEMENT WIN MANUFACTURER. 2. AFTER REMOVAL OF EKISTIG PIPE SUPPORTS CONTRACTOR SHALL REPAIR EXISTING TANK FLOOR IN ACCORDANCE WTI THE CONTRACT DOCUMENTS PAYMENT SHALL BE IN ACCORDANCE WTI sconce 01271. Eir EX K Mwnu*c IC ROM • CARLTON SERRETIE P.E. F: 83640 e• ea MEND (T1P.) MINCE PLATE PPE g Q ELEV. IC.BS SECTION SCALE 3/8• - 0 I SCALE: 3/9' 1'-0' irk COOR DINATE R CTOR FOTCONSTRUCRON T- SEE SHEET G-1. ___ LL.. I SECTION SCALE 5/8' - 1'-0• pr=� SCALE: 2/8' . 1'-0' RE -AERATION TANKS SECTIONSAAT T -J • EL.I1.75 A' AP WADER (TTP,) 3I0 sat NA wv N/A 00 LL_ , F'-- PPE SUPPORTS (TIP.) (BY DIFFUSER MANUFACTURER) IV APRIL •2X008 "css ePt'"`io 07 -0005 -UT w- M 5017002 • • • • F r ORATING SUPPORT DEMQI5H BLOWER OSCMARCE PIP1I0 UP TO E% 20' BFV (rn. OF 3) —Jn +71/ul5n. REAM NARA .__ A.,. TRANS,BOO. ([VIUNEI ELEC RE SEE NORE 2 VOGUIEETRIE REEDER T:r1CONTROL Tye •oL t I r�T EA„„ 5Evvx .F.. 0 ON, CONTROL GEN., LERNRA GAR P PuN ON MEET 11-47 LL2_2777275Tt z / 77.C.<j t Lunt zuT r2 trE / A nw.E s.roaAPAAP 11$1110 /////t2 ERrDMBBB MOWN Ir BLOREII MEAB7 PIGS (EV. OF 3) 44! 16 -0" (3, 6'-0" SLUTS d9j ♦ /PI ererjr A NSMl7..s' y� DEMDDE0 SLOW D BTS rQ UCANIN. EI'ZN OR RI, TERSE RECORD DRAWINGS 1.04TER RR ILED ._W cad nt0 REVISION A. 7<44)Bcw3K S NOTE 3 PI AM LAT FI FV 22.50 CITY OF CLEARWATER, FLORIDA ENGINEERING DEPARTMENT 10) S. Myrtle Ave. Clearwater. Fl 33756 0 litam NO. 111 SWEP•Oarr IWO J. AVL f -ICO CNILTON SERRETIE I.E. R 63640 CONTROL BUILDING DEMOLITION PLANS RECORD DRAW)NGL draeNe reflects enonen from de be eeregene end occur. MALCQM LARNE. IXC Owr i LV • f 9' NOTES FOR SEQUENCE OF DEMOLI70W. SEE SHEET M -D CWETRACTOR SHALL CLEAR AND PREPARE AREA FOR INSTALLATION CF TEMPORARY BLOWER. CVT AND CAP PIPING AT WALL. SEE STRUCTURAL SHEETS FOR DETAILS. FILL COSTING BURIED 42. PIPE MTX SAND PNOR TO CAPPING 2® SCALE'. 1/A" . 1'-0' ew e. 22C ERr rvIV emus "CSS - ueaa erN/A m w N/A •501 1002 •w. N/A AP II{rL EONS '741102-510340 M -Is RECORD DRAWINGLLI SEE NOTE 1 Z=1 PUITOTM CUT OUT, 20. AV W/ MANUAL OPERATOR FOR BURIED AROUND COLUMN SUPPORTCHANNEL L T P SERVICE OPERARNO NUT (TM.) W 00 M.UMINUW GRATING YUTFORM R rLAMAR c (TW. OF 2) Ir WASH e0' ODD (Tl. R 3) Ir SINE SO` OD (TAP. Of 3) h SEE OTE_I_ EEE NOTE _ la Ark IB' TEE SPOOL PIECE SEE ENLARGED PUN ON SHEET M-17 (S) (S) 1x.11' REDUONG PO' BEND (TM OF 3) RPE SUPPORT (TM.) 12'-r (4' EXPANSION JOINT TYP. a 3) MOTOR 7.) SLOWER MET (T9. Cr 2) BLOWIER (TP. OF 3) SLOWER OUTLET (TP. O 3) PLAN AT ELEV. 12.00 A) AS SSW SSSN)S000 B2 tttiff 7tt 201A ttlltt tit27$ANUtt3F27t 5111WARR ]IL AIR PIPE CHANNEL TEMPORARY BLOWER (EXACT LOCAPON TTM BE DETERMINED IN E MELD) Pr 71 LTJ 20 ,0" -T7u 2sTzzzrs E0'iCSdO 2) 20•X2.' 41n '', OMI11) SIIEORT (TWA) 24.21# REDUCERa` I iktW. Ir P WAS. DEE �WI MI No (*Ws* ... E, IDSL 5fAN NUA1(JH T� 20' RO SEND (T11.. Of 2) ]r RA AM45 (ROTATED AN DOWN) C`n PI AN AT FI FV 22.50 CONNECT TEMPORARY BLOWER PIPING IN VERPCAL PE SUPPORT 20' AR HEADER NOTES I. CONTRACTOR SHALL COVER EXISTING FLOOR OPENINGS. MATERIAL MID TYPE OF COMERS SHALL MATCH DHE COVER ON THE POSING AR PIPE CHANNEL. SCALE: I/O' 1•-0' 2.14;25:P;FEE;.-7:' nom Won.. proMea to tn. Emmm. MALCOLM PIRNNIIE, INC. m. R(1.41+ RECORD DRAWINGS • CITY OF CLEARWATER, FLORIDA ENGINEERING DEPARTMENT 100 S. Myrtle Ave. Clearwater, Fl 33758 CARITON SStC1E P.E. f OWN MDOTC 7, M. rAM F-100 • CONTROL BUILDING PLANS • L • • • RECORD DRAWING 000 MO* 0.0010 404 MALCOLAI PIRNIE. INC 111,. ppyto S i4. tan T �I fe %, EL 81,0 Ao� Viz iS,1 I,,#. 11-r7: „(•1 LOU, NG Z' f/ // ;I f s+`g % °a f. PIPE SLIM. (]EE NOTES GN 13011 MEET) ham= 20 MOTORIZED_ p B20 (TVP. a D �� C ¢. n.v� 20• X 1B• RED a 5. 24. AIR 18• RESTRAINED HEADER EXPANSION _.—. JOINT (TVP. OF 3) 20' 9O BEM BLOWER SUPPORT (FOR SUPPORT DETAILS SEE STRUCTURAL DRAMNGS) SECTION SCALE: 3/8” - 1'-0" 0 2 SCALE: 3/Er - 1'-0" PPE SUPPORT TYP OF 3 (FOR SUPPORT DETAILS SEE STRUCTURAL DRAMNGS) Ark Jr NOTES 1. FOR SEQUENCE DF DEMOUOOJ, SEE SHEET 9-3. 2. CUT AND CAP PIPING AT WALL. SEE STRUCTURAL SHEETS FOR DETAILS. RLL CANTOS BURIED 42• PIPE MTH SAND PRIOR TO CAPPING. J. AN ASBESTOS SURVEY OF THE EXISTING CONTROL BUILDING WAS PERFORMED BY THE OWNER AND IT HAS BEEN DETERMINED THAT THE CEILING AND SOME CASKETS ON THE PIPE FLANGES CONTAINS ASBESTOS CONTAINING MATERIALS. A LETTER REPORT DATED MARCH 14, 2008 AND A REPORT DATED AUGUST 30. 2006 ARE AVAILABLE FG TO $OR INSPECTION BY BIDDER'(S. ��� NOT AANT M PART FGNPEI THIS fWI040 ANT AS AVVNNIARIFVEYS AFORE FINFTWAA11M1 CP RPMFEtickS 0. ME OWNER RILL BE RESPONSIBLE FOR ALL ASBESTOS ABATEMENT AND AIR MONITORING. S. IMMEDIATELY AFTER NOTICE TO PROCEED. THE CONTRACTOR SMALL IDENTIFY ALL LOCATIONS WHERE EXISTING PIPE HANGERS MU. BE DEMOLISHED AND WHERE NEW PIPE HANGERS WILL BE INSTALLED AND COORONATE THESE LOCATORS WITH THE OPMER'S ENONEERING DEPARTMENT. B. PRIOR TO ABATEMENT OF ME GASKETS ON THE PIPE FLANGES, THE CONTRACTOR SHALL BE RESPONSIBLE FOR OSASSEIABUNG/UNBOCTNG THE PIPING AT THE FLANGES FOR ACCESS AT THE OYMER TO PERFORM ALL ABATEMENT WORK. T. NO DEMOLITION AND INSTALLATION OF PIPE HANGERS SHALL OCCUR PRIOR TO ANY ABATEMENT WOK BY 111E OWNER. .1r 9r SEM 20. 9r RM PIPE SU�ORT r (T0P.XSEE NOTES ON TMS SHEET 2C 00' BEND. PIPEHANGER —F 3000 TEE L 0 24•A1e" REDUCER (4,40:=0 �� \174 - TEE 1 /,� O30"A2♦' ECC, 1D N REDUCER -- MPH JOINT II B0.— ■■ (TVP. CE J) E�. CF I-IaM 7I, 20" 90' BEND 3r W 1[MD 20' N Tr RED (TP. OF 3) BLOM MET (TVP. OF 3) PIPE SUPPORT-,� (FINED) -SE uPP6e3 20' 9P BEM ,r TEE 20" ere MOM PACE 18'At♦' REDUCING 90 BEND (TVP. OF 3) HiAIN (Tm (S) OF 3) it RESTRAINED RUBBER EIVAMSION JOINT (TPP.) 18" BFV (TVP. CF 3) SECTION 0 SCALE: 3/8" - 1.-O" 0 2 BLOWER OUTLET QP 013) 18 CHECK VALOE (TNP. OF 3) 19" 90' BEND DM -9.0♦ (TM. OF 8) PE SUPPORT (010.) RECORD DRAWINGS IED 4041444.. CSS Bn0 mart, 0/(0401 Orr 100•rmi 0004 11, .0404 Pt PM REVISION CITY OF CLEARWATER, FLORIDA ENGINEERING DEPARTMENT l00 S. Myrtle Ave. Clearwater, F) 33758 CARLTON SERRETTE WE. N 63640 4104 MOO.. RONDA mom CONTROL BUILDING SECTIONS JJC N/A MONO RR 0309.9. IV n W m N/A n2009 mcN/A wiTws-s1e. 07 -0003 -UT v X81)002 orl PPM 0000. WAR PA. Ylig SLOPE 2-224OU PLATE 2-7xe w/ 1/T PL SLORE �LLEu� DEMOLISH IS" INLET PIPING SFE SHEET 14-14 FOR CONTINUATION (TTP OF 3) 0#1. - .iC: M 8A96 PO2 ROTC TO C, IN PI 24' ...,M AK 1'187 MUFF Sllov* DEMOLITION PLAN SCALE: 1/4" - 1'-0" _O2_2.4.06 7 0 SCALE: I/4- TO OR+' WELL SECTION SCALE: 1/4" - 1.-0" m (TP) TYPICAL WELDED SADDLE DETAILS NOT TO SCALE RUSH 18 GOA. STEEL DOOR AND !RAMS O' • 6 718 THRESH., AN. 17,7,18/8 _LICK 9 ▪ �., VA.CH tC'ACEM1 NDOOR DEMOLISH INLET FILIER/SLENCER DEMOLISH tr INLET PIPING SEE SHEET M-14 FOR CONTINUATION (TYP OF 3) ODYOLISN ANGLE IRON SUPPORTS —MELD 7•K3/.E' ANGLE•VIC P t0 MOUNT DJCT VJE "URE TO FLOOR MTN 3/9" 1191p1E9 (2) EA LEC AS SHOWN (3) PLACES PROPOSED PLAN SCALE: I/4" - r-0" SECTION SCALE: 1/4" - r-0" I© TYPICAL FIXED SADDLE SECTION SCALE: NOT TO SCALE 0 WELDED SADDLE SCHEDULE FOR AIR PIPING ON FIXED SADDLES SUPPORT TYPICAL DIMENSION SADDLE BOLT PIPE DIA. A B L DE - HOLE DIA. 10• r r 3/r I/O" 34 14 3/4• 1r 1'-B• r -r 3/0" 1/9• S• 1• 3/A• 74• 1'-B• 1'-r 3/r 1/24 B I/O" 1• 3/4" 30• Y-10. r-11• 3/B• I/O" B 1/7• 1 3/4" 1 In' PIPE SUPPORT LOAD CALCULATIONS SUPPORT 3.3 LAD FRICTION FORCE (NIPS) UNBALANCED FORCE (NIPS) REMARKS 51 850 0.21 - S7 1350 0.34 - S3 2000 0.50 - PI 7400- 0.70 N 500 E UNBALANCED FORCES ACT AT EL 17.52 54 7300 056 - - SB 3000 0.73 - SB 1300 0.33 - 12 1900_ 0.70 N 11.3E S7 3050 0.98 - (TIP.) L RECORD DRAWING -upTet a A>«I. MALCOLM PUNIC INC. - NOTES 1 ANL SUOING PIPE SUPPORTS FOR AIR PIPING LESS MAN 15 -INCHES IN DIAMETER SHALL BE DESIGNED FOR A DEAD LOAD Of 1.100 LBS AND A FRICTION FORCE OF 0.78 RIPS. 2. ALL MED PIPE SUPPORTS FOR AIR PIPING LESS DNAN 1B -INCHES IN DIAMETER SHALL BE DESIGNED POR AN IMBALANCED FORCE CF 2.0 KIPS RECORD DRAWINGS MITNNO OT PrrN LED N-oN CSS B/10 Nat REVISION CITY OF CLEARWATER, FLORIDA ENGINEERING DEPARTMENT 100 S. Myrtle Ave. Clearwater. Fl 33756 fYYK 67 IMOD,UN, RONDA 33805 CARLTON SE TE P.E. 1• 63640 • • DETAILS -DC - NIV *.'""CSS - • N/A 4v 'N/A m o.N/A r e 5617007 ....a N/A A"7". 61152-317.0W0 Nm M -ti • • • (Fa') h'—DOUELE AIR 0,,SER OECNAJAANA 00N !ASK K' S -400 90, TANA S -A CO !ANK 070,0...1A0ON #1 E r-7 LHA44 4A.4.4 AIR REO W/4' Pr //Fey/ / Wrilff#1047,0VIN RoT I TANK 11 I 1 '44444.44,A44,44,444444444.444 4 A.4. A4A444 A.4 Affeed9791C1.7 El. 10 00 CO 400 BOTT TANK j • rppyppvvr ppvvppppfl, DEMOUSN DIFFUSER 000$ DEMOUSN DIFFUSER GRIDS 2 0 SCALE -4r, PLATE - 8- 8,8 I 1' TEE DO BOOST TANK PLAN DEMCURN DIFFUSER MS SECTION Seate SCALE: 1/e . NOTES: 1. AFTER REMOVAL OF DOMING PIPE SUPPORTS, CONTRACTOR SHALL REPAIR EXISTING TANK FLOOR IN ACCORDANCE PITH 110E CONTRACT DOCUMENTS. KEY PLAN CORD DRAWINGS . LED CSS • REVISION CITY OF CLEARWATER, FLORIDA ENGINEERING DEPARTMENT 100 S. Myrtle Ave. Clearwater, Fl 33756 INV 30111730. 3.5 00,,3113110130.t1101. 1300 Lt. 31.1133"0"-10 13.1*. MAIM .00 CARLTON SERRETTE PC 4 63640 DO BOOST TANKS DEMOLITION PLAN AND SECTION "N/A N/A "APRIL'2008 l*Tairooz-sre,o 07-0AS-UT " 511,002 o-oraw 010100. 0.140110 PA I 1311.1 11111 B07 '>I / V. E. 0 0 —B' AR EL 10.00 S VAN DECHLORINA.7..r \; •1E. -0'— —$ -7 --r--rCEcmoo- --� —a— r SECTION SCALE: r/{- • 7'-0" RECORD DRAWING 4' AIR NEMER (TW.) 4' 1POCESS AIR un OLO (rn.) S -A 00 S ji fOr El 0 00 e TEES - }- 1 -TOP OF GP nnNG EL :1.00 SCREW ::F. PLNPS DO BOOST TANK PLAN < 0 6 FieSMTI SCALE: 1H" - V-0' DROP lEG (Tw.I PIPE SUPPORT (TTP.) (SY DIFFUSER MANUFACTURER) L KEY PLAN RECORD DRAWINGS MAIRAIR MISR VAMP Rno On POOP ARM • VALK 3$721 OAR REVISION OAR CITY OF CLEARWATER, FLORIDA ENGINEERING DEPARTMENT 100 S. myrtle Ave. Clearwater, Fl 33758 CARLTON SERRETTE P.E. F: 63640 DO BOOST TANKS PLAN AND SECTION ^..^ 44D €me^Iv P.eo^Dss r NM N/A "jNR ]DOE ST001-414.540 N-lB • s • • • • I 0B. µ 'L ARCM e Tw LDC BU BLI SAG CANTL aCOL V. COW NST cin CN GET ow OElri GW r. EA E EJ. r.B. F.F. iTU GBV QiG 11GT IHaRz N.R STRUCTURAL ABBREVIATIONS gTRUCTURAL SNAPS CON C01�UETE MASONRY UNIT COLCOMPRESSBE CONCRETEQU CONNECT CENTEt DETAILDEPTH DIACONAL RECORD DRAWING WaWS° X1 1 := .?,1 :: Wo- M 1X• lo ,,mq�timN occvml W d MALCOM PIRNIL INC. Cn INV IN9GE CE iEB INVWi JT JOINT K.0 MOCK WT L PE (S1NUCIRAL SHAPE) P0.0 u LOC/81°01fLOC P. OW PONT LONG WAr Y WIM NAH�UF CTURE, MANUFACTURER AS MAX 1EP INN o -G o.D. o.F. OCRPPMO P.C.O. ir. vt LION VERT xP ws w/ law TOP AND BOTTON TCP OF CONCRETE TIHI4K CF TREAD TYPICAL UNLESS OTHERWISE NOTED VERTICAL NOEH; FLANGE STRUCTURAL SHAPE. ST WOWING POINT wATERSTOP WELDED WIRE FABRIC GENERAL NOTES FOUNDATION F-1. ALLOWABLE SOL BEARING PRESSURE: AS INDICATED ON GRATINGS. F-2. CONCRETE GENERAL NOTES APPLY TO FOUNDATION. F-3. INSTALL ADEQUATE SHEETING. BRACING A SHORING FOR EXCAVATOR PROTECTION OF ADJACENTSTRUCTURES. c-1 CCN TTEE CO STRENGTH 400D PS AT Ni DAYS WEIGHT: 145 PO. C-2 BAR REINFORCEMENT: ASTM 0515. GRADE 60 C-3 MESH REINFORCEMENT: AST1 A105 AND A82 0-4 DETAILS WORKMANSHIP, AND GENERAL PROCEDURE: 00 310. AC 315, AD 3P, UNLESS OTHERWISE N01ED. C-5 1. THE MINRNM LENGTH OF LAPS FOR 3044055 SHALL BE AS GAN I III! TABLE R DRAWINGS �B• LAPS. PROVIDE CLASS .A' LAPS YMENE 2. REFER TO SECTOR 12.24.3 OF AO 316 CODE FOR ADDITIONAL LAP SPLICING REQUIRED FOR EPDXY COATED REINFORCEMENT. C-6 CONSTRUCTION EOII0n0NSO100011ce C�In010. HS1CI05 TS. C_7 ALL DBIENSONS INDICATED (•) TO BE DETERMINED BY EQUIPMENT FURNISHED. F6 STRUCTURE I5 DESIGNED FOR EQUIPMENT LOADS AS SHOWN GN THE DRAWINGS. VERIFY EQUIPMENT DIMENSIONS AND LOADS AND CONTACT ENGINEER IF ACTUAL LOADS ARE GREATER NNAN SHOWN. C -I) CONCRETE COVER FOR RENFOR0NG SHALL BE: A. SURFACES WHICH ARE IN Y MIN. CONTACT NTH LIQUIDS B. FOOTING A SLAB ON OROND S C. SLAB SURFACES W/WATERSTOP AT WALL JOINT 0. FORMED SURFACES EXPOSED TO WEATHFA OR M CONTACT MTM SGL E. FORMED SURFACES NOT EXPOSED TO FEATHER OR IN CONTACT NTH I 1/1' MIN. SOL OR LIQU10. S1RUCTURAL STEEL S -I GENERAL REQUIREMENTS: AMSC SPECIFICATIONS FOR STRUCTURAL STEEL BUILDINGS. ISBN AND LATEST SUPPLEMENTS. 5.2 MATERIAL: ASTI 436. S-3 CONNECTIONS: SEE SPEDFICATONS 5-4 PANTING: SEE SPECIfCATONS DO NOT PAINT SURFACES TO BE IN CONTACT WITH FIELD PLACED CONCRETE. DO NOT PAINT TOP FLANGES TO WHICH METAL DECK OR PERMANENT SLAB FORM 'AWL BE WIELDED. S-5 ALL 011019055 INDICATED (') TO BE DETERMINED BY EQUIPMENT FURNISHED. OL 5-6 BTS: ASTM A 325 REINFORCING LAP SPLICE & EMBEDMENT LENGTH iim•i•'mPTJz,:••L3l•:.Lu' I• ••=e •,Th ir.31 El -n-i.�t•51`: L!T�lL.L:..LL /.Si 1�"'N� =11E•!. tREM IBA - iii>t•lffi SLABS & WALLS VAN Y + COVER f.--.--Ja-Eaffla_. __FaffIO •.:ailaiEaORM=IM EMIMUM •a •: aa'a—F__FafrafFisiFaomn• f:aiEai:aisitl•M FEaaSafQ7 •11aii II fF:ii:afa• fJaa'aa—F7IiI� fF7fiFafO f3•aLa6f IIMMILafFEaUfFA :. SLABS & WALLS WIN < Y COVER ' ilf•Mil= —L__LafF.__I =IMAMa or fila—La—Laifai is_i __1a IMMIMMI r E__.am_l__ filMIlika _.__._ Tai7f0•11:WfQa WZIIII MIMMUMMR,aaja fa;ailai:•iia BEAMS & COLUMNS VAN 3.75" CLEAR SPACING IMT1IIIMMENIRSIMIDNIMS1MMLINIMIMMICFMGMM faMMMLIIMMESIIIIIIMFMMIMM=IIMIMIlikIMWRIRM IMIMIIIMMONIRMIRI f7Eii1•aa EE•fA�iTai6laEl•7 f' 7X3 iia!!afFiaf/F•iia f:at :iiL1•i: ailaiii=T• fill /•Fa•ZililafFTaitai'•aMMEr•iEa I.iaEitEsi?ailaiiai{.f iL1 • FPI BAR OEM FAO° LDS MAH 3.75•, ADD ARD FOR PAR CHEM SPACING LESS MAN 2X6•• ADD HMR STANDARD NOON STRAIGHT BAR EMBEDMENT LENGTH EMBEDMENT LEN R1 WITH STANDARD WPM INN 661MIIW B, •ASE 140 RECORD DRAWINGS .«n IED REVISIO CITY OF CLEARWATER, FLORIDA ENGINEERING DEPARTMENT 100 S. Myrtle Ave. Clearwater, FI 33756 JUSTIN 000 DEG P.E. 6'. 4 25 GENERAL NOTES, ABBREVIATIONS AND DETAILS MH 1'•S0' xxa 1 • RO APER BW6 /A N1ECM-a5 " WI' 6e1F00a r PLAN AT ELEV 10 00 SCI;E:t/4'-1'-O SEE MARGO PANT PVN THIS SHEET POR M. BLAV9R SUPPORT PLAID 1 FRIED SUPPORT III m Fir El <2?)5( t<? -77 2 DETNL 2E ENST. MOTORAIL EL la00 r7>St. t<t1>S0n DST U7>S0Ca C<7 PLAN AT ELEV. 26.00 00011111 ATE LOCATION OP STEEL BEAMS A5 REVD TO SUPPOR X SA .y 3'-V 1Y 9 1/4'• 9 i/4'. 4i4%4 MB 1,2_I s 6 IIII 1 8 -1 -EV 0 1 11 a Isa a Jr L 1 I 16 -El2 FM ARCED PART PI AN AT Fl EV. 11.00 SCALE: 1/2'-1'-0' NOTES I. ASTERISK (•) DENOTES BEAM LOCATOR TO BE COORDINATED SUCH THAT THE BOLT HOES FOR THE BLOSER SKID AUCH TRIO THE GAGE OF THE BENZ. 13..1/4 CROSS-BRA000 RECORD DRAWING LL ho. been VW. `o. . to Enpineer iLi.lin KKm�in/:." :4 MN.AL" 4woo.lin al MALCOLM PIRNIE. INC. o.l. NIAI f• 9r Aun DETAIL : 2 SCALE:l 1/Y.1. -V fE CORC%IST. BEAM DETAIL 5 : SCALE:1 1/2'.1.-0' DETAIL SCALE:1 1/2' -r -O' ©© 1. &YA 14103 1/2.]/5.5 1/T LOON W/ 2-3/4'P A325 -N BOLTS SCALE: 1/2' - 1'-0' 2 0 2 SCALE: 1/2' - I' -V SCALE. 1 1/2- RECORD DRAWINGS PIMP REVISION CITY OF CLEARWATER, FLORIDA ENGINEERING DEPARTMENT 100 S. Myrtle Ave. Clearwater, Fl 33756 JUS N MINADEO P E i 44928 CONTROL BUILDING PLANS & DETAILS JCM "N/A CM WNW N/A 391721 .APRIL -0005 MiMM- • • • • • • T/CAP t 10')119.X1/2../ 4-,/C. SCATS DETAIL SCALE:I 1/2'-1'-0' Jr; s ] DETAIL I2, SCALE:1 1/2'-1'-0' SECTION t].s ORDS$ -B1/4 RAG GUSSET t GROUT vv NIS 4%M1/4 BASE PLATE DETAIL DETAIL MSS MMP/4 3/O STEEL BASE t w/ 4-1/4". DALV. THREADED RODS EASED e' kV/EPDXY Ag1ESW SCALE I 1/2'-1'-O' To, 10100.113/4' Sitio SASE It T/COP t 1O'03'10/2' w/ 4-1/4". BOLTS 4-3/4". GALV. TREADED ROOS 00IE4�WINTO SLer AB AT xT 0.. B.1T DETAIL I4, SCALE:I 1/2'-1'-0' TSP MSS MMI/4 x DETAIL IS, SCALE:1 1/2'-1'-0' 0 21I OD HIS (TV.) MSS MM1/4 (re.) 1}311I/4 DROss- BRAMIO (TSP 7,Y8 BETOND (7,) 1-1414111"sti°14s/i I Se Rn SECTION ©v 0/8'-1,-0' SECTION vv RECORD DRAWINGS Icow w IED wineten .1.1 roan Imoret INOltetkaPAL 0.1.1,z. • War Da REVISION CITY OF CLEARWATER, FLORIDA ENGINEERING DEPARTMENT 100 S. Myrtle Ave. Clearwater, Fl 33758 TWA.. FLORIDA 13006 JUSTIN NADEO P Et: 44928 CONTROL BUILDING SECTIONS AND DETAILS RECORD DRAWING a.°�W�vh..M-ASM a= to M MALCOLM ORNIE, INC. WM 4(0111. .. JAM 024 SCALE: 3/B' - P' -C' 2 O SCALE I/Y' - 1'-0- M1.r n rs ®Sm "you ° "JCM O1-000 ar. MLA uNa0N/A swn N/A uw. SB17002 .m. N/A MRiL1005 BBIYOYOOB-2w. PIPE SUPPORT F2/S6 SCALE: 3/8'1'-O' NOTE: 1. UNLESS OTHERWISE 50150 W1 128121 F02 - 502165 HSS 12 - 1211113/8 SECTION 3/8' -l' -O' JLN50S/8 6/2-3/4' ASS 1 . BOATS (TTP) I' BASE E DETAIL SCALE: 3/4'.1'-O' TTY 1/4 1/4 GUSSET E 4-1'0 ANCHOR BOLTS W/12' EMBED. 121311/4 14.1/2/2 AROIIID 1/90/4 CAP E A41h]/8 W/2 -S/4' 1/2' SIIEFENER O BOLTS (TTP) DETAIL $2. SCALE: 3/4'.l'-0' SS 12 NOTE: PIPE NOT SHOWN FOR CLARITY. PLAN SCALE:, 1/2' - C-0' RECORD DRAWING Pam fowwa°Inform..Hm.. amoi :)ia. MALCOLM PNWE. RIC. pay B)NIY N-4121-- TYPICAL r 4121 TYPICAL DETAIL AT PIPE SADDLE CONNECTION TO BEAM NOTES: 1. SES 'M' OWOS. FOR LOCATION DF PIPE SUPPORTS 2. SEE "Al. DSOS FOR SADDLE DETAILS. SECTION SCALE:3/4' - 1'-D. BASE PLATE DETAIL SCALE: 1 1/2' - 1'-0' PIPE SUPPORT Si, S2 & S3 0 ARIES STIFFENEER WEIR ro CIA 5$ B W/1/4 CONWNU !ss FILLET NOLO CM) H55 81B13/8 NOTE: PIPE NOT SHOWN FOR CLARITY. PLAN SCALE:1 1/21 - ,'-0' OF PP as PIPE1111 0121$ lbw NIM+irMYlrw I HSS 81813/8 I' BASE E SEE DETAIL A SEE 'M' OWLS. FOR PIPE .4 SADDLE DETAILS 4-1'OA. ST SR. ANCHOR BOLTS W/ DOUBLE NUTS 1' NON -SHRINK GROUT &00 /8012' .WT ilii,; n;: //. /i. / . // BASE PLATE DETAIL SCALE: , 1/2' • Y-0' PIPE SUPPORT S4, S5 & S7 NOTE 1- SEE 'M DUGS. FOR LOCADON OF FIPE SUPPORTS. RECORD DRAWINGS 11.6.2 Iw.n IED .,eon JN 5/10 • REVISION CITY OF CLEARWATER. FLORIDA ENGINEERING DEPARTMENT 100 S. Myrtle Ave. Clearwater, Fl 33756 IOW CPRIPFZAZ trATino FLORPS1 13605 JUSTIN MIN ADEO P.E. A. 44938 PIPE SUPPORT DETAILS SHEET 1 L S. COMPACTED CRUSHED STONE (TM) o 2 SCALE: 3/e' - 1'-0' SCALE: 3/4' - t'-0' 1 0 1 SCALE: 1 1/2' - 1.-0' .ur"SS °`".'"uma•"""JCY/SY 0) -0003 -UT or. ,' . 50' ''.'o'N/A .ASN/A A ". $817002 we • 80 MML 1008 BSiIOOC-BOO.on • '' S-4 mew. DM • • • • • vv EBOTOB CCMC. a. NOTE: PIPE SUPPORT Fl SCALE: 3/8•-8-0• UNLESS OTHERWISE NOTED W12 . 812.65 HSS 8 - 0.83/6 HSI 4 - 46405/e 1' BASE t HSS 1 1 EL. 7.00 TYPICAL SLIDING PIPE SUPPORT AT AERATION TANKS 1-3 SCALE A A A SECTION 3/8•-1'-0• VD AIL 1/4 GUSSET t HSS 4 BEYOND L33'1/4 HSS 6 (M) CONNECTION (TIP) 1. BASE t (TTP) r NON-9HMNX GROUT (TYP) SECTION 3/e' -r -D' vv DETAIL 61, SCALE: 3/4•.1,-0• DETAIL B E 5 SCALE: 3/4'.8-O• DETAIL SCALE: 3/4•-1'-0• f , :0113„1/0261/4 CAP t AROUSE 055 6%4X3/B BASE t W/ 3/4' ADNESNE ANCHOR W/6 s/r EMBED. MELD ANGLE TO BASE t ALL AROUND C 5 T/r .i L.. PLAN 1.1.351/A SECTION TYPICAL FIXED PIPE SUPPORT AT AERATION TANKS 1-3 NOTES: 1. PIPE SADDLE NOT SHOW FON CLARITY. 2. SEE 'M• OWLS FOR LOCATOR OF SUPPORTS TYPICAL SLIDING PIPE SUPPORT AT RE—AERATION TANKS B1 TON alt T CRT 1' NON-SHRINN *0000 SULEW: (BOERE READ.) ROUGHEN a CLEAN EXIST. SURFACE. COAT W/EPDXY BONDING COMPOUND. 1/4• NEOPRENE ON ALL PIPE SUPPORTS L_ 4' (MAX.) FOR ELECTR. e' (MIN.) FOR OTHERS 116 AT It AROUND PAD CLLEAN MA GROUT S DRILLED DIE TMREAOEO BOT, SZE e LENGTH BY EWA. WPPUER TYPICAL EQUIPMENT SUPPORT PAD DETAIL ON EXISTING CONCRETE NOT TO SCALE FOR AU. EOUIPMETIT SUPPORT PADS E ROE AAW PPE DIA. VARIES ON PUN 6 VARIES 3-p MI OO ES TES AT Ir (MK 2) A AT It IT 2• CL. (TSP.) EL SEE H ROUGHEN A CLEAN EAST. DRILLED MOLES, CLEAN SURFACE. COAT W/LPDXY A CROUT W/ EPDXY BONDING COMPOUND NOTE: 1. SUPPORT TO BE It MICE UNLESS OTHERWISE NOTED. TYPICAL PIPE SUPPORT ON EXISTING FLOOR DETAIL NOT TO SCALE i ANCHgI BASE ELBOW CR BASE TEE BOLTS 2.11 UU TON CONCRETE mem SECTION i1 LUSOT. 105:0111 -Ygll1 .�. ba ELEVATION CONCRETE PEDESTAL DETAIL Petr TES RECORD DRAWING « ,°'.:,D Aa PIED Nm�nemRI�tiona,.W. ; .. 10 Ond occureN In 611 MALCOW NAME, INC. DOOR !114(1. 4ASS RECORD DRAWINGS OO IPP-« LID mom y 5/10 REVISION CITY OF CLEARWATER, FLORIDA ENGINEERING DEPARTMENT 100 S. Myrtle Ave. C1eerwMter, Fl 33758 C.117.117 .1710167.01 67 111.1.101117 1.1, MOM maw STN 04020MINADO E. A 44826 PIPE SUPPORT DETAILS SHEET 2 R• m20 RO.m'LGM SM sm. JCM M ""t". • 50. •m"o/A RR..a M/A an,•• 6617002 -m. 1' • 50' m 1.11.-tommo "` I-6 DIAGRAMS GENERAL NOTES ABBREVIATIONS 480V, ° v O GENERATOR 30, 4W (325 KW) NORMAL AUTOMATIC TRANSFER SWITCH -ATS NORMALLY OP.RELAY CONTACT - DES...IGE0T1F ES PURPOSE Cr CONTACT GENERATOR WITH VOLTAGE, PRASE, NUMBER OF WIRES AND KILOWATTS OUTPUT �� WOAD CONDUCTOR - 410V, Jw, 4W WrE A LM.l! TRANSFORMER- SZE ANO CONFIGURATION TWO MA TRANSFORMER 1. (YYYI AS NOTO ON NE CRANKS /+r 1. ALL ELECTRICAL ENCLOSURES IN BLOWER BUILDING. RATED AS NEV0 4X.AERATION AND VIOH BASIN AREA . ALL BE 2. CONTRACTOR SHALL UTIOZE AS MUCH EASING CONDUIT AS BEFORE FOR POWER AND SIGNAL CONDUCTOR BEFORE INSTALLING NEW CONDUIT. 3. CONTRACTOR SHALL INSTALL DENCENET CABLE DROPLEGS IN SUCH A WAY THAT THE MAXIMUM DISTANCE FROM TRUNK TAP TO INSTRUMENT IS 20 FEET OR LESS. 4. CONTRACTOR SHALL REPLACE EAST FIBERGLASS RDNFORCED CONDUIT SUPPORTS WITH ALUMINUMET CONDUIT SUPPORTS. CONTRACTOR SHALL ROUTE CONDUIT IN SUCH A AT THAT WALKWAYS AND EQUIPMENT ADE ACCESSIBLE, AND RED A AMPERES A/C CONDITIONING AUR &meoOIR WRR.T NEC ABOVE FIN1.EO WNORETE PEG ABOVE FINISHED DUDE NTS AUTO TRANSFER SNITCH BA CONTREOLGpµ0. EICP BLD BUNKER BLDG DNG COR .0 CONDUIT OR CONTROL CONDUIT CLAT 0-TPxEi ENCEN004001 PANEL OP ELECTRICAL PANEL EN ELECTRICAL DUCTBANE EMI ELECTRICAL MWWOLE ENT ELECTRICAL MANXOE PAT ELECTRICAL EMETALUC EP EIPLOSPRO MOI- TANG CONDUITUIUZNNG PAR FULL VOLTAGE. OF VOLTAGE XON -REVERSING GOT CROMD FAULT CURRENT TRANSMITTERSIZE GE GROUND FAULT NTERRUPIOR X/A HAND/WTO HOA HAND/OFF/AUTO HER HEATER (MT INTERRUPTING CURRENT NINTERMEDIATE METAL GALVANIZED .UNCI. BOX FOR POWER CABLES ...ACTON BOX FOR STANDARD INSTRUMENT CASES RAC 1NOUSWO AMPERE INTERRUPTING CAPACITY (SYMMETRICAL) KVA KILOVOLT AMPERES LE 10NA1fi LA LEVEL LA UGRAN° ARRESTOR LCP LOCAL CONTROL PANEL LS LEVEL SNI. T GHT LTG LIGHTING A MILIMAIPERE MOP MASTER BLOWER PANEL MCC MOTOR CONTROL CENTER MLO MAIN LUGS GILT Nis WICK TRANSFER SNITCH MW OTOxZur MOTOR CROATCTOR 0 VALVE PANEL ME NOT APPLICABLE C NORMALLY CLOSED NEC NI SOMBER ELECTRIC CODE B o�.� .EN NOTCA TO SCALE OPEN/CLOSE/AUTO SW/01 OL OVERLOAD RELAY PO POWER CONDUIT RANBUTTOI PULLS. Pt. PANEL PS PRESSURE SAT. Pi Po1FNIAL TRANSFORMER PVC PpLYNXYT .LONDE REC REWMIMENDAn. REGEP RECEPTACLE REO REWIRED :NIR REDUCED VOLTAGE N. -REVERSING SEC SECONDARY SILL SELECTOR SPEC SPARESPSPECIFICATION 511 STAINLESS STEEL 555 SNILNUOSS 0 5WRD Sdi START SYSTEw SWTGR PATCHGEAR T IMP TB TERMTEMPERATUREINAL BOX F. pENCErvET TEMP RMIN TERM TEMPERATUREERWXAL TS ITAASETUSMI. TOSS TRANSIT VOLTAGE SURGE SUPPRESSOR rMN MACK SHIELDED PER UNOND UNDERGROUND VOLTS VAC VOLTS ALTERNATING CURRENT MO YTD TION WATVIBRTS FREQUENCY DRIVE wjO NOWT MI NP RAAEOPM TWO TRANSFORMEROO SINGLE MASE 3W THRREEE WE AW FOUR CURE AUTWATC TRANSFER SWITDI IN NEMA ENCLOSURE ❑J JUHLAW BOX FOR POWER WIRING; AS REWIRED BY N.E.C. WHEN EASING CONDUIT ROUTES AS NEEDED WHEN FASTING CONDUIT ROUTES. S. Ott W IS RESPSIBLE F RELOCATION AND RECONNECTION OF OSSOUVFD OXYGEN ANALYZERS. R CONTRACTOR SHALL BE RESPONSIBLE FOR TYING SYS -3 414 A O ® JUNCTION BOX FOR STANDARD CIXITROL WINING DEVICES SIZE AS REAMED BYIC N.E.L. SOFT STARTER - TOP: STARTER IDENTIFICATION BOTTOM: ® TERMINAL BOX FOR STANDARD TWISTED LL LOAD AMPS PAIR DEVICES. SIZE AS REQUIRED BY NE.C. EMOTORIZED VALVE O PULL BOX. SIZED AS REARED BY NEC. ELECTRIC MOTOR (NUMBER INDICATES HORSEPOWER).U ABOVE GROUND CONDUIT IN DISSOLVED OXYGEN SIGNAL TO NEW BLOWER CONTROL PANEL O ---- S TEMPERATURE SNITCH (TSR DENOTES TEMPERATURE SWATCH MGN BELOW GROUND CONDUIT MID TA DENOTES TEMPERATURE SNIT. 101Y) — — — — EXISTING BELOW GROUND CONDUIT OALLYELECTRICAL. NBR.VI. SNITCH (K INDICATESVIBRATIONELEIMENT) EXISTING ABOVE GROUND CONDUITTNN DETAILS TO. E SPACE HEATER RADIUS, TY? L7-1/2*P/e PPPPPP ATT O UNI FIELD INSTRUMENT, TOP. TYPE CF INSTRUMENT BOTTOM: NUMERIC i1_ T 1/2', TYP NEW EXISTING DESIGNATION 1. f-1 3/16' DIAMETER, TYPICAL CURRENT TRANSFORMER 1 11 (TRWE NOR) 1/2' RADIUS, TIP ELAN. LiOLi STEEL PLATE 1/L'X7 1/I'XB' PLATESTEEL MOUNTIW\ROUNC PLATE VI\ROUND EDGES p / 3p (SIP 51211) /71 3 POLE THERMAL-MACNETC MOLGED CASE CIRCUIT BREAKER , U M' 'i I' �I 3/16' I 4 STEEL CHANNEL ® TRANSIENT VOLTAGE SURGE SUPPRESS. 1 FLOOR OR PLATFORM • -��. F 3/TB', 1' NDN -SHRINK GROUT -3 E- POTENTIAL IRSOMHR —0= -- FVSE .', a+v ... 1/2' ADHESIVE ANCHORS (TYPICAL OF 4) RECORD DRAWING EL VATIOpN EQUIPMENT MOUNTING PEDESTAL ® A EE Own,l Nis e^V.,oo.Hquim m.. non one here _ prepared omen. onoHnf. NNR wl .a°,`.ARN.Mh.+r..I.I MALCOLM. IM.tt,V• 44A13---- N.T.S. NOTES: 1. USE WASHERS AND SPLIT LOCK -WASHERS UNDER ALL NUTS. RECORD DRAWINGS , CITY OF CLEARWATER, FLORIDA • ENGINEERING DEPARTMENTevenoteee IOD S. Myrtle Ave. Clearwater, Fl 33756 iAKPARet.WIT F-100 AUBREY HAUOMWOIT .E. s WMt ELECTRICAL LEGEND ABBREVIATION NOTES & DETAILS r r "wEH w "WEN aeaM.. AAH �MiRCt , .....P" I.u«W LLD NTS "MORE W. "xoNE aA Senaox R,W.NI" AIH ewTo ._. NTS AIPMT 2008 7.1+:011-.ox.P. " _ ..ANI 6=4.,P. REVISION " >„ ° P.e,e.,.WWwa..,P.P e.R WaM.. • • • • • iMCOMiN,^, 4404 pBi TPviNA TJN C nF.. 4" w, e-6008CM_ AC 4800, 38. 419 woo A ,AAAJ PAD 210 TRANSFORMER�ryyyl RECORD DRAWING no Or Owl < to tn. InCrow �a MwM1<�N5dr IIA LOUj wN OAR art INC. CT'S ,NAd LT'i ENTRANCE (OLA 1SE, S OY (-5- oo D300110035 1 SWBO404 BLOWER 0 I 2UA 500 31.03.5 BLOWER NO. 1 92DA - STANDBY AMP, ARO2 ENEREENE. '1111 HI 1 5I P 12ONIICR,NG NKR NO SWBD NC. 3000 045. 005 --2000A, SR, 3W CORKER BLS, 65.000 AIC �. 1000 3P 0 \ 1000 SP b 8 3P p) 1.0 SPACE 1000 PI O 7 '000 3 900 0 REMOVE ALL CONDUCTORS BETWEEN SOT STMT. SWITCHBOARD I AND BLOWER COi1R0L PANEL AS SHOWN. sW130 NO. 1 CONNECTED LOAD . 500 - AMPS SwBO NO. 1 CONNECTED NVA - F48 NVA 4,090 3,0 2 120A - 120 ALPS 300 AMPS SOK, 10 2 CONNECTED LOA0 - 1020 AMPS TOTAL. CONNECTED LOAD - 1520 AMPS TO,. CONNECTED NSA - 139A .LVA RCP RCP 414 - n/ LEGEND TO BE DOMCUS= ,OWER 03/0 IC GROUND GRID 5 PTS -1 rrr • J eeov, 3o, 4 it (123 W 2--3'w/3-SSOACMIL W 101/0 CND. EP. 2012. 6X14. I'll'!! ER 300* GNO. 005 2-3' w/3-3500050. 5 101/0 COD EA. ---- 5-A' w, e-fi00NCvi, CPCH-\ 0WRD NO r --L12_55.1 ---} SP -1 2.2/001851-1' —wY —1.7;,7,11j 3� 3-13 20000. 3, 30 COPPER 505. 60.000 AIC,\ 2-3"w/3-3S01ECMIL. R 181/0 OND EA. 08 ply) MCC -1 3P OOc 22 ) !000 SPARE M30 _ 5.5-2 JW,, 2D r' / 1-3'wi3-S50,120 A 103/0 O40 CAEN— >I TNI,, 6,1A. a 1011 f o -I FFF�!✓✓✓ J/�/ L REMOVE ALL CONDUCTORS BETWEEN MOTOR, SOFT START,SMTCNBOARD 2 AND BLOWER CONTROL PANEL. NOTES, I. CIRCUIT BREAKER SHALL BE REMOVED FROM SWITCHBOARD 2 SECTION Ma AND REINSTALLED INTO SWITCHBOARD I SECTION FA. RECORD DRAWINGS CITY OF CLEARWATER, FLORIDA ENGINEERING DEPARTMENT 100 S. Myrtle Ave. Clearwater. Fl 33756 WYMAN N .N.le'TKTINIA. 'IMAM MBA AUBREY NAUDRICDURT P . E. 88081 ELECTRICAL DEMOLITION ONE LINE DIAGRAM Siwe. NONE Nw. NONE 'NG NCUM'0G iaBlNr' _ ae.10n C4b1nE. . RECORD DRAWING a p w P e>M M [wRe'w •.e xvaM n m '•� MALCIXL PIp 6E MC. lB 2000e. 4e0., 3 F40NS10RAC0 sW1RAT0, PROPOSED LOAD TABULATION DESCRIPTION flA ag (430 24( 5150.120-1 B LOWER NO. I 414A • 1B AMPS B LOWER N0. 3 • 414 .AMPS BLOWER N0. 2 (STANDBY) 4144 414 AMPS 5630 N0. 1 CONNECTED LOAD • 032 M- APS 59010 NO. 1 CONNECTED KVA • 774 KVA 300 AUR+ 300 AMPS 332AMES • 1023 Kv4 OV, , EXISTING PAP Mr„ RbANSFa 0 YE G, ER kr`-r1 G I'/ METER S98D N0. 1 SP -1 Ex'SPNG 2.2/041654,-:" 3 r—ENSTING 20004. 3e. 3W COPPER 9U5. 65,000 41„ 10 0 V 1000 2, . 300 20 02 0 ) BOD MR SEE NOTE 2 0-15C-0 C-1 549-3 41401 998-1 !414 A' MBP 0-930 LESION. N -r -w/2 awKCMe_ Sr, 1MJ/0 GND EACC MBP C -13A P-010 (SEE NOTE 5) C-030,0 - C-010,0 C-038,0 AT' C -016A P-03 P-03 BLOWER NO, 1 P� OA 0-130 EX/STING •BOY M. SWITC4RD 3000 GAD. 605 C-06 E0'STINC 43/0 10 GROUND 0,0 02 P-020 (SEE ROTE 5) C G2A,C C-023.0 • wi 4-6004CUI: EnC4-- \. SII®D NO Z S -I 0001,00 2.2/Cd1650-1' RON, 1*'SI.NO 20004. 34. SW COPPER BUS. 69,000 410 . / 600 SPACE C ) '000 SPARE 03151100 2-3" w/3-35000010 4 141/0 CND E2. NO. 2 (STANDBY) 101,00 2-S4/3-350KCML k 141/0 000 0, FXISIINL 0 (I r A10 4800 32. aw (345 W)) �- F%IS NG 2-3 w/3- 350KCM1. k 141/0 CND. EA ONE LINE DIAGRAM L NOTES, 1. CONTRACTOR SHALL TEMPORARILY RECONNECT BLOWERS AS WORN ON STAGING ORATING 1.1-3 k ELECTRICAL 0909000 E-6. CONTRACTOR SHALL PROVIDE ALL TEMPORARY CONDUIT AND WIRING AS REWIRED. COOR0NATE 10111 OPERATIONS STAFF FOR ANY ADDITIONAL REQUIREMENTS. 2 CONTRACTOR11MANUFACTURER OF 110E EM5TNGVI�S O EQUIPMENT (4090 ARE 0) TO PERFORM RECAUBRATI 00 SOFT STARTERS, MOTOR PROTECTION, AND FEEDER BREAKERS, ].CONTRACTOR SHALL PROVIDE NEN FEEDER AND RELOCATE 04141100 CIRCUIT BREAKER FRO4 SWITCHBOARD 2 TO SWITCHBOARD 1. CONTRACTOR SHALL PROADE ALL NECESSARY WORN TO PREPARE SPACE FOR BREAKER. 4. CW1RACTOR SHALL RECONNECT SOT START SYSTEM SYSTEM TO NEW BLOWER CONTROL PANEL. BREAKER, AND MOTOR. CONTRACTOR SHALL RESET OVERLOAD RELAY AND OTHER MOTOR PROTECTOR TO NEW TRIP SETTINGS MILE IN TIE PRESENCE OF SQUARE D REPRESENTATIVE. 5. USE EXISTING CONDUIT TO WEED NEW MOTOR LEADS AS NECESSARY • CITY OF CLEARWATER, FLORIDA ENGINEERING DEPARTMENT 100 S. Myrtle Ave. Clearwater. FI 33756 AUBREY HAUDIWCQURT P.E. k 98661 NO 97 INDEPENOENT PNINDNIPTAL POWER; 1300,L aZirt. WM F-11:0 • PROCESS AIR BLOWER SYSTEM ONE LINE DIAGRAM • • • • AERATION AERATION AERATION AERATION KW. AERATION AERATION TANK 00.1 TANK NO.4 TANK NOS TANK NOS TANK NO.1 TANK N0.2 TANK NO.3 ZONE A ZONE B ZONE A ZONE a AIR ROW NR ROW AH FLOW MR FLOW AIR FLOW MR ROW AIR FLOW CONTROL CONTROL CONTROL CONTROL CONTROL CONTROL C NTRCL VIIAALLVVIIE�p�Y VIIAA.ILLV�IIE�y VIAALYLV�fE�pp' VII(A�YLYK VpAALLpV�VI�E�y IpAALVLVVILE�Y VALVE DEVICENE DCABLENET MI yI ,IL yI ♦I yI VALVE `I pJV,V ROUND J%A1C ly y 1 ���---q���+111 W y4, 77W TERMINAL BOK •Ill .-t , t'I -,t-- iAP(TWN•CExET OEVICENEi I�J -�� � IJ LLLJJJ 1"T1MUIE ROUND I R1 CAIB/11EIC� CABLES RBER OPTIC 1'C I/O PANEL (0 -NET -I) 1220 Imo F,T, 420Ej e" 1 AERATION AERATION AERATION 00 AERATION AERATION AERATION AERATION AERATION AVIATION BL0WER BLOWER BLOWER BLOWER AH( NO.1 TANK N0.2 TANK 003 BOOSTER TANKS NO. TANKS NO. TANK 40.3 TANK TANK NO. TANK NO. O.t 014C11MGE DISCHARGE 20TM1 AIR FLOW ANI ROI MR FLOW 1*5 A -A 1-S 01590.V19 NO.1 4-5 4-5 MI.ET ROW PRESSURESTART01 MR FLOW ZONE A AIR ZONE a OXYGEN DISSOLVED ZONE A ZONE B CURRENT FLOW AIR FLOW OXYGEN OISSOLV„D ISS N°D (TW. OF J) (TYP. E 3) BLOWER NO.1 SMT START BLOREN N0.2 SOFT STMT BLOWER N0.3 SOFT START CI II . 0/I♦ 37.'t MASTER BLOWER CONTROL MK (MBP) �� LP -I. 3.4A• A 5 ARE EXISTINGND PANELS. P-05 CC, RICER - EXISTING ANALYZER SHALL BE REWIRED TO NEW I/O PANEL RECORD DRAWING Pdrawing reflects cflooges From We fwrnetwn we.. VMwr(.I NO.nwI.I Nicht. MALC0.04 PMIII INO 001. 3 ( 11 5 /{11(I�I.i C BTPS 3 1'C 3-30101115 10/4 20 J 1'C 110.1 0 3/Iy cAELE re "�\\3H c FO-FO-AeLCO y B FIBER OPTIC a CABLE 1'C 5 FIBER CABLE EXISTING 2' a CONWIT� BLOWER MOTOR NO.1 TEMP. VWYRATION ELEM01T5 (TYP. OF 3) SCORER NO.1 TEMP. VIBRATION ELEMENTS VAL1 CPE INLET VALVE VALVE POSITION GOO J/1'C 2WI1-O O -j SI C1P5 K [RORER COMM PANEL (SCP -1) AERATION AERATION AERATION AERATION RE -AERATION RE -AERATION RE -AERATION RE -AERATION TANKS N0. TANK NO. TANK N0. TANK NO. TANK NO.1 TANK 002 TANK NO.3 TANK 50.4 6-7 5-9 10-11 12-13 AIR FLOW AIR FLOW AIR ROW AR FLOW AIR FLOW AIR FLOW AIR ROW AIR FLOW CONTROL CONTROL CONTROL CONTROL 00NT50. CONTROL 03NTROL CONTROL VALVE VALVE VALVE VALVE VIIyALLVEE2p�5Vr VAAL1ppyyV�ILE��py VAALLVV�VE�y VI�ALLVVE�pSy IlypYpy�lf y 1yYp.A y r RCOMO TMH 1 p OPLM• THICK RaLMo I I I I TERMINAL BOX HM OEVICEOET TAP(IYP.) I/O PANEL (O -NET -2) 3/1'0`" AERATION AERATION AERATION AERATRHRE-AERATION RE -AERATION TANKS NO. TANKS NO. TANKS NO TANKS NO TANK TANN 5 -TI S -S 10-11 2-13 NO. 1 NO. 2 MR FLOW MR FLOW AN FLOW NR ROW ZONE A ZONE A AIR ROW MR ROW INTERCONNECT DIAGRAM -AERATION TNM NO. J ZONE A AIR FLOW AERATION TANK NO.4 ZONE A NR FLOW .1212Y /' -tau '^:,-'...1.10Y �20y Li lx_., AERATION RE -AERATION RE -AERATION IM -I RE -AERATION TOMNO.3 S TANK NO.1 TANK H0.2 THINN0.3 TANK x0.10.4 OXYGEN DISSOLVED DISSOLVED DISSOLVED DISSOLVED REDUCTION OXYGEN OKYCEN 011401 0X7004 POTENTIAL EWST1NG ANALYZER A /O PANELNEW RfO TO NOTE: 1. PRTW PROVIDE O 3P -60A BREAKERS FCRROA PANELS MVP -1, D MVP -2 EAK RECORD DRAWINGS Wwnel I,.-^ ED FAIR AIN t 0 Few, v•a911 REVISION CITY OF CLEARWATER. FLORIDA ENGINEERING DEPARTMENT 100 S. Myrtle Ave. Clearwater, Fl 33756 ea. W.INIZPOINI 1300_ •WI AVE. SUM I-100 TIONI, 3311100 AUBREY RAUDRICOURT0 KN MA0I0 "*50 04 CMN MM. Ma P.E. N 56161 AAW law q.P wn. NON[ g""N/A N/A 311IT002 MCC ONE LINE DIAGRAM & INTERCONNECT DIAGRAM NONE NP L RECORD DRAWING to a()/e:nMgq nw coal LIALGOLMRE. INC. 9Z \ FILTER s D \"/ GMPLEX N. CHEM /A N MAIN TEN ANDF BUILDING \ N N AN AEROBIC D CESTER ES" -ER EEffi CEL PRIMARY - TANKS T -77 -r II N 0', 1-1 GP �--ESR SNARGD NN O E-] I I 1NTROL I. _. - ='REBS _t SECOND A.N 05 C TANKS RCS ENLARGED PLAN SEE SHEET E-10 N F',:N t RECORD DRAWINGS Iw.. LED HAHN. AML 6A0 MOON REVISION • CITY OF CLEARWATER, FLORIDA ENGINEERING DEPARTMENT 100 S. Myrtle Ave. Clearwater. Fl 33756 TURRET NAUDRICOU P.E. 6 60161 maws • ELECTRICAL SITE PLAN WEN Orn nX/A APRIL 2006 ATX Wa+a N/A 6611502 041.1001 • • • • MASTER BLOWER CONTROL PANEL 011ICP2 P -OAA P -DIB V III LII SEE NOTE J CTCN ROD III III OA SEE NOTE 2 BM -1 o V -1 -TR EXISTING YSKVA TRANSFORMER 1,...0%151,NG PAN, .Ia �s sxns _i7M13iE JUNCTION BO POWER AND CONTROLS ]BIRf 1 P1B S C TO I -3 J/12 7�I'C 00 L➢- -20 B WER NO 2'.. B OX BELT VMOTORAL (TIP. Of 3) TEMPORARY LOCATOR OF EMSIMO KDAER. SEE NOTE 3 SEI 0 It N/O GROUND CABLE I, PER SPEC /Y SPAR E P_. - FOR REINFORCEMENT SEE TABLE BELOW DUCTBANK SECTION NOT TO SCALE L REINFORCEMENT TABLE DUCT BANK YE NESSOTER UNDER ROADWAY* AT NCR -TRAFFIC AREA T < Ie' SS • 12' (MIR) AU. AROUND M MY ALL AROUND T LIS' ST • 12' (NN) ALL AROUND SS MY ALL MOUND NOTE; I. DUCT BARN DIMENSION (1'-0' 1MNMUM) VARIES TO CLEAR UNDERGROUND SYSTEMS AND TO MAN AM SLOPE AS REWIRED. DUCTBANK DETAIL NOTES NOM I, CONTRACTOR SHALL EXTEND CASTING POWER CONDUITS TO GRADE OF NEW BLOWER PLATFORM. CONTRACTOR SHALL PROVIDE AND INSTALL NEW JUNCTION SHOES, CONDUCTORS, AND FLEXIBLE CONDUITS FOR THE BLOTTER MOTORS. 2. USE EXISTING CONDUITS UNDER FLOOR CONDUIT TO REPCED NEW BLOWER FEEDER CABLES. REFER TO SPECIFICATIONS FOR THE CLEANING AND REUSE CF CONDUITS. O. CONTRACTOR SHALL CONNECT NEW AND TEMPORARY BLOWER MOTOR FEEDER CABLES TO EOSTDO FEEDER CAKES LOCATED IN JUNCTION BOX. PROVIDE TERMINAL BLOCKS AS NECESSARY. I. CONTRACTOR SNKL REMOVE ABANDONED CONDUIT AS NECESSARY. CONTRACTOR SHALL TEMPORARILY RECONNECT SLOWER AS 510151 ON STAGING DRAPANG M -O. CONTRACTOR SNAIL PROVIDE ALL TEMPORARY CONDUIT ARA PARING FOR BOTH POWER AND CONTROL SONALS USE EXISTING CONVERTED MCC JUNCTION BOX IN BLOWER BUILDING TO CONNECT TEMPORARY FEWER CAKES. SUPPORT CABLES OVERHEAD OR PROVIDE STEEL CONDUIT PROTECTION IF ON GROUND AS NECESSARY TO KEEP OUT OF WOO AREA, REFER TO NOTES ON SHEET M-18 IF SUPPORTING OVERHEAD. CONFORM TO NEC REQUIREMENTS FOR TEMPORARY ELECTRICAL CONNECTIONS. COORDINATE PITH OPERATIONS STAFF FOR ANY ADDITIONAL REQUIREMENTS 0 I 12 SCALE: 3/18' I' -O" RECORD DRAWINGS LED Pinc•n n AM a r poppet REVISION CITY OF CLEARWATER, FLORIDA ENGINEERING DEPARTMENT 100 S. Myrtle Ave. Clearwater, Fl 33758 MD 07 0000001M7 1300.,A. AZ MG PAIS I-100 AUBREY HAUDWCOURT P.E. /: 6E861 ELECTRICAL Sc BLOWER BUILDING POWER PLAN HONE Kw NONE d "WEN AaWwI nNrA APRIL 2005 amour N d.N/A OP -0000{ -UT 11•17002-403.0Ne tl as 5817002 RECORD DRAWING „W�.MP , ,'qHW ta, iv0Hao. weel MALCOLLI HIE. INC. c(itt0 , 4 V SEE NOTE 3 ELECTRICAL & BLOWER BUILDING CONTROL PLAN 0 D•a- 12 SCALE: 3/15 V-0' DUCTBANK SECTION 0 NOT TO SCALE NOTE: 1. DUCT BANK DIMENSION (-0' IMAM) VARIES TO CLEAR 01HER uNDER0R0UND SYSTEMS ANO TO MAINTAIN SLOPE AS REWIRED. NOTES: CONTRACTOR SHALL REMOVE UNUSED CONDUIT TO EXISTING BLOWER. CONTRACTOR 301 CHOSE TO REUSE 00151N0 CONDUIT IF CLEANED AND PREPARED PER SPECIFICATIONS. 2 NEW FIBER PATCH PANEL LOCATED ON UPPER LEVEL ABOVE BLOWER N0. 2 IN CONTROL ROW'S COMMUNICATION CABINET. 3. CONTRACTOR SINAL COORDINATE 1HE REMOVAL Of SOFT START SIGNALS AND CONTROL FROM En5TIN0 BLOWER CONTROL PANEL TO NEW MASTER BLOWER PANEL (MBP). COORDINATE RATHSTAGING EWIREMENTS Of SHEET 3-3. L RECORD DRAWINGS Ww.n LEO MOASI P.M REVISION CITY OF CLEARWATER, FLORIDA ENGINEERING DEPARTMENT 100 S. Myrtle Ave. Clearwater, FI 33750 fwfli crnmcart Or 431310103341336 13333 E um MS 3.111,3',130 TM, Fue$DA 33605 AUOREY NAUORICWRT P.E. R SSW • • ELECTRICAL & BLOWER BUILDING CONTROL PLAN ..rn WEN N "WEN e. "MN xn. NONE Rw "N/A mrN/A 3817002 xra NONE pPNIL • . :1 002-ROE.OWG E -Y • �_.~~~ .~�~~~.^~� • • • 1 - RECORD DRAWING .ernp.mim “c4rals NALCO.410. WC. e, Kj Lo_l DEVMENET irre I OERMTML .02 1./ TAP ("'. OF 3 1.5 —1 I •ox crYP I r I - - MOTORIZED —1 CONDE.. VAEXE (T,W2 C-06 1:C" 11111=1 C-123 C-04 C-00 AEPRICI4 TAME PLOMWEITER (TM CE AERATOR UM I 11 200 .11r1-1: m 611I1 /3 C -0 C-07 [C2i 111 gENCE OCT (O -NET -1) -04 7-2C/I5IPS. I -1/Ye T32. iOnIC. MVP -1 -.‘1111-2111 2-#12. /120 j] MATCHLINE SEE DWG. E-9 AERATION TANK 2 1013 Sf120 1 1/4 AERATION TAM 3 DO ROOSTER T creme DISSOLVED MOEN ANALYZER (TIP, OP 2) NON IP3.3/4*. µDTE, L 1. CONTRACTOR SHALL FE -ROUTE E)OSTNG DISSOLVED OXYGEN ANALYZER SIGNAL MIRING TO 0 -NET -1 AND POWER WIRING TO 2. CONTRACTOR TO INSTALL CITY SUPPLIED HACH AMMONIA (TAP. OF 3) A 0_4 3 EiSAIWRINdeM SCALE: tie- RECORD DRAWINGS CITY OF CLEARWATER, FLORIDA ENGINEERING DEPARTMENT 100 S. Myrtle Ave. Clearwater, Fl 33758 AUBREY HAVDRICOURT P.E. #: 36861 AERATION TANKS 1-3 ELECTRICAL POWER PLAN NOTES: I. MOTORIZED VALVES AND FLOWLIETERS ON AERATION TANKS B TNRU 13 ARE AT ELEVATION B'-0'. CONTRACTOR MALL PRONOE A UNI -STRUT SUPPORT SYSTEM FOR CO0OOT AT AN ELEVATION SUCH THAT THE OROPUNES ON THE DENCENET TRUNKUNE 00 NOT EXCEED 20 FEET. 2. CONTRACTOR SHALL RE-ROUTE DIMING DISSOLVED EN OXYG 00A. AIT -005) SIGNAL WRING TO 0 -NET -1 AND POWER WRING TO MVP -1. _0 B _ SCALE: I/B' . 1•-C' "A"' WEN NFXxm 'WEN "..:KT . NONE 1Kr.( •'N/A mr N/A n:a 5117002 m. NONE ".74 1001. i22-bWOWI .m C -I RECORD DRAWING LU IIIUtllllllll MATCHUNE SEE DWG. E-8 C -10A 1 ANALKER FROM AERA TM•AS B- g p� ii' - I -P OS J it C 1 _rTT TERMINAL BOX W/ DEVIOENET II T S (SWEET) 0 II II Ftt� C-04--tol III III II 1 I, Id�I =L -0 D VALVE CONTROL (TIP. OF A) °-05 SRA 11_c. (SEE NOTE 1) I/O DEVICE NET PANEL (D -NET -2) C -TOB RECORD DRAWINGS EXISTING FIBER PULL BOX p TERWNAM 10-/li. B/12O SPARE CONDUIT HER i-1 A'C C-10 NEW 1 IN OPTIC IN CABLE EXISTING 2.C. tj P-00 BP 2/Ix 171. sontrair..igh 1MRI. IZI \_ MATCHUNE SEE DWG. E-6 & E-7 SEE DUCTBANN SECTION ORAWNG E -T PB IDTMINII(E4ARES PULLBO% SEE DUCTBANN SECTION01000 E-0 P -OAA AVOO EXISTING IMDERGROIND AUCTBANNS AND PPMG WEEN (ASTOUND CONDUIT IN THIS AREA. 8I 0 C -10A PILLBOX N NANO -AUTO STOAT OPEN PUSH BUTTON S10P PUSH BUTTON OPEN UGHT CLOSED UGNT CLOSED PUSH BUTTON MOTORIZED VALVE OONTROL STATION I ... LED .+0. AAA 1 O memo, Of REVISION Don CITY OF CLEARWATER, FLORIDA ENGINEERING DEPARTMENT 100 S. Myrtle Ave. Clearwater, FI 33758 hitiffir NO. 6, wwwtsoToT EMANWENTAL 10101110115, MIBREV NAUDRICOURT P.E. A 66861 AERATION TANKS 4-13 ELECTRICAL POWER PLAN • • • • • • MATCHUNE SEE DWG. E-9 H TiVano;,'',Itar FROM MVP -2 vrz.t. 11/120 1 -1 /f I I L r 1 1 1 L I I r T L r 1 LI ITT -a L L 4 0 4 6 SCALE: L r LI LJ 05100 SIGNAL CONDUCTOR(Ttp.) P-06 _.( z 1111110DI ANALYZER (11P.) 11 C-04 -AERATION TANN 60 1 00 C-06 P-07 POPAYMIlliiigEHIDW 44, El • Icurd 1-00 TERMINAL BON OVACEN(T TAP(T1P. OF 2) -co C-05 C-06 P-07 RE -AERATION T DISSOLVED OMR- (TTP.) -AERATOR TANN 06 C -011I C 13erJ' 6-07 C-04 C-06 1 RE -AERATION TANK NO. 4 6-07 TRANSISTION TO ABOVE GROUND. ROVIt CONDUIT ABOVE COSTING ELECTRICAL ENCLOSURE. L RECORD DRAWINGS 66.666N AAR MIR ROM OAR REVISION PAR CITY OF CLEARWATER, FLORIDA ENGINEERING DEPARTMENT 100 S. Myrtle Ave. Clearwater, Fl 33766 Ins NTIFICAN Of Amomunos .144:010, ANGINUR• SMARM • MAPATN1711 WO A. MN ANL UM I-100 TAPIR. ROMA •A•01 MOREY HAUDRICOURT P.O 6 SSW RE—AERATION TANKS ELECTRICAL POWER PLAN Haws f4f.wEll WON MN 17Z�o-*t *055 .„ 5517001 autt.. 7:11/0 aa mov NONE .0 Orr ROMP Room. • 0..a. PA • AM at. ? Iai E 1315016111011131501611101113150161110110 LOAD MSM INA PER AIM! NAVA DESCRIPTION D LOA/ ! 3 00 A e c I 15 AFM710$ TANK 1 CDIM0. KIK 0.17 // ��/ 5 0.17 MEMO741* 200150. VNK - - S A 2 e 0.17 /�j34 ELEGRCA1 ROOM NCEPTA4.FS / 0.17 OK .//0". C - 20 22 0.17 I Il A 4[021X41 TANK 3 WI1R0 Kee 11 0.340.17 �/J/ 105 400 744* A 00 A 021710. MLLE - 15 A e 10 12 0.17 /0.17 LP -CA - 125 2, . 10 ,, _ 'P 0.nj2 //1. 061 A 00 0.17 33 3 O 35 A AMMO Um a ME B CONTROL VMK - 0.17 0.34 Os. 1 0.17 TM s NNE A CONTROL NK - 15 14 13 II 0.17 1.00 034 /0.1] 1. 0.17 j/ ��j ass 0.17 It D 2] 15 A AEMIIDN rAM 3 20E B CONTROL vALE - - 0.17 15 m ��j/ j/ 30 WKS W NFODEA VNK - 15 A 20 22 24 0.t) /� / 1.13 0.17 0.1) j//7 ,08:09116/40.y 0.34 0.17 25 n m - - - !AM - - 0.w 0.n v 00 60 0.24 0-x[]-1 m m 0. W / 0.0 j/ 0.02 DISSOLVED OMEN .ANALYZER OV -K1) 20 ]a 11113 /�/ 30 33 J< 000 0.02 DASOLKD 11(1034 WOW (Ni -w3) 20 30 31 20 OOLWD MINN ANNAN (M7-002) 004 002 / j// 0.02 AMNONA NMLY0R (NT -Oil) is 32 A 20 AO -00.1 - / 0.0E /��/ 002 AMMONIA ANALYZER (417-012) 15 34 MIEN VALK le 0.17 �// =SOLED 0112001 NMLVER (Nr -550) on /// =RCE 3347603100 002 0.16 NNONIA ANNIZER (NT -013) m 36 RVv 1 RARRIALL MEET APV MCNEAL MON 101EW K 1.54 1.07 1.47 46461E 014M LIIN41A3 120/206 MKT - 3 MAS - 4 IME - 60 M PROVE NM LUGS CM) A SOD KORAI. a GROUNDBUS MND COMMIE) TOTAL MYA CM MOTORI7ED VALVE POWERPANEL 1 (MVP -1) ALOE E= 05CRIPNOa 0 _DAO KOR A NV PER PRASE ,A CESEH.P,N 51 ,..AO - NOr A fl C 7 3 5 20 ELECIROA IlOOPI4 0,09 0 H // //// 0 76 5 ..L2 0.00 OS ELECTR CAL a CEP115112 Ora 115.2 20 00 2 4 1 20 ELEGRCA1 ROOM NCEPTA4.FS / 20 &DNP CONTROL PANEL 0.A0 C - 20 22 E 6 _2--- 200 A10.67 - 21-3/29_5 11 12 //n� 105 �.. 15 A - a 10 12 QII a.00 LP -CA - 125 2, . 10 ,, _ 'P {t / //1. 061 A 00 12 20 SCAN PANE_ SP-' RE AFMADI TAMS 1 COMM MV.K - - 494 0.34 Os. 1 C EL PCI - ,/ 0 ' / 1.00 BCP -1 0_030 1. 007 20 ��j // - 200 ///// 1.03 1.00 SAD d-2 BLP -3 20 20 15 m a j/ 30 -- 20 20 V22 RASTER BLOM CONTROL PANEL r: / 043 / 1.13 RIP -2 MM -2 BPP -2 00 BO 50 22 24 20 ,08:09116/40.y Ow////// 1A3 1.13 1.00 213 RE -402 }4102 90041710. VKK - / 1.13 27 D 00 60 Mw -I 9-t RW -1 ///' 1.30 /- - FAM a5z m 120 jj onwLlEo MYDN ANNrmI(Nr-CON Em - KW FACE FACE - 30 33 J< 1.30 1.30 0.02 11330.410 002034 NMLV ER(NT-010) - 33 35 o 15 I5 35 Mn YALE N MET MK O KET 00411 N 017 0.17 / - an Q // - 0.11 - FACE SUPPRESSOR LOGE SUPPRE5501 - 15 15 m X 20 0.17 020 an l/ /20 / 0.03 0.03 m IS MIET YALE 9 43 15 MIEN VALK le 0.17 �// =SOLED 0112001 NMLVER (Nr -550) 0.20 0.w =RCE 3347603100 I5 40 43 IS MET WOE /Y 0.I7 0.3I 1.31 I.00 aD MILT VNK P 15 44 MIT /� 017 MET KKK 13 15 M V - - - j/ 0.17 0.17 MEE FALK 43 I5 40 MND WIRCI4 u0 TOTAL RW :S.)EL -') EE '.021206I OnOi 1S0A SOA Mol .+-205'.121 AX -P0.2 60 02 CA, .P N SOLO NES -PAL 0.T 0I1 DEBDa'1pN OF LOAD MONITOP IOM PBI ROSE TVSS 0730161101 OF LOAD 9-02 P-022 A 6 C 7 3 5 N A - AERATOR TANKS S a MORS YANK - - 0.37 9-002 000 3 (72) 0.17 AEM11p1 TANS 0 ! 0 0WA0. VALE - - IS A - 2 1 6 0.17 �//�� / 0.34 / at) 01) %/ 1000ASP 034 0.17 1 A TOM 10 411 CW40. VNK C-010 3-3C8167PS �� (FUTURE) AERATION TNa3 lY t 13 COMM. vKtC - - 15 A - a 10 12 QII /0.]i 3/4. //_/� 0.1) 0.1] //1. C -0243-x410190 0.17 I33 S A 15 A - RE AFMADI TAMS 1 COMM MV.K - - 494 0.34 / � j/ 2-2006193 M AFM110N TANTS 3 cannot vNK - - 35 A - 14 1/ N 00.17 .1] 3/4• 0_030 00.17 .1] 007 ��j 0.N 0.17 D m F _ M -AM 14102 R Lcxm0. PALE - _ - 0-03D j/ 3/4. - 22 - /0.w C-= DEMCENE1 TNMCABLE ROUND 0T0PUNE aw - �j/0 26N0165 Ow////// 0w 27 27 15 A RE -402 }4102 90041710. VKK - C -w 3-20410193 ,/ 0.24 0-1E7-2 40 m - / a5z 3• aw onwLlEo MYDN ANNrmI(Nr-CON 20 m 2_11 6-3CN61PS 002 0.02 11330.410 002034 NMLV ER(NT-010) 20 30 31 20 OF NMLYIIR (411 -DOS) 0.04 0.02 /// / - sow 20 32 33 20 0$30.410 DG.001 N01Y2ER (411-w2) 0.03 / // 002 // - FME m 34 36 20 =SOLED 0112001 NMLVER (Nr -550) a02 10-414 1' 0.02 - sem 20 m P_2 KP -2R1 51MET APti 0024106 TANKS 1-3 TOTAL RMI 1.31 I.00 1.02 RRKE OIM4CTED9133 140/2060(1- 3 MAS - 4 RDC - 60 32 MIM LOS DAY a S0D NEUTRAL a 6111)010 Bus 0UM CO MORO L346 TOTAKVA MOTORIZFD VALVE POWERPANFL 2 (MVP -2) uou 0a - M_ MONITOP IVES TVSS 1000A -SP 9-02 P-022 '000A3P (rl) P -w 11-030 (M92) 10000.31 9-002 000 3 (72) 17-040 BS EXIS01` c .00P PON2 600,59 P-05 5021,3P (FS) 11-02 VBe) 1000ASP MY EVI Y.W�tb) RN - P-07 SPACE (FA) KW LOCARON OF 550-2 C-010 3-3C8167PS 1• (FUTURE) SPACE 3/4' RECORD DRAWING °CT `"" 209.2421, l°2"e.°�'Z l*H. /..'.X41. TOO.: xa a m.t 4 accurate n an rma NMALCOLM PONE M0. DPI. y4/6 6Y FXISTING SWITCHBOARD ELEVATION SCALE: NTS CONDUIT NUMBER NUMBER OF PARES AND SS CONDUIT SS REMARKS P-01 P-014 2 SETS OF 3- 2001=11. & 410440. 2-412 X120. J' EON 9-02 P-022 2 SETS OF J- 300046. a 40040. 2-810 ORO. 3• [0041 P -w 11-030 2 SETS OF 3- 300I4146. a NON. 2-410 4120. ]' EACH 9-002 4-41.9104. 1-1451 17-040 4-94. N00. 1-1/4. P-05 3-N2. 4120. 3/4. 11-02 4-412.412D. 3/4• MY EVI Y.W�tb) RN - P-07 2-412 4120. 3/4. C-010 3-3C8167PS 1• C -MB 1N4 3/4' C -OIC 2-x410195 3/4. C-012 6414 3/4' C -0243-x410190 1. C-020 494 3/4' c -o. 2-2006193 3/4. 0-020 024 3/4• 0_030 3-x400193 1. 0-036 4414 3/4. 0-030 2-2096193 3/4. 0-03D 024 3/4. 0-04 DEMCENET 02104 ROUND 1RUNKUNE CABLE 1-1/4' C-= DEMCENE1 TNMCABLE ROUND 0T0PUNE 3/Y C-= 26N0165 3/4. 0-07 2-204161PS 1. C -w 3-20410193 1-1/4. C_00 4-20416191 1-1/4' 0-100 8gmER0417108 3• 0-1= 6 FNP" 6"6012• CAGE 2_11 6-3CN61PS 2. c-12 C&E BER OPTICAL 1-1/Y 0-130 4 FIBER 0110DAL CAGE 1. C-138 4 3BER*BLE 094008 C I. 0-130 4C40LE FIBER OP71CAL 1• 0-14 6 FNE9 666061 2202E Y. C -ISA 30-414 1• C-150 60-814 1. C -NSC 10-414 1' C -I. CABLE SUPPLIED IT 41107471 341' p_0e 24-412. 0-8120 1 1/47 TO PC2E11211011 TANKS 1-4 NOTE: CONDUIT SCHEDULE (SEE NOTE 1) 1. 001101111 SCHEDULE BASED ON CABLE ORAL PS AND DOES Nor SHDW INDIMDUAL NUMBERED CABLE RUNS. REFER TO PLAN AND ONE LINE °PAWNOR KR CABLE RUNS. RECORD DRAWINGS 1187811,0 IaM"" LED 0/10 1880.81 M1007 0718 REVISION OEM CITY OF CLEARWATER. FLORIDA ENGINEERING DEPARTMENT 100 S. Myrtle Ave. Clearwater. Fl 33756 .7717111077 NO. 87 18008170017 0}wA14 13110 MRS YR 8-107 IMP& MANN SNAP AUBREY HAUDRIO0IRT P.E. k 60261 • • SWITCHBOARD ELEVATION CONDUIT AND PANEL SCHEDULE eM""WEN '66" "WEN 06666 NONE 41"4 "N/A 66" M60/441 "." Se17=2 Nw NONE . NI1W1-416.OWS 551 C -II 11014.1 810880. 081888. 11 3Y4.1 • • • • INSTRUMENT IDENTIFICATION LEGEND FIRST LEON SUCCEITCONG LAMS. MEASPOS OR VMO/ILL Nowa MOOUT OR natclON OUTPUT ROTO ORA RANO O 1.4 "MN mow lW�'INnRI IOW MATE NOT NCO LRM OFFS FMN. RAM Nor uSDI NOT WO Waft at waRN INITAILK "4E2" SPP[1v— Final MULINNOTIOR Wart OR PALL Muslinio DICLARIM INLAY M CORM i VI n/I IV RECORD DRAWING MALCFL,P E� NC. Date Bi1L,ID BY T� POINT FOR SNARED VIDEO DISPLAY (FUNCTIONS LOGIC CONTROLLER) AS ABOVE PATH UMTm ACCESS OR [o,wOENTCCBASED ENT RELAY MOUNTED IN REM OF PANEL (BROKEN UNE). IA DEACTIVATES CONN% AD/OR ALARM SWOONS AT PRESET VALUES. SEE BELOW FOR FORM. (X). Cr SELECTOR C/CURM. T C CURRENT/CURRENT OMNHT/CURIaT CON.. (REPEATER) AVERAGE R. M MI TWO RNCFNS (SOOT Cr ONO. SKS= /OR MALYIIGN DEWED US °fly slg 0�$ PANEL SCHEDULE s_v.. PANEL IDENIW1CAIRIN no C. 0-1 MOO COMA PANEL MT 11410 ICP -2 PAM CONTROL PANEL WI 11410 5w -S LONER CONTROL PANEL 110.3 11410 IOU 00515W LOM PLC PANEL 11110 D-Ntt-1 OIC KT PNC. N0 1 11410 EI -NET -2 CCM KT PMC. NO0 11410 ('X' LOOP LOCATION/ NwT (mann) OUTPUT (DISCRETE) SPOT (ANALOG) WWI' (MAIC) 1 OF (BE NOTE) MIGLOOT DESORPTION SEALWATER OF PRI MARIE INTERLOCK LOSS ROW SOL. CAUSE RESPECTIVE MM TO TINT DOSP AFTER RALE TATEYCOAT-tiuuu BE McaMwAITO G PIMP STMT -LP . ALL PUMPS SW MAIL H)AW NM REIERLOODEBORA=C PUMP RAMAT. !H; G M PERISTALTIC POSE PIMP SCR. Pump 0504 MP C: jl — uO — COO- - 0— ▪ KW— FoaOP00RAVE ESSURE SELF KORA . VALVE Y L/U COMET. IN -UNE MOIR wLGnon DRAWN. SLUICE GATE SIM GTE SLNNER FRaRNE MOOR GLOBE YNTE PLUG ME DAPHRA. TALK IRI TEOLY HOB WL VALA FINCH ME DRAIN FLAME ARRESTER TE Inx A NOTE: THE SYMBOLS SHOWN ON THIS SHEET ARE STANDARD DESIGNATIONS; NOT ALL SYMBOLS ARE APPLICABLE TO THE INCLUDED DIAGRAMS. INSTRUMENT TAG NUMBERING SYSTEM PINKS ONO TAG 01 ANE A) STANDARD INSTRUMENT TAO MAWR MARE M (Y51mRai ROOM LOOP MRAs INSTR. IDE.FICATIOM OUPIIGTE MTMIENT ALPHA-NUMENC CHARACTER OF REVD) NDTEST I. DOES NOT OW. IF UG TSIGNAL IS BROUGHT TO AN 0000 CWIRACT NIG L RIAL ALPHA CNMACTER N TAE (L0 11 -]DIA) NMN' TES GCMG TF OMCE CASTS MAY SE R AMEN_ S KNEW SWIM COMFY MSIR NENTS MTH DIFFERENT FUNCTIONS AND ARE PREMED DI A OIXNAL PONT (E.G., A - 10. FOR OPEN Mull. NIT) - 10.12 TON CUBED 00CA11.). FLOW TRAMTTER KID Y.NRp POM SUPPLY REWIRED LCCNIY WHERE SWORN. NSNIS TFOR DETAILS INSTRUMENT AGNUIPF DENNE VOTER. INSTRUMENT AIR suppLT 120V AC POP. ScPPLY ROOWEFA (ROW RIOGTCA) MASS ITIM B➢aT (NORMAL MOM. T rPE) YENIUM (ROY 0ENEN0 RUNE (ROW ELEMDI1) INOCATES EXISTING MDF ANNLAAR RCM ELEMENT MKT. ROA ELBERT IMOMACIA xON UtVALVE EMSM MM. TATo I us ) CALIBRATION Cam NEAT DORMER ELECTRIC NOT. F K (50 PAM POSITION TR TONWE STATA LYS (BTT W i WLCKG MORON D CLOAK/ 11E01DAY DIM 5010.0 AC1MA15 CYVaC ACTUATOR NUNCIO ACOMTCO 41RORR UGIT/IOTA ■AmN 0 - 000OREE* C]I ALARM NON R �0 R, 0 ro R-Rm (RLN W UNIT O-wEBR(FPatv.awq N-0iu (NrNI munaN) F -MESA ORM E WRAY U.T OF ILLWINATED. LETTER COM. MORI OHARD (MANUAL) SOEGTO /WS PCR HASP SMT. NA PUSHBUTTON CONTROLS RSE Aro/A FORWARD-OFF-LUUTO N/0/ST HAND-FT-STANCBT LAO OC-FP-KNOF M/0/0 0/C/A 0/0 0/S/C RS h R/0 5/S C/aA ASI° FOU -CLOSE FEN -CLOSE -AUTO FEN -STOP -0W. RESIT REBOTE-LOCAL RUN -OR START -STOP START -STOP PATH LOCKOUT STOPSPEED D PACONTI. PO114 TROL PoFx11aE1C TNM DDi KONGROUTING F 118 WO MAL. INRRCOMIECTOGMOTT COT INMATE LNLS aK MM ONE SIGNAL Of E0TWME LIG. PS. MEM CONNECTION F COMMIE.. UW MAN PROCESS UNE MINURAT SHIERS --•— EOwuDNT PACKAF MT MOTNC (EIECMFNC) SOMAL - MINATIC MAL —EI --N— OPIUM UNE I. NIVIAU O BOWL - TONIC MAL KAT 1RAFD AIA MUM M ® AROMA ROM VIE COMNU/M. ® PROMS ROU UNE CONTINNEU COME SOK CC DRAW. • MXIIIMY 9M101 ROM AYO AMRIAE W V LA1m VANArE ORALE I SET POINT L RECORD DRAWINGS •RRa R. PA...N LEO B/10 AAM REVISION CITY OF CLEARWATEK FLORIDA ENGINEERING DEPARTMENT 100 s. Myrtle Ave. Clearwater. Fl 33756 AUBREY HAUDMCWRT P.E. 6 66861 Gam. OF AUTORGATIM NO Of WOORMENT OMMONNK Iwo, ROMA SNOS INSTRUMENTATION LEGEND ABBREVIATION & GENERAL NOTES WEN WEN ARIL SOON MN M M NONE 64170011-500.DW0 n N 0017000 OAP. SYS. RE -AIR TANK NO.1 RE -AIR TANK NO.2 RE -AIR TANK NO.3 0 • a L'4 ANALOG SIGNAL WIRING (TYP.) 1 BJ RE -AIR TANK NO.4— -i- i— — — RESPONSIBILITY OF CIMS SYSTEM INTEGRATOR leJ TANK N0.12 & 13 D -NET -2 ia} TANK NO.10 & 11 ZRl TANK NO.8 & 9 NEW FLE%LO0% R MOTE I/O W/ CONTROLNET AND CONTROL OVER FIBER Ex;s'vLG DEVICENET Dsol vEr, COMMUNICATION OPTIC CABLE -=rnYL u, TER _ - _ o R) lSCAT, �I E 01S -NG Y 1 NEW FIBER TO E -NET CONVERTOR NEW FIBER PATCH PANEL ETHERNET OVER FIBER OPTIC CABLE �af TANK NO.6 & 7 L'] 1 1 I � 1 I I I / / / -T-- ooi •• NEW FLE%LOGI% REMOTE I/O WI CONTROLNET AND DEVICENET COMMUNICATON CONTROL NET OVER FIBER OPTIC CABLE NEW CONTROL NEW BLOWER LOGI% MASTER CONTROL BLOWER PANEL PANEL PLC PLC (BCP) (MBP) (TYP. OF 3) D -NET -I TANK N0.5A TANK N0,1 TANK NO.2 TANK NO.3 DEVICE NET CABLE TRUNK (rn°.) L DEVICE NET CABLE DROP (TYP.) TANK NO.4A TANK NOM TANK N0.48 RECORD DRAWING xia(.1% a �l•I. �[ngln a.Irp ..ssN MALCOLM PUNIE INC. RECORD DRAWINGS 11.04.10 07 I--^ IED AAM MOW DOIllin URI PM REVISION CITY OF CLEARWATER, FLORIDA ENGINEERING DEPARTMENT 100 S. Myrtle Ave. Clearwater, Fl 33756 AUBREY HAUORICOUST P.E. P 66861 NETWORK BLOCK DIAGRAM "NLN NONE Kw NONE eN' WEN •'"••NONE MMN 07 -0003 -UT 6617001 APRIL 2006 Ni7W1-661AN0 em 1-1 • • • • • UN/ IMNOT IN STARTS SEQUENCE HEADER BLONER DISCHARGE .0v, DL'S SURGE SURGE WED AUTO UNITED MALI. OPEN CLOSED PRESSURE NB B PRESSURE FLOW rte` '®` r®` 0� elm I®` m Um` ::Ys: L.".rLAF 1„4.41.44, ;„„...4I..�H.' �.�: :u✓ T'.'ix'�. b:7 _�EDsB�1 (•'�'i•�• � ::i:: 8 51 1 —f r..—t—..1...L 7 ,_Li� u III mom T OYER TSER ETHERNET OVER FIBER II . ETMANET OVER FIBER I MERRIER TER FIBER ET OYER PI ETRJMER 4 IMPENDING IN STARTS ffWOMF I M SURGE SURGE NCFM AUTO ULRTED MAV. CRM CLOSED N RCM01[ YTB MB PRESSURE PLOW 151.11 FFOE EN �� DL Z®I VP �� ® (CT'y7 IYY !!JL:!t'L�-..�. I -- 7W �_ Nom_ NF— ? 4i, rL% ,_,—,—,_,_,_•—. — —.� 1 4 To/ r WI w airLia ' ' • .14 i li 4 Ni/ I ,. I 161 I ,i $ 1 g 6 el DJHOA x ] ♦ XS -, 20 i B S 10 6 �1x ,., zz zs M. FOR I PSI 4 J WALT TOTER COIRF0.S 1 i i •' • �STARD 40 (...)START I Q N / I �J 5�- -- N _ ., __- AWG �r' IM yM. INLET TEMPEIIATRE AMD *RADON MONITORS GENERAL NOTES'. I. FOR SPECIFICATION TDESCRIPTIONS110, SEE DETAILED 2. ALL DISPLAYSSHOYM ON MASTER CLOSER PLC PANEL SHALL SE TRMSMITTEO TO TIE ENSTNO SCMA SKTEM.. S SPPEEGP�ICATON 104SW M[NT AND DEVICES. SEE DETAILEDA. SC CONTRACTOR SHALL REFER TO CRAW* 0-3 FOR STAGING Cr ISE EQUIPMENT, e TW. FOR 0 MARS 0 e ee ee .__.__.__.__.__.__.—_.__._—,__. 8 a 4iii, TO Tx ODB OUT .__.—_.__.__._—.__._—_ woos IS CF TOPER BUILDINGI�Vj(% BUILDING E - X�— MOTOR PROCESS AM — ROHR N0.1 1111 xw -� '-"I zz 2 s ♦ s I 7474 o r --1 xO AIO Exi " --J * PIT RANGE 0-10' PSI m1 RECORD DRAWING �`�'�I STAR., I 1� e a a reflects than., fr A '"—' /BY G/C/B T ,(f._ L� TO AERATOR TANKS Op been cc. by the .c.cn. wn^ai.xi>in °w(Nl. p'n�.wbaeol t a a D.R• e�I11�VMALCOY 20 i zo 0 _r T, 0. L-♦ L- T • . B 0. II I -J MAI OIEG VALVE g5OIM0[ vKK `. ) _D RMOE 0-25' HA (T1P. 8 oe0 FROM ATMOSPHERE ® R MET VALVE NO.Z, VAT% INLET FILTER SILENCER �.��.�_'_�'��.�_'__.__.��_��._` ---.__.__._—._—.____ .__.--,_ -- J ®FROMBLONERS BLOWER SKTEM N0.1 (TIP DP 0) "'AAAI RECORD DRAWINGS '� CITY OF CLEARWATER, FLORIDA ENGINEERING DEPARTMENT too S. Myrtle Ave. I' :I3�. ' Clearwater, Fl 33758 uuu���E��7�It�B ��u h�(N TN., nam. MON AUBREY HAUDIRCOURT P.E. P. 66161 PROCESS AIR BLOWERS P&I DIAGRAM ''''"'"WEIR ^^• .NONE w ••wEH "N/A m 'np 01 -0003 -UT �w senooz ....m.. Iwo Lm «am. HOR a}&'i"2OOI „"N mxP.D - x +WAR• AM Ino N.<aaa. '"� .ry nsn..Nw 0 NWA .. • N„, >•w m NPw. iW P R.w.• , NN' we REVISION w N. RECORD DRAMANG .ag a «.,,rate etkV 1 MALCRI�NIE, wc. OLY '.Z�E1JR-Li( DO AERATOR TANK NO 1 DO NOSIER TANKS DO AERATOI TANI N0. 2 AERA0R1 T1ANN N0. 3 DO SET AUTO/ ALVE VALVE An A142OWA R DO SET AUTO/ VALVE _uK R Glu DO DO AUTO/ AL ALVE AIR AMMONIA I � Y� 0 C � 'OW � ROW IMd� � Y� � � 1Nd� 501 T MANUALPrif FuEr ,s0 T .... �.... EIIERNET OVq ABG ETHERNET OVER FIBER . ETHERNET OVER FIBER EIIERNE OVER F•ER I a A $ xi 1 1 i 3;•,t 'I^•` I:,l` "LQ A S:IYA; ,W' . 4'!J. WL IVY. �'i✓. 4V. Ll 4iIA 'L4` I"1 'I: f' 'I!F� 'il Ll %7 L!►` wag 'I^l` %^i %l !► %1 S:il. \'iiL �ili7. 8iJ 3ifJ, �ilf7. {7t7, .l"r/, 49/, 8i1:►.. V WJ, �'::J, 4CJ, yI^ 1 i8 RI 5 • �s R§ 0 • ="s • CONTROINET OVER FIBER CONTROL/ICI OVER FIBER 00011ROLNET OVER FIBER CONTRGNET OVER FIBER 1 1 % a A $ xi • y } alb i a§ x REE yI^ 1 i8 RI 5 • �s R§ mg it + Hi§ Si • ="s • NOTES: I. FOB MOLT STAGE CENTRINGAL AIR BLOWERS. SEE DETAILED SPEOFICATON 11510. 0. ALL DISPLAYS SHO. ON AERAT1I PLC PANEL SHALL BE TRANSMITTED TO RIE GSTNG SCADA SYSTEM. O AU. DEVOCENET VALVES SIGNALS NOT 5110011 FOR CLARITY. REFER TO SPELIFICATON 15100 FOR ALL VALVE DEVICEMET SIGNALS TO BE SENT TO MBP. 5 5 4 RANGE O -a' NIO (1700) cul 13 TANN 3 ,4 51110 DISSOLVED OXYGEN ANAL12ER5 (TVP.) 0 Is VE11109 1LOVNIElER (TR.) ) /RCN ROPERS L RECORD DRAWINGS IPAPOO I"^ Lm me. W AAN NA AMMO Fr REVISION CITY OF CLEARWATER, FLORIDA ENGINEERING DEPARTMENT (00 S. Myrtle Ave. Clearwater, Fl 33756 AUBREY HAUdB000RT P.E. E 50551 AERATION TANKS 1-3 P&I DIAGRAM DIFFUSER CONTROL eaw WEN 0aa^WEN 001205 NMN 0]?0p0 1051. NOME ^"^p^NONE ^'^NONE 4"O 501700E 0Bv. NONE "Alita200$ TATiow-005.000 I -A P. MOM .08 OPPAPP4 Pt 111111 PP • • • • • • NITRATE NITRATE iNDI CN SEi .;j AUM NO. AYM� TANK 4 TANK 9 TANK 1 TANK 5 TANKS 4 k 5 TANKS 4k9 ZONE A ZONE A TANKS I4,5 ZONE B ZONE B TANKS 12 k 13 TANKS 10 k 11 TANKS 1 k a TARNS 7 k B ROW CONTROL VALVE VALVE VALVE VALVE TANK 12 k 13 TANKS 10 Jr 11 TANKS B k a TANKS 7 k 6 VALVE WTO/ VALVE VALVE 20NC B AUTO VALVE VALVE AUTO/ VKK VALVE qR OXY. TO/ LVE VWVE aro.' WTO/ ALK VALVE AIR ROW WTO/ VALVE ALVE DO///RRROM ROW WTO/ VALVE VWK NR ZONE A WTO 'OA AN ttOw WTO/ VALVE VWVE AIB ROM :at. SET INR ON MMIUAL P� M01 0 C PO MDI ANL P INDI 0 C P C 9E1PgNT M 0 C P P 441UAL P N� 0/C Y 0 C P 8K55i FpA1B�E{ I I J AI"nj ' tiAI• p}A1 ( 1 QI I t i Epp- 1 1 ( I I 1 I I ETIKRHETIOWN nem I I I ETHERNET OVER FKFI, i I ETHERNET OVER mei I CTIERNLT OVER 111 1 1 1 cc Ij T 'L.1 VE7, I,".1` I'1` W' ..W'. it '�.'.i` %C '�.'�l` SO %'1 3f7. I'1' A Il 3:'7. W '/.•,1` 'I!:l A 7. S7. V a�7 I." -l' I."l` il` T B:Y..lL'.7..W". ,' 1 i'1 Ll {':i►, SL7 I'1 A ,l"L✓, W a W 4'✓. E] .. .. i� i3 is • • w/ r►� Pv ►�i „^-- ,, -- ,', "-"":=.-— O r 0 ry ry PV 3.l r 5_P ry a & 5 5 5 4 i ,,---- --- 4--� „ W.►� L]A 4 4 ry ry w Q ►� w L]A P:. � I ry II t I I 5 CONTROINET OVER rum eP—,4 •d e.. fl� 1A j i NI RATE/W.0.A SIGNAL EXISTING FROM SCANARESPONSIBLE # e OWING CRP ANALYZER i�'� /(CONTRACTOR SIGNAL TO CONTROL PANEL SCADA.) TANK 13 a e NITRATE/AMMONIA SMALL BE TOTYING IN DIMINO NEW MASTER BLOWER MA DIVING TANK 12 TANK a� 9 11 2 TANK TO TANK 9 '4 TONIC B TANK A A 7 4 e e TNM 1 TANK B " 44 1 TANK 20 f..... i BONEZON[ T 201[ A A BZa1K zaNE A A B220422ON[ N T N i0ON[Zp1E 2aBv 0 14 1611 0 POBv IB 176 AlkI ZOAK ms ' I I __ RELOCATED NOTES 1 FOR CONTROL DESCRIPTION, SEE DETAILED SPECIFICATION ZOIK 11610. 2. AU. DISPLAYS SHORN ON AERATION PLC PANEL SHALL BE TRANSMITTED TO ME EMSTINC SCADA SYSTEM. I ALL OEVICENET VALVE SGNALS NOT SHOWN. FOR n '.. 201E 201E A A .. n n ZONE ZIRIE A IA n n 2011E ZONE A A n n MK rote A 6 k A .. 0 0 2011V 20 16 ISA�is . OKY N DISSOLVED ANALYZER 20HE B PCAB15100 FOR ALL CLARITY. REETO SPECIFICATION VALVE OEVICFNET SIGNALS TO BE SENT TO Mr ----- ------ �- _ LQ•-xLLT, 3�'-Lry v-- Ste- WTgaGD CONTROL VALVE (M) Bim'Q Ila j, 1141:F _I. RECORD C nnv: qu° ;irwl is by et. Tn.Ee.:`a.m.e. .wNl DRAWING In. mw ',ve .:7. n.end eve ..n m.N ptencred . N°. to the Engineer I °a<.«.,.H No-°. a. MALC041 0, INC. 11 1 JL1 7 RANDS o-26' NA (^M.) KNTWI 1'Lmreml (M.)lik __..__ _...a—.._ 70TOKESAR I TO TANKS 1-3 AND TANKsoosl RECORD DRAWINGS CITY OF CLEARWATER, FLORIDA ". ENGINEERING DEPARTMENT M 100 0. Myrtle Ave. I'*° Clearwater, Fl 33756 � P� ,N FNWIWMa� eN.; T., naw 33.08 AU BREY HAUDMCOIRT P.E. K 63861 AERATION TANKS 4-13 Pact/ DIAGRAM DIFFUSER CONTROL 07-�BBI)DO! ......, °, LEO . NON[ Awem nH//^ w,W MOAN "` .ww.. AAM yFD ..W NON[ APRIL 1005 MIT112-MIANN na N1 All T+m....°.w�a. v.. MRI o.x REVISION .. w. w. MM.....M..A, WV 3.W RE-AEAAIgN DO DD NR PLAW TT ANK N0. ♦ RE-AERATON 10'40.'4/4 AUTO/ ALK A DO DO AM '1' TANK NO. J RE-N 0110K AUTO/ VL VALVE DO !j19 TANK NO. R RE-KRAAM TANK NO. 1 MANUAL , P NVEONSET I... i; _,,.._, ETHERNET OVER MEN ETRINET OCR DBER ETIFbICT OVEN Ee1DL ETHERNET OVER SW I 1' 8 Aw W W 1 Eng WEi5 arr �.✓ W u W is •A 3.Y W �✓ W �✓ S.Y W W W 5v �:✓ 1 Cp11NXNET CONTRONET ( WIITROLNET COMTRCLNET 4--)g S g § big I 4 +� # 4 s ,0 4 FRW BLOWGS D * '$ TNA aWV.h ky VENTURI , ,I.ONAETa (TP.> eEa SOW T z TNN 2 .. a ( e CONTROL VALVEFIT.) ( TNM 1 � 0.4 RANGE O..20 00 (TVP. RECORD DRAWING � r„•••b. LALCOLM FI aI E NC. ISI �J U 0 _�L ---` DISBOLKO OXYGEN -.--� FINAL fR1000 TANK INFLUENT CHANNEL ....- J ANALYZER (TW.) NOTES. I f 1. FOR CONTROL DESCRIPTOR. SEE 001010D A SPECNICALO5 11810. - 1 i ALL DISPLAYS 910. CH AERARON PLC PANEL SHALL RE TRANSMITTED TO TIE EMS1100 SCADA SYSTEM. J. ALL OENCENET VALVE SIGNALS NOT SNOTS FOR CLARITY. REFER TO SPECIDCAOON 15100 FOR ALL VALVE OENCENFT 0ONALE5 TO BE BENT TO F•/A RECORD DRAWINGSUBREY 3 CITY OF CLEARWATER. FLORIDAA[DA ENGINEERING DEPARTMENT rwows IDe0 S. Myrtle Ave. •�.> Clearwater, Fl 33758 A h1 • ICA URA. nNIM SM. NBABUVORICOURT P.E. ,: 56551 RE—AERATION TANKS P&I DIAGRAM wwEN ONE NONE wN/A O/A 1PgliiQDB w N/A S0 NM 7002-805.0 OT-ao03-UT '' 581700, ,.W I W IID �e4@ DIFFUSER CONTROL �'"� r.em en eRNP.en•. MU, •A.NN. ..c ,.. •..w•.ew• P•w•.••.• Nx ••,• REVISION W Nw • • • • • FRRNEN7A7/ON PEW- ANOX/C TAN/SR <!44R-0 e(.4..00 1—LEL.344WATER .D0 NQA/ RM AMMMT. PIPPP 0017701. BAHT TANK O TANK Na 7ANR N010 TA'NR No 7 TYPE /1/C PAPP JUPP/Cr I5.e"roc PEP GPTA/L 5N7'/sZ 8"UEWATEW SO°A/O'Rte. JOTNIM'RED. 50'•f it. 1.0 00 4!'A SO" RED. 8'CRRNN ER AIR DIFFUSER GR/O•TYP. SOPS. �N 0/'., rIPEIT (TrP)' Se P!7RN.3 SMT 51- COVE. STOICS REP DETAILS snr�, ' I CONTROL BUILD/NO 0.738 R SrA/Rs REPLACE 04/T .v t+rNEN RPM, RE/ -EN 2VO. LUOGE TRW,. TOP OFIVALL(UNDER PIPJ •!L. IS..M TYR K' ILL NO AMR /s x/ET '4AROA1kW SIN ST.--TATE/4501/NO) �— SATE/ I)S.ROUN) B * H TRANSFORMER PLATFORM TYPE o' Ga PRE es0A�Ts INT. leg - BLOCK CHANNEL 24'- I EL. 22.00 (C6v AV TANK ay..“) PIP! JUI.MRT BRACRGT(TX)RA95 .SIC PPIRA. Smear AS7 ALL A/R PIP/NG AND FITTINGS ABOVE WATER SURFACE AND/ OR UNDERGROUND SHALL BE 304 STAINLESS STEEL. SCHEDULE 5. AIR PIPING BENEATH WATER SURFACES FOR HEADER AND DIFFUSER MOUNTING SHALL BE EITHER 30455. SCHEDULE 5 DR PVC SCHEDULE 80. ULTRAVIOLET LIGHT INHIBITED. B,( 0'* STAINLESS STEEL YARD PIPING FOR BURIED SERVICE SHALL HAVE SUFFICIENT WALL THICKNESS AND STRENGTH TO PERFORM THE INTENDED SERVICE. n",roR P¢!Rpp TlRTIP III 21'X /64 uA. To GRa MR.V506 NOT PRAM O PROM ORIGINAL TRACING THO TOO WAS 14.6 FROM OF AM MON. POMO PREPATOO BY BALM W. AWILD AM ABBOOu'Rq MO MOON DOCLAABB MN FOR w,gr r Ar v TO me we TO NM. LEGEND EX/5T/NB PROPOSED REPLACE GRATA/ON/AEA, DRAM/0 APTeS REMOVING GAVCRETE SLUDGE TROUGS AL. 5TNR5 R/0eR36 7". tl rREAp'S e,tl"= 0,4" A IOS�C PA(7�9UR/e03° IN ORD.) S'O'N 5'-O' RECORD DRAWING G iP ��i.I, pitB i i t 2i SCALE 011 FEET SCALE: 1/B . P B R A- EFOR (STOW wl,NrxAW t AM IMO. OW .A� IHMal KIN. MO OTOVAL OltiA Nowa RD mem ONMIINi wa. 315 Bee DATE RECORD DRAM/NG 055/N 5 RD PER PEN 0/7 RAO Rd 6-I . TRW REVISION BY DESIGNS ORAwM CHECNED M7D PJ.S SES ..�...., �.'......o.. M. .,.....e Briley, Wild & Rssociotes, Inc. CORSULTIRG EDGIREERS PM) PLRDOERS Otme.d Mooch - Cl..,....tot - Mted.etee. Flet!/e MARSHALL STREET ADVANCED POLLUTION CONTROL FACILITY AERATION REACTORS 4-13 - PLAN FLORIDA CLEA DATE,AUG. 1888 "A/C, //8'• /'-0' MOI. No. 8707!-2 SHEET N0. 88 OF)87 12824 M 92020 2' 0" WAW' REO. NEN GRATING G" B.V (TIP) G'SPOOL PILL (TEP) (A'• HD' SENO ,7YR) 30 TYPE C/D PWT SUPPORT. SEE OGTNC $015 /57 11• /U' AOR/P,45 PLATE EL, 13.007 OFFSET ACTUATOR. BEG L. /4. /7 Y✓ wEIR GATE GRATING BEAN BRACKET DEE DETAIL GOT 52 W56/2•4W 4 SEE LETAIL �TI(.0 SALVE BON MVP. OPTIMA IN WALL (TVP) T, STEEL —EO ARC7W 4PALE-TYPE PPE BUPaPer 5/5'0"0OA 555 LCTAIL SHEET L)G PGTUY OPIAAO. AN MILL 811w5 EL.4.50 8•Ae' TEE b"4ATE VALVE tw�LH4 NAD II 3'0' TYP. 5 E/2•E 8L0• 0'HEADER FILL WITH CONCRETE RELOCATE SLUDGE SHOE ,ONN' Rea. EROS-, ALL AIR PIPING AND FITTINGS ABOVE WATER SURFACE AND/ OR UNDERGROUND SHALL BE 304 STAINLESS STEEL. SCHEDULE S. AIR PIPING BENEATH WATER SURFACES FOR HEADER AND DIFFUSER MOUNTING SHALL BE EITHER 30455, SCHEDULE 5 OR PVC SCHEDULE BO, ULTRAVIOLET LIGHT INHIBITED. ,1V 3' GONG MALA rARAT/AIR EL ,9 /T 900 SECTION SDALE: oi,o• 8'-0' 04. 6•-8" 4•-O" PLAN PLATE 5y A1. b /* STAINLESS STEEL YARD PIPING FOR BURIED SERVICE SHALL HAVE SUFFICIENT WALL THICKNESS AND STRENGTH TO PERFORM THE INTENDED SERVICE. AIR DIFFUSER PIPE 13'-o` 5@. r- 1• ErsB/z• ��; SII �, s486•E.w. z pe AL. AAya.E. z AIrDI•BABL l N7S4•1B2. ex. ears EEL IBA, SECT/ ON IQ SCALE, Y -./:o' 5ECT,ON 54418: EL. /2.0 2-V6 8077. 2-R5 TOP W3 57/RRU/S G; /2" -B•A E• COL. r�4-W5 VERT. *2 7)05 8 /5' EL. 7.0 2-14 E.N. [P) I,-G"./'-UA/Z• CoAC. P74. 210" DO. SECTION TRANSFORMER PLATFORM DETAILS SCALE: 3/G' •I•-0• -*5 E.W. 2-4ETN4• S.S. MCA SECTS EACH SRO_ PIPE SUPPORT DIFFUSER GRID SEE DETAIL SNEETIG2 SEE DETAIL SHEET !60 RECORD ORA lPART OND. FonuATnav EY NOT PRIMED FROM ORIGINAL TRACING A OIRIC.ATPRINT E WAS ROODOME OF NI ORM. DRAWILD WING AND AS 0D07OO IG ORLEY WILD AND m vru Amy RESPORSOILITY OR 11.11.11Y ON TN0 RESUME uwt�PDESE ESNTA OA M OSHA TY//CAL G/E'ATI,VG {NIALKA/AY DETAIL B•ALUNIORATIOoS No SALE Lf • Ioo as- NOT q/%'0 BE TIRNED AG TO WALL ISMAECT/ON AS REDO 2.) FELL CONC`., 'PGL. PORT 70roPAORCA TONS cecevc ex/enwc PROPOSE:G RECORD DRAWING 1 SE S 4-21-n RD • E Nor Esr,NAroNs 0111., 8 FAT 11,00,14 Nov R INSr H A &IMP Al C CANER porter 50 Na IK Rev ATs e.O. 04470 .eacaos. PENN .G REV/SED NOTECAdG-I ) I+RW DESIGNED DRAWN P RAE WV/ DATE REVISION BE CHECKED BCS Briley, Wild & Associates, Inc. CODSULTIDG EOGIOEERS ROD PLRI/RERB Ormeed Beach - avenue.. - Bred oelee, Ronde MARSHALL STREET ADVANCED POLLUTION CONTROL FACILITY AERATION REACTORS 4-13- SCIEARWAYER, FLF6PIDIkS OAYE.AUG. 1988 SOALE,AS SHOWN PRO, No. 07055-2 SMELT N0. 60 0f 183 FILE N0. 12826 • • • • s • IVB' pl e tl AL 0-10,04.0L. A44's YE' 141_ C e PIAS E0.TS,L4UT9 __ I N,G G AAEHoRS AJNPLL 6E <'A u.05W i4-- hTdeL 77: . �"E' HINGE 4 CLAMP GE TAIL• YALe'3"e0•o' VP PATS, NUTS G HASHNES AL HINGE It 5515 Oen THIS 5HT AL, MOUNTING R. eri 4EJE DOTA,L41 51 T1455HT " �I5N41 IF1-.-II 4 AL MOIINTIN6 R.-frAocs0.6) 341", I.O" AL MO111J3ING R (.TANIci445) NH'- O LOVER ARM. 17" x 1b' Al R. 3"' VL" 5v,7 POR A0JUSTNENT PLANT LTION I'li' • 10.41. LEVEC A:A4 4'%4"$I' AL L AOSTCu to HALL N/ 44 -Sp" OAP POLTO 4 Al ,041 R�?Te vy 3ELTe. NUA4TS N NPS NRR+ (TVP Rog 4.13) i RIOLO vsE,Pr aLsvdn —1 r es AI}T gpNTCOL 6l0(a- wC13T }'Pe h'A' RA UAL EtA C:5 2600 •. _ EAL HAND __ II. (TTP) : 4'4kIt'442'AL It WOLVN9 70 J- s ,.. L 2 �\ S TION 5(Ca-IN/'•I'•0A 4'x4"40IL' A'-. 4—� AL. ANGLE 7F T' dna L5b A//H) IIfE"s II.On AL L PASTEutP T/RJ AL R. TO ACNE. 4"x4"* L' 7"A9s' ALUMr.JM AMALO I -- RN 0. 4!2A A L NtLOED TO AL L THeIN FA4T044IL TO Rowe HI V6" TOP I O%P E0_TS PRDWT ^' AL. ANI EDTA1.5_(wRTAJR-,Afi I'WI a 1L0I FLOW SPLITTER DETAIL SCALE Ae e1 -o N" NRIMMN rein NIRINII INIIII IH TOP of OEATNG 300 1s N 24'0414. AIR UNC) (ABOVE) 3.00 (ELev A -w WALL UNDER PIPE 59 ALL AIR PIPING AND FITTINGS MOVE WATER SURFACE AND/ OR UNDERGROUND SHALL BE 304 STAINLESS STEEL. SCHEDULE 5. AIR PIPING BENEATH WATER SURFACES FOR HEADER AND DIFFUSER MOUNTING SHALL BE EITHER 30455. SCHEDULE 5 OR PVC SCHEDULE 80. ULTRAVIOLET LIGHT INHIBITED. 0 Lb, STAINLESS STEEL YARD PIPING FOR BURIED SERVICE. SHALL HAVE SUFFICIENT WALL THICKNESS AND STRENGTH TO PERFORM THE INTENDED SERVICE. 2404 AIR ,Ne 22v E BL 130o, COIL STAT CO' 000A,. RIS•i5 it TREAIJS610"-.1,2" 145 0 CORFJ,. jFAITGOL Repo .5.84.E Lr iLo* 2 //��r5 un wET L6/ / t,i4HR 00 I.1 EL. 670 J— R,II C IST }eCOJJ aLR ECORD DRAWING IS RASED IN PART 4 AN INFORMATION FURANDIEO BY OTHERS. NOT PGHOED PROM ORNiiAL TRACEEO TRW PRIM' WAS KAM FREW PRIPARID BY AHo , WILD AemATML MLR, WILD AND Aeo0AM NG MOM MMOMEam' wF'Luum FOR MOMATON OONTAMO ON MB TNT DUB TO tNNN 0lk IMINWMMoa� Al4 CO NL BY DTIERR RECORD DRAWING rO%IYI FLR `EL. 7.22 SEGT.9 T � F%S:4Ld'.4:oN(` S•'96.w.. Ear. Lz•Rcaa'o) snows! Mrmw a.,n AD 4-tt-lt C B 0 a taf ii.:: fav R ', ave NR,m H A RD PS. RECON ORAL yBs REVISED NOTE CA44-1) RAP AEW MED 175 DRA Eva e. Re ANWAR. OA REVISION CHECKED 545 Briley, Wild & Rasociotea, Inc. CODSULTIDG EDGIDEERS RDD PLRDDERS Orme.N /Sash Claerutevr - tre414tea, Florida MARSHALL STREET ADVANCED POLLUTION CONTROL FACLITV AERSEICTIONS 8 DETAILS 3- CLEARWATER, FLORIDA DATE, ALIO. roes SALE, A0 SHOWN SMELL NO,50 OF/OB PRO, NO. 87054-s ILE NO. 12025 31,..: 11"—'— . _ I 1 JU i, .6 9 w 6 ) r LTION I'li' • 10.41. LEVEC A:A4 4'%4"$I' AL L AOSTCu to HALL N/ 44 -Sp" OAP POLTO 4 Al ,041 R�?Te vy 3ELTe. NUA4TS N NPS NRR+ (TVP Rog 4.13) i RIOLO vsE,Pr aLsvdn —1 r es AI}T gpNTCOL 6l0(a- wC13T }'Pe h'A' RA UAL EtA C:5 2600 •. _ EAL HAND __ II. (TTP) : 4'4kIt'442'AL It WOLVN9 70 J- s ,.. L 2 �\ S TION 5(Ca-IN/'•I'•0A 4'x4"40IL' A'-. 4—� AL. ANGLE 7F T' dna L5b A//H) IIfE"s II.On AL L PASTEutP T/RJ AL R. TO ACNE. 4"x4"* L' 7"A9s' ALUMr.JM AMALO I -- RN 0. 4!2A A L NtLOED TO AL L THeIN FA4T044IL TO Rowe HI V6" TOP I O%P E0_TS PRDWT ^' AL. ANI EDTA1.5_(wRTAJR-,Afi I'WI a 1L0I FLOW SPLITTER DETAIL SCALE Ae e1 -o N" NRIMMN rein NIRINII INIIII IH TOP of OEATNG 300 1s N 24'0414. AIR UNC) (ABOVE) 3.00 (ELev A -w WALL UNDER PIPE 59 ALL AIR PIPING AND FITTINGS MOVE WATER SURFACE AND/ OR UNDERGROUND SHALL BE 304 STAINLESS STEEL. SCHEDULE 5. AIR PIPING BENEATH WATER SURFACES FOR HEADER AND DIFFUSER MOUNTING SHALL BE EITHER 30455. SCHEDULE 5 OR PVC SCHEDULE 80. ULTRAVIOLET LIGHT INHIBITED. 0 Lb, STAINLESS STEEL YARD PIPING FOR BURIED SERVICE. SHALL HAVE SUFFICIENT WALL THICKNESS AND STRENGTH TO PERFORM THE INTENDED SERVICE. 2404 AIR ,Ne 22v E BL 130o, COIL STAT CO' 000A,. RIS•i5 it TREAIJS610"-.1,2" 145 0 CORFJ,. jFAITGOL Repo .5.84.E Lr iLo* 2 //��r5 un wET L6/ / t,i4HR 00 I.1 EL. 670 J— R,II C IST }eCOJJ aLR ECORD DRAWING IS RASED IN PART 4 AN INFORMATION FURANDIEO BY OTHERS. NOT PGHOED PROM ORNiiAL TRACEEO TRW PRIM' WAS KAM FREW PRIPARID BY AHo , WILD AemATML MLR, WILD AND Aeo0AM NG MOM MMOMEam' wF'Luum FOR MOMATON OONTAMO ON MB TNT DUB TO tNNN 0lk IMINWMMoa� Al4 CO NL BY DTIERR RECORD DRAWING rO%IYI FLR `EL. 7.22 SEGT.9 T � F%S:4Ld'.4:oN(` S•'96.w.. Ear. Lz•Rcaa'o) snows! Mrmw a.,n AD 4-tt-lt C B 0 a taf ii.:: fav R ', ave NR,m H A RD PS. RECON ORAL yBs REVISED NOTE CA44-1) RAP AEW MED 175 DRA Eva e. Re ANWAR. OA REVISION CHECKED 545 Briley, Wild & Rasociotea, Inc. CODSULTIDG EDGIDEERS RDD PLRDDERS Orme.N /Sash Claerutevr - tre414tea, Florida MARSHALL STREET ADVANCED POLLUTION CONTROL FACLITV AERSEICTIONS 8 DETAILS 3- CLEARWATER, FLORIDA DATE, ALIO. roes SALE, A0 SHOWN SMELL NO,50 OF/OB PRO, NO. 87054-s ILE NO. 12025 TYPICAL GUIDE FRAME MTC, ALL LOWS TO MLMNYLENE MARINO MR 770. 09035 - SECTION TYPE L. GUIDE FRAME HAND— LIFT ALUMINUM STOP GATE DETAILS SCALE, NOME SIDE -MOUNT HANDWHEEL DETAIL SCALE: NONE IVO DA FIALL40.4 0444.6 or 01111.1704.0 0.41,4 BOX—OUT DETAILS SCALE NONE FLUSH -MOUNT SELF-CONTAINED WEIR GATE DETAIL SCALE NONE 13444/ son SLUICE GATE-FWSH-MOUNT DETAIL SCALE - NONE CIRCULAR SLUICE GATE DETAIL SCALE: NONE FLUSH MOUNTED DATE 777-4 •0N D EMBEDDED DATE SLIDE GATE DETAILS SCALE WIG GATE SCHEDULE MARI LOCATION OPEl3T01T3PE RTE TYPE 0Y. 0.33041GATE FwA.R.R.N1 A A HEIGHTW I.. 9 EM'10m ...LENT PUMP MT. TED SLIME 2 ] 0 TRIP 4OTT ..A 30• 3'•e• CecLUI x ORD FEMORAL INFECT -12 1W43MEB SLOE ] 2.0' 13'B- 8' 3 CANT REMOVAL STRUCTURE NMomEEL MEE1 l• -o- T.s ] !'.a• BlEClED AERATION REACTORS 14 CP/ANCPERAIED YEN a M'-0' 1.'0' M1'.O• a.r BEV 0011A11E0 ! AERATION REACTORS.. NNOMEB SIDE x.6'.0• !•-0' !'a' .. 1 ' + ' ELB D/RAMO TOPE CALMTMp 3 AERATION REACTORS 4s N0EB NIW 350E a e'.0• toe .a• 3,,7T MOVE ORATIN3 T AERATION 'FACTORS .13 CRWEOPERATED WEN . to0 10.,0• 'S'e• a'.r RUBIYOMVIED AERATION REACTOR86! CRMNOPERAIED NEN. EVOORAEED e AERATCNRI.EMNALCT0p4! CRANACPERATED WEN 2 +B'.0' t..0 ! 0 .'.!• IF°DWAO EM 10 qPSfAMX1 INC STOP 4 4.3' .•.e• 3 6 BIM= 11 RECYCLE0NMB- 1N0NEEL SLOE 3 ] 0 ]''o' +'e' e.®Ce0 +2 SCREW-LPT PIMP STATION NANDINEE. 350E Ia:P s a WM:CEO 13 PLIEROMPLE01 CR...OPERATED MACE VARIES e•.3' 4•.0• e.B• num MOURED, WIDE A ETV/PUMP STATION FWD STOP + ].0 a.0• a'0' +' OEM 15 011FALL 3RITIER BOX 43*13OPBUIED SLUG£ + a'0• 10.0- S'0• a0 PLUM1M0MEDr WOE 15 !!.3Z&N 3 PANONIFEEL aDE ! s.o• e•.3• r.e• a++r BQCED 17 GRIT IEMOVALSTRUCTME NP20YME6 MOE 4 TARNS t0•.a• 9.0• a'.T• 23 WIDE AMIN MOUNTED 1 PNRT GY DOOPBNTMiI IS MOM L BY MEM • ELDT nen®WINK WANG n1oEe TN 1M. ASM Lome NON 5 2OAle mammas craw maw ammo PRAM= N mat MSD AND AOOW]b, PN. BRAY, tan NB A.3mm.. NM WNW DMA= ANY• IMPONINLITY ON MLRY GRIN. Nom. to P`p� CAINaY iv"='. CORD DRAWIN ILI LCv 10.1 RD4-22-02 DESIGNED )75 4-P2 RECORD OYANIA6 RAP DRAWN yIN2 Ammcm or *mei DATE REV'SION BY CN€CANED 5A5 Briley, Wild & Associates, Inc. CORSULTIRG MINERS RID PLRORER3 Omega Ise2h - CIeNNeter - Irednter, 90.7442 MARSHALL STREET ADVANCED POLLUTION COMM MONJfY, GATE SCHEDULES & DETAILS CLEARWATER..FLORIDA 0270 AUG. 1988 RALE. 909E 4NEEI NO. 161 or 183 PRONo. 87058-2 FILE NO. 12927 s i • 92020 • • • AFFA1C14 IL no THE /'GAO. 510. A/R ARKS AV PE Eo3T DIVOV/T 50RORT 37AVG5 MIME dE REMOVED AMC MAIMED 7o THE GTN. LEGEA/O EA/ST,A/G TO REM&/N HYA5E Z REAXJ 4t FMCSE Q REAM✓AL TANK MA 9 TAng NB A /I REMOVE CONCRETE SLAG AS SHONN (TVP. 5 PM) N N b w AN.S VN,T IT IS THE RESPONSIBIUTY OF THE CONTRACTOR TO FAMILIARIZE HIMSELF WITH THE EXISTING SITE CONDITIONS IN COMPARISON WITH THESE PLANS TO INSURE ADEQUATE PERFORMANCE OF WORK AND ADEQUATE COST EST1M4790N FOR SWIMS PURPOSE& IywIE RI.ro. NrnT REMOVE EFFLUGNT TRO Ubn (3 GCH TACH% cx R ./1R d.M REMOVE A•/ANTM,e.R an.. Co....l•R Iff '.� 1_•.Ts .r. a✓wfflN'•w 4 7'�L � /Bibi Ira y YR roa<.CTe. ANON AMA Ill- - FI'" ♦�' IRie� FiSTAIi/i♦i♦< 7 Ng°a i7 1Y' ClA�Ya9�1.41k FIdINKS 44 NT 'it[fS�r )i44-.. COUP/NO KmeD STEEL .0C TANK Arf If alt mAlr b. AMO 1 WV [ MON r/ REMOVE CONCRE+E 'RE -URN SLUDGE TROUGH (BENEATH GRATING) 10.,0014 ENA$TMIQSYVH PIMP RAEp MUMMA A TAW CITY. EVlCl/M! 4. IWI PINY T: Bt P(NTYD G3 • . • /1 ,A' £W I MTs- NUN CONY TO 109W AMA- A F. R A. S. STRUCTURE Gte PLUG DURING PHR5E 1 THIS RECORD ORAWND IS COOED IMT OT INFORMATION FORMS,.t BY 017101a J NOT PAWN, FROM ORIGINAL TRACING TIM Men WAS WOE MOM WroodAaE Of AN ONOINAL C.11.10 PMM•mmil0 ME, /AO AMMOOATEM I N *Y n . OM LMm PON ON TM PPM OM t0 RI MCINM IMOMMINIMMORBOM IKE MT 41IOIR RSMOVE ALL MR /io,hC rn15 .,.NANn!4 AM.N f 4t.N RECOR_p DRAWING SCALE IN FEET SCALE: 1/4• - V'-0• NRA. S. STRUCTURE Ecru /[7S G 11.41A./Y<41794, RenmO/ reerre me armee, eetor. -. IG /DES I �i♦i/5',!.i♦s i�♦♦�i�♦�4..Z. ♦i �i♦D�c♦p4% !a^J4iit z*::! i t :!+:Ti' �4♦ �i:': �_ •_-_�+Pic_♦--,.a _ ♦ S n.V lino .4 An.1 OA n ' 4-12-92 RD P E EST B IPA lo (Om 0 , R rc N A 2 1IEa. RN, RD 0.111 SIGNED 4.92 RECORD ORANIMD RAP DOA PG DATE REVISION BY CHECKED SCS Briley, Wild & Raaociotes. Inc. CODSULTIDG EDOIDEERS NOD FLAMERS O,moad Booth - Clearwater - Deadest, Flood. MARSHALL STREET ADVANCED POLLUTION CONTROL FACILITY EXISTING FINAL TANKS - REMOVALS PLAN (SOUTH HALF) CLEARWATER, FLORIDA 04r[,AUG. 1988 SHEET NO.55 0F183 ro.1 N0. WOW& EN 12821 M 93020 \,‘N 3c#n PCn.P N.2 -.INP IT IS THE RESPONSIBILITY OF THE CONTRACTOR TO FA1..RLIARIZE HIMSELF WITH THE EXISTING SITE CONDITIONS IN COMPARISON WITH THESE PLANS TO INSURE ADEQUATE PERFORMANCE OF WORK AND ADEQUATE COST ESTIMATION FOR BIDDING PURPOSES. TANK N. TANK N. S C R6MOVE EXISTING SCUM PUMP ALL OHL.VER TOTNE CITY ___4. 4. I I 4.5188,1 7ANIC.8 (NOT 9NO4Nj DIVERSION ASSEMOcr AISMAFTAPAII AA B W‘ ili • e...... REMOVE \. EFFLUENT TROUGH \�\\\�\ (3 EAlll TANK REMOVE CONCRETE ALAS AS SHOWN OTP = PEGS) S A 0R steno MNT PO 00 TANK NO IME R00 RO moms) R wooRWWIE ten M1 ON INFORMATION FORMENEII BY °WERE SVOIV/s.LAAVAAAAAA`Li.AAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAAvIAAAAAAAAAAAAAAA�VAAAOy\� VAOAA• AAAAv�3A. \.ate\"ItO\"raIc..:..`ik,`\` \=:.ft co1'4 �\\�\`\.\\Q\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\\�`\\�'�\`�\\\\\�\\\\\`2`�a\' NOTE : TME /"OALV. 5TEEL A/R P/PVNS IN 7HE EXIST CONEWIT BLIP/ -ORT STANDS 4...t bE OYrMO/E;. 4 DELIVErA -O THE CITY. 1 I I SCALE IN FEET SCALE: 114• CE6EN0 e. ,orm, TO A'EA1A/N pNASE J 56M01.AC REMOVE MOTORIZED SCUM COLLECTOR TANK' Na B REMOVE EXIST. CR/VE MOTOR: ANL GEAR REQUCURO ANG DEL/VER' 70774E CI . REMOVE CONCREr: SLUDGE RETURN TROUGH (BENEATH GRATIN®) I it L. F SCALE W FEET SCALE: INC 1'A• NOT PRINTED PROM ORIGINAL TRACING ,N.APORT WWI RACE MON Or AL PRAWNO PREPARED ASO ITNO AWL, WILD AND ASSOCIATES. Oa WWI COICIANS ANY ANWORSOR MOUT' FOR INFO 1°roRwATIOR GOWNING OR u axME RNrnwm." OR ME BY on.Im P5MOVE A. A7 G IN T. $ CwO L 5L n DRAWING RD .22-92 A A ♦-921 RED GRAN/NG RAP SflI IOn ,BY H Alb 0E5,00E9. ?AC_ NPR..R w new. DRAWN 'Lt VQ -- CNECNEO !SOS ....: ,'..-...... .. ,.' Briley, Wild .& Rssociotes, Inc. EI CODSULTIDG ED610EERs RDD PLRDDERS Ormond lead - CI.eIWe1.Y - lred.nlen. Fleas MARSHALL STREET ADVANCED POLLUTION CONTROL. ACILITV EXISTING FINAL TANKKSSRWRA EO REMOVALS PLAN (NORTH HALF) C RWTIAUG.. 1988 W1.I 1/4% .1 U1 So. 56 OF163 T. o.. 87056-2 SO. Ali 12822 ' 92020 FlU • • • N. 200 ..TC(/*/ 7,01,01V cYAr772212 mororrIzro JCON 34. INAr.""."'011 IWC01111'"."6. RIMBNEt a"leL] MY Mint NOT PRINTED FROM dmosuL TRACING TIM PANT WAS MACE RIM A OBAUCATS ASPBCOUOISLA Of AN ORION. DPAWINCI PREPAPEO BY ME, WAS ABO ASSOCAATIA NM MAY. MD IWO ASSOCIATE% WM KAM C4SCAANS RISPONSWANY LIABANY INFORIATION CONTAINED OS TRW PANT OM TO WACO MMES. IASNEPABSENTATIONS, CA USE BY OTHS. • ear< pod SLOW, (P124071/KG AleGYANINH, ..;-AravallooHNAPPFSg.........d—ooreAro Scas.• • (;), • NN \ • 0 1 N k•.‘ 1 LEGEIVO e-r/srban, TO REMAIN ,H4/KE .1' REMOVAL Szc• rion, aloe •so., rrAnrawrea flSKO 'flour( VOL VII r.Pira ro CLEAR INPAoromir.TAnwei. -REMOVE DEWATERN6 PIPE AT HALL SLEEVE/Of rAWK.S.41.5- SCALE IN FEET SCALE IN FEET SCALE: 1/4" I. -C' SCALE: 3/E". SEcric)Al@l RECORD DRAWING IT IS THE RESPONSIBILITY OF THE CONTRACTOR TO FAMILIARIZE HIMSELF WITH THE EXMING SITE CONDITIONS IN COMPARISON WITH THESE PLANS TO INSURE ADEQUATE PERFORMANCE OF WORK AND ADEQUATE COST ESTIMATION FOR BIDDING PURPOSES. 8.3.110 DESIGNED RECORD ORAMINS RAP DROWN AND $9,0 NNVINireN Of RECORD DATE REVISION BY CHECKED r-leS O Briley, Wild & Associates, Inc. consuimnc EfIGIfIEER3 SOD ponnEns 0,',d Beath - CINOIWiltet • Brod Florida MARSHALL STREET ADVANCED POLLUTION CONTROL FACILITY EXISTING FINAL TANKS - REMOVALS SECTIONS CLEARWATER. FLORIDA DATE, Awl OKI PRO!. NO, 1170116-11 SHEET Na,37 IV 183 12823 COY OF CLEARWATER FLORIDA MARSHALL STREET IDVANCED POLLUTION CONTROL FACILITY 1'-11 1/2' NEW, SECTION OR y CETNL NUMBER l SHEET NUMBER ON *ICH NEW, [BEND FIXED JOINT FJ -SEE DETAIL FB -10A SHEET 23 GUDE SUPPORT GS1 -SFE DETAIL SUP -1 SHEET 22 ^ 9' SSI WE MEMBRANE DIFFUSER ASSEMBLY ( ) -SEE DETAIL F6-3 SHEET 23 REMOVABLE END CAP ASSETIBLY U -SFE DETAIL FB -12A SHEET 23 PRESSURE MOMIORING ASSEMBLY I -SEE DETAIL 11I -1K SHEET 25 PURGE ASSEMBLY ▪ -SEE DETAIL FURGE-24 SHEET 24 FOR TYPICAL NR DISIRBUTOR SECTION -SEE DETAIL FB -22C SHEET 23 GRD TYPE 2 2 -TANKS 2 -GRIDS PER TANK 7 -AIR DISTRIBUTORS PER GRID 37 -HOLDERS PER AIR DISTRIBUTOR 259 -HOLDERS PER GRD 37 -DIFFUSERS PER NR DISTRIBUTOR 259-06RISERS PER GRID 1036 -TOTAL DIFFUSERS INSTALLED FOR THIS KBD TYPE GRID TYPE 2 AERATION TANK 4 2 REgWRED AS SHOWN AERATION TANK 5 2 REQUIRED MIRROR IMAGE PLAN VIEW® NOTE SUPPORT SPACING Every attempt has been made to insure locational dimensions of the supports are correct. However, after one line of air distributor anchors for any grid type have been installed, the locations must be checked for proper clearances by installing the supplied air headers. Spacing between lines must be checked for fit with the cross manifold and drain line. My discrepancies or interferences must be brought to the attention of SANTTNRE prior to further installation. The actual support anchor locations must be Indexed from the centerline of the manifold. The actual accumulative dimensional error from the manifold to the anchor bolt must not exceed ± 3/4'. MILNIMLIIVZIWEIFAUSESENTION "" AERATION TANKS 4 d: 5 GRID TYPE 2 PUN NEW ITT Corporation SANITAI err eM =COM ams Air 'r 108-7001S e7' c pF . ▪ s. sIs • E-7 25 ( 12-625 ) '_ _ _ - _• 16, ®� 1 {• I I h a DROPLEG i nen wire 0 L0000000000000004300000000000d00000000000 0 I-PMPoSo6 MIz 000000000000000000000000000 00x0000000000000-0700101 d0000000:000 0000000000000000000000000 I 00000000000000 0 13-71 ) 0000000000000000001000x0000 000000000000000 00000000000000000100000000 I 00000000000000000010 Oa00000Ox000000 0 000 0 0000000000 0 0 0 0 Y31 a a 21 5 NEW, SECTION OR y CETNL NUMBER l SHEET NUMBER ON *ICH NEW, [BEND FIXED JOINT FJ -SEE DETAIL FB -10A SHEET 23 GUDE SUPPORT GS1 -SFE DETAIL SUP -1 SHEET 22 ^ 9' SSI WE MEMBRANE DIFFUSER ASSEMBLY ( ) -SEE DETAIL F6-3 SHEET 23 REMOVABLE END CAP ASSETIBLY U -SFE DETAIL FB -12A SHEET 23 PRESSURE MOMIORING ASSEMBLY I -SEE DETAIL 11I -1K SHEET 25 PURGE ASSEMBLY ▪ -SEE DETAIL FURGE-24 SHEET 24 FOR TYPICAL NR DISIRBUTOR SECTION -SEE DETAIL FB -22C SHEET 23 GRD TYPE 2 2 -TANKS 2 -GRIDS PER TANK 7 -AIR DISTRIBUTORS PER GRID 37 -HOLDERS PER AIR DISTRIBUTOR 259 -HOLDERS PER GRD 37 -DIFFUSERS PER NR DISTRIBUTOR 259-06RISERS PER GRID 1036 -TOTAL DIFFUSERS INSTALLED FOR THIS KBD TYPE GRID TYPE 2 AERATION TANK 4 2 REgWRED AS SHOWN AERATION TANK 5 2 REQUIRED MIRROR IMAGE PLAN VIEW® NOTE SUPPORT SPACING Every attempt has been made to insure locational dimensions of the supports are correct. However, after one line of air distributor anchors for any grid type have been installed, the locations must be checked for proper clearances by installing the supplied air headers. Spacing between lines must be checked for fit with the cross manifold and drain line. My discrepancies or interferences must be brought to the attention of SANTTNRE prior to further installation. The actual support anchor locations must be Indexed from the centerline of the manifold. The actual accumulative dimensional error from the manifold to the anchor bolt must not exceed ± 3/4'. MILNIMLIIVZIWEIFAUSESENTION "" AERATION TANKS 4 d: 5 GRID TYPE 2 PUN NEW ITT Corporation SANITAI err eM =COM ams Air 'r 108-7001S e7' c pF . ▪ s. sIs • E-7 25 CITY OF CLEARWATER FLORIDA MARSHALL STREET 1DVANCED POLLUTION CONTROL FACILE!) nal • • • • = 1B'-4• e. 1 I I p DROPIEG •�-I T a7 77 W/ TAPS) /O `.V0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Opo 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Oat' (((7W101--MPMPo7OBMR ( )0 0 o 0 0a O 0 04 I 1300 oa o 0 00 0 0 0[110 o 0 1 29-71 ) $C 7001-MP10 MR, CO 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 O 0�0 O O 0a O O 00 O O 0{4), 7001-MFIN rn 0 0 Or 0 0 00 0 0 0a I 1300 Oc 0 0 00 0 0 0130 2 i 4 - Y3 °7 16 L3 4 1 8 • 2 :Y aY3 Yd _ 15 NEW, BECTON OR DETAL NUMBER 2 SHEET NUMBER ON *ICH NEW, SECTION OR DETAIL I FOURS LEGEND MED JOINT FJ -SEE OETML FR -101 SHEET 23 GIME SUPPORT G51 -SEE OETML SUP -1 SHEET 22 O 9• SSB WE MEINRNfK DIFFUSER ASSEMBLY -SEE DETAIL FB -3 SHEET 23 REMOVABLE END CAP ASSEMBLY ❑ -SEE DETAIL FR -12A SHEET 23 PURGE ASSEMBLY -SEE DETAIL PURGE -5 SHEET 24 PRESSURE MONRORNG ASSEMBLY I -SEE DETAIL PIA -1K SHEET 25 FOR TYPAL AR MIRRUTOR SECTION -SEE DETAIL FB -22C SHEET 23 GRA) TYPE 3 8 -TANKS 1 -GRID PER TAM( 4 -Alt DISTRIBUTORS PER GRID 17 -HOLDERS PER NR DISTRIBUTOR 88 -HOLDERS PER (RID 17 -DIFFUSERS PER MR DISTRIBUTOR 88-ORFUSEtS PER GRID 544 -TOTAL DIFFUSERS INSTALLED FOR THIS GRID TYPE NOTE: SUPPORT SPACING GRID TYPE 3- ZONE A AERATION TANKS 7, 9, 11 & 13 4 REQUIRED AS SHOWN AERATION TANKS 6, 8, 10 & 12 4 REQUIRED MRROR IMAGE PLAN VIEW 14 Every attempt hoe been made to insure locational dimensions of the supports are correct. However, after one line of air distributor anchors for any grid type have been Installed, the locations must be checked for proper clearances by installing the supplied air headers. Spacing between lines must be checked for fit with the cross manifold and drain line. My discrepancies or Interferences must be brought to the attention of SANITAIRE prior to further installation. The actual support anchor locations must be indexed from the centerline of the manifold. The actual accumulative dlmenetonal error from the manifold to the anchor bait must not exceed ± 3/4•. AERATION TANKS 6-13 GRID TYPE 3- ZONE A PLAN NEW 0 snN rn Re wow oew. swami wan ITT Corporation ,ww s ON Q011•L a.08-70015 pQ' E-9 OF APPENDIX—OTHER PROJECT DOCUMENTATION BYPASSING CONCEPT APPENDIX 2 Updated 6/20/2018 Conceptual Bypassing Layout Phase I Ex. Weirs (10 total) Ex. Slide Gates (30 total Bypass Equipment 13 Aeration Basin # Aff Flow Arrow Offline Channel *Bypass layout and phasing will be submitted by the Contractor for approval prior to installation. Above is included for reference only. Conceptual Bypassing Layout Phase II Block off channel Block off channel Ex. Weirs (10 total) Ex. Slide Gates (30 total) El Bypass Equipment 13 Aeration Basin # Flow Arrow Offline Channel *Bypass layout and phasing will be submitted by the Contractor for approval prior to installation. Above is Included for reference only. Conceptual Bypassing Layout Phase III Block off channel Ex. Weirs (10 total) Ex. Slide Gates (30 total) 13 Aeration Basin # Offline Channel *Bypass layout and phasing will be submitted by the Contractor for approval prior to installation. Above is included for reference only. • SECTION V • • CONTRACT DOCUMENTS Table of Contents PUBLIC CONSTRUCTION BOND 1 CONTRACT 3 CONSENT OF SURETY TO FINAL PAYMENT 7 PROPOSAL/BID BOND 8 AFFIDAVIT 9 NON -COLLUSION AFFIDAVIT 10 PROPOSAL 11 CITY OF CLEARWATER ADDENDUM SHEET 13 BIDDER'S PROPOSAL 14 SCRUTINIZED COMPANIES AND BUSINESS OPERATIONS WITH CUBA AND SYRIA CERTIFICATION FORM 15 SCRUTINIZED COMPANIES THAT BOYCOTT ISRAEL LIST CERTIFICATION FORM 16 SECTION V Page i Updated: 5/4/2020 • • • SECTION V — Contract Documents Bond No.: PUBLIC CONSTRUCTION BOND (1) This bond is given to comply with § 255.05, Florida Statutes, and any action instituted by a claimant under this bond for payment must be in accordance with the notice and time limitation provisions in subsections (2) and (10). Pursuant to § 255.05(1)(b), Florida Statutes, "Before commencing the work or before recommencing the work after a default or abandonment, the contractor shall provide to the public entity a certified copy of the recorded bond. Notwithstanding the terms of the contract or any other law governing prompt payment for construction services, the public entity may not make a payment to the contractor until the contractor has complied with this paragraph." CONTRACTOR SURETY OWNER Poole & Kent Travelers Casualty and Surety Company of Florida Company of America 1715 W. Lemon Street One Tower Square, Tampa, FL 33606 Hartford, CT 06183 (813) 251-2438 (860) 277-0111 City of Clearwater Engineering 100 S. Myrtle Avenue Clearwater, FL 33756 (727) 562-4750 PROJECT NAME: MARSHALL STREET WRF PROCESS CONTROL GATE REPAIRS (FDEP) PROJECT NO.: 18 -0047 -UT PROJECT DESCRIPTION: Design improvements include the replacement of the existing slide gates within the aeration basins 4-13. While the basins are isolated and drained for gate replacement, the Contractor will remove all accumulated grit in the aeration basins, replace damaged or missing elements of the diffused air system and make structural repairs as noted on the plans. BY THIS BOND, We, Poole & Kent Company of Florida, as Contractor, and Travelers Casualty and Surety Company of America, a corporation, as Surety, are bound to the City of Clearwater, Florida, herein called Owner, in the sum of $3,161,578.20, for payment of which we bind ourselves, our heirs, personal representatives, successors, and assigns, jointly and severally. THE CONDITION OF THIS BOND is that if Contractor: 1. Performs the contract dated , between Contractor and Owner for construction of Marshall Street WRF Process Control Gate Repairs (FDEP), the contract documents being made a part of this bond by reference (which include the Advertisement for Bids, Proposal, Contract, Surety Bond, Instructions to Bidders, General Conditions, Plans, Technical Specifications and Appendix, and such alterations as may be made in said Plans and Specifications as therein provided for), at the times and in the manner prescribed in the contract; and 2. Promptly makes payments to all claimants, as defined in Section 255.05(1), Florida Statutes, supplying Contractor with labor, materials, or supplies, used directly or indirectly by Contractor in the prosecution of the work provided for in the contract; and SECTION V Page 1 of 16 Updated: 5/4/2020 • • • SECTION V — Contract Documents Bond No.: PUBLIC CONSTRUCTION BOND (2) 3. Pays Owner all losses, damages, expenses, costs, and attorney's fees, including appellate proceedings, that Owner sustains because of a default by Contractor under the contract; and 4. To the limits of § 725.06(2), Florida Statutes, shall indemnify and hold harmless Owner, their officers and employees, from liabilities, damages, losses and costs, including, but not limited to, reasonable attorney's fees, to the extent caused by the negligence, recklessness, or intentional wrongful misconduct of Contractor and persons employed or utilized by Contractor in the performance of the construction contract; and 5. Performs the guarantee of all work and materials furnished under the contract for the time specified in the contract, then this bond is void; otherwise it remains in full force. 6. Any action instituted by a claimant under this bond for payment must be in accordance with the notice and time limitation provisions in Section 255.05(2), Florida Statutes. 7. Any changes in or under the contract documents and compliance or noncompliance with any formalities connected with the contract or the changes does not affect Surety's obligation under this bond, and Surety does hereby waive notice of any such change, extension of time, alteration or addition to the terms of the contract or to the work or to the specifications. IN TESTIMONY WHEREOF, witness the hands and seals of the parties hereto this day of , 20 • (If sole Ownership or Partnership, two (2) Witnesses required). (If Corporation, Secretary only will attest and affix seal). POOLE & KENT COMPANY OF FLORIDA By: Title: Print Name: WITNESS: WITNESS: Corporate Secretary or Witness Print Name: Print Name: (affix corporate seal) (Corporate Surety) By: ATTORNEY-IN-FACT Print Name: (affix corporate seal) (Power of Attorney must be attached) SECTION V Page 2 of 16 Updated: 5/4/2020 • • • SECTION V — Contract Documents CONTRACT (1) This CONTRACT made and entered into thisday of I kd- , 2(} by and between the City of Clearwater, Florida, a municipal corporation, hereinafter designated as the "City", and Poole & Kent Company of Florida, of the City of Tampa, County of Hillsborough and State of Florida, hereinafter designated as the "Contractor". [Or, if out of state:] NOT APPLICABLE This CONTRACT made and entered into this day of , 20 by and between the City of Clearwater, Florida, a municipal corporation, hereinafter designated as the "City", and , a/an (State) Corporation authorized to do business in the State of Florida, of the City of County of and State of , hereinafter designated as the "Contractor". WITNESSETH: That the parties to this contract each in consideration of the undertakings, promises and agreements on the part of the other herein contained, do hereby undertake, promise and agree as follows: The Contractor, and his or its successors, assigns, executors or administrators, in consideration of the sums of money as herein after set forth to be paid by the City and to the Contractor, shall and will at their own cost and expense perform all labor, furnish all materials, tools and equipment for the following: PROJECT NAME: MARSHALL STREET WRF PROCESS CONTROL GATE REPAIRS (FDEP) PROJECT NO.: 18 -0047 -UT in the amount of $3,16__1,578.20 In accordance with such proposal and technical supplemental specifications and such other special provisions and drawings, if any, which will be submitted by the City, together with any advertisement, instructions to bidders, general conditions, technical specifications, proposal and bond, which may be hereto attached, and any drawings if any, which may be herein referred to, are hereby made a part of this contract, and all of said work to be performed and completed by the contractor and its successors and assigns shall be fully completed in a good and workmanlike manner to the satisfaction of the City. If the Contractor should fail to comply with any of the terms, conditions, provisions or stipulations as contained herein within the time specified for completion of the work to be performed by the Contractor, then the City, may at its option, avail itself of any or all remedies provided on its behalf and shall have the right to proceed to complete such work as Contractor is obligated to perform in accordance with the provisions as contained herein. SECTION V Page 3 of 16 Updated: 5/4/2020 • • • SECTION V — Contract Documents CONTRACT (2) THE CONTRACTOR AND HIS OR ITS SUCCESSORS AND ASSIGNS DOES HEREBY AGREE TO ASSUME THE DEFENSE OF ANY LEGAL ACTION WHICH MAY BE BROUGHT AGAINST THE CITY AS A RESULT OF THE CONTRACTOR'S ACTIVITIES ARISING OUT OF THIS CONTRACT AND FURTHERMORE, IN CONSIDERATION OF THE TERMS, STIPULATIONS AND CONDITIONS AS CONTAINED HEREIN, AGREES TO HOLD THE CITY FREE AND HARMLESS FROM ANY AND ALL CLAIMS FOR DAMAGES, COSTS OF SUITS, JUDGMENTS OR DECREES RESULTING FROM ANY CLAIMS MADE UNDER THIS CONTRACT AGAINST THE CITY OR THE CONTRACTOR OR THE CONTRACTOR'S SUB CONTRACTORS, AGENTS, SERVANTS OR EMPLOYEES RESULTING FROM ACTIVITIES BY THE AFOREMENTIONED CONTRACTOR, SUB CONTRACTOR, AGENT SERVANTS OR EMPLOYEES, TO THE LIMITS OF § 725.06(2). In addition to the foregoing provisions, the Contractor agrees to conform to the following requirements: In connection with the performance of work under this contract, the Contractor agrees not to discriminate against any employee or applicant for employment because of race, sex, religion, color, or national origin. The aforesaid provision shall include, but not be limited to, the following: employment, upgrading, demotion, or transfer; recruitment or recruitment advertising; lay off or termination; rates of pay or other forms of compensation; and selection for training, including apprenticeship. The Contractor agrees to post hereafter in conspicuous places, available for employees or applicants for employment, notices to be provided by the contracting officer setting forth the provisions of the non-discrimination clause. The Contractor further agrees to insert the foregoing provisions in all contracts hereunder, including contracts or agreements with labor unions and/or worker's representatives, except sub -contractors for standard commercial supplies or raw materials. It is mutually agreed between the parties hereto that time is of the essence of this contract, and in the event that the work to be performed by the Contractor is not completed within the time stipulated herein, it is then further agreed that the City may deduct from such sums or compensation as may be due to the Contractor the sum of $1,000.00 per day for each day that the work to be performed by the Contractor remains incomplete beyond the time limit specified herein, which sum of $1,000.00 per day shall only and solely represent damages which the City has sustained by reason of the failure of the Contractor to complete the work within the time stipulated, it being further agreed that this sum is not to be construed as a penalty but is only to be construed as liquidated damages for failure of the Contractor to complete and perform all work within the time period as specified in this contract. It is further mutually agreed between the City and the Contractor that if, any time after the execution of this contract and the public construction bond which is attached hereto for the faithful performance of the terms and conditions as contained herein by the Contractor, that the City shall at any time deem the surety or sureties upon such public construction bond to be unsatisfactory or if, for any reason, the said bond ceases to be adequate in amount to cover the performance of the work the Contractor shall, at his or its own expense, within ten (10) days after receipt of written notice from the City to do so, furnish an additional bond or bonds in such term and amounts and with such surety or sureties as shall be satisfactory to the City. If such an event occurs, no further payment shall be made to the Contractor under the terms and provisions of this contract until such new or additional security bond guaranteeing the faithful performance of the work under the terms hereof shall be completed and furnished to the City in a form satisfactory to it. SECTION V Page 4 of 16 Updated: 5/4/2020 • • • SECTION V — Contract Documents CONTRACT (3) In addition to all other contract requirements as provided by law, the contractor executing this agreement agrees to comply with public records law. IF THE CONTRACTOR HAS QUESTIONS REGARDING THE APPLICATION OF CHAPTER 119, FLORIDA STATUTES, THE CONTRACTORS DUTY TO PROVIDE PUBLIC RECORDS RELATING TO THIS CONTRACT. CONTACT THE CUSTODIAN OF PUBLIC RECORDS AT 727-562-4092, Rosemarie .Call(a,myclearwater.com, 600 Cleveland St. Clearwater, FL 33756 The contractor's agreement to comply with public records law applies specifically to: a) Keep and maintain public records required by the City of Clearwater (hereinafter "public agency") to perform the service being provided by the contractor hereunder. b) Upon request from the public agency's custodian of public records, provide the public agency with a copy of the requested records or allow the records to be inspected or copied within a reasonable time at a cost that does not exceed the cost provided for in Chapter 119, Florida Statutes, as may be amended from time to time, or as otherwise provided by law. c) Ensure that the public records that are exempt or confidential and exempt from public records disclosure requirements are not disclosed except as authorized by law for the duration of the contract term and following completion of the contract if the contractor does not transfer the records to the public agency. d) Upon completion of the contract, transfer, at no cost, to the public agency all public records in possession of the contractor or keep and maintain public records required by the public agency to perform the service. If the contractor transfers all public records to the public agency upon completion of the contract, the contractor shall destroy any duplicate public records that are exempt or confidential and exempt from public records disclosure requirements. If the contractor keeps and maintains public records upon completion of the contract, the contractor shall meet all applicable requirements for retaining public records. All records stored electronically must be provided to the public agency, upon request from the public agency's custodian of public records, in a format that is compatible with the information technology systems of the public agency. e) A request to inspect or copy public records relating to a public agency's contract for services must be made directly to the public agency. If the public agency does not possess the requested records, the public agency shall immediately notify the contractor of the request and the contractor must provide the records to the public agency or allow the records to be inspected or copied within a reasonable time. f) The contractor hereby acknowledges and agrees that if the contractor does not comply with the public agency's request for records, the public agency shall enforce the contract provisions in accordance with the contract. g) A contractor who fails to provide the public records to the public agency within a reasonable time may be subject to penalties under Section 119.10, Florida Statutes. h) If a civil action is filed against a contractor to compel production of public records relating to a public agency's contract for services, the court shall assess and award against the contractor the reasonable costs of enforcement, including reasonable attorney fees, if: 1. The court determines that the contractor unlawfully refused to comply with the public records request within a reasonable time; and SECTION V Page 5 of 16 Updated: 5/4/2020 • • • SECTION V — Contract Documents CONTRACT (4) 2. At least 8 business days before filing the action, the plaintiff provided written notice of the public records request, including a statement that the contractor has not complied with the request, to the public agency and to the contractor. i) A notice complies with subparagraph (h)2. if it is sent to the public agency's custodian of public records and to the contractor at the contractor's address listed on its contract with the public agency or to the contractor's registered agent. Such notices must be sent by common carrier delivery service or by registered, Global Express Guaranteed, or certified mail, with postage or shipping paid by the sender and with evidence of delivery, which may be in an electronic format. j) A contractor who complies with a public records request within 8 business days after the notice is sent is not liable for the reasonable costs of enforcement. IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the parties to the agreement have hereunto set their hands and seals and have executed this Agreement, the day and year first above written. CITY OF CLEARWATER IN PINELLAS COUNTY, FLORIDA By: 6'. Slooft.04? Jon P. Jennings City Manager Countersigned: By: Attest: Fthnk Hibbard ayor Contrr ctor must indicate whether: ✓ Corporation, Partnership, Assistant City Attorney Company, or Individual R16 tafse fea-P--T 6,.'�Oif4.-. 6/c Al.a0Af.:� (Contract Print Name: Title: The person signing shall, in his own handwriting, sign the Principal's name, his own name, and his title; where the person is signing for a Corporation, he must, by Affidavit, show his authority to bind the Corporation — provide Affidavit. SECTION V Page 6 of 16 Updated: 5/4/2020 SECTION V — Contract Documents • CONSENT OF SURETY TO FINAL PAYMENT • • TO OWNER: City of Clearwater PROJECT NAME: MARSHALL STREET WRF PROCESS CONTROL GATE REPAIRS (FDEP) Engineering PROJECT NO.: 18 -0047 -UT 100 S. Myrtle Ave. CONTRACT DATE: [ 1 Clearwater, FL 33756 BOND NO.: [ 1, recorded in O.R. Book [ 1, Page [ 1, of the Public Records of Pinellas County, Florida. CONTRACTOR: POOLE & KENT COMPANY OF FLORIDA Pursuant to § 255.05(11), Florida Statutes, and in accordance with the provisions of the Contract between the Owner and the Contractor as indicated above, the: Travelers Casualty and Surety Company of America One Tower Square, Hartford, CT 06183 on bond of Poole & Kent Company of Florida 1715 W. Lemon Street Tampa, FL 33606 ,SURETY, ,CONTRACTOR, hereby approves of the final payment to the Contractor, and agrees that final payment to the Contractor shall not relieve Surety of any of its obligations to City of Clearwater Engineering 100 S. Myrtle Ave. Clearwater, FL 33756 as set forth in said Surety's bond. IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the Surety has hereunto set its hand this day of Attest: (Seal): ,OWNER, (Surety) (Signature of authorized representative) (Printed name and title) SECTION V Page 7 of 16 Updated: 5/4/2020 • • • SECTION V —Contract Documents PROPOSAL/BID BOND (Not to be filled out if a certified check is submitted) KNOWN ALL MEN BY THESE PRESENTS: That we, the undersigned, Poole & Kent Company of Florida 1715 W. Lemon Street, Tampa, FL 33606 as Contractor, and Travelers Casualty and Surety Company of America as Surety, whose address is One Tower Square, Hartford CT 06183 , are held and firmly bound unto the City of Clearwater, Florida, in the sum of Ten Percent of the Amount Bid Dollars ($ 10% of Amt. Bid ) (being a minimum of 10% of Contractor's total bid amount) for the payment of which, well and truly to be made, we hereby jointly and severally bind ourselves, our heirs, executors, administrators, successors and assigns. The condition of the above obligation is such that if the attached Proposal of Poole & Kent Company of Florida as Contractor, and Travelers Casualty and Surety Company of America as Surety, for work specified as: Marshall Street WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) (18 -0047 -UT) all as stipulated in said Proposal, by doing all work incidental thereto, in accordance with the plans and specifications provided herefor, all within Pinellas County, is accepted and the contract awarded to the above named bidder, and the said bidder shall within ten days after notice of said award enter into a contract, in writing, and furnish the required Public Construction Bond with surety or sureties to be approved by the City Manager, this obligation shall be void, otherwise the same shall be in full force and virtue by law and the full amount of this Proposal/Bid Bond will be paid to the City as stipulated or liquidated damages. Principal must indicate whether: x Corporation, Partnership, Company, or Individual Signed this 16th day of March , 20 22 . Poole & Kent Company of Florida Contra Principal Patrick H. Carr By: President & CEO Pi_ `CCS Title Travelers Casualty and Surety Company of America. Surety Camille Maitland, Attorney -In -Fact Non Resident License #W012268 The person signing shall, in his own handwriting, sign the Principal's name, his own name, and his title; where the person is signing for a Corporation, he must, by Affidavit, show his authority to bind the Corporation — provide Affidavit. SECTION V Page 8 of 17 Updated: 5/4/2020 FLORIDA DEPARTMENT OF FINANCIAL SERVICES CAMILLE M MAITLAND License Number : W012268 Non Resident Insurance License Issue Date • 0920 - NONRES GEN LINES (PROP & CAS) 09/03/2010 Please Note: NOTICE - This non-resident license is limited to the classes of insurance reflected above and is further limited to ONLY those classes of insurance for which you are licensed in your home state. A licensee may only transact insurance with an active appointment by an eligible insurer or employer If you are acting as a surplus lines agent, public adjuster, or reinsurance intermediary manager/broker, you should have an appointment recorded in your own name on file with the Department. If you are unsure of your license status you should contact the Florida Department of Financial Services immediately. This license will expire if more than 48 months elapse without an appointment for each class of insurance listed. If such expiration occurs, the individual will be required to re -qualify as a first-time applicant. If this license was obtained by passing a licensure examination offered by the Florida Department of Financial Services, the licensee is required to comply with continuing education requirements contained in 626.2815 or 648.385, Florida Statutes. A licensee may track their continuing education requirements completed or needed in their MyProfile account at https://dice.fldfs.com. To validate the accuracy of this license you may review the individual license record under "Licensee Search" on the Florida Department of Financial Services website at http://www.MyFloridaCFO.com/Division/Agents /014-44 Jeff Atwater Chief Financial Officer State of Florida • • TRAVELERS Travelers Casualty and Surety Company of America Travelers Casualty and Surety Company St. Paul Fire and Marine Insurance Company POWER OF ATTORNEY KNOW ALL MEN BY THESE PRESENTS: That Travelers Casualty and. Surety Company of America, Travelers Casualty and Surety Company, and St. Paul Frye and Marine Insurance Company are corporations duly organized under the laws of the State of Connecticut (herein collectively called the "Companies"), and that the Companies do hereby make, constitute and appoint Camino Maitland of UNIONDALE , New York , their true and lawful Attomey(s)-in-Fact to sign, execute, seal and acknowledge any and all bonds, recognizances, conditional undertakings and other writings obligatory in the nature thereof on behalf of the Companies in their business of guaranteeing the fidelity of persons, guaranteeing the performance of contracts and executing or guaranteeing bonds and undertakings required or permitted in any actions or proceedings allowed by law. IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the Companies have caused this instrument to be signed, and their corporate seals to be hereto affixed, this 21st day of Apri, 2021. State of Connecticut By: City of Hartford ss. Robert L. Ra nior Vice President On this the 21st day of Apra, 2021, before me personally appeared Robert L Raney, who acknowledged himself to be the Senior Vice President of each of the Companies, and that he, as such, being authorized so to do, executed the foregoing instrument for the purposes therein contained by signing on behalf of said Companies by himself as a duly authorized officer. IN WITNESS WHEREOF, I hereunto set my hand and official seal. My Commission expires the 30th day of June, 2026 This Power of Attorney is granted under and by the authority of the following resolutions adopted by the Boards of Directors of each of the Companies, which resolutions are now in full force and effect, reading as follows: RESOLVED, that the Chatmman, the President, any Vice Chairman, any Executive Vice President, any Senior Vice President, any Vice President, any Second Vice President, the Treasurer, any Assistant Treasurer, the Corporate Secretary or any Assistant Secretary may appoint Attorneys -in -Fact and Agents to act for and on behalf of the Company and may give such appointee such authority as his or her certificate of authority may prescribe to sign with the Company's name and seal with the Company's seal bonds, recognizances, contracts of indemnity, and other writings obligatory in the nature of a bond, recognizance, or conditional undertaking, and any of said officers or the Board of Directors at any time may remove any such appointee and revoke the power given him or her, and it is FURTHER RESOLVED, that the Chairman, the President, any Vice Chairman, any Executive Vice President, any Senior Vice President or any Vice President may delegate all or any part of the foregoing authority to one or more officers or employees of this Company, provided that each such delegation is in writing and a copy thereof is filed in the office of the Secretary; and it is FURTHER RESOLVED, that any bond, recognizance, contract of indemnity, or writing obligatory in the nature of a bond, recognizance, or conditional undertaking shall be valid and binding upon the Company when (a) signed by the President, any Vice Chairman, any Executive Vice President, any Senior Vice President or any Vice President, any Second Vice President, the Treasurer, any Assistant Treasurer, the Corporate Secretary or any Assistant Secretary and duly attested and sealed with the Company's seal by a Secretary or Assistant Secretary; or (b) duty executed (under seal, if required) by one or more Attorneys -in -Fact and Agents pursuant to the power prescribed in his or her certificate or their certificates of authority or by one or more Company officers pursuant to a written delegation of authority; and it is FURTHER RESOLVED, that the signature of each of the following officers: President, any Executive Vice President, any Senior Vice President, any Vice President, any Assistant Vice President, any Secretary, any Assistant Secretary, and the seal of the Company may be affixed by facsimile to any Power of Attorney or to any certificate relating thereto appointing Resident Vice Presidents, Resident Assistant Secretaries or Attorneys -in - Fact for purposes only of executing and attesting bonds and undertakings and other writings obligatory in the nature thereof, and any such Power of Attorney or certificate bearing such facsimfie signature or facsimile seal shall be valid and binding upon the Company and any such power so executed and certified by such facsimile signature and facsimile seal shall be valid and binding on the Company in the future with respect to any bond or understanding to which it is attached. I, Kevin E. Hughes, the undersigned, Assistant Secretary of each of the Companies, do hereby certify that the above and foregoing is a true and correct copy of the Power of Attorney executed by said Companies, which remains in full force and effect. Dated this 16th day of March .2022 • Kevin E. Hughes�Secretary To verity the asthm hddty of this Power ofAttorney, please callus at 1-800-421-38110. Please refer to the above-nervedA y(s) M -Pact anal me ddtall5 of the bond to whldr !lots PowerofAttorney Is attached. • State of On this • Florida TRAVELERS CASUALTY AND SURETY COMPANY OF AMERICA , County of HARTFORD, CT 06183 PRINCIPAL'S ACKNOWLEDGMENT Miami -Dade 1ss. 27th day of April in the year 20 22 , before me, the undersigned, personally appeared Patrick H. Carr personally known to me or proved to me on the basis of satisfactory evidence to be the individual whose name is subscribed to the within instrument and acknowledged to me that he/she executed the same in his/her capacity, and that by his/her signature on the instrument, the individual, or the person upon behalf of which the individual acted, executed the instrument. State of NEW YORK On this I day of SURETY COMPANY'S ACKNOWLEDGMEN , County of NASSAU ;ss. •t""•"! ; WENDY CAMPBELL .*; MY COMMISSIONS HH 062370 oi EXPIRES: February 1, 2025 ."4:Fi FSO•' Bonded Tbru Nott'/ Public Underwear' IAALAn in the year 20 ZZ , before me, the undersigned, personally appeared • Notary Public personally known to me, and who, being by me duly sworn, did depose and say: That he/she resides in Nassau County, New York ; that he/she is Attorney -in -Fact of TRAVELERS CASUALTY AND SURETY COMPANY OF AMERICA, the corporation described in and which executed the within instrument; that he/she knows the corporate seal of said Company; that the seal affixed to said instrument is such corporate seal; and that he/she signed said instrument as Attorney -in -Fact by authority of the Board of Directors of said Company; and affiant did further depose and say that the Superintendent of the State of New York Department of Financial Services has, pursuant to Section 1111 of the New York Insurance Law, issued to TRAVELERS CASUALTY AND SURETY COMPANY OF AMERICA his/her certificate that said Company is qualified to become and be accepted as surety or guarantor on all bonds, undertakings, recognizances, guaranties, and other obligations required or permitted by law; and that such certificate has not been revoked. TRAVELERS CASUALTY AND SURETY COMPANY OF AMERICA HARTFORD, CONNECTICUT 06183 FINANCIAL STATEMENT AS OF DECEMBER 31 2020 AS FILED IN THE STATE OF NEW YORK CAPITAL STOCK $ 6,480,000 Notary Public NELLY RENCHIWICH M Notary Public -State of New York No. 01RE6218158 Qualified in Nassau County Commission Expires March 1, 2026 ASSETS LIABILITIES & SURPLUS CASH AND INVESTED CASH BONDS STOCKS INVESTMENT INCOME DUE AND ACCRUED OTHER INVESTED ASSETS PREMIUM BALANCES NET DEFERRED TAXASSET REINSURANCE RECOVERABLE RECEIVABLES FROM PARENT, SUBSIDIARIES AND AFFILIATES OTHER ASSETS •TOTALASSETS S 239,403,348 3,831.156.861 109,074,035 36,856,709 4,970,512 277,653,788 55,188.715 32,553,518 34,876.347 4,155,794 S 4,625, ':9,627 UNEARNED PREMIUMS LOSSES LOSS ADJUSTMENT EXPENSES COMMISSIONS TAXES, LICENSES AND FEES OTHER EXPENSES CURRENT FEDERAL AND FOREIGN INCOME TAXES REMITTANCES AND ITEMS NOT ALLOCATED AMOUNTS WITHHELD / RETAINED BY COMPANY FOR OTHERS POLICYHOLDER DIVIDENDS PROVISION FOR REINSURANCE ADVANCE PREMIUM CEDED REINSURANCE NET PREMIUMS PAYABLE RETROACTIVE REINSURANCE RESERVE ASSUMED OTHER ACCRUED EXPENSES AND LIABILITIES TOTAL LIABILITIES CAPITAL STOCK PAID IN SURPLUS OTHER SURPLUS TOTAL SURPLUS TO POLICYHOLDERS TOTAL LIABILITIES & SURPLUS $ 1,121,070,380 1,003 200 666 163,346,678 48,805,693 13,561,421 42,506,558 4,865,484 8,646,391 42,228,250 12,353,304 7,930.280 1,867,512 63,102,972 800,763 568,668 $ 2,534,855,020 $ 6,480,000 433,803,760 1,650,750,847 S 2,091,034,607 $ 4,625,:':9,627 • SECTION V — Contract Documents AFFIDAVIT (To be filled in and executed if the bidder is a corporation) STATE OF FLORIDA COUNTY OF Miami -Dade David A. Strickland , being duly sworn, deposes and says that he/she is Assistant Secretary of Poole & Kent Company of Florida a corporation organized and existing under and by virtue of the laws of the State of Florida, and having its principal office at: • • 1781 N.W. North River Drive (Street & Number) Miami Miami -Dade (City) (County) FL (State) Affiant further says that he is familiar with the records, minute books and by-laws of Poole & Kent Company of Florida (Name of Corporation) Affiant further says that of the corporation, Patrick H. Carr (Officer's Name) is President & CEO (Title) is duly authorized to sign the Proposal for City of Clearwater or said corporation by virtue of **See attached Certificate of Assistant Secretary (state whether a provision of by laws or a Resolution Board of Directors. If by Resolut' Sworn to before me this 27th day of April of David A. Strickland, Assistant Secretary Affiant .1474Z,g, WENDYCAMPBELL *_ •, MY COMMISSION # HH 062370 .:' EXPIRES: February 1, 2025 Bonded TMU Notary PKC Underwriters I e 0 22 Notary Public Wendy Campbell Type/print/stamp name of Notary HH 062370 Title or rank, and Serial No., if any SECTION V Page 9 of 17 Updated: 5/4/2020 • CERTIFICATE OF ASSISTANT SECRETARY OF POOLE & KENT COMPANY OF FLORIDA The undersigned, David A. Strickland, certifies that he is the duly elected, qualified and acting Assistant Secretary of Poole & Kent Company of Florida, a corporation duly organized and existing under the laws of Delaware with a business address of 1781 N. W. North River Drive, Miami, FL 33125 and that as Secretary, he is the keeper of the corporate records and seal of said Corporation. • 2022. • The undersigned further certifies: 1. Attached hereto as Exhibit A is a true, correct and complete copy of resolutions adopted upon written consent of the sole director of this Corporation dated as of April 12, 2022; and said resolutions do not contravene any provision of the certificate of incorporation or by-laws of said Corporation and have not been rescinded or modified in any respect but still remain in full force and effect. IN WITNESS WHEREOF, I have hereunto set my hand this 13th day of April, avi s A. S 'c 1. nd, Assistant Secretary Poole & Kent Company of Florida, a Delaware Corporation 1781 N. W. North River Drive, Miami, FL 33125 • • • EXHIBIT A RESOLVED, that Patrick H. Carr the duly elected President and Chief Executive Officer, Brian D. MacClugage the duly elected Executive Vice President & Assistant Secretary and David BuShea the duly elected Vice President of the Company, be and each hereby are, authorized, empowered and directed to execute and submit a bid and all related bonds, agreements and contract documents related to City of Clearwater, Marshall Street WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP), Project No. 18 -0047 -UT and such other instruments in writing as may be necessary on behalf of the said Corporation, and that the Contract, Bond and other such instruments signed by him shall be binding upon the said Corporation as its own acts and deeds. SECTION V — Contract Documents • NON -COLLUSION AFFIDAVIT • • STATE OF FLORIDA COUNTY OF Miami -Dade ) Patrick H. Carr being, first duly sworn, deposes and says that he is President & CEO of Poole & Kent Company of Florida the party making the foregoing Proposal or Bid; that such Bid is genuine and not collusive or sham: that said bidder is not financially interested in or otherwise affiliated in a business way with any other bidder on the same contract; that said bidder has not colluded, conspired, connived, or agreed, directly or indirectly, with any bidders or person, to put in a sham bid or that such other person shall refrain from bidding, and has not in any manner, directly or indirectly, sought by agreement or collusion, or communication or conference, with any person, to fix the bid price or affiant or any other bidder, or to fix any overhead, profit or cost element of said bid price, or that of any other bidder, or to secure any advantage against the City of Clearwater, Florida, or any person or persons interested in the proposed contract; and that all statements contained in said proposal or bid are true; and further, that such bidder has not directly or indirectly submitted this bid, or the contents thereof, or divulged information or data relative thereto to any association or to any member or agent thereof. Affiant Patrick H. Carr, President & CEO Sworn to and subscribed before me this 27th day of April Notary Public Wendy Campbell , 20 22 „vs WENDYCAMPBELL •, ;,, MY COMMISSION # HH 062370 '•• ,�. •A�: EXPIRES: February 1, 2025 ,tpiry°'' Bolded ',btu Notary Pubes Underwriters SECTION V Page 10 of 17 Updated: 5/4/2020 • • • SECTION V — Contract Documents PROPOSAL (1) TO THE CITY OF CLEARWATER, FLORIDA, for MSWRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) (18 -0047 -UT) and doing such other work incidental thereto, all in accordance with the contract documents, marked MSWRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) (18 -0047 -UT) Every bidder must take notice of the fact that even though his proposal be accepted and the documents signed by the bidder to whom an award is made and by those officials authorized to do so on behalf of the City of Clearwater, Florida, that no such award or signing shall be considered a binding contract without a certificate from the Finance Director that funds are available to cover the cost of the work to be done, or without the approval of the City Attorney as to the form and legality of the contract and all the pertinent documents relating thereto having been approved by said City Attorney; and such bidder is hereby charged with this notice. The signer of the Proposal, as bidder, also declares that the only person, persons, company or parties interested in this Proposal, are named in this Proposal, that he has carefully examined the Advertisement, Instructions to Bidders, Contract Specifications, Plans, Supplemental Specifications, General Conditions, Special Provisions, and Public Construction Bond, that he or his representative has made such investigation as is necessary to determine the character and extent of the work and he proposes and agrees that if the Proposal be accepted, he will contract with the City of Clearwater, Florida, in the form of contract; hereto annexed, to provide the necessary labor, materials, machinery, equipment, tools or apparatus, do all the work required to complete the contract within the time mentioned in the General Conditions and according to the requirements of the City of Clearwater, Florida, as herein and hereinafter set forth, and furnish the required surety bonds for the following prices to wit: If the foregoing Proposal shall be accepted by the City of Clearwater, Florida, and the undersigned shall fail to execute a satisfactory contract as stated in the Advertisement herein attached, then the City may, at its option determine that the undersigned has abandoned the contract, and thereupon this Proposal shall be null and void, and the certified check or bond accompanying this Proposal, shall be forfeited to become the property of the City of Clearwater, Florida, and the full amount of said check shall be retained by the City, or if the Proposal Bond be given, the full amount of such bond shall be paid to the City as stipulated or liquidated damages; otherwise, the bond or certified check accompanying this Proposal, or the amount of said check, shall be returned to the undersigned as specified herein. SECTION V Page 11 of 17 Updated: 5/4/2020 • • • SECTION V — Contract Documents PROPOSAL (2) Attached hereto is a bond or certified check on Bid Bond Bank, for the sum of ten percent (10%) of total amount bid (being a minimum of 10% of Contractor's total bid amount). ($ ) The full names and residences of all persons and parties interested in the foregoing bid are as follows: (If corporation, give the names and addresses of the President and Secretary. If firm or partnership, the names and addresses of the members or partners. The Bidder shall list not only his name but also the name of any person with whom bidder has any type of agreement whereby such person's improvements, enrichment, employment or possible benefit, whether sub -contractor, materialman, agent, supplier, or employer is contingent upon the award of the contract to the bidder). NAMES: ADDRESSES: See attached Signature of Bidder: Patrick H. Carr, President & CEO The person signing shall, in his own handwriting, sign the Principal's name, his own name and his title. Where the person signing for a corporation is other than the President or Vice President, he must, by affidavit, show)] is -authority, ind the corporation. Principal: By:1'A-T4 c,c- 4-I. 6342 -rt - Title: Company Legal Name: Poole & Kent Company of Florida Doing Business As (if different than above): N/A Business Address of Bidder: City and State: Tampa, FL Phone: (813) 251-2438 Dated at Miami -Dade 646'5-/['6'0 1715 W. Lemon Street Email Address: daveb@pkflorida.com Zip Code 33606 , this 27th day of April , A.D., 2022. SECTION V Page 12 of 17 Updated: 5/4/2020 SECTION V —Contract Documents • CITY OF CLEARWATER • • ADDENDUM SHEET PROJECT: MSWRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) (18 -0047 -UT) Acknowledgment is hereby made of the following addenda received since issuance of Plans and Specifications. Addendum No. 1 Date: 3/24/2022 Addendum No, 2 Addendum No. Addendum No. Addendum No. Addendum No. Addendum No. Addendum No. Addendum No. Addendum No. Addendum No. Date: 4/18/2022 Date: Date: Date: Date: Date: Date: Date: Date: Date: Poole & Kent Company of Florida e o : idd (Signature of Officer) Patrick H. Carr President & CEO (Title of Officer) April 27, 2022 (Date) SECTION V Page 13 of 17 Updated: 5/4/2020 ADDENDUM NO. 1 for MSWRF Gates Replacement Project Number 18 -0047 -UT DATE: March 24, 2022 SUBJECT: Addendum No. 1 TO: Prospective Bidders and Other Concerned Parties • w Bidders on the above project are hereby notified that the following Addenda are made to the Contract Documents: The following items shall be removed and replaced from the Contract Documents: 1. Remove Spec Section 11103 2.03 A and replace with: "The gate frame shall be a rigid, welded unit, composed of the guide rails, cross bars, and deadrails, with a clear opening sized per the gate dimension detail in the Plans. The gate frame shall be designed for face mounting as shown on the drawings and gate schedule. The guides shall be of T -316L stainless steel and shall have a slot suitable for mating with the gate body. ScUIs shall be frame mountcd. The flush bottom • ii1 I The frame configuration shall be of the flush -bottom type and shall allow the replacement of the side seals without removing the gate frame from the wall. Where self-contained guides are extended above the operating floor level to form the bench stand upon which the lift mechanism is fastened, they must be suitably strong and rigid without the use of additional stiffening members. The arrangement of the yoke shall be such that the disc and stem can be removed without disconnecting the yoke. The yoke shall be sufficiently strong to support the lift forces when subjected to a load of 80 pounds pull on the operator. The manufacturer's shop welds, welding procedures and welders shall be qualified and certified in accordance with the requirement of the latest edition of AWS Sections D 1.1, 1.2, and 1.6." Addendum 1 Page 1 • • BRIGHT AND BEAUTIFUL . BAY TO BEACH 2. Remove Spec Section 11103 2.03 B and replace with: "The slide gate body shall be manufactured of fiberglass reinforced polyester totally encapsulating an internal reinforcing structure. Each gate shall be molded individually to the exact dimensions specified in the Contract Documents using an infusion molding process. Seams and joints in and on the body are not acceptable. Slide gates shall be manufactured of reinforced thermoset plastic. Gate body shall have UV Stabilizing pigment in Resin to provide long-term protection from UV. The surface shall be resin rich to a depth of .010 inches to .020 inches (.25 - .51mm) and reinforced with C -glass and/or polymeric fiber surfacing material. The surface shall be free of exposed reinforcing fibers. The composition of these layers shall be approximately 95% (by weight) resin. The remaining laminate shall be made up of copolymer composite and reinforcing fibers in a form, orientation, and position to meet the mechanical requirements. The gate shall be designed and manufactured with seals mechanically attached to the gate body, NOT to the guide frame, to allow for seal replacement without removing channel of installation from service. The elastomeric seals shall be J bulb type manufactured of extruded EPDM having a hardness range of 55 to 65 shore A durometer and conforming to ASTM spec. D-2000, with a maximum compression set of 25%, and low temperature brittleness to meet suffix F-17 (-400). Structural reinforcing shall be utilized to attain the necessary stiffness to meet deflection requirements and shall be well encapsulated with laminate not Tess than %" thick on each side to ensure against any permeation by water to the core areas. A T -316L stainless steel. stem mounting bracket shall fasten to the gate with through bolts. The through holes shall not pass through or be in contact with the internal mild steel reinforcing. Core material must be 100% resistant to decay and attack by fungus and bacteria and be resistant to hydrocarbons." 3. Remove Spec Section 11103 2.04 and replace with: "Operators shall be a manual type, supplied with a handwheel and a 2" square nut compatible with the lift/handheld valve operator. Operator< shall be h3ndwhccl type. Operators shall meet AWWA C561 specifications, except as otherwise specified, and shall be designed to meet the operating requirements specified in paragraph 11103-1.01 D. Clear plastic stem covers shall be provided as specified in AWWA C561, Section 4.4.13.6. On handwheel, manual operators, gears, and bearings shall be enclosed in a weatherproof housing, and pressure type fittings shall be provided for grease lubrication of the bearings and gears. A maximum effort of 40 pounds pull of the crank or handwheel shall operate the gate under the specified operating conditions. The crank or handwheel shall be able to withstand, without damage, an effort of 80Ib. Addendum 1 Page 2 • • BRIGHT AND BEAUTIFUL • BAY TO BEACH Handheld valve operators shall be Wachs P-2 Handheld Valve Operator or approved equal. The valve operator shall be 110V without torque control, 0- 20rpm with a max torque of 500 ft/lbs. The operator shall be either pedestal or bench mounted as specified. Pedestal type floor standards shall be the offset type of the standard type with wall mounting bracket. Pedestal or bench stands shall be cast iron or aluminum. The head of the pedestal or bench stand operator shall have a solid bronze, internally threaded operating nut. The operator shall be mounted on antifriction roller bearings. Cranks and handwheels shall be removable from the operator." 4. In Specification Section 11103, replace references to "AWWA C561" with "AWWA C563". 5. Remove Spec Section 11220 2.09.D.1 and replace with: "1. Determine standard oxygen transfer efficiencies for one test grid conforming to Tank 6, Grid B and D.O. Boost Tank, Grid 2B." 6. Remove Spec Section 11220 2.09.D.3 and replace with: "3. The minimum oxygen transfer efficiencies in the test grid shall be as follows: a. Test Grid: 1) At 0.75 scfm/diffuser: 17.2 percent 2) At 1.05 scfm/diffuser: 16 percent 3) At 2.1 scfm/diffuser: 13.6 percent" END OF ADDENDUM #1 Addendum 1 Page 3 BRIGHT AND BEAUTIFUL • BAY TO BEACH ADDENDUM NO. 2 for MSWRF Gates Replacement Project Number 18 -0047 -UT DATE: April 18, 2022 SUBJECT: Addendum No. 2 TO: Prospective Bidders and Other Concerned Parties • • Bidders on the above project are hereby notified that the following Addenda are made to the Contract Documents: Contractor Submitted Questions 1. The Pre -Bid Agenda (No. 18 -0047 -UT) Revision, No. 6 Bid Tabulation Sheet states to use the Excel version of the Bid Tab to calculate the proposal total, and once completed, print and include the Bid Tab with our bid package. Pricing is unpredictable, especially on bid day, and it may be difficult to complete this form and have it printed out in time to include with our bid package. Is it possible for us to provide a flash drive including the Bid Tab Excel file with our bid package, and then provide the printed copy of the Bid Tab within 24 hours after bid time? Please confirm if this is acceptable. Response: All documents pertaining to this bid shall be submitted at or before the time and place indicated in the advertisement. No items received after this time will be accepted. Because pricing is read at the public bid opening, a hard copy of the bid pricing sheet is required. 2. Section 15062-2.07.6 states the lining for the ductile iron pipe is to be cement mortar lined for all piping downstream of the primary clarifier splitter box and ceramic epoxy lined if upstream from the primary clarifier splitter box. Note 4 on Drawing G-00-05 states that the primary tanks were replaced with the Salsnes Filters installed in 2012. Please confirm the lining of the pipe to be used. Response: Buried Ductile Iron Pipe (DIP) used for the aeration basin drainage piping shown on Sheet M-00-03 shall be coated per 15062 2.06. Above ground DIP and submerged DIP used for the aeration basin drainage piping shall be coated per the new Section 15062 2.06.0 added below. All DIP used for aeration basin drainage piping shall be epoxy lined per Section 2.07 B, as modified below. Addendum 2 Page 1 • BRIGHT AND BEAUTIFUL • BAY TO BEACH See the following modifications to the Contract Documents: A. Add Spec Section 15062 2.06 C : "Coating of above -ground DIP shall be per Specification Section 09900 3.05 Coating System EU -1, colored safety green per City Specification Section IV. Coating of the submerged DIP within the aeration basins shall be per Specification Section 09900 3.05 Coating System E-2." B. Remove Spec Section 15062 2.07 B and replace with: "1. CEMENT MORTAR LINING: for all piping downstream of the Primary Clarifier Splitter Box, interior surfaces of pipe and fittings shall be cement mortar lined in accordance with AWWA C104. Cement shall be ASTM C150, Type II or V, low alkali, containing les; than 0.60 alkalies. 1. 2, EPDXY LINING: For all drainage piping upstream downs+, of the , ductile iron pipe and fittings shall be lined with a ceramic -filled amine -cured epoxy, Protecto 401 by Induron. The lining thickness shall be 40 mils minimum. Application shall be performed by an applicator approved by the coating manufacturer, in accordance with manufacturer's instructions and under controlled conditions at the applicator's shop or the pipe manufacturer's plant. Applicator shall submit a certified affidavit of compliance with manufacturer's instructions and requirements specified herein." 3. Specification Section 01014 - Work Sequence is listed in the Table of Contents of Section Vla, but it is not provided in the document. Please provide Specification Section 01014 - Work Sequence. Response: Specification Section 01014 - Work Sequence, has been included in this Addendum as Attachment 1. 4. The Contract Specifications do not reference a wage determination for the project. Please provide the wages that will be used for this project. Response: There is no wage determination for the project. 5. The Contract Specifications do not state requirements for the Engineer's or Contractor's field offices. Please confirm that there is no requirement for these offices. Response: • Confirmed, there are no requirements for a field office. Addendum 2 Page 2 • • ARIGHT AND BEAUTIFUL BAY TO BEACH 6. The Contract Specifications include Coating Systems, Section 09900. The project plans do not include drawings or notes addressing coatings to be applied after concrete repair or anywhere else. Please advise as to what areas need to receive coating systems. Response: Section 09900 is included to specify the above ground ductile iron pipe (DIP) coating system. No other coating systems are anticipated for this project. 7. Spec Section 01010 1.04.13 states a normal operating schedule as a "regular 40 -hour work week." It is assumed that this references a 5 day, 8 hour schedule. Please confirm if the Contractor can work a 5 day, 10 hour schedule. Response: A 5 -day, l0 -hour schedule is acceptable. 8. Specification Section 01250 3.09.2 reads, "Payment of the unit price bid shall be made based on the cubic yards of grit removed, decanted, and deposited in an on-site City - Owned receptacle to be coordinated during the pre -construction meeting. Costs include all labor and materials associated with removing accumulated grit, decanting the grit to remove excess water, and delivery to an on-site City -Owned receptacle." The Contract Drawings and Specifications do not reference where the grit is to be decanted? Can the grit be decanted on-site? Please confirm if the grit can be decanted in the City -Owned receptacle. Please confirm that the excess water removed from the grit during decanting can be disposed back into the system on-site. If not, please confirm where this excess water can be disposed. Please provide the location of the City -Owned receptacle. Please provide information on the size of the City -Owned receptacle. Response: The grit can be decanted on-site but the contractor will be responsible for decanting the grit with their own equipment. The excess water removed from the grit can be sent back through the plant through either the headworks or the gravity sewer manhole upstream of the headworks. The City roll -off for grit is located just inside the southwest entrance gate or at the headworks building, usually outside just north of the building. 9. Specification Section V, Bidder's Proposal, Item No. 9 Grit Removal, has a quantity of 630 CY. How s this 630 CY of grit measured for the bid item quantity. Is this the quantity of wet grit or dry grit? Please confirm. Response: The quantity was calculated based on the assumption that wet grit may be accumulated in the bottom lft of each basin. The 630 CY quantity is 1ft depth times the surface area of all the basins combined. Addendum 2 Page 3 • • BRIGHT AND BEAUTIFUL • BAY 10 BEACH 10. The grit and excess water that is removed from the basins is assumed to be classified as hazardous waste. Please confirm that the Owner is the generator of this waste and will provide and pay for any manifests needed for its disposal. Response: The grit is not expected to be considered hazardous waste. The Contractor is only responsible for the decanting and disposal as required by the Contract Docs, and response #8 above. 11. Specification Section 11220, 3.04.6 states the Strength Testing of Pipe Supports. Will any of the existing pipe supports be tested? If so, please confirm the number of supports to be tested? Response: Section 11220 3.04.B requires new supports to be tested, no existing supports will need to be tested. See the following modifications to the Contract Documents: A. Revise Spec Section 11220 3.04.6.1 as follows: "Upon replacement of the supports and prior to installation of the piping, test five (5) supports of each type." 12. Specification Section 11220, 3.04.0 states the Test for Anti -Rotation of Distribution Headers. Will any of the existing pipe header be tested? If so, please confirm the number of joints to be tested? Response: Remove Section 11220 3.04.0 from the Specifications. This test will not be required. 13. Specification Section 11220, 3.04.0 states the Leakage Test. Will any of the existing diffuser grid be tested? If so, could you quantify the number of joints to be tested? Response: The leakage testing required by Section 11220 3.04.D will be completed for the entire grid. All of the diffusers should be able to be observed at the same time during this test. 14. Specification Section 11220, 3.04.F states the Uniform Air Distribution Test. Please confirm which Bid Item on the Bidder's Proposal this is for. Response: Uniform Air Distribution Tests can be included in Bid Item No. 6 MEMBRANE DISC DIFFUSER REPLACEMENT. Addendum 2 Page 4 • • BRIGHT AND BEAUTIFUL • BAY TO BEACH 15. Specification Section 11220, 3.04.G states the Mixing Test. Please confirm which Bid Item on the Bidder's Proposal this is for. Response: Remove Section 11220 3.04.0 from the Specifications. This test will not be required. 16. Specification Section 11220, 3.05.A states, "A factory trained representative shall be provided for installation supervision, start-up and test services and operation and maintenance personnel services. The representative shall make a site visit to verify the completed repairs." The number of days for this representative to be onsite is unknown due to the project having multiple phases that are dependent on the quantity of piping, supports and diffusers for each phase. Please provide an estimated number of days you think is required for this item. Could this be an allowance item? Please confirm. Response: The estimated number of days required for this item is six (6) total days. Include this effort in Bid Item #6 Membrane Disc Diffuser Replacement. 17. Specification Section 01250, Part 3, 3.01-3.11 lists the Measurement and Payment for Bid Items 1-11. The individual specification sections may contain work beyond what is listed in these Measurements and Payments. Please confirm that Specification Section 01250, Part 3, 3.01-3.11 takes precedent over the individual specification sections. Response: The work included in the Contract is shown on the Plans and outlined in the Specifications. The Measurement and Payment Specification details how the work is to be measured and paid for under the Contract. Exclusion of any part of the work from the Measurement and Payment section does not preclude the Contractor from performing the work as shown on the Contract Documents. Please reference Specification Section 01250 1.01.E for this provision. 18. Contract Drawing M-00-01 notes to "Temporarily Remove and Replace Flow Splitters as Needed". A Record Drawing for Marshall Street Advanced Pollution Control Facility, File No. 12825 shows details of these flow splitters, but it is not clear as to why the flow splitters need to be removed and replaced. Do the flow splitters need to be removed in order to remove the existing slide gates? Please confirm. Response: Removal of the flow splitters for the replacement of the gates is not anticipated to be required. However, the flow splitters could be removed by the Contractor to make room for a coffer dam to be installed upstream of the gates to decrease the bypass pumping duration. Addendum 2 Page 5 • BRIGHT AND BEAUTIFUL • BAY TO BEACH 19. Section III - General Conditions, 11.3 Unit Price Work states, "The Owner or Contractor may make a claim for an adjustment in the Contract Price if: (i) the quantity of any item of Unit Price Work performed by Contractor differs materially and significantly from the estimated quantity of such item indicated in the Contract Documents; and (ii) there is no corresponding adjustment with respect to any other item of Work; and (iii) if Contractor believes that Contractor is entitled to an increase in Contract Price as a result of having incurred additional expense or the Owner believes that the Owner is entitled to a decrease in Contract Price and the parties are unable to agree as to the amount of any such increase or decrease." What percent over or under the estimated Bid Item's quantity will the Contractor be compensated for extra work or a reduction of work? Please confirm. Response: This is a unit cost, bid item job. Any over or under is determined by the unit cost. 20. Contract Drawing M-00-01, Note 7, states that the City will allow for the dewatering of the grit onsite prior to hauling. Specification Section 01250, 3.09-2 states that the Contractor shall include cost for delivery to an onsite City -Owner receptacle. Is the contractor responsible for hauling the grit offsite, or just depositing it in the City -Owned receptacle onsite? Please confirm. Response: Contractor is responsible for removing, decanting, and depositing the grit in an on-site City -Owned receptacle per Specification Section 01250. 21. Please provide the as-builts or submittals for the existing slide gates and flow splitters so we may determine existing anchor locations to appropriately estimate the work required for their removal. Response: Per Engineer Response for Contractor Question No. 18 above, the flow splitter details with anchor details are shown on Page 603 of 631 of the Technical Specifications. The anchor details of the existing slide gates are shown on Page 604 of 631. The gates are shown on the Record Drawings to be embedded. However, when one of the tanks was drained during design, the gates were observed to have been installed flush mounted. Photos from this event are provided in this Addendum in Attachment 2. We do not have additional information that would indicate that the other basins are different than the tank drained during design. 22. The 356 SY Construction Laydown Area shown on Contract Drawing G-00-06 takes up a • portion of the plant parking in that area. Please confirm that this is a designated Addendum 2 Page 6 • laydown for the Contractor and there will be no parking or interruption by plant trucks or equipment in this area during the project. Response: Confirmed. 23. Specification Section 11220, 3.04.A.5 states, "CONTRACTOR shall coordinate with OWNER to fill and drain the aeration tanks and for hosing down as required. Water for filling and hosing down the tanks shall be provided by OWNER." It is unclear from this statement who is exactly responsible for draining the tanks. Does this mean the Contractor will coordinate with the Owner, who is the responsible party draining the tanks, or does the Contractor take responsibility for draining the tanks? Please confirm. Response: The Contractor is responsible for draining the tanks. 24. Please reference the Bypassing Concept in Appendix B of the Specifications. In order to block off channels in Conceptual Bypassing Layouts Phases 1-3, an initial bypass of aeration basins 4-13 may need to occur. This bypass layout would start at aeration basins 1-3 and bypass to the second anoxic tanks. Please confirm if a temporary bypass of aeration basin 4-13 will be allowed. Response: No, a minimum of 4 basins must remain online at all times. 25. How will the City measure the amount of grit removed in order to make payment to the Contractor? Please advise as to how the City will determine measurement of the removed grit in order to make payment to the Contractor? Response: Measurement of grit will be determined by volume. Once the tank is dewatered, the Contractor along with construction inspector will agree on the observable depth of accumulated grit and derive a wet volume from this agreed upon calculation. 26. General Conditions, Section 5.2.6 states that the Owner will be responsible for purchasing and maintaining an "All Risk" Builder's Risk policy but very few details are provided about the limits, sublimits, deductibles and coverage extensions. It is not equitable to give the Contractor the financial risk of loss for loss or damage to the work without full transparency of the builder's risk coverage provided to protect Contractor from such risk. Please provide the policy limit, applicable deductibles, all sublimits, including but not limited to flood, earthquake, LEG 3, off-site storage, in -transit, extra expense, debris removal, pollution cleanup, and contractors continuing expenses. Addendum 2 Page 7 • • BRIGHT AND BEAUTIFUL • BAY TO BEACH Response: Since there is no building construction as part of the project scope, there will be no builder's risk insurance provided. 27. General Conditions, Section 6.12 states Contractor is responsible for any loss or damage to the Work however caused yet Owner is responsible for purchasing and maintaining Builders All Risk Insurance. Very few details are provided about the limits, sub -limits, and coverage extensions to be provided by Owner's policy. It is not equitable to give the Contractor the financial risk of loss for Toss or damage to the Work for which it is not able to insure. Please revise to the following: "The Contractor shall rebuild, repair, and make good, at his own expense, all injuries or damages to any portion of the Work occasioned by any cause before its completion and final acceptance by the Owner. Notwithstanding the first $25,000 (or other amount mutually agreeable to you and the Owner), Contractor's total liability for loss of or damage to the work shall be limited to the recoveries from the owner -provided Builders' Risk policy ..." Response: Since there is no building construction as part of the project scope, there will be no builder's risk insurance provided. 28. Section IV, Technical Specifications, 405-6.3.3(3) states a 10 -year Contractor warranty must be provided on coating system. Sureties will not agree to provide bonding for contractors in excess of 5 years that are not clearly designated to be manufacturer or supplier warranties. Naturally, Contractor will assign all manufacturer and supplier warranties to Owner. Our bid price contemplates a 5 year construction / workmanship warranty on the coating systems and a 10 year manufacturer warranty from the manufacturer or supplier. Response: A 10 -year contractor warranty must be provided on the construction/workmanship and the material/hardware. 29. Please reference Contract Drawing M-00-01. The existing gravity drain piping and fittings on the east side of the aeration basins are shown to be demolished, but neither the Contract or Record Drawings show where that line is routed from or routed to. Please provide As -Built drawings for this line to show where it starts and ends. Response: See Attachment 3 for a figure that consolidates record drawing information for the existing gravity drain piping. At the northern end, the pipe terminates at Aeration Basin 1 in the Northwest corner of the structure. The piping to the south used to go to the dewatering pump, but the dewatering pump is no longer in service. We do not have reliable record drawing information documenting any changes to the drainage piping Addendum 2 Page 8 • • BRIGHT AND BEAUTIFUL • BAY TO BEACH to the south after the 2012 Salsnes Filter project other than the cap shown in blue near the Salsnes Filters. The limits of the drainage pipe demolition are shown on Sheet M- 00-01. 30. In the Public Notice Invitation to Bid on the last page under the section Bid Opening Procedures, it reads Bids will be received until March 30th, 2022 at 2 p.m. (EST). On the second page it reads Bids Due April 27th, 2022 at 2 p.m. Please confirm Bids are due on April 27th. Response: Confirmed the bids are due on April 27th, 2022 at 2pm. 31. Please provide the as-builts or submittals for the existing weir gates in aeration basins 6- 13. Response: Record Drawings provided in Appendix of Technical Specifications page 602 of 631. 32. Section III — General Conditions Article 6.12 states, "the Contractor shall remedy any defects in the work at his own expense and pay for any damage to other work resulting therefrom which appear within a period of one year from the date of final acceptance." This appears to conflict with the warranty term, GC 13.5, which requires correction within one year of Substantial Completion. Please clarify if the warranty period will begin at final acceptance or substantial completion. Response: The warranty period will begin at final acceptance. END OF ADDENDUM #2 Addendum 2 Page 9 • • • Attachment A: Section 01014 Work Sequence BrownANDCaldwell • • • SECTION 01014 WORK SEQUENCE PART 1 - GENERAL 1.01 CONTINUITY OF PLANT OPERATIONS A. The existing Marshall St. WRF is currently and continuously receiving and treating wastewater, and those functions shall not be interrupted except as specified herein. The Contractor shall coordinate the work with the Owner and Engineer to avoid any interference with normal operation of plant equipment and processes. B. The Contractor shall take all precautionary measures necessary to protect existing equipment that is not designated to be demolished. All existing equipment and/or facilities damaged by the Contractor shall be expeditiously repaired at the expense of the Contractor without additional compensation. 1.02 BYPASSING A. Bypass pumping of wastewater flows shall be directed from and routed to only those locations approved in writing by the Owner and Engineer. Bypass pumping shall be performed in accordance with Section 02145. B. Bypassing of untreated or partially treated wastewater to surface waters or drainage courses is prohibited during construction. In the event accidental bypassing to surface waters or drainage courses is caused by the Contractor's operations, the Owner shall immediately be entitled to employ others to stop the bypassing without giving written notice to the Contractor. 1.03 SUBMITTAL A. In accordance with Section 01300, the Contractor shall submit a detailed outage plan and time schedule for operations, which will make it necessary to remove a tank, pipeline, channel, electrical circuit, equipment, or structure from service. The schedule shall be coordinated with the construction schedule specified in Section 01310 and shall meet the restrictions and conditions specified in this section. The detailed plan shall describe the Contractor's method for preventing bypassing of other treatment units, the length of time required to complete said operation, and the necessary equipment that the Contractor shall provide in order to prevent bypassing of associated treatment units. 01014-1 Work Sequence December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • B. In accordance with Section 01300, the Contractor shall submit a detailed bypassing plan, which will outline the proposed sequence of operations that the Contractor will employ to set up bypassing operations and limit the operational impacts to the WRF. The plan shall be coordinated with the construction schedule specified in Section 01310 and shall meet the restrictions and conditions specified in this section. The detailed plan shall describe the Contractor's method for establishing the bypassing operation, the length of time required to complete said operation, and the necessary equipment that the Contractor shall provide to establish the required bypassing operation. Conceptual bypassing information has been included in the Appendix of these specifications for the Contractor's reference. C. The Contrapctor shall observe the following restrictions: 1. Systems or individual equipment items that are to be taken offline shall be isolated, dewatered, decommissioned, deenergized, or depressurized in accordance with the detailed outage plan and schedule. 2. The Owner and Engineer shall be notified in writing at least one week in advance of planned outage and/or bypass operations. 1.04 SEQUENCE AND SCHEDULE OF CONSTRUCTION A. The Contractor shall not remove more than four (4) Aeration Basins from service ata time. B. The Project Sequencing Plan shall include: 1. Detailed description of the Contractor's methods and sequencing of operations and work, 2. Length of time required to complete each individual operation, 3. Equipment that the Contractor shall utilize, 4. Resources that are required from the Owner, 5. List of deviations and/or exceptions from the sequence and schedule presented in the Contract Documents along with a detailed explanation for why the deviation is required and/or justified. END OF SECTION 01014-2 Work Sequence December 2020 Marshall St WRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) City Project No. 18 -0047 -UT • • • Attachment B: Existing Slide Gate Photos Brown m Caldwell Looking down on the west side of aeration basin gate. West is up on the photo. 4# 00 f 01. 40.; SW . 4 fOlik "'N'io, "4,11. 00 0 # .001+ fill OW 00.0. moo tie 000 O. 174 , *NO . • di• .- r,...? ..... ---... 01,00,0•01'.414.0 *Pt: ..„ . • ...._, *1 vows IP s'irse **". .allrn Illbe ‘ '0 * 04 6:11 41 F LJ I =4,1-tss • Attachment C: Existing Drainage Piping Layout • • EX. 8" DW EX. 8" DW EX. 8" DW CAPPED BY 2012 SALSNES PROJECT EX. 8" DW EX. 12" DW EX. 6" DW DISCHARGE CAPPED BY 2012 SALSNES PROJECT EX. 8" DW EX. 6" DW DISCHARGE FIGURE 1 EX. DEWATERING PUMP TO 1 BE CONFIRMED SECTION V — Contract Documents • BIDDER'S PROPOSAL • • PROJECT: MSWRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) (18 -0047 -UT) CONTRACTOR: Poole & Kent Company of Florida BIDDER'S GRAND TOTAL: $ 3/ 1 (, ) 1 S 7 2.0 (Numbers) BIDDER'S GRAND TOTAL:-/'kre " :()1(ti h oho )144A A'' d 5\ -t-y Ohe iXdIiLSGnoff. , : J -P Atnne? z -J SLvfn't` y '225X 00 (Words) MSWRF Process Control Gates Repairs (FDEP) Item No. Bid Item Qty Unit Unit Price Total Amount 1 Mobilization and Demobilization 1 LS 14fa,cSov • t,t 01000 2 Process Control Gates 30 EA 3 Drainage Piping 1 LS 6 Zfal 00 2s01 000" 4 Structural Patch Repairs 20 SF 202, 25 441 So o - 5 Crack Repair/T-Beam Repairs 90 LF 434 6 441 6 CFd 6 Membrane Disc Diffuser Replacement 150 EA (PS 6,75-o Air Piping and Appurtenances Replacement 100 LF / i i J /1( PIO 8 Air Piping Support Replacement 20 EA S 71S6o- 9 Grit Removal 630 CYD .20R /3), 6/0- 10 Bypass Pumping 1 LS q n) 60A; /17140a. Subtotal ,2, 2"74/1/ C. .2_ 11 Owner's Contingency (10%) 1 LS 2,87,4142-6- 2° 1.R7( 444 Grand Total la 3.i4t,sVf-- SECTION V Page 14 of 17 Updated: 5/4/2020 • • • SECTION V — Contract Documents THE BIDDER'S GRAND TOTAL ABOVE IS HIS TOTAL BID BASED ON HIS UNIT PRICES AND LUMP SUM PRICES AND THE ESTIMATED QUANTITIES REQUIRED FOR EACH SECTION. THIS FIGURE IS FOR INFORMATION ONLY AT THE TIME OF OPENING BIDS. THE CITY WILL MAKE THE TABULATION FROM THE UNIT PRICES AND LUMP SUM PRICE BID. IF THERE IS AN ERROR IN THE TOTAL BY THE BIDDER, IT SHALL BE CHANGED AS ONLY THE UNIT PRICES AND LUMP SUM PRICE SHALL GOVERN. THE CONTRACTOR SHALL PROVIDE COPIES OF A CURRENT CONTRACTOR LICENSE/REGISTRATION WITH THE STATE OF FLORIDA AND PINELLAS COUNTY IN THE BID RESPONSE. SECTION V Page 15 of 17 Updated: 5/4/2020 • • • SECTION V — Contract Documents SCRUTINIZED COMPANIES AND BUSINESS OPERATIONS WITH CUBA AND SYRIA CERTIFICATION FORM PER SECTION HI, ITEM 25, IF YOUR BID IS $1,000,000 OR MORE, THIS FORM MUST BE COMPLETED AND SUBMITTED WITH THE BID PROPOSAL. FAILURE TO SUBMIT THIS FORM AS REQUIRED, MAY DEEM YOUR SUBMITTAL NONRESPONSIVE. The affiant, by virtue of the signature below, certifies that: 1. The vendor, company, individual, principal, subsidiary, affiliate, or owner is aware of the requirements of section 287.135, Florida Statutes, regarding companies on the Scrutinized Companies with Activities in Sudan List, the Scrutinized Companies with Activities in the Iran Petroleum Energy Sector List, or engaging in business operations in Cuba and Syria; and 2. The vendor, company, individual, principal, subsidiary, affiliate, or owner is eligible to participate in this solicitation and is not listed on either the Scrutinized Companies with Activities in Sudan List, the Scrutinized Companies with Activities in the Iran Petroleum Sector List, or engaged in business operations in Cuba and Syria; and 3. Business Operations means, for purposes specifically related to Cuba or Syria, engaging in commerce in any form in Cuba or Syria, including, but not limited to, acquiring, developing, maintaining, owning, selling, possessing, leasing or operating equipment, facilities, personnel, products, services, personal property, real property, military equipment, or any other apparatus of business or commerce; and 4. If awarded the Contract (or Agreement), the vendor, company, individual, principal, subsidiary, affiliate, or owner will immediately notify the City of Clearwater in writing, no later than five (5) calendar days after any of its principals are placed on the Scrutinized Companies with Activities in Sudan List, the Scrutinized Companies with Activit in the Iran Petroleum Sector List, or engages in business operations in Cuba and Syria. STATE OF Florida COUNTY OF Miami -Dade The foregoing instrument was 20 22 , by Patrick H. Carr as the President & CEO corporation/entity), personally N/A Authorized Signature Patrick H. Carr Printed Name President & CEO Title Poole & Kent Company of Florida Name of Entity/Corporation acknowledged before me on this 27th day of April (name of person whose signature is being notarized) (title) of Poole & Kent Company of Florida (name of known to me as described herein personally known , or produced a (type of identification) as dentificat. n, and who did/did not take an oath. Notary Public Wendy Campbell My Commission Expires: February 1, 2025 NOTARY SEAL ABOVE Printed Name WENDY CAMPBELL MY COMMISSION # HH 062370 P= EXPIRES: February 1, 2025 -...pee Banded Tbru Notary Public Underwriters SECTION V Page 16 of 17 Updated: 5/4/2020 • • • SECTION V — Contract Documents SCRUTINIZED COMPANIES THAT BOYCOTT ISRAEL LIST CERTIFICATION FORM PER SECTION HI, ITEM 25, THIS FORM MUST BE COMPLETED AND SUBMITTED WITH THE BID PROPOSAL. FAILURE TO SUBMIT THIS FORMAS REQUIRED, MAY DEEM YOUR SUBMITTAL NONRESPONSIVE. The affiant, by virtue of the signature below, certifies that: 1. The vendor, company, individual, principal, subsidiary, affiliate, or owner is aware of the requirements of section 287.135, Florida Statutes, regarding companies on the Scrutinized Companies that Boycott Israel List, or engaged in a boycott of Israel; and 2. The vendor, company, individual, principal, subsidiary, affiliate, or owner is eligible to participate in this solicitation and is not listed on the Scrutinized Companies that Boycott Israel List, or engaged in a boycott of Israel; and 3. "Boycott Israel" or "boycott of Israel" means refusing to deal, terminating business activities, or taking other actions to limit commercial relations with Israel, or persons or entities doing business in Israel or in Israeli -controlled territories, in a discriminatory manner. A statement by a company that it is participating in a boycott of Israel, or that it has initiated a boycott in response to a request for a boycott of Israel or in compliance with, or in furtherance of, calls for a boycott of Israel, may be considered as evidence that a company is participating in a boycott of Israel; and 4. If awarded the Contract (or Agreement), the vendor, company, individual, principal, subsidiary, affiliate, or owner will immediately notify the City of Clearwater in writing, no later than five (5) calendar days after any of its principals are placed on the Scrutiryz' ed Companies that Boycott Israel List, or engaged in a boycott of Israel. STATE OF Florida COUNTY OF Miami -Dade The foregoing instrument was 20 22 , by Patrick H. Carr Authorized Signature Patrick H. Carr Printed Name President & CEO Title Poole & Kent Company of Florida Name of Entity/Corporation acknowledged before me on this _ 27th day of April (name of person whose signature is being notarized) as the President & CEO corporation/entity), personally N/A (title) of Poole & Kent Company of Florida (name of known to me as described herein _personally known , or produced a (type of identification) as i lentificatign, and who did/did not take an oath. My Commission Expires: February 1, 2025 NOTARY SEAL ABOVE Notary Public Wendy Campbell Printed Name �.�= MY COMMISSION CAMPBELL 062370 � EXPIRES: February UnderwritersT1, 2002.5y 'EOf,f;;. Bonded Notary PYNN Underwriters SECTION V Page 17 of 17 Updated: 5/4/2020 VERIFICATION OF EMPLOYMENT ELIGIBILITY FORM PER FLORIDA STATUTE 448.095, CONTRACTORS AND SUBCONTRACTORS MUST REGISTER WITH AND USE THE E -VERIFY SYSTEM TO VERIFY THE WORK AUTHORIZATION STATUS OF ALL NEWLY HIRED EMPLOYEES. THIS FORM MUST BE COMPLETED AND SUBMITTED WITH THE BID/PROPOSAL. FAILURE TO SUBMIT THIS FORM AS REQUIRED MAY DEEM YOUR SUBMITTAL NONRESPONSIVE. The affiant, by virtue of the signature below, certifies that: 1. The Contractor and its Subcontractors are aware of the requirements of Florida Statute 448.095. 2. The Contractor and its Subcontractors are registered with and using the E -Verify system to verify the work authorization status of newly hired employees. 3. The Contractor will not enter into a contract with any Subcontractor unless each party to the contract registers with and uses the E -Verify system. 4. The Subcontractor will provide the Contractor with an affidavit stating that the Subcontractor does not employ, contract with, or subcontract with unauthorized alien. 5. The Contractor must maintain a copy of such affidavit. 6. The City may terminate this Contract on the good faith belief that the Contractor or its Subcontractors knowingly violated Florida Statutes 448.09(1) or 448.095(2)(c). 7. If this Contract is terminated pursuant to Florida Statute 448.095(2)(c), the Contractor may not be awarded a public contract for at least 1 year after the date on which this Contract was terminated. 8. The Contractor is liable for any additional cost incurred by the City as a result of the termination of this Contract. Autf(orized Signature Patrick H. Can Printed Name President & CEO Title Poole & Kent Company of Florida Name of Entity/Corporation STATE OF Florida COUNTY OF Miami -Dade The foregoing instrument was acknowledged before me by means of lXI physical presence or ❑ online notarization on, this 27th day of April 2022 , by Patrick H. Can (name of person whose signature is being notarized) as the President & CEO (title) of Poole & Kent Company of Florida (name of corporation/entity), personally known X , or produced (type of identification) as identification, and who did/did not take an oath. . A — - i?""..►" WENDY CAMPBELL * % MY COMMISSION # HH 062370 EXPIRES: February 1, 2025 os n;'.•` Bonded Thru Notary Public Undeavrreers My Commission Expires: February 1 202 NOTARY SEAL ABOVE • Notary Public Wendy Campbell Printed Name • • State of Florida Contractor Licenses Poole & Kent Contractors An EMCOR Company Ron (*Santis. Governor STATE OF FLORIDA Halsey 8eshears, Secretary dbiziar DEPARTMENT OF BUSINESS AND PROFESSIONAL REGULATION CONSTRUCTION IIS LICENSING BOARD THE GENERAL CON RACP a EIN IS CERTIFIED UNDER THE PROVISIOI4(tWCH r' ArSTATUTES LICEN WUM C00061808 EXPIRATION DATE:. AUGUST 31, 2022 Always verify licenses online at MyFloridaLicense.com Do not alter this document in any form. This is your license. It is unlawful for anyone other than the licensee to use this document. Ron DeSantls. Governor STATE OF FLORIDA Halsey 8eshears. Secretary dbpr DEPARTMENT OF BUSINESS AND PROFESSIONAL REGULATION CONSTRUCTION INpm4TRy LICENSING BOARD THE MECHANICAL CO HEREIN IISCERTIFIED UNDER THE PROVISIONSeOE rll ' - '. FLQ ?ArSTATUTES EXPIRATION DATE: AUGUST 31, 2022 Always verify licenses online at MyFloridalicense.com Do not alter this document in any form. This is your license. It is unlawful for anyone other than the licensee to use this document. Headquarters - Miami -Dade County 1781 N.W. North River Drive Miami, FL 33125 P:305-325-1930 Hillsborough County 1715 W. Lemon Street Tampa, FL 33606 P:813-251-2438 Palm Beach County 801 Northpoint Parkway, Ste #64 West Palm Beach, FL 33407 P:561-721-6439 Charlotte County 18245 Paulson Drive, Ste #125 Port Charlotte, FL 33954 P:941-206-2210 Broward County 1451 W. Cypress Creek Rd #310 Fort Lauderdale, FL 33309 P:954-334-5818 • • State of Florida Contractor Licenses 4- Poole & Kent Contractors An EMCOR Company Ron DeSantis. Governor Halsey 8 shears. Secretary STATE OF FLORIDA dbpr DEPARTMENT OF BUSINESS AND PROFESSIONAL REGULATION CONSTRUCTION. itipmRy LICENSING BOARD s THE POLLUTANT STORAGE SMIN IS CERTIFIED UNDER THE PROVISIOI SOFCH ,F •' •AfATUTES LICENSE MI RiPCC1256776 EXPIRATION DATE: AUGUST 31, 2022 Always verify licenses online at MyFloridalicense.com Do not alter this document in any form. This is your license. It is unlawful for anyone other than the licensee to use this document. Ron DeSaneis, Governor STATE OF FLORIDA Halsey Reshears. Secretary dbiar DEPARTMENT OF BUSINESS AND PROFESSIONAL REGULATION CONSTRUCTION INDUSTRY LICENSING BOARD THE PLUMBING CONTIBACT1AltHEREIN TIFIED UNDER THE PROVISION QF CH + f•A TATUTES LICENSiNDNISt CPC:07380 EXPIRATION DATE: AUGUST 31, 2022 Always verify licenses online at MyFloridaLicense.com Do not alter this document in any form. This is your license. It is unlawful for anyone other than the licensee to use this document. Headquarters - Miami -Dade County 1781 N.W. North River Drive Miami, FL 33125 P::305-325-1930 Hillsborough County 1715 W. Lemon Street Tampa, FL 33606 P:813-251-2438 Palm Beach County 801 Northpoint Parkway, Ste #64 West Palm Beach, FL 33407 P:561-721-6439 Charlotte County 18245 Paulson Drive, Ste #125 Port Charlotte, FL 33954 F:941-206-2210 Broward County 1451 W. Cypress Creek Rd #310 Fort Lauderdale, FL 33309 P:954-334-5818 • • State of Florida Contractor Licenses Poole & Kent Contractors An EMCOR Company Ron DeSants, Governor STATE OF FLORIDA Halsey Beshears, Secretary dbpr DEPARTMENT OF BUSINESS AND PROFESSIONAL REGULATION ELECTRICAL CONTRACT/ORB LICENSING BOARD THE ELECTRICAL CO I CERTIFIED UNDER THE PROVISIOIS�OFCH�!? A[ATUTES LICENSEMMIAFR £C'13002938 EXPIRATION DATE: AUGUST 31, 2022 Always verify licenses online at MyFloridaUcense.com Do not alter this document in any form. This is your license. It is unlawful for anyone other than the licensee to use this document. Ron DeSantis, Governor STATE OF FLORIDA DEPARTMENT OF BUSINESS AND PROFESSIONAL REGULATION Halsey Beshears, Secretary CONSTRUCTION INDUSTRY LICENSING BOARD THE UNDERGROUND UTILITY + ` XC VAt1ON Cil MopN IS CERTIFIED UNDER THE PROVISIOb4S E.GH 9, • 'ASTATUTES I UCENSENONInetiCIX,1223771 EXPIRATION DATE AUGUST 31, 2022 Always verify licenses online at MyFloridaLcense.com Do not alter this document in any form. This is your license. It is unlawful for anyone other than the licensee to use this document. Headquarters - Miami -Dade. County 1781 N.W. North River Drive Miami, FL 33125 P:305-325.1930 Hillsborough County 1715 W. Lemon Street Tampa, FL 33606 P:813-251-2438 Palm Beach County 801 Northpoint Parkway, Ste #64 West Palm Beach, FL 33407 P:561-721-6439 Charlotte County 18245 Paulson Drive, Ste #125 Port Charlotte, FL 33954 P:941-206-2210 Broward County 1451 W. Cypress Creek Rd #310 Fort Lauderdale, FL 33309 P:954-334-5818 Certificate of Competency (2021-2022) Pinellas County Poole & Kent Contractors An EMCOR Company ie PINELLAS COUNTY CONSTRUCTION LICENSING BOARD THIS CERTIFIES THAT David Alan Strickland DBA Poole & Kent Company Of Florida STATE CERT # I-CGC061808 HAS FILED HIS/HER LICENSE AND PROOF OF REQUIRED LIABILITY AND WORKERS' COMPENSATION INSURANCE WITH THIS BOARD. IN GOOD STANDING UNTIL September 30, 2022 DATE OF ISSUANCE 06/14/2021 PINELLAS COUNTY CONSTRUCTION LICENSING BOARD THIS CERTIFIES THAT David Alan Strickland DBA Poole & Kent Company of Florida STATE CERT* I-CMC057192 HAS FILED HIS/HER LICENSE AND PROOF OF REQUIRED LIABILITY AND WORKERS' COMPENSATION INSURANCE WITH THIS BOARD. IN GOOD STANDING UNTIL September 30, 2022 DATE OF ISSUANCE 06114/2021 Headquarters - Miami -Dade County 1781 N.W. North River Drive Miami, FL 33125 P:305-325-1930 Hillsborough County 1715 W. Lemon Street Tampa, FL 33606 P:813-251-2438 Palm Beach County 801 Northpoint Parkway, Ste #64 West Palm Beach, FL 33407 P:561-721-6439 Charlotte County 18245 Paulson Drive, Ste #125 Port Charlotte, FL 33954 P:941-206-2210 Broward County 1451 W. Cypress Creek Rd #310 Fort Lauderdale, FL 33309 P:954-334-5818 Certificate of Competency (2021-2022) Pinellas County Poole & Kent Contractors An EMCOR Company to PINELLAS COUNTY CONSTRUCTION LICENSING BOARD THIS CERTIFIES THAT David Alan Strickland DBA Poole & Kent Company of Florida STATE CERT # I-EC13002938 HAS FILED HIS/HER LICENSE AND PROOF OF REQUIRED LIABILITY AND WORKERS' COMPENSATION INSURANCE WITH THIS BOARD. IN GOOD STANDING UNTIL September 30, 2022 DATE OF ISSUANCE 06/14/2021 PINELLAS COUNTY CONSTRUCTION LICENSING BOARD THIS CERTIFIES THAT David Alan Strickland DBA Poole & Kent Company of Flrodia STATE CERT # I-CUC1223771 HAS FILED HIS/HER LICENSE AND PROOF OF REQUIRED LIABILITY AND WORKERS' COMPENSATION INSURANCE WITH THIS BOARD. IN GOOD STANDING UNTIL September 30, 2022 DATE OF ISSUANCE 06/14/2021 • Headquarters - Miami -Dade County 1781 N.W. North River Drive Miami, FL 33125 P:305-325-1930 Hillsborough County 1715 W. Lemon Street Tampa, FL 33606 P:813-251-2438 Palm Beach County 801 Northpoint Parkway, Ste #64 West Palm Beach, FL 33407 P:561-721-6439 Charlotte County 18245 Paulson Drive, Ste #125 Port Charlotte, FL 33954 P:941-206-2210 Broward County 1451 W. Cypress Creek Rd #310 Fort Lauderdale, FL 33309 P:954-334-5818 • Certificate of Competency (2021-2022) •Pinellas County An EMCOR Company Poole & Kent Contractors • PINELLAS COUNTY CONSTRUCTION LICENSING BOARD THIS CERTIFIES THAT David Alan Strickland DBA Poole & Kent Company of Florida STATE CERT # I-CFC057380 HAS FILED HIS/HER LICENSE AND PROOF OF REQUIRED LIABILITY AND WORKERS' COMPENSATION INSURANCE WITH THIS BOARD. IN GOOD STANDING UNTIL September 30, 2022 DATE OF ISSUANCE 06/14/2021 PINELLAS COUNTY CONSTRUCTION LICENSING BOARD THIS CERTIFIES THAT David Alan Strickland DBA Poole & Kent Company of Florida STATE CERT # I-PCC1256776 HAS FILED HIS/HER LICENSE AND PROOF OF REQUIRED LIABILITY AND WORKERS' COMPENSATION INSURANCE WITH THIS BOARD. IN GOOD STANDING UNTIL September 30, 2022 DATE OF ISSUANCE 06/14/2021 Headquarters - Miami -Dade County 1781 N.W. North River Drive Miami, FL 33125 P:305-325-1930 Hillsborough County 1715 W. Lemon Street Tampa, FL 33606 P:813-251-2438 Palm Beach County 801 Northpoint Parkway, Ste #64 West Palm Beach, FL 33407 P:561-721-6439 Charlotte County 18245 Paulson Drive, Ste #125 Port Charlotte, FL 33954 P:941-206-2210 Broward County 1451 W. Cypress Creek Rd #310 Fort Lauderdale, FL 33309 P:954-334-5818 • Insurance • Poole & Kent Contractors An EMCOR Company Poole & Kent Company of Florida (P&K) can provide the proper types of insurance that meet your requirements. our insurance carriers have an A.M. Best Rating of "A-" or higher. • Continental Casualty Company [General / Automobile] • American Casualty Company of Reading, PA [Workers Compensation] • Continental Insurance Company [Umbrella] • GuideOne National Insurance Company [Property / Builder's Risk] • Steadfast Insurance Company [Professional / Pollution] All of A.M. Best Rating: A (Excellent) A.M. Best Rating: A (Excellent) A.M. Best Rating: A (Excellent) A.M. Best Rating: A- (Excellent) A.M. Best Rating: A+ (Superior) Marsh USA, Inc. Contact: Brian M Lynch Phone: 212-345-0557 Broker for Continental Casualty Company / American Casualty Company / Continental Insurance Company Aon Risk Services Southwest, Inc. Contact: Katrina Whitehead Phone: 713-624-4628 Broker for GuideOne National Insurance Company Willis Towers Watson Northeast, Inc. Contact: Jeffrey Bakowski Phone: 860-263-1041 Broker for Steadfast Insurance Company Refer to the attached evidence of insurance. Headquarters - Miami -Dade County 1781 N.W. North River Drive Miami, FL 33125 P:305-325-1930 Hillsborough County 1715 W. Lemon Street Tampa, FL 33606 6:813-251-2438 Palm Beach County 801 Northpoint Parkway, Ste 564 West Palm Beach, FL 33407 P:561-7216439 Charlotte County 18245 Paulson Drive, Ste 8125 Port Charlotte, FL 33954 P:941-206-2210 Broward County 1451 W. Cypress Creek Rd 8310 Fort Lauderdale, FL 33309 P:954-334-5818 ACORO® CERTIFICATE OF LIABILITY INSURANCE `.� DATE/YYYY) 11/20/2021 THIS CERTIFICATE IS ISSUED AS A MATTER OF INFORMATION ONLY AND CONFERS NO RIGHTS UPON THE CERTIFICATE HOLDER. THIS CERTIFICATE DOES NOT AFFIRMATIVELY OR NEGATIVELY AMEND, EXTEND OR ALTER THE COVERAGE AFFORDED BY THE POLICIES 'BELOW. THIS CERTIFICATE OF INSURANCE DOES NOT CONSTITUTE A CONTRACT BETWEEN THE ISSUING INSURER(S), AUTHORIZED REPRESENTATIVE OR PRODUCER, AND THE CERTIFICATE HOLDER. IMPORTANT: If the certificate holder is an ADDITIONAL INSURED, the policy(ies) must have ADDITIONAL INSURED provisions or be endorsed. If SUBROGATION IS WAIVED, subject to the terms and conditions of the policy, certain policies may require an endorsement. A statement on this certificate does not confer rights to the certificate holder in lieu of such endorsement(s). PRODUCER ***MARSH USA INC 1166 AVENUE OF THE AMERICAS NEW YORK, NY 10036 Phone: 866-966-4664 Emcor.Certrequest@marsh.com / Fax: 203-229-6787 CN102796740-POOLE-TAM-21-22 CONTACT NAME: PHONE FAX (A/C. No. Ext): (A/C. No): E-MAIL ADDRESS: INSURER(S) AFFORDING COVERAGE NAIC # INSURERA: Continental Casualty Companv 20443 INSURED POOLE & KENT COMPANY OF FLORIDA 1715 WEST LEMON STREET TAMPA, FL 33606 INSURERB: Amen .-n - u -I Com. - n .f R: -.in. PA 20427 INSURER C : Transportation Insurance Co 20494 INSURER D : Continental Insurance Company 35289 INSURER E : INSURER F : X COVERAGES CERTIFICATE NUMBER: NYC -009733805 R THIS IS TO CERTIFY THAT THE POLICIES OF INSURANCE LISTED BELOW HAVE BEEN ISSUED TO THE INSURED NAMED ABOVE FOR THE POLICY PERIOD INDICATED. NOTWITHSTANDING ANY REQUIREMENT, TERM OR CONDITION OF ANY CONTRACT OR OTHER DOCUMENT WITH RESPECT TO WHICH THIS CERTIFICATE MAY BE ISSUED OR MAY PERTAIN, THE INSURANCE AFFORDED BY THE POLICIES DESCRIBED HEREIN IS SUBJECT TO ALL THE TERMS, EXCLUSIONS AND CONDITIONS OF SUCH POLICIES. LIMITS SHOWN MAY HAVE BEEN REDUCED BY PAID CLAIMS. INSR LTR TYPE OF INSURANCE ADDL FWD SUBR wvn POLICY NUMBER POLICY EFF (MM/DD/YYYY) POLICY EXP (MM/DD/YYYY) LIMITS A X COMMERCIAL GENERAL LIABILITY GL 7015289851 10/01/2021 10/01/2022 EACH OCCURRENCE $ 2,000,000 CLAIMS -MADE X OCCUR DAMAGE TO RENTED PREMISES (Ea occurrence) $ 1,000,000 MED EXP (Any one person) $ 25,000 PERSONAL & ADV INJURY $ 2,000,000 GEN'L AGGREGATE POLICY OTHER: X LIMIT APPLIES JECT PER: LOC GENERAL AGGREGATE $ 6,000,000 PRODUCTS -COMP/OP AGG $ 14,000,000 $ AUTOMOBILE X X LIABILITY ANY AUTO OWNED AUTOS ONLY HIRED AUTOS ONLY _ X _ SCHEDULED AUTOS NON -OWNED AUTOS ONLY BUA 7015289882 10/01/2021 10/01/2022 NED SINGLE LIMIT Ea COMBIaccident) ( $ 2,000,000 BODILY INJURY (Per person) $ BODILY INJURY (Per accident) $ PROPERTY DAMAGE (Per accident) $ Auto Physical Damage $ Included D X UMBRELLA LIAB EXCESS LIAB X OCCUR CLAIMS -MADE CUE 7015644968 10/01/2021 10/01/2022 EACH OCCURRENCE $ 5,000,000 AGGREGATE $ 5,000,000 DED X RETENT ON $ 1n non $ B B C WORKERS COMPENSATION AND EMPLOYERS' LIABILITY ANYPROPRIETOR/PARTNER/EXECUTIVE Y / N OFFICER/MEMBEREXCLUDED? (Mandatory In NH) N If yes, describe under DESCRIPTION OF OPERATIONS below N/A WC 7015294418 (AOS) WC 7015294385 (CA) WC 7015302405 (AZ, OR, WI) 10/01/2021 10/01/2021 10/01/2021 10/01/2022 10/01/2022 10/01/2022 X STATUTE ETH E.L. EACH ACCIDENT$ 1,000,000 E.L. DISEASE - EA EMPLOYEE $ 1,000,000 E.L. DISEASE - POLICY LIMIT $ 1,000,000 DESCRIPTION OF OPERATIONS / LOCATIONS / VEHICLES (ACORD 101, Additional Remarks Schedule, may be attached if more space is required) EVIDENCE OF COVERAGE CERTIFICATE HOLDER CANCELLATION POOLE & KENT COMPANY OF FLORIDA 1715 WEST LEMON STREET TAMPA, FL 33606 SHOULD ANY OF THE ABOVE DESCRIBED POLICIES BE CANCELLED BEFORE THE EXPIRATION DATE THEREOF, NOTICE WILL BE DELIVERED IN ACCORDANCE WITH THE POLICY PROVISIONS. AUTHORIZED REPRESENTATIVE of Marsh USA Inc. OL'VtpO �+ ACORD 25 (2016/03) © 1988-2016 ACORD CORPORATION. All rights reserved. The ACORD name and logo are registered marks of ACORD ACORO4111® GENCY ***MARSH USA INC POLICY NUMBER CARRIER ADDITIONAL REMARKS AGENCY CUSTOMER ID: CN102796740 LOC #: Norwalk ADDITIONAL REMARKS SCHEDULE Page 2 of 2 NAIC CODE NAMED INSURED POOLE & KENT COMPANY OF FLORIDA 1715 WEST LEMON STREET TAMPA,FL 33606 EFFECTIVE DATE: THIS ADDITIONAL REMARKS FORM IS A SCHEDULE TO ACORD FORM, FORM NUMBER. 25 FORM TITLE: Certificate of Liability Insurance AUTO PHYSICAL DAMAGE COMP / COLL DEDUCTIBLE $500 IN THE EVENT OF CANCELLATION OR MATERIAL CHANGE THAT REDUCES OR RESTRICTS THE INSURANCE AFFORDED BY THIS COVERAGE PART (OTHER THAN THE REDUCTION OF AGGREGATE LIMITS THROUGH PAYMENT OF CLAIMS AS APPLICABLE), INSURER AGREES TO MAIL PRIOR WRITTEN NOTICE OF CANCELLATION OR MATERIAL CHANGE TO: CERTIFICATE HOLDER SCHEDULE 1. NUMBER OF DAYS ADVANCE NOTICE: FOR ANY STATUTORILY PERMITTED REASON OTHER THAN NON-PAYMENT OF PREMIUM, THE NUMBER OF DAYS REQUIRED FOR NOTICE OF CANCELLATION AS PROVIDED IN PARAGRAPH 2 OF EITHER THE CANCELLATION COMMON POLICY CONDITIONS OR AS AMENDED BY THE APPLICABLE STATE CANCELLATION ENDORSEMENT IS INCREASED TO THE LESSER OF 60 DAYS OR THE NUMBER OF DAYS REQUIRED IN A WRITTEN CONTRACT. FOR NON-PAYMENT OF PREMIUM, THE GREATER OF (1) THE NUMBER OF DAYS REQUIRED BY STATE LAW OR (2) THE NUMBER OF DAYS REQUIRED BY WRITTEN CONTRACT. 2. NAME: NOTICE WILL BE MAILED TO: CERTIFICATE HOLDER • T ACORD 101 (2008/01) © 2008 ACORD CORPORATION. All rights reserved. The ACORD name and logo are registered marks of ACORD A� 0® CERTIFICATE OF PROPERTY INSURANCE °10/11/2021 THIS CERTIFICATE IS ISSUED AS A MATTER OF INFORMATION ONLY AND CONFERS NO RIGHTS UPON THE CERTIFICATE HOLDER. THIS CERTIFICATE DOES NOT AFFIRMATIVELY OR NEGATIVELY AMEND, EXTEND OR ALTER THE COVERAGE AFFORDED BY THE POLICIES BELOW. THIS CERTIFICATE OF INSURANCE DOES NOT CONSTITUTE A CONTRACT BETWEEN THE ISSUING INSURER(S), AUTHORIZED REPRESENTATIVE OR PRODUCER, AND THE CERTIFICATE HOLDER. PRODUCER Aon Risk Services Southwest, Inc. Houston TX Office 5555 San Felipe Suite 1500 Houston TX 77056 USA CONTACT NAME: PHONE (866) 283-7122 I FAX (800) 363-0105 (NC. No. Ext): (NC. No.): E-MAIL ADDRESS. PRODUCER 570000088002 CUSTOMER ID#: INSURER(S) AFFORDING COVERAGE NAIC # INSURED Poole & Kent Company of Florida 1715 W. Lemon Street Tampa FL 33606 USA INSURER A: GuideOne National Insurance Company 14167 INSURER B: 10/01/2021 INSURER c: INSURER D: INSURER E: INSURER F: • 570089852430 • LOCATION OF PREMISES/ DESCRIPTION OF PROPERTY (Attach ACORD 101, Additional Remarks Schedule, If more space is required) Evidence of Insurance - value of $200,000 THIS IS TO CERTIFY THAT THE POLICIES OF INSURANCE LISTED BELOW HAVE BEEN ISSUED TO THE INSURED NAMED ABOVE FOR THE POLICY PERIOD INDICATED. NOTWITHSTANDING ANY REQUIREMENT, TERM OR CONDITION OF ANY CONTRACT OR OTHER DOCUMENT WITH RESPECT TO WHICH THIS CERTIFICATE MAY BE ISSUED OR MAY PERTAIN, THE INSURANCE AFFORDED BY THE POLICIES DESCRIBED HEREIN IS SUBJECT TO ALL THE TERMS, EXCLUSIONS AND CONDITIONS OF SUCH POLICIES. LIMITS SHOWN MAY HAVE BEEN REDUCED BY PAID CLAIMS. INSR LTR TYPE OF INSURANCE POLICY NUMBER POLICY EFFECTIVE DATE (MM/DD/YYYY) POLICY EXPIRATION DATE (MM/DD/YYYY) COVERED PROPERTY LIMITS A )(PROPERTY OF LOSS DEDUCTIBLES 099002194 10/01/2021 10/01/2022 BUILDING PERSONAL PROPERTY BUSINESS INCOME EXTRA EXPENSE RENTAL VALUE CAUSES BASIC BUILDING - BROAD CONTENTS SPECIAL ' = BLANKET BUILDING EARTHQUAKE BLANKET PERS PROP BLANKET BLDG & PP Loss Limit WIND FLOOD X ALL RISK -Subject to Exclusions X $12,500,000 A X INLAND MARINE OF LOSS NAMED PERILS All Risk TYPE OF POLICY Builders Risk 10/01/2021 10/01/2022 x Job Site In Tranist Contractors Equipment Temp Storage $10,000,000 CAUSES — X $2,500,000 POLICY NUMBER 099002194 X $2,500,000 X X $3,000,000 CRIME OF POLICY TYPE JBOILER & MACHINERY / EQUIPMENT BREAKDOWN SPECIAL CONDITIONS / OTHER COVERAGES (ACORD 101, Additional Remarks Schedule, may be attached N more space is required) CERTIFICATE HOLDER CANCELLATION Holder Identifier : Poole & Kent company of Florida 1715 West Lemon street Tampa FL 33606 USA SHOULD ANY OF THE ABOVE DESCRIBED POLICIES BE CANCELLED BEFORE THE EXPIRATION DATE THEREOF, NOTICE WILL BE DELIVERED IN ACCORDANCE WITH THE POLICY PROVISIONS. AUTHORIZED REPRESENTATIVE ( ACORD 24 (2016/03) © 1995-2015 ACORD CORPORATION. All rights reserved. The ACORD name and logo are registered marks of ACORD Page 1 of 1 Aca 0" CERTIFICATE OF LIABILITY INSURANCE DATE(MMIDD/YYYY) 10/27/2021 THIS CERTIFICATE IS ISSUED AS A MATTER OF INFORMATION ONLY AND CONFERS NO RIGHTS UPON THE CERTIFICATE HOLDER. THIS CERTIFICATE DOES NOT AFFIRMATIVELY OR NEGATIVELY AMEND, EXTEND OR ALTER THE COVERAGE AFFORDED BY THE POLICIES BELOW. THIS CERTIFICATE OF INSURANCE DOES NOT CONSTITUTE A CONTRACT BETWEEN THE ISSUING INSURER(S), AUTHORIZED REPRESENTATIVE OR PRODUCER, AND THE CERTIFICATE HOLDER. IMPORTANT: If the certificate holder Is an ADDITIONAL INSURED, the policy(les) must have ADDITIONAL INSURED provisions or be endorsed. If SUBROGATION IS WAIVED, subject to the terms and conditions of the policy, certain policies may require an endorsement. A statement on this certificate does not confer rights to the certificate holder in lieu of such endorsement(s). PRODUCER Willis Towers Watson Northeast, Inc. c/o 26 Century Blvd P.O. Boz 305191 Nashville, TN 372305191 USA CONTACT Willis Towers Watson Certificate Center PHONE 1-877-945-7378 FAX 1-888-467-2378 INC. No. Ertl: IAIC No): p p3S: certificates@willia.com INSURER(S) AFFORDING COVERAGE NAIC 0 INSURERA: Steadfast Insurance Company 26387 INSURED Poole a Kant Company of Florida 1715 W. Lemon Street Tampa, FL 33606 INSURER B: INSURERC: INSURER D: S INSURER E : INSURER F : RAGES CERTIFICATE NUMBER: W22629101 • THIS IS TO CERTIFY THAT THE POLICIES OF INSURANCE LISTED BELOW HAVE BEEN ISSUED TO THE INSURED NAMED ABOVE FOR THE POLICY PERIOD INDICATED. NOTWITHSTANDING ANY REQUIREMENT, TERM OR CONDITION OF ANY CONTRACT OR OTHER DOCUMENT WITH RESPECT TO WHICH THIS CERTIFICATE MAY BE ISSUED OR MAY PERTAIN, THE INSURANCE AFFORDED BY THE POLICIES DESCRIBED HEREIN IS SUBJECT TO ALL THE TERMS, EXCLUSIONS AND CONDITIONS OF SUCH POLICIES. LIMITS SHOWN MAY HAVE BEEN REDUCED BY PAID CLAIMS. LTR TYPE OF INSURANCE INSD wvp POUCY NUMBER IMI POLICY EFF IMM DD/YYYUCY Y1 LIMITS /t- i _ /� �'f� Tampa, FL 33606 COMMERCIAL GENERAL UABILITY EACH OCCURRENCE S CLAIMS -MADE OCCUR DAMAGE TO RENTED PREMISES (Ea occurrence) $ MED EXP (Any one person) $ PERSONAL & ADV INJURY 8 GENL AGGREGATE POLICY OTHER: LIMIT APPLIES JPERCOT- PER: LOC GENERAL AGGREGATE 8 PRODUCTS - COMP/OP AGG S S AUTOMOBILE LIABILITY ANY AUTO OWNED AUTOS ONLY HIRED AUTOS ONLY _ SCHEDULED AUTOSaccident) NON -OWNED AUTOS ONLY COMBINED SINGLE LIMIT (Ea accident) $ BODILY INJURY (Per person) S BODILYINJURY(PerS PROPERTY DAMAGE (Per accident) S S _ UMBRELLA UAB EXCESS LIAR OCCUR CLAIMS -MADE EACH OCCURRENCE S AGGREGATE S DED RETENTION S S WORKERS COMPENSATION ANDEMPLOYERS'UABlUTY YIN ANYPROPRIETOR/PARTNER/EXECUTIVE OFFICER/MEMBEREXCLUDED? n (Mandatory In NH) Hes, describe under DESCRIPTION OF OPERATIONS below NIA PER OTH- STATUTE ER E.L. EACH ACCIDENT E E.L. DISEASE - EA EMPLOYEE S E.L. DISEASE - POLICY LIMIT S A Pollution Liability SOC 9817132 05 10/31/2021 10/31/2022 Per Claim Aggregate 82,000,000 82,000,000 DESCRIPTION OF OPERATIONS (LOCATIONS 1 VEHICLES (ACORD 101, Additional Remarks Schedule, may be attached If more space is required) Evidence of Insurance CERTIFICATE HOLDER ACORD 25 (2016103) © 1988-2016 ACORD CORPORATION. All rights reserved. The ACORD name and logo are registered marks of ACORD SR ID: 21755667 BATCH: 2287107 SHOULD ANY OF THE ABOVE DESCRIBED POLICIES BE CANCELLED BEFORE THE EXPIRATION DATE THEREOF, NOTICE WILL BE DELIVERED IN ACCORDANCE WITH THE POLICY PROVISIONS. Poole i Kent Company of Florida AUTHORIZED REPRESENTATIVE 1715 W. Lemon Street /t- i _ /� �'f� Tampa, FL 33606 SVrlw r �1 /tt/CNa— ACORD 25 (2016103) © 1988-2016 ACORD CORPORATION. All rights reserved. The ACORD name and logo are registered marks of ACORD SR ID: 21755667 BATCH: 2287107 Page 1 of 1 A`� o® CERTIFICATE OF LIABILITY INSURANCE DATE(MWDD�) 10/27/2021 THIS CERTIFICATE IS ISSUED AS A MATTER OF INFORMATION ONLY AND CONFERS NO RIGHTS UPON THE CERTIFICATE HOLDER. THIS CERTIFICATE DOES NOT AFFIRMATIVELY OR NEGATIVELY AMEND, EXTEND OR ALTER THE COVERAGE AFFORDED BY THE POLICIES BELOW. THIS CERTIFICATE OF INSURANCE DOES NOT CONSTITUTE A CONTRACT BETWEEN THE ISSUING INSURER(S), AUTHORIZED REPRESENTATIVE OR PRODUCER, AND THE CERTIFICATE HOLDER. IMPORTANT: If the certificate holder is an ADDITIONAL INSURED, the policy(ies) must have ADDITIONAL INSURED provisions or be endorsed. If SUBROGATION IS WAIVED, subject to the terms and conditions of the policy, certain policies may require an endorsement. A statement on this certificate does not confer rights to the certificate holder in lieu of such endorsement(s). PRODUCER Willis Towers Watson Northeast, Inc. oho 26 Century Blvd P.O. Box 305191 Nashville, TN 372305191 USA CONTACT Willis Towers Watson Certificate Center NAME: PHONE .�g 1-877-945-7378 ( No): 1-888-467-2378 E-MAIL certificates@willia.com INSURER(S) AFFORDING COVERAGE NAICX INSURER A: Steadfast Insurance Company 26387 INSURED Poole 6 Kent Company of Florida 1715 W. Lemon Street Tampa, PL 33606 INSURER B: INSURER C: INSURER D : $ INSURER E : CLAIMS MADE INSURER F : OCCUR CERTIFICATE NUMBER: W22629097 • THIS IS TO CERTIFY THAT THE POLICIES OF INSURANCE LISTED BELOW HAVE BEEN ISSUED TO THE INSURED NAMED ABOVE FOR THE POLICY PERIOD INDICATED. NOTWITHSTANDING ANY REQUIREMENT, TERM OR CONDITION OF ANY CONTRACT OR OTHER DOCUMENT WITH RESPECT TO WHICH THIS CERTIFICATE MAY BE ISSUED OR MAY PERTAIN, THE INSURANCE AFFORDED BY THE POLICIES DESCRIBED HEREIN IS SUBJECT TO ALL THE TERMS, EXCLUSIONS AND CONDITIONS OF SUCH POLICIES. LIMITS SHOWN MAY HAVE BEEN REDUCED BY PAID CLAIMS. INSR LTR TYPE OF INSURANCE ADOL INSD SUBR WVD POUCY NUMBER POLICY EFF IMM/DDIYYYYI POLICY EXP IMMIDDIYYYY) LIMITS COMMERCIAL GENERAL LIABILITY EACH OCCURRENCE $ CLAIMS MADE OCCUR DAMAGE TO RENTED PREMISES (Ea occurrence) $ _ _ _ _ _ MED EXP (Any one person) S PERSONAL & ADV INJURY S GEN% AGGREGATE POLICY OTHER. LIMIT APPLIES JECT PER: LOC GENERAL AGGREGATE S PRODUCTS - COMP/OP AGG S S AUTOMOBLEUABIUTY _ ANY AUTO OWNED AUTOS ONLY HIRED AUTOS ONLY _ SCHEDULED AUTOS NON -OWNED AUTOS ONLY COMBINED SINGLE LIMIT (Ea accident) $ BODILY INJURY (Per person) S BODILY INJURY (Per accident) S PROPERTY DAMAGE (Per accident) S S UMBRELLA UAB EXCESS UAB OCCUR CLAIMS -MADE EACH OCCURRENCE S AGGREGATE $ DED RETENTIONS S WORKERS COMPENSATION AND EMPLOYERS LIABIUTY , / N ANYPROPRIETOR/PARTNER/EXECUTIVE OFFICER/MEMBER yER EXCLUDED? (Mandatory In M NNH) It yes, describe under DESCRIPTION OF OPERATIONS below N / A PER OTH- STATUTE ER E.L. EACH ACCIDENT S E.L. DISEASE - EA EMPLOYEE S E.L. DISEASE - POLICY LIMIT S A Professional Liability EOC 9817132 05 10/31/2021 10/31/2022 Per Claim Aggregate 82,000,000 $2,000,000 DESCRIPTION OF OPERATIONS I LOCATIONS / VEHICLES (ACORD 101, Additions! Remarks Schedule, may be attached M more apace is requited) Evidence of Insurance CERTIFICATE HOLDER Poole 6 Fent Company of Florida 11715 W. Lemon Street Tampa, FL 33606 SHOULD ANY OF THE ABOVE DESCRIBED POLICIES BE CANCELLED BEFORE THE EXPIRATION DATE THEREOF, NOTICE WILL BE DELIVERED IN ACCORDANCE WITH THE POLICY PROVISIONS. AUTHORIZED REPRESENTATIVE 19/ 41_, N" r%"^" 4 ACORD 25 (2016/03) ©1988-2016 ACORD CORPORATION. All rights reserved. The ACORD name and logo are registered marks of ACORD SR ID: 21755667 PATCH: 2287107 • • Bonding Poole & Kent Contractors An EMCOR Company Poole & Kent Company of Florida is bonded through Travelers Casualty and Surety Company of America and Federal Insurance Company. Our Bonding Agent is Alliant Insurance Services, Inc. Travelers Casualty & Surety Company of America 343 Thornall Street, 5th Floor Edison, NJ 08837-2238 Phone: 732-321-5600 Contact: Joseph Powers Rated A++ (Superior) Chubb & Son a division of Federal Insurance Company 150 Allen Road Basking Ridge, NJ 07920 Phone: 908-605-3154 Contact: Michael D. Romano Rated A++ (Superior) Alliant Insurance Services, Inc. 333 Earle Ovington Blvd., Suite 700 Uniondale, NY 11553-3610 Phone: 516-414-8907 Contact: Rita Losquadro Florida License #L075432 Florida Resident Agent 7108 Fairway Drive, Suite 225 Palm Beach Gardens, FL 33418 Phone: 561-214-6371 Contact: Peter F. Jones Poole & Kent Company of Florida has an aggregate bonding capacity of $500,000,000 and individual projects of $200,000,000. Headquarters - Miami -Dade County 1781 N.W. North River Drive Miami. FL 33125 P:305-325-1930 Hillsborough County 1715 W. Lemon Street Tampa, FL 33506 P:813-251-2438 Palm Beach County 801 Northpoint Parkway, Ste 564 West Palm Beach, FL 33407 P:561-721 6439 Charlotte County 18245 Paulson Drive. Ste 6125 Port Charlotte, FL 33954 P:941-206-2210 Broward County 1451 W. Cypress Creek Rd 5310 Fort Lauderdale. FL 33309 P:954-334-5818 • • • • FRONT PAGE CONTRACTOR'S PERFORMANCE AND PAYMENT BOND (Public Work) Bond No.: Contractor Name: Contractor Address: Contractor Phone No.: Surety Company: Owner Name: Owner Address: Owner Phone No.: (If different from property Owner, or Dual Obligee) Obligee Address: Obligee Phone No.: Bond Amount: * 107664935 / K41592102 * Poole & Kent Company of Florida *1715 W. Lemon Street, Tampa, FL 33606 *813-251-2438 *Travelers Casualty and Surety Company of America Federal Insurance Company *City of Clearwater, Florida *100 S. Myrtle Avenue Clearwater, FL 33756 *727-562-4747 *Same as above *Same as above *$3,161,578.20 Contract No. (if applicable) * Project No. 18 -0047 -UT Description of Work: * Marshall Street WRF Process Control Gate Repairs (FDEP) Project Location: * City of Clearwater, Florida Legal Description: * Marshall Street WRF Process Control Gate Repairs (FDEP) Project No. 18 -0047 -UT This Bond has been furnished to comply with the requirements of F.S. 255.05. This bond is hereby amended such that all provisions and limitations, including conditions, notice and time limitations of F.S. 255.05 are incorporated herein by reference. Any provision of this bond which conflicts with or purports to grant broader or more expanded coverage in excess of the minimum of the applicable statute shall be deemed deleted herefrom. This bond is a statutory bond, not a common law bond. This is the front page of the Performance/Payment Bond(s) regardless of preprinted numbers on other pages issued in compliance with Florida Statute 255.05. n/share/bon ds/f rontpag SECTION V — Contract Documents • Bond No.: 107664935 / K41592102 • • PUBLIC CONSTRUCTION BOND (I) This bond is given to comply with § 255.05, Florida Statutes, and any action instituted by a claimant under this bond for payment must be in accordance with the notice and time limitation provisions in subsections (2) and (10). Pursuant to § 255.05(1)(b), Florida Statutes, "Before commencing the work or before recommencing the work after a default or abandonment, the contractor shall provide to the public entity a certified copy of the recorded bond. Notwithstanding the terms of the contract or any other law governing prompt payment for construction services, the public entity may not make a payment to the contractor until the contractor has complied with this paragraph." CONTRACTOR SURETY OWNER Poole & Kent Travelers Casualty and Surety Company of America & Federal Insurance Company Company of Florida 1715 W. Lemon Street Tampa, FL 33606 One Tower Square, Hartford, CT 06183 (TR) 202B Halls Mill Rd, Whitehouse Station, NJ 08889 (FE) (813) 251-2438 732-321-5616 (TR), 908-360-7927 (FE) City of Clearwater Engineering 100 S. Myrtle Avenue Clearwater, FL 33756 (727) 562-4750 PROJECT NAME: MARSHALL STREET WRF PROCESS CONTROL GATE REPAIRS (FDEP) PROJECT NO.: 18 -0047 -UT PROJECT DESCRIPTION: Design improvements include the replacement of the existing slide gates within the aeration basins 4-13. While the basins are isolated and drained for gate replacement, the Contractor will remove all accumulated grit in the aeration basins, replace damaged or missing elements of the diffused air system and make structural repairs as noted on the plans. BY THIS BOND, We, Poole & Kent Company of Florida, as Contractor, and Travelers Casualty and Surety Company of America & Federal Insurance Company, a corporation, as Surety, are bound to the City of Clearwater, Florida, herein called Owner, in the sum of $3,161,578.20, for payment of which we bind ourselves, our heirs, personal representatives, successors, and assigns, jointly and severally. THE CONDITION OF THIS BOND is that if Contractor: 1. Performs the contract dated , between Contractor and Owner for construction of Marshall Street WRF Process Control Gate Repairs (FDEP), the contract documents being made a part of this bond by reference (which include the Advertisement for Bids, Proposal, Contract, Surety Bond, Instructions to Bidders, General Conditions, Plans, Technical Specifications and Appendix, and such alterations as may be made in said Plans and Specifications as therein provided for), at the times and in the manner prescribed in the contract; and 2. Promptly makes payments to all claimants, as defined in Section 255.05(1), Florida Statutes, supplying Contractor with labor, materials, or supplies, used directly or indirectly by Contractor in the prosecution of the work provided for in the contract; and SECTION V Page 1 of 16 Updated: 5/4/2020 SECTION V — Contract Documents • Bond No.: 107664935 / K41592102 PUBLIC CONSTRUCTION BOND (2) 3. Pays Owner all losses, damages, expenses, costs, and attorney's fees, including appellate proceedings, that Owner sustains because of a default by Contractor under the contract; and 4. To the limits of § 725.06(2), Florida Statutes, shall indemnify and hold harmless Owner, their officers and employees, from liabilities, damages, losses and costs, including, but not limited to, reasonable attorney's fees, to the extent caused by the negligence, recklessness, or intentional wrongful misconduct of Contractor and persons employed or utilized by Contractor in the performance of the construction contract; and 5. Performs the guarantee of all work and materials furnished under the contract for the time specified in the contract, then this bond is void; otherwise it remains in full force. 6. Any action instituted by a claimant under this bond for payment must be in accordance with the notice and time limitation provisions in Section 255.05(2), Florida Statutes. 7. Any changes in or under the contract documents and compliance or noncompliance with any formalities connected with the contract or the changes does not affect Surety's obligation under this bond, and Surety does hereby waive notice of any such change, extension of time, alteration or addition to the terms of the contract or to the work or to the specifications. IN TESTIMONY WHEREOF, witness the hands and seals of the parties hereto this 17th day of August , 20 22 . (If sole Ownership or Partnership, two (2) Witnesses required). • (If Corporation, Secretary only will attest and affix seal). • WITNESS: Corporate Se• ety or Witness Print Name: David A. Strickland, Assistant Secretary 2s� _p+/f SECTION V POOLE & KEIYT.COMPANY QF FLORIDA By: Title: President & CEO Print Name: WITNESS: Patrick H. Carr Print Name: Travelers Casualty and Surety Company of America & Federal Insurance Company (Corporate Surety) By: G • • ATTORNEY-IN-FACT Print Name: Camille Maitland (affix corporate seal) (Power of Attorney must be attached);; Page 2 of 16 Updatad: 5/412020 • • FLORIDA DEPARTMENT OF FINANCIAL SERVICES Non Resident Insurance License .0920 - NONRES GEN LINES (PROP & CAS) Please Note: CAMILLE M MAITLAND License Number : W012268 Issue Date 09/03/2010 NOTICE - This non-resident license is limited to the classes of insurance reflected above and is further limited to ONLY those classes of insurance for which you are licensed in your home state. A licensee may only transact insurance with an active appointment by an eligible insurer or employer. If you are acting as a surplus lines agent, public adjuster, or reinsurance intermediary manager/broker, you should have an appointment recorded in your own name on file with the Department. If you are unsure of your license status you should contact the Florida Department of Financial Services immediately. This license will expire if more than 48 months elapse without an appointment for each class of insurance listed. If such expiration occurs, the individual will be required to re -qualify as a first-time applicant. If this license was obtained by passing a licensure examination offered by the Florida Department of Financial Services, the licensee is required to comply with continuing education requirements contained in 626.2815 or 648.385, Florida Statutes. A licensee may track their continuing education requirements completed or needed in their MyProfile account at https://dice.fldfs.com. To validate the accuracy of this license you may review the individual license record under "Licensee Search" on the Florida Department of Financial Services website at http://www.MyFloridaCFO.com/Division/Agents 1014-04 Jeff Atwater Chief Financial Officer State of Florida • • • 7RAVELERgr Travelers Casualty and Surety Company of America Travelers Casualty and Surety Company St. Paul Fire and Marine Insurance Company POWER OF ATTORNEY KNOW ALL MEN BY THESE PRESENTS: That Travelers Casualty and Surety Company of America, Travelers Casualty and Surety Company, and St. Paul Fire and Marine Insurance Company are corporations duly organized under the laws of the State of Connecticut (herein collectively called the "Companies"), and that the Companies do hereby make, constitute and appoint Camille Maitland of UNIONDALE , New York their true and lawful Attomey(s)-in-Fact to sign, execute, seal and acknowledge any and all bonds, recognizances, conditional undertakings and other writings obligatory in the nature thereof on behalf of the Companies in their business of guaranteeing the fidelity of persons, guaranteeing the performance of contracts and executing or guaranteeing bonds and undertakings required or permitted in any actions or proceedings allowed by law, IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the Companies have caused this instrument to be signed, and their corporate seals to be hereto affixed, this 21st day of April, 2021. State of Connecticut By: City of Hartford as. Via,,, Robert L. Ra .: ' - nior Vice President On this the 21st day of AprH, 2021, before me personally appeared Robert L. Raney, who acknowledged himself to be the Senior Vice President of each of the Companies, and that he, as such, being authorized so to do, executed the foregoing instrument for the purposes therein contained by signing on behalf of said Companies by himself as a duly authorized officer, IN WITNESS WHEREOF, 1 hereunto set my hand and official seal. My Commission expires the 30th day of June, 2026 This Power of Attomey is granted under and by the authority of the following resolutions adopted by the Boards of Directors of each of the Companies, which resolutions are now in full force and effect, reading as follows: RESOLVED, that the Chairman, the President, any Vice Chairman, any Executive Vice President, any Senior Vice President, any Vice President, any Second Vice President, the treasurer, any Assistant Treasurer, the Corporate Secretary or any Assistant Secretary may appoint Attomeys-in-Fact and Agents to ad for and on behalf of the Company and may give such appointee such authority as his or her certificate of authority may prescribe to sign with the Company's name and seal with the Company's seal bonds, recognizances, contracts of indemnity, and other writings obligatory in the nature of a bond, recognizance, or conditional undertaking, and any of said officers or the Board of Directors at any time may remove any such appointee and revoke the power given him or her; and it is FURTHER RESOLVED, that the Chairman, the President, any Vice Chairman, any Executive Vice President, any Senior Vice President or any Vice President may delegate all or any part of the foregoing authority to one or more officers or employees of this Company, provided that each such delegation is in writing and a copy thereof is filed in the office of the Secretary; and itis FURTHER RESOLVED, that any bond, recognizance, contract of indemnity, or writing obligatory in the nature of a bond, recognizance, ` or conditional undertaking shall be valid and binding upon the Company when (a) signed by the President, any Vice Chairman, any Executive Vice President, any Senior Vice President or any Vice President, any Second Vice President, the Treasurer, any Assistant Treasurer, the Corporate Secretary or any Assistant Secretary and duly attested and sealed with the Company's seal by a Secretary or Assistant Secretary; or (b) duly executed (under seal, if required) by one or more Attomeys-in-Fact and Agents pursuant to the power prescribed in his or her certificate or their certificates of authority or by one or more Company officers pursuant to a written delegation of authority; and it is FURTHER RESOLVED, that the signature of each of the following officers: President, any Executive Vice President, any Senior Vice President, any Vice President, any Assistant Vice President, any Secretary, any Assistant Secretary, and the seal of the Company may be affixed by facsimile to any Power of Attorney or to any certificate relating thereto appointing Resident Vice Presidents, Resident Assistant Secretaries or Attorneys -in - Fad for purposes only of executing and attesting bonds and undertakings and other writings obligatory in the nature thereof, and any such Power of Attomey or certificate bearing such facsimile signature or facsimile seal shall be valid and binding upon the Company and any such power so executed and certified by such facsimile signature and facsimile seal shall be valid and binding on the Company in the future with respect to any bond or understanding to which it is attached. I, Kevin E. Hughes, the undersigned. Assistant Secretary of each of the Companies, do hereby certify that the above and foregoing is a true and correct copy of the Power of Attorney executed by said Companies, which remains in full force and effect. _tr Dated this 17th day of August .2022 • • '6. To verily the aumentldlyofthis Powar igtLorsey,3P call upsat1-800-4213880. Please relarta the above-namedAHnmey(s)-/n-Fact and the details oftlte bond to whkh this Potrero,Aftomea /s attached. Kevin E. Hughes�Secretary "' State of Florida TRAVELERS CASUALTY AND SURETY COMPANY OF AMERICA HARTFORD, CT 06183 PRINCIPAL'S ACKNOWLEDGMENT , County of Miami -Dade }ss. On this 18th day of August in the year 20 22, before me, the undersigned, personally appeared Patrick H. Carr personally known to me or proved to me on the basis of satisfactory evidence to be the individual whose name is subscribed to the within instrument and acknowledged to me that he/she executed the same in his/her capacity, and that by his/her signature on the instrument, the individual, or the person upon behalf of which the individual acted, executed the instrument. State of NEW YORK On this 1 day of TS C Lt d t in the year 20 Z -Z - personal ly known to me, and who, being Nassau County, New York SURETY COMPANY'S ACKNOWLEDGMENT , County of NASSAU }ss. ,�►t+44; WENDY CAMPBELL ,„i MY COMMISSION # HH 062370 r_o' EXPIRES: February 1, 2025 _,,f, or n? Bpcded Thru Notary Public Underflters me, the undersigned, personally appeared Camille Maitland by me duly sworn, did depose and say: That he/she resides in : that he/she is Attorney -in -Fact of TRAVELERS CASUALTY AND SURETY COMPANY OF AMERICA, the corporation described in and which executed the within instrument: that he/she knows the corporate seal of said Company: that the seal affixed to said instrument is such corporate seal: and that he/she signed said instrument as Attorney -in -Fact by authority of the Board of Directors of said Company: and affiant did further depose and say that the Superintendent of the State of New York Department of Financial Services has. pursuant to Section 1111 of the New York Insurance Law, issued to TRAVELERS CASUALTY AND SURETY COMPANY OF AMERICA his/her certificate that said Company is qualified to become and be accepted as surety or guarantor on all bonds, undertakings. recognizances, guaranties, and other obligations required or permitted by law: and that such certificate has not been revoked. TRAVELERS CASUALTY AND SURETY COMPANY OF AMERICA HARTFORD, CONNECTICUT 06183 FINANCIAL STATEMENT. AS OF DECEMBER 31, 2021 AS FILED IN THE STATE OF NEW YORK CAPITAL STOCK $ 6.480,000 Notary Public NELLY RENCHIWICH M Notary Public -State of New York No. 01RE6218158 Qualified in Nassau County Commission Expires March 1, 2026 ASSETS LIABILITIES & SURPLUS BONDS STOCKS CASH AND INVESTED CASH OTHER INVESTED ASSETS SECURITIES LENDING REINVESTED COLLATERAL ASSETS INVESTMENT INCOME DUE AND ACCRUED PREMIUM BALANCES REINSURANCE RECOVERABLE NET DEFERRED T# ASSET OTHER ASSETS TOTAL ASSETS $ 4,427,068,873 90,892.083 3,976,380 4.609.133 7,433.086 37.877.324 294.081.729 70.677.646 60.156.960 3.286.703 $ 5.000.059.915 LOSSES LOSS ADJUSTMENT EXPENSES COMMISSIONS OTHER EXPENSES TAXES. LICENSES AND FEES CURRENT FEDERAL AND FOREIGN INCOME TAXES UNEARNED PREMIUMS ADVANCE PREMIUM POLICYHOLDER DIVIDENDS CEDED REINSURANCE NET PREMIUMS PAYABLE AMOUNTS WITHHELD / RETAINED BY COMPANY FOR OTHERS REMITTANCES AND ITEMS NOT ALLOCATED PROVISION FOR REINSURANCE PAYABLE TO PARENT, SUBSIDIARIES AND AFFILIATES PAYABLE FOR SECURITIES LENDING ESCHEAT LIABILITY RETROACTIVE REINSURANCE RESERVE ASSUMED OTHER ACCRUED EXPENSES AND LIABILITIES TOTAL LIABILITIES CAPITAL STOCK PAID IN SURPLUS OTHER SURPLUS TOTAL SURPLUS TO POLICYHOLDERS $ 1,224.258,147 157.266.812 49.977.644 46,607.590 16.655.025 1.972 277 1.212,347,629 1.824,313 14,256.052 47;473.619 42,097.038 10.579,448 6.873.132 40,373.235 7.433.086 537.132 816,092 250.005 $ 2,881,598.277 $ 6.480 000 433.803 760 1,678,177, 878 $ 2.118.461.638 TOTAL LIABILITIES & SURPLUS $ 5,000.059,915 • • • CHUBB' Power of Attorney Federal Insurance Company I Vigilant Insurance Company 1 Pacific Indemnity Company Westchester Fire Insurance Company 1 ACE American Insurance Company Know All by These Presents, that FEDERAL INSURANCE COMPANY, an Indiana corporation, VIGILANT INSURANCE COMPANY. a New York corporation, PACIFIC INDEMNITY COMPANY, a Wisconsin corporation, WESTCHESTER FIRE INSURANCE COMPANY and ACE AMERICAN INSURANCE COMPANY corporations of the Commonwealth of Pennsylvania, do each hereby constintte and appoint Katherine Acosta, Thomas Bean, George O. Brewster, Desiree Cardlin, Colette R. Chisholm, Dana Granice, Susan Lupski, Gerard 5. Macholz, Camille Maitland, Robert T. Pearson, Nelly Renchiwich, Rita Losquadro, Vincent A. Walsh, Michelle Wannamaker and Ian Williams of Uniondale, New York each as their true and lawful Attorney -In -Fact to execute under such designation in their names and to affix their corporate seals to and deliver for and on their behalf as surety thereon or otherwise, bonds and undertakings and other writings obligatory in the nature thereof (other than ball bonds) given or executed in the course of business, and any instruments amending or altering the same, and consents to the modification or alteration of any instrument referred to in said bonds or obligations. Itt Witness Whereof, said FEDERAL INSURANCE COMPANY, VIGILANT INSURANCE COMPANY, PACIFIC INDEMNITY COMPANY, WESTCHESTER FIRE INSURANCE COMPANY and ACE AMERICAN INSURANCE COMPANY have each executed and attested these presents and affixed their corporate seals on this Zm day of August, 2022. Qoust,—smesrasetkas Iktvin \I. cullacts Attasistant Secretary Swphfn M. Haney. Vice President STATE OF NEW JERSEY County of Hunterdon ss. On this 2.3 day of August, 2022 before me, a Notary Public of New Jersey, personally came Dawn M. Chloros and Stephen M. Haney, to me known to be Assistant Secretary and Vice President respectively, of FEDERAL INSURANCECOMPANY,VIGiLANT INSURANCE COMPANY, PACIFIC INDEMNITY COMPANY, WESTCHESTER FIRE INSURANCE COMPANY and ACE AMERICAN INSURANCE COMPANY, the companies which executed the foregoing Power of Attorney, and the said Dawn M. Chloros and Stephen M. Haney, being by me duly sworn, severally and each for herself and himself did depose and say that they are Assistant Secretary and Vice President, respectively, of FEDERAL INSURANCE COMPANY, VIGILANT INSURANCE COMPANY, PACIFIC INDEMNITY COMPANY, WESTCHESTER FiRE INSURANCE COMPANY and ACE AMERICAN INSURANCE COMPANY and know the corporate seals thereof, that the seals affixed to the foregoing Power of Attorney are such corporate seals and were thereto affixed by authority of said Companies; and that their signatures as such officers were duly affixed and subscribed by like authority. Notarial Seat KATHERINE J. AOELAAR NOTARY PUBLIC OF NEW JERSEY No. 2316688 COM839180n Eapir*e July 16.2024 CERTIFICATION Resolutions adopted by the Boards of Directors of FEDERAL INSURANCE COMPANY, VIGILANT INSURANCE COMPANY, and PACIFIC INDEMNITY COMPANY on August 30, 2016; WESTCHESTER FIRE INSURANCE COMPANY on December 11, 2006; and ACE AMERICAN INSURANCE COMPANY on March 20, 2009: 'RESOLVED, that the following authorizations relate to the execution, for and on behalf of the Company, of bonds, undertakings, recognizanoes, contracts and other written conunttments of the Company entered Into m the ordinary course of business (each a 'Written Commitment"): (1) Each of the Chairman, the President and the Vice Presidents of the Company is hereby authorized to execute any Written Commitment for and on behalf of the Company, under the seal of theCompany or otherwise. (2) Each duly appointed attorney-in-fact of the Company is hereby authorized to execute any Written Commitment for and on behalf of the Company, under the seal of the Company or otherwise, to the extent that such action is authorized by the grant of powers provided for in such person's written appointment as such attorney-in-fact Each of six. Chairmen. the Praeid.ni ttnd the Vise ProeWwKs of thy Company I. h...by Authorised, for and on behalf of Qt. Company, to appoint In writing any parson tins attorney-tn- fact of the Company with NR power and authority to execute, for and on behalf of the Company, under the seal of the Company or otherwise, such Written Commitments of the Company as may be spedfled in such written appointment which specification may be by general type or class of Written Commitments or by specification of one or more particular Written Commitments. (4) Each of the Chairman, the President and the Vice Presidents of the Company Is hereby authorized, for and on behalf of the Company. to delegate in writing to any other officer of the Company the authority to execute, for and on behalf of the Company, under the Company's seal or otherwise, such Written Commitments of the Company as are specified in such written delegation, which spedtcation may be by general type or class of Written Commitments or by specification of one or more particular Written Commitments. (5) The signature of any officer or other person executing any Written Commitment or appointment or delegation pursuant to this Resolution, and the seal of the Company, may be affixed by facsimile on such Written Commitment or written appointment or delegation FURTHER RESOLVED, that the foregoing Resolution shall not be deemed to be an exclusive statement of the powers and authority of officers, employees and other persons to act for and on behalf of the Company, and such Resolution shall not limit or otherwise affect the exercise ofany such power or authority otherwise validly granted or vested.' I, Dawn M. Chloros, Assistant Secretary of FEDERAL INSURANCE COMPANY, VIGILANT INSURANCE COMPANY, PACIFIC INDEMNITY COMPANY, WESTCHESTER FIRE INSURANCE COMPANY and ACE AMERICAN INSURANCE COMPANY (the 'Companies') do hereby certify that (I) the foregoing Resolutions adopted by the Board of Oil eclurs of the Companies are true, correct and in full force and effect, (U) the foregohtg Power of Attorney is true, correct and in fill force and effect. Given under my hand and seals of said Companies at Whitehouse Station, NJ, this 17th day of August, 2022 (3) >X(}A rt,,.T1. l of w.tSL7/t.0 Item M. (:hicwca. rtver,tant Svcrct:tr IN THE EVENT YOU WISH TO VERIFY THE AUTHENTICITY OF THIS 80(40 OR NOTIFY US OF ANY OTHER MATTER, PLEASE CONTACT US AT: Telephone (908)903- 3493. Fax (908) 903- 3656 e-mail: surety®chubb.com Combined FED-VIG-PI•WFIC-AAIC (rev. 11.19) • • • ACKNOWLEDGMENT OF SURETY COMPANY STATE OF NEW YORK ) COUNTY OF NASSAU On this Al G r 4- 1/ 20 LZ , before me personally came Camille Maitland to me known, who, being by me duly sworn, did depose and say; that he/she resides in Nassau County , State of New York that he/she is the Attorney -In -Fact of the Federal Insurance Company the corporation described in which executed the above instrument; that he/she knows the seal of said corporation; that the seal affixed to said instrument is such corporate seal; that is was so affixed by the Board of Directors of said corporation; and that he/she signed his/her name thereto by like order; and the affiant did further depose and say that the Superintendent of Insurance of the State of New York, has pursuant to Section 1111 of the Insurance Law of the State of New York, issued to Federal Insurance Company (Surety) his/her certificate of qualification evidencing the qualification of said Company and its sufficiency under any law of the State of New York as surety and guarantor, and the propriety of accepting and approving it as such; and that such certifica - h s of men revoked NY acknowledgement Notary c NEL Y RENCHIWICH M Notary Public -State of New York No. 01RE6218158 Qualified in Nassau County Commission Expires March 1, 2026 • • • FEDERAL INSURANCE COMPANY STATEMENT OF ASSETS, LIABLITi ES AND SURPLUS TO POLICYHOLDERS y Basis December 31.2021 ASSETS Cash and Short Term Investments United Stents Government, Stats and Municipal Bonds Other Bonds Stocks Other Invested Assets TOTAL INVESTMENTS Investments in A1Wietss: Greet Northern Ins. Co. Vigilant Ire Co. Chubb Indemnity Ins. Co. Chubb National Ins. Co. Other Affiliates Premiums s Receivable Other Assets TOTAL ADMITTED ASSETS $ (567.308) 4,271,534 5,994,873 875,588 1.847.712 12,022,201 414,838 354,898 183,242 190,801 118,373 1,728,853 3.078.488 $ 18.087.070 (In thousands) LABAITIES AND SURPLUS 70 POLICYHOLDERS Oubtendn9 Losses and Loss Expenses $ 8,701,383 Reinsurance Payable on Losses and Expenses 1,484,198 Unearned Premiums 2,400,711 Ceded Reinsurance Premiums Payable 388,332 Other Lknbifliss 498.472 TOTAL UABILJTIES Capital Stock Paid -In Surplus Unassigned Funds SURPLUS TO POLICYHOLDERS TOTAL UASIUTIES AND SURPLUS 13.451.094 20.980 2,711,474 1.903.522 4.835.978 ti r, $1813'7 j ni, r Invesbnents ars valued in accordance with requirements of the National Assodalton of Insurance Commissioners, At December 31 2621, kmveatm enta with a denying value of $509,065,182 were deposited with govemrrent authorities as required by law. STATE OF PENNSYLVANIA COUNTY OF PHILADELPHIA John Taylor, being duly sworn, says that he is Senior Vice President of Federal Insurance Company and that to the best of his knowledge and belief the foregoing le a true and corned statement of the said Companys financial oondibon as of the 31 at day of December. 2021. Sworn betas Mach 14 i 2022 • i `rhe./j .T,, ' - Commonwealth of Pennsylvania - Notary Seal Jaime L. Yates, Notary Public Piteadelphia Comty My commission expires SSPta '199, 2023 Commission number 1 Member, Pennsylvania Association of Notaries • Poole & Kent Contractors An EMCOR Company 1715 W. LEMON STREET • TAMPA, FLORIDA 33606 TELEPHONE: (813) 251-2438 FAX: (813) 253-2515 TO: City of Clearwater 100 South Myrtle Avenue Clearwater, FL 33756 A1TN: Ivan Tamayo WE TRANSMIT Submittal data Copy of letter X Attached Shop Drawings Sample _ET EROF CELEBRATING YEARS 1947 - 2022 RANSM TTA DATE August 22, 2022 JOB NO. 22702 REF: Marshall Street WRF Process Control Gate Repairs Project No. 18 -0047 -UT (City of Clearwater) 1 Hand carried Change order request UPS Overnight Separate cover via Plans Specifications COPIES DATA ITEM DESCRIPTION 1 Original Payment & Performance Bonds (Signed, Sealed, Notarized) 1 Original Surety Letter Authorizing City to Date Bonds 1 Copy Insurance Certificate THESE ARE TRANSMITTED as checked below: X For approval For your use & information As requested For review and comment For BIDS DUE Approved as submitted Approved as noted Amend and Resubmit Sign and return RELEASE EQUIPMENT ON THIS ORDER FOR MANUFACTURE AND SHIPMENT TO ARRIVE ON JOBSITE ON OR ABOUT ACKNOWLEDGEMENT OF THIS TRANSMITTAL REQUESTED. REMARKS: COMMENTS: Copy - P&K File (Tampa) • Resubmit Submit Return Copies for approval Copies for distribution Copies for prints PRINTS RETURN AFTER LOAN TO US PROVISION OF SET OF MAINTENANCE INSTRUCTIONS AND SPARE LISTS ARE A PART OF THIS ORDER._INVOICES ON THIS ORDER WILL NOT BE HONORED UNTIL THEIR RECEIPT. AIG c: Poole & Kent Company of Florida By Debbie Holloway, Project Administrator � TRAVELERS) • • Travelers Bond & Financial Products Construction Services, One Tower Square, Hartford, CT 06183 Phone: 732-321-5600 Fax: 866-829-0409 August 17, 2022 City of Clearwater, Florida 100 South Myrtle Avenue Clearwater, FL 33756 Federal Insurance Company, 202B Halls Mill Road Whitehouse Station, NJ 08889 Phone: 908-860-4672 Fax: 908-903-79100 RE: Authority to Date Bonds Principal: Poole & Kent Company of Florida Bond No.: 107664935 / 1(41592102 Project: Marshall Street WRF Process Control Gate Repairs (FDEP) Project No. 18 -0047 -UT Dear Sir or Madam: Please be advised that as Surety on the above referenced bond executed on behalf of Poole & Kent Company of Florida, we hereby authorize you to date the bond with the date of the contract. Once dated, please send a copy of the dated bond to Alliant Insurance Services, Inc., attn: Camille Maitland, 333 Earle Ovington Blvd, Suite 700, Uniondale, NY 11553 Best Regards, Travelers Casualty and Surety Company of America Federal Insurance Company Camille Maitland Attorney -in -Fact and Florida Licensed Non -Resident Agent. • • • TRAVELERtT Travelers Casualty and Surety Company of America Travelers Casualty and Surety Company St. Paul Fire and Marine Insurance Company POWER OF ATTORNEY KNOW ALL MEN BY THESE PRESENTS: That Travelers Casualty and Surety Company of America, Travelers Casualty and Surety Company, and St. Paul Fire and Marine Insurance Company are corporations duly organized under the laws of the State of Connecticut (herein collectively called the "Companies"), and that the Companies do hereby make, constitute and appoint Camille Maitland of UNIONDALE , New York , their true and lawful Attomey(s)-in-Fact to sign, execute, seal and acknowledge any and all bonds, recognizances, conditional undertakings and other writings obligatory in the nature thereof on behalf of the Companies in their business of guaranteeing the fidelity of persons, guaranteeing the performance of contracts and executing or guaranteeing bonds and undertakings required or permitted in any actions or proceedings allowed by law. IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the Companies have caused this instrument to be signed, and their corporate seals to be hereto affixed, this 21st day of April, 2021. State of Connecticut By: City of Hartford ss. Robert L. Ra - nior Vice President On this the 21st day of Apra, 2021, before ma personally appeared Robert L. Raney, who acknowledged himself to be the Senior Vice President of each of the Companies, and that he, as such, being authorized so to do, executed the foregoing instrument for the purposes therein contained by signing on behalf of said Companies by himself as a duly authorized officer. IN WITNESS WHEREOF, I hereunto set my hand and official seal. My Commission expires the 30th day of June, 2028 This Power of Attorney is granted under and by the authority of the following resolutions adopted by the Boards of Directors of each of the Companies, which resolutions are now in full force and effect, reading as follows: RESOLVED, that the Chairman, the President, any Vice Chairman, any Executive Vice President, any Senior Vice President, any Vice President, any Second Vice President, the Treasurer, any Assistant Treasurer, the Corporate Secretary or any Assistant Secretary may appoint Attorneys -in -Fact and Agents to act for and on behalf of the Company and may give such appointee such authority as his or her certificate of authority may prescribe to sign with the Company's name and seal with the Company's seal bonds, recognizances, contracts of indemnity, and other writings obligatory in the nature of a bond, recognizance, or conditional undertaking, and any of said officers or the Board of Directors at any time may remove any such appointee and revoke the power given him or her; and it is FURTHER RESOLVED, that the Chairman, the President, any Vice Chairman, any Executive Vice President, any Senior Vice President or any Vice President may delegate all or any part of the foregoing authority to one or more officers or employees of this Company, provided that each such delegation is in writing and a copy thereof is filed in the office of the Secretary; and it is FURTHER RESOLVED, that any bond, recognizance, contract of indemnity, or writing obligatory in the nature of a bond, recognizance, or conditional undertaking shall be valid and binding upon the Company when (a) signed by the President, any Vice Chairman, any Executive Vice President, any Senior Vice President or any Vice President, any Second Vice President, the Treasurer, any Assistant Treasurer, the Corporate Secretary or any Assistant Secretary and duly attested and sealed with the Company's seal by a Secretary or Assistant Secretary; or (b) duly executed (under seal, if required) by one or more Attorneys -in -Fact and Agents pursuant to the power prescribed in his or her certificate or their certificates of authority or by one or more Company officers pursuant to a written delegation of authority; and it is FURTHER RESOLVED, that the signature of each of the following officers: President, any Executive Vice President, any Senior Vice President, any Vice President, any Assistant Vice President, any Secretary, any Assistant Secretary, and the seal of the Company may be affixed by facsimile to any Power of Attorney or to any certificate relating thereto appointing Resident Vice Presidents, Resident Assistant Secretaries or Attorneys -in - Fact for purposes only of executing and attesting bonds and undertakings and other writings obligatory in the nature thereof, and any such Power of Attorney or certificate bearing such facsimile signature or facsimile seal shall be valid and binding upon the Company and any such power so executed and certified by such facsimile signature and facsimile seal shall be valid and binding on the Company in the future with respect to any bond or understanding to which it is attached. i, Kevin E. Hughes, the undersigned, Assistant Secretary of each of the Companies, do hereby certify that the above and foregoing is a true and correct copy of the Power of Attorney executed by said Companies, which remains in full force and effect. Dated this 17th day of August , 2022 Kevin E. Hughes, Assistant Secretary To verily the authentfdtyofthisPowerofAttotney,pleasecalltaiat1-800-421-3880. Please refer to the above-named At nrey(s)-Inlactand the details of the bond to which this Power of Attorney Is attached. • • • ACKNOWLEDGMENT OF SURETY COMPANY STATE OF NEW YORK } COUNTY OF NASSAU On this (-4.,t'f 11 20 L Z, before me personally came Camille Maitland to me known, who, being by me duly sworn, did depose and say; that he/she resides in Nassau County , State of New York that he/she is the Attorney -In -Fact of the Travelers Casualty and Surety Company of America the corporation described in which executed the above instrument; that he/she knows the seal of said corporation; that the seal affixed to said instrument is such corporate seal; that is was so affixed by the Board of Directors of said corporation; and that he/she signed his/her name thereto by like order; and the affiant did further depose and say that the Superintendent of Insurance of the State of New York, has pursuant to Section 1111 of the Insurance Law of the State of New York, issued to Travelers Casualty and Surety Company of America (Surety) his/her certificate of qualification evidencing the qualification of said Company and its sufficiency under any law of the State of New York as surety and guarantor, and the propriety of accepting and approving it as such; and that such certificate has noten revoked. C,.. idle/ NY acknowledgement Nota : blic NELLY RENCHIWICH M Notary Public -State of New York No. 01RE6218158 Qualified in Nassau County Commission Expires March 1, 2026 • TRAVELERS CASUALTY AND SURETY COMPANY OF AMERICA HARTFORD, CONNECTICUT 06183 FINANCIAL STATEMENT AS OF DECEMBER 31, 2021 CAPITAL STOCK $ 6,480.000 ASSETS UABIUTIES & SURPLUS BONDS STOCKS CASH AND INVESTED CASH OTHER INVESTED ASSETS SECURITIES LENDING REINVESTED COLLATERAL ASSETS INVESTMENT INCOME DUE AND ACCRUED PREMIUM BALANCES REINSURANCE RECOVERABLE NET DEFERRED TAX ASSET OTHER ASSETS diAL ASSETS $ 4,427,068,873 90,892,083 3,978,380 4,609,133 7,433,088 37,877,324 294,081,729 70,877,848 80,158,980 3,288,709 $ 5,000,059,916 LOSSES LOSS ADJUSTMENT EXPENSES COMMISSIONS OTHER EXPENSES TAXES, LICENSES AND FEES CURRENT FEDERAL AND FOREIGN INCOME TAXES UNEARNED PREMIUMS ADVANCE PREMIUM POLICYHOLDER DIVIDENDS CEDED REINSURANCE NET PREMIUMS PAYABLE AMOUNTS WITHHELD / RETAINED BY COMPANY FOR OTHERS REMITTANCES AND ITEMS NOT ALLOCATED PROVISION FOR REINSURANCE PAYABLE TO PARENT, SUBSIDIARIES AND AFFIUATES PAYABLE FOR SECURITIES LENDING ESCHEAT UABILITY RETROACTIVE REINSURANCE RESERVE ASSUMED OTHER ACCRUED EXPENSES AND UABIU11ES TOTAL LIABILITIES CAPITAL STOCK PAID IN SURPLUS OTHER SURPLUS TOTAL SURPLUS TO POLICYHOLDERS:7 TOTAL UABILITIES & SURPLUS $ 1,224,258,147 157,266.812 49.977,844 48,807,590 18,856,025 1,972,277 1,212,347,829 1.824,313 14,256,052 47,473,819 42,097,038 10,679,448 6,873,132 40,373,235 7,433,086 537,132 816,092 250,005 $ 2,881,898,277 $ 6,480,000 433,003,780 1,878.177.878 4 2,118,481,838 •$6,000,069,915 tosigi. STATE OF CONNECTICUT COUNTY OF HARTFORD CITY OF HARTFORD ) SS. MICHAEL J. DOODY, BEING DULY SWORN, SAYS THAT HE IS VICE PRESIDENT - FINANCE, OF TRAVELERS CASUALTY AND SURETY COMPANY OF AMERICA, AND THAT TO THE BEST OF HIS KNOWLEDGE AND BELIEF, THE FOREGOING IS A TRUE AND CORRECT STATEMENT OF THE FINANCIAL CONDITION OF SAID COMPANY AS OF THE 31ST DAY OF DECEMBER, 2021. SUBSCRIBED AND SWORN TO BEFORE ME THIS 17TH DAY OF MARCH, 2022 • ---7/79 a Z°edr VICE PRESIDENT - CE r t r1���A52 NOTARY PUBLIC SUSAN M. WEISSLEDER Notary Public My Commission Expires November 30, 2022 J • • • C H U B B N Power of Attorney Federal Insurance Company I Vigilant Insurance Company 1 Pacific Indemnity Company Westchester Fire Insurance Company 1 ACE American Insurance Company Know All by These Presents, that FEDERAL INSURANCE COMPANY, an Indiana corporation, VIGILANT INSURANCE COMPANY, a New York corporation, PACIFIC INDEMNITY COMPANY, a Wisconsin corporation, WESTCHESTER FIRE INSURANCE COMPANY and me AMERICAN INSURANCE COMPANY corporations of the Commonwealth of Pennsylvania, do each hereby constitute and appoint Katherine Acosta, Thomas Bean, George 0. Brewster, Desiree Cardlin, Colette R. Chisholm, Dana Granice, Susan Lupskl, Gerard 5. Macholz, Camille Maitland, Robert T. Pearson, Nelly Renchiwich, Rita Losquadro, Vincent A. Walsh, Michelle Wannamaker and Ian Williams of Uniondale, New York each as their true and lawful Attorney -In -Fact to execute under such designation in their names and to affix their corporate seals to and deliver for and on their behalf as surety thereon or otherwise, bonds and undertakings and other writings obligatory in the nature thereof (other than bail bonds) given or executed in the course of business, and any instruments amending or altering the same, and consents to the modification or alteration of any instrument referred to in said bonds or obligations. In Witness Whereof, said FEDERAL INSURANCE COMPANY, VIGILANT INSURANCE COMPANY, PACIFIC INDEMNITY COMPANY, WESTCHESTER FIRE INSURANCE COMPANY and ACE AMERICAN INSURANCE COMPANY have each executed and attested these presents and affixed their corporate seals on this 2.1 day of August, 2022. ikiwn M. Ctilon ARcislaniSvcrcrary STATE OF NEW JERSEY County of Hunterdon ss. Stephen M. Haney. Vice Preident On this Zea day of August, 2022 before me, a Notary Public of New Jersey, personally came Dawn M. Chloros and Stephen M. Haney, to me known to be Assistant Secretary and Vire President respectively, of FEDERAL INSURANCE COMPANY, VIGILANT INSURANCE COMPANY, PACIFIC INDEMNITY COMPANY, WESTCHESTER FIRE INSURANCE COMPANY and ACE AMERICAN INSURANCE COMPANY, the companies which executed the foregoing Power of Attorney, and the said Dawn M. Chloros and Stephen M. Haney, being by me duly sworn. severally and each for herself and himself did depose and say that they are Assistant Secretary and Vice President respectively, of FEDERAL INSURANCE COMPANY, VIGILANT INSURANCE COMPANY, PACIFIC INDEMNITY COMPANY, WESTCHESTER FIRE INSURANCE COMPANY and ACE AMERICAN INSURANCE COMPANY and know the corporate seals thereof, that the seals affixed to the foregoing Power of Attorney are such corporate seals and were thereto affixed by authority of said Companies; and that their signatures as such officers were duly affixed and subscribed by like authority. Notarial Seal KATHERINE J. ADELAAR NOTARY PUBLIC OF NEW JERSEY No. 2316086 Commission Expires July 16, 2024 CERTIFICATION Resolutions adopted by the Boards of Directors of FEDERAL INSURANCE COMPANY, VIGILANT INSURANCE COMPANY, and PACIFIC INDEMNITY COMPANY on August 30, 2016; WESTCHESTER FIRE INSURANCE COMPANY on December 11, 2006; and ACE AMERICAN INSURANCE COMPANY on March 20, 2009: 'RESOLVED, that the following authorisations relate to the execution, for and on behalf of the Company, of bonds, undertakings, reeognhancea, contracts and other written commitments of the Company entered into in the ordinary course of business (each a' Written Commitment"): (1) Each of the Chairman, the President and the Vice Presidents of the Company is hereby authorized to execute any Written Commitment for and on behalf of the Company, under the seal of the Company or otherwise. (2) Each duly eppolnted attorney-in-fact of die Company is hereby authorized to execute any Written Commitment for and on behalf of the Company, under the seal of the Company or otherwise, to the extent that such action is authorized by the grant of powers provided for in such persons written appointment as such attorney-in-fact (9) Beth of the Chairmen. the President and the Vis. Presidents of the Company te herby authorized, for and on behalf of the Company, to appoint in writing any person the ettorney.tn, fact of the Company with NII power and authority to execute, for and on behalf of the Company, under the seal of the Company or otherwise, such W,itten Comn,Itn,ents 01 the Company as may be specified in such written appointment which specification may be by general type or class of Written Commitments or by specification of one or more particular Written Commitments. (4) Bach of the Chairman, the President and the Vim Presidents of the Company is hereby autliorlzed, for and on behalf of the Company, to delegate in writing to any other officer oldie Company the authority u, execute, for and on behalf of the Company, under the Company's seal or otherwise, such Written Commitments of the Company as are specified In such written delegation, which specification may be by general type or class of Written Commitments or by specification of one or more partlalar Written Commitments. (5) The signature of any officer or other person executing any Written Commitment or appointment or delegation pursuant to this Resolution, and the seal of the Company, may be affixed by facsimile on such Written Commitment or wrRhenappointment or delegation. FURTHER RESOLVED, that the foregoing Resolution shall not be deemed to bean exclusive statement of the powers and authority of officers, employees and other persons to act for and on behalf of the Company, and such Resolution Mall not Emltorothetwise affect the exercise ofany sutra power or authority otherwise validly granted or vested,' 1. Dawn M. Chloros, Assistant Secretary of FEDERAL INSURANCE COMPANY, VIGILANT INSURANCE COMPANY, PACIFIC INDEMNITY COMPANY, WESTCHESTER FIRE INSURANCE COMPANY and ACE AMERICAN INSURANCE COMPANY (the 'Companies') do hereby certify that (1) the foregoing Resolutions adopted by the Board of Directors of the Companies are true, correct and in full force and effect, ((i) the foregoing Power of Attorney is true, correct and in full force and effect, Given under my hand and seats of said Companies at Whitehouse Station, NJ, this August 17, 2022 Ikiv.11 M. liths w. ,assistant secret:ay' IN THE EVENT YOU WISH TO VERIFY THE AUTHENTICITY Oit' ifl6 B0Nikelr U3: OF ANY OTHER MATTER, PLEASE CONTACT US AT: Telephone (908) 903- 3493 fax (9tTB'.N0I`, e -matt suretrechubbcom Combined FED-VIG.PI•WFIC-AAIC (rev. 11.13) • • ACKNOWLEDGMENT OF SURETY COMPANY STATE OF NEW YORK } COUNTY OF NASSAU On this Au a rf 11) 2 TL 2, before me personally came Camille Maitland to me known, who, bding by me duly sworn, did depose and say; that he/she resides in Nassau County , State of New York that he/she is the Attorney -In -Fact of the Federal Insurance Company the corporation described in which executed the above instrument; that he/she knows the seal of said corporation; that the seal affixed to said instrument is such corporate seal; that is was so affixed by the Board of Directors of said corporation; and that he/she signed his/her name thereto by like order; and the affiant did further depose and say that the Superintendent of Insurance of the State of New York, has pursuant to Section 1111 of the Insurance Law of the State of New York, issued to Federal Insurance Company (Surety) his/her certificate of qualification evidencing the qualification of said Company and its sufficiency under any law of the State of New York as surety and guarantor, and the propriety of accepting and approving it as such; and that such certificate has of b n revoked NY acknowledgement * -'(-7 Notary .Iic NE Y RENCHIWICH M Notary Public -State of New York No. 01RE6218158 Qualified in Nassau County Commission Expires March 1, 2026 • • • FEDERAL INSURANCE COMPANY STATIEENT OF ASSETS, UABMJTiES AND SURPLUS TO POUCYHOLDERS Stakrlory Basis December 31.2021 ASSETS Cash and Shat Tenn Investments Untied States Government State and Municipal Bonds Oiler Bonds Stride Other Invested Assets TOTAL INVESTMENTS Investments in Affiliates: Great Natsm Inns. Co. Vigilant Ins Co. Chubb Indemnity Ins, Co. Chubb National Ins. Co. OtherAMBates Premiums Receivable Other Assets TOTAL ADMITTED ASSETS S (587.308) 4.271,534 5,994,873 675,588 1,647.712 1Z022.201 414,638 354,696 183.242 190,801 116,373 1,726,653 3.078.466 i 18,087.070 (M thousands) LIAB1L TIES AND SURPLUS TO POUCYHOLDERS Outstanding Loses and Loss Expanses i 8,701.383 Raknurance Payable on Lases and Expenses 1,484,198 Unearned Prem ms 2A00,711 Ceded Reinsurance Premiums Payable 386,332 Other Liabilities 498,472 TOTAL. LIABILITIES Capital Stock Paid -in Surplus Unassigned Funds SURPLUS TO POUCYHOLDERS TOTAL UASIUT1ES AND SURPLUS 13.451.094 20.980 2,711,474 1.903.522 4.835.978 318,087,070 Investments are valued in accordance with requirements of the Nations! Assodaton of Insurance Commissioners, At December 31, 2021, investments with a carrying value of 3509,085,162 were deposited with gove mnrd authorities ties as required by law. STATE OF PENNSYLVANIA COUNTY OF PHILADELPHIA John Taylor, being duly sworn, says that he is Senior Vice Provident of Federal Insurance Compo ny and that to is bat of his knowledge and belief the foregoing is a true and correct statement of the said Company's Mendel condition as of the 31 et day of December. 2021. Swan before March 1 t, i 2022. Commonwealth• Notary Seal Yates,Jaime L. P Nita Public Philadelphia CoUMy My commission eupke6 Seeletiber 19, 2023 Commission number 1 070 Member, Pennsylvania Association of Notaries i y A�COO R® CERTIFICATE OF LIABILITY INSURANCE DATE (MM/DD/YYYY) 08/20/2022 THIS CERTIFICATE IS ISSUED AS A MATTER OF INFORMATION ONLY AND CONFERS NO RIGHTS UPON THE CERTIFICATE HOLDER. THIS CERTIFICATE DOES NOT AFFIRMATIVELY OR NEGATIVELY AMEND, EXTEND OR ALTER THE COVERAGE AFFORDED BY THE POLICIES BELOW. THIS CERTIFICATE OF INSURANCE DOES NOT CONSTITUTE A CONTRACT BETWEEN THE ISSUING INSURER(S), AUTHORIZED EPRESENTATIVE OR PRODUCER, AND THE CERTIFICATE HOLDER. IMPORTANT: If the certificate holder is an[ADD1TLONAt INSURED, the pohcy�ies� IrFmiIi st have ADDITIONAL INSURED provisions or be endorsed. If SUBROGATION IS WAIVED, subject to the terms ArtdrcOiditibns of the policy, certain policies may require an endorsement. A statement on this certificate does not confer rights to thl certificate btlIdbr in -lieu of such endorserbent(s). PRODUCER ***MARSH USA INC 1166 AVENUE OF THE AMERICAS NEW YORK, NY 10036 Phone: 866-966-4664 Emcor.Certrequest@marsh.com / Fax 203-229-678 :; g CN102796740-POOLE-TAM-21-22 18-0V7420443 CONTACT NAME` FAX PHONE.No. Ext): (A/C, No): E-MAILDR INSURER(S) AFFORDING COVERAGE NAIC # INSURt RA : Continental Casualty Company COMMERCIAL GENERAL LIABILITY INSURED - - POOLE & KENT COMPANY OF FLORIDA 1715 WEST LEMON STREET TAMPA, FL 33606 GL 7015289851 20427 INSURER B : American Casualty Company of Reading, PA INSURER C : Transportation Insurance Co 20494 INSURER D : Continental Insurance Company 35289 INSURER E : OCCUR INSURER F : $ 1.000,000 COVERAGES CERTIFICATE NUMBER: NYC -011378217-01 REVISION NUMBER: 1 THIS IS TO CERTIFY THAT THE POLICIES OF INSURANCE LISTED BELOW HAVE BEEN ISSUED TO THE INSURED NAMED ABOVE FOR THE POLICY PERIOD INDICATED. NOTWITHSTANDING ANY REQUIREMENT, TERM OR CONDITION OF ANY CONTRACT OR OTHER DOCUMENT WITH RESPECT TO WHICH THIS CERTIFICATE MAY BE ISSUED OR MAY PERTAIN, THE INSURANCE AFFORDED BY THE POLICIES DESCRIBED HEREIN IS SUBJECT TO ALL THE TERMS, EXCLUSIONS AND CONDITIONS OF SUCH POLICIES. LIMITS SHOWN MAY HAVE BEEN REDUCED BY PAID CLAIMS. INSR LTR TYPE OF INSURANCE ADDL INSD SUBR WVD POLICY NUMBER POLICY EFF (MM/DD/YYYY) POLICY EXP (MM/DD/YYYY) LIMITS A X COMMERCIAL GENERAL LIABILITY GL 7015289851 10/01/2021 10/01/2022 EACH OCCURRENCE $ 2,000,000 CLAIMS -MADE X OCCUR DAMAGE TO PREMISES (EaEoccuE occurrence) $ 1.000,000 MED EXP (Any one person) $ 25,000 PERSONAL & ADV INJURY $ 2,000,000 GENERAL AGGREGATE $ 6,000,000 GEN'L AGGREGATE POLICY OTHER: X LIMIT APPLIES jp- PER: LOC14,000,000 PRODUCTS-COMP/OPAGG $ $ AUTOMOBILE X X LIABILITY ANY AUTO OWNED AUTOS ONLY HIRED AUTOS ONLY x SCHEDULED AUTOS NON -OWNED AUTOS ONLY BUA 7015289882 10/01/2021 10/01/2022 COMBINED SINGLE LIMIT (Ea accident) $ 2,000,000 BODILY INJURY (Per person) $ BODILY INJURY (Per accident) $ PROPERTY DAMAGE (Per accident) $ Auto Physical Damage $ Included D X UMBRELLA LIAB EXCESS LIAB X OCCUR CLAIMS -MADE CUE 7015644968 10/01/2021 10/01/2022 EACH OCCURRENCE $ 5,000,000 AGGREGATE $ 5,000,000 $ DED X RETENT ON $10,000 B B c WORKERS COMPENSATION AND EMPLOYERS' LIABILITY ANIPROPRIETORIPARTNER/EXECUTIVE OFFICER/MEMBEREXCLUDED? (Mandatory In NH) If yes, describe under DESCRIPTION OF OPERATIONS below Y / N N N /A WC 7015294418 (AOS) WC 7015294385 (CA) WC 7015302405(AZ, OR, WI)10/01/2021 10/01/2021 10/01/2021 10/01/2022 10/01/2022 10/01/2022 X PER STATUTE OTH- ER E.L. EACH ACCIDENT $ 1.000,000 E.L. DISEASE - EA EMPLOYEE $ 1.000,000 E.L. DISEASE - POLICY LIMIT $ 1,000,000 DESCRIPTION OF OPERATIONS / LOCATIONS / VEHICLES (ACORD 101, Additional Remarks Schedule, may be attached If more space is required) RE: 18 -0047 -UT - MARSHALL STREET WRF PROCESS CONTROL GATE REPAIRS (FDEP). ADDITIONAL INSURED UNDER ALL POLICIES (EXCEPT WORKERS COMPENSATION & EMPLOYERS LIABILITY) WHERE REQUIRED BY CONTRACT: CITY OF CLEARWATER. COVERAGE PROVIDED TO THE ADDITIONAL INSUREDS IS PRIMARY & NON-CONTRIBUTORY. WAIVER OF SUBROGATION AS REQUIRED BY CONTRACT AND WHERE NOT PROHIBITED BY LAW. CONTRACTUAL LIABILITY IS INCLUDED IN THE GENERAL LIABILITY COVERAGE FORM. CERTIFICATE HOLDER CANCELLATION CITY OF CLEARWATER ATTN: CONTRACT AND PROCUREMENT SPECIALIST ENGINEERING DEPARTMENT P.O. BOX 4748 CLEARWATER, FL 33758-4748 SHOULD ANY OF THE ABOVE DESCRIBED POLICIES BE CANCELLED BEFORE THE EXPIRATION DATE THEREOF, NOTICE WILL BE DELIVERED IN ACCORDANCE WITH THE POLICY PROVISIONS. AUTHORIZED REPRESENTATIVE of Marsh USA Inc. -..Ca.uar,t.. �4wL.Ce_r tt ACORD 25 (2016/03) © 1988-2016 ACORD CORPORATION. All rights reserved. The ACORD name and logo are registered marks of ACORD RO® AGENCY CUSTOMER ID: CN102796740 LOC #: Norwalk ADDITIONAL REMARKS SCHEDULE Page 2 of 2 NCY ***MARSH USA INC NAMED INSURED POOLE & KENT COMPANY OF FLORIDA 1715 WEST LEMON STREET TAMPA, FL 33606 POLICY NUMBER CARRIER NAIC CODE EFFECTIVE DATE: ADDITIONAL REMARKS THIS ADDITIONAL REMARKS FORM IS A SCHEDULE TO ACORD FORM, FORM NUMBER: 25 FORM TITLE: Certificate of Liability Insurance AUTO PHYSICAL DAMAGE COMP / COLL DEDUCTIBLE $500 IN THE EVENT OF CANCELLATION OR MATERIAL CHANGE THAT REDUCES OR RESTRICTS THE INSURANCE AFFORDED BY THIS COVERAGE PART (OTHER THAN THE REDUCTION OF AGGREGATE LIMITS THROUGH PAYMENT OF CLAIMS AS APPLICABLE), INSURER AGREES TO MAIL PRIOR WRITTEN NOTICE OF CANCELLATION OR MATERIAL CHANGE TO: CERTIFICATE HOLDER SCHEDULE 1. NUMBER OF DAYS ADVANCE NOTICE: FOR ANY STATUTORILY PERMITTED REASON OTHER THAN NON-PAYMENT OF PREMIUM, THE NUMBER OF DAYS REQUIRED FOR NOTICE OF CANCELLATION AS PROVIDED IN PARAGRAPH 2 OF EITHER THE CANCELLATION COMMON POLICY CONDITIONS OR AS AMENDED BY THE APPLICABLE STATE CANCELLATION ENDORSEMENT IS INCREASED TO THE LESSER OF 60 DAYS OR THE NUMBER OF DAYS REQUIRED IN A WRITTEN CONTRACT. FOR NON-PAYMENT OF PREMIUM, THE GREATER OF (1) THE NUMBER OF DAYS REQUIRED BY STATE LAW OR (2) THE NUMBER OF DAYS REQUIRED BY WRITTEN CONTRACT. 2. NAME: NOTICE WILL BE MAILED TO: CERTIFICATE HOLDER • ACORD 101 (2008/01) © 2008 ACORD CORPORATION. All rights reserved. The ACORD name and logo are registered marks of ACORD CNA • POLICY NUIIIBER: GL 7015289851 NAMED INSURED: EMCOR GROUP, INC. POLICY TERM: 10/01/2021 to 10101/2022 G -300703-A (Ed. 05/09) THIS ENDORSEMENT CHANGES THE POLICY. PLEASE READ IT CAREFULLY. AMENDMENT - OTHER INSURANCE PRIMARY AND NON-CONTRIBUTORY This endorsement modifies insurance provided under the following: COMMERCIAL GENERAL LIABILITY COVERAGE PART Paragraph a. Primary Insurance of 4. Other Insurance of Section IV- Commercial General Liability Conditions is deleted and replaced with the following: a. Primary Insurance (1) You have agreed in writing in a contract or This itsuranoe is primary except when Paragraph b. agreement that this insurance will be primary below applies. If this insurance is primary, our and non-contributory; and obligations are not affected unless any of the other (2) The written contract or written agreement was insurance is also primary. Then, we will share with executed prior to: all that other insurance by the method described in (a) The "today injury or "property damage"; or Paragraph c. below. However, coverage afforded to an additional insured under the terms of an (b) The offense that caused the "personal and endorsement attached to this policy is primary advertising injury insurance and we will not seek contribution from any such additional insureds primary insurance if: for which the additional insured seeks coverage under this Coverage Part G -300703-A Includes copyrighted material of Insurance Services Office, Inc., with its pemdsslon. Page 1 of 1 (Ed. 05/09) • • • POLICY NUMBER: GL 7015289851 NAMED INSURED: EMCOR Group, Inc. POLICY TERM: 10-01-2021 to 10-01-2022 CG 201010 93 THIS ENDORSEMENT CHANGES THE POLICY. PLEASE READ IT CAREFULLY. ADDITIONAL INSURED - OWNERS, LESSEES OR CONTRACTORS (FORM B) This endorsement modifies insurance provided under the following: COMMERCIAL GENERAL LIABILITY COVERAGE PART SCHEDULE Name of Person or Organization: ALL PERSONS OR ORGANIZATIONS FOR WHOM YOU ARE REQUIRED BY CONTRACT TO ADD AS AN ADDITIONAL INSURED BUT ONLY IF THE PERSON OR ORGANIZATION DOES NOT QUALIFY AS AN ADDITIONAL INSURED WITH RESPECT TO WORK PERFORMED BY OR FOR YOU PURSUANT TO THAT CONTRACT OR ANOTHER ADDITIONAL INSURED ENDORSEMENT ATTACHED TO AND FORMING A PART OF THIS POLICY. Of no entry appears above, information required to complete this endorsement will be shown in the Declarations as ap- plicable to this endorsement.) WHO IS AN INSURED (Section 9) is amended to include as an insured the person or organization shown in the Sched- ule, but only with respect to IiabBty arising out of your ongoing operates performed for that insured. CG20101093 Hart rams & Services Reorder No. 144737 Copyright, Insurance Services Office, Inc., 1992 Page 1 of 1 i • • POLICY NUMBER: GL 7015289851 NAMED INSURED: EM(,OK (;roup, inc. POLICY TERM: 10-01-2021 to 10-01-2022 COMMERCIAL GENERAL LIABIUTY CG 20 37 07 04 THIS ENDORSEMENT CHANGES THE POLICY. PLEASE READ IT CAREFULLY. ADDITIONAL INSURED - OWNERS, LESSEES OR CONTRACTORS - COMPLETED OPERATIONS This endorsement modifies instance provided under the foiowing: COMMERCIAL GENERAL LIABIUTY COVERAGE PART SCHEDULE Name Of Additional Insured Person(s) Or Organization(s): Location And Description Of Completed Operations PERSONS OR ORGANIZATIONS FOR WHOM AS PER THE WRITTEN CONTRACT OR YOU ARE REQUIRED BY CONTRACT TO ADD AS WRITTEN AGREEMENT, PROVIDED THE AN ADDITIONAL INSURED FOR COMPLETED LOCATION IS WITHIN THE "COVERAGE OPERATIONS COVERAGE BUT ONLY IF THE TERRITORY" OF THIS COVERAGE PART. PERSON OR ORGANIZATION DOES NOT QUALPY AS AN ADDTIONAL INSURED FOR COMPLETED OPERATIONS ON ANOTHER ADDITIONAL INSURED ENDORSEMENT ATTACHED TO AND FORMING A PART OF THIS POLICY. Information required to complete this Schedule, if not shown above, will be shown in the Declarations. Section I1 — Who Is An Insured is amended to include as an additional insured the person(s) or organization(s) shown in the Schedule, but only with respect to liability for "bodily injury" or "property dam- age' caused, in whole or in part, by "your work" at the location designated and described in the sched- ule of this endorsement performed for that additional insured and included in the 'products -completed operations hazard'. CG 20 37 07 04 0 ISO Properties, Inc., 2004 Page 1 of 1 0